Escolar Documentos
Profissional Documentos
Cultura Documentos
Unit 1 Unit 2
Current Theories and Practice Building the NurseClient Relationship
1 5
Foundations of Psychiatric- Therapeutic Relationships 00
Mental Health Nursing 00
Components of a Therapeutic Relationship 00
Mental Health and Mental Illness 00 Types of Relationships 00
Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Establishing the Therapeutic Relationship 00
Mental Disorders (DSM-IV-TR) 00 Avoiding Behaviors That Diminish the
Historical Perspectives of the Treatment of Mental Illness 00 Therapeutic Relationship 00
Mental Illness in the 21st Century 00 Roles of the Nurse in a Therapeutic Relationship 00
Psychiatric Nursing Practice 00 Self-Awareness Issues 00
Self-Awareness Issues 00
2 6
Therapeutic Communication 00
Neurobiologic Theories
and Psychopharmacology 00 What Is Therapeutic Communication? 00
Verbal Communication Skills 00
The Nervous System and How It Works 00 Nonverbal Communication Skills 00
Brain Imaging Techniques 00 Understanding the Meaning of Communication 00
Neurobiologic Causes of Mental Illness 00 Understanding Context 00
The Nurses Role in Research and Education 00 Understanding Spirituality 00
Psychopharmacology 00
Cultural Considerations 00
Cultural Considerations 00
The Therapeutic Communication Session 00
Self-Awareness Issues 00
Community-Based Care 00
Self-Awareness Issues 00
3
Psychosocial Theories and Therapy 00 7
Psychosocial Theories 00 Clients Response to Illness 00
Cultural Considerations 00
Treatment Modalities 00 Individual Factors 00
The Nurse and Psychosocial Interventions 00 Interpersonal Factors 00
Self-Awareness Issues 00 Cultural Factors 00
Self-Awareness Issues 00
4
Treatment Settings and Therapeutic Programs 00
8
Assessment 00
Treatment Settings 00
Psychiatric Rehabilitation Programs 00 Factors Influencing Assessment 00
Special Populations of Clients With Mental Illness 00 How to Conduct the Interview 00
Interdisciplinary Team 00 Content of the Assessment 00
Psychosocial Nursing in Public Health and Home Care 00 Data Analysis 00
Self-Awareness Issues 00 Self-Awareness Issues 00
xiii
xiv Contents
Types of Losses 00
The Grieving Process 00
16
Dimensions of Grieving 00 Personality Disorders 00
Cultural Considerations 00 Categories of Personality Disorders 00
Disenfranchised Grief 00 Onset and Clinical Course 00
Complicated Grieving 00 Etiology 00
Application of the Nursing Process 00 Cultural Considerations 00
Self-Awareness Issues 00 Treatment 00
Paranoid Personality Disorder 00
Schizoid Personality Disorder 00
Unit 4 Schizotypal Personality Disorder 00
Nursing Practice for Psychiatric Disorders Antisocial Personality Disorder 00
Application of the Nursing Process:
Antisocial Personality Disorder 00
13 Borderline Personality Disorder 00
Anxiety and Anxiety Disorders 00 Application of the Nursing Process:
Borderline Personality Disorder 00
Anxiety as a Response to Stress 00 Histrionic Personality Disorder 00
Incidence 00 Narcissistic Personality Disorder 00
Onset and Clinical Course 00 Avoidant Personality Disorder 00
Related Disorders 00 Dependent Personality Disorder 00
Etiology 00 Obsessive-Compulsive Personality Disorder 00
Cultural Considerations 00 Depressive Personality Disorder 00
Treatment 00 Passive-Aggressive Personality Disorder 00
Contents xv
17 20
Substance Abuse 00 Child and Adolescent Disorders 00
Types of Substance Abuse 00 Autistic Disorder 00
Onset and Clinical Course 00 Retts Disorder 00
Related Disorders 00 Childhood Disintegrative Disorder 00
Etiology 00 Aspergers Disorder 00
Cultural Considerations 00 Attention Deficit Hyperactivity Disorder 00
Types of Substances and Treatment 00 Application of the Nursing Process: ADHD 00
Treatment and Prognosis 00 Conduct Disorder 00
Application of the Nursing Process 00 Application of the Nursing Process: Conduct Disorder 00
Community-Based Care 00 Community-Based Care 00
Mental Health Promotion 00 mental health promotion 00
Substance Abuse in Health Professionals 00 Oppositional Defiant Disorder 00
Self-Awareness Issues 00 Pica 00
Rumination Disorder 00
18 Feeding Disorder 00
Tourettes Disorder 00
Eating Disorders 00 Chronic Motor or Tic Disorder 00
Overview of Eating Disorders 00 Separation Anxiety Disorder 00
Etiology 00 Selective Mutism 00
Cultural Considerations 00 Reactive Attachment Disorder 00
Treatment 00 Stereotypic Movement Disorder 00
Application of the Nursing Process 00 Self-Awareness Issues 00
Community-Based Care 00
Mental Health Promotion 00 21
Self-Awareness Issues 00
Cognitive Disorders 00
19 Delirium 00
Application of the Nursing Process: Delirium 00
Somatoform Disorders 00
Community-Based Care 00
Overview of Somatoform Disorders 00 Dementia 00
Onset and Clinical Course 00 Application of the Nursing Process: Dementia 00
Related Disorders 00 Community-Based Care 00
Etiology 00 mental health promotion 00
Cultural Considerations 00 Role of the Caregiver 00
Treatment 00 Related Disorders 00
Application of the Nursing Process 00 Self-Awareness Issues 00
Preface
The second edition of Psychiatric Mental Health Nurs- Unit 4: Nursing Practice for Psychiatric Dis-
ing continues to have students as the primary focus. orders covers all the major categories identified in the
It presents sound nursing theory, therapeutic modal- DSM-IV-TR. Each chapter provides current informa-
ities, and clinical applications across the treatment tion on etiology, onset and clinical course, treatment,
continuum. Chapters are short, to the point, and easy and nursing care.
to read and understand. They highlight and empha-
size important material to facilitate student learning. New Features in the Second Edition
This text uses the nursing process framework and
A new chapter on Legal and Ethical Issues ad-
emphasizes assessment, therapeutic communication,
dresses some current dilemmas in psychiatric
neurobiologic theory, and pharmacology throughout.
nursing today.
Interventions focus on all aspects of client care, in-
Sections on Mental Health Promotion in
cluding communication, client and family teaching,
Units 3 & 4 include the latest research.
and community resources, and their practical appli-
Additional NCLEX-style multiple-choice ques-
cation in various clinical settings.
tions are found in the Chapter Study Guide
sections.
Organization of the Text Updates in pharmacology include new drugs
Unit 1: Current Theories and Practice provides a currently being tested and FDA Black Box
Warnings for psychotropic medications.
strong foundation for students. It addresses current
Additional artwork illustrates key terms and
issues in psychiatric nursing, as well as the many
concepts.
treatment settings in which nurses encounter clients.
It discusses neurobiologic theories and psychophar-
macology and psychosocial theories and therapy Pedagogical Features
thoroughly as a basis for understanding mental illness Psychiatric Mental Health Nursing incorporates
and its treatment. several pedagogical features designed to facilitate
Unit 2: Building the NurseClient Relationship student learning:
presents the basic elements essential to the practice Learning Objectives to focus the students read-
of mental health nursing. Chapters on therapeutic ing and study
relationships and therapeutic communication pre- Key Terms that identify new terms used in
pare students to begin working with clients both in the chapter. Each term is identified in bold
mental health settings and in all other areas of nurs- and defined in the text.
ing practice. The chapter on the clients response to Application of the nursing process using the as-
illness provides a framework for understanding the sessment framework presented in Chapter 8,
individual client. An entire chapter is devoted to as- so students can compare and contrast the var-
sessment, emphasizing its importance in nursing. ious disorders more easily
Unit 3: Current Social and Emotional Concerns Critical thinking questions to stimulate stu-
covers topics that are not exclusive to mental health dents thinking about current dilemmas and
settings, including legal and ethical issues; anger, issues in mental health
aggression, and hostility; abuse and violence; and Key points that summarize chapter content to
grief and loss. Nurses in all practice settings find reinforce important concepts
themselves confronted with issues related to these Chapter Study Guides that provide workbook-
topics. Additionally, many legal and ethical concerns style questions for students to test their knowl-
are interwoven with issues of violence and loss. edge and understanding of each chapter
ix
x PREFACE
Contributor
Chapter 12
Charlotte M. Spade, MS, RN, CS
Associate Professor of Nursing
Community College of Denver
Denver, Colorado
vii
Reviewers
Carolyn R. Pierce Buckelew, BSN, MA, APN, RNCS, Cynthia Foust, PhD, RN
NCC, ChP Associate Professor
Nursing Instructor Division of Nursing
CE Gregory School of Nursing Southwestern Oklahoma State University
Raritan Bay Medical Center Weatherford, Oklahoma
Perth Amboy, New Jersey
Judith A. Gardner, MSN, RN, CNS
Lucindra Campbell, MSN, APNP Full-Time Nursing Faculty and Consultant
Assistant Professor of Nursing Stark State College
Houston Baptist University Canton, Ohio
Houston, Texas
Alice Grady, MSN, RN, FNP
Pattie Garrett Clark, RN, MSN Assistant Professor
Associate Professor and Nursing Outreach Coordinator Nursing Department
Abraham Baldwin College Tennessee Wesleyan College, Fort Sanders
Tifton, Georgia Knoxville, Tennessee
Carol Cornwell, PhD, MS, RN, CS Mary Ann Helms, MSN, MRE, RN
Assistant Professor of Nursing and Director, Center for Assistant Professor
Nursing Scholarship Tennessee State University
Georgia Southern University School of Nursing School of Nursing
Statesboro, Georgia Nashville, Tennessee
v
vi REVIEWERS
Susan R. Seager, RN, MSN, EdD Arlene Wandel Zawadzki, MS, RN, CS, HNC
Associate Professor, Nursing Part-time Instructor
Tennessee State University School of Nursing Niagara County Community College
Nashville, Tennessee Sanborn, New York
1 Foundations
of Psychiatric-
Learning Objectives Mental Health
Nursing
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
1. Describe characteristics of
mental health and mental
illness.
2. Discuss the purpose and
use of the Diagnostic
and Statistical Manual
of Mental Disorders
(DSM-IV-TR).
3. Identify important histori-
cal landmarks in psychi-
atric care. Key Terms
4. Discuss current trends in asylum mental disorder
the treatment of people
with mental illness. case management mental health
5. Discuss the American deinstitutionalization phenomena of concern
Nurses Association stan- Diagnostic and Statistical psychotropic drugs
dards of practice for
Manual of Mental revolving door
psychiatric-mental
health nursing. Disorders (DSM-IV-TR) self-awareness
6. Describe common student managed care standards of care
concerns about psychiatric
managed care organizations utilization review firms
nursing.
2
1 FOUNDATIONS OF PSYCHIATRIC-MENTAL HEALTH NURSING 3
As you begin the study of psychiatric-mental health or cooperatively with others without losing
nursing, you may be excited, uncertain, and even a his or her autonomy.
little anxious. The field of mental health often seems Maximization of ones potential: The person is
a little unfamiliar or mysterious, making it hard to oriented toward growth and self-actualization.
imagine What is this experience going to be like? or He or she is not content with the status quo
What does a nurse do in this area? This chapter ad- and continually strives to grow as a person.
dresses these and other questions by providing an Tolerance of lifes uncertainties: The person
overview of the history of mental illness, advances in can face the challenges of day-to-day living
treatment, current issues in mental health, and the with hope and a positive outlook despite not
role of the psychiatric nurse. knowing what lies ahead.
Self-esteem: The person has a realistic aware-
ness of his or her abilities and limitations.
MENTAL HEALTH Mastery of the environment: The person can
AND MENTAL ILLNESS deal with and influence the environment in a
Mental health and mental illness are difficult to de- capable, competent, and creative manner.
fine precisely. People who can carry out their roles in Reality orientation: The person can distin-
society and whose behavior is appropriate and adap- guish the real world from a dream, fact from
tive are viewed as healthy. Conversely those who fail fantasy, and act accordingly.
to fulfill roles and carry out responsibilities or whose Stress management: The person can tolerate
behavior is inappropriate are viewed as ill. The cul- life stresses, appropriately handle anxiety or
ture of any society strongly influences its values and grief, and experience failure without devas-
beliefs, and this in turn affects how that society de- tation. He or she uses support from family
fines health and illness. What one society may view and friends to cope with crises, knowing that
as acceptable and appropriate, another society may the stress will not last forever.
see as maladaptive or inappropriate. These factors constantly interact; thus, a persons
mental health is a dynamic or ever-changing state.
Factors influencing a persons mental health can
Mental Health be categorized as individual, interpersonal, and so-
The World Health Organization (WHO) defines cial/cultural. Individual factors include a persons
health as a state of complete physical, mental, and biologic makeup, sense of harmony in life, vitality,
social wellness, not merely the absence of disease or ability to find meaning in life, emotional resilience
infirmity. This definition emphasizes health as a pos- or hardiness, spirituality, and positive identity
itive state of well-being, not just absence of disease. (Seaward, 1997). Interpersonal factors include effec-
People in a state of emotional, physical, and social tive communication, ability to help others, intimacy,
well-being fulfill life responsibilities, function effec- and a balance of separateness and connection. Social/
tively in daily life, and are satisfied with their inter- cultural factors include a sense of community, access
personal relationships and themselves. to adequate resources, intolerance of violence, and
No single, universal definition of mental health support of diversity among people. Individual, inter-
exists. Generally a persons behavior can provide clues personal, and social/cultural factors are discussed in
to his or her mental health. Because each person can Chapter 7.
have a different view or interpretation of behavior
(depending on his or her values and beliefs), the de-
termination of mental health may be difficult. In most
Mental Illness
cases, mental health is a state of emotional, psycho- The American Psychiatric Association (APA, 2000)
logical, and social wellness evidenced by satisfying defines a mental disorder as a clinically significant
interpersonal relationships, effective behavior and behavioral or psychological syndrome or pattern that
coping, positive self-concept, and emotional stabil- occurs in an individual and that is associated with
ity. Mental health has many components, and a wide present distress (e.g., a painful symptom) or disabil-
variety of factors influence it (Mohr, 2003): ity (i.e., impairment in one or more important areas
Autonomy and independence: The person of functioning) or with a significantly increased risk
can look within for guiding values and rules of suffering death, pain, disability, or an important
by which to live. He or she considers the loss of freedom (p. xxxi). General criteria to diagnose
opinions and wishes of others but does mental disorders include dissatisfaction with ones
not allow them to dictate decisions and characteristics, abilities, and accomplishments; in-
behavior. The person who is autonomous effective or nonsatisfying relationships; dissatisfac-
and independent can work interdependently tion with ones place in the world; ineffective coping
4 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
with life events; and lack of personal growth. In ad- The DSM-IV-TR has three purposes:
dition, the persons behavior must not be culturally To provide a standardized nomenclature and
expected or sanctioned, nor does deviant behavior language for all mental health professionals
necessarily indicate a mental disorder (APA, 2000). To present defining characteristics or symp-
Factors contributing to mental illness also can be toms that differentiate specific diagnoses
viewed within individual, interpersonal, and social/ To assist in identifying the underlying
cultural categories. Individual factors include bio- causes of disorders
logic makeup, anxiety, worries and fears, a sense of A multi-axial classification system that involves
disharmony in life, and a loss of meaning in ones life assessment on several axes, or domains of informa-
(Seaward, 1997). Interpersonal factors include in- tion, allows the practitioner to identify all the factors
effective communication, excessive dependency or that relate to a persons condition:
withdrawal from relationships, and loss of emotional Axis I is for identifying all major psychiatric
control. Social and cultural factors include lack of re- disorders except mental retardation and
sources, violence, homelessness, poverty, and discrim- personality disorders. Examples include
ination such as racism, classism, ageism, and sexism. depression, schizophrenia, anxiety, and
substance-related disorders.
Axis II is for reporting mental retardation
DIAGNOSTIC AND STATISTICAL and personality disorders as well as promi-
MANUAL OF MENTAL DISORDERS nent maladaptive personality features and
(DSM-IV-TR) defense mechanisms.
The Diagnostic and Statistical Manual of Men- Axis III is for reporting current medical
tal Disorders-Text Revision (DSM-IV-TR), now conditions that are potentially relevant to
in its fourth edition, is a taxonomy published by understanding or managing the persons
the APA. The DSM-IV-TR describes all mental dis- mental disorder as well as medical condi-
orders, outlining specific diagnostic criteria for each tions that might contribute to understanding
based on clinical experience and research. All mental the person.
health clinicians who diagnose psychiatric disorders Axis IV is for reporting psychosocial and
use the DSM-IV-TR. environmental problems that may affect the
diagnosis, treatment, and prognosis of men-
tal disorders. Included are problems with
primary support group, social environment,
education, occupation, housing, economics,
access to health care, and legal system.
Axis V presents a Global Assessment of
Functioning (GAF), which rates the persons
overall psychological functioning on a scale
of 0 to 100. This represents the clinicians
assessment of the persons current level of
functioning; the clinician also may give a
score for prior functioning (for instance, high-
est GAF in past year or GAF 6 months ago).
All clients admitted to a hospital for psychi-
atric treatment will have a multi-axis diagnosis
from the DSM-IV-TR. Although student nurses do
not use the DSM-IV-TR to diagnose clients, they
will find it a helpful resource to understand the rea-
son for the admission and to begin building knowl-
edge about the nature of psychiatric illnesses.
HISTORICAL PERSPECTIVES OF
THE TREATMENT OF MENTAL ILLNESS
Ancient Times
People of ancient times believed that any sickness
indicated displeasure of the gods and in fact was pun-
Demons ishment for sins and wrongdoing. Those with mental
1 FOUNDATIONS OF PSYCHIATRIC-MENTAL HEALTH NURSING 5
disorders were viewed as being either divine or de- and promoted adequate shelter, nutritious food, and
monic depending on their behavior. Individuals seen warm clothing (Gollaher, 1995).
as divine were worshipped and adored; those seen as The period of enlightenment was short-lived.
demonic were ostracized, punished, and sometimes Within 100 years after establishment of the first asy-
burned at the stake. Later Aristotle (382322 BC) at- lum, state hospitals were in trouble. Attendants were
tempted to relate mental disorders to physical dis- accused of abusing the residents, the rural location of
orders and developed his theory that the amounts hospitals was viewed as isolating patients from fam-
of blood, water, and yellow and black bile in the body ily and their homes, and the phrase insane asylum
controlled the emotions. These four substances, or took on a negative connotation.
humors, corresponded with happiness, calmness,
anger, and sadness. Imbalances of the four humors
Sigmund Freud and Treatment
were believed to cause mental disorders, so treatment
of Mental Disorders
aimed at restoring balance through bloodletting, starv-
ing, and purging. Such treatments persisted well The period of scientific study and treatment of men-
into the 19th century (Baly, 1982). tal disorders began with Sigmund Freud (18561939)
In early Christian times (11000 AD), primitive and others such as Emil Kraepelin (18561926) and
beliefs and superstitions were strong. All diseases Eugene Bleuler (18571939). With these men, the
were again blamed on demons, and the mentally ill study of psychiatry and the diagnosis and treatment of
were viewed as possessed. Priests performed exor- mental illnesses started in earnest. Freud challenged
cisms to rid evil spirits. When that failed, they used society to view human beings objectively. He studied
more severe measures such as incarceration in dun- the mind, its disorders, and their treatment as no one
geons, flogging, starving, and other brutal treatments. had before. Many other theorists built on Freuds pi-
During the Renaissance (13001600), people with oneering work (see Chap. 3). Kraepelin began classi-
mental illness were distinguished from criminals in fying mental disorders according to their symptoms,
England. Those considered harmless were allowed to and Bleuler coined the term schizophrenia.
wander the countryside or live in rural communities,
but the more dangerous lunatics were thrown in
Development of
prison, chained, and starved (Rosenblatt, 1984). In
Psychopharmacology
1547, the Hospital of St. Mary of Bethlehem was of-
ficially declared a hospital for the insane, the first of A great leap in the treatment of mental illness began
its kind. By 1775, visitors at the institution were in about 1950 with the development of psychotropic
charged a fee for the privilege of viewing and ridicul- drugs (drugs used to treat mental illness). Chlor-
ing the inmates, who were seen as animals, less than promazine (Thorazine), an antipsychotic drug, and
human (McMillan, 1997). During this same period in lithium, an antimanic agent, were the first drugs
the colonies (later the United States), the mentally to be developed. Over the following 10 years, mono-
ill were considered evil or possessed and were pun- amine oxidase inhibitor antidepressants; haloperidol
ished. Witch hunts were conducted, and offenders (Haldol), an antipsychotic; tricyclic antidepressants;
were burned at the stake. and antianxiety agents called benzodiazepines were
introduced. For the first time, drugs actually reduced
agitation, psychotic thinking, and depression. Hos-
Period of Enlightenment and pital stays were shortened, and many people were
Creation of Mental Institutions well enough to go home. The level of noise, chaos, and
In the 1790s, a period of enlightenment concerning violence greatly diminished in the hospital setting
persons with mental illness began. Phillippe Pinel in (Trudeau, 1993).
France and William Tukes in England formulated
the concept of asylum as a safe refuge or haven of-
Move Toward Community
fering protection at institutions where people had
Mental Health
been whipped, beaten, and starved just because they
were mentally ill (Gollaher, 1995). With this move- The movement toward treating those with mental ill-
ment began the moral treatment of the mentally ill. ness in less restrictive environments gained momen-
In the United States, Dorothea Dix (18021887) began tum in 1963 with the enactment of the Community
a crusade to reform the treatment of mental illness Mental Health Centers Act. Deinstitutionalization,
after a visit to Tukes institution in England. She a deliberate shift from institutional care in state hos-
was instrumental in opening 32 state hospitals that pitals to community facilities, began. Community men-
offered asylum to the suffering. Dix believed that so- tal health centers served smaller geographic catch-
ciety was obligated to those who were mentally ill ment (service) areas that provided less restrictive
6 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
treatment located closer to the persons home, family, severe and persistent mental illnesses have shorter
and friends. These centers provided emergency care, hospital stays, they are admitted to hospitals more
inpatient care, outpatient services, partial hospital- frequently. The continuous flow of clients being ad-
ization, screening services, and education. Therefore, mitted and discharged quickly overwhelms general
deinsitutionalization had three components: release hospital psychiatric units. In some cities, emergency
of individuals from state institutions, diversion from department visits for acutely disturbed persons have
hospitalization, and development of alternative com- increased by 400% to 500%.
munity services (Lamb & Bachrach, 2001). Shorter hospital stays further complicate fre-
In addition to deinstitutionalization, federal leg- quent, repeated hospital admissions. People with
islation was passed to provide an income for disabled severe and persistent mental illness may show signs
persons: Supplemental Security Income (SSI) and of improvement in a few days but are not stabilized.
Social Security Disability Income (SSDI). This allowed Thus they are discharged into the community with-
people with severe and persistent mental illnesses out being able to cope with community living. The re-
to be more independent financially and not have to sult frequently is decompensation and rehospitaliza-
rely on family for money. States were able to spend tion. In addition, many people have a dual problem
less money on care of the mentally ill than they had of both severe mental illness and substance abuse.
in state hospitals, because these programs were fed- Use of alcohol and drugs exacerbates symptoms of
erally funded. Also commitment laws changed in the mental illness, again making rehospitalization more
early 1970s, making it more difficult to commit people likely. Substance abuse issues cannot be dealt with
for mental health treatment against their will. This in the 3 to 5 days typical for admissions in the cur-
further decreased the state hospital populations and, rent managed care environment.
Many providers believe todays clients to be more
consequently, the money that states spent on them
aggressive than those in the past. Four to eight per-
(Torrey, 1997).
cent of clients seen in psychiatric emergency rooms
are armed (Ries, 1997), and people with severe and
MENTAL ILLNESS persistent mental illness who are not receiving ade-
IN THE 21ST CENTURY quate care commit about 1,000 homicides per year
(Torrey, 1997). Ten to fifteen percent of those in state
The Department of Health and Human Services (2002) prisons have severe and persistent mental illness
estimates that 56 million Americans have a diagnos- (Lamb & Weinberger, 1998).
able mental illness. Furthermore, mental illnesses or Homelessness is a major problem in the United
serious emotional disturbances impair daily activities States today. The Department of Health and Human
for an estimated 10 million adults and 4 million chil- Services (2002) estimates that 750,000 people live
dren and adolescents. For example, attention deficit/ and sleep in the streets. Estimates of the prevalence
hyperactivity disorder affects 3% to 5% of school-age
children. More than 10 million children younger than
7 years grow up in homes where at least one parent
suffers from significant mental illness or substance
abuse, which hinders the readiness of these chil-
dren to start school. The economic burden of mental
illness in the United States, including both health
care costs and lost productivity, exceeds $170 billion
(Department of Health and Human Services [DHHS],
2002). Four of the ten leading causes of disability in the
United States and other developed countries are men-
tal disorders: major depression, bipolar disorder, schiz-
ophrenia, and obsessive-compulsive disorder (NIMH,
2002). Yet only one in four adults and one in five chil-
dren and adolescents in need of mental health ser-
vices get the care they need.
Some believe that deinstitutionalization has had
negative as well as positive effects (Torrey, 1997).
Although deinstitutionalization reduced the number
of public hospital beds by 80%, the number of admis-
sions to those beds correspondingly increased by 90%
(Appleby & Desai, 1993). Such findings have led to
the term revolving door effect. While people with Revolving door
1 FOUNDATIONS OF PSYCHIATRIC-MENTAL HEALTH NURSING 7
of mental illness among the homeless population are 15% of people with mental illness appear to be get-
that one-third of adult homeless persons have a seri- ting minimally adequate treatment, which is a pre-
ous mental illness and more than one-half also have scription for medication and four or more visits with
substance abuse problems (DHHS, 2002). Those who a psychiatrist or eight visits with any kind of mental
are homeless and mentally ill are found in parks, air- health specialist (Wang, 2002).
port and bus terminals, alleys and stairwells, jails, In 1993, the federal government created and
and other public places. Some use shelters, halfway funded Access to Community Care and Effective Ser-
houses, or board-and-care rooms; others rent cheap vices and Support (ACCESS) to begin to address
hotel rooms when they can afford it (Haugland et al., the needs of people with mental illness who were
1997). Homelessness worsens psychiatric problems homeless either all or part of the time. The goals of
for many people with mental illness who end up on ACCESS were to improve access to comprehensive
the streets, which contributes to a vicious cycle. services across a continuum of care, reduce dupli-
Many problems of the homeless mentally ill, as cation and cost of services, and improve the efficiency
well as those who pass through the revolving door of of services (Randolph et al., 1997). Programs such as
psychiatric care, stem from the lack of adequate com- these provide services to people who otherwise would
munity resources. Money saved by states when state not receive them.
hospitals were closed has not been transferred to
community programs and support. Inpatient psychi-
Objectives for the Future
atric treatment still accounts for most of the spend-
ing for mental health in the United States, so com- Unfortunately only one in four affected adults and
munity mental health has never been given the one in five children and adolescents receive treat-
financial base it needs to be effective. In addition, ment (DHHS, 2002). Statistics like these underlie
mental health services provided in the community the Healthy People 2010 objectives for mental health
must be individualized, available, and culturally rel- proposed by the U.S. Department of Health and
evant to be effective (Lamb & Bachrach, 2001). Only Human Services (Box 1-1). These objectives, originally
Box 1-1
HEALTHY PEOPLE 2010 MENTAL HEALTH OBJECTIVES
Reduce suicides to no more than 6 per 100,000 people
Reduce the incidence of injurious suicide attempts by 1% in 12 months for adolescents ages 1417
Reduce the proportion of homeless adults who have serious mental illness to 19%
Increase the proportion of persons with serious mental illnesses who are employed to 51%
Reduce the relapse rate for persons with eating disorders including anorexia nervosa and bulimia nervosa
Increase the number of persons seen in primary health care who receive mental health treatment screening
and assessment
Increase the proportion of children with mental health problems who receive treatment
Increase the proportion of juvenile justice facilities that screen new admissions for mental health problems
Increase the proportion of adults with mental disorders who receive treatment by 17%
Adults 1854 with serious mental illness to 55%
Adults 18 and older with recognized depression to 50%
Adults 18 and older with schizophrenia to 75%
Adults 18 and older with anxiety disorders to 50%
Increase the population of persons with concurrent substance abuse problems and mental disorders who
receive treatment for both disorders
Increase the proportion of local governments with community-based jail diversion programs for adults with
serious mental illness
Increase the number of states that track consumers satisfaction with the mental health services they receive
to 30 states
Increase the number of states with an operational mental health plan that addresses cultural competence
Increase the number of states with an operational mental health plan that addresses mental health crisis inter-
vention, ongoing screening, and treatment services for elderly persons
U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (2000). Healthy people 2010: National health promotion and disease prevention
objectives. Washington, DC: DHHS.
8 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
developed as Healthy People 2000, were revised in preferable for treating many people with mental ill-
January 2000 to increase the number of people who ness. Clients can remain in their communities, main-
are identified, diagnosed, treated, and helped to live tain contact with family and friends, and enjoy per-
healthier lives. The objectives also strive to decrease sonal freedom that is not possible in an institution.
rates of suicide and homelessness, to increase em- People in institutions often lose motivation and hope
ployment among those with serious mental illness, as well as functional daily living skills such as shop-
and to provide more services for both juveniles and ping and cooking. Therefore treatment in the com-
adults who are incarcerated and have mental health munity is a trend that will continue.
problems.
Cost Containment and Managed Care
Community-Based Care Health care costs spiraled upward throughout the
After deinstitutionalization, the 2,000 community 1970s and 1980s in the United States. Managed
mental health centers (CMHCs) that were supposed care is a concept designed to purposely control the
to be built by 1980 had not materialized. By 1990, balance between the quality of care provided and
only 1,300 programs provided various types of psycho- the cost of that care. In a managed care system, people
social rehabilitation services. Persons with severe receive care based on need rather than on request.
and persistent mental illness were either ignored or Those who work for the organization providing the
underserved by the CMHCs (International Associa- care assess the need for care. Managed care began in
tion of Psychosocial Rehabilitation Services, 1990). the early 1970s in the form of health maintenance
This meant that many people needing services were, organizations (HMOs), which were successful in some
and still are, in the general population with their areas with healthier populations of people.
needs unmet. In the 1990s, a new form of managed care called
Community support services programs were de- utilization review firms or managed care orga-
veloped to meet the needs of persons with mental nizations were developed to control the expenditure
illness outside the walls of an institution. These pro- of insurance funds by requiring providers to seek ap-
grams focus on rehabilitation, vocational needs, ed- proval before the delivery of care. Case management,
ucation, and socialization, as well as management of or management of care on a case-by-case basis, rep-
symptoms and medication. These services are funded resented an effort to provide necessary services while
by states (or counties) and some private agencies. containing cost. The client is assigned to a case man-
Therefore the availability and quality of services ager, the person who coordinates all types of care
vary among different areas of the country. For exam- needed by the client. In theory, this approach is de-
ple, rural areas may have limited funds to provide signed to decrease fragmented care from a variety of
mental health services and smaller numbers of people sources, eliminate unneeded overlap of services, pro-
needing them. Large metropolitan areas, while having vide care in the least restrictive environment, and de-
larger budgets, also have thousands of people in need crease costs for the insurers. In reality, expenditures
of service. Rarely is there enough money to provide are often reduced by withholding services deemed un-
all the services needed by the population. Chapter 4 necessary or substituting less expensive treatment
provides a detailed discussion of community-based alternatives for more expensive care such as hospital
programs. admission.
Unfortunately the community-based system did Psychiatric care is costly because of the long-term
not accurately anticipate the extent of the needs of nature of the disorders. A single hospital stay can
people with severe and persistent mental illness. cost $20,000 to $30,000. Also, there are fewer objec-
Many clients do not have the skills needed to live in- tive measures of health or illness. For example, when
dependently in the community, and teaching these a person is suicidal, the clinician must rely on the
skills is often time-consuming and labor-intensive, persons report of suicidality; no laboratory tests or
requiring a one-to-one staff-client ratio. In addition, other diagnostic studies can identify suicidal ideas.
the nature of some mental illnesses makes learning Mental health care is separated from physical health
these skills more difficult. For example, a client who is care in terms of insurance coverage: there are often
hallucinating, or hearing voices, can have difficulty specific dollar limits or permitted numbers of hospi-
listening to or comprehending instructions. Other tal days in a calendar year. When private insurance
clients experience drastic shifts in mood, being un- limits are met, public funds through the state are
able to get out of bed one day, then unable to concen- used to provide care. Legislation has been proposed in
trate or pay attention a few days later. some states to provide parity between mental and
Despite the flaws in the system, community-based physical health coverage, meaning that mental health
programs have positive aspects that make them care would get equal amounts of insurance coverage
1 FOUNDATIONS OF PSYCHIATRIC-MENTAL HEALTH NURSING 9
as physical illnesses, which often have no monetary diverse population, and that includes being aware of
caps. However, this has not yet happened. cultural differences that influence mental health and
Mental health care is managed through privately the treatment of mental illness. See Chapter 7 for a
owned behavioral health care firms that often provide discussion of cultural differences.
the services as well as manage their cost. Persons Diversity is not limited to culture; the structure
without private insurance must rely on their county of families in the United States has changed as well.
of residence to provide funding through tax dollars. With a divorce rate of 50% in the United States, sin-
These services and the money to fund them often lag gle parents head many families, and many blended
far behind the need that exists. In addition, many per- families are created when divorced persons remarry.
sons with mental illness do not seek care and in fact Twenty-five percent of households consist of a single
avoid treatment. These persons are often homeless or person (Wright, 1995), and many people live together
in jail. Two of the greatest challenges for the future without being married. Gay men and lesbians form
are to provide effective treatment to all who need it partnerships and sometimes adopt children. The face
and to find the resources to pay for this care. of the family in the United States is varied, provid-
The Health Care Finance Administration (HCFA) ing a challenge to nurses to provide sensitive, com-
administers two insurance programs: Medicare and petent care.
Medicaid. Medicare covers people 65 years and older,
with permanent kidney failure, or with certain dis-
abilities. Medicaid is jointly funded by the federal
PSYCHIATRIC NURSING PRACTICE
and state governments and covers low-income indi- In 1873, Linda Richards graduated from the New
viduals and families. Medicaid varies depending on England Hospital for Women and Children in Boston.
the state, because each state determines eligibility re- She went on to improve nursing care in psychiatric
quirements, scope of services, and rate of payment for hospitals and organized educational programs in state
services. Medicaid covers people receiving either Sup- mental hospitals in Illinois. Richards is called the
plemental Security Income (SSI) or Social Security first American psychiatric nurse; she believed that
Disability Insurance (SSDI) until they reach 65 years the mentally sick should be at least as well cared for
of age, although people receiving SSDI are not eligible as the physically sick (Doona, 1984).
for 24 months. SSI recipients, however, are eligible The first training of nurses to work with persons
immediately. At 65 years of age, Medicare provides with mental illness was in 1882 at McLean Hospital
the insurance. Unfortunately not all people who are in Waverly, Mass. The care was primarily custodial
disabled apply for disability benefits, and not all peo- and focused on nutrition, hygiene, and activity. Nurses
ple who apply are approved. Thus, many people with adapted medical-surgical principles to the care of
severe and persistent mental illness have no bene- clients with psychiatric disorders and treated them
fits at all. with tolerance and kindness. The role of psychiatric
Another funding issue in mental health involves nurses expanded as somatic therapies for the treat-
spending caps by insurers for mental illness and sub- ment of mental disorders were developed. Treatments
stance abuse treatment. Some policies place an an- such as insulin shock therapy (1935), psychosurgery
nual dollar limitation for treatment, while others (1936), and electroconvulsive therapy (1937) required
limit the number of days that will be covered annu- nurses to use their medical-surgical skills further.
ally or in the insured persons lifetime (of the policy). The first psychiatric nursing textbook, Nursing
There has been some support for parity (or equality) Mental Diseases by Harriet Bailey, was published in
of coverage for mental health and substance abuse 1920. In 1913, Johns Hopkins was the first school of
treatment. This means that insurers would provide nursing to include a course in psychiatric nursing in
coverage for mental illness equal to coverage they its curriculum. It was not until 1950 that the Na-
provide for medical illness or surgery. As yet, not all tional League for Nursing, which accredits nursing
states have passed and enacted legislation to provide programs, required schools to include an experience
parity of coverage. in psychiatric nursing.
Two early nursing theorists shaped psychiatric
nursing practice: Hildegard Peplau and June Mel-
Cultural Considerations low. Peplau published Interpersonal Relations in
The United States Census Bureau (2000) estimates Nursing in 1952 and Interpersonal Techniques: The
that 62% of the population has European origins. Crux of Psychiatric Nursing in 1962. She described
This number is expected to continue to decrease as the therapeutic nurseclient relationship with its
more U.S. residents trace their ancestry to Africa, phases and tasks and wrote extensively about anxi-
Asia, or the Arab or Hispanic worlds in the future. ety (see Chap. 13). The interpersonal dimension that
Nurses must be prepared to care for this culturally was crucial to her beliefs forms the foundations of
10 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
practice today. Mellows 1968 work Nursing Therapy phases of the nursing process, including specific types
described her approach of focusing on the clients of interventions, for nurses in psychiatric settings
psychosocial needs and strengths. Mellow contends and outline standards for professional performance:
that the nurse as therapist is particularly suited to quality of care, performance appraisal, education, col-
working with those with severe mental illness in the legiality, ethics, collaboration, research, and resource
context of daily activities, focusing on the here-and- utilization (Box 1-3). Box 1-4 summarizes specific
now to meet each persons psychosocial needs (1986). areas of practice and specific interventions for both
Both Peplau and Mellow substantially contributed to basic and advanced nursing practice.
the practice of psychiatric nursing.
In 1973, the division of psychiatric and mental
Student Concerns
health practice of the American Nurses Association
developed standards of care, which it revised in 1982, Student nurses beginning their clinical experience in
1994, and 2000. Standards of care are authorita- psychiatric-mental health nursing usually find the
tive statements by professional organizations that discipline to be very different from any previous ex-
describe the responsibilities for which nurses are ac- perience; as a result, they often have a variety of con-
countable. They are not legally binding unless they cerns. These concerns are normal and usually do not
are incorporated into the state nurse practice act or persist once the student has had initial contacts with
state board rules and regulations. When legal prob- clients.
lems or lawsuits arise, these professional standards Some common concerns and helpful hints for
are used to determine what is safe and acceptable beginning students are as follows:
practice and to assess the quality of care. What if I say the wrong thing?
A two-part document, Statement on Psychiatric- No one magic phrase can solve a clients
Mental Health Clinical Nursing Practice and Stan- problems; likewise, no single statement will
dards of Psychiatric-Mental Health Clinical Nursing significantly worsen them. Listening care-
Practice, was jointly published in 1994 and revised in fully, showing genuine interest, and caring
2000 by the American Nurses Association, the Amer- about the client are extremely important. A
ican Psychiatric Nurses Association, the Association nurse who possesses these elements but says
of Child and Adolescent Nurses Association, and the something that sounds out of place can sim-
Society for Education and Research in Psychiatric- ply restate it by saying, That didnt come
Mental Health Nursing. This document outlines the out right. What I meant was . . .
areas of concern and standards of care for todays What will I be doing?
psychiatric-mental health nurse. The phenomena In the mental health setting, many familiar
of concern describe the 12 areas of concern that tasks and responsibilities are minimal. Phys-
mental health nurses focus on when caring for clients ical care skills or diagnostic tests and proce-
(Box 1-2). The standards of care incorporate the dures are fewer than those conducted in a
Box 1-2
PSYCHIATRIC MENTAL HEALTH NURSING PHENOMENA OF CONCERN
Actual or potential mental health problems pertaining to
The maintenance of optimal health and well-being and the prevention of psychobiologic illness
Self-care limitations or impaired functioning related to mental and emotional distress
Deficits in the functioning of significant biologic, emotional, and cognitive symptoms
Emotional stress or crisis components of illness, pain, and disability
Self-concept changes, developmental issues, and life process changes
Problems related to emotions such as anxiety, anger, sadness, loneliness, and grief
Physical symptoms that occur along with altered psychological functioning
Alterations in thinking, perceiving, symbolizing, communicating, and decision-making
Difficulties relating to others
Behaviors and mental states that indicate the client is a danger to self or others or has a severe disability
Interpersonal, systemic, sociocultural, spiritual, or environmental circumstances or events that affect the
mental or emotional well-being of the individual, family, or community
Symptom management, side effects/toxicities associated with psychopharmacologic intervention, and other
aspects of the treatment regimen
1 FOUNDATIONS OF PSYCHIATRIC-MENTAL HEALTH NURSING 11
Box 1-3
STANDARDS OF PSYCHIATRIC-MENTAL HEALTH CLINICAL NURSING PRACTICE
STANDARDS OF CARE
Standard I. Assessment Standard Vc. Self-Care Activities
The psychiatric-mental health nurse collects client The psychiatric-mental health nurse structures interven-
health data. tions around the clients activities of daily living to
Standard II. Diagnosis foster self-care and mental and physical well-being.
The psychiatric-mental health nurse analyzes the data Standard Vd. Psychobiologic Interventions
in determining diagnoses. The psychiatric-mental health nurse uses knowledge of
Standard III. Outcome Identification psychobiologic interventions and applies clinical
The psychiatric-mental health nurse identifies ex- skills to restore the clients health and prevent fur-
pected outcomes individualized to the client. ther disability.
Standard IV. Planning Standard Ve. Health Teaching
The psychiatric-mental health nurse develops a plan of The psychiatric-mental health nurse, through health
care that prescribes interventions to attain expected teaching, assists clients in achieving satisfying, pro-
outcomes. ductive, and healthy patterns of living.
Standard V. Implementation Standard Vf. Case Management
The psychiatric-mental health nurse implements the The psychiatric-mental health nurse provides case
interventions identified in the plan of care. management to coordinate comprehensive health
Standard Va. Counseling services and ensure continuity of care.
The psychiatric-mental health nurse uses counseling Standard Vg. Health Promotion and Maintenance
interventions to assist clients in improving or re- The psychiatric-mental health nurse employs strate-
gaining their previous coping abilities, fostering gies and interventions to promote and maintain
mental health, and preventing mental illness and mental health and prevent mental illness.
disability. (Interventions Vh-Vj are advanced practice interven-
Standard Vb. Milieu Therapy tions and may be performed only by the certified
The psychiatric-mental health nurse provides, struc- specialist in psychiatric-mental health nursing.)
tures, and maintains a therapeutic environment in Standard VI. Evaluation
collaboration with the client and other health care The psychiatric-mental health nurse evaluates the
providers. clients progress in attaining expected outcomes.
Reprinted with permission from American Nurses Association. Scope and Standards of Psychiatric-Mental Health Nursing Practice.
Copyright 2000. American Nurses Publishing, American Nurses Foundation/American Nurses Association, Washington, D.C.
12 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
Box 1-4
AREAS OF PRACTICE
BASIC-LEVEL FUNCTIONS
Counseling
Interventions and communication techniques
Problem solving
Crisis intervention
Stress management
Behavior modification
Milieu therapy
Maintain therapeutic environment
Teach skills
Encourage communication between clients and
others
Promote growth through role-modeling
Self-care activities
Encourage independence
Increase self-esteem
Improve function and health
Psychobiologic interventions
Administer medications
Teaching
Observations
Health teaching
Case management
Health promotion and maintenance
available to assist the student in such situa- handle the situation. It is usually best for the
tions. Students should never feel as if they student (and sometimes the instructor or
will have to handle situations alone. staff) to talk with the client and reassure
What happens if a client asks me for a date or him or her about confidentiality. The client
displays sexually aggressive or inappropriate should be reassured that the student will not
behavior? read the clients record and will not be as-
Some clients have difficulty recognizing or signed to work with the client.
maintaining interpersonal boundaries. When Students may discover that some of the prob-
a client seeks contact of any type outside the lems, family dynamics, or life events of clients are
nurseclient relationship, it is important similar to their own or those of their family. It can be
for the student (with the assistance of the a shock for students to discover that sometimes there
instructor or staff) to clarify the boundaries are as many similarities between clients and staff as
of the professional relationship (see Chap- there are differences.
ter 5). Likewise, setting limits and maintain- There is no easy answer for this concern. Many
ing boundaries are needed when the clients people have stressful lives or abusive childhood ex-
behavior is sexually inappropriate. Initially periences; some cope fairly successfully, and others
the student might be uncomfortable dealing are devastated emotionally. Although we know that
with such behavior, but it becomes easier to coping skills are a key part of mental health, we do
manage with practice and the assistance of not always know why some people have serious emo-
the instructor and staff. It is also important tional problems and others do not. Chapter 7 dis-
to protect the clients privacy and dignity cusses these factors in more detail.
when he or she cannot do so.
Is my physical safety in jeopardy?
Often students have had little or no contact
SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES
with seriously mentally ill people. Media cov- Self-awareness is the process by which
erage of those with mental illness who com- the nurse gains recognition of his or her own feel-
mit crimes is widespread, leaving the im- ings, beliefs, and attitudes. In nursing, being aware
pression that most clients with psychiatric of ones feelings, thoughts, and values is a primary
disorders are violent. Actually clients hurt focus. Self-awareness is particularly important in
themselves more often than they harm others. mental health nursing. Everyone, including nurses
Staff members usually monitor clients with a and student nurses, has values, ideas, and beliefs that
potential for violence closely for clues of an are unique and different from others. At times, the
impending outburst. When physical aggres- students values and beliefs will conflict with those of
sion does occur, staff members are specially the client or with the clients behavior. The nurse must
trained to handle aggressive clients in a safe learn to accept these differences among people and
manner. The student should not become in- view each client as a worthwhile person regardless of
volved in the physical restraint of an aggres- that clients opinions and lifestyle. The student does
sive client because he or she has not had the not need to condone the clients views or behavior;
training and experience required. When talk- he or she merely needs to accept it as different from
ing to or approaching clients who are poten- his or her own and not let it interfere with care.
tially aggressive, the student should sit in an For example, a nurse who believes that abortion
open area rather than a closed room, provide is wrong may be assigned to care for a client who has
plenty of space for the client, or request that had an abortion. If the nurse is going to help the client,
the instructor or a staff person be present. he or she must be able to separate his or her own be-
What if I encounter someone I know being liefs about abortion from those of the client. The stu-
treated on the unit? dent must be certain that personal feelings and be-
In any clinical setting, it is possible that a liefs do not interfere with or hinder the clients care.
student nurse might see someone he or she The nurse can accomplish self-awareness through
knows, or a coworker. People often have ad- reflection, spending time consciously focusing on how
ditional fears because of the stigma that is one feels and what one values or believes. Although
still associated with seeking mental health we all have values and beliefs, we may not have really
treatment. It is essential in mental health spent time discovering how we feel or what we believe
that the clients identity and treatment be about certain issues such as suicide or a clients re-
kept confidential. If the student recognizes fusal to take needed medications. The nurse needs to
someone he or she knows, the student should discover himself or herself and what he or she believes
notify the instructor, who can decide how to before trying to help others with different views.
14 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
Lamb, H. R., & Bachrach, L. L. (2001). Some perspectives Seaward, B. L. (1997). Stand like mountains, flow like
on deinstitutionalization. Psychiatric Services, 52(8), water. Deerfield Beach, FL: Health Communications.
10391045. Torrey, E. F. (1997). The release of the mentally ill from
Lamb, H. R., & Weinberger, L. E. (1998). Persons with institutions: A well-intentioned disaster. Chronicle of
severe mental illness in jails and prisons: A review. Higher Education, 43(40), B4.
Psychiatric Services, 49(4), 483492. Trudeau, M. E. (1993). Informed consent: The patients
McMillan, I. (1997). Insight into Bedlam: One hospitals right to decide. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing &
history. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing, 3(6), 2834. Mental Health Services, 31(6), 912.
Mellow, J. (1986). A personal perspective of nursing U.S. Census Bureau. (2000). http://www.census.gov/
therapy. Hospital and Community Psychiatry, 37(2), Wang, P. S. (2002). Adequacy of treatment for serious
182183. mental illness in the United Stages. American Jour-
Mohr, W. K. (2003). Johnsons psychiatric-mental health nal of Public Health, 92(1).
nursing: Adaptation and growth (5th ed.). Philadel- Wright, R. (1995). 20th century blues. Time, Aug. 28,
phia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins. 5057.
National Institute of Mental Health (NIMH). (2002).
http://www.nimh.nih.gov
Randolph, F., Blasinsky, M., Leginski, W., Parker, L. B., ADDITIONAL READINGS
& Goldman, H. H. (1997). Creating integrated service
systems for homeless persons with mental illness: Forchuk, C., & Tweedell, D. (2001). Celebrating our past:
The ACCESS program. Psychiatric Services, 48(3), The history of Hamilton Psychiatric Hospital. Jour-
369373. nal of Psychosocial Nursing, 39(10), 1624.
Ries, R. (1997). Advantages of separating the triage func- Rosenheck, R. (1997). Disability payments and chemical
tion from the emergency service. Psychiatric Services, dependence: Conflicting values and uncertain effects.
48(6), 755756. Psychiatric Services, 48(6), 789791.
Rosenblatt, A. (1984). Concepts of the asylum in the care Spector, R. E. (2000). Cultural diversity in illness and
of the mentally ill. Hospital and Community Psychia- health (5th ed.). Upper Saddle River, NJ: Prentice
try, 35, 244250. Hall Health.
Chapter Study Guide
MULTIPLE-CHOICE QUESTIONS
Select the best answer for each of the following
questions.
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Indicate what type of information is recorded for each axis of the DSM-IV.
Axis I
Axis II
Axis III
Axis IV
Axis V
17
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
1. Explain how the standards of practice developed by American Nurses
Association are used.
18
2 Neurobiologic
Theories
Learning Objectives and Psycho-
pharmacology
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
Although much remains unknown about what causes THE NERVOUS SYSTEM
mental illness, science in the past 20 years has made AND HOW IT WORKS
great strides in helping us understand how the brain
works and in presenting possible causes of why some Central Nervous System
brains work differently than others. Such advances The CNS is composed of the brain, the spinal cord,
in neurobiologic research are continually expanding and associated nerves that control voluntary acts.
the knowledge base in the field of psychiatry and are Structurally the brain is divided into the cerebrum,
greatly influencing clinical practice. The psychiatric- cerebellum, brain stem, and limbic system (Lewis,
mental health nurse must have a basic understand- 2000). Figures 2-1 and 2-2 show the locations of these
ing of how the brain functions and of the current structures.
theories regarding mental illness. This chapter in-
cludes an overview of the major anatomic structures
CEREBRUM
of the nervous system and how they workthe neuro-
transmission process. It presents the major current The cerebrum is divided into two hemispheres: all
neurobiologic theories regarding what causes mental lobes and structures are found in both halves of the
illness including genetics and heredity, stress and the brain except for the pineal body or gland which is
immune system, and infectious causes. located between the hemispheres. The pineal body is
The use of medications to treat mental illness an endocrine gland that influences the activities of
(psychopharmacology) has evolved from these the pituitary gland, islets of Langerhans, parathy-
neurobiologic discoveries. These medications directly roids, adrenals, and gonads. The corpus callosum is
affect the central nervous system (CNS) and, sub- a pathway connecting the two hemispheres and co-
sequently, behavior, perceptions, thinking, and emo- ordinating their function. The left hemisphere con-
tions. This chapter discusses five categories of drugs trols the right side of the body and is the center for
used to treat mental illness including mechanisms of logical reasoning and analytic functions such as
action, side effects, and the roles of the nurse in ad- reading, writing, and mathematical tasks. The right
ministration and client teaching. Although pharma- hemisphere controls the left side of the body and is
cologic interventions are the most effective treatment the center for creative thinking, intuition, and artis-
for many psychiatric disorders, adjunctive therapies tic abilities.
such as cognitive and behavioral therapy, family ther- The cerebral hemispheres are each divided into
apy, and psychotherapy greatly enhance the success four lobes: frontal, parietal, temporal, and occipital.
of treatment and the clients outcome. Chapter 3 dis- Some functions of the lobes are distinct; others are
cusses these psychosocial modalities. integrated. The frontal lobes control the organiza-
Temporal lobe
Occipital lobe
Pons
Medulla
Cerebellem
Septum pellucidum
Cortical sulci
Occipital lobe
Frontal lobe
Third ventricle
Anterior
commissure Thalamus*
*Hypothalamic sulcus
Olfactory bulb Optic chiasm
and tract
*Amygdala
Pituitary gland
Hippocampus*
Mamillary body
Pons
Brain stem
Cerebellum
Medulla
Fourth ventricle
* = Limbic system
Figure 2-2. The brain and its structures.
tion of thought, body movement, memories, emotions, nated movements in diseases such as Parkinsons
and moral behavior. The integration of all this infor- and dementia.
mation helps regulate arousal, focuses attention, and
enables problem-solving and decision-making. Ab-
BRAIN STEM
normalities in the frontal lobes are associated with
schizophrenia, attention deficit/hyperactivity disorder The brain stem includes the midbrain, pons, and
(ADHD), and dementia. medulla oblongata and the nuclei for cranial nerves 3
The parietal lobes interpret sensations of taste through 12. The medulla, located at the top of the
and touch and assist in spatial orientation. The tem- spinal cord, contains vital centers for respiration and
poral lobes are centers for the senses of smell and hear- cardiovascular functions. Above the medulla and in
ing, memory, and emotional expression. The occipi- front of the cerebrum, the pons bridges the gap both
tal lobes assist in coordinating language generation structurally and functionally, serving as a primary
and visual interpretation such as depth perception. motor pathway. The midbrain connects the pons and
cerebellum with the cerebrum. It measures only 0.8
inch (2 cm) in length and includes most of the reticu-
CEREBELLUM
lar activating system and the extrapyramidal system.
The cerebellum is located below the cerebrum and is The reticular activating system influences motor
the center for coordination of movements and pos- activity, sleep, consciousness, and awareness. The
tural adjustments. The cerebellum receives and in- extrapyramidal system relays information about
tegrates information from all areas of the body such movement and coordination from the brain to the
as the muscles, joints, organs, and other components spinal nerves. The locus ceruleus, a small group of
of the CNS. Research has shown that inhibited trans- norepinephrine-producing neurons in the brain stem,
mission of dopamine, a neurotransmitter, in this is associated with stress, anxiety, and impulsive
area is associated with the lack of smooth, coordi- behavior.
22 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
Axon
(conducts impulse
away from cell body)
Dendrite
(conducts impulse
toward cell body)
ls e
pu
Direction of ner ve im
Synapse
(site of neurotransmission)
Presynaptic
neuron
Synaptic
vesicles
Soma
(cell body)
Mitochondrion
Synaptic cleft
Postsynaptic
neuron receptor
Axon Polarized
membrane
synapses. Studies are beginning to show differences tion, learning and memory, sleep and wakefulness,
in the amount of some neurotransmitters available and mood regulation. Norepinephrine and its deriv-
in the brains of people with certain mental disorders ative, epinephrine, also are known as noradrena-
compared with people who have no signs of mental line and adrenaline respectively. Excess norepineph-
illness (Fig. 2-4). rine has been implicated in several anxiety disorders;
Major neurotransmitters have been found to play deficits may contribute to memory loss, social with-
a role in psychiatric illnesses as well as actions and drawal, and depression. Some antidepressants block
side effects of psychotropic drugs. Table 2-1 lists the reuptake of norepinephrine, while others inhibit
the major neurotransmitters and their actions and MAO from metabolizing it. Epinephrine has limited
effects. Dopamine and serotonin have received the distribution in the brain but controls the fight-or-flight
most attention in terms of the study and treatment response in the peripheral nervous system.
of psychiatric disorders (Tecott, 2000). The following
is a discussion of the major neurotransmitters that
SEROTONIN
have been associated with mental disorders.
Serotonin, a neurotransmitter found only in the
brain, is derived from tryptophan, a dietary amino
DOPAMINE
acid. The function of serotonin is mostly inhibitory,
Dopamine, a neurotransmitter located primarily in and it is involved in the control of food intake, sleep
the brain stem, has been found to be involved in the and wakefulness, temperature regulation, pain con-
control of complex movements, motivation, cognition, trol, sexual behavior, and regulation of emotions.
and regulation of emotional responses. Dopamine is Serotonin plays an important role in anxiety and mood
generally excitatory and is synthesized from tyrosine, disorders and schizophrenia. It has been found to
a dietary amino acid. Dopamine is implicated in schiz- contribute to the delusions, hallucinations, and with-
ophrenia and other psychoses as well as movement drawn behavior seen in schizophrenia. Some anti-
disorders such as Parkinsons disease. Antipsychotic depressants block serotonin reuptake, thus leaving it
medications work by blocking dopamine receptors and available for longer in the synapse, which results in
reducing dopamine activity. improved mood.
Dopamine Dopamine
receptor
Table 2-1
MAJOR NEUROTRANSMITTERS
Type Mechanism of Action Physiologic Effects
alertness. Some psychotropic drugs block histamine, tion, such as benzodiazepines, are used to treat anx-
resulting in weight gain, sedation, and hypotension. iety and induce sleep.
Table 2-2
BRAIN IMAGING TECHNOLOGY
Procedure Imaging Method Results Duration
Computed tomography (CT) Serial x-rays of brain Structural image 2040 minutes
Magnetic resonance Radio waves from brain detected Structural image 45 minutes
imaging (MRI) from magnet
Positron emission tomography Radioactive tracer injected into Functional 23 hours
(PET) bloodstream and monitored as
client performs activities
Single photon emission computed Same as PET Functional 12 hours
tomography (SPECT)
Figure 2-5. Example of computed tomography scan of brain of patient with schizo-
phrenia compared to normal control.
26 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
ease have decreased glucose metabolism in the brain and cannot be detected with current imag-
and decreased cerebral blood flow. Some persons with ing techniques (Karson & Renshaw, 2000;
schizophrenia also demonstrate decreased cerebral Malison & Innis, 2000).
blood flow. Figure 2-7 compares the images obtained
from CAT, MRI, and PET scans.
NEUROBIOLOGIC CAUSES
OF MENTAL ILLNESS
Limitations of Brain Genetics and Heredity
Imaging Techniques
Unlike many physical illnesses that have been found
Although imaging techniques such as PET and SPECT to be hereditary such as cystic fibrosis, Huntingtons
have helped bring about tremendous advances in the disease, and Duchennes muscular dystrophy, the ori-
study of brain diseases, they have some limitations: gins of mental disorders do not seem to be that simple.
The use of radioactive substances in PET Current theories and studies indicate that several
and SPECT limits the number of times a per- mental disorders may be linked to a specific gene or
son can undergo these tests. There is the risk combination of genes but that the source is not solely
that the client will have an allergic reaction genetic; nongenetic factors also play important roles.
to the substances. Some clients may find To date, one of the most promising discoveries is
receiving intravenous doses of radioactive the identification of two genetic links to Alzheimers
material frightening or unacceptable. disease: chromosomes 14 and 21. Research is contin-
Imaging equipment is expensive to purchase uing in an attempt to find genetic links to other dis-
and maintain, so availability can be limited. eases such as schizophrenia and mood disorders. This
A PET camera costs about $2.5 million; a is the focus of ongoing research in the Human Genome
SPECT camera costs about $500,000. Project, funded by the National Institutes of Health
Some persons cannot tolerate these proce- and the U.S. Department of Energy. This interna-
dures because of fear or claustrophobia. tional research project, started in 1988, is the largest
Researchers are finding that many of the of its kind. It has identified all human DNA and con-
changes in disorders such as schizophrenia tinues with research to discover the human charac-
are at the molecular and chemical levels teristics and diseases each gene is related to (encod-
2 NEUROBIOLOGIC THEORIES AND PSYCHOPHARMACOLOGY 27
ing). In addition, the project also addresses the ethi- these illnesses are solely genetically linked. Investi-
cal, legal, and social implications of human genetics gation continues about the influence of inherited traits
research. This program (known as ELSI) focuses on versus the influence of the environmentthe nature
privacy and fairness in the use and interpretation of versus nurture debate. The influence of environmen-
genetic information, clinical integration of new genetic tal or psychosocial factors is discussed in Chapter 3.
technologies, issues surrounding genetics research,
and professional and public education (National Insti-
tute of Health [NIH], 2000). The researchers publish
Stress and the Immune System
their results in the journal Science; further informa- (Psychoimmunology)
tion can be obtained at www.genome.gov. Researchers are following many avenues to discover
Three types of studies are commonly conducted possible causes of mental illness. Psychoimmunol-
to investigate the genetic basis of mental illness: ogy, a relatively new field of study, examines the ef-
1. Twin studies are used to compare the rates fect of psychosocial stressors on the bodys immune
of certain mental illnesses or traits in system. A compromised immune system could con-
monozygotic (identical) twins, who have an tribute to the development of a variety of illnesses par-
identical genetic makeup, and dizygotic ticularly in populations already genetically at risk.
(fraternal) twins, who have a different So far, efforts to link a specific stressor with a specific
genetic makeup. Fraternal twins have the disease have been unsuccessful.
same genetic similarities and differences as
nontwin siblings.
Infection as a Possible Cause
2. Adoption studies are used to determine a
trait among biologic versus adoptive family Some researchers are focusing on infection as a cause
members. of mental illness. Most studies involving viral theo-
3. Family studies are used to compare whether ries have focused on schizophrenia, but so far none
a trait is more common among first-degree has provided specific or conclusive evidence. Theories
relatives (parents, siblings, children) than that are being developed and tested include the exis-
among more distant relatives or the general tence of a virus that has an affinity for tissues of the
population. CNS, the possibility that a virus may actually alter
Although some genetic links have been found in human genes, and maternal exposure to a virus dur-
certain mental disorders, studies have not shown that ing critical fetal development of the nervous system.
28 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
Principles That Guide pany Alzheimers disease (Weiss et al., 2000). Anti-
Pharmacologic Treatment psychotic drugs work by blocking receptors of the
neurotransmitter dopamine. They have been in clin-
The following are several principles to guide the use of ical use since the 1950s. They are the primary med-
medications to treat psychiatric disorders (Maxmen &
ical treatment for schizophrenia and also are used
Ward, 2002):
in psychotic episodes of acute mania, psychotic de-
A medication is selected based on its effect
pression, and drug-induced psychosis. Clients with
on the clients target symptoms such as delu-
dementia who have psychotic symptoms sometimes
sional thinking, panic attacks, or hallucina-
respond to low dosages of antipsychotics. Short-term
tions. The medications effectiveness is eval-
therapy with antipsychotics may be useful for tran-
uated largely by its ability to diminish or
sient psychotic symptoms such as those seen in some
eliminate the target symptoms.
clients with borderline personality disorder (Maxmen
Many psychotropic drugs must be given in
& Ward, 2002).
adequate dosages for some time before their
Table 2-3 lists available dosage forms, usual
full effect is realized. For example, tricyclic
daily oral dosages, and extreme dosage ranges for
antidepressants can require 4 to 6 weeks be-
fore the client experiences optimal therapeu- conventional and atypical antipsychotic drugs. The
tic benefit. low end of the extreme range typically is used with
The dosage of medication often is adjusted to older adults or children with psychoses, aggression,
the lowest effective dosage for the client. or extreme behavior management problems.
Sometimes a client may need higher dosages
to stabilize his or her target symptoms, while MECHANISM OF ACTION
lower dosages can be used to sustain those
effects over time. The major action of all antipsychotics in the nervous
As a rule, older adults require lower dosages system is to block receptors for the neurotransmit-
of medications than do younger clients to ex- ter dopamine; however, the therapeutic mechanism
perience therapeutic effects. It also may take of action is only partially understood. Dopamine re-
longer for a drug to achieve its full therapeu- ceptors are classified into subcategories (D1, D2, D3,
tic effect in older adults. D4, and D5), and D2, D3, and D4 have been associ-
Psychotropic medications often are decreased ated with mental illness. The typical antipsychotic
gradually (tapering) rather than abruptly. drugs are potent antagonists (blockers) of D2, D3,
This is because of potential problems with and D4. This makes them effective in treating target
rebound (temporary return of symptoms), symptoms but also produces many extrapyramidal
recurrence of the original symptoms, or side effects (discussed below) because of the blocking
withdrawal (new symptoms resulting from of the D2 receptors. Newer, atypical antipsychotic
discontinuation of the drug). drugs, such as clozapine (Clozaril), are relatively
Follow-up care is essential to ensure compli- weak blockers of D2, which may account for the lower
ance with the medication regimen, to make incidence of extrapyramidal side effects. In addition,
needed adjustments in dosage, and to manage atypical antipsychotics inhibit the reuptake of sero-
side effects. tonin, as do some of the antidepressants, increasing
Compliance with the medication regimen their effectiveness in treating the depressive aspects
often is enhanced when the regimen is as of schizophrenia.
simple as possible in terms of both the number A new generation of antipsychotics called dopa-
of medications prescribed and the number of mine system stabilizers (DSS) is being developed.
daily doses. These drugs are thought to stabilize dopamine out-
put; that is, they preserve or enhance dopaminergic
transmission where it is too low and reduce it where
Antipsychotic Drugs
it is too high (Stahl, 2001). This results in control of
Antipsychotic drugs, also known as neuroleptics, symptoms without some of the side effects of other
are used to treat the symptoms of psychosis such as antipsychotic medications. Aripiprazole (Abilify), the
the delusions and hallucinations seen in schizophre- first drug of this type, was approved for use in Novem-
nia, schizoaffective disorder, and the manic phase of ber 2002. In clinical trials, the most common side
bipolar disorder. Off-label uses of antipsychotics in- effects were headache, anxiety, and nausea.
clude treatment of anxiety and insomnia; aggres- Two antipsychotics are available in depot in-
sive behavior; and delusions, hallucinations, and jection, a time-release form of medication for
other disruptive behaviors that sometimes accom- maintenance therapy. The vehicle for these injec-
30 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
Table 2-3
ANTIPSYCHOTIC DRUGS
Generic (Trade) Name Forms Daily Dosage* Extreme Dosage Ranges*
CONVENTIONAL ANTIPSYCHOTICS
Phenothiazines
Chlorpromazine (Thorazine) T, L, INJ 2001,600 252,000
Perphenazine (Trilafon) T, L, INJ 1632 464
Fluphenazine (Prolixin) T, L, INJ 2.520 160
Thioridazine (Mellaril) T, L 200600 40800
Mesoridazine (Serentil) T, L, INJ 75300 30400
Trifluoperazine (Stelazine) T, L, INJ 650 280
Thioxanthene
Thiothixene (Navane) C, L, INJ 630 660
Butyrophenone
Haloperidol (Haldol) T, L, INJ 220 1100
Droperidol (Inapsine) INJ 2.5 mg
Dibenzazepine
Loxapine (Loxitane) C, L, INJ 60100 30250
Dihydroindolone
Molindone (Moban) T, L 50100 15250
ATYPICAL ANTIPSYCHOTICS
Clozapine (Clozaril) T 150500 75700
Risperidone (Risperdol) T 28 116
Olanzapine (Zyprexa) T 515 520
Quetiapine (Seroquel) T 300600 200750
Ziprasidone (Geodon) C, INJ 40160 20200
NEW GENERATION ANTIPSYCHOTIC
Aripiprazole (Abilify) 1530
*mg/day for oral doses only
T, tablet; C, capsule; L, liquid for oral use; INJ, injection for IM (usually prn) use.
tions is sesame oil, so the medication is absorbed sponsible for the development of EPS. Conventional
slowly over time; thus, less frequent administration antipsychotic drugs cause a greater incidence of EPS
is needed to maintain the desired therapeutic effects. than do atypical antipsychotic drugs, with ziprasi-
Prolixin (decanoate fluphenazine) has a duration of 7 done (Geodon) rarely causing EPS (Keck, McElroy, &
to 28 days, and Haldol (decanoate haloperidol) has a Arnold, 2001).
duration of 4 weeks. Once the clients condition is Therapies for acute dystonia, pseudoparkinson-
stabilized with oral doses of these medications, ad- ism, and akathisia are similar and include lowering
ministration by depot injection is required every 2 the dosage of the antipsychotic, changing to a differ-
to 4 weeks to maintain the therapeutic effect. ent antipsychotic, or administering anticholinergic
Valenstein et al. (2001) report that depot injections medication (see discussion below). As anticholinergic
are prescribed relatively infrequently despite high drugs also produce side effects, Gray & Gourney (2000)
levels of medication noncompliance among clients. advocate prescribing atypical antipsychotic medica-
tions because the incidence of EPS side effects asso-
ciated with them is decreased.
SIDE EFFECTS
Acute dystonia includes acute muscular rigid-
Extrapyramidal Side Effects. Extrapyramidal ity and cramping, a stiff or thick tongue with diffi-
symptoms (EPS), serious neurologic symptoms, culty swallowing, and, in severe cases, laryngospasm
are the major side effects of antipsychotic drugs. and respiratory difficulties. Dystonia is most likely in
They include acute dystonia, pseudoparkinsonism, the first week of treatment, in clients younger than
and akathisia. Although often collectively referred 40 years, in males, and in those receiving high-potency
to as EPS, each of these reactions has distinct fea- drugs such as haloperidol and thiothixene. Spasms
tures. One client can experience all the reactions or stiffness in muscle groups can produce torticollis
in the same course of therapy, which makes distin- (twisted head and neck), opisthotonus (tightness in
guishing among them difficult. Blockade of D2 re- the entire body with the head back and an arched
ceptors in the midbrain region of the brain stem is re- neck), or oculogyric crisis (eyes rolled back in a locked
2 NEUROBIOLOGIC THEORIES AND PSYCHOPHARMACOLOGY 31
Table 2-4
DRUGS USED TO TREAT EXTRAPYRAMIDAL SIDE EFFECTS
Generic (Trade) Name Oral Dosages (mg) IM/IV Doses (mg) Drug Class
lor; delirium; and elevated levels of enzymes particu- vision, dry eyes, photophobia, nasal congestion, and
larly CPK. Clients with NMS usually are confused decreased memory. These side effects usually de-
and often mute; they may fluctuate from agitation to crease within 3 to 4 weeks but do not entirely remit.
stupor. All antipsychotics seem to have the potential The client who is taking anticholinergic agents for
to cause NMS, but high dosages of high-potency drugs EPS may have increased problems with anticholin-
increase the risk. NMS most often occurs in the first ergic side effects. Using calorie-free beverages or
2 weeks of therapy or after an increase in dosage, but hard candy may alleviate dry mouth; stool softeners,
it can occur at any time. adequate fluid intake, and the inclusion of grains and
Dehydration, poor nutrition, and concurrent med- fruit in the diet may prevent constipation.
ical illness all increase the risk for NMS. Treatment in-
cludes immediate discontinuance of all antipsychotic Other Side Effects. Antipsychotic drugs also in-
medications and the institution of supportive medical crease blood prolactin level. Elevated prolactin may
care to treat dehydration and hyperthermia until the cause breast enlargement and tenderness in men
clients physical condition stabilizes. After NMS, the and women; diminished libido, erectile and orgas-
decision to treat the client with other antipsychotic mic dysfunction, and menstrual irregularities; in-
drugs requires full discussion between the client and crease risk for breast cancer; and may contribute to
the physician to weigh the relative risks against the weight gain.
potential benefits of therapy. Weight gain can accompany most antipsychotic
medications but it is most likely with the atypical
Tardive Dyskinesia. Tardive dyskinesia (TD), a antipsychotic drugs with ziprasidone (Geodon) being
syndrome of permanent, involuntary movements, is the exception. Weight increases are most significant
most commonly caused by the long-term use of con- with clozapine (Clozaril) and olanzapine (Zyprexa).
ventional antipsychotic drugs. The pathophysiology Though the exact mechanism of this weight gain is
is still not understood, and no effective treatment is unknown, it is associated with increased appetite,
binge eating, carbohydrate craving, food preference
available (Sachdev, 2000). At least 20% of those
changes, and decreased satiety in some clients. Pro-
treated with neuroleptics in the long term develop TD.
lactin elevation may stimulate feeding centers; his-
The symptoms of TD include involuntary movements
tamine antagonism stimulates appetite; and there
of the tongue, facial and neck muscles, upper and
may be an as yet undetermined interplay of multi-
lower extremities, and truncal musculature. Tongue
ple neurotransmitter and receptor interactions with
thrusting and protruding, lip-smacking, blinking,
resultant changes in appetite, energy intake, and feed-
grimacing, and other excessive, unnecessary facial
ing behavior (McIntyre, McCann, & Kennedy, 2001;
movements are characteristic. Once it has developed,
Casey & Zorn, 2001; Allison & Casey, 2001). Obesity
TD is irreversible although decreasing or discontin-
is common in clients with schizophrenia, causing an
uing antipsychotic medications can arrest its pro- increased risk for type 2 diabetes mellitus and cardio-
gression. Unfortunately antipsychotic medications vascular disease. In addition, clients with schizophre-
can mask the beginning symptoms of TD: that is, in- nia are less likely to exercise or eat low-fat, nutri-
creased dosages of the antipsychotic medication will tionally balanced diets; this pattern decreases the
cause the initial symptoms to disappear temporarily. likelihood that they can minimize potential weight
As the symptoms of TD worsen, however, they break gain or lose excess weight (Green et. al., 2000).
through the effect of the antipsychotic drug. Most antipsychotic drugs cause relatively minor
Preventing TD is one goal when administering cardiovascular adverse effects such as postural hypo-
antipsychotics. This can be done by keeping mainte- tension, palpitations, and tachycardia. Certain anti-
nance dosages as low as possible, changing medica- psychotic drugs, such as thioridazine (Mellaril),
tions, and monitoring the client periodically for ini- droperidol (Inapsine), and mesoridazine (Serentil),
tial signs of TD using a standardized assessment tool also can cause a lengthening of the QT interval. A
such as the Abnormal Involuntary Movement Scale QT interval that is longer than 500 milliseconds is
(see Chap. 14). Clients who have already developed considered dangerous and is associated with life-
signs of TD but still need to take an antipsychotic threatening dysrhythmias and sudden death (Gray,
medication often are given one of the atypical anti- 2001). Thioridazine and mesoridazine are used to
psychotic drugs that have not yet been found to cause treat psychosis; droperidol is most often used as an
or, therefore, worsen TD. adjunct to anesthesia or to produce sedation. Sertin-
dole (Serlect) was never approved in the United
Anticholinergic Side Effects. Anticholinergic side States to treat psychosis but was used in Europe
effects often occur with the use of antipsychotics and and subsequently withdrawn from the market be-
include orthostatic hypotension, dry mouth, consti- cause of the number of cardiac dysrhythmias and
pation, urinary hesitance or retention, blurred near deaths that it caused.
2 NEUROBIOLOGIC THEORIES AND PSYCHOPHARMACOLOGY 33
Table 2-5
ANTIDEPRESSANT DRUGS
Generic (Trade) Name Forms Usual Daily Dosages* Extreme Dosage Ranges*
MAOIs are potentially lethal in overdose and MAOIs. Evaluation of the risk for suicide must con-
pose a potential risk for clients with depres- tinue even after treatment with antidepressants is
sion who may be considering suicide. initiated. The client may feel more energized but
The SSRIs, first available in 1987 with the re- still have suicidal thoughts, which increases the
lease of fluoxetine (Prozac), have replaced the cyclic likelihood of a suicide attempt. Also, because it often
drugs as the first choice in treating depression because takes weeks before the medications have a full ther-
they are equal in efficacy and produce fewer trouble- apeutic effect, clients may become discouraged and
some side effects. The SSRIs and clomipramine are tire of waiting to feel better, which can result in sui-
effective in the treatment of OCD as well. Prozac cidal behavior.
Weekly is the first and only medication that can be
given once a week as maintenance therapy for de-
pression after the client has been stabilized on fluoxe- MECHANISM OF ACTION
tine. It contains 90 mg of fluoxetine with an enteric The precise mechanism by which antidepressants
coating that delays release into the bloodstream. produce their therapeutic effects is not known, but
much is known about their action on the CNS. The
PREFERRED DRUGS FOR CLIENTS major interaction is with the monoamine neuro-
AT HIGH RISK FOR SUICIDE transmitter systems in the brain, particularly nor-
epinephrine and serotonin. Both of these neuro-
Suicide is always a primary consideration when treat- transmitters are released throughout the brain, and
ing clients with depression. SSRIs, venlafaxine, ne- help to regulate arousal, vigilance, attention, mood,
fazodone, trazodone, and bupropion are often a bet- sensory processing, and appetite. Norepinephrine,
ter choice for those who are potentially suicidal or serotonin, and dopamine are removed from the
highly impulsive because they carry no risk of lethal synapses after release by reuptake into presynaptic
overdose in contrast to the cyclic compounds and the neurons. After reuptake, these three neurotransmit-
2 NEUROBIOLOGIC THEORIES AND PSYCHOPHARMACOLOGY 35
ters are reloaded for subsequent release or metabo- cholinergic effects, such as agitation, delirium, and
lized by the enzyme MAO. The SSRIs block the re- ileus, may occur particularly in older adults. Other
uptake of serotonin; the cyclic antidepressants and common side effects include orthostatic hypotension,
venlafaxine block the reuptake of norepinephrine pri- sedation, weight gain, and tachycardia. Clients may
marily and serotonin to some degree; and the MAOIs develop tolerance to anticholinergic effects, but these
interfere with enzyme metabolism. This is not the side effects are common reasons that clients dis-
complete explanation, however: the blockade of sero- continue drug therapy. Clients taking cyclic com-
tonin and norepinephrine reuptake and the inhibi- pounds frequently report sexual dysfunction similar
tion of MAO occur in a matter of hours, whereas anti- to problems experienced with SSRIs. Both weight
depressants are rarely effective until taken for several gain and sexual dysfunction are cited as common
weeks. The cyclic compounds may take 4 to 6 weeks reasons for noncompliance (Fava, 2000; Woodrum &
to be effective; MAOIs need 2 to 4 weeks for effective- Brown, 1998).
ness; and SSRIs may be effective in 2 to 3 weeks. Re-
searchers believe that the actions of these drugs are an
initiating event and that eventual therapeutic effec- SIDE EFFECTS OF MAOIs
tiveness results when neurons respond more slowly, The most common side effects of MAOIs include day-
making serotonin available at the synapses (Maxmen time sedation, insomnia, weight gain, dry mouth, or-
& Ward, 2002). thostatic hypotension, and sexual dysfunction. The
sedation and insomnia are difficult to treat and may
SIDE EFFECTS OF SSRIs necessitate a change in medication. Of particular con-
cern with MAOIs is the potential for a life-threatening
SSRIs have fewer side effects compared with the hypertensive crisis if the client ingests food that con-
cyclic compounds. Enhanced serotonin transmission tains tyramine or takes sympathomimetic drugs. Be-
can lead to several common side effects such as anx- cause the enzyme monoamine oxidase is necessary to
iety, agitation, akathisia (motor restlessness), nau- break down the tyramine in certain foods, its inhibi-
sea, insomnia, and sexual dysfunction, specifically tion results in increased serum tyramine levels, which
diminished sexual drive or difficulty achieving an causes severe hypertension, hyperpyrexia, tachy-
erection or orgasm. In addition, weight gain is both cardia, diaphoresis, tremulousness, and cardiac dys-
an initial and ongoing problem during antidepres- rhythmias. Drugs that may cause potentially fatal in-
sant therapy though SSRIs cause less weight gain teractions with MAOIs include SSRIs, certain cyclic
than other antidepressants. Taking medications with compounds, buspirone (BuSpar), dextromethorphan,
food usually can minimize nausea. Akathisia usually and opiate derivatives such as meperidine. The client
is treated with a beta-blocker such as propranolol must be able to follow a tyramine-free diet; Box 2-1
(Inderal), or a benzodiazepine. Insomnia may con- lists the foods to avoid.
tinue to be a problem even if the client takes the
medication in the morning; a sedative-hypnotic or SIDE EFFECTS OF OTHER
low-dosage trazodone may be needed. ANTIDEPRESSANTS
Less common side effects include sedation (par- Of the other or novel antidepressant medications,
ticularly with paroxetine [Paxil]), sweating, diarrhea, nefazodone, trazodone, and mirtazapine (Remeron)
hand tremor, and headaches. Diarrhea and headaches commonly cause sedation. Both nefazodone and tra-
usually can be managed with symptomatic treatment. zodone commonly cause headaches. Nefazodone also
Sweating and continued sedation most likely indicate can cause dry mouth and nausea. Bupropion and
the need for a change to another antidepressant. venlafaxine may cause loss of appetite, nausea, agita-
tion, and insomnia. Venlafaxine also may cause dizzi-
SIDE EFFECTS OF CYCLIC ness, sweating, or sedation. Sexual dysfunction is
ANTIDEPRESSANTS much less common with the novel antidepressants
with one notable exception: trazodone can cause pri-
Cyclic compounds have more side effects than do apism (a sustained and painful erection that neces-
SSRIs and the newer, miscellaneous compounds. The sitates immediate treatment and discontinuation of
individual medications in this category vary in terms the drug). Priapism also may result in impotence.
of the intensity of side effects, but generally side ef-
fects fall into the same categories. The cyclic anti-
WARNING: Nefazadone
depressants block cholinergic receptors, resulting in
anticholinergic effects such as dry mouth, constipa- May cause rare but potentially life-threatening
tion, urinary hesitancy or retention, dry nasal pas- liver damage, which could lead to liver failure
sages, and blurred near vision. More severe anti-
36 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
Box 2-1
FOODS (CONTAINING TYRAMINE) TO AVOID WHEN TAKING MAOIS
Mature or aged cheeses or dishes made with cheese, such as lasagna or pizza. All cheese is considered aged
except cottage cheese, cream cheese, ricotta cheese, and processed cheese slices.
Aged meats such as pepperoni, salami, mortadella, summer sausage, beef logs, and similar products. Make
sure meat and chicken are fresh and have been properly refrigerated.
Italian broad beans (fava) pods or banana peel. Banana pulp and all other fruits and vegetables are permitted.
All tap beers and microbrewery beer. Drink no more than two cans or bottles of beer (including non-alcoholic
beer) or 4 ounces of wine per day.
Sauerkraut, soy sauce or soybean condiments, or marmite (concentrated yeast)
Adapted from Gardener, D.M., Shulman, K.L. Walker, S.E., & Taylor, S.A.N. (1996). The making of a user-friendly MAOI diet.
Journal of Clinical Psychiatry, 57, 99104.
release of norepinephrine through competition with extreme dosage range is 750 to 3,000 mg/day. Serum
calcium. Lithium produces its effects intracellularly drug levels, obtained 12 hours after the last dose of
rather than within neuronal synapses; it acts di- the medication, are monitored for therapeutic levels
rectly on G proteins and certain enzyme subsystems of both these anticonvulsants.
such as cyclic adenosine monophosphates and phos-
phatidylinositol (Schatzberg & Nemeroff, 2001).
SIDE EFFECTS
The mechanism of action for anticonvulsants is
not clear as it relates to their off-label use as mood Common side effects of lithium therapy include mild
stabilizers. Valproic acid and topiramate are known nausea or diarrhea, anorexia, fine hand tremor, poly-
to increase levels of the inhibitory neurotransmitter dipsia, polyuria, a metallic taste in the mouth, and
GABA. Both valproic acid and carbamazepine are fatigue or lethargy. Weight gain and acne are side ef-
thought to stabilize mood by inhibiting the kindling fects that occur later in lithium therapy; both are dis-
process. This can be described as the snowball-like tressing for clients. Taking the medication with food
effect seen when minor seizure activity seems to may help with nausea, and the use of propranolol
build up into more frequent and severe seizures. In often improves the fine tremor. Lethargy and weight
seizure management, anticonvulsants raise the level gain are difficult to manage or minimize and fre-
of the threshold to prevent these minor seizures. It is quently lead to noncompliance.
suspected that this same kindling process also may Toxic effects of lithium are severe diarrhea, vom-
occur in the development of full-blown mania with iting, drowsiness, muscle weakness, and lack of coor-
stimulation by more frequent, minor episodes. This dination. Untreated, these symptoms worsen and can
may explain why anticonvulsants are effective in the lead to renal failure, coma, and death. When toxic
treatment and prevention of mania as well (Egan & signs occur, the drug should be discontinued immedi-
Hyde, 2000). ately. If lithium levels exceed 3.0 mEq/L, dialysis may
be indicated.
DOSAGE Side effects of carbamazepine and valproic acid
include drowsiness, sedation, dry mouth, and blurred
Lithium is available in tablets, capsules, liquid, and
vision. In addition, carbamazepine may cause rashes
a sustained-released form; no parenteral forms are
and orthostatic hypotension, and valproic acid may
available. The effective dosage of lithium is deter-
cause weight gain, alopecia, and hand tremor. Topi-
mined by monitoring serum lithium levels and as-
ramate causes dizziness, sedation, weight loss (rather
sessing the clients clinical response to the drug.
than gain), and increased incidence of renal calculi
Daily dosages generally range from 900 to 3,600 mg;
more importantly, the serum lithium level should be (Schatzberg & Nemeroff, 2001).
about 1.0 mEq/L. Serum lithium levels of less than
0.5 mEq/L are rarely therapeutic, and levels of more WARNING: Valproic Acid and
than 1.5 mEq/L are usually considered toxic. The Its Derivatives
lithium level should be monitored every 2 to 3 days
while the therapeutic dosage is being determined, Can cause hepatic failure resulting in fatality.
then weekly. When the clients condition is stable, Liver function tests should be performed prior
the level may need to be checked once a month or less to therapy and at frequent intervals thereafter,
frequently. especially for the first 6 months. Can produce
tetratogenic effects such as neural tube defects
(e.g., spina bifida). Can cause life-threatening pan-
WARNING: Lithium creatitis in both children and adults. Can occur
Toxicity is closely related to serum lithium levels shortly after initiation or after years of therapy.
and can occur at therapeutic doses. Facilities for
serum lithium determinations are required to
monitor therapy. WARNING: Carbamazepine
Can cause aplastic anemia and agranulocytosis
Carbamazepine is available in liquid, tablet, at a rate five to eight times greater than the gen-
and chewable tablet forms. Dosages usually range eral population. Pretreatment hematologic base-
from 800 to 1,200 mg/day; the extreme dosage range line data should be obtained and monitored peri-
is 200 to 2,000 mg/day. Valproic acid is available in odically throughout therapy to discover lowered
liquid, tablet, and capsule forms and as sprinkles WBC or platelet counts.
with dosages ranging from 1,000 to 1,500 mg/day; the
38 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
SIDE EFFECTS
Although not a side effect in the true sense, one chief
problem encountered with the use of benzodiazepines
is their tendency to cause physical dependence. Sig-
nificant discontinuation symptoms occur when the
drug is stopped; these symptoms often resemble the
original symptoms for which the client sought treat-
ment. This is especially a problem for clients with long-
Periodic blood levels term benzodiazepine use such as those with panic
2 NEUROBIOLOGIC THEORIES AND PSYCHOPHARMACOLOGY 39
Table 2-6
ANTIANXIETY (ANXIOLYTIC) DRUGS
Generic (Trade) Name Daily Dosage Range Half-Life (hours) Speed of Onset
BENZODIAZEPINES
Alprazolam (Xanax) 0.751.5 1215 Intermediate
Chlordiazepoxide (Librium) 15100 50100 Intermediate
Clonazepam (Klonopin) 1.520 1850 Intermediate
Chlorazepate (Tranxene) 1560 30200 Fast
Diazepam (Valium) 440 30100 Very fast
Flurazepam (Dalmane) 1530 47100 Fast
Lorazepam (Ativan) 28 1020 Moderately slow
Oxazepam (Serax) 30120 321 Moderately slow
Temazepam (Restoril) 1530 9.520 Moderately fast
Triazolam (Halcion) 0.250.5 24 Fast
NONBENZODIAZEPINE
Buspirone (BuSpar) 1530 311 Very slow
disorder or generalized anxiety disorder. Psycho- Benzodiazepine withdrawal can be fatal: once
logical dependence on benzodiazepines is common: the client has started a course of therapy, he or she
clients fear the return of anxiety symptoms or believe should never discontinue benzodiazepines abruptly
themselves incapable of handling anxiety without or without the supervision of the physician (Maxmen
the drugs. This can lead to overuse or abuse of these & Ward, 2002).
drugs. Buspirone does not cause this type of physical
dependence.
The side effects most commonly reported with
benzodiazepines are those associated with CNS de-
pression such as drowsiness, sedation, poor coordina-
tion, and impaired memory or clouded sensorium.
When used for sleep, clients may complain of next-day
sedation or a hangover effect. Clients often develop a
tolerance to these symptoms, and they generally de-
crease in intensity. Common side effects from bus-
pirone include dizziness, sedation, nausea, and
headache (Schatzberg & Nemeroff, 2001).
Elderly clients may have more difficulty man-
aging the effects of CNS depression. They may be
more prone to falls from the effects on coordination
and sedation. They also may have more pronounced
memory deficits and may have problems with uri-
nary incontinence particularly at night.
CLIENT TEACHING
Clients need to know that antianxiety agents are
aimed at relieving symptoms such as anxiety or in-
somnia but do not treat the underlying problems that
cause the anxiety. Benzodiazepines strongly potenti-
ate the effects of alcohol: one drink may have the ef-
fect of three drinks. Therefore clients should not
drink alcohol while taking benzodiazepines. Clients
should be aware of decreased response time, slower
reflexes, and possible sedative effects of these drugs
when attempting activities such as driving or going
to work. No alcohol with benzodiazepines
40 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
Table 2-7
STIMULANT DRUGS
Generic (Trade) Name Dosage
palpitations. The most common long-term problem odorant, and over-the-counter medications such as
with stimulants is the growth and weight suppression cough preparations contain alcohol; when used by
that occurs in some children. This can usually be pre- the client taking disulfiram, these products can pro-
vented by taking drug holidays on weekends and duce the same reaction as drinking alcohol. The
holidays or during summer vacation, which helps to client must read product labels carefully and select
restore normal eating and growth patterns. items that are alcohol-free.
diazepines, and other sedative-hypnotic agents. Valer- It is also important for the nurse to know about
ian helps produce sleep and is sometimes used to re- current biologic theories and treatments. Many clients
lieve stress and anxiety. Ginkgo biloba is primarily and their families will have questions about reports
used to improve memory but is also taken for fatigue, in the news about research or discoveries. The nurse
anxiety, and depression. can help them distinguish between what is factual
It is essential for the nurse to ask clients specif- and what is experimental. Also it is important to keep
ically if they use any herbal preparations. Clients discoveries and theories in perspective.
may not consider these products as medicine or Clients and families need more than factual in-
may be reluctant to admit their use for fear of cen- formation to deal with mental illness and its effect on
sure by health professionals. Herbal medicines are their lives. Many clients do not understand the na-
often chemically complex and are not standardized or ture of their illness and ask, Why is this happening
regulated for use in treating illnesses. Combining to me? They need simple but thorough explanations
herbal preparations with other medicines can lead to about the nature of the illness and how they can
unwanted interactions, so it essential to assess the manage it. The nurse must learn to give out enough
clients use of these products. information about the illness while providing the
care and support needed by all those confronting
mental illness.
SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES
Nurses must examine their own beliefs
Points to Consider When Working on
and feelings about mental disorders as illnesses
Self-Awareness
and the role of drugs in treating mental disorders.
Some nurses may be skeptical about some mental Chronic mental illness has periods of remis-
disorders and may believe that clients could gain con- sion and exacerbation just like chronic physi-
trol of their lives if they would just put forth enough cal illness. A recurrence of symptoms is not
effort. Nurses who work with clients with mental dis- the clients fault nor is it a failure of treat-
orders come to understand that many disorders are ment or nursing care.
similar to chronic physical illnesses such as asthma Research regarding the neurobiologic
or diabetes, which require lifelong medication to causes of mental disorders is still in its in-
maintain health. Without proper medication man- fancy. Do not dismiss new ideas just because
agement, clients with certain mental disorders, such they may not yet help in the treatment of
as schizophrenia or bipolar affective disorder, cannot these illnesses.
survive and cope with the world around them. The Often when clients stop taking medication
nurse must explain to the client and family that this or take medication improperly, it is not be-
is an illness that requires continuous medication cause they intend to; rather it is the result of
management and follow-up just like a chronic physi- faulty thinking and reasoning, which is part
cal illness. of the illness.
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
The primary use of stimulants such as Maxmen, J. S., & Ward, N. G. (2002). Psychotropic drugs:
methylphenidate (Ritalin) is the treatment of Fast facts. New York: Norton Publishing.
McIntyre, R. S., McCann, S. M., & Kennedy, S. H. (2001).
children with ADHD. Methylphenidate has Antipsychotic metabolic effects: weight gain, Diabetes
been proven to be successful in allowing these mellitus, and lipid abnormalities. The Canadian
children to slow down their activity and focus Journal of Psychiatry, 46, 273281.
on the tasks at hand and their schoolwork. National Institute of Health. (2000). About ELSI. Re-
Its exact mechanism of action is unknown. trieved 2/3/2002. http://www.nhgri.nhi.gov/ELSI
Ruiz, S., Chu, P., Sramek, J. J., Rotavu, E., & Herrera, J.
Clients from various cultures may metabolize (1996). Neuroleptic dosing in Asian and Hispanic
medications at different rates and, therefore, outpatients with schizophrenia. Mt. Sinai Journal of
require alterations in standard dosages. Medicine, 63(56), 306309.
Assessing use of herbal preparations is essen- Sachdev, P. S. (2000). The current status of tardive
dyskinesia. Australian and New Zealand Journal of
tial for all clients. Psychiatry, 34, 355369.
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com. Schatzberg, A. F., & Nemeroff, C. B. (2001). Essentials of
clinical psychopharmacology. Washington, DC:
American Psychiatric Publishing.
REFERENCES
Selemon, L. D. & Goldman-Rakic, P. S. (1995). Prefrontal
Allison, D. B., & Casey, D. E. (2001). Antipsychotic-induced cortex. American Journal of Psychiatry, 152(1), 5.
weight gain: A review of the literature. Journal of Shank, R. P., Smith-Swintosky, V. L., & Twyman, R. E.
Clinical Psychiatry, 62(suppl. 7), 2231. (2000). Amino acid neurotransmitters. In B. J.
American Psychiatric Association. (2000). Diagnostic and Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive text-
statistical manual of mental disorders (4th ed., text book of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 5059).
revision). Washington, DC: Author. Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Beaubrun, G., & Gray, G. E. (2000). A review of herbal Small, G. Genetic risk and imaging. Program and ab-
medicines for psychiatric disorders. Psychiatric Ser- stracts of the 8th International Conference on
vices, 51(9), 11301134. Alzheimers Disease and Related Disorders; July
Casey, D. E., & Zorn, S. H. (2001). The pharmacology of 2025, 2002; Stockholm, Sweden. Abstract 1307.
Sramek, J. J., & Pi, E. H. (1996). Ethnicity and anti-
weight gain with antipsychotics. Journal of Clinical
depressant response. Mt. Sinai Journal of Medicine,
Psychiatry, 62(suppl. 7), 410.
63(56), 320325.
Egan, M. F., & Hyde, T. M. (2000). Schizophrenia: Neuro-
Stahl, S. M. (2001). Dopamine system stabilizers, arip-
biology. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Com-
iprazole, and the next generation of antipsychotics:
prehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1. (7th ed.,
Goldilocks actions at d receptors. Journal of Clinical
pp. 11291147). Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Psychiatry, 62(11), 841842.
Wilkins. Tecott, L. H. (2000). Monoamine transmitters. In B. J.
Gray, R. (2001). Medication-related cardiac risks and Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive text-
sudden deaths among people receiving antipsychotics book of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 4150).
for the first time. Mental Health Care, 4(3), 301304. Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Gray, R., & Gournay, K. (2001). What can we do about ex- Valenstein, M., Copeland, L. A., Owne, R., Blow, F. C., &
trapyramidal symptoms? Journal of Psychiatric and Visnic, S. (2001). Adherence assessments and the use
Mental Health Nursing, 7, 205211. of depot antipsychotics in patients with schizophre-
Green, A. I., Patel, J. K., Goisman, R. M., Allison, D. B., nia. Journal of Clinical Psychiatry, 62(7), 545551.
& Blackburn, G. (2000). Weight gain from novel anti- Washington, H. (1999). Infection connection. Psychology
psychotic drugs: Need for action. General Hospital Today, 4, 4344, 7476.
Psychiatry, 22, 224235. Weiss, E., Hummer, M., Koller, D., Ulmer, H., & Fleisch-
Karson, C. N., & Renshaw, P. F. (2000). Principles of hacker, W. W. (2000). Off-label use of antipsychotic
neuroimaging: Resonance techniques. In B. J. Sadock drugs. Journal of Clinical Psychopharmacology,
& V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of 20(6), 695698.
psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 162172). Philadelphia: Woodrum, S. T., & Brown, C. S. (1998). Management of
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins. SSRI-induced sexual dysfunction. The Annals of
Keck, P. E., McElroy, S. L., & Arnold, L. M. (2001). Pharmacotherapy, 32, 12091214.
Ziprasidone: A new atypical antipsychotic. Expert
Opinions in Pharmacotherapy, 2(6), 10331042.
Kudzma, E. C. (1999). Culturally competent drug admin- ADDITIONAL READINGS
istration. American Journal of Nursing, 99(8), 4652.
Lawson, W. B. (1996). The art and science of psycho- Hsin-Tung, E., & Simpson, G. M. (2000). Medication-
pharmacology of African Americans. Mt. Sinai Journal induced movement disorders. In B. J. Sadock & V. A.
of Medicine, 63(56), 301305. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry,
Lewis, D. A. (2000). Functional neuroanatomy. In B. J. Vol. 2 (7th ed., pp. 22652271). Philadelphia:
Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive text- Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
book of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 331). Mathews, C. A., & Friemer, N. B. (2000). Genetic linkage
Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins. analysis of the psychiatric disorders. In B. J. Sadock
Malison, R. T., & Innis, R. B. (2000). Principles of neuro- & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psy-
imaging: Radiotracer techniques. In B. J. Sadock & chiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 184198). Philadelphia:
V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psy- Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
chiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 154162). Philadelphia: Snell, R. S. (1997). Clinical neuroanatomy for medical
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins. students (2d ed.) Philadelphia: Lippincott-Raven.
Chapter Study Guide
MULTIPLE-CHOICE QUESTIONS
Select the best answer for each of the following
questions.
3. The signs of lithium toxicity include which of the B. Navane 10 mg p.o. bid
following? C. Prolixin 5 mg p.o. tid
A. Sedation, fever, restlessness D. Risperdal 2 mg bid
B. Psychomotor agitation, insomnia, increased
thirst 8. Clients taking which of the following types of
psychotropic medications need close monitoring
C. Elevated WBC count, sweating, confusion of their cardiac status?
D. Severe vomiting, diarrhea, weakness A. Antidepressants
4. Which of the following is a concern for children B. Antipsychotics
taking stimulants for ADHD for several years? C. Mood stabilizers
A. Dependence on the drug D. Stimulants
B. Insomnia
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com
45
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify the drug classification for each of the following medications.
1. Clozapine (Clozaril)
2. Fluoxetine (Prozac)
3. Amitriptyline (Elavil)
4. Benztropine (Cogentin)
5. Methylphenidate (Ritalin)
6. Carbamazepine (Tegretol)
7. Clonazepam (Klonopin)
8. Quetiapine (Seroquel)
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
1. Explain the rationale for tapering psychotropic medication doses before the
client discontinues the drug.
46
2. Describe the teaching needed for a client who is scheduled for
PET scanning.
47
3 Psychosocial
Theories and
Learning Objectives Therapy
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
48
3 PSYCHOSOCIAL THEORIES AND THERAPY 49
Todays mental health treatment has an eclectic ap- centuries in Vienna, where he spent most of his life.
proach, meaning one that incorporates concepts and Several other noted psychoanalysts and theorists
strategies from a variety of sources. This chapter pre- have contributed to this body of knowledge, but Freud
sents an overview of major psychosocial theories, high- is its undisputed founder. Many clinicians and theo-
lights the ideas and concepts in current practice, and rists did not agree with much of Freuds psycho-
explains the various psychosocial treatment modali- analytic theory and later developed their own theo-
ties. The psychosocial theories have produced many ries and styles of treatment.
models currently used in individual and group therapy Psychoanalytic theory supports the notion that
and various treatment settings. The medical model of all human behavior is caused and can be explained
treatment is based on the neurobiologic theories dis- (deterministic theory). Freud believed that repressed
cussed in Chapter 2. (driven from conscious awareness) sexual impulses
and desires motivated much human behavior. He de-
PSYCHOSOCIAL THEORIES veloped his initial ideas and explanations of human
behavior from his experiences with a few clients, all
Many theories attempt to explain human behavior, of them women who displayed unusual behaviors
health, and mental illness. Each theory suggests how such as disturbances of sight and speech, inability
normal development occurs based on the theorists to eat, and paralysis of limbs. These symptoms had
beliefs, assumptions, and view of the world. These no physiologic basis, so Freud considered them to
theories suggest strategies that the clinician can use be the hysterical or neurotic behavior of women.
to work with clients. Many of the theories discussed After several years of working with these women,
in this chapter were not based on empirical or re- Freud concluded that many of their problems re-
search evidence; rather, they evolved from individual sulted from childhood trauma or failure to complete
experiences and might more appropriately be called tasks of psychosexual development. These women re-
conceptual models or frameworks. pressed their unmet needs and sexual feelings as well
as traumatic events. The hysterical or neurotic be-
Psychoanalytic Theories haviors resulted from these unresolved conflicts.
SIGMUND FREUD: Personality Components: Id, Ego, and Superego.
THE FATHER OF PSYCHOANALYSIS Freud conceptualized personality structure as having
Sigmund Freud (18561939; Fig. 3-1) developed three components: id, ego, and superego. The id is the
psychoanalytic theory in the late 19th and early 20th part of ones nature that reflects basic or innate de-
sires such as pleasure-seeking behavior, aggression,
and sexual impulses. The id seeks instant gratifica-
tion; causes impulsive, unthinking behavior; and has
no regard for rules or social convention. The super-
ego is the part of a persons nature that reflects moral
and ethical concepts, values, and parental and social
expectations; therefore, it is in direct opposition to the
id. The third component, the ego, is the balancing or
mediating force between the id and the superego. The
ego represents mature and adaptive behavior that al-
lows a person to function successfully in the world.
Freud believed that anxiety resulted from the egos
attempts to balance the impulsive instincts of the id
with the stringent rules of the superego. The accom-
panying drawing demonstrates the relationship of
these personality structures.
Table 3-1
EGO DEFENSE MECHANISMS
Compensation Overachievement in one area to offset real or perceived deficiencies in another area
Napoleon complex: diminutive man becoming emperor
Nurse with low self-esteem works double shifts so her supervisor will like her.
Conversion Expression of an emotional conflict through the development of a physical symptom, usually
sensorimotor in nature
A teenager forbidden to see X-rated movies is tempted to do so by friends and develops
blindness, and the teenager is unconcerned about the loss of sight.
Denial Failure to acknowledge an unbearable condition; failure to admit the reality of a situation, or
how one enables the problem to continue
Diabetic eating chocolate candy
Spending money freely when broke
Waiting 3 days to seek help for severe abdominal pain
Displacement Ventilation of intense feelings toward persons less threatening than the one who aroused
those feelings
A person who is mad at the boss yells at his or her spouse.
A child who is harassed by a bully at school mistreats a younger sibling.
Dissociation Dealing with emotional conflict by a temporary alteration in consciousness or identity
Amnesia that prevents recall of yesterdays auto accident
An adult remembers nothing of childhood sexual abuse.
Fixation Immobilization of a portion of the personality resulting from unsuccessful completion of
tasks in a developmental stage.
Never learning to delay gratification
Lack of a clear sense of identity as an adult
Identification Modeling actions and opinions of influential others while searching for identity, or aspiring to
reach a personal, social, or occupational goal
Nursing student becoming a critical care nurse because this is the specialty of an instructor
she admires.
Intellectualization Separation of the emotions of a painful event or situation from the facts involved; acknowl-
edging the facts but not the emotions
Person shows no emotional expression when discussing serious car accident.
Introjection Accepting another persons attitudes, beliefs, and values as ones own
A person who dislikes guns becomes an avid hunter, just like a best friend.
Projection Unconscious blaming of unacceptable inclinations or thoughts on an external object
Man who has thought about same-gender sexual relationship but never had one, beats a
man who is gay.
A person with many prejudices loudly identifies others as bigots.
Rationalization Excusing own behavior to avoid guilt, responsibility, conflict, anxiety, or loss of self-respect
Student blames failure on teacher being mean.
Man says he beats his wife because she doesnt listen to him.
Reaction Formation Acting the opposite of what one thinks or feels
Woman who never wanted to have children becomes a super-mom.
Person who despises the boss tells everyone what a great boss she is.
Regression Moving back to a previous developmental stage in order to feel safe or have needs met
Five-year-old asks for a bottle when new baby brother is being fed.
Man pouts like a four-year-old if he is not the center of his girlfriends attention.
Repression Excluding emotionally painful or anxiety-provoking thoughts and feelings from conscious
awareness
Woman has no memory of the mugging she suffered yesterday.
Woman has no memory before age 7 when she was removed from abusive parents.
Resistance Overt or covert antagonism toward remembering or processing anxiety-producing information
Nurse is too busy with tasks to spend time talking to a dying patient.
Person attends court-ordered treatment for alcoholism but refuses to participate.
(continued )
52 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
Table 3-1
(Continued)
are automatic and unconscious in the therapeutic re- adopting a parental or chastising tone. The nurse is
lationship. For example, an adolescent female client countertransfering her own attitudes and feelings
working with a nurse who is about the same age as toward her children onto the client. Nurses can deal
the teens parents might react to the nurse like she with countertransference by examining their own feel-
reacts to her parents. She might experience intense ings and responses, using self-awareness, and talking
feelings of rebellion or make sarcastic remarks; these with colleagues.
reactions are actually based on her experiences with
her parents, not the nurse.
CURRENT PSYCHOANALYTIC PRACTICE
Countertransference occurs when the thera-
pist displaces onto the client attitudes or feelings from Psychoanalysis focuses on discovering the causes of
his or her past. For example, a female nurse who has the clients unconscious and repressed thoughts, feel-
teenage children and who is experiencing extreme ings, and conflicts believed to cause anxiety and help-
frustration with an adolescent client may respond by ing the client to gain insight into and resolve these
Table 3-2
FREUDS DEVELOPMENTAL STAGES
Phase Age Focus
Oral Birth to 18 months Major site of tension and gratification is the mouth, lips, and tongue;
includes biting and sucking activities.
Id present at birth
Ego develops gradually from rudimentary structure present at birth.
Anal 1836 months Anus and surrounding area are major source of interest.
Acquisition of voluntary sphincter control (toilet training)
Phallic/oedipal 35 years Genital focus of interest, stimulation, and excitement
Penis is organ of interest for both sexes.
Masturbation is common.
Penis envy (wish to possess penis) seen in girls; oedipal complex (wish
to marry opposite-sex parent and be rid of same-sex parent) seen in
boys and girls
Latency 511 or 13 years Resolution of oedipal complex
Sexual drive channeled into socially appropriate activities such as
school work and sports
Formation of the superego
Genital 1113 years Final stage of psychosexual development
Begins with puberty and the biologic capacity for orgasm; involves the
capacity for true intimacy
Adapted from Gabbard, G. O. (2000). Theories of personality and psychopathology: Psychoanalysis. In B. J.
Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.). Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 2 (7th ed., pp. 563607). Philadel-
phia, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
3 PSYCHOSOCIAL THEORIES AND THERAPY 53
conflicts and anxieties. The analytic therapist uses the the negative outcome of this stage, will impair the
techniques of free association, dream analysis, and persons development throughout his or her life.
interpretation of behavior.
Psychoanalysis is still practiced today but on a
JEAN PIAGET AND COGNITIVE
very limited basis. Analysis is lengthy with weekly or
STAGES OF DEVELOPMENT
more frequent sessions for several years. It is costly
and not covered by conventional health insurance Jean Piaget (18961980) explored how intelligence
programs; thus, it has become known as therapy for and cognitive functioning developed in children. He
the wealthy. believed that human intelligence progresses through
a series of stages based on age with the child at each
successive stage demonstrating a higher level of func-
Developmental Theories tioning than at previous stages. In his schema, Piaget
ERIK ERIKSON AND PSYCHOSOCIAL strongly believed that biologic changes and matura-
STAGES OF DEVELOPMENT tion were responsible for cognitive development.
Piagets four stages of cognitive development are
Erik Erikson (19021994) was a German-born psy- as follows:
choanalyst who extended Freuds work on personal- 1. Sensorimotorbirth to 2 years: The child
ity development across the life span while focusing develops a sense of self as separate from the
on social development as well as psychological devel- environment and the concept of object per-
opment in the life stages. In 1950, Erikson published manence; that is, tangible objects dont cease
Childhood and Society, in which he described eight to exist just because they are out of sight. He
psychosocial stages of development. In each stage, the or she begins to form mental images.
person must complete a life task that is essential to 2. Preoperational2 to 6 years: The child devel-
his or her well-being and mental health. These tasks ops the ability to express self with language,
allow the person to achieve lifes virtues: hope, pur- understands the meaning of symbolic ges-
pose, fidelity, love, caring, and wisdom. The stages, life tures, and begins to classify objects.
tasks, and virtues are described in Table 3-3. 3. Concrete operations6 to 12 years: The
A variety of disciplines still use Eriksons eight child begins to apply logic to thinking, under-
psychosocial stages of development. In his view, stands spatiality and reversibility, and is
psychosocial growth occurs in sequential phases increasingly social and able to apply rules;
and each stage is dependent on completion of the pre- however, thinking is still concrete.
vious stage and life task. For example, in the infant 4. Formal operations12 to 15 years and be-
stage (birth to 18 months), trust versus mistrust, the yond: The child learns to think and reason
baby must learn to develop basic trust (the positive in abstract terms, further develops logical
outcome) such as that he or she will be fed and taken thinking and reasoning, and achieves cogni-
care of. The formation of trust is essential: mistrust, tive maturity.
Table 3-3
ERIKSONS STAGES OF PSYCHOSOCIAL DEVELOPMENT
Stage Virtue Task
Trust vs. mistrust (infant) Hope Viewing the world as safe and reliable; relationships as
nurturing, stable, and dependable
Autonomy vs. shame and Will Achieving a sense of control and free will
doubt (toddler)
Initiative vs. guilt Purpose Beginning development of a conscience; learning to manage
(preschool) conflict and anxiety
Industry vs. inferiority Competence Emerging confidence in own abilities; taking pleasure in
(school age) accomplishments
Identity vs. role confusion Fidelity Formulating a sense of self and belonging
(adolescence)
Intimacy vs. isolation Love Forming adult, loving relationships and meaningful attachments
(young adult) to others
Generativity vs. stagnation Care Being creative and productive; establishing the next generation
(middle adult)
Ego integrity vs. despair Wisdom Accepting responsibility for ones self and life
(maturity)
54 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
Piagets theory suggests that individuals reach basis for all emotional problems (Sullivan, 1953). The
cognitive maturity by middle to late adolescence. Some importance and significance of interpersonal rela-
critics of Piaget believe that cognitive development is tionships in ones life was probably Sullivans great-
less rigid and more individualized than his theory sug- est contribution to the field of mental health.
gests. Piagets theory is useful when working with chil-
dren. The nurse may better understand what the child Five Life Stages. Sullivan established five life stages
means if the nurse is aware of his or her level of cog- of development (infancy, childhood, juvenile, pre-
nitive development. Also teaching for children is often adolescence, and adolescence), each focusing on var-
structured with their cognitive development in mind. ious interpersonal relationships (Table 3-4). Sullivan
also described three developmental cognitive modes of
Interpersonal Theories experience and believed that mental disorders were
related to the persistence of one of the early modes.
HARRY STACK SULLIVAN: INTERPERSONAL The prototaxic mode, characteristic of infancy and
RELATIONSHIPS AND MILIEU THERAPY childhood, involves brief unconnected experiences
Harry Stack Sullivan (18921949; Fig. 3-2) was an that have no relationship to one another. Adults with
American psychiatrist who extended the theory of per- schizophrenia exhibit persistent prototaxic experi-
sonality development to include the significance of ences. The parataxic mode begins in early child-
interpersonal relationships. Sullivan believed that hood as the child begins to connect experiences in
ones personality involved more than individual char- sequence. The child may not make logical sense of
acteristics, particularly how one interacted with the experiences and may see them as coincidence or
others. He thought that inadequate or nonsatisfying chance events. The child seeks to relieve anxiety by
relationships produced anxiety, which he saw as the repeating familiar experiences, although he or she
may not understand what he or she is doing. Sullivan
explained paranoid ideas and slips of the tongue as
a person operating in the parataxic mode. In the
syntaxic mode, which begins to appear in school-
age children and becomes more predominant in pre-
adolescence, the person begins to perceive himself or
herself and the world within the context of the envi-
ronment and can analyze experiences in a variety of
settings. Maturity may be defined as predominance
of the syntaxic mode (Sullivan, 1953).
Table 3-4
SULLIVANS LIFE STAGES
Stage Ages Focus
Infancy Birth to onset Primary need for bodily contact and tenderness
of language Prototaxic mode dominates (no relation between experiences)
Primary zones are oral and anal.
If needs are met, infant has sense of well-being; unmet needs lead
to dread and anxiety.
Childhood Language to 5 years Parents viewed as source of praise and acceptance
Shift to parataxic mode (experiences are connected in sequence to
each other)
Primary zone is anal.
Gratification leads to positive self-esteem.
Moderate anxiety leads to uncertainty and insecurity; severe
anxiety results in self-defeating patterns of behavior.
Juvenile 58 years Shift to the sytaxic mode begins (thinking about self and others
based on analysis of experiences in a variety of situations).
Opportunities for approval and acceptance of others
Learn to negotiate own needs
Severe anxiety may result in a need to control or restrictive,
prejudicial attitudes.
Preadolescence 812 years Move to genuine intimacy with friend of the same sex
Move away from family as source of satisfaction in relationships
Major shift to syntaxic mode
Capacity for attachment, love, and collaboration emerges or fails
to develop.
Adolescence Puberty to adulthood Lust is added to interpersonal equation.
Need for special sharing relationship shifts to the opposite sex.
New opportunities for social experimentation lead to the consoli-
dation of self-esteem or self-ridicule.
If the self-system is intact, areas of concern expand to include
values, ideals, career decisions, and social concerns.
Adapted from Gabbard, G. O. (2000). Theories of personality and psychopathology: Psychoanalysis.
In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.). Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 2 (7th ed., pp. 563607).
Philadelphia, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
cept of the therapeutic nursepatient relation- Leader: offering direction to the client or
ship, which includes four phases: orientation, iden- group
tification, exploitation, and resolution (Table 3-5). Surrogate: serving as a substitute for another
During these phases, the client accomplishes certain such as a parent or sibling
tasks and the relationship changes that help the heal- Counselor: promoting experiences leading to
ing process (Peplau, 1952). health for the client such as expression of
1. The orientation phase is directed by the feelings
nurse and involves engaging the client in Peplau also believed that the nurse could take
treatment, providing explanations and infor- on many other roles such as consultant, tutor,
mation, and answering questions. safety agent, mediator, administrator, observer,
2. The identification phase begins when the and researcher. These were not defined in detail but
client works interdependently with the nurse, were left to the intelligence and imagination of the
expresses feelings, and begins to feel stronger. readers (Peplau, 1952, p. 70).
3. In the exploitation phase, the client makes
full use of the services offered. Four Levels of Anxiety. Peplau defined anxiety as
4. In the resolution phase, the client no longer the initial response to a psychic threat. She described
needs professional services and gives up four levels of anxiety: mild, moderate, severe, and
dependent behavior. The relationship ends. panic (Table 3-6). These serve as the foundation for
Peplaus concept of the nurseclient relation- working with clients with anxiety in a variety of con-
ship, with tasks and behaviors characteristic of each texts (see Chap. 13).
stage, has been modified but remains in use today 1. Mild anxiety is a positive state of heightened
(see Chap. 5). awareness and sharpened senses, allowing
the person to learn new behaviors and solve
Roles of the Nurse in the Therapeutic Relationship. problems. The person can take in all avail-
Peplau also wrote about the roles of the nurse in the able stimuli (perceptual field).
therapeutic relationship and how these roles helped 2. Moderate anxiety involves a decreased
to meet the clients needs. The primary roles she iden- perceptual field (focus on immediate task
tified were as follows: only); the person can learn new behavior
Stranger: offering the client the same accep- or solve problems only with assistance.
tance and courtesy that the nurse would to Another person can redirect the person
any stranger to the task.
Resource person: providing specific answers 3. Severe anxiety involves feelings of dread or
to questions within a larger context terror. The person cannot be redirected to a
Teacher: helping the client to learn formally task; he or she focuses only on scattered
or informally details and has physiologic symptoms of
Table 3-5
PEPLAUS STAGES AND TASKS OF RELATIONSHIPS
Stage Tasks
Table 3-6
ANXIETY LEVELS
Mild Moderate Severe Panic
Sharpened senses Selectively attentive Perceptual field reduced to Perceptual field reduced to
Increased Perceptual field limited one detail or focus on self
motivation to the immediate task scattered details Cannot process environ-
Alert Can be redirected Cannot complete tasks mental stimuli
Enlarged Cannot connect Cannot solve problems Distorted perceptions
perceptual field thoughts or events or learn effectively Loss of rational thought
Can solve independently Behavior geared toward Personality disorganization
problems Muscle tension anxiety relief and is Doesnt recognize danger
Learning Diaphoresis usually ineffective Possibly suicidal
is effective Pounding pulse Feels awe, dread, horror Delusions or hallucination
Restless Headache Doesnt respond to possible
GI butterflies Dry mouth redirection Cant communicate
Sleepless Higher voice pitch Severe headache verbally
Irritable Increased rate of speech Nausea, vomiting, diarrhea Either cannot sit (may bolt
Hypersensitive GI upset Trembling and run) or is totally
to noise Frequent urination Rigid stance mute and immobile
Increased automatisms Vertigo
(nervous mannerisms) Pale
Tachycardia
Chest pain
Crying
Ritualistic (purposeless,
repetitive) behavior
Adapted from Peplau, H. (1952). Interpersonal relations in nursing. New York: G. P. Putnams Sons.
tachycardia, diaphoresis, and chest pain. that he focused on the total person, not just one facet
People with severe anxiety often go to emer- of the person, and emphasized health instead of sim-
gency departments, believing they are hav- ply illness and problems. Maslow (1954) formulated
ing a heart attack. the hierarchy of needs in which he used a pyramid
4. Panic anxiety can involve loss of rational to arrange and illustrate the basic drives or needs that
thought, delusions, hallucinations, and com- motivate people. The most basic needsthe physio-
plete physical immobility and muteness. logic needs of food, water, sleep, shelter, sexual ex-
The person may bolt and run aimlessly, pression, and freedom from painmust be met first.
often exposing himself or herself to injury. The second level involves safety and security needs,
which include protection, security, and freedom from
harm or threatened deprivation. The third level is
Humanistic Theories love and belonging needs, which include enduring in-
Humanism represents a significant shift away from timacy, friendship, and acceptance. The fourth level
the psychoanalytic view of the individual as a neu- involves esteem needs, which include the need for
rotic, impulse-driven person with repressed psychic self-respect and esteem from others. The highest level
problems and away from the focus on and exami- is self-actualization, the need for beauty, truth, and
nation of the clients past experiences. Humanism justice.
focuses on a persons positive qualities, his or her Maslow hypothesized that the basic needs at
capacity to change (human potential), and the promo- the bottom of the pyramid would dominate the per-
tion of self-esteem. Humanists do consider the per- sons behavior until those needs were met, at which
sons past experiences, but they direct more attention time the next level of needs would become domi-
toward the present and future. nant. For example, if needs for food and shelter are
not met, they become the overriding concern in life:
the hungry person risks danger and social ostracism
ABRAHAM MASLOW: HIERARCHY OF NEEDS
to find food.
Abraham Maslow (19211970) was an American Maslow used the term self-actualization to
psychologist who studied the needs or motivations of describe a person who has achieved all the needs of
the individual. He differed from previous theorists in the hierarchy and has developed his or her fullest
58 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
If a motorist consistently speeds (negative be- 4. Positive reinforcers that follow a behavior
havior) and does not get caught, he or she is likely increase the likelihood that the behavior
to continue to speed. If the driver receives a speeding will recur.
ticket (a negative reinforcer), he or she is likely to slow 5. Negative reinforcers that are removed after
down. However, if the motorist does not get caught for a behavior increase the likelihood that the
speeding for the next 4 weeks (negative reinforcer is behavior will recur.
removed), he or she is likely to resume speeding. 6. Continuous reinforcement (a reward every
time the behavior occurs) is the fastest way
to increase that behavior, but the behavior
IVAN PAVLOV: CLASSICAL CONDITIONING
will not last long after the reward ceases.
Laboratory experiments with dogs provided the basis 7. Random, intermittent reinforcement (an occa-
for the development of Ivan Pavlovs theory of classi- sional reward for the desired behavior) is
cal conditioning: behavior can be changed through slower to produce an increase in behavior,
conditioning with external or environmental condi- but the behavior continues after the reward
tions or stimuli. His experiment with dogs involved ceases.
his observation that dogs naturally began to salivate These behavioral principles of rewarding or re-
(response) when they saw or smelled food (stimulus). inforcing behaviors are used to help people change
Pavlov (18491936) set out to change this salivating their behavior in a therapy known as behavior mod-
response or behavior through conditioning. He would ification. Behavior modification is a method of
ring a bell (new stimulus) then produce the food, and attempting to strengthen a desired behavior or re-
the dogs would salivate (the desired response). Pavlov sponse by reinforcement, either positive or negative.
repeated this ringing of the bell along with the pre- For example, if the desired behavior is assertive-
sentation of food many times. Eventually he could ness, whenever the client uses assertiveness skills
ring the bell and the dogs would salivate without see- in a communication group, the group leader provides
ing or smelling food. The dogs had been conditioned positive reinforcement by giving the client atten-
or had learned a new responseto salivate when tion and positive feedback. Negative reinforcement
they heard the bell. Their behavior had been modi- involves removing a stimulus immediately after a
fied through classical conditioning or a conditioned behavior occurs so that the behavior is more likely to
response. occur again. For example, if a client becomes anxious
when waiting to talk in a group, he or she may volun-
teer to speak first to avoid the anxiety.
B. F. SKINNER: OPERANT CONDITIONING
In a group home setting, operant principles may
One of the most influential behaviorists was B. F. come into play in a token economy, a way to involve
Skinner (19041990), an American psychologist. He residents in performing activities of daily living. A
developed the theory of operant conditioning, chart of desired behaviors, such as getting up on time,
which says people learn their behavior from their taking a shower, and getting dressed, is kept for each
history or past experiences, particularly those expe- resident. Each day, the chart is marked when the de-
riences that were repeatedly reinforced. Although sired behavior occurs. At the end of the day or the
some criticize his theories for not considering the week, the resident gets a reward or token for each
role that thoughts, feelings, or needs play in moti- time each of the desired behaviors occurred. The res-
vating behavior, his work has provided several im- ident can redeem the tokens for items such as snacks,
portant principles still used today. Skinner did not TV time, or a relaxed curfew.
deny the existence of feelings and needs in motiva- Conditioned responses, such as fears or phobias,
tion; however, he viewed behavior as only that which can be treated with behavioral techniques. System-
could be observed, studied, and learned or unlearned. atic desensitization can be used to help clients over-
He maintained that if the behavior could be changed come irrational fears and anxiety associated with a
then so too could the accompanying thoughts or feel- phobia. The client is asked to make a list of situations
ings. Changing the behavior was what was important. involving the phobic object, from the least to the most
The following principles of operant conditioning anxiety-provoking. The client learns and practices
described by Skinner (1974) form the basis for behav- relaxation techniques to decrease and manage anxi-
ior techniques in use today: ety. The client then is exposed to the least anxiety-
1. All behavior is learned. provoking situation and uses the relaxation techniques
2. Consequences result from behavior to manage the resulting anxiety. The client is gradu-
broadly speaking, reward and punishment. ally exposed to more and more anxiety-provoking situ-
3. Behavior that is rewarded with reinforcers ations until he or she can manage the most anxiety-
tends to recur. provoking situation.
60 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
Behavioral techniques can be used for a variety rience and determines how he or she feels and be-
of different problems. In the treatment of anorexia haves. For example, if a person interprets a situation
nervosa, the goal is weight gain. A behavioral con- as dangerous, he or she experiences anxiety and tries
tract between the client and therapist or physician to escape. Basic emotions of sadness, elation, anxiety,
is initiated when treatment begins. Initially the and anger are reactions to perceptions of loss, gain,
client has little unsupervised time and is restricted danger, and wrongdoing by others (Beck & Rush,
to the hospital unit. The contract may specify that 1995). Aaron Beck is credited with pioneering cogni-
if the client gains a certain amount of weight such tive theory in persons with depression.
as 0.2 kg/day, in return he or she will get increased
unsupervised time or time off the unit as long as the
RATIONAL EMOTIVE THERAPY
weight gain progresses (Agras, 1995).
Albert Ellis, founder of rational emotive therapy, iden-
tified 11 irrational beliefs that people use to make
Existential Theories themselves unhappy. An example of an irrational be-
Existential theorists believe that behavioral devia- lief is, If I love someone, he or she must love me back
tions result when a person is out of touch with himself just as much. Ellis claimed that continuing to believe
or herself or the environment. The person who is self- this patently untrue statement will make the person
alienated is lonely and sad and feels helpless. Lack of utterly unhappy, but he or she will blame it on the
self-awareness, coupled with harsh self-criticism, pre- person who does not return his or her love. Ellis also
vents the person from participating in satisfying rela- believes that people have automatic thoughts that
tionships. The person is not free to choose from all cause them unhappiness in certain situations. He
possible alternatives because of self-imposed restric- used the ABC technique to help people identify these
tions. Existential theorists believe that the person is automatic thoughts: A is the activating stimulus or
avoiding personal responsibility and giving in to the event, C is the excessive inappropriate response, and
wishes or demands of others. B is the blank in the persons mind that he or she must
All existential therapies have the goal of help- fill in by identifying the automatic thought.
ing the person discover an authentic sense of self.
They emphasize personal responsibility for ones self,
VIKTOR FRANKL AND LOGOTHERAPY
feelings, behaviors, and choices. These therapies en-
courage the person to live fully in the present and to Viktor Frankl based his beliefs on his observations of
look forward to the future. Carl Rogers is sometimes people in Nazi concentration camps during World
grouped with existential therapists. Table 3-7 sum- War II. His curiosity about why some survived and
marizes existential therapies. others did not led him to conclude that survivors
were able to find meaning in their lives even under
miserable conditions. Hence the search for meaning
COGNITIVE THERAPY
(logos) is the central theme in logotherapy. Coun-
Many existential therapists use cognitive therapy, selors and therapists who work with clients in spiri-
which focuses on immediate thought processing tuality and grief counseling often use the concepts
how a person perceives or interprets his or her expe- that Frankl developed.
Table 3-7
EXISTENTIAL THERAPIES
Therapy Therapist Therapeutic Process
Rational emotive Albert Ellis A cognitive therapy using confrontation of irrational beliefs that
therapy prevent the individual from accepting responsibility for self and
behavior
Logotherapy Viktor E. Frankl A therapy designed to help individuals assume personal responsibil-
ity. The search for meaning (logos) in life is a central theme.
Gestalt therapy Frederick S. Perls A therapy focusing on the identification of feelings in the here and
now, which leads to self-acceptance
Reality therapy William Glasser Therapeutic focus is need for identity through responsible behavior.
Individuals are challenged to examine ways in which their behav-
ior thwarts their attempts to achieve life goals.
3 PSYCHOSOCIAL THEORIES AND THERAPY 61
the local mental health services agency or contact- gether cooperatively to accomplish the purpose. Co-
ing the primary care provider is another way for a hesiveness is a desirable group characteristic and is
client to check a therapists credentials and ethical associated with positive group outcomes. Cohesive-
practices. ness is evidenced when members value one anothers
contributions to the group; members think of them-
selves as we and share responsibility for the work
Groups
of the group. When a group is cohesive, members feel
A group is a number of persons in a face-to-face set- free to express all opinions, either positive or nega-
ting to accomplish tasks that require cooperation, tive with little fear of rejection or retribution. If
collaboration, or working together. Each person in a group is overly cohesive in that uniformity and
a group is in a position to influence and to be influ- agreement become the groups implicit goal, there
enced by other group members. Group content refers may be a negative effect on the group outcome. In
to what is said in the context of the group including a therapy group, members do not give one another
educational material, feelings, and emotions, or dis- needed feedback if the group is overly cohesive. In a
cussions of the project to be completed. Group process work group, critical thinking and creative problem-
refers to the behavior of the group and its individual solving are unlikely, which may make the work of the
members including seating arrangements, tone of group less meaningful.
voice, who speaks to whom, who is quiet, and so forth. Some groups exhibit competition, or rivalry
Content and process occur continuously throughout among group members. This may positively affect the
the life of the group. outcome of the group if the competition leads to com-
promise, improved group performance, and growth
for individual members. Many times, however, com-
STAGES OF GROUP DEVELOPMENT
petition can be destructive for the group; when con-
A group may be established to serve a particular pur- flicts arent resolved, members become hostile; or the
pose in a specified period such as a work group to groups energy is diverted from accomplishment of
complete an assigned project or a therapy group that their purpose to bickering and power struggles.
meets with the same members to explore ways to deal The final stage or termination of the group oc-
with depression. These groups develop in observable curs before the group disbands. The work of the group
stages. In the pre-group stages, members are selected, is reviewed with the focus on group accomplishments,
the purpose or work of the group is identified, and growth of group members, or both depending on the
group structure is addressed. Group structure includes purpose of the group.
where and how often the group will meet, identifica- Observing the stages of group development in
tion of a group leader, and the rules of the groupfor groups that are ongoing is difficult with members
example, can members join the group after it begins, joining and leaving the group at various times.
how to handle absences, and expectations for group Rather, the group involvement of new members as
members. they join the group evolves as they feel accepted by
The beginning stage of group development, or the the group, take a more active role, and join in the
initial stage, commences as soon as the group begins work of the group. An example of this type of group
to meet. Members introduce themselves, a leader can would be Alcoholics Anonymous (AA), a self-help group
be selected (if not done previously), the group purpose with stated purposes; members may attend AA meet-
is discussed, and rules and expectations for group ings as often or infrequently as they choose. Group
participation are reviewed. Group members begin to cohesiveness or competition can still be observed in
check out one another and the leader as they deter- ongoing groups.
mine their levels of comfort in the group setting.
The working stage of group development begins
GROUP LEADERSHIP
as members begin to focus their attention on the pur-
pose or task the group is trying to accomplish. This Groups often have an identified or formal leader
may happen relatively quickly in a work group with someone designated to lead the group. In therapy
a specific assigned project, but may take two or three groups and education groups, a formal leader is usu-
sessions in a therapy group because members must ally identified based on his or her education, qualifi-
develop some level of trust before sharing personal cations, and experience. Some work groups have for-
feelings or difficult situations. During this phase, mal leaders appointed in advance, while other work
several group characteristics may be seen. Group co- groups select a leader at the initial meeting. Support
hesiveness is the degree to which members work to- groups and self-help groups usually do not have iden-
64 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
GROUP ROLES
Roles are the parts that members play within the
group. Not all members are aware of their role be-
havior, and changes in members behavior may be a
topic that the group will need to address. Some roles
facilitate the work of the group, while other roles can
negatively affect the process or outcome of the group.
Growth-producing roles include information-seeker,
opinion-seeker, information-giver, energizer, coordina-
tor, harmonizer, encourager, and elaborator. Growth- Group therapy
inhibiting roles include monopolizer, aggressor, dom-
inator, critic, recognition-seeker, and passive follower.
Gaining insight into ones problems and
behaviors and how they affect others
GROUP THERAPY Giving of oneself for the benefit of others
(altruism)
In group therapy, clients participate in sessions Therapy groups vary with different purposes,
with a group of people. The members share a common degrees of formality, and structures. Our discus-
purpose and are expected to contribute to the group sion will include psychotherapy groups, family ther-
to benefit others and receive benefit from others in apy, education groups, support groups, and self-help
return. Group rules are established that all members groups.
must observe. These rules vary according to the type
of group. Being a member of a group allows the client Psychotherapy Groups. The goal of a psychother-
to learn new ways of looking at a problem or ways of apy group is for members to learn about their be-
coping or solving problems and also helps him or her havior and to make positive changes in their behav-
to learn important interpersonal skills. For example, ior by interacting and communicating with others
by interacting with other members, clients often re- as a member of a group. Groups may be organized
ceive feedback on how others perceive and react to around a specific medical diagnosis, such as depres-
them and their behavior. This is extremely important sion, or a particular issue such as improving inter-
information for many clients with mental disorders, personal skills or managing anxiety. Group techniques
who often have difficulty with interpersonal skills. and processes are used to help group members learn
The therapeutic results of group therapy (Yalom, about their behavior with other people and how it
1995) include the following: relates to core personality traits. Members also learn
Gaining new information or learning that they have responsibilities to others and can help
Gaining inspiration or hope other members achieve their goals (Alonso, 2000).
Interacting with others Psychotherapy groups are often formal in struc-
Feeling acceptance and belonging ture, with one or two therapists as the group leaders.
Becoming aware that one is not alone and One task of the group leader or the entire group is
that others share the same problems to establish the rules for the group. These rules deal
3 PSYCHOSOCIAL THEORIES AND THERAPY 65
with confidentiality, punctuality, attendance, and so- cation groups usually are scheduled for a specific
cial contact between members outside of group time. number of sessions and retain the same members for
There are two types of groups: open groups and the duration of the group. Typically the leader pre-
closed groups. Open groups are ongoing and run sents the information, then members can ask ques-
indefinitely, allowing members to join or leave the tions or practice new techniques.
group as they need to. Closed groups are structured In a medication management group, the leader
to keep the same members in the group for a speci- may discuss medication regimens and possible side
fied number of sessions. If the group is closed, the effects, screen clients for side effects, and in some
members decide how to handle members who wish instances actually administer the medication (for in-
to leave the group and the possible addition of new stance, depot injections of haloperidol [Haldol] deca-
group members (Yalom, 1995). noate or fluphenazine [Prolixin] decanoate).
Family Therapy. Family therapy is a form of group Support Groups. Support groups are organized
therapy in which the client and his or her family to help members who share a common problem cope
members participate. The goals include understand- with it. The group leader explores members thoughts
ing how family dynamics contribute to the clients and feelings and creates an atmosphere of acceptance
psychopathology, mobilizing the familys inherent so that members feel comfortable expressing them-
strengths and functional resources, restructuring mal- selves. Support groups often provide a safe place for
adaptive family behavioral styles, and strengthening group members to express their feelings of frustration,
family problem-solving behaviors (Gurman & Lebow, boredom, or unhappiness and also to discuss common
2000). Family therapy can be used both to assess problems and potential solutions. Rules for support
and treat various psychiatric disorders. Although groups differ from those in psychotherapy in that
one family member usually is identified initially as members are allowedin fact, encouragedto contact
the one who has problems and needs help, it often one another and socialize outside the sessions. Confi-
becomes evident through the therapeutic process that dentiality may be a rule for some groups; the members
other family members also have emotional problems decide this. Support groups tend to be open groups in
and difficulties. which members can join or leave as their needs dictate.
Common support groups include those for cancer
Family Education. The National Alliance for the
or stroke victims, persons with AIDS, and family
Mentally Ill (NAMI) has developed a unique 12-week
members of someone who has committed suicide.
Family-to-Family Education course taught by trained
One national support group, Mothers Against Drunk
family members. The curriculum focuses on schizo-
Driving (MADD), is for family members of someone
phrenia, bipolar disorder, clinical depression, panic
killed in a car accident caused by a drunk driver.
disorder, and obsessive-compulsive disorder (OCD).
The course discusses the clinical treatment of these
Self-Help Groups. In a self-help group, members
illnesses and teaches the knowledge and skills that
family members need to cope more effectively. The share a common experience, but the group is not a
specific features of this education program include formal or structured therapy group. Although pro-
emphasis on emotional understanding and healing in fessionals organize some self-help groups, many are
the personal realm, and power and action in the so- run by members and do not have a formally identi-
cial realm. NAMI also conducts Provider Education fied leader. Various self-help groups are available.
programs taught by two consumers, two family mem- Some are locally organized and announce their meet-
bers, and a mental health professional who is also a ings in local newspapers. Other groups are nation-
family member or consumer. This course is designed ally organized, such as Alcoholics Anonymous, Parents
to help providers realize the hardships that families Without Partners, Gamblers Anonymous, or Al-Anon
and consumers endure and to appreciate the courage (a group for spouses and partners of alcoholics), and
and persistence it takes to reconstruct lives that have national headquarters and Internet websites
must be lived, through no fault of the consumer or (see Internet Resources).
family, on the verge (NAMI, 2002, p. 1). Most self-help groups have a rule of confidential-
ity: whoever is seen at a meeting or what is said at the
Education Groups. The goal of an education group meetings cannot be divulged to others or discussed
is to provide information to members on a specific outside the group. In many 12-step programs, such
issuefor instance, stress management, medication as Alcoholics Anonymous and Gamblers Anonymous,
management, or assertiveness training. The group people use only their first names so their identities are
leader has expertise in the subject area and may be not divulged (although in some settings, group mem-
a nurse, therapist, or other health professional. Edu- bers do know one anothers names).
66 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
was based on sexual energy (libido) as the the nurse in the relationship, and the four
driving force. anxiety levels.
Erik Eriksons theories focused on both social Abraham Maslow developed a hierarchy of
and psychological development across the life needs stating that people were motivated by
span. He proposed eight stages of psycho- progressive levels of needs; each level must
social development; each stage includes be satisfied before the person can progress to
a developmental task and a virtue to be the next level. The levels begin with physio-
achieved (hope, will, purpose, fidelity, love, logic needs, then proceed to safety and secu-
caring, and wisdom). Eriksons theories rity needs, belonging needs, esteem needs,
remain in wide use today. and finally reach self-actualization needs.
Jean Piaget described four stages of cognitive Carl Rogers developed client-centered ther-
development: sensorimotor; preoperational; apy in which the therapist plays a supportive
concrete operations; and formal operations. role, demonstrating unconditional positive
Harry Stack Sullivans theories focused on regard, genuineness, and empathetic under-
development in terms of interpersonal rela- standing to the client.
tionships. He viewed the therapists role Behaviorism focuses on the clients observable
(termed participant observer) as key to the performance and behaviors and external
clients treatment. influences that can bring about behavior
Hildegard Peplau is a nursing theorist whose changes, rather than focusing on feelings
theories formed much of the foundation of and thoughts.
modern nursing practice including the thera- Systematic desensitization is an example
peutic nursepatient relationship, the role of
of conditioning in which a person who has
an excessive fear of something, such as
frogs or snakes, learns to manage his or her
anxiety response to being exposed to the
Critical Thinking Questions feared object.
1. Can sound parenting and nurturing in a loving B. F. Skinner is a behaviorist who developed
environment overcome a genetic or biologic the theory of operant conditioning in which
predisposition to mental illness? people are motivated to learn behavior or
2. Can children raised in a hostile environment change behavior with a system of rewards or
without parental love, support, and consis- reinforcement.
tency avoid mental health problems as adults? Existential theorists believe that problems
If so, how, or what factors could help a person result when the person is out of touch with
overcome a neglected or traumatic childhood? the self or the environment. The person has
self-imposed restrictions, criticizes himself or
68 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES AND PRACTICE
herself harshly, and does not participate in Caplan, G. (1964). Principles of preventive psychiatry.
satisfying interpersonal relationships. New York: Basic Books.
Ellis, A. (1989). Inside rational emotive therapy. San Diego:
Founders of existentialism include Albert Academic Press.
Ellis (rational emotive therapy), Viktor Erikson, E. H. (1963). Childhood and society (2d ed.).
Frankl (logotherapy), Frederick Perls New York: Norton.
(gestalt therapy), and William Glasser Gabbard, G. O. (2000). Theories of personality and
psychopathology: Psychoanalysis. In B. J. Sadock &
(reality therapy).
V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psy-
All existential therapies have the goals of re- chiatry, Vol. 2 (7th ed., pp. 563607). Philadelphia:
turning the person to an authentic sense of Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
self through emphasizing personal responsi- Gurman, A. S., & Lebow, J. L. (2000). Family therapy
bility for oneself and ones feelings, behavior, and couple therapy. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock
(Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 2
and choices. (7th ed., pp. 21572167). Philadelphia: Lippincott,
A crisis is a turning point in an individuals Williams, & Wilkins.
life that produces an overwhelming response. Hemingway, S., Ashmore, R. & Askoorum, G. (2000).
Crises may be maturational, situational, or Telephone intervention in mental health nursing.
Nursing Times, 96(22), 3334.
adventitious. Effective crisis intervention in- Maslow, A. H. (1954). Motivation and personality.
cludes assessment of the person in crisis, New York: Harper & Row.
promotion of problem-solving, and provision National Alliance for the Mentally Ill (NAMI). (2002).
of empathetic understanding. http://www.nami.org/family/index.html
Peplau, H. (1952). Interpersonal relations in nursing.
Cognitive therapy is based on the premise New York: G. P. Putnams Sons.
that how a person thinks about or interprets Rogers, C. R. (1961). On becoming a person: A therapists
life experiences determines how he or she view of psychotherapy. Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
will feel or behave. It seeks to help the per- Skinner, B. F. (1974). About behaviorism. New York:
son change how he or she thinks about Alfred A. Knopf, Inc.
Sullivan, H. S. (1953). The interpersonal theory of psychi-
things to bring about an improvement in atry. New York: Norton.
mood and behavior. Yalom, I. D. (1995). The theory and practice of group
Treatment for mental disorders and emotional psychotherapy. New York: Basic Books.
problems can include one or more of the fol-
lowing: individual psychotherapy, group ADDITIONAL READINGS
psychotherapy, family therapy, family educa-
tion, psychiatric rehabilitation, self-help Beck, A. T. (1976). Cognitive therapy and the emotional
disorders. New York: The New American Library, Inc.
groups, support groups, education groups, and
Berne, E. (1964). Games people play. New York: Grove
other psychosocial interventions such as set- Press.
ting limits or giving positive feedback. Caplan, G. (1964). Principles of preventive psychiatry.
An understanding of psychosocial theories New York: Basic Books.
and treatment modalities can help the nurse Crain, W. C. (1980). Theories of development: Concepts and
application. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall, Inc.
select appropriate and effective intervention Frankl, V. E. (1959). Mans search for meaning: An intro-
strategies to use with clients. duction to logotherapy. New York: The Beacon Press.
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com. Glasser, W. (1965). Reality therapy: A new approach to
psychiatry. New York: Harper & Row.
Miller, P. H. (1983). Theories of developmental psychol-
REFERENCES ogy. San Francisco: W. H. Freeman & Co.
Millon, T. (Ed.). (1967). Theories of psychopathology.
Agras, W. S. (1995). Behavior therapy. In H. I. Kaplan & Philadelphia: W. B. Saunders.
B. J. Sadock (Eds.). Comprehensive textbook of psy- Perls, F. S., Hefferline, R. F., & Goodman, P. (1951).
chiatry, Vol. 2 (6th ed., pp. 18771806). Philadelphia: Gestalt therapy: Excitement and growth in the human
J. B. Lippincott. personality. New York: Dell Publishing Co., Inc.
Aguilera, D. C. (1998). Crisis intervention: Theory and Schultz, J. M., & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts
methodology (7th ed.). St. Louis: Mosby. manual of psychiatric nursing care plan (6th ed.).
Alonso, A. (2000). Group psychotherapy, combined indi- Philadelphia: Lippincott, Williams, & Wilkins.
vidual and group therapy. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sugarman, L. (1986). Life-span development: Concepts,
Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, theories and interventions. London: Methuen &
Vol. 2 (7th ed., pp. 21462157). Philadelphia: Lippin- Co., Ltd.
cott Williams & Wilkins. Szasz, T. (1961). The myth of mental illness. New York:
Beck, A. T., & Rush, A. J. (1995). Cognitive therapy. In Hoeber-Harper.
H. I. Kaplan & B. J. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive Viscott, D. (1996). Emotional resilience: Simple truths for
textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 2 (6th ed., pp. 18471856.) dealing with the unfinished business of your past.
Philadelphia: J. B. Lippincott. New York: Harmony Books.
Chapter Study Guide
MULTIPLE-CHOICE QUESTIONS
Select the best answer for each of the following
questions.
69
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Write the name of the appropriate theorist beside the statement or theory.
Names may be used more than once.
6. Client-centered therapy
7. Gestalt therapy
8. Hierarchy of needs
9. Logotherapy
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
Describe each of the following types of groups, and give an example.
1. Group psychotherapy
70
2. Education group
3. Support group
4. Self-help group
71
4 Treatment
Settings and
Learning Objectives Therapeutic
Programs
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
72
4 TREATMENT SETTINGS AND THERAPEUTIC PROGRAMS 73
Mental health care has undergone profound changes recertification of admissions, utilization review, and
in the past 50 years. Before the 1950s, humane treat- case managementall of which have altered inpatient
ment in large state facilities was the best available treatment significantly. The growth of managed care
strategy for people with chronic and persistent men- has been associated with declining admissions, shorter
tal illness, many of whom stayed in such facilities for lengths of stay, reduced reimbursement, and increased
months or years. The introduction of psychotropic acuity of inpatients. Therefore clients are sicker when
medications in the 1950s offered the first hope of suc- they are admitted and do not stay as long in the
cessfully treating the symptoms of mental illness in hospital.
a meaningful way. By the 1970s, focus on client rights McGihon (1999) maintains that inpatient hospi-
and changes in commitment laws led to deinstitution- tal units must change their approach to inpatient care
alization and a new era of treatment (McGihon, 1999). if they are to be effective (that is, if they are to meet
Institutions could no longer hold clients with mental clients needs given the constraints on admission and
illness indefinitely, and treatment in the least re- length of stay). She believes that many units are still
strictive environment became a guiding principle and trying to function according to the milieu therapy ap-
right. Large state hospitals emptied. Treatment in the proach, which is no longer practical or effective for in-
community was intended to replace much of state- patients. Today inpatient units must provide rapid
hospital inpatient care. Adequate funding, however, assessment, stabilization of symptoms, and discharge
has not kept pace with the need for community pro- planning, and they must accomplish goals quickly. To
grams and treatment (see Chap. 1). meet these goals, McGihon has proposed the PACED
Today people with mental illness receive treat- model, which is a client-centered, multi-disciplinary
ment in a variety of settings. This chapter describes approach to a brief stay.
the range of treatment settings available for those with Pacing treatment is one of the important concepts
mental illness and the psychiatric rehabilitation pro- of the PACED model. Clinicians learn to help clients
grams that have been developed to meet their needs. recognize symptoms, identify coping skills, and choose
Both of these sections discuss the challenges of inte- discharge supports. Once the client is safe and stable,
grating people with mental illness into the community. the clinicians and the client identify long-term issues
The chapter also addresses two populations who are for the client to pursue in outpatient therapy.
receiving inadequate treatment because they are not
connected with needed services: homeless clients and
clients who are in jail. In addition, the chapter de- SCHEDULED INTERMITTENT
scribes the multidisciplinary team including the role HOSPITAL STAYS
of the nurse as a member. Finally it briefly discusses
A unique approach to providing inpatient care for
psychosocial nursing in public health and home care.
people who seek it is scheduled, intermittent inpatient
hospital stays (Dilonardo et al., 1998). A study con-
TREATMENT SETTINGS ducted in a Veterans Administration hospital fol-
lowed two groups of people with severe and persistent
Inpatient Hospital Treatment mental illness who were frequently admitted to the
In the 1980s, inpatient psychiatric care was still a hospital. One group had predetermined, scheduled
primary mode of treatment for people with mental admissions to the inpatient unit over a 2-year period;
illness (McGihon, 1999). A typical psychiatric unit the other group used hospital admission during crises
emphasized talk therapy, or one-on-one interactions only, as they had been doing. At the end of the 2 years,
between residents and staff, and milieu therapy, the number of hospital stays for the two groups was
meaning the total environment and its effect on the similar, but there were remarkable differences: the
clients treatment. Individual and group interactions group with scheduled admissions had higher self-
focused on trust, self-disclosure by clients to staff and esteem, greater feelings of control over their lives, and
one another, and active participation in groups. Ef- fewer negative and physical symptoms than the other
fective milieu therapy required long lengths of stay group. The authors suggested that the group with cri-
because clients with more stable conditions helped sis admission perceived coming to the hospital as a
to provide structure and support for newly admitted failure, whereas the group with scheduled admission
clients with more acute conditions (McGihon, 1999). saw admission as successful implementation of their
By the 1990s, the economics of health care began treatment plan. The authors believe that inpatient
to change dramatically, and the length of stay in hos- care is important in the continuum of services, and
pitals decreased to just a few days. Today most Amer- that scheduled admissions might be an alternative
icans are insured under some form of managed care. for delivery of inpatient care to those who continue to
Managed care exerts cost-control measures such as need it.
74 Unit 1 CURRENT THEORIES & PRACTICE
LONG-STAY CLIENTS
Fisher et al. (2001) identify a group of clients with se-
vere and persistent mental illness who still require
acute care despite the current emphasis on decreased
hospital stays. They call this group long-stay clients.
This population includes clients who were hospital-
ized before deinstitutionalization and remain hospi-
talized despite efforts at community placement. It
also includes clients who have been hospitalized con-
sistently for long periods despite efforts to minimize
their hospital stays. Seventy-five percent of the pop-
ulation studied had schizophrenia, and thirty percent
had a co-morbid diagnosis of substance abuse. Eighty-
four percent of the clients had at least one major med-
ical problem, such as obesity or respiratory problems,
and many had more than one medical disorder. In ad-
dition, 69% of the clients exhibited problematic be-
havior within the past month. Community placement
of clients with problematic behaviors still meets re-
sistance from the public. All these factors were barri-
ers to successful placement in community settings.
These authors concluded that a small portion of long-
stay clients would continue to require inpatient hos-
pital care.
One approach to working with long-stay clients is
a hospital hostel, or a unit within a hospital that is Case Manager
designed to be more home-like and less institutional.
In Great Britain, several hospital hostel projects have
been established that provide access to community that as the focus of inpatient psychiatric care shifts
facilities and focus on normal expectations such as to an emphasis on quick resolution of acute symptoms,
cooking, cleaning, and doing housework. A study of one and rapid transfer to stepdown, less costly treatment
such program found that clients had improved func- interventions, the role of discharge planning has be-
tioning and fewer aggressive episodes and were more come even more central (p. 2). Environmental sup-
satisfied with their care. Some clients remained in the ports, such as housing and transportation, and access
hostel setting, while others were eventually resettled to community resources and services are crucial to
in the community (King, Singh, & Sheperd, 2000). successful discharge planning. In fact, the adequacy of
these discharge plans was a better predictor of how
CASE MANAGEMENT long the person could remain in the community than
were clinical indicators such as psychiatric diagnosis
Case management, or management of care on a (Caton & Gralnick, 1987).
case-by-case basis, is an important concept in both in- Impediments to successful discharge planning
patient and community settings. Inpatient case man- include alcohol and drug abuse, criminal or violent be-
agers are usually nurses or social workers who follow havior, noncompliance with medication regimens, and
the client from admission to discharge and serve as li- suicidal ideation (Gantt et al., 1999). For example, op-
aisons between the client and community resources, timal housing often is not available to people with a re-
home care, and third-party payers. In the community, cent history of drug or alcohol abuse or criminal be-
the case manager works with clients on a broad range havior. Also, clients who still had suicidal ideas or a
of issues, from accessing needed medical and psychi- history of noncompliance with medication regimens
atric services, to carrying out tasks of daily living such were ineligible for some treatment programs or ser-
as using public transportation, managing money, and vices. The study found that clients with these impedi-
buying groceries. ments to successful discharge planning often had a
marginal discharge plan in place because optimal ser-
vices or plans were not available to them. Conse-
DISCHARGE PLANNING
quently people discharged with marginal plans were
An important concept in any inpatient treatment set- readmitted more quickly and more frequently than
ting is discharge planning. Gantt et al. (1999) wrote those who had better discharge plans.
4 TREATMENT SETTINGS AND THERAPEUTIC PROGRAMS 75
Creating successful discharge plans that offer op- Clients in PHPs may complete the program after
timal services and housing is essential if people with an inpatient hospital stay, which is usually too short
mental illness are to be integrated into the commu- to address anything other than stabilization of symp-
nity. Gibson (1999) wrote that a holistic approach to toms and medication effectiveness. Other clients may
reintegrating persons into the community is the only come to a PHP to treat problems earlier, thus avoid-
way to prevent repeated hospital admissions and im- ing a costly and unwanted hospital stay. Others may
prove quality of life for clients. She maintains that make the transition from a PHP to longer-term out-
community programs after discharge from the hospi- patient therapy. Wilberg et al. (1999) reported that
tal should emphasize social services, day treatment, completion of a day-treatment program was effective
and housing programs. These services must be geared in stabilizing symptoms and improving daily func-
toward survival in the community, compliance with tioning, and it encouraged poorly functioning clients
treatment recommendations, rehabilitation, and in- with personality disorders to participate in outpatient
dependent living. Gibson identified assertive com- therapy. Pittman et al. (1990) found that day treat-
munity treatment (ACT) programs as providing ment for clients with severe and persistent mental ill-
most of the services that are necessary to stop the re- ness prevented hospital admission and improved the
volving door of repeated hospital admissions punctu- quality of clients lives with respect to socialization,
ated by unsuccessful attempts at community living. structure, and support.
ACT programs are discussed in detail later in this
chapter.
Residential Settings
Partial Hospitalization Programs Persons with mental illness may live in community
residential treatment settings that vary according
Partial hospitalization programs (PHPs) are de- to structure, level of supervision, and services pro-
signed to help clients make a gradual transition from vided (Box 4-2). Some settings are designed as transi-
being an inpatient to living independently and to pre- tional housing with the expectation that residents will
vent repeat admissions (Pittman et al., 1990). In day- progress to more independent living. Other residential
treatment programs, clients return home at night; programs serve clients for as long as the need exists,
evening programs are just the reverse. The services sometimes years. Board and care homes often provide
that different PHPs offer vary, but most programs in- a room, bathroom, laundry facilities, and one common
clude groups for building communication and social meal each day. Adult foster homes may care for one
skills, solving problems, monitoring medications, and to three clients in a family-like atmosphere including
learning. Individual sessions are available in some meals and social activities with the family. Halfway
PHPs as well as vocational assistance and occupa- houses usually serve as a temporary placement that
tional and recreation therapy. provides support as the client prepares for indepen-
Each client has an individualized treatment plan dence. Group homes house six to ten residents who
and goals, which the client develops with the case man- take turns cooking meals and sharing household
ager and other members of the treatment team. Eight chores under the supervision of one or two staff per-
broad categories of goals usually addressed in PHPs sons. Independent living programs are often housed in
(Swearingen, 1987) are summarized in Box 4-1. an apartment complex, where clients share an apart-
ment. Staff members are available for crisis interven-
tion, transportation, assistance with daily living tasks,
and sometimes drug monitoring. In addition to on-site
Box 4-1 staff, many residential settings provide case manage-
ment services for clients and put them in touch with
PARTIAL HOSPITALIZATION
PROGRAM GOALS
Stabilizing psychiatric symptoms
Monitoring drug effectiveness Box 4-2
Stabilizing living environment
Improving activities of daily living RESIDENTIAL SETTINGS
Learning to structure time Group homes
Developing social skills Supervised apartments
Obtaining meaningful work, paid employment, Board and care homes
or a volunteer position Adult foster care
Providing follow-up of any health concerns Respite/crisis housing
76 Unit I CURRENT THEORIES & PRACTICE
other programs (e.g., vocational rehabilitation; med- housing for people with mental illness is that they
ical, dental, and psychiatric care; psychosocial reha- may have to move many times, from one type of set-
bilitation programs or services) as needed. ting to another, as their independence increases. This
Some agencies provide respite housing, or crisis continual moving necessitates readjustment in each
housing services, for clients in need of short-term, tem- setting, making it difficult for clients to sustain their
porary shelter. These clients may live in a group home gains in independence. Because the ECH is a per-
or independently most of the time but have a need for manent living arrangement, it eliminates the problem
respite from their usual residence. This usually oc- of relocation.
curs when the client experiences a crisis, feels over- During the demonstration project, it was found
whelmed, or cannot cope with problems or emotions. that poverty among people with mental illness was a
Respite services often provide increased emotional significant barrier to maintaining housing, which
support and assistance with problem solving in a set- psychiatric rehabilitation seldom addressed (Ware &
ting away from the source of the clients distress. One Goldfinger, 1997). Residents often rely on government
such program is START in San Diego County, Califor- entitlements, such as Social Security Insurance (SSI)
nia. Acute care services, delivered in a facility in a res- or Social Security Disability Insurance (SSDI), for
idential neighborhood, provide an alternative to more their income, which averages $400 to $450 per month.
expensive hospitalization. Each year, the six START Although many clients express the desire to work,
programs in San Diego County provide 24,000 days of many cannot do so consistently. Even with vocational
care to 3000 adults with psychiatric illness. services, the jobs available tend to be unskilled and
Boydell et al. (1999) found that a clients living en- part-time, resulting in income that is inadequate to
vironment affected his or her level of functioning, rate maintain independent living. In addition, the SSI sys-
of reinstitutionalization, and duration of remaining in tem is often a disincentive to making the transition
the community setting. In fact, the living environment to paid employment: the client would have to trade
was more predictive of the clients success than were a reliable source of income and much-needed health
the characteristics of his or her illness. A client with insurance for a poorly paying, relatively insecure job
a poor living environment in the community would that is unlikely to include fringe benefits (Ware &
leave the community or be readmitted to the hospital. Goldfinger, 1997). The authors believed that both psy-
This study showed the need for finding quality living chiatric rehabilitation programs and society must
situations for clients, which is often a difficult task. address poverty among people with mental illness
Boydell et al. (1999) also found that many clients were to remove this barrier to independent living and
living in crime-ridden or commercial, rather than res- self-sufficiency.
idential, areas.
Frequently residents oppose plans to establish a
PSYCHIATRIC REHABILITATION
group home or residential facility in their neighbor-
PROGRAMS
hood. They argue that having a group home will de-
crease their property values, and they may believe that Psychiatric rehabilitation, sometimes called psycho-
people with mental illness are violent, act bizarrely in social rehabilitation, refers to services designed to
public, or will be a menace to their children. These peo- promote the recovery process for clients with mental
ple have strongly ingrained stereotypes and a great illness (Box 4-3). This recovery goes beyond symptom
deal of misinformation. Local residents must be given control and medication management to include per-
the facts so that safe, affordable, and desirable hous- sonal growth, reintegration into the community, em-
ing can be established for persons needing residential powerment, increased independence, and improved
care. Nurses are in a position to advocate for clients by quality of life (Wilbur & Arns, 1998). Community sup-
providing education to members of the community. port programs and services provide psychiatric reha-
bilitation to varying degrees, often depending on the
resources and funding available. Some programs
Evolving Consumer Households focus primarily on reducing hospital readmissions
The evolving consumer household (ECH) is a through symptom control and medication manage-
group-living situation in which the residents make ment, whereas others include social and recreation
the transition from a traditional group home to a res- services. There are not enough programs available
idence where they fulfill their own responsibilities and nationwide to meet the needs of people with mental
function without on-site supervision from paid staff illness.
(Ware, 1999). This concept was developed as part of the Hughes (1999) stated that the likelihood of achiev-
Boston McKinney Research Demonstration Project in ing even minimal treatment goals is unlikely without
the early 1990s, which is sponsored by the National a broad array of psychosocial, vocational, and housing
Institute of Mental Health. One of the problems with services, even though these services are typically not
4 TREATMENT SETTINGS AND THERAPEUTIC PROGRAMS 77
Box 4-4
TEN REASONS TO INCLUDE COMMUNITY SUPPORT IN EVERY BEHAVIORAL HEALTH PLAN
1. Decreased hospitalization means lower cost of care. Clients who have access to more intensive support are
less likely to decompensate to a point where they require inpatient hospitalization.
2. Normalization. Clients respond favorably to community interactions that are more normal and not
directly treatment related such as pursuing a hobby or joining the YMCA or YWCA with the help of their
community support worker.
3. Linkage to resources. Community support workers can identify and access resources for the client when he
or she may be unable to do so.
4. Effective advocacy. Community support workers can confront individuals or institutions in a professional
manner to resolve any attempts to prevent a client from reaching goals.
5. Improved quality of life. Because clients often survive on SSI benefits, they need assistance to access such
services as food pantries, energy grants, and weatherization programs to help make ends meet.
6. Respite for natural caregivers. Community support workers can arrange doctors appointments and lab
work, pick up drugs, and monitor compliance with medications to alleviate the stress of these tasks on
the clients caregiver. They also can provide direct support and information to caregivers to make their
tasks easier.
7. Consolidated funding. Services in the community are often provided and funded by a variety of programs
and agencies. Community support workers can advocate for the enhancement of community support
services and improved, adequate funding of these services.
8. Equalization of a two-tiered system. Private sector mental health care is often limited when the illness is
persistent and severe. Consequently, clients revert to care provided through public funds. All payers, public
or private, could benefit from community support programs to promote wellness and manage crises or
serious mental illness.
9. Flexibility. Community support employs a variety of persons at different skill levels to provide assistance
with everything from daily activities to psychiatric care, depending on the needs of the client.
10. Continuum of care. Community support provides the opportunity for clients to move along a continuum of
services without repeated transfers to different programs with unfamiliar staff.
Hughes, W. C. (1999). Managed care, meet community support. Health & Social Work, 24(2), 103110.
78 Unit I CURRENT THEORIES & PRACTICE
services to overcome these barriers were not funded encounters that focus on symptom management are
(Mallik et al., 1998). not sufficient to promote rehabilitation efforts. The
rehabilitation alliance refers to the network of re-
lationships that must develop over time to support
Clubhouse Model people with psychiatric disabilities. This alliance in-
In 1948, Fountain House pioneered the clubhouse cludes the client, family, friends, clinicians, and even
model of community-based rehabilitation in New landlords, employers, and neighbors. The rehabilita-
York City. Currently more than 350 such clubhouses tion alliance needs community support, opportuni-
have been established worldwide (Aquila et al., 1999). ties for success, coordination of service providers, and
Fountain House is an intentional community based member involvement to maintain a positive focus on
on the belief that men and women with serious and life goals, strengths, creativity, and hope as the mem-
persistent psychiatric disability can and will achieve ber pursues recovery. The clubhouse model exists to
normal life goals when given the opportunity, time, promote the rehabilitation alliance as a positive force
support, and fellowship. The essence of membership in the members life.
in the clubhouse is based on the four guaranteed rights The clubhouse focus is on health, not illness. Tak-
of members: ing prescribed drugs, for example, is not a condition of
A place to come to participation in the clubhouse. The member, not the
Meaningful work staff, must ultimately make decisions about treatment
Meaningful relationships such as whether or not he or she needs hospital ad-
A place to return to (lifetime membership) mission. Clubhouse staff support members, help them
The clubhouse provides members with many op- to obtain needed assistance, and most of all allow them
portunities including daytime work activities focused to make the decisions that ultimately affect all aspects
on the care, maintenance, and productivity of the club- of their lives. This approach to psychiatric rehabilita-
house; evening, weekend, and holiday leisure activi- tion is the cornerstone and the strength of the club-
ties; transitional and independent employment sup- house model.
port and efforts; and housing options. Members are
encouraged and assisted to use psychiatric services,
Assertive Community Treatment
which are usually local clinics or private practitioners.
The clubhouse model recognizes the physician One of the most effective approaches to community-
client relationship as a key to successful treatment based treatment for people with mental illness is as-
and rehabilitation while acknowledging that brief sertive community treatment (ACT) (Box 4-5). Marx,
Box 4-5
COMPONENTS OF AN ACT PROGRAM
Having a multidisciplinary team that includes a psychiatrist, psychiatric-mental health nurse, vocational reha-
bilitation specialist, and a social worker for each 100 clients (low staff-client ratio)
Identifying a fixed point of responsibility for clients with a primary provider of services
Ameliorating or eliminating the debilitating symptoms of mental illness
Improving client functioning in adult social and employment roles and activities
Decreasing the familys burden of care by providing opportunities for clients to learn skills in real-life situations
Implementing an individualized, ongoing treatment program defined by clients needs
Involving all needed support systems for holistic treatment of clients
Promoting mental health through the use of a vast array of resources and treatment modalities
Emphasizing and promoting client independence
Using daily team meetings to discuss strategies to improve the care of clients
Providing services 24 hours a day that would include respite care to deflect unnecessary hospitalization and
crisis intervention to prevent destabilization with unnecessary emergency department visits
Client outcomes are measured on the following aspects: symptomatology; social, psychological, and familial
functioning; gainful employment; client independence; client empowerment; use of ancillary services; client,
family, and societal satisfaction; hospital use; agency use; rehospitalization; quality of life; and costs.
Test, and Stein conceived this idea in 1973 in Madi- SPECIAL POPULATIONS OF CLIENTS
son, Wisconsin, while working at Mendota State Hos- WITH MENTAL ILLNESS
pital. They believed that skills training, support, and
teaching should be done in the community where it Homeless
was needed rather than in the hospital. Their program Homeless people with mental illness have been the
was first known as the Madison model, then training focus of recent studies. For this population, shelters,
in community living, and finally ACT or the program rehabilitation programs, and prisons may serve as
for assertive treatment. The mobile outreach and con- makeshift alternatives to inpatient care or support-
tinuous treatment programs of today all have their ive housing (Sullivan, Burman, Koegel, & Hollenberg,
roots in the Madison model (Hughes, 1999). 2000). Frequent shifts between the street, programs,
An ACT program has a problem-solving orienta- and institutions worsen the marginal existence of this
tion: staff members attend to specific life issues, no population. Compared with homeless people without
matter how mundane. ACT programs provide most mental illness, the mentally ill homeless are home-
services directly rather than relying on referrals to less longer, spend more time in shelters, have fewer
other programs or agencies, and they implement the contacts with family, spend more time in jail, and face
services in the clients home or community not in an greater barriers to employment (Haugland et al.,
office. The ACT services are also intense; three or 1997). For this population, professionals supersede
more face-to-face contacts with clients are tailored to families as the primary source of help.
meet clients needs. The team approach allows all staff Kuno, Rothbard, Averyt, & Culhane (2000) found
to be equally familiar with all clients, so clients do not that an enhanced community-based health system
have to wait for an assigned person. ACT programs was not sufficient to prevent homelessness among
also make a long-term commitment to clients, provid- high-risk people with mental illness. Likewise, pro-
ing services for as long as the need persists with no viding housing alone does not significantly alter the
time constraints (McGrew et al., 1996). When par- prognosis (Dickey et al., 1996). In a study conducted
ticipants were asked which components of ACT were in Boston, homeless people with mental illness were
most satisfying to them, they identified staff avail- given permanent housing in an apartment or an ECH,
ability, home visits, and help with everyday problems access to mental health treatment, and specialized so-
(McGrew et al., 1996). cial services. There was no difference in the housing
ACT programs were developed and had flour- stability of the two groups based on the type of res-
ished in urban settings. Fekete et al. (1998) studied idence. Both groups significantly increased their hous-
the effectiveness of ACT programs in rural areas, ing stability and use of mental health treatment
where traditional psychiatric services were more lim- services. Similarly Shern et al. (1997) followed 896
ited, fragmented, and difficult to obtain in rural areas homeless mentally ill adults in four major cities. After
than in cities. They noted that although 20% of the receiving stable community housing, community sup-
U.S. population is rural, 33% of the poor population is port, and rehabilitation services, 78% of the partici-
rural. Therefore, rural areas have less money to fund pants were housed stably at the 12- to 24-month final
services. Further, social stigma about mental illness is follow-up. Chinman, Rosenheck, & Lam (2000) found
greater in rural areas, as are negative attitudes about that homeless clients who had a positive relationship
public service programs. The study found that ACT with their case manager had fewer homeless days and
programs were successful in rural areas and resulted higher general life satisfaction than clients reporting
in fewer hospital admissions, greater housing stabil- no relationship with their case manager.
ity, improved quality of life, and improved psychiatric The success of such projects suggests that it is
symptoms. This success occurred even though certain possible to make significant differences in the lives of
modifications of traditional ACT programs were re- mentally ill homeless by providing active psychiatric
quired such as two-person teams, fewer and shorter rehabilitation services along with housing alterna-
contacts with clients, and minimal participation from tives. The Center for Mental Health Services initiated
some disciplines. the Access to Community Care and Effective
Bond, Drake, Mueser, & Latimer (2001) report Services and Support (ACCESS) Demonstration
that ACT programs continue to succeed in providing Project in 1994 to assess whether or not more inte-
more cost-effective alternatives to hospitalization grated systems of service delivery enhance the quality
while improving client satisfaction with services. They of life of homeless people with serious mental dis-
also identify areas that ACT programs need to address abilities through the use of services and outreach.
more effectively: vocational focus, social skills train- ACCESS was a 5-year demonstration program with
ing, development of social networks, and working with locations in 18 communities of 15 U.S. cities, repre-
family members. The authors believe these areas are senting most geographic areas of the continental
within the scope of ACT and would enhance the re- United States (Chinman et al., 1999). Each site pro-
covery of clients in the community. vides outreach and intensive case management to 100
80 Unit I CURRENT THEORIES & PRACTICE
Box 4-6
BARRIERS TO SUCCESSFUL COMMUNITY REINTEGRATION
Double stigma: Individuals are stigmatized as being cons as well as enduring the stigma of mental illness.
Lack of family or social support: Offenders are often estranged from family members even more so than
clients with mental illness who are not in jail, and they have few or no friends to provide social support.
Comorbidity: Substance abuse is a problem for most of the mentally ill offenders in the program sponsored
by the authors, and 50% have severe chronic or subacute medical illnesses.
Adjustment problems: Many offenders report difficulty readjusting to living in the community after a prison
term, including a lack of support in the community.
Boundary issues: Offenders often view any person, including psychiatrists or other health professionals, as
being an extension of correctional staff. This makes trust very difficult.
Roskes, B., Feldman, R., Arrington, S., & Leisher, M. (1999). A model program for the treatment of mentally ill offenders in the
community. Community Mental Health Journal, 35(5), 461 475.
improve their attitudes toward people with inated for clubhouse participants. They had fewer ar-
mental illness. rests and incarcerations than they had before psycho-
Perform careful screening of incoming pris- social rehabilitation. In some cases, the reduced in-
oners to provide treatment, including med- volvement with criminal justice did not continue long
ication, when needed. after clubhouse participation ended. The study has
Encourage the diversion of people with positive implications for involving offenders with men-
mental illness who have committed minor tal illness in ongoing psychosocial rehabilitation as a
offenses to the mental health system. way to decrease involvement in the criminal justice
Implement ACT programs to provide out- system.
reach services in the community. The Thresholds Collaborative Jail Linkage Proj-
Provide social control interventions, such as ect in Chicago, Illinois, works with mentally ill of-
outpatient commitment, court-ordered treat- fenders caught in the revolving door of homelessness
ment, psychiatric conservatorship, or 24-hour and incarceration. Threshold staff members visit the
structured care, as conditions of probation for client in jail and begin working with him or her prior
people who do not voluntarily accept treat- to release. They locate housing, establish relation-
ment or services. ships with landlords and local police, and may also
Ensure involvement of and support for secure an early release for the client. The members
families. of the multidisciplinary team function according to
Provide appropriate mental health treatment. many of the principles of ACT programs such as 24/7
Some programs for people with mental illness who availability for crises, money management, home vis-
have committed crimes have been successful. Kravitz its, and access to a wide variety of community ser-
and Kelly (1999) described a mandatory forensic out- vices. The program is succeeding in helping clients
patient program for mentally ill offenders who were avoid arrest or rehospitalization. In addition, the pro-
found not guilty by reason of insanity. Since they en- gram costs about $26 a day per client as opposed to
rolled in the program, 47% were admitted to the hos- $70 a day to keep a person in jail or $500 a day in a
pital at least once and 19% were rearrested or had public psychiatric hospital (Thresholds, 2001).
committed a new crime. With respect to psychiatric Appelbaum, Hickey, & Packer (2001) describe the
stability, only 24% were in full remission and 68% role of correctional officer on the multidisciplinary
showed at least one indicator of difficulty reintegrat- team to treat incarcerated people with mental illness.
ing into the community. The authors suggested that, Along with their usual duties involving safety and se-
although successful outcomes often include decreased curity, correctional officers provide therapeutic inter-
hospital admission rates, inpatient care might be a ventions to inmates in specialized residential units of
positive outcome for this population. the institution. These officers also provide valuable ob-
Johnson and Hickey (1999) studied the criminal servations that they relay to the treatment team to en-
justice involvement of offenders with mental illness hance the psychiatric care that inmates with mental
who participated in a clubhouse-type psychosocial re- illness receive. This approach has improved both the
habilitation program. The extent of criminal justice quality of treatment and the safety of the correctional
involvement diminished but was not completely elim- environment.
82 Unit I CURRENT THEORIES & PRACTICE
Roskes et al. (1999) proposed a model of working chologist, psychiatric nurse, psychiatric social worker,
with mentally ill offenders that calls for a collabora- occupational therapist, recreation therapist, and vo-
tive working relationship between a community men- cational rehabilitation specialist. Their primary roles
tal health center and a probation office. On release are described in Box 4-7. Not all settings have a full-
from incarceration, each offender is assigned to a pa- time member from each discipline on their team; the
role officer and a psychiatrist who work with the of- programs and services that the team offers determine
fender to avoid re-arrest or parole violation and to ob- its composition in any setting.
tain needed mental health services. Their results were Functioning as an effective team member requires
anecdotal in nature, but they had success in diverting the development and practice of several core skill areas
many long-term offenders from the criminal justice (White & Brooker, 2001):
system and into mental health services. Interpersonal skills such as tolerance,
patience, understanding
INTERDISCIPLINARY TEAM Humanity such as warmth, acceptance, em-
pathy, genuineness, nonjudgmental attitude
Regardless of the treatment setting, rehabilitation Knowledge base about mental disorders,
program, or population, an interdisciplinary (or symptoms, behavior
multidisciplinary) team approach is most useful in Communication skills
dealing with the multifaceted problems of clients with Personal qualities such as consistency,
mental illness. Different members of the team have assertiveness, problem-solving abilities
expertise in specific areas. By collaborating, they can Teamwork skills such as collaborating, shar-
meet clients needs more effectively. Members of the ing, integrating
interdisciplinary team include the psychiatrist, psy- Risk assessment/risk management skills
Box 4-7
INTERDISCIPLINARY TEAM PRIMARY ROLES
Psychiatrist: The psychiatrist is a physician certified in psychiatry by the American Board of Psychiatry and
Neurology, which requires a 3-year residency, 2 years of clinical practice, and completion of an examination.
The primary function of the psychiatrist is diagnosis of mental disorders and prescription of medical
treatments.
Psychologist: The clinical psychologist has a doctorate (Ph.D.) in clinical psychology and is prepared to prac-
tice therapy, conduct research, and interpret psychological tests. Psychologists may also participate in the
design of therapy programs for groups of individuals.
Psychiatric nurse: The registered nurse gains experience in working with clients with psychiatric disorders
after graduation from an accredited program of nursing and completion of the licensure examination. The
nurse has a solid foundation in health promotion, illness prevention, and rehabilitation in all areas, allowing
him or her to view the client holistically. The nurse is also an essential team member in evaluating the effec-
tiveness of medical treatment, particularly medications. Registered nurses who obtain a masters degree in
mental health may be certified as clinical specialists or licensed as advanced practitioners, depending on indi-
vidual state nurse practice acts. Advanced practice nurses are certified to prescribe drugs in many states.
Psychiatric social worker: Most psychiatric social workers are prepared at the masters level, and they are
licensed in some states. Social workers may practice therapy and often have the primary responsibility for
working with families, community support, and referral.
Occupational therapist: Occupational therapists may have an associate degree (certified occupational therapy
assistant) or a baccalaureate degree (certified occupational therapist). Occupational therapy focuses on the
functional abilities of the client and ways to improve client functioning such as working with arts and crafts
and focusing on psychomotor skills.
Recreation therapist: Many recreation therapists complete a baccalaureate degree, but in some instances
persons with experience fulfill these roles. The recreation therapist helps the client to achieve a balance of
work and play in his or her life and provides activities that promote constructive use of leisure or unstruc-
tured time.
Vocational rehabilitation specialist: Vocational rehabilitation includes determining clients interests and abili-
ties and matching them with vocational choices. Clients are also assisted in job-seeking and job-retention
skills, as well as pursuit of further education if that is needed and desired. Vocational rehabilitation specialists
can be prepared at the baccalaureate or masters level and may have different levels of autonomy and pro-
gram supervision based on their education.
4 TREATMENT SETTINGS AND THERAPEUTIC PROGRAMS 83
The role of the case manager has become increas- abuse, domestic violence, child abuse, grief, and de-
ingly important with the proliferation of managed care pression. In addition, public health nurses care for
and the variety of services that clients need. No stan- children in schools and teach health-related subjects
dard formal educational program to become a case to community groups and agencies. Mental health
manager exists, however, and people from many dif- services that public health and home care nurses
ferent backgrounds may fill this role. In some set- provide can reduce the suffering that many people
tings, a social worker or psychiatric nurse may be the experience as a result of physical disease, mental dis-
case manager. In other settings, people who work in orders, social and emotional disadvantages, and other
psychosocial rehabilitation settings may take on the vulnerabilities.
role of case manager with a baccalaureate degree in
a related field, such as psychology, or by virtue of their
experience and demonstrated skills. Liberman, Hilty, SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES
Drake, & Tsang (2001) identify three distinct sets of Psychiatric-mental health nursing is
competencies necessary for effective case managers: evolving as changes continue in health care. The focus
clinical skills, relationship skills, and liaison and advo- is shifting from traditional hospital-based goals of
cacy skills. Clinical skills include treatment planning, symptom and medication management to more client-
symptom and functional assessment, and skills train- centered goals, which include improved quality of life
ing. Relationship skills include the ability to establish and recovery from mental illness. Therefore, the nurse
and maintain collaborative, respectful, and therapeu- also must expand his or her repertoire of skills and
tic alliances with a wide variety of clients. Liaison and abilities to assist clients in their efforts. These chal-
advocacy skills are necessary to develop and maintain lenges may overwhelm the nurse at times, and he or
effective interagency contacts for housing, financial she may feel underprepared or ill equipped to meet
entitlements, and vocational rehabilitation. them.
As clients needs become more varied and com- Mental health services are moving into some non-
plex, the psychiatric nurse is in an ideal position to traditional settings such as jails and homeless shel-
fulfill the role of case manager. In 1994, the American ters. As nursing roles expand in these alternative set-
Nurses Association stated that the psychiatric nurse tings, the nurse does not have the array of backup
can assess, monitor, and refer clients for general med- services found in a hospital or clinic such as on-site
ical problems as well as psychiatric problems; admin- physicians and colleagues, medical services, and so
ister drugs; monitor for drug side effects; provide drug forth. This requires the nurse to practice in a more
and client and family health education; and monitor autonomous and independent manner, which can be
for general medical disorders that have psychological unsettling.
and physiologic components. Registered nurses bring Empowering clients to make their own decisions
unique nursing knowledge and skills to the multi- about treatment is an essential part of full recovery.
disciplinary team (Wilbur & Arns, 1998). This differs from the model of the psychiatrist or treat-
ment team as the authority on what is the best course
for the client to follow. It is a challenge for the nurse
PSYCHOSOCIAL NURSING IN to be supportive to the client when the nurse believes
PUBLIC HEALTH AND HOME CARE the client has made choices that are less than ideal.
Psychosocial nursing is an important area of public The nurse may experience frustration when work-
health nursing practice (Collins & Diego, 2000) and ing with mentally ill adults who are homeless, incar-
home care. Public health nurses working in the com- cerated, or both. Typically these clients are difficult to
munity provide mental health prevention services to engage in a therapeutic relationship and may present
reduce risks to the mental health of persons, families, great challenges to the nurse. The nurse may feel re-
and communities. Examples include primary preven- jected by clients who do not engage readily in a rela-
tion such as stress management education; secondary tionship, or the nurse may feel inadequate in attempts
prevention such as early identification of potential to engage these clients.
mental health problems; and tertiary prevention such
as monitoring and coordinating rehabilitation ser-
vices for the mentally ill.
Points to Consider When Working
Finkelman (2000) identifies the need to provide
in Community-Based Settings
self-management skills training to mental health The client can make mistakes, survive them,
home care clients in addition to support and treat- and learn from them. Mistakes are a part
ment to facilitate recovery. The clinical practice of of normal life for everyone, and it is not the
public health and home care nurses includes caring nurses role to protect clients from such
for clients and families with issues such as substance experiences.
84 Unit I CURRENT THEORIES & PRACTICE
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
The nurse will not always have the answer to The PACED model of inpatient care is a
solve a clients problems or resolve a difficult client-centered approach that uses a multi-
situation. disciplinary approach to brief hospital stays.
As clients move toward recovery, they need The model includes rapid assessment, stabi-
support to make decisions and follow a lization of symptoms, and discharge planning.
course of action, even if the nurse thinks the Adequate discharge planning is a good indi-
client is making decisions that are unlikely cator of how successful the clients commu-
to be successful. nity placement will be.
Working with clients in community settings Impediments to successful discharge plan-
is a more collaborative relationship than the ning include alcohol and drug abuse, crimi-
traditional role of caring for the client. The nal or violent behavior, noncompliance with
nurse may be more familiar and comfortable medications, and suicidal ideation.
with the latter. Partial hospitalization programs usually ad-
dress the clients psychiatric symptoms, med-
ication use, living environment, activities of
Critical Thinking Questions daily living, leisure time, social skills, work,
and health concerns.
1. Discuss the role of the nurse in advocating for Community residential settings vary in
social or legislative policy changes needed to terms of structure, level of supervision, and
provide psychiatric rehabilitation services for services provided. Some residential settings
clients in all settings. are transitional with the expectation that
2. When are programs for special populations, clients will progress to independent living;
such as mentally ill adults who are offenders others serve the client for as long as he or
or homeless, considered successful? she needs.
3. How can the nurse reconcile the trend for Types of residential settings include board
short inpatient hospitalization with the long- and care homes, adult foster homes, halfway
term needs of some clients with severe and houses, group homes, and independent living
persistent mental illness? programs.
A clients ability to remain in the community
is closely related to the quality and adequacy
of his or her living environment.
KEY POINTS Poverty among persons with mental illness
People with mental illness are treated in a is a significant barrier to maintaining hous-
variety of settings, and some are not in touch ing in the community and is seldom ad-
with needed services at all. dressed in psychiatric rehabilitation.
Shortened inpatient hospital stays necessi- Psychiatric rehabilitation refers to services
tate changes in the ways hospitals deliver designed to promote the recovery process for
services to clients. clients with mental illness. This recovery
4 TREATMENT SETTINGS AND THERAPEUTIC PROGRAMS 85
goes beyond symptom control and medication tal health care in prisons. Psychiatric Services,
management to include personal growth, 52(10), 13431347.
Aquila, R., Santos, G. Malamud, T. J., & McCrory, D.
reintegration into the community, empower-
(1999). The rehabilitation alliance in practice: The
ment, increased independence, and improved clubhouse connection. Psychiatric Rehabilitation
quality of life. Journal, 23(1), 1923.
The clubhouse model of psychosocial rehabil- Bond, G. R., Drake, R. E., Mueser, K. T., & Latimer, E.
itation is an intentional community based on (2001). Assertive community treatment for people
with severe mental illness. Disease Management and
the belief that men and women with mental Health Outcomes, 9(3), 141159.
illness can and will achieve normal life goals Boydell, K. M., Gladstone, B. M., Crawford, E., & Trainor,
when provided time, opportunity, support, J. (1999). Making do on the outside: Everyday life in
and fellowship. the neighborhoods of people with psychiatric disabili-
Assertive community treatment is one of the ties. Psychiatric Rehabilitation Journal, 23(1), 1117.
Caton, C., & Gralnick, A. (1987). A review of issues sur-
most effective approaches to community- rounding length of psychiatric hospitalization. Hospi-
based treatment. It includes 24-hour-a-day tal and Community Psychiatry, 38, 858863.
services, low staffclient ratios, in-home or Chinman, M. J., Rosenheck, R., & Lam, J. A. (1999). The
community services, intense and frequent development of relationships between people who are
homeless and have a mental disability and their case
contact, and unlimited length of service. managers. Psychiatric Rehabilitation Journal, 23(1),
Psychiatric rehabilitation services such as 4755.
ACT must be provided along with stable Chinman, M. J., Rosenheck, R., & Lam, J. A. (2000). The
housing to produce positive outcomes for case management relationship and outcomes of
homeless persons with serious mental illness. Psychi-
mentally ill adults who are homeless.
atric Services, 51(9), 11421147.
Adults with mental illness may be placed in Collins, A. M., & Diego, L. (2000). Mental health promo-
the criminal justice system more frequently tion and protection. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing,
due to deinstitutionalization, rigid criteria 38(1), 2732.
for civil commitment, lack of adequate sup- Community Research Foundation. (2001). A community-
based program providing a successful alternative to
port, and the attitudes of police and society. acute psychiatric hospitalization. Psychiatric Ser-
Barriers to community reintegration for vices, 52(10), 13831385.
mentally ill persons who have been incarcer- Dickey, B., Gonzalez, O., Latimer, E., Powers, K., Schutt,
ated include double stigma, lack of family or R., & Goldfinger, S. (1996). Use of mental health ser-
vices by formerly homeless adults residing in group
social support, comorbidity, adjustment
and independent housing. Psychiatric Services, 47(2),
problems, and boundary issues. 152158.
The multidisciplinary team includes the psy- Dilonardo, J. D., Connely, C. E., Gurel, L., Kendrick, K., &
chiatrist, psychologist, psychiatric nurse, Deutsch, S. I. (1998). Scheduled intermittent hospital-
psychiatric social worker, occupational ther- ization for psychiatric patients. Psychiatric Services,
49(4), 504509.
apist, recreation therapist, and vocational Fekete, D. M., Bond, G. R., McDonel, E. C., Salyers, M.,
rehabilitation specialist. Chen, A., & Miller, L. (1998). Rural assertive com-
The psychiatric nurse is in an ideal position munity treatment: A field experiment. Psychiatric
to fulfill the role of case manager. The nurse Rehabilitation Journal, 21(4), 371379.
Finkelman, A. W. (2000). Self-management for the psychi-
can assess, monitor, and refer clients for gen- atric patient at home. Home Care Provider, 6, 95103.
eral medical and psychiatric problems; Fisher, W. H., Barreira, P. J., Geller, J. L., White, A. W.,
administer drugs; monitor for drug side Lincoln, A. K., & Sudders, M. (2001). Long-stay pa-
effects; provide drug and patient and family tients in state psychiatric hospitals at the end of the
health education; and monitor for general 20th century. Psychiatric Services, 52(8). 10511056.
Haugland, G., Siegel, C., Hopper, K., and Alexander,
medical disorders that have psychological M. J. (1997). Mental illness among homeless individ-
and physiologic components. uals in a suburban county. Psychiatric Services,
Empowering clients to pursue full recovery 48(4), 504509.
requires a collaborative working relationship Gantt, A. B., Cohen, N. L., & Saintz, A. (1999). Impedi-
ments to the discharge planning effort for psychiatric
with the client rather than the traditional inpatients. Social Work in Health Care, 29(1), 114.
approach of caring for the client. Gibson, D. M. (1999). Reduced hospitalizations and re-
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com. integration of persons with mental illness into
community living: A holistic approach. Journal of
Psychosocial Nursing, 37(11), 2025.
REFERENCES Hughes, W. C. (1999). Managed care, meet community
support: Ten reasons to include direct support services
Appelbaum, K. L., Hickey, J. M., & Packer, I. (2001). The in every behavioral health plan. Health & Social
role of correctional officers in multidisciplinary men- Work, 24(2), 103110.
86 Unit I CURRENT THEORIES & PRACTICE
Johnson, J., & Hickey, S. (1999). Arrests and incarcera- treatment. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing,
tions after psychosocial program involvement: 28(11), 611.
Clubhouse vs. jailhouse. Psychiatric Rehabilitation Roskes, E., Feldman, R., Arrington, S., & Leisher, M.
Journal, 23(1), 6669. (1999). A model program for the treatment of mentally
King, C., Singh, K., & Sheperd, G. (2000). An analysis of ill offenders in the community. Community Mental
process and outcomes for new long-stay patients in a Health Journal, 35(5), 461475.
ward-in-a-house. Journal of Mental Health, 9(2), Shern, D. L., Felton, C. J., Hough, R. L., Lehman, A. F.,
179191. Goldfinger, S., Valencia, E., Dennis, D., Straw, R.,
Kravitz, H. M., & Kelly, J. (1999). An outpatient psychia- Wood, P. A. (1997). Housing outcomes for homeless
try program for offenders found not guilty by reason
adults with mental illness: Results from the second-
of insanity. Psychiatric Services, 50(12), 15971605.
Kuno, E., Rothbard, A. B., Averyt, J. & Culhane, D. (2000). round McKinney program. Psychiatric Services,
Homelessness among persons with serious mental ill- 48(2), 239241.
ness in an enhanced community-based mental health Sullivan, G., Burman, A., Koegel, P., & Hollenberg, J.
system. Psychiatric Services, 51(8). 10121016. (2000). Quality of life of homeless persons with men-
Lam, J. A., & Rosenheck, R. A. (2000). Correlates of im- tal illness: Results from the course-of-homelessness
provement in quality of life among homeless persons study. Psychiatric Services, 51(9), 11351141.
with serious mental illness. Psychiatric Services, Swearingen, L. (1987). Transitional day treatment: An in-
51(1), 116118. dividualized goal-oriented approach. Archives of Psy-
Lamb, H. R., & Weinberger, L. E. (1998). Persons with chiatric Nursing, I(2), 104110.
severe mental illness in jails and prisons: A review. Thresholds Collaborative Jail Linkage Project. (2001).
Psychiatric Services, 49(4), 483492. Helping mentally ill people break the cycle of jail and
Liberman, R. P., Hilty, D. M., Drake, R. E., & Tsang, homelessness. Psychiatric Services, 52(10), 13801382.
H. W. H. (2001). Requirements for multidisciplinary Ware, N. C. (1999). Evolving consumer households. Psy-
teamwork in psychiatric rehabilitation. Psychiatric chiatric Rehabilitation Journal, 23(1), 310.
Services, 52(10), 13311342. Ware, N. C., & Goldfinger, S. (1997). Poverty and rehabil-
Mallik, K., Reeves, R. J., & Dellario, D. J. (1998). Barriers
itation in severe psychiatric disorders. Psychiatric
to community integration for people with severe and
Rehabilitation Journal, 21(1), 39.
persistent psychiatric disabilities. Psychiatric Reha-
bilitation Journal, 22(2), 175180. White, L., & Brooker, C. (2001). Working with a multi-
McGihon, N. N. (1999). Psychiatric nursing for the 21st disciplinary team in a secure psychiatric environment.
century: The PACED model. Journal of Psychosocial Journal of Psychosocial Nursing, 39(9), 2631.
Nursing, 37(10), 2227. Wilberg, T., Urnes, O., Friis, S., Irion, T., Pedersen, G., &
McGrew, J. H., Wilson, R. G., & Bond, G. R. (1996). Client Karterud, S. (1999). One-year follow-up of day treat-
perspectives on helpful ingredients of assertive com- ment for poorly functioning patients with personality
munity treatment. Psychiatric Rehabilitation Journal, disorders. Psychiatric Services, 50(10), 13261330.
19(3), 1321. Wilbur, S., & Arns, P. (1998). Psychosocial rehabilitation
Pittman, D. C., Parson, R., & Peterson, R. W. (1990). nurses: Taking our place on the multidisciplinary
Easing the way: A multifaceted approach to day team. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing, 36(4), 3341.
4 TREATMENT SETTINGS AND THERAPEUTIC PROGRAMS 87
1. All of the following are characteristics of ACT 5. Which of the following interventions is an exam-
except ple of primary prevention implemented by a pub-
lic health nurse?
A. Services are provided in the home or
community. A. Reporting suspected child abuse
B. Services are provided by the clients case B. Monitoring compliance with medications for
manager. a client with schizophrenia
C. There are no time limitations on ACT C. Teaching effective problem-solving skills to
services. high school students
D. All needed support systems are involved in D. Helping a client to apply for disability benefits
ACT.
6. The primary purpose of psychiatric rehabilitation
2. Research has shown that scheduled, intermit- is to
tent hospital admissions result in which of the
A. Control psychiatric symptoms
following?
B. Manage clients medications
A. Fewer inpatient hospital stays
C. Promote the recovery process
B. Increased sense of control for the client
D. Reduce hospital readmissions
C. Feelings of failure when hospitalized
D. Shorter hospital stays 7. Managed care provides funding for psychiatric
rehabilitations programs to
3. The PACED model for inpatient psychiatric care
A. Develop vocational skills
focuses on all of the following except
B. Improve medication compliance
A. Brief interventions
C. Provide community skills training
B. Case management
D. Teach social skills
C. Discharge planning
D. Independent living skills 8. The mentally ill homeless population benefits
most from
4. How many persons in the state prison population
A. Case management services
have severe mental illness?
B. Outpatient psychiatric care to manage psy-
A. Less than 5%
chiatric symptoms
B. 10% to 15%
C. Stable housing in a residential neighborhood
C. 25% to 30%
D. A combination of housing, rehabilitation ser-
D. More than 45% vices, and community support
87
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify the interdisciplinary team member responsible for the functions listed below.
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
3. List factors that have caused an increased number of persons with mental
illness to be detained in jails.
88
Unit 2
Building the
NurseClient
Relationship
5
Learning Objectives
After reading this chapter, the
Therapeutic
Relationships
student should be able to
1. Describe how the nurse
uses the necessary compo-
nents involved in building
and enhancing the
nurseclient relationship
(trust, genuine interest,
empathy, acceptance, and
Key Terms
positive regard). acceptance positive regard
2. Explain the importance of
advocacy preconception
values, beliefs, and attitudes
in the development of the attitudes problem identification
nurseclient relationship. beliefs self-awareness
3. Describe the importance of
self-awareness and thera- confidentiality self-disclosure
peutic use of self in the congruence social relationship
nurseclient relationship. countertransference termination or resolution
4. Identify self-awareness
issues that can enhance or duty to warn phase
hinder the nurseclient empathy therapeutic relationship
relationship.
exploitation therapeutic use of self
5. Define Carpers four pat-
terns of knowing and give genuine interest transference
examples of each. intimate relationship unknowing
6. Describe the differences be-
tween social, intimate, and orientation phase values
therapeutic relationships. patterns of knowing working phase
7. Describe and implement the
phases of the nurseclient
relationship as outlined by
Hildegard Peplau.
8. Explain the negative be-
haviors that can hinder or
diminish the nurseclient
relationship.
9. Explain the various possible
roles of the nurse (teacher,
caregiver, advocate, and
parent surrogate) in the
nurseclient relationship.
90
5 THERAPEUTIC RELATIONSHIPS 91
comprehend what the nurse is saying. Likewise, a Several therapeutic communication techniques,
client with panic disorder may be too anxious to focus such as reflection, restatement, and clarification, help
on the nurses communication. Although clients with the nurse to send empathetic messages to the client.
mental disorders frequently give incongruent mes- For example, a client says, Im so confused! My son
sages because of their illness, the nurse must con- just visited and wants to know where the safety de-
tinue to provide consistent, congruent messages. Ex- posit box key is. Using reflection, the nurse responds,
amining ones own behavior and doing ones best to Youre confused because your son asked for the safety
make messages clear, simple, and congruent help to deposit key? The nurse using clarification responds,
facilitate trust between the nurse and the client. Are you confused about the purpose of your sons
visit? From these empathetic moments, a bond can be
established to serve as the foundation for the nurse
Genuine Interest client relationship. More examples of therapeutic com-
When the nurse is comfortable with himself or her- munication techniques are found in Chapter 6.
self, aware of his or her strengths and limitations, The nurse must understand the difference be-
and clearly focused, the client will perceive a genuine tween empathy and sympathy (feelings of concern or
person showing genuine interest. Clients with compassion one shows for another). By expressing
mental illness can detect when someone is exhibit- sympathy, the nurse may project his or her personal
ing dishonest or artificial behavior such as asking a concerns onto the client, thus inhibiting the clients
question and then not waiting for the answer, talk- expression of feelings. In the above example, the
ing over the client, or assuring the client everything nurse using sympathy would have responded, I know
will be all right. The nurse should be open and hon- how confusing sons can be. My son confuses me, too,
est and display congruent behavior. Sometimes, how- and I know how bad that makes you feel. The nurses
ever, responding with truth and honesty alone does feelings of sadness or even pity could influence the re-
not provide the best professional response. In such lationship and hinder the nurses abilities to focus on
cases, the nurse may choose to disclose to the client the clients needs. Sympathy often shifts the empha-
a personal experience related to the clients current sis to the nurses feelings, hindering the nurses abil-
concerns. Doing so helps to develop trust and allows ity to view the clients needs objectively.
the client to see the nurse as a real person with per-
haps similar problems. The client then may choose Acceptance
to reveal more information to the nurse. This self-
The nurse who does not become upset or respond
disclosure, revealing personal information (e.g., bio-
negatively to a clients outbursts, anger, or acting
graphical data, ideas, thoughts, feelings), can enhance
openness and honesty. Nevertheless the nurse must
not shift emphasis to the nurses problems rather than
the clients problems.
Empathy
Empathy is the ability of the nurse to perceive the
meanings and feelings of the client and to communi-
cate that understanding to the client. It is considered
one of the essential skills a nurse must develop. Being
able to put himself or herself in the clients shoes does
not mean that the nurse has had the same exact ex-
periences as the client. Nevertheless, by listening and
sensing the importance of the situation to the client,
the nurse can imagine the clients feelings about the
experience. Both the client and the nurse give a gift
of self when empathy occursthe client by feeling
safe enough to share feelings, and the nurse by listen-
ing closely enough to understand. Empathy has been
shown to positively influence client outcomes. Clients
tend to feel better about themselves and more under-
stood when the nurse is empathetic (Reynolds & Scott,
1999; Kunyk & Olson, 2001). Empathy vs. sympathy
5 THERAPEUTIC RELATIONSHIPS 93
Box 5-3
VALUES CLARIFICATION EXERCISE
VALUES CLARIFICATION
Your values are your ideas about what is most important to you in your lifewhat you want to live by and live for.
They are the silent forces behind many of your actions and decisions. The goal of values clarification is for their
influence to become fully conscious, for you to explore and honestly acknowledge what you truly value at this time.
You can be more self-directed and effective when you know which values you really choose to keep and live by as
an adult, and which ones will get priority over others. Identify your values first, and then rank your top three or five.
Being with people Being independent Striving for perfection Not getting taken
Being loved Being courageous Making a contribution advantage of
Being married Having things in control to the world Having it easy
Having a special Having self-control Fighting injustice Being comfortable
partner Being emotionally Living ethically Avoiding boredom
Having companionship stable Being a good parent Having fun
Loving someone Having self-acceptance (or child) Enjoying sensual
Taking care of others Having pride or dignity Being a spiritual person pleasures
Having someones Being well organized Having a relationship Looking good
help Being competent with God Being physically fit
Having a close family Having peace and quiet Being healthy
Learning and knowing
Having good friends a lot Making a home Having prized
Being liked Achieving highly Preserving your roots possessions
Being popular Being productively Having financial Being a creative person
Getting someones busy security Having deep feelings
approval Having enjoyable work Holding on to what Growing as a person
Being appreciated Having an important you have Living fully
position Being safe physically Smelling the flowers
Being treated fairly
Making money Being free from pain Having a purpose
Being admired
By Joyce Sichel. From Bernard, M. E., & Wolfe, J. L. (Eds.) (2000). The RET resource book for practitioners. New York: Albert Ellis
Institute.
matic responses or behaviors just because they are In creating a Johari window, the first step is
familiar. They need to examine such accepted ways for the nurse to appraise his or her own qualities by
of responding or behaving and evaluate how they creating a list of them: values, attitudes, feelings,
help or hinder the therapeutic relationship. strengths, behaviors, accomplishments, needs, de-
One tool that is useful in learning more about sires, and thoughts. The second step is to find out
oneself is the Johari window (Luft, 1970), which cre- the perceptions of others by interviewing them and
ates a word portrait of a person in four areas and asking them to identify qualities, both positive and
indicates how well that person knows himself or her- negative, that they see in the nurse. To learn from this
self and communicates with others. The four areas exercise, the opinions given must be honest; there
evaluated are as follows: must be no sanctions taken against those who list
Quadrant 1: Open/public self: qualities one negative qualities. The third step is to compare lists
knows about oneself and others also know and to assign qualities to the appropriate quadrant.
Quadrant 2: Blind/unaware self: qualities If quadrant 1 is the longest list, this indicates
known only to others that the nurse is open to others; a smaller quadrant 1
Quadrant 3: Hidden/private self: qualities means that the nurse shares little about himself or
known only to oneself herself with others. If quadrants 1 and 3 are both
Quadrant 4: Unknown: an empty quadrant small, the person demonstrates little insight. Any
to symbolize qualities as yet undiscovered by change in one quadrant will be reflected by changes
oneself or others in other quadrants. The goal is to work toward moving
96 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
qualities from quadrants 2, 3, and 4 into quadrant 1 Carper (1978) identified four patterns of know-
(qualities known to self and others). Doing so indi- ing in nursing: empirical knowing (derived from
cates that the nurse is gaining self-knowledge and the science of nursing), personal knowing (derived
awareness. See the accompanying figure for an ex- from life experiences), ethical knowing (derived from
ample of a Johari window. moral knowledge of nursing), and aesthetic knowing
(derived from the art of nursing). These patterns
provide the nurse with a clear method of observing
PATTERNS OF KNOWING
and understanding every client interaction. Under-
Nurse theorist Hildegard Peplau (1952) identified standing where knowledge comes from and how it
preconceptions, or ways one person expects another affects behavior helps the nurse become more self-
to behave or speak, as a roadblock to the formation aware (Table 5-1). Munhall (1993) added another
of an authentic relationship. Preconceptions often pattern that she called unknowing: for the nurse to
prevent people from getting to know one another. Pre- admit she does not know the client or the clients sub-
conceptions and different or conflicting personal be- jective world opens the way for a truly authentic en-
liefs and values may prevent the nurse from devel- counter. The nurse in a state of unknowing is open to
oping a therapeutic relationship with a client. Here seeing and hearing the clients views without impos-
is an example of preconceptions that interfere with a ing any of his or her values or viewpoints. In psychi-
therapeutic relationship. Mr. Lopez, a client, has the atric nursing, negative preconceptions on the nurses
preconceived, stereotypical idea that all male nurses part can adversely affect the therapeutic relation-
are homosexual and refuses to have Samuel, a male ship, thus, it is especially important for the nurse to
nurse, take care of him. Samuel has a preconceived, work on developing this openness and acceptance
stereotypical notion that all Hispanics use switch- toward the client.
blades, so he is relieved that Mr. Lopez has refused
to work with him. Both men are missing the oppor-
tunity to do some important work together because
TYPES OF RELATIONSHIPS
of incorrect preconceptions. Each relationship is unique because of the various
combinations of traits and characteristics of and cir-
cumstances related to the people involved. Although
every relationship is different, all relationships may
be categorized into three major types: social, intimate,
and therapeutic.
Table 5-1
CARPERS PATTERNS OF NURSING KNOWLEDGE
Pattern Example
Social Relationship structor, paving the way for a more therapeutic re-
lationship to develop.
A social relationship is primarily initiated for the
purpose of friendship, socialization, companionship,
or accomplishment of a task. Communication, which ESTABLISHING THE
may be superficial, usually focuses on sharing ideas, THERAPEUTIC RELATIONSHIP
feelings, and experiences and meets the basic need The nurse who has self-confidence rooted in self-
for people to interact. Advice is often given. Roles may awareness is ready to establish appropriate thera-
shift during social interactions. Outcomes of this kind peutic relationships with clients. Because personal
of relationship are rarely assessed. When a nurse growth is ongoing over ones lifetime, the nurse can-
greets a client and chats about the weather or a sports not expect to have complete self-knowledge. Aware-
event or engages in small talk or socializing, this is a ness of his or her strengths and limitations at any
social interaction. This is acceptable in nursing, but particular moment, however, is a good start.
for the nurseclient relationship to accomplish the
goals that have been decided on, social interaction
must be limited. If the relationship becomes more Phases
social than therapeutic, serious work that moves the Peplau studied and wrote about the interpersonal
client forward will not be done. processes and the phases of the nurseclient rela-
tionship for 35 years. Her work has provided the
nursing profession with a model that can be used
Intimate Relationship to understand and document progress with inter-
A healthy intimate relationship involves two peo- personal interactions. Peplaus model (1952) has three
ple who are emotionally committed to each other. Both phases: orientation, working, and resolution or termi-
parties are concerned about having their individual nation (Table 5-2). In real life, these phases are not
needs met and helping each other to meet needs as that clear-cut; they overlap and interlock.
well. The relationship may include sexual or emo-
tional intimacy as well as sharing of mutual goals. ORIENTATION
Evaluation of the interaction may be ongoing or not.
The intimate relationship has no place in the nurse The orientation phase begins when the nurse and
client interaction. client meet and ends when the client begins to identify
problems to examine. During the orientation phase,
the nurse establishes roles, the purpose of meeting,
Therapeutic Relationship and the parameters of subsequent meetings; identifies
the clients problems; and clarifies expectations.
The therapeutic relationship differs from the so- Before meeting the client, the nurse has impor-
cial or intimate relationship in many ways because it tant work to do. The nurse reads background materi-
focuses on the needs, experiences, feelings, and ideas als available on the client, becomes familiar with any
of the client only. The nurse and client agree about medications the client is taking, gathers necessary
the areas to work on and evaluate the outcomes. The paperwork, and arranges for a quiet, private, comfort-
nurse uses communication skills, personal strengths, able setting. This is a time for self-assessment. The
and understanding of human behavior to interact nurse should consider his or her personal strengths
with the client. In the therapeutic relationship, the and limitations in working with this client. Are there
parameters are clear: the focus is the clients needs, any areas that might signal difficulty because of past
not the nurses. The nurse should not be concerned experiences? For example, if this client is a spouse
about whether or not the client likes him or her or is batterer and the nurses father was also, the nurse
grateful. Such concern is a signal that the nurse is needs to consider the situation: How does it make him
focusing on a personal need to be liked or needed. The or her feel? What memories does it prompt, and can he
nurse must guard against allowing the therapeutic or she work with the client without these memories
relationship to slip into a more social relationship. interfering? The nurse must examine preconceptions
The nurse must constantly focus on the clients needs, about the client and ensure that he or she can put
not his or her own. them aside and get to know the real person. The nurse
The nurses level of self-awareness can either must come to each client without preconceptions or
benefit or hamper the therapeutic relationship. For prejudices. It may be useful for the nurse to discuss
example, if the nurse is nervous around the client, all potential problem areas with the instructor.
the relationship is more apt to stay social because During the orientation phase, the nurse begins to
superficiality is safer. If the nurse is aware of his or build trust with the client. It is the nurses responsi-
her fears, he or she can discuss them with the in- bility to establish a therapeutic environment that
98 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Table 5-2
PHASES OF THE NURSE CLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Orientation Working Termination
Identification Exploitation
CLIENT
Seeks assistance Participates in identifying Makes full use of services Abandons old needs
Conveys needs problems Identifies new goals Aspires to new goals
Asks questions Begins to be aware of Attempts to attain new Becomes independent of
Shares pre- time goals helping person
conceptions and Responds to help Rapid shifts in behavior: Applies new problem-
expectations of Identifies with nurse dependent, independent solving skills
nurse based on Recognizes nurse as a Exploitative behavior Maintains changes in
past experience person Self-directing style of communication
Explores feelings Develops skill in interper- and interaction
Fluctuates dependence, sonal relationships and Shows positive changes
independence, and inter- problem-solving in view of self
dependence in relation- Displays changes in Integrates illness
ship with nurse manner of communication Exhibits ability to stand
Increases focal attention (more open, flexible) alone
Changes appearance
(for better or worse)
Understands continuity
between sessions
(process and content)
Testing maneuvers
decrease
NURSE
Responds to client Maintains separate Continues assessment Sustains relationship
Gives parameters identity Meets needs as they as long as client feels
of meetings Exhibits ability to edit emerge necessary
Explains roles speech or control focal Understands reason for Promotes family inter-
Gathers data attention shifts in behavior action to assist with goal
Helps client iden- Shows unconditional Initiates rehabilitative plans planning
tify problem acceptance Reduces anxiety Teaches preventive
Helps client plan Helps express needs, Identifies positive factors measures
use of community feelings Helps plan for total needs Uses community
resources and Assesses and adjusts Facilitates forward move- agencies
services to needs ment of personality Teaches self-care
Reduces anxiety Provides information Deals with therapeutic Terminates nurse
and tension Provides experiences impasse client relationship
Practices active that diminish feelings of
listening helplessness
Focuses clients Does not allow anxiety
energies to overwhelm client
Clarifies precon- Helps client focus on cues
ceptions and Helps client develop
expectations of responses to cues
nurse Uses word stimuli
Adapted from Forchuck, C., & Brown, B. (1989). Establishing a nurseclient relationship. Journal of Psycho-
social Nursing, 27(2), 3034.
fosters trust and understanding (Table 5-3). The needs to overcome nervousness and convey feelings
nurse should share appropriate information about of warmth, expertise, and understanding. If the rela-
himself or herself at this time: name, reason for being tionship gets off to a positive start, it is more likely
on the unit, and level of schooling: for example, Hello, to succeed and to meet established goals (Forchuk
James. My name is Miss Ames and I will be your et al., 2000).
nurse for the next 6 Tuesdays. I am a senior nursing At the first meeting, the client may be distrustful
student at the University of Mississippi. if previous relationships with nurses have been un-
The nurse needs to listen closely to the clients satisfactory. The client may use rambling speech, act
history, perceptions, and misconceptions. He or she out, or exaggerate episodes as ploys to avoid discussing
5 THERAPEUTIC RELATIONSHIPS 99
Table 5-3
COMMUNICATION DURING THE PHASES OF THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Phase of
Relationship Sample Conversation Communication Skill
Orientation Nurse: Hello, Mr. OHare. I am Sally Fourth, a nursing Establishing trust; placing bound-
student from Orange County Community College. aries on the relationship and
I will be coming to the hospital for the next 6 Mondays. first mention of termination in
I would like to meet with you each time I am here to 6 weeks
help support you as you work on your treatment
goals.
Orientation Nurse: Mr. OHare, we will meet every Monday from Establishing specifics of the rela-
June 1 to July 15 at 11 AM in conference room #2. We tionship time, date, place, and
can use that time to work on your feelings of loss duration of meetings (can be
since the death of your twin sister. written as a formal contract or
stated as an informal contract)
Orientation Nurse: Mr. OHare, it is important that I tell you I will Establishing confidentiality
be sharing some of what we talk about with my in-
structor, peers, and staff at clinical conference. I will
not be sharing any information with your wife or
children without your permission. If I feel a piece of
information may be helpful, I will ask you first if I
may share it with your wife.
Working Client: Nurse, I miss my sister Eileen so much. Gathering data
Nurse: Mr. OHare, how long have you been without
your sister?
Working Client: Without my twin, I am not half the person I was. Promoting self-esteem
Nurse: Mr. OHare, lets look at the strengths you have.
Working Client: Oh, why talk about me. Im nothing without my Overcoming resistance
twin.
Nurse: Mr. OHare, you are a person in your own
right. I believe working together we can identify
strengths you have. Will you try with me?
Termination Nurse: Well, Mr. OHare, as you know I only have Sharing of the termination experi-
1 week left to meet with you. ence with the client demon-
Client: I am going to miss you. I feel better when you strates the partnership and the
are here. caring of the relationship
Nurse: I will miss you also, Mr. OHare.
(including medications), and protecting the clients Nurses should remember these therapeutic goals
civil rights. The client needs to know the limits of of self-disclosure and use disclosure to help the client
confidentiality in nurseclient interactions and how feel more comfortable and more willing to share
the nurse will use and share this information with thoughts and feelings. Sharing may help the client
professionals involved in client care. gain insight about his or her situation or encourage
him or her to resolve concerns. The nurse should not
Self-Disclosure. Self-disclosure means revealing use self-disclosure to meet personal needs.
personal information such as biographical informa- When using self-disclosure, the nurse must con-
tion and personal ideas, thoughts, and feelings about sider cultural factors. For example, if the client is
oneself to clients (Deering, 1999). Traditionally con- from a culture that is stoic and noncommunicative,
ventional wisdom held that nurses should share only he or she may deem self-disclosure inappropriate.
their name, marital status, and number of children, The nurse should keep self-disclosure brief and com-
and perhaps should give a general idea about their fortable, respect the clients privacy by making sure
residence such as I live in Ocean County. Now, the discussion takes place away from others, and un-
however, it is believed that more self-disclosure can derstand that each experience is different. The nurse
improve rapport between the nurse and client (Deer- must monitor his or her own comfort level. If the
ing, 1999). The nurse can use self-disclosure to convey nurse has unresolved feelings about the issue, he or
support, educate clients, demonstrate that a clients she should not share personal experiences.
anxiety is normal, and even facilitate emotional heal- Disclosing personal information can be harmful
ing (Deering, 1999). and inappropriate for a client, so the nurse must give
5 THERAPEUTIC RELATIONSHIPS 101
it careful thought. For example, when working with dren and discovers that her approach is usually highly
a client whose parents are getting a divorce, the critical and needy. Mrs. OShea begins to realize that
nurse says, My parents got a divorce when I was 12 her behavior contributes to driving her children away.
and it was a horrible time for me. The nurse has With Nurse Jones, she begins to explore how she
shifted the focus away from the client and has given might change her methods of communication.
the client the idea that this experience will be horri- The specific tasks of the working phase include
ble for the client. While the nurse may have meant to the following:
communicate empathy, the result can be quite the Maintaining the relationship
opposite. If the client does not seem ready to deal Gathering more data
with the issue, or the conversation is purely social, it Exploring perceptions of reality
is not a good time to disclose information about one- Developing positive coping mechanisms
self (Hancock, 1998). Promoting a positive self-concept
Encouraging verbalization of feelings
Facilitating behavior change
WORKING
Working through resistance
The working phase of the nurseclient relation- Evaluating progress and redefining goals as
ship is usually divided into two subphases. During appropriate
problem identification, the client identifies the Providing opportunities for the client to prac-
issues or concerns causing problems. During ex- tice new behaviors
ploitation, the nurse guides the client to examine Promoting independence
feelings and responses and to develop better coping As the nurse and client work together, it is com-
skills and a more positive self-image; this encour- mon for the client unconsciously to transfer to the
ages behavior change and develops independence. nurse feelings he or she has for significant others.
(Note that Peplaus use of the word exploitation had This is called transference. For example, if the client
a very different meaning than current usage, which has had negative experiences with authority figures,
involves unfairly using or taking advantage of a per- such as a parent or teachers or principals, he or she
son or situation. For that reason, this phase is better may display similar reactions of negativity and resis-
conceptualized as intense exploration and elabora- tance to the nurse, who also is viewed as an authority.
tion on earlier themes that the client discussed.) The A similar process can occur when the nurse responds
trust established between nurse and client at this to the client based on personal unconscious needs
point allows them to examine the problems and to and conflicts; this is called countertransference.
work on them within the security of the relationship. For example, if the nurse is the youngest in her fam-
The client must believe that the nurse will not turn ily and often felt as if no one listened to her when she
away or be upset when the client reveals experiences, was a child, she may respond with anger to a client
issues, behaviors, and problems. Sometimes the client who does not listen or resists her help. Again, self-
will use outrageous stories or acting-out behaviors to awareness is important so that the nurse can identify
test the nurse. Testing behavior challenges the nurse when transference and countertransference might
to stay focused and not to react or be distracted. occur. By being aware of such hot spots, the nurse
Often when the client becomes uncomfortable because has a better chance of responding appropriately rather
they are getting too close to the truth, he or she will than letting old unresolved conflicts interfere with the
use testing behaviors to avoid the subject. The nurse relationship.
may respond by saying, It seems as if we have hit an
uncomfortable spot for you. Would you like to let it go
TERMINATION
for now? This statement focuses on the issue at hand
and diverts attention from the testing behavior. The termination phase, also known as the resolu-
The nurse must remember that it is the client tion phase, is the final stage in the nurseclient re-
who examines and explores problem situations and re- lationship. It begins when the problems are resolved,
lationships. The nurse must be nonjudgmental and re- and it ends when the relationship is ended. Both nurse
frain from giving advice; the nurse should allow the and client usually have feelings about ending the
client to analyze situations. The nurse can guide the relationship; the client especially may feel the ter-
client to observe patterns of behavior and whether or mination as an impending loss. Often clients try to
not the expected response occurs. For example, Mrs. avoid termination by acting angry or as if the prob-
OShea suffers from depression. She continues to lem has not been resolved. The nurse can acknowl-
complain to the nurse about the lack of concern her edge the clients angry feelings and assure the client
children show her. With Nurse Jones assistance, Mrs. that this response is normal to ending a relationship.
OShea explores how she communicates with her chil- If the client tries to reopen and discuss old resolved
102 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
issues, the nurse must avoid feeling as if the sessions of ethical conduct. Nurses must continually assess
were unsuccessful; instead, he or she should identify themselves and ensure that they keep their feelings
the clients stalling maneuvers and refocus the client in check and focus on the clients interests and needs.
on newly learned behaviors and skills to handle the Nurses can assess their behavior by using the Nurs-
problem. It is appropriate to tell the client that the ing Boundary Index in Table 5-4. A full discussion of
nurse enjoyed the time spent with the client and will ethical dilemmas encountered in relationships is
remember him or her, but it is inappropriate for the found in Chapter 9.
nurse to agree to see the client outside the therapeu-
tic relationship.
Nurse Jones comes to see Mrs. OShea for the Feelings of Sympathy and
last time. Mrs. OShea is weeping quietly. Encouraging Client Dependency
Mrs. OShea: Oh, Ms. Jones, you have been so The nurse must not let feelings of empathy turn into
helpful to me. I just know I will go back to my old self sympathy for the client. Unlike the therapeutic use
without you here to help me. of empathy, the nurse who feels sorry for the client
Nurse Jones: Mrs. OShea, I think weve had a often tries to compensate by trying to please him or
very productive time together. You have learned so her. When the nurses behavior is rooted in sym-
many new ways to have a better relationship with pathy, the client finds it easier to manipulate the
your children, and I know you will go home and be nurses feelings. This discourages the client from
able to use those skills. When you come back for your exploring his or her problems, thoughts, and feelings;
follow-up visit, I will want to hear all about how discourages client growth; and often leads to client
things have changed at home. dependency.
The client may make increased requests of the
AVOIDING BEHAVIORS THAT nurse for help and assistance or may regress and act
DIMINISH THE THERAPEUTIC as if he or she cannot carry out tasks previously done.
RELATIONSHIP These can be signals that the nurse has been over-
doing for the client and may be contributing to the
The nurse has power over the client by virtue of his clients dependency. Clients often test the nurse to
or her professional role. That power can be abused if
see how much the nurse is willing to do. If the client
excessive familiarity or an intimate relationship oc-
cooperates only when the nurse is in attendance and
curs or if confidentiality is breached.
will not carry out agreed-on behavior in the nurses
absence, the client has become too dependent. In any
Inappropriate Boundaries of these instances, the nurse needs to reassess his or
her professional behavior and refocus on the clients
All staff, both new and veteran, is at risk for allowing
needs and therapeutic goals.
a therapeutic relationship to expand into an inappro-
priate relationship. Self-awareness is extremely im-
portant: the nurse who is in touch with his or her feel- Nonacceptance and Avoidance
ings and aware of his or her influence over others can
help maintain the boundaries of the professional re- The nurseclient relationship can be jeopardized if
lationship. The nurse must maintain professional the nurse finds the clients behavior unacceptable
boundaries to ensure the best therapeutic outcomes. or distasteful and allows those feelings to show by
It is the nurses responsibility to define the bound- avoiding the client or making verbal responses or
aries of the relationship clearly in the orientation facial expressions of annoyance or turning away from
phase and to ensure that those boundaries are main- the client. The nurse should be aware of the clients
tained throughout the relationship. The nurse must behavior and background before beginning the rela-
act warmly and empathetically but must not try to be tionship; if the nurse thinks that there may be any
friends with the client. Social interactions that con- conflict, he or she must explore these with a colleague.
tinue beyond the first few minutes of a meeting con- If the nurse is aware of a prejudice that would place
tribute to the conversation staying on the surface. the client in an unfavorable light, he or she must
This lack of focus on the problems that have been explore such issues. Sometimes by talking about
agreed on for discussion erodes the professional rela- and confronting these feelings, the nurse can accept
tionship. the client and not let a prejudice hinder the rela-
If a client is attracted to a nurse or vice versa, it tionship. If the nurse cannot resolve such negative
is up to the nurse to maintain professional bound- feelings, however, he or she should consider request-
aries. Accepting gifts or giving a client ones home ad- ing another assignment. It is the nurses responsi-
dress or phone number would be considered a breach bility to treat each client with acceptance and posi-
5 THERAPEUTIC RELATIONSHIPS 103
Table 5-4
NURSING BOUNDARY INDEX
Please rate yourself according to the frequency that the following statements reflect your behavior, thoughts, or
feelings within the past 2 years while providing patient care.
1. Have you ever received any feedback about your behavior Never Rarely Sometimes Often
for being overly intrusive with patients or their families?
2. Do you ever have difficulty setting limits with patients? Never Rarely Sometimes Often
3. Do you arrive early or stay late to be with your patient Never Rarely Sometimes Often
for a longer period of time?
4. Do you ever find yourself relating to patients or peers as Never Rarely Sometimes Often
you might a family member?
5. Have you ever acted on sexual feelings you have for a Never Rarely Sometimes Often
patient?
6. Do you feel that you are the only one who understands Never Rarely Sometimes Often
the patient?
7. Have you ever received feedback that you get too Never Rarely Sometimes Often
involved with patients or families?
8. Do you derive conscious satisfaction from patients Never Rarely Sometimes Often
praise, appreciation, or affection?
9. Do you ever feel that other staff members are too critical Never Rarely Sometimes Often
of your patient?
10. Do you ever feel that other staff members are jealous of Never Rarely Sometimes Often
your relationship with a patient?
11. Have you ever tried to match-make a patient with one Never Rarely Sometimes Often
of your friends?
12. Do you find it difficult to handle patients unreasonable Never Rarely Sometimes Often
requests for assistance, verbal abuse, or sexual language?
Any item that is responded to with a sometimes or often should alert the nurse to a possible area of vulnera-
bility. If the item is responded to with a rarely, the nurse should determine if it was an isolated event or a possi-
ble pattern of behavior.
Pilette, P., Berck, C., & Achber, L. (1995). Therapeutic management. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing, 33(1), 45.
tive regard, regardless of the clients history. Part of or she has and must know the limitations of that
the nurses responsibility is to continue to become knowledge base. The nurse should be familiar with
more self-aware and to confront and resolve any prej- the resources in the health care setting and commu-
udices that threaten to hinder the nurseclient re- nity and on the Internet, which can provide needed
lationship (Box 5-4). information for clients. The nurse must be honest
about what information he or she can provide and
when and where to refer clients for further informa-
ROLES OF THE NURSE IN A tion. This behavior and honesty build trust in clients.
THERAPEUTIC RELATIONSHIP
As when working with clients in any other nursing
Caregiver
setting, the psychiatric nurse uses various roles to
provide needed care to the client. The nurse under- The primary caregiving role in mental health set-
stands the importance of assuming the appropriate tings is the implementation of the therapeutic rela-
role for the work that he or she is doing with the tionship to build trust, explore feelings, assist the
client. client in problem solving, and help the client meet
psychosocial needs. If the client also requires physi-
cal nursing care, the nurse may need to explain to the
Teacher client the need for touch while performing physical
The teacher role is inherent in most aspects of client care. Some clients may confuse physical care with in-
care. During the working phase of the nurseclient timacy and sexual interest, which can erode the ther-
relationship, the nurse may teach the client new apeutic relationship. The nurse must consider the
methods of coping and solving problems. He or she boundaries and parameters of the relationship that
may instruct about the medication regimen and have been established and must repeat the goals that
available community resources. To be a good teacher, were established together at the beginning of the
the nurse must feel confident about the knowledge he relationship.
104 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Box 5-4
POSSIBLE WARNINGS OR SIGNALS OF ABUSE OF THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Secrets, reluctance to talk about the work being done with clients
Sudden increase in phone calls between nurse and client or calls outside clinical hours
Nurse making more exceptions for client than normal
Inappropriate gift-giving between client and nurse
Loaning, trading, or selling goods or possessions
Nurse disclosure of personal issues or information
Inappropriate touching, comforting, or physical contact
Overdoing, overprotecting, or over-identifying with client
Change in nurses body language, dress, or appearance (with no other satisfactory explanation)
Extended one-on-one sessions or home visits
Adapted from Walker, R., & Clark, J. J. (1999). Heading off boundary problems: clinical supervision as Risk Management. Psychi-
atric Services, 50(11), 14351439.
limits. By retaining an open, easygoing, nonjudgmen- tends to lose the objectivity that comes with self-
tal attitude, the nurse can continue to nurture the awareness and personal growth activities. In the end,
client while establishing boundaries. The nurse must nurses who fail to take good care of themselves also
ensure that the relationship remains therapeutic and cannot take good care of clients and families.
does not become social or intimate (Box 5-5).
Points to Consider about Building
SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES Therapeutic Relationships
Self-awareness is crucial in establishing Attend workshops about values clarification,
therapeutic nurseclient relationships. For example, beliefs, and attitudes to help you assess and
a nurse who is prejudiced against people from a cer- learn about yourself.
tain culture or religion but is not consciously aware of Keep a journal of thoughts, feelings, and
it may have difficulty relating to a client from that lessons learned to provide self-insight.
culture or religion. If the nurse is aware of, acknowl- Listen to feedback from colleagues about
edges, and is open to reassessing the prejudice, the your relationships with clients.
relationship has a better chance of being authentic. If Participate in group discussions on self-
the nurse has certain beliefs and attitudes that he growth at the local library or health center to
or she will not change, it may be best for another nurse aid self-understanding.
to care for the client. Examining personal strengths Develop a continually changing care plan for
and weaknesses helps one gain a strong sense of self. self-growth.
Understanding oneself helps one understand and ac- Read books on topics that support the
cept others who may have different ideas and values. strengths you have identified and help to
The nurse must continue on a path of self-discovery develop your areas of weakness.
to become more self-aware and more effective in car-
ing for clients.
Nurses also need to learn to care for themselves.
KEY POINTS
This means balancing work with leisure time, build- Factors that enhance the nurseclient rela-
ing satisfying personal relationships with friends, and tionship include trust and congruence, gen-
taking time to relax and pamper oneself. Nurses who uine interest, empathy, acceptance, and
are overly committed to work become burned out, positive regard.
never find time to relax or see friends, and sacrifice Self-awareness is crucial in the therapeutic
their own personal lives in the process. When this relationship. The nurses values, beliefs, and
happens, the nurse is more prone to boundary viola- attitudes all come into play as he or she
tions with clients (e.g., sharing frustrations, respond- forms a relationship with a client.
ing to the clients personal interest in the nurse). In Carper identified four patterns of knowing:
addition, the nurse who is stressed or overwhelmed empirical, aesthetic, personal, and ethical.
Box 5-5
METHODS TO AVOID INAPPROPRIATE RELATIONSHIPS BETWEEN NURSES AND CLIENTS
Realize that all staff members, whether male or female, junior or senior, or from any discipline, are at risk of
over-involvement and loss of boundaries.
Assume that boundary violations will occur. Supervisors should recognize potential problem clients and
regularly raise the issue of sexual feelings or boundary loss with staff members.
Provide opportunities for staff members to discuss their dilemmas and effective ways of dealing with them.
Develop orientation programs to include how to set limits, how to recognize clues that the relationship is
losing boundaries, what the institution expects of the professional, a clear understanding of consequences,
case studies, developing skills for maintaining boundaries, and recommended reading.
Provide resources for confidential and nonjudgmental assistance.
Hold regular meetings to discuss inappropriate relationships and feelings toward clients.
Provide senior staff to lead groups and model effective therapeutic interventions with difficult clients.
Use clinical vignettes for training.
Use situations that reflect not only sexual dilemmas but also other boundary violations including problems
with abuse of authority and power.
106 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
Munhall established the pattern of unknow- change, working through resistance, evalu-
ing as an openness that the nurse brings to ating progress and redefining goals as ap-
the relationship that prevents preconceptions propriate, providing opportunities for the
from clouding his or her view of the client. client to practice new behaviors, and pro-
The three types of relationships are social, moting independence.
intimate, and therapeutic. The nurseclient Termination begins when the problems are
relationship should be therapeutic, not social resolved and ends with the termination of
or intimate. the relationship.
Nurse theorist Hildegard Peplau developed Factors that diminish the nurseclient rela-
the phases of the nurseclient relationship: tionship include loss of or unclear bound-
orientation, working (with subphases of aries, intimacy, and abuse of power.
problem identification and exploitation), and Therapeutic roles of the nurse in the
termination or resolution. These phases are nurseclient relationship include teacher,
ongoing and overlapping.
caregiver, advocate, and parent surrogate.
The orientation phase begins when the nurse
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com.
and client meet and ends when the client be-
gins to identify problems to examine.
Tasks of the working phase include main-
taining the relationship, gathering more REFERENCES
data, exploring perceptions of reality, devel-
oping positive coping mechanisms, promot- Carper, B. (1978). Fundamental patterns of knowing in
ing a positive self-concept, encouraging ver- nursing. Advances in Nursing Science, 1323.
Deering, C. G. (1999). To speak or not to speak? Self-
balization of feelings that facilitate behavior
disclosure with patients. American Journal of
Nursing, 99(1), 3439.
Critical Thinking Questions Forchuk, C., Westwell, J., Martin, M., Bamber-Azzapardi,
W., Kosterewa-Tolman, D., & Hux, M. (2000). The
developing nurse-client relationship: Nurses per-
1. When is it appropriate to accept a gift from a spectives. Journal of the American Psychiatric
client? What types of gifts are acceptable? Nurses Association, 6(1), 310.
Under what circumstances should the nurse Hancock, C. (1998). How to decide about self-disclosure.
accept a gift from a client? Nursing, 98(3), 1213.
2. What relationship-building behaviors would Hewitt, J. (2002). A critical review of the arguments
debating the role of the nurse advocate. Journal of
the nurse use with a client who is very dis-
Advanced Nursing, 37(5), 439445.
trustful of the health care system? Hyland, D. (2002). An exploration of the relationship be-
3. What preconceptions do you have about mental tween patient autonomy and patient advocacy: Impli-
health clients? cations for nursing practice. Nursing Ethics, 9(5),
472482.
5 THERAPEUTIC RELATIONSHIPS 107
Kohnke, M. F. (1982). Advocacy: What is it? Nursing and Psychiatric and Mental Health Nursing, 6(5),
Health Care, 3(6), 314318. 363370.
Kunyk, D., & Olson, J. K. (2001). Clarification of concep-
tualizations of empathy. Journal of Advanced Nurs-
ing, 35(3), 317325. ADDITIONAL READINGS
Luft, J. (1970). Group processes: An introduction in group
dynamics. Palo Alto, CA: National Press Books. Beeber, L. S. (2000). Hildahood: Taking the interpersonal
theory of nursing to the neighborhood. Journal of the
Mohr, W. K., & Horton-Deutsch, S. (2001). Malfeasance
American Psychiatric Nurses Association, 6(2), 4955.
and regaining nursings moral voice and integrity.
Hanson, B., & Taylor, M. F. (2000). Being-with, doing-
Nursing Ethics, 8(1), 1935. with: A model of the nurse-client relationship in
Munhall, P. (1993). Unknowing: Toward another pattern mental health nursing. Journal of Psychiatric and
of knowing in nursing. Nursing Outlook, 41(3), Mental Health Nursing, 7, 417423.
125128. Mead, N., & Bower, P. (2000). Patient-centredness:
Peplau, H. E. (1952). Interpersonal relations in nursing. A conceptual framework and review of the empiri-
New York: J. P. Putnams Sons. cal literature. Social Science & Medicine, 51,
Peternilji-Taylor, C. (1998). Forbidden love: Sexual ex- 10871110.
ploitation in the forensic milieu. Journal of Psycho- OBrien, L. (2000). Nurse-client relationships: The expe-
social Nursing, 36(6), 1723. rience of community psychiatric nurses. Australian
Reynolds, W. J., & Scott, B. (1999). Empathy: A crucial and New Zealand Journal of Mental Health Nurs-
component of the helping relationship. Journal of ing, 9, 184194.
Chapter
ChapterStudy
Review
Guide
MULTIPLE-CHOICE QUESTIONS
Select the best answer for each of the following
questions.
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify the pattern of knowing as described by Carper.
108
5 THERAPEUTIC RELATIONSHIPS 109
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
1. Give a dialogue example of each of the following:
Congruence
Positive regard
Acceptance
109
2. For each of the following client statements, write a response the nurse
might make and the rationale for each.
Client: I thought you said you were going to be here for 8 weeks, not 6!
CLINICAL EXAMPLE
Mr. V., 56 years of age, emigrated to the United States 25 years ago. He has
seen many groups of student nurses come and go on his unit. He looks over the
newest group and points at one nurse. Ill take the cute little thing over there,
he announces to the instructor and students. He sidles up to the chosen stu-
dent and puts his arm around her. You are the nurse he has chosen. Create a
dialogue that indicates an orientation phase with evidence of trust-building
and relationship-enhancing behaviors for working with this client.
110
6 Therapeutic
Communication
Learning Objectives
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
111
112 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Communication is the process that people use to guage invalidates the words (incongruent message).
exchange information. Messages are simultaneously The message conveyed is Im apologizing because
sent and received on two levels: verbally through I think I have to. Im not really sorry.
the use of words and nonverbally by behaviors that
accompany the words (Balzer Riley, 2000).
WHAT IS THERAPEUTIC
Verbal communication consists of the words a
COMMUNICATION?
person uses to speak to one or more listeners. Words
are symbols used to identify the objects and concepts Therapeutic communication is an interpersonal
being discussed. Placement of words into phrases and interaction between the nurse and client during which
sentences that are understandable to both speaker the nurse focuses on the clients specific needs to pro-
and listener gives an order and a meaning to these mote an effective exchange of information. Skilled use
symbols. Content is verbal communication, the lit- of therapeutic communication techniques helps the
eral words that a person speaks. Context is the envi- nurse understand and empathize with the clients ex-
ronment in which communication occurs and can perience. All nurses need skills in therapeutic com-
include the time and the physical, social, emotional, munication to effectively apply the nursing process
and cultural environment (Weaver, 1996). Context and to meet standards of care for their clients.
includes the circumstances or parts that clarify the Therapeutic communication can help nurses to
meaning of the content of the message. It is discussed accomplish many goals:
in more detail throughout this chapter. Establish a therapeutic nurseclient
Nonverbal communication is the behavior that relationship.
accompanies verbal content such as body language, Identify the most important client concern at
eye contact, facial expression, tone of voice, speed and that moment (the client-centered goal).
hesitations in speech, grunts and groans, and distance Assess the clients perception of the problem
from the listener. Nonverbal communication can indi- as it unfolded. This includes detailed actions
cate the speakers thoughts, feelings, needs, and values (behaviors and messages) of the people
that the speaker acts out mostly unconsciously. involved and the clients thoughts and feelings
Process denotes all nonverbal messages that about the situation, others, and self.
the speaker uses to give meaning and context to the Facilitate the clients expression of emotions.
message. The process component of communication Teach the client and family necessary self-
requires the listener to observe the behaviors and care skills.
sounds that accent the words and to interpret the Recognize the clients needs.
speakers nonverbal behaviors to assess whether they Implement interventions designed to address
agree or disagree with the verbal content. A congru- the clients needs.
ent message is when content and process agree. For Guide the client toward identifying a plan of
example, a client says, I know I havent been myself. action to a satisfying and socially acceptable
I need help. She has a sad facial expression and a resolution.
genuine and sincere voice tone. The process validates Establishing a therapeutic relationship is one of
the content as being true. But when the content and the most important responsibilities of the nurse when
process disagreewhen what the speaker says and working with clients. Communication is the means by
what he or she does do not agreethe speaker is giv- which a therapeutic relationship is initiated, main-
ing an incongruent message. For example, if the tained, and terminated. The therapeutic relationship
client says, Im here to get help but has a rigid pos- is discussed in depth in Chapter 5 including confiden-
ture, clenched fists, an agitated and frowning facial tiality, self-disclosure, and therapeutic use of self. To
expression, and snarls the words through clenched have effective therapeutic communication, the nurse
teeth, the message is incongruent. The process or ob- also must consider privacy and respect of boundaries,
served behavior invalidates what the speaker says use of touch, and active listening and observation.
(content).
Nonverbal process represents a more accurate
message than does verbal content. Im sorry I yelled
Privacy and Respecting Boundaries
and screamed at you is readily believable when the Privacy is desirable but not always possible in ther-
speaker has a slumped posture, a resigned voice tone, apeutic communication. An interview or conference
downcast eyes, and a shameful facial expression, room is optimal if the nurse believes this setting is not
because the content and process are congruent. The too isolative for the interaction. The nurse also can
same sentence said in a loud voice tone and with talk with the client at the end of the hall or in a quiet
raised eyebrows, a piercing gaze, an insulted facial corner of the day room or lobby, depending on the phys-
expression, hands on hips, and outraged body lan- ical layout of the setting. The nurse needs to evaluate
6 THERAPEUTIC COMMUNICATION 113
if interacting in the clients room is therapeutic. For ually, depending on how often the client has invaded
example, if the client has difficulty maintaining bound- the nurses space and the safety of the situation.
aries or has been making sexual comments, then the
clients room is not the best setting. A more formal set-
Touch
ting would be desirable.
Proxemics is the study of distance zones between As intimacy increases, the need for distance decreases.
people during communication. People feel more com- Knapp (1980) identified five types of touch:
fortable with smaller distances when communicating Functional-professional touch is used in
with someone they know rather than with strangers examinations or procedures such as when
(Northouse & Northouse, 1998). People from the Uni- the nurse touches a client to assess skin
ted States, Canada, and many Eastern European turgor or a masseuse performs a massage.
nations generally observe four distance zones: Social-polite touch is used in greeting, such
Intimate zone (0 to 18 inches between as a handshake and the air kisses some
people): This amount of space is comfortable women use to greet acquaintances, or when
for parents with young children, people who a gentle hand guides someone in the correct
mutually desire personal contact, or people direction.
whispering. Invasion of this intimate zone Friendship-warmth touch involves a hug in
by anyone else is threatening and produces greeting, an arm thrown around the shoulder
anxiety. of a good friend, or the back slapping some
Personal zone (18 to 36 inches): This dis- men use to greet friends and relatives.
tance is comfortable between family and Love-intimacy touch involves tight hugs and
friends who are talking. kisses between lovers or close relatives.
Social zone (4 to 12 feet): This distance is Sexual-arousal touch is used by lovers.
acceptable for communication in social, work, Touching a client can be comforting and sup-
and business settings. portive when it is welcome and permitted. The nurse
Public zone (12 to 25 feet): This is an should observe the client for cues that show if touch is
acceptable distance between a speaker and desired or indicated. For example, holding the hand
an audience, small groups, and other of a sobbing mother whose child is ill is appropriate
informal functions (Hall, 1963). and therapeutic. If the mother pulls her hand away,
People from some cultures (e.g., Hispanic, however, she signals to the nurse that she feels un-
Mediterranean, East Indian, Asian, Middle Eastern) comfortable being touched. The nurse also can ask
are more comfortable with less than 4 to 12 feet of the client about touching (e.g., Would it help you to
space between them while talking. The nurse of squeeze my hand?).
European-American or African-American heritage Although touch can be comforting and therapeu-
may feel uncomfortable if clients from these cultures tic, it is an invasion of intimate and personal space.
stand close when talking. Conversely, clients from Some clients with mental illness have difficulty under-
these backgrounds may perceive the nurse as remote standing the concept of personal boundaries or know-
and indifferent (Andrews & Boyle, 2003). ing when touch is or is not appropriate. Consequently
Both the client and the nurse can feel threatened most psychiatric inpatient, outpatient, and ambula-
if one invades the others personal or intimate zone, tory care units have policies against clients touching
which can result in tension, irritability, fidgeting, or one another or staff. Unless they need to get close to a
even flight. When the nurse must invade the inti- client to perform some nursing care, staff members
mate or personal zone, he or she always should ask should serve as role models and refrain from invading
the clients permission. For example, if a nurse per- clients personal and intimate space. When a staff
forming an assessment in a community setting needs member is going to touch a client while performing
to take the clients blood pressure, he or she should nursing care, he or she must verbally prepare the
say, Mr. Smith, to take your blood pressure I will client before starting the procedure. A client with
wrap this cuff around your arm and listen with my paranoia may interpret being touched as a threat and
stethoscope. Is this acceptable to you? He or she may attempt to protect himself or herself by striking
should ask permission in a yes/no format so the clients the staff person.
response is clear. This is one of the times when yes/
no questions are appropriate.
The therapeutic communication interaction is
Active Listening and Observation
most comfortable when the nurse and client are 3 to To receive the senders simultaneous messages, the
6 feet apart. If a client invades the nurses intimate nurse must use active listening and active observa-
space (0 to 18 inches), the nurse should set limits grad- tion. Active listening means refraining from other
114 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
internal mental activities and concentrating exclu- detailed descriptions of that behavior. The nurse also
sively on what the client says. Active observation documents these details. To help the client develop
means watching the speakers nonverbal actions as insight into his or her interpersonal skills, the nurse
he or she communicates. analyzes the information obtained, determines the
Peplau (1952) used observation as the first step underlying needs that relate to the behavior, and
in the therapeutic interaction. The nurse observes connects pieces of information (makes links between
the clients behavior and guides him or her in giving various sections of the conversation).
A common misconception by students learning
the art of therapeutic communication is that they
always must be ready with questions the instant the
client has finished speaking. Hence, they are con-
stantly thinking ahead regarding the next question
rather than actively listening to what the client is say-
ing. The result can be that the nurse does not under-
stand the clients concerns, and the conversation is
vague, superficial, and frustrating to both partici-
pants. When a superficial conversation occurs, the
nurse may complain that the client is not cooperat-
ing, is repeating things, or is not taking responsibil-
ity for getting better. Superficiality, however, can
be the result of the nurses failure to listen to cues in
the clients responses and repeatedly asking the same
question. The nurse does not get details and works
from his or her assumptions rather than from the
clients true situation.
While listening to a clients story, it is almost
impossible for the nurse not to make assumptions.
A persons life experiences, knowledge base, values,
and prejudices often color the interpretation of a mes-
sage. In therapeutic communication, the nurse must
ask specific questions to get the entire story from the
Four types of touch. AFunctionalprofessional touch; clients perspective, to clarify assumptions, and to de-
BSocialpolite touch; CFriendshipwarmth touch; velop empathy with the client. Empathy is the abil-
DLoveintimacy touch. ity to place oneself into the experience of another for
6 THERAPEUTIC COMMUNICATION 115
a moment in time. Nurses develop empathy by gath- The following are examples of concrete and ab-
ering as much information about an issue as possible stract messages:
directly from the client to avoid interjecting their per- Abstract (unclear): Get the stuff from him.
sonal experiences and interpretations of the situa- Concrete (clear): John will be home today at 5 pm,
tion. The nurse asks as many questions as needed to and you can pick up your clothes at that time.
gain a clear understanding of the clients perceptions Abstract (unclear): Your clinical performance
of an event or issue. has to improve.
Active listening and observation help the nurse to Concrete (clear): To administer medications
Recognize the issue that is most important to tomorrow, youll have to be able to calculate dosages
the client at this time. correctly by the end of todays class.
Know what further questions to ask the
client.
Using Therapeutic
Use additional therapeutic communication
Communication Techniques
techniques to guide the client to describe his
or her perceptions fully. The nurse can use many therapeutic communication
Understand the clients perceptions of the techniques to interact with clients. The choice of tech-
issue instead of jumping to conclusions. nique depends on the intent of the interaction and the
Interpret and respond to the message clients ability to communicate verbally. Overall the
objectively. nurse selects techniques that will facilitate the inter-
action and enhance communication between client and
VERBAL COMMUNICATION SKILLS nurse. Table 6-1 lists these techniques and gives ex-
amples. Techniques such as exploring, focusing, re-
Using Concrete Messages stating, and reflecting encourage the client to discuss
The nurse should use words that are as clear as pos- his or her feelings or concerns in more depth.
sible when speaking to the client so that the client can In contrast, there are many nontherapeutic tech-
understand the message. Anxious people lose cogni- niques that nurses should avoid (Table 6-2). These re-
tive processing skillsthe higher the anxiety, the sponses cut off communication and make it more dif-
less ability to process conceptsso concrete mes- ficult for the interaction to continue. Many of these
sages are important for accurate information ex- responses are common in social interaction such as
change. In a concrete message, the words are explicit advising, agreeing, or reassuring. Therefore it takes
and need no interpretation; the speaker uses nouns practice for the nurse to avoid making these typical
instead of pronounsfor example, What health symp- comments.
toms caused you to come to the hospital today? or
When was the last time you took your antidepres-
Interpreting Signals or Cues
sant medications? Concrete questions are clear, di-
rect, and easy to understand. They elicit more accurate To understand what a client means, the nurse watches
responses and avoid the need to go back and rephrase and listens carefully for cues. Cues are verbal or non-
unclear questions, which interrupts the flow of a ther- verbal messages that signal key words or issues for the
apeutic interaction. client. Finding cues is a function of active listening.
Abstract messages, in contrast, are unclear pat- Cues can be buried in what a client says or can be acted
terns of words that often contain figures of speech that out in the process of communication. Often cue words
are difficult to interpret. They require the listener to introduced by the client can help the nurse to know
interpret what the speaker is asking. For example, a what to ask next or how to respond to the client. The
nurse who wants to know why a client was admitted nurse builds his or her responses on these cue words or
to the unit asks, How did you get here? This is an ab- concepts. Understanding this can relieve pressure on
stract message: the terms how and here are vague. students who are worried and anxious about what
An anxious client might not be aware of where he or question to ask next. The following example illustrates
she is and reply, Where am I? or might interpret this questions the nurse might ask when responding to a
as a question about how he or she was conveyed to the clients cue:
hospital and respond, The ambulance brought me. Client: I had a boyfriend when I was younger.
Clients who are anxious, from different cultures, cog- Nurse: You had a boyfriend? (reflecting)
nitively impaired, or suffering from some mental dis- Tell me about you and your boyfriend. (encour-
orders often function at a concrete level of comprehen- aging description)
sion and have difficulty answering abstract questions. How old were you when you had this boyfriend?
The nurse must be sure that statements and questions (placing events in time or sequence)
are clear and concrete. (text continues on page 120)
116 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Table 6-1
THERAPEUTIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUES
Therapeutic
Communication Technique Examples Rationale
(continued )
6 THERAPEUTIC COMMUNICATION 117
Table 6-1
(Continued )
Therapeutic
Communication Technique Examples Rationale
Giving information My name is . . . Informing the client of facts increases his or her
making available the facts Visiting hours are . . . knowledge about a topic or lets the client know
that the client needs My purpose in being what to expect. The nurse is functioning as a
here is . . . resource person. Giving information also
builds trust with the client.
Giving recognition Good morning, Mr. S . . . Greeting the client by name, indicating aware-
acknowledging, indicating Youve finished your list of ness of change, or noting efforts the client has
awareness things to do. made all show that the nurse recognizes the
I notice that youve client as a person, as an individual. Such
combed your hair. recognition does not carry the notion of value,
that is, of being good or bad.
Making observations You appear tense. Sometimes clients cannot verbalize or make
verbalizing what the Are you uncomfortable themselves understood. Or the client may not
nurse perceives when . . . ? be ready to talk.
I notice that youre biting
your lip.
Offering selfmaking Ill sit with you awhile. The nurse can offer his or her presence, interest,
oneself available Ill stay here with you. and desire to understand. It is important that
Im interested in what this offer is unconditional, that is, the client
you think. does not have to respond verbally to get the
nurses attention.
Placing event in time or What seemed to lead Putting events in proper sequence helps both the
sequenceclarifying the up to . . . ? nurse and client to see them in perspective.
relationship of events Was this before or The client may gain insight into cause-and-
in time after . . . ? effect behavior and consequences, or the client
When did this happen? may be able to see that perhaps some things
are not related. The nurse may gain information
about recurrent patterns or themes in the clients
behavior or relationships.
Presenting realityoffering I see no one else in the When it is obvious that the client is misinterpreting
for consideration that room. reality, the nurse can indicate what is real. The
which is real That sound was a car nurse does this by calmly and quietly expressing
backfiring. the nurses perceptions or the facts not by way
Your mother is not here; of arguing with the client or belittling his or her
I am a nurse. experience. The intent is to indicate an alter-
native line of thought for the client to consider, not
to convince the client that he or she is wrong.
Reflectingdirecting client Client: Do you think Reflection encourages the client to recognize
actions, thoughts, and I should tell the and accept his or her own feelings. The nurse
feelings back to client doctor . . . ? Nurse: Do indicates that the clients point of view has
you think you should? value, and that the client has the right to
Client: My brother spends have opinions, make decisions, and think
all my money and then independently.
has nerve to ask for more.
Nurse: This causes you to
feel angry?
Restatingrepeating the Client: I cant sleep. The nurse repeats what the client has said in
main idea expressed I stay awake all night. approximately or nearly the same words the
Nurse: You have client has used. This restatement lets the client
difficulty sleeping. know that he or she communicated the idea
Client: Im really mad, effectively. This encourages the client to con-
Im really upset. tinue. Or if the client has been misunderstood,
Nurse: Youre really mad he or she can clarify his or her thoughts.
and upset.
Seeking information Im not sure that I follow. The nurse should seek clarification throughout
seeking to make clear that Have I heard you interactions with clients. Doing so can help the
which is not meaningful correctly? nurse to avoid making assumptions that under-
or that which is vague standing has occurred when it has not. It helps
the client to articulate thoughts, feelings, and
ideas more clearly.
(continued )
118 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Table 6-1
(Continued )
Therapeutic
Communication Technique Examples Rationale
Silenceabsence of verbal Nurse says nothing but Silence often encourages the client to verbalize,
communication, which continues to maintain eye provided that it is interested and expectant.
provides time for the contact and conveys Silence gives the client time to organize
client to put thoughts or interest. thoughts, direct the topic of interaction, or
feelings into words, focus on issues that are most important.
regain composure, or Much nonverbal behavior takes place during
continue talking silence, and the nurse needs to be aware of
the client and his or her own nonverbal
behavior.
Suggesting collaboration Perhaps you and I can The nurse seeks to offer a relationship in which
offering to share, to strive, discuss and discover the the client can identify problems in living with
to work with the client for triggers for your anxiety. others, grow emotionally, and improve the
his or her benefit Lets go to your room, and ability to form satisfactory relationships. The
Ill help you find what nurse offers to do things with, rather than for,
your looking for. the client.
Summarizingorganizing Have I got this straight? Summarization seeks to bring out the important
and summing up that Youve said that . . . points of the discussion and to increase the
which has gone before During the past hour, you awareness and understanding of both partici-
and I have discussed . . . pants. It omits the irrelevant and organizes the
pertinent aspects of the interaction. It allows
both client and nurse to depart with the same
ideas and provides a sense of closure at the
completion of each discussion.
Translating into feelings Client: Im dead. Often what the client says, when taken literally,
seeking to verbalize Nurse: Are you suggesting seems meaningless or far removed from reality.
clients feelings that he that you feel lifeless? To understand, the nurse must concentrate on
or she expresses only Client: Im way out in the what the client might be feeling to express
indirectly ocean. himself or herself this way.
Nurse: You seem to feel
lonely or deserted.
Verbalizing the implied Client: I cant talk to you or Putting into words what the client has implied
voicing what the client anyone. Its a waste of or said indirectly tends to make the discussion
has hinted at or time. Nurse: Do you less obscure. The nurse should be as direct
suggested feel that no one under- as possible without being unfeelingly blunt
stands? or obtuse. The client may have difficulty
communicating directly. The nurse should take
care to express only what is fairly obvious;
otherwise the nurse may be jumping to
conclusions or interpreting the clients
communication.
Voicing doubtexpressing Isnt that unusual? Another means of responding to distortions of
uncertainty about the Really? reality is to express doubt. Such expression
reality of the clients Thats hard to believe. permits the client to become aware that others
perceptions do not necessarily perceive events in the same
way or draw the same conclusions. This does
not mean the client will alter his or her point of
view, but at least the nurse will encourage the
client to reconsider or reevaluate what has
happened. The nurse neither agreed nor dis-
agreed; however, he or she has not let the
misperceptions and distortions pass without
comment.
Adapted from Hayes, J. S., & Larsen, K. (1963). Interactions with patients. New York: Macmillan Press.
6 THERAPEUTIC COMMUNICATION 119
Table 6-2
NONTHERAPEUTIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUES
Techniques Examples Rationale
Advisingtelling the client I think you should . . . Giving advice implies that only the nurse knows
what to do Why dont you . . . what is best for the client.
Agreeingindicating accord Thats right. Approval indicates the client is right rather
with the client I agree. than wrong. This gives the client the impres-
sion that he or she is right because of agree-
ment with the nurse. Opinions and conclusions
should be exclusively the clients. When the
nurse agrees with the client, there is no oppor-
tunity for the client to change his or her mind
without being wrong.
Belittling feelings Client: I have nothing When the nurse tries to equate the intense and
expressedMisjudging to live for . . . I wish overwhelming feelings the client has expressed
the degree of the clients I was dead. to everybody or to the nurses own feelings,
discomfort Nurse: Everybody gets the nurse implies that the discomfort is tempo-
down in the dumps. OR rary, mild, self-limiting, or not very important.
Ive felt that way myself. The client is focused on his or her own worries
and feelings; hearing the problems or feelings
of others is not helpful.
Challengingdemanding But how can you be Often the nurse believes that if he or she can
proof from the client President of the United challenge the client to prove unrealistic ideas,
States? the client will realize there is no proof
If youre dead, why is your and then will recognize reality. Actually
heart beating? challenging causes the client to defend the
delusions or misperceptions more strongly
than before.
Defendingattempting to This hospital has a fine Defending what the client has criticized implies
protect someone or reputation. that he or she has no right to express impres-
something from verbal Im sure your doctor sions, opinions, or feelings. Telling the client
attack has your best interests that his or her criticism is unjust or unfounded
in mind. does not change the clients feelings but only
serves to block further communication.
Disagreeingopposing the Thats wrong. Disagreeing implies the client is wrong.
clients ideas I definitely disagree Consequently the client feels defensive about
with . . . his or her point of view or ideas.
I dont believe that.
Disapprovingdenouncing Thats bad. Disapproval implies that the nurse has the right
the clients behavior or Id rather you wouldnt . . . to pass judgment on the clients thoughts or
ideas actions. It further implies that the client is
expected to please the nurse.
Giving approval Thats good. Im glad Saying what the client thinks or feels if good
sanctioning the clients that . . . implies that the opposite is bad. Approval,
behavior or ideas then, tends to limit the clients freedom to
think, speak, or act in a certain way. This can
lead to the clients acting in a particular way
just to please the nurse.
Giving literal responses Client: Theyre looking in Often the client is at a loss to describe his or her
responding to a figurative my head with a television feelings, so such comments are the best he or
comment as though it camera. she can do. Usually it is helpful for the nurse to
were a statement of fact Nurse: Try not to watch focus on the clients feelings in response to
television. OR What such statements.
channel?
Indicating the existence of What makes you say The nurse can ask, What happened? or What
an external source that? events led you to draw such a conclusion?
attributing the source of What made you do that? But to question What made you think that?
thoughts, feelings, and Who told you that you implies that the client was made or compelled
behavior to others or to were a prophet? to think in a certain way. Usually the nurse
outside influences does not intend to suggest that the source is
external but that is often what the client
thinks.
(continued )
120 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Table 6-2
(Continued )
Interpretingasking to What you really The clients thoughts and feelings are his or her
make conscious that mean is . . . own, not to be interpreted by the nurse or for
which is unconscious; Unconsciously youre hidden meaning. Only the client can identify or
telling the client the saying . . . confirm the presence of feelings.
meaning of his or her
experience
Introducing an unrelated Client: Id like to die. The nurse takes the initiative for the interaction
topicchanging the Nurse: Did you have away from the client. This usually happens
subject visitors last evening? because the nurse is uncomfortable, doesnt
know how to respond, or has a topic he or she
would rather discuss.
Making stereotyped Its for your own good. Social conversation contains many clichs and
commentsoffering Keep your chin up. much meaningless chit-chat. Such comments
meaningless clichs or Just have a positive atti- are of no value in the nurseclient relationship.
trite comments tude and youll be better Any automatic responses will lack the nurses
in no time. consideration or thoughtfulness.
Probingpersistent ques- Now tell me about this Probing tends to make the client feel used or
tioning of the client problem. You know I have invaded. Clients have the right not to talk about
to find out. issues or concerns if they choose. Pushing and
Tell me your psychiatric probing by the nurse will not encourage the
history. client to talk.
Reassuringindicating I wouldnt worry about Attempts to dispel the clients anxiety by implying
there is no reason for that. that there is not sufficient reason for concern
anxiety or other feelings Everything will be all right. completely devalue the clients feelings. Vague
of discomfort Youre coming along just reassurances without accompanying facts are
fine. meaningless to the client.
Rejectingrefusing to Lets not discuss . . . When the nurse rejects any topic, he or she
consider or showing I dont want to hear closes it off from exploration. In turn, the client
contempt for the clients about . . . may feel personally rejected along with his or
ideas or behaviors her ideas.
Requesting an explanation Why do you think that? There is a difference between asking the client to
asking the client to provide Why do you feel that describe what is occurring or has taken place
reasons for thoughts, way? and asking him to explain why. Usually a why
feelings, behaviors, events question is intimidating. In addition, the client is
unlikely to know why and may become defen-
sive trying to explain himself or herself.
Testingappraising the Do you know what kind of These types of questions force the client to try to
clients degree of insight hospital this is? recognize his or her problems. The clients
Do you still have the idea acknowledgement that he or she doesnt know
that . . . ? these things may meet the nurses needs but is
not helpful for the client.
Using denialrefusing to Client: Im nothing. The nurse denies the clients feelings or the
admit that a problem Nurse: Of course youre seriousness of the situation by dismissing his
exists somethingeverybodys or her comments without attempting to
something. discover the feelings or meaning behind them.
Client: Im dead.
Nurse: Dont be silly.
Adapted from Hays, J. S., & Larson, K. (1963). Interactions with patients. New York: Macmillan.
If a client has difficulty attending to a conversa- themes and cues to help the nurse formulate further
tion and drifts into a rambling discussion or a flight of communication.
ideas, the nurse listens carefully for a theme, a topic Theme of sadness:
around which the client composes his or her words. Client: Oh, hi, nurse. ( face is sad; eyes look
Using the theme, the nurse can assess the nonverbal teary; voice is low, with little inflection)
behaviors that accompany the clients words and build Nurse: You seem sad today, Mrs. Venezia.
responses based on these cues. In the following exam- Client: Yes, it is the anniversary of my hus-
ples of identifying themes, the underlined words are bands death.
6 THERAPEUTIC COMMUNICATION 121
Nurse: How long ago did your husband die? implication is that the speaker thinks the woman to
(Or the nurse can use the other cue.) whom he or she refers is not smart, acts before think-
Nurse: Tell me about your husbands death, ing, or has no common sense. The nurse can clarify
Mrs. Venezia. what the client means by saying, Give me one exam-
Theme of loss of control: ple of how you see Mary as having more guts than
Client: I had a fender bender this morning. Im brains (focusing).
OK. I lost my wallet, and I have to go to the bank to
cover a check I wrote last night. I cant get in contact
with my husband at work. I dont know where to NONVERBAL COMMUNICATION
start. SKILLS
Nurse: I sense you feel out of control. (trans- Nonverbal communication is behavior that a person
lating into feelings) exhibits while delivering verbal content. It includes
Clients may use many word patterns to cue the lis- facial expression, eye contact, space, time, boundaries,
tener to their intent. Overt cues are clear statements and body movements. Nonverbal communication is as
of intent such as, I want to die. The message is clear important, if not more so, than verbal communication.
that the client is thinking of suicide or self-harm. It is estimated that one-third of meaning is transmit-
Covert cues are vague or hidden messages that need ted by words and two-thirds is communicated non-
interpretation and explorationfor example, if a client verbally. The speaker may verbalize what he or she
says, Nothing can help me. The nurse is unsure, but thinks the listener wants to hear, while nonverbal
it sounds as if the client might be saying he feels so communication conveys the speakers actual meaning.
hopeless and helpless that he plans to commit suicide. Nonverbal communication involves the unconscious
The nurse can explore this covert cue to clarify the
mind acting out emotions related to the verbal con-
clients intent and to protect the client. Most suicidal
tent, the situation, the environment, and the relation-
people are ambivalent about whether to live or die and
ship between the speaker and the listener.
often admit their plan when directly asked about it.
Knapp and Hall (2002) list the ways in which
When the nurse suspects self-harm or suicide, he or
nonverbal messages accompany verbal messages:
she uses a yes/no question to elicit a clear response.
Accent: using flashing eyes or hand movements
Theme of hopelessness and suicidal ideation:
Complement: giving quizzical looks, nodding
Client: Life is hard. I want it to be done. There
is no rest. Sleep, sleep is good . . . forever. Contradict: rolling eyes to demonstrate that
Nurse: I hear you saying things seem hopeless. I the meaning is the opposite of what one
wonder if you are planning to kill yourself. (verbal- is saying
izing the implied) Regulate: taking a deep breath to demonstrate
Other word patterns that need further clarifica- readiness to speak, using and uh to signal
tion for meaning include metaphors, proverbs, and the wish to continue speaking
clichs. When a client uses these figures of speech, the Repeat: using nonverbal behaviors to augment
nurse must follow up with questions to clarify what the verbal message such as shrugging after
the client is trying to say. saying, Who knows?
A metaphor is a phrase that describes an object Substitute: using culturally determined body
or situation by comparing it to something else familiar. movements that stand in for words such as
Client: My sons bedroom looks like a bomb pumping the arm up and down with a closed
went off. fist to indicate success
Nurse: Youre saying your son is not very neat.
(verbalizing the implied) Facial Expression
Client: My mind is like mashed potatoes.
Nurse: I sense you find it difficult to put thoughts The human face produces the most visible, com-
together. (translating into feelings) plex, and sometimes confusing nonverbal messages
Proverbs are old, accepted sayings with gener- (Weaver, 1996). Facial movements connect with words
ally accepted meanings. to illustrate meaning; this connection demonstrates
Client: People who live in glass houses shouldnt the speakers internal dialogue (Arnold & Boggs, 1999;
throw stones. Schrank, 1998). Facial expressions can be categorized
Nurse: Who do you believe is criticizing you into expressive, impassive, and confusing:
but actually has similar problems? (encouraging An expressive face portrays the persons
description of perception) moment-by-moment thoughts, feelings, and
A clich is an expression that has become trite needs. These expressions may be evident
and generally conveys a stereotype. For example, if even when the person does not want to
a client says she has more guts than brains, the reveal his or her emotions.
122 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Vocal Cues seems like a long time. It may confuse the client if the
nurse jumps in with another question or tries to re-
Vocal cues are nonverbal sound signals transmitted state the question differently. Also, in some cultures,
along with the content. The voice volume, tone, pitch, verbal communication is slow with many pauses, and
intensity, emphasis, speed, and pauses augment the the client may believe the nurse is impatient or dis-
senders message. Volume, the loudness of the voice, respectful if he or she does not wait for the clients
can indicate anger, fear, happiness, or deafness. Tone response.
can indicate if someone is relaxed, agitated, or bored.
Pitch varies from shrill and high to low and threat-
ening. Intensity is the power, severity, and strength UNDERSTANDING THE MEANING
behind the words, indicating the importance of the OF COMMUNICATION
message. Emphasis refers to accents on words or Few messages in social and therapeutic communica-
phrases that highlight the subject or give insight on tion have only one level of meaning; messages often
the topic. Speed is number of words spoken per minute. contain more meaning than just the spoken words
Pauses also contribute to the message, often adding (deVito, 2002). The nurse must try to discover all the
emphasis or feeling. meaning in the clients communication. For example,
The high-pitched, rapid delivery of a message the client with depression might say, Im so tired
often indicates anxiety. The use of extraneous words that I just cant go on. If the nurse considers only the
with long, tedious descriptions is called circumstan- literal meaning of the words, he or she might assume
tiality. Circumstantiality can indicate the client is the client is experiencing the fatigue that often ac-
confused about what is important or is spinning an companies depression. However, statements such as
untrue story (Morley et al., 1967). Slow, hesitant the previous example often mean the client wishes to
responses can indicate that the person is depressed, die. The nurse would need to further assess the clients
confused and searching for the correct words, having statement to determine whether or not the client is
difficulty finding the right words to describe an inci- suicidal.
dent, or reminiscing. It is important for the nurse to It is sometimes easier for clients to act out their
validate these nonverbal indicators rather than to as- emotions than to organize their thoughts and feelings
sume that he or she knows what the client is thinking into words to describe feelings and needs. For exam-
or feeling (e.g., Mr. Smith, you sound anxious. Is that ple, people who outwardly appear dominating and
how youre feeling?). strong and often manipulate and criticize others in
reality may have low self-esteem and feel insecure.
Eye Contact They do not verbalize their true feelings but act them
out in behavior toward others. Insecurity and low
The eyes have been called the mirror of the soul be- self-esteem often translate into jealousy and mistrust
cause they often reflect our emotions. Messages that of others and attempts to feel more important and
the eyes give include humor, interest, puzzlement, strong by dominating or criticizing them.
hatred, happiness, sadness, horror, warning, and
pleading. Eye contact, looking into the other persons
eyes during communication, is used to assess the other UNDERSTANDING CONTEXT
person and the environment and to indicate whose Understanding the context of communication is ex-
turn it is to speak; it increases during listening but tremely important in accurately identifying the mean-
decreases while speaking (Northouse & Northouse, ing of a message. Think of the difference in the mean-
1998). While maintaining good eye contact is usually ing of Im going to kill you! when stated in two
desirable, it is important that the nurse doesnt stare different contexts: anger during an argument, and
at the client. when one friend discovers another is planning a sur-
prise party for him or her. Understanding the context
of a situation gives the nurse more information and
Silence reduces the risk of assumptions.
Silence or long pauses in communication may indicate To clarify context, the nurse must gather infor-
many different things. The client may be depressed mation from verbal and nonverbal sources and vali-
and struggling to find the energy to talk. Sometimes date findings with the client. For example, if a client
pauses indicate the client is thoughtfully considering says, I collapsed, she may mean she fainted or felt
the question before responding. At times, the client weak and had to sit down. Or she could mean she was
may seem to be lost in his or her own thoughts and tired and went to bed. To clarify these terms and
not paying attention to the nurse. It is important to view them in the context of the action, the nurse could
allow the client sufficient time to respond, even if it say, What do you mean collapsed? (seeking clarifi-
124 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
cation) or Describe where you were and what you were verbal greeting used primarily by men often to size
doing when you collapsed (placing events in time and up or judge someone just met. For women, a polite
sequence). Assessment of context focuses on who was hello is an accepted form of greeting. In some Asian
there, what happened, when it occurred, how the event cultures, bowing is the accepted form of greeting and
progressed, and why the client believes it happened departing and a method of designating social status.
as it did. Because of these differences, cultural assessment
is necessary when establishing a therapeutic relation-
ship. The nurse must assess the clients emotional
UNDERSTANDING SPIRITUALITY
expression, beliefs, values, and behaviors; modes of
Spirituality is a clients belief about life, health, ill- emotional expression; and views about mental health
ness, death, and ones relationship to the universe. and illness.
Spirituality differs from religion, which is an orga- When caring for people who do not speak English,
nized system of beliefs about one or more all-powerful, the services of a qualified translator who is skilled
all-knowing forces that govern the universe and offer at obtaining accurate data are necessary. He or she
guidelines for living in harmony with the universe and should be able to translate technical words into an-
others (Andrews & Boyle, 2003). Spiritual and reli- other language while retaining the original intent of
gious beliefs usually are supported by others who the message and not injecting his or her own biases.
share them and follow the same rules and rituals for The nurse is responsible for knowing how to contact
daily living. Spirituality and religion often provide a translator, regardless of whether the setting is
comfort and hope to people and can greatly affect a inpatient, outpatient, or in the community.
persons health and health care practices. The nurse must understand the differences in
The nurse must first assess his or her own spiri- how various cultures communicate. It helps to see how
tual and religious beliefs. Religion and spirituality are a person from another culture acts and speaks toward
highly subjective and can be vastly different among others. U.S. and many European cultures are individ-
people. The nurse must remain objective and non- ualistic; they value self-reliance and independence
judgmental regarding the clients beliefs and must not and they focus on individual goals and achievements.
allow them to alter nursing care. The nurse must Other cultures, such as Chinese and Korean, are col-
assess the clients spiritual and religious needs and lectivistic, valuing the group and observing obliga-
guard against imposing his or her own on the client. tions that enhance the security of the group. Persons
The nurse must ensure that the client is not ignored from these cultures are more private and guarded
or ridiculed because his or her beliefs and values when speaking to members outside the group and
differ from those of the staff (Chant et al., 2002). sometimes may even ignore outsiders until they are
As the therapeutic relationship develops, the formally introduced to the group.
nurse must be aware of and respect the clients reli- Cultural differences in greetings, personal space,
gious and spiritual beliefs. Ignoring or being judgmen- eye contact, touch, and beliefs about health and ill-
tal will quickly erode trust and could stall the rela- ness are discussed in-depth in Chapter 7.
tionship. For example, a nurse working with a Native
American client could find him looking up at the sky
and talking to Grandmother Moon. If the nurse did THE THERAPEUTIC
not realize that the clients beliefs embody all things COMMUNICATION SESSION
with spirit including the sun, moon, earth, and trees,
the nurse might misinterpret the clients actions as
Goals
inappropriate. The nurse uses all the therapeutic communication
Chapter 7 gives a more detailed discussion on techniques and skills previously described to help
spirituality. achieve the following goals:
Establish rapport with the client by being em-
pathetic, genuine, caring, and unconditionally
CULTURAL CONSIDERATIONS accepting of the client regardless of his or her
Culture is all the socially learned behaviors, values, behavior or beliefs.
beliefs, and customs transmitted down to each gen- Actively listen to the client to identify the
eration. The rules about the way in which to conduct issues of concern and to formulate a client-
communication vary because they arise from each cul- centered goal for the interaction.
tures specific social relationship patterns (Kreps & Gain an in-depth understanding of the
Kunimoto, 1994). Each culture has its own rules gov- clients perception of the issue, and foster
erning verbal and nonverbal communication. For ex- empathy in the nurseclient relationship.
ample, in Western cultures the handshake is a non- Explore the clients thoughts and feelings.
6 THERAPEUTIC COMMUNICATION 125
Facilitate the clients expression of thoughts Client: Really? Its hard to tell what its doing
and feelings. outside. Still seems hot in here to me.
Guide the client to develop new skills in Nurse: It does get stuffy here sometimes. So tell
problem-solving. me, how are you doing today? (broad opening)
Promote the clients evaluation of solutions.
NONDIRECTIVE ROLE
Beginning Therapeutic When beginning therapeutic interaction with a client,
Communication it is often the client (not the nurse) who identifies the
Often the nurse will be able to plan the time and set- problem he or she wants to discuss. The nurse uses ac-
ting for therapeutic communication such as having tive listening skills to identify the topic of concern. The
an in-depth, one-on-one interaction with an assigned client identifies the goal, and information-gathering
client. The nurse has time to think about where to about this topic focuses on the client. The nurse acts as
meet and what to say and will have a general idea of a guide in this conversation. The therapeutic commu-
the topic such as finding out what the client sees as his nication centers on achieving the goal within the time
or her major concern or following up on interaction limits of the conversation.
from a previous encounter. At times, however, a client The following are examples of client-centered
may approach the nurse saying, Can I talk to you goals:
right now? Or the nurse may see a client sitting Client will discuss her concerns about her
alone, crying, and decide to approach the client for an 16-year-old daughter who is having trouble
interaction. In these situations, the nurse may know in school.
that he or she will be trying to find out what is hap- Client will describe difficulty she has with
pening with the client at that moment in time. side effects of her medication.
When meeting the client for the first time, intro- Client will share his distress about sons
ducing oneself and establishing a contract for the re- drug abuse.
lationship is an appropriate start for therapeutic Client will identify the greatest concerns he
communication. The nurse can ask the client how he has about being a single parent.
The nurse is assuming a nondirective role in
or she prefers to be addressed. A contract for the re-
this type of therapeutic communication, using broad
lationship includes outlining the care the nurse will
openings and open-ended questions to collect infor-
give, the times the nurse will be with the client, and
mation and help the client to identify and discuss the
acceptance of these conditions by the client.
topic of concern. The client does most of the talking.
Nurse: Hello, Mr. Kirk. My name is Joan, and
The nurse guides the client through the interaction,
Ill be your nurse today. Im here from 7 am to 3:30 pm.
facilitating the clients expression of feelings and iden-
Right now I have a few minutes, and I see you are
tification of issues. The following is an example of the
dressed and ready for the day. I would like to spend nurses nondirective role:
some time talking with you if this is convenient. (giv- Client: Im so upset about my family.
ing recognition and introducing self, setting Nurse: Youre so upset? (reflecting)
limits of contract) Client: Yes, I am. I cant sleep. My appetite is
After making the introduction and establishing poor. I just dont know what to do.
the contract, the nurse can engage in small talk to Nurse: Go on. (using a general lead)
break the ice and help to get acquainted with the Client: Well, my husband works long hours and
client if they have not met before. Then the nurse can is very tired when he gets home. He barely sees the
use a broad opening question to guide the client to- children before their bedtime.
ward identifying the major topic of concern. Broad Nurse: I see. (accepting)
opening questions are helpful to begin the therapeu- Client: Im busy trying to fix dinner, trying to
tic communication session because they allow the keep an eye on the children, but I also want to talk to
client to focus on what he or she considers important. my husband.
The following is a good example of how to begin the Nurse: How do feel when all this is happening?
therapeutic communication: (encouraging expression)
Nurse: Hello, Mrs. Nagy. My name is Donna, Client: Like Im torn in several directions at once.
and I am your nurse today and tomorrow from 7 am Nothing seems to go right, and I cant straighten
to 3 pm. What do you like to be called? (introducing everything out.
self, establishing limits of relationship) Nurse: It sounds like youre feeling overwhelmed.
Client: Hi, Donna. You can call me Peggy. (translating into feelings)
Nurse: The rain today has been a welcome relief Client: Yes, I am. I cant do everything at once
from the heat of the past few days. all by myself. I think we have to make some changes.
126 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Nurse: Perhaps you and I can discuss some In English, people frequently substitute the word
potential changes youd like to make. (suggesting feel for think. Emotions differ from the cognitive
collaboration) process of thinking, so using the appropriate term is
In some therapeutic interactions, the client wants important. For example, What do you feel about that
only to talk to an interested listener and feel like he or test? is a vague question that could elicit several
she has been heard. Often just sharing a distressing types of answers. A more specific question is, How
event can allow the client to express thoughts and well do you think you did on the test? The nurse
emotions that he or she has been holding back. It should ask, What did you think about . . . ? when
serves as a way to lighten the emotional load and re- discussing cognitive issues and How did you feel
lease feelings without a need to alter the situation. about . . . ? when trying to elicit the clients emotions
Other times, the client may need to reminisce and and feelings. Box 6-1 lists feeling words that are
share pleasant memories of past events. Older adults commonly used to express or describe emotions. The
often find great solace in reminiscing about events in following are examples of different responses that
their life such as what was happening in the world clients could give to questions using think and feel:
when they were growing up, meeting and marrying Nurse: What did you think about your daughters
their spouses, and so forth. Reminiscence is discussed role in her automobile accident?
further in Chapter 21. Client: I believe she is just not a careful driver.
She drives too fast.
DIRECTIVE ROLE Nurse: How did you feel when you heard about
your daughters automobile accident?
When the client is suicidal, experiencing a crisis, or out
Client: Relieved that neither she nor anyone else
of touch with reality, the nurse uses a directive role,
was injured.
asking direct, yes /no questions and using problem-
Using active listening skills, asking many open-
solving to help the client develop new coping mecha-
ended questions, and building on the clients responses
nisms to deal with present, here-and-now issues. The
will help the nurse obtain a complete description of an
following is an example of therapeutic communication
issue or an event and understand the clients experi-
using a more directive role:
ence. Some clients do not have the skill or patience to
Nurse: I see you sitting here in the corner of
describe how an event unfolded over time without as-
the room away from everyone else. (making obser-
sistance from the nurse. Clients tend to recount the be-
vation)
ginning and the end of a story, leaving out crucial in-
Client: Yeah, whats the point?
formation about their own behavior. The nurse can
Nurse: Whats the point of what? (seeking
clarification)
Client: Of anything
Nurse: You sound hopeless. (verbalizing the Box 6-1
implied) Are you thinking about suicide? (seeking
information) FEELING WORDS
Client: I have been thinking Id be better off dead. Afraid Hopeless
The nurse uses a very directive role in this ex- Alarmed Horrified
ample because the clients safety is at issue. Angry Impatient
As the nurse-client relationship progresses, the Anxious Irritated
nurse will use therapeutic communication to imple- Ashamed Jealous
ment many interventions in the clients plan of care. Bewildered Joyful
Calm Lonely
The chapters in Unit IV that discuss mental illness
Carefree Pleased
and disorders contain therapeutic communication Confused Powerless
interventions and examples of how to use the tech- Depressed Relaxed
niques effectively. Ecstatic Resentful
Embarrassed Sad
How to Phrase Questions Enraged Scared
Envious Surprised
The manner in which the nurse phrases questions is Excited Tense
important. Open-ended questions elicit more descrip- Fearful Terrified
tive information; yes/no questions yield just an answer. Frustrated Threatened
The nurse asks different types of questions based Guilty Thrilled
on the information the nurse wishes to obtain. The Happy Uptight
nurse uses active listening to build questions based on Hopeful
the cues the client has given in his or her responses.
6 THERAPEUTIC COMMUNICATION 127
help the client by using techniques such as clarification 3. Reflect the clients behavior signaling there
and placing an event in time or sequence. is a more important issue to be discussed.
4. Mentally file the other topic away for later
ASKING FOR CLARIFICATION exploration.
5. Ignore the new topic, because it seems that
Nurses often believe that they always should be able
the client is trying to avoid the original topic.
to understand what the client is saying. This is not
The following example shows how the nurse can
always the case: the clients thoughts and communi-
try to identify which issue is most important to the
cations may be unclear. The nurse never should as-
client:
sume that he or she understands; rather, the nurse
Client: I dont know whether it is better to tell or
should ask for clarification if there is doubt. Asking
not tell my husband that I wont be able to work any-
for clarification to confirm the nurses understanding
more. He gets so upset whenever he hears bad news.
of what the client intends to convey is paramount to
He has an ulcer, and bad news seems to set off a new
accurate data collection.
bout of ulcer bleeding and pain.
If the nurse needs more information or clarifica-
Nurse: Which issue is more difficult for you to
tion on a previously discussed issue, he or she may
confront right now: your bad news or your husbands
need to return to that issue. The nurse also may need
ulcer? (encouraging expression)
to ask questions in some areas to clarify information.
The nurse then can use the therapeutic technique of
consensual validation, which means repeating his or
Guiding the Client in Problem-Solving
her understanding of the event that the client just de-
and Empowering the Client to Change
scribed to see if their perceptions agree. It is impor- Many therapeutic situations involve problem-solving.
tant to go back and clarify rather than working from The nurse is not expected to be an expert or to tell the
assumptions. client what to do to fix his or her problem. Rather the
The following is an example of clarifying and nurse should help the client explore possibilities and
focusing techniques: find solutions to his or her problem. Often just help-
Client: I saw it coming. No one else had a clue ing the client to discuss and explore his or her per-
this would happen. ceptions of a problem stimulates potential solutions
Nurse: What was it that you saw coming? (seek- in the clients mind. The nurse should introduce the
ing information) concept of problem-solving and offer himself or her-
Client: We were doing well, and then the floor self in this process.
dropped out from under us. There was little anyone Virginia Satir (1967) explained how important the
could do but hope for the best. clients participation is to finding effective and mean-
Nurse: Help me understand by describing what ingful solutions to problems. If someone else tells the
doing well refers to. (seeking information) client how to solve his or her problems and does not
Who are the we you refer to? (focusing) allow the client to participate and develop problem-
How did the f loor drop out from under you? solving skills and paths for change, the client may fear
(encouraging description of perceptions) growth and change. The nurse who gives advice or di-
What did you hope would happen when you rections about the way to fix a problem does not allow
hoped for the best? (seeking information) the client to play a role in the process and implies
that the client is less than competent. This process
CLIENTS AVOIDANCE OF makes the client feel helpless and not in control and
THE ANXIETY-PRODUCING TOPIC lowers self-esteem. The client may even resist the
directives in an attempt to regain a sense of control.
Sometimes clients begin discussing a topic of minimal When a client is more involved in the problem-
importance because it is less threatening than the solving process, he or she is more likely to follow
issue that is increasing the clients anxiety. The client through on the solutions. The nurse who guides the
is discussing a topic but seems to be focused elsewhere. client to solve his or her own problems helps the client
Active listening and observing changes in the intensity to develop new coping strategies, maintains or in-
of the nonverbal process help to give the nurse a sense creases the clients self-esteem, and demonstrates the
of what is going on. Many options can help the nurse to belief that the client is capable of change. These goals
determine which topic is more important: encourage the client to expand his or her repertoire
1. Ask the client which issue is more important of skills and to feel competent; feeling effective and
at this time. in control is a comfortable state for any client.
2. Go with the new topic because the client has Problem-solving is frequently used in crisis inter-
given nonverbal messages that this is the vention but is equally effective for general use. The
issue that needs to be discussed. problem-solving process is used when the client has
128 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
difficulty finding ways to solve the problem or when caregiver and resource person for increasingly high-
working with a group of people whose divergent view- risk clients treated in the home and their families and
points hinder finding solutions. It involves several will become more responsible for primary prevention
steps: in wellness and health maintenance. Therapeutic com-
1. Identify the problem. munication techniques and skills are essential to suc-
2. Brainstorm about all possible solutions. cessful management of clients in the community.
3. Select the best alternative. Caring for older adults in the family unit and in
4. Implement the selected alternative. communities today is a major nursing concern and
5. Evaluate the situation. responsibility. It is important to assess the relation-
6. If dissatisfied with results, select another ships of family members; identifying their areas of
alternative and continue the process. agreement and conflict can greatly affect the care of
Identifying the problem involves engaging the clients. To be responsive to the needs of these clients
client in therapeutic communication. The client tells and their families for support and caring, the nurse
the nurse the problem and what he or she has tried must be able to communicate and relate to clients
to do to solve it: and establish a therapeutic relationship.
Nurse: I see you frowning. What is going on? When practicing in the community, the nurse
(making observation; broad opening) needs self-awareness and knowledge about cultural
Client: Ive tried to get my husband more involved differences. When the nurse enters the home of a
with the children other than yelling at them when he client, the nurse is the outsider and must learn to ne-
comes in from work, but Ive had little success. gotiate the cultural context of each family by under-
Nurse: What have you tried that has not worked? standing their beliefs, customs, and practices and not
(encouraging expression) judging them according to his or her own. Asking
Client: Before my surgery, I tried to involve him the family for help in learning about their culture
in their homework. My husband is a math whiz. Then demonstrates the nurses unconditional positive re-
I tried TV time together, but the kids like cartoons gard and genuineness. Families from other cultural
and he wants to watch stuff about history, natural backgrounds often respect nurses and health care
science, or travel. professionals and are quite patient and forgiving of
Nurse: How have you involved your husband in the cultural mistakes that nurses might make as they
this plan for him to get more involved with the chil- learn different customs and behaviors.
dren? (seeking information) Another reason the nurse needs to understand
Client: Uh, I havent. I mean, he always says he the health care practices of various cultures is to make
wants to spend more quality time with the kids, but sure these practices do not hinder or alter the pre-
he doesnt. Do you mean it would be better for him to scribed therapeutic regimens. Some cultural healing
decide how he wants to do thisI mean, spend qual- practices, remedies, and even dietary practices may
ity time with the kids? alter the clients immune system and may enhance or
Nurse: That sounds like a place to start. Per- interfere with prescribed medications.
haps you and you husband could discuss this issue The nurse in community care is a member of the
when he comes to visit, and decide what would work health care team and must learn to collaborate with
for both of you. (formulating a plan of action) the client and family as well as other health care
It is important to remember that the nurse is fa- providers who are involved in the clients care such
cilitating the clients problem-solving abilities. The as physicians, physical therapists, psychologists, and
nurse may not think the client is choosing the best or home health aides.
most effective solution, but it is essential that the Working with several people at one time rather
nurse supports the clients choice and assists him or than just the client is the standard in community care.
her to implement the chosen alternative. If the client Self-awareness and sensitivity to the beliefs, behav-
makes a mistake or the selected alternative isnt suc- iors, and feelings of others are paramount to the suc-
cessful, the nurse can support the clients efforts and cessful care of clients in the community setting.
assist the client to try again. Effective problem-
solving involves helping the client to resolve his or
her own problems as independently as possible.
SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES
Therapeutic communication is the pri-
mary vehicle that nurses use to apply the nursing
COMMUNITY-BASED CARE process in mental health settings. The nurses skill in
As community care for people with physical and men- therapeutic communication influences the effective-
tal health problems continues to expand, the nurses ness of many interventions. Therefore the nurse must
role expands as well. The nurse may become the major evaluate and improve his or her communication skills
6 THERAPEUTIC COMMUNICATION 129
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
1. Client: I had an accident. 4. How does Jerry make you upset? is a non-
therapeutic communication technique because it
Nurse: Tell me about your accident.
A. Gives a literal response
This is an example of which therapeutic
B. Indicates an external source of the emotion
communication technique?
C. Interprets what the client is saying
A. Making observations
D. Is just another stereotyped comment
B. Offering self
A. Consensual validation 6. When the client says, I met Joe at the dance
last week, what is the best way for the nurse
B. Encouraging comparison to ask the client to describe her relationship
with Joe?
C. Accepting
A. Joe who?
D. General lead
B. Tell me about Joe.
3. Why do you always complain about the night C. Tell me about you and Joe.
nurse? She is a nice woman and a fine nurse, D. Joe, you mean that blond guy with the dark
and has five kids to support. Youre wrong blue eyes?
when you say she is noisy and uncaring.
This example reflects which nontherapeutic
technique? 7. Which of the following is a concrete message?
131
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
Define the following:
1. Culture
2. Proxemics
3. Incongruent message
4. Spirituality
132
5. Nonverbal communication
6. Clich
7. Metaphor
133
In the following client statements, underline the cues (words, phrases, or
issues) that should be followed up with therapeutic communication inter-
ventions. Then write a therapeutic response.
1. I feel good.
3. I have two children, one from my wife and one from my girlfriend.
5. My son is never going to understand the way his wife is ruining them.
134
7 Clients
Response
Learning Objectives to Illness
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
Nursing philosophies often describe the person or in- challenging. Nurses must be aware of the childs level
dividual as a biopsychosocial being, who possesses of language and work to understand the experience as
unique characteristics and responds to others and he or she describes it.
the world in various and diverse ways. This view of Erik Erikson described psychosocial development
the individual as unique requires nurses to assess across the life span in terms of developmental tasks
each person and his or her responses to plan and to accomplish in each stage (Table 7-1). Each stage of
provide nursing care that is personally meaningful. development depends on the successful completion of
This uniqueness of response may partially explain the previous stage. In each stage, the person must
why some people become ill while others do not. complete a critical life task that is essential to well-
Understanding why two people raised in a stressful being and mental health. Failure to complete the crit-
environment (e.g., one with neglect or abuse) turn ical task results in a negative outcome for that stage of
out differently is difficult: one person becomes rea- development and impedes completion of future tasks.
sonably successful and maintains a satisfying mar- For example, the infancy stage (birth to 18 months) is
riage and family, while the other feels isolated, de- the stage of trust versus mistrust, when babies
pressed, and lonely; is divorced; and abuses alcohol. must learn to develop basic trust that their parents
Although we do not know exactly what makes the dif- or guardians will take care of them, feed them, change
ference, studies have begun to show that certain per- their diapers, love them, and keep them safe. If the
sonal, interpersonal, and cultural factors influence a infant does not develop trust in this stage, he or she
persons response. may be unable to love and trust others later in life,
Culture is all the socially learned behaviors, val- because the ability to trust others is essential to es-
ues, beliefs, customs, and ways of thinking of a pop- tablishing good relationships. Specific developmental
ulation that guide its members views of themselves tasks for adults are summarized in Table 7-2.
and the world. This view affects all aspects of the per- According to Eriksons theory, people may get
sons being including health, illness, and treatment. stuck at any stage of development. For example, a
Cultural diversity refers to the vast array of differ- person who never completed the developmental task
ences that exist among populations.
This chapter examines some of the personal,
interpersonal, and cultural factors that create the Table 7-1
unique individual response to both illness and treat-
ment. In determining how a person copes with illness, ERIKSONS STAGES OF PSYCHOSOCIAL DEVELOPMENT
we cannot single out one or two of these factors. Rather Stage Tasks
we must consider each person as a combination of all
these overlapping and interacting factors. Trust vs. mistrust Viewing the world as safe
(infant) and reliable
Viewing relationships as
INDIVIDUAL FACTORS nurturing, stable, and
dependable
Age, Growth, and Development Autonomy vs. shame Achieving a sense of
and doubt control and free will
A persons age seems to affect how he or she copes (toddler)
with illness. For instance, the age of onset of schizo- Initiative vs. guilt Beginning to develop a
(preschool) conscience
phrenia is a strong predictor of the prognosis of the
Learning to manage
disease (Buchanan & Carpenter, 2000). People with conflict and anxiety
a younger age of onset have poorer outcomes, such as Industry vs. inferiority Building confidence in own
more negative signs (apathy, social isolation, lack (school age) abilities
of volition) and less effective coping skills, than do Taking pleasure in accom-
plishments
people with a later age of onset. A possible reason for Identity vs. role Formulating a sense of self
this difference is that younger clients have not had diffusion and belonging
experiences of successful independent living or the (adolescence)
opportunity to work and be self-sufficient and have a Intimacy vs. isolation Forming adult, loving rela-
less well-developed sense of personal identity than (young adult) tionships and meaningful
attachment to others
older clients. Generativity vs. Being creative and
A clients age also can influence how he or she stagnation productive
expresses illness. A young child with attention deficit (middle adult) Establishing the next
hyperactivity disorder (ADHD) may lack the under- generation
standing and ability to describe his or her feelings, Ego integrity vs. Accepting responsibility for
despair (maturity) ones self and life
which may make management of the disorder more
7 CLIENTS RESPONSE TO ILLNESS 137
Table 7-2
ADULT GROWTH AND DEVELOPMENT TASKS
Stage Tasks
of autonomy may become overly dependent on others. persons response to illness and perhaps even to treat-
Failure to develop identity can result in role confu- ment. Hence family history and background are es-
sion or an unclear idea about whom one is as a per- sential parts of the nursing assessment.
son. Negotiating these developmental tasks affects
how the person will respond to stress and illness.
Lack of success may result in feelings of inferiority,
Physical Health and Health Practices
doubt, lack of confidence, and isolationall of which Physical health also can influence how a person re-
can affect how a person responds to illness. sponds to psychosocial stress or illness. The healthier
a person is, the better he or she can cope with stress
or illness. Poor nutritional status, lack of sleep, or a
Genetics and Biologic Factors chronic physical illness may impair a persons ability
Heredity and biologic factors are not under voluntary to cope. Unlike genetic factors, how a person lives
control. We cannot change these factors. Research and takes care of himself or herself can alter many of
has identified genetic links to several disorders. For these factors. For this reason, nurses must assess the
example, some people are born with a gene associ- clients physical health even when the client is seek-
ated with one type of Alzheimers disease. Although ing help for mental health problems.
specific genetic links have not been identified for sev- Personal health practices, such as exercise, can
eral mental disorders (e.g., bipolar disorder, major influence the clients response to illness. Auchus et
depression, alcoholism), research has shown that al. (1995) studied the exercise patterns of psychiatric
these disorders tend to appear more frequently in inpatients and found that walking was a common
families. Genetic makeup tremendously influences a form of exercise. Those who walked one to five times
138 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
(although hardiness did not seem to be related to as victims of multiple problems such as poverty, un-
adaptation to hypertension or arthritis). Lambert employment, and low socioeconomic status. Hill (1998)
(1990) found that hardiness was a significant predic- identified family protective mechanisms that improved
tor of psychological well-being and social support for the resiliency of children including instilling positive
women with rheumatoid arthritis. family values, promoting positive communication and
Although hardiness has been described as a trait, social interaction, maintaining flexible family roles,
some researchers believe that education can increase exercising control over children, and providing aca-
health-related hardiness. Webster and Austin (1999) demic support to children. Other family protective
conducted research in which people who believed that factors that have been shown to improve the re-
stress was affecting their lives participated in a study siliency of adolescents include caring and supportive
designed to improve their abilities to manage stress. relationships with adult caregivers; high expecta-
They were referred by local health providers, thera- tions for good citizenship, academic achievement,
pists, and physicians or obtained information about and spiritual involvement; and encouragement to
the study through newspaper advertisements or lit- participate in caring for siblings, household chores,
erature at the local mental health center. The Well- part-time work, and carefully selected, safe activities
ness Program focused on identifying and managing outside the home (Calvert, 1997).
feelings, developing coping strategies, taking time Resourcefulness involves using problem-solving
for oneself, and improving communication. After the abilities and believing that one can cope with adverse
education groups, the researchers found that the or novel situations. People develop resourcefulness
participants had increased control and commitment through interactions with others, that is, through
(hardiness components) and significantly reduced successfully coping with life experiences (Krafcik,
symptoms such as obsessive-compulsive behaviors, 2002). Examples of resourcefulness include performing
hostility, withdrawal/isolation, and level of distress. health-seeking behaviors, learning self-care, monitor-
Some believe that the concept of hardiness is ing ones thoughts and feelings about stressful situa-
vague and indistinct and may not help everyone. Some tions, and taking action to deal with stressful circum-
research on hardiness suggests that its effects are stances (Harvard Womens Health Watch, 2001).
not the same for men and women (Benishek & Lopez,
1997) and that hardiness is a better stress moderator
in men. Low (1999) suggested that hardiness may be Spirituality
useful only to those who value individualism such
Spirituality involves the essence of a persons being
as people from some Western cultures. For people
and his or her beliefs about the meaning of life and
and cultures who value relationships over individ-
the purpose for living. It may include belief in God or
ual achievement, hardiness may not be beneficial.
a higher power, the practice of religion, cultural be-
liefs and practices, and a relationship with the envi-
Resilience and Resourcefulness ronment. Although many clients with mental dis-
Two closely related concepts, resilience and resource- orders have disturbing religious delusions, for many
fulness, help people to cope with stress and to mini- in the general population, religion and spirituality
mize the effects of illness. Resilience is defined as are a source of comfort and help in times of stress or
having healthy responses to stressful circumstances trauma. Studies have shown that spirituality is a
or risky situations (Hill, 1998). This concept helps to genuine help to many mentally challenged adults,
explain why one person reacts to a slightly stressful serving as a primary coping device and a source of
event with severe anxiety, while another person does meaning and coherence in their lives or helping to
not experience distress even when confronting a provide a social network (Fallot, 2001).
major disruption (Krafcik, 2002; Harris, 2001). Stud- Religious activities such as church attendance
ies on resiliency first focused on factors that resulted and praying and associated social support have been
in positive outcomes for children who were at risk shown to be very important for many people and are
because their parents had alcohol or mental health linked with better health and a sense of well-being
problems (Rutter, 1987). Factors that enhanced out- (Baetz et al., 2002). These activities also have been
comes were childrens abilities to develop self-esteem found to help people cope with poor health. Hope and
and self-efficacy through relationships with others, faith have been identified as critical factors in psy-
have new experiences, and obtain assistance with life chiatric as well as physical rehabilitation (Lunt, 2001;
transitions as they matured. Musgrave et al., 2002; Adams & Partee, 1998).
Studies have found that families who use their Studies have shown that religion and spiritual-
strengths show improved resiliency and more posi- ity can be helpful to families who have a relative with
tive outcomes than families who view themselves mental illness: religion was found to play an impor-
140 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
tant role in providing support to caregivers and was A persons sense of belonging is closely related to
a major source of solace (Longo & Peterson, 2002). his or her social and psychological functioning. A sense
Because spiritual or religious beliefs and prac- of belonging was found to promote health, whereas a
tices help many clients to cope with stress and ill- lack of belonging impaired health (Tanner, 2001). An
ness, the nurse must be particularly sensitive to and increased sense of belonging also was associated with
accepting of such beliefs and practices. Incorporating decreased levels of anxiety. Persons with a sense of
those practices into the care of clients can help them belonging are less alienated and isolated, have a sense
cope with illness and find meaning and purpose in of purpose, believe they are needed by others, and feel
the situation. Doing so also can offer a strong source productive socially (Dirksen, 2000). Hence, the nurse
of support. should focus on interventions that help increase a
clients sense of belonging.
INTERPERSONAL FACTORS
Social Networks and Social Support
Sense of Belonging
Social networks are groups of people whom one
A sense of belonging is the feeling of connectedness knows and with whom one feels connected. Studies
with or involvement in a social system or environment have found that having a social network can help
of which a person feels an integral part (Ross, 2002). reduce stress, diminish illness, and positively in-
Abraham Maslow described a sense of belonging as a fluence the ability to cope and to adapt (Bisconti &
basic human psychosocial need that involves both Bergeman, 1999).
feelings of value and fit. Value refers to feeling needed Social support is emotional sustenance that
and accepted. Fit refers to feeling that one meshes or comes from friends, family members, and even health
fits in with the system or environment. This means care providers who help a person when a problem
that when a person belongs to a system or group, he arises. It is different from social contact, which does
or she feels valued and worthwhile within that sup- not always provide emotional support. An example
port system (Tanner, 2001). Examples of support sys- of social contact is the friendly talk that goes on at
tems include family, friends, coworkers, club or social parties.
groups, and even health care providers.
Persons who are supported emotionally and func- have the capacity to seek help when needed, while a
tionally have been found to be healthier than those lack of well-being may cause others to withdraw from
who are not supported (Dickinson et al., 2002). Mean- potential providers of support. The nurse can help the
ingful social relationships with family or friends were client to find support people who will be available and
found to improve the health and well-being outcomes helpful and can teach the client to request support
for older adults (Bisconti & Bergeman, 1999). These re- when needed.
searchers also found that an essential element of these
improved outcomes was that the family or friends
Family Support
responded with support when it was requested. In
other words, the person must be able to count on these Family as a source of social support can be a key fac-
friends or family to help or support him or her by vis- tor in the recovery of clients with psychiatric illnesses.
iting or talking on the phone. Thus the primary com- Although family members are not always a positive
ponents of satisfactory support are the persons abil- resource in mental health, they are most often an im-
ity and willingness to request support when needed portant part of recovery (Teschinsky, 2000). Health
and the ability and willingness of the support system care professionals cannot totally replace family mem-
to respond. bers. The nurse must encourage family members to
Health care providers should encourage family continue to support the client even while he or she is
members and friends to maintain contact with clients in the hospital and should identify family strengths,
in institutional care. Studies have shown social sup- such as love and caring, as a resource for the client.
port to be beneficial for older adults with chronic men-
tal illness in institutional settings. Beeler et al. (1999) CULTURAL FACTORS
found that 75% of people living in the institution had
family contact, which is contrary to the stereotype that According to the U.S. Census Bureau, 33% of U.S.
people with mental illness in institutions lose family residents currently are members of nonwhite cul-
ties. Siblings and mothers accounted for most of the tures. By 2050, the nonwhite population will more
contacts. Residents with family contact were happier than triple. This changing composition of society has
implications for health care professionals, who are
and felt connected to their families even though they
predominantly white and unfamiliar with different
lived in an institution.
cultural beliefs and practices (Bechtel et al., 1998).
Knisely and Northouse (1994) also found that
Culturally competent nursing care means being
social support and help-seeking behaviors among
sensitive to issues related to culture, race, gender,
adult psychiatric inpatients were highly correlated:
sexual orientation, social class, economic situation,
in other words, having a social network and being
and other factors (Kennedy, 1999).
able to ask for and receive support when needed are
Nurses and other health care providers must
vital steps in the recovery process. Clients with social
learn about other cultures and become skilled at
support were more likely to seek help and participate
providing care to people with cultural backgrounds
in their treatment and felt more satisfied with their that are different from their own. Finding out about
hospital stay. anothers cultural beliefs and practices and under-
Buchanan (1995) focused on the specific elements standing their meaning is essential to providing holis-
required for a support system to be effective for the tic and meaningful care to the client (Table 7-3).
client. In a study of social support in adults with schiz-
ophrenia, Buchanan found that two key components
were necessary: the clients perception of the support Beliefs About Causes of Illness
system and the responsiveness of the support system Culture has the most influence on a persons health
(mobilization). The client must perceive that the social beliefs and practices (Campinha-Bacote, 2002). Cul-
support system bolsters his or her confidence and self- ture has been shown to influence ones concept of dis-
esteem and provides such stress-related interpersonal ease and illness. The two prevalent types of beliefs
help as offering assistance in solving a problem. The about what causes illness in non-Western cultures
client also must perceive that the actions of the sup- are personalistic and naturalistic. Personalistic be-
port system are consistent with the clients desires liefs attribute the cause of illness to the active, pur-
and expectationsin other words, the support pro- poseful intervention of an outside agent, spirit, or
vided is what the client wants, not what the supporter supernatural force or deity. The naturalistic view is
thinks would be good for the client. Also the support rooted in a belief that natural conditions or forces,
system must be able to provide direct help or material such as cold, heat, wind, or dampness, are responsi-
aid (e.g., providing transportation, making a follow-up ble for the illness (Campinha-Bacote, 2002). A sick
appointment). Buchanan explained that some people person with these beliefs would not see the relation-
142 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Table 7-3
CULTURAL BELIEFS ABOUT HEALTH AND ILLNESS
Illness Beliefs: Causes of
Culture Mental Illness Concept of Health
African American Lack of spiritual balance Feelings of well-being, able to fulfill role ex-
pectations, free of pain or excess stress
American Indians Loss of harmony with natural world, Holistic and wellness-oriented
breaking of taboos, ghosts
Arab Americans Wrath of God, sudden fears, pretending Gift of God manifested by eating well, meet-
to be ill to manipulate family ing social obligations, good mood, no
stressors or pain
Cambodians Khmer Rouge brutalities Health as equilibrium, individually maintained
but influenced by family and community
Chinese Lack of harmony of emotions, evil spirits Health maintained by balance of yin and
yang, body, mind, and spirit
Cubans Heredity, extreme stress Fat and rosy-cheeked (traditional); fitness
and staying trim (acculturated)
Filipinos Disruption of harmonious function of Maintaining balance; good health involves
individual and spirit world good food, strength, and no pain
Haitians Supernatural causes Maintenance of equilibrium by eating well,
attention to personal hygiene; prayer and
good spiritual habits
Japanese Americans Loss of mental self-control caused by Balance and harmony between oneself,
evil spirits, punishment for behavior or society, and universe
not living good life
Mexican Americans Humoral, God, spirituality, and interper- Feeling well and being able to maintain role
sonal relationships all can contribute function
Puerto Ricans Heredity, follows sufriamientos (suffering) No mental, spiritual, or physical discomforts;
being clean and not being too thin
Russians Stress and moving into new environment Regular bowel movements and no symptoms
South Asians Spells cast by enemy, falling prey to Balance of digestive fire, bodily humors, and
evil spirit waste products; senses functioning nor-
mally; body, mind, and spirit in harmony
Vietnamese Disruption of harmony in individual; Harmony and balance within oneself
ancestral spirit haunting
ship between his or her behavior or health practices ive, while other cultures find touch offensive. Some
and the illness. Thus he or she would try to counter- Asian women avoid shaking hands with one another
act the negative forces or spirits using traditional or men. Some Native American tribes believe that vig-
cultural remedies rather than taking medication or orous handshaking is aggressive, whereas people from
changing his or her health practices.
Table 7-4
CULTURAL ASSESSMENT FACTORS OF VARIOUS CULTURES AFFECTING RESPONSE TO ILLNESS
Social Time
Culture Communication Space Organization Orientation
African American Nonverbal: affec- Respect privacy, Family: nuclear, Flexible, nonlinear;
tionate, hugging, respectful ap- extended, matriar- life issues may take
touching, eye proach, hand- chal, may include priority over keep-
contact shake appropriate close friends ing appointments
Tone: may be loud
and animated
American Nonverbal: respect Light-touch hand- Family: vary; may Flexible, nonlinear;
Indians/Native communicated shake be matrilineal or flow with natural
Americans by avoiding eye patrilineal clan cycles rather than
contact scheduled, rigid
Tone: quiet, appointments
reserved
Arab American Nonverbal: expres- Prefer closeness in Family: nuclear and More past and future
sive, warm, other- space and with extended, often in than present
oriented, shy and same sex same household
modest
Tone: flowery, loud
voice means mes-
sage is important
Cambodian Nonverbal: silence Small personal Family-oriented, Flexible attitude,
welcomed rather space with one usually three tardiness for
than chatter; eye another generations in appointments
contact accept- one house expected, emphasis
able, but polite on past (remember-
women lower ing ancestors) but
their eyes also on present,
Tone: quiet because actions will
determine future
Chinese Nonverbal: eye con- Keep respectful Extended families Being on time not
tact and touching distance common, wife valued
among family and expected to be
friends; eye con- part of husbands
tact avoided with family
authority figures
Tone: expressive
and may appear
loud
Cuban Nonverbal: direct Preferences for Family-oriented, ex- Social orientation to
eye contact, personal space tended families in time varies, on
outgoing, close vary greatly same household time for business
contact and appointments
touching with
family and friends
Tone: loud in nor-
mal conversation,
direct commands
or requests may
seem forceful
Filipinos Nonverbal: shy and Handshakes not Family-oriented, Both past and present
affectionate, little usually practiced, nuclear and orientations; tardy
direct eye contact personal space extended, may for social events
with authority constricted have several but on time for
figures generations in business events like
Tone: soft-spoken, one household appointments
tone changes with
emotion
(continued )
144 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Table 7-4
(Continued )
Social Time
Culture Communication Space Organization Orientation
Haitians Nonverbal: polite, Very friendly and Close, tightly knit, Not committed to
shy, less eye con- close with family, extended family time or schedule,
tact with authority respectful hand- and nuclear fam- everyone and
figures, smile and shake with others ily, matriarchal everything can wait
nod as sign of society
respect
Tone: rich and
expressive, in-
creased volume
for emphasis
Japanese Nonverbal: quiet and Touching un- Family-oriented, Promptness impor-
American polite, reserved common, small self subordinate tant, often early for
and formal, little bow, handshake to family unit; appointments
eye contact with with younger family structure
authority figures generation hierarchical,
Tone: soft, conflict interdependence
avoided
Mexican Nonverbal: avoid Touch by strangers Mostly nuclear fami- Present-oriented, time
American direct eye contact not appreciated, lies with extended viewed as relative
with authority handshake polite family and god- to situation
figures and welcomed parents; family
Tone: respectful and comes first
polite
Puerto Ricans Nonverbal: eye Space close for fam- All activities, deci- May be late for
contact varies ily and friends, sions, social and appointments or
greatly, desire handshake with cultural standards want more time
warm and smooth others conceived around than allotted
interpersonal family
relationships
Tone: melodic,
increased volume
for emphasis
Russians Nonverbal: direct Space close for Extended family On time or early
eye contact, family and friends with strong family
nodding means and more distant bonds and great
approval for others until fa- respect for elders
Tone: sometimes miliarity is estab-
loud even in lished
pleasant
conversations
South Asians Nonverbal: direct Personal space Extended family Not extremely
eye contact constricted; hand- common, daugh- time-conscious in
considered rude; shake acceptable ter expected to social situations,
modesty, humil- for men but not move in with but on time for
ity, shyness common among husbands family appointments
emphasize women
Tone: soft, may
boss younger
people
Vietnamese Nonverbal: gentle Personal space Highly family- Fashionably late at
touch may be more distant than oriented, may social functions,
accepted in in European be nuclear or but understand
conversation, no Americans extended the importance of
eye contact with being on time for
authority appointments
Tone: soft-spoken
7 CLIENTS RESPONSE TO ILLNESS 145
Spain and France consider a firm handshake a sign of cedures or time-related treatment regimens. Health
strength and good character (Bechtel et al., 1998). care providers can become resentful and angry when
While Western cultures view direct eye contact these clients miss appointments or fail to follow spe-
as positive, Native American and Asian cultures may cific treatment regimens such as taking medications
find it rude, and people from these backgrounds may at prescribed times. Nurses should not label such
avoid looking strangers in the eye when talking to clients as noncompliant when their behavior may be
them. People from Middle Eastern cultures can main- related to a different cultural orientation to the mean-
tain very intense eye contact, which may appear to ing of time. When possible, the nurse should be sen-
be glaring to those from different cultures. These dif- sitive to the clients time orientation, as with follow-
ferences are important to note, because many people up appointments. When timing is essential as with
make inferences about a persons behavior based on some medications, the nurse can explain the impor-
the frequency or duration of eye contact. tance of more precise timing.
Chapter 6 provides a detailed discussion of com-
munication techniques.
ENVIRONMENTAL CONTROL
Environmental control refers to a clients ability
PHYSICAL DISTANCE OR SPACE
to control the surroundings or direct factors in the en-
Various cultures have different perspectives on what vironment (Bechtel et al., 1998). People who believe
they consider a comfortable physical distance from that they have control of their health are more likely
another person during communication. In the United to seek care, to change their behavior, and to follow
States and many other Western cultures, 2 to 3 feet treatment recommendations. Those who believe that
is a comfortable distance. Latin Americans and peo- illness is a result of nature or natural causes (person-
ple from the Middle East tend to stand closer to one alistic or naturalistic view) are less likely to seek tra-
another than do people in Western cultures (Bechtel ditional health care because they do not believe it can
et al., 1998). People from Asian and Native American help them.
cultures are usually more comfortable with distances
greater than 2 or 3 feet. The nurse should be conscious
BIOLOGIC VARIATIONS
of these cultural differences in space and should allow
enough room for clients to be comfortable. Biologic variations exist among people from different
cultural backgrounds, and research is just beginning
to help us understand these variations (Bechtel et al.,
SOCIAL ORGANIZATION
1998). For example, we now know that differences
Social organization refers to family structure and related to ethnicity/cultural origins cause varia-
organization, religious values and beliefs, ethnic- tions in response to some psychotropic drugs (dis-
ity, and culture, all of which affect a persons role cussed earlier). Biologic variations based on physical
and, therefore, his or her health and illness behavior makeup are said to arise from ones race, whereas
(Bechtel et al., 1998). In Western cultures, people may other cultural variations arise from ethnicity. For
seek the advice of a friend or family member or may example, sickle-cell anemia is found almost exclu-
make most decisions independently. Many Chinese, sively in African Americans, and Tay-Sachs disease
Mexican, Vietnamese, and Puerto Rican Americans is most prevalent in the Jewish community (Bechtel
strongly value the role of family in making health care et al., 1998).
decisions. People from these backgrounds may delay
making decisions until they can consult appropriate
family members. Autonomy in health care decisions
Socioeconomic Status
is an unfamiliar and undesirable concept because the
and Social Class
cultures consider the collective to be greater than the Socioeconomic status refers to ones income, edu-
individual. cation, and occupation. It strongly influences a per-
sons health including whether or not the person has
insurance and adequate access to health care or can
TIME ORIENTATION
afford prescribed treatment. People who live in poverty
Time orientation, or whether or not one views time are also at risk for threats to health such as inade-
as precise or approximate, differs among cultures. quate housing, lead paint, gang-related violence, drug
Many Western countries focus on the urgency of time, trafficking, or substandard schools (Ostrove, 1999).
valuing punctuality and precise schedules. Clients Social class has less influence in the United
from other cultures may not perceive the importance States, where barriers among the social classes are
of adhering to specific follow-up appointments or pro- loose and mobility is common: people can gain access
146 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
individual. Loss of country, family, or friends also drawn, believing they will lose body heat needed for
may cause mental illness. Such clients may seek harmony and balance (Kulig, 1996).
mental health care only as a last resort after they
have exhausted all family and community resources.
CHINESE
When sick, these clients expect family or health care
professionals to take care of them. The client will re- The Chinese are often shy in unfamiliar environ-
serve his or her energy for healing and, thus, will be ments, so socializing or friendly greetings are helpful.
likely to practice complete rest and abdication from They may avoid direct eye contact with authority fig-
all responsibilities during illness. The clients view ures to show respect; keeping a respectful distance is
mental illness more negatively than physical illness recommended (Chin, 1996). Asking questions can be
and believe mental illness to be something the per- a sign of disrespect; silence is a sign of respect. Chi-
son can control. Although early immigrants were nese is an expressive language, so loudness is not
Christians, more recent immigrants are Muslims. necessarily a sign of agitation or anger. Traditional
Prayer is very important to Muslims: strict Muslims Chinese societies tend not to highly value time ur-
pray five times a day, wash before every prayer, and gency. Extended families are common, with the eldest
pray in silence. male member of the household making decisions and
Western medicine is the primary treatment serving as the spokesperson for the family.
sought, but some may use home remedies and amulets Mental illness is thought to result from a lack of
(charms or objects used for their protective powers) harmony of emotions, or evil spirits. Health prac-
(Meleis, 1996). tices may vary according to how long immigrants
have lived in the United States. Immigrants from 40
to 60 years ago are strong believers in Chinese folk
CAMBODIANS
medicine, whereas immigrants from the last 20 years
The preferred term for people from Cambodia is combine folk and Western medicine. First- and second-
Khmer (pronounced Kami) or Sino-Khmer (if Chinese- generation Chinese Americans are mostly oriented
Cambodian). Those who have assimilated into West- to Western medicine (Chin, 1996). Many Chinese use
ern culture use a handshake for greeting, whereas herbalists and acupuncture, however, either before or
others may slightly bow, bringing the palms together in conjunction with Western medicine. Rarely these
with the fingers pointed upward, and make no contact clients will seek a spiritual healer for psychiatric
with the person they are greeting. Many Asians speak problems to rid themselves of evil spirits. Many Chi-
softly, so it is important to listen carefully rather than nese are Buddhists, but Catholic and Protestant re-
asking them to speak louder. Cambodian clients highly ligions are also common.
value politeness. Eye contact is acceptable, but women
may lower their eyes to be polite. Silences are common
CUBANS
and appropriate; nurses should avoid meaningless
chatter. These clients may consider it impolite to dis- Cubans, or Cuban Americans if born in the United
agree so they say yes when not really agreeing or in- States, are typically outgoing and may speak loudly
tending to comply. It is inappropriate to touch some- during normal conversation. Extended family is very
ones head without permission because some believe important, and often more than one generation resides
the soul is in the head. Cambodian clients usually in- in a household. These clients expect direct eye contact
clude family members in making decisions. Orienta- during conversation and may view looking away as a
tion to time can be flexible (Kulig, 1996). lack of respect or honesty. Silence indicates awkward-
Most Khmer immigrated to the United States ness or uncertainty. While orientation to social time
after 1970 and believe that mental illness is the re- may vary greatly, these clients view appointments as
sult of the Khmer Rouge war and associated brutali- business and are punctual (Varela, 1996).
ties. When ill, they assume a passive role, expecting Cuban clients view stress as a cause of both phys-
others to care for them. Many may use Western med- ical and mental illness, and some believe mental ill-
icine and traditional healing practices simultane- ness is hereditary. Mental illness is a stigma for the
ously. Buddhism is the primary religion, although family; thus, Cuban clients may hide or not publicly
some have converted to Christianity. An accha (holy acknowledge such problems. The person in the sick
person) may perform many elaborate ceremonies in role often is submissive, helpless, and dependent on
the persons home but will not do so in the hospital. others. While Cuban clients may use herbal medicine
Healers may visit the client in the hospital but are to treat minor illness at home, they usually seek West-
unlikely to disclose that they are healers, much less ern medicine for more serious illness. Most Cubans
what their practices are. Some still have a naturalis- are Catholic or belong to other Christian denomina-
tic view of illness and may be reluctant to have blood tions, so prayer and worship may be very important.
148 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
(e.g., Mexican American, Latino, Hispanic). Most pleasant conversations. Most clients are on time or
Mexicans consider a handshake to be a polite greet- early for appointments (Evanikoff, 1996).
ing but do not appreciate other touch by strangers, Russians believe the cause of mental illness to be
although touching and embracing warmly are com- stress and moving into a new environment. Some
mon among family and friends. To convey respect, Russian Christians believe illness is Gods will or a
Mexican clients may avoid direct eye contact with test of faith. Sick people often put themselves on bed
authority figures. They usually prefer polite social rest. Many Russians do not like to take any medica-
interaction to help establish rapport before answering tions and will try home remedies first. Some older
health-related questions. Generally one or two ques- Russians believe that excessive drug use can be
tions will produce a wealth of information, so listen- harmful and that many medicines can be more dam-
ing is important. Silence is often a sign of disagree- aging than natural remedies. Primary religious affil-
ment, which these clients may use in place of words. iations are Eastern Orthodox with a minority being
Orientation to time is flexible; the client may be 15 or Jewish or Protestant (Evanikoff, 1996).
20 minutes late for an appointment but will not con-
sider that as being late (Miller & Davidhizar, 2001).
There is no clear separation of mental and phys- SOUTH ASIANS
ical illness. Many have a naturalistic or personal- South Asians living in the United States include peo-
istic view of illness and believe disease is based on ple from India, Pakistan, Bangladesh, Sri Lanka,
the imbalance of the person and the environment Nepal, Fiji, and East Africa. Preferred terms of
including emotional, spiritual, social, and physical identification may be related to geography, such as
factors (Mendelson, 2002). Mexican Americans may South Asians, East Indians, Asian Indians, or Indo-
seek medical care for severe symptoms while still
Americans, or by religious affiliation such as Sikhs,
using folk medicine to deal with spiritual or psychic
Hindus, or Muslims. Greetings are expressed orally
influences. Eighty percent to 90% of Mexican Ameri-
as well as in gestures. Hindus and Sikhs press their
cans are Catholic and observe the rites and sacra-
palms together while saying namaste (Hindus) or
ments of this religion (de Paula et al., 1996).
sasariyakal (Sikhs). Muslims take the palm of the
right hand to their forehead and bow slightly while
PUERTO RICANS saying AsSalamOAlaikuum. Shaking hands is com-
mon among men but not women. Touching is not com-
Preferences for personal space vary among Puerto
mon among South Asians; rather, they express feel-
Ricans, so it is important to assess each individual.
ings through eyes and facial expressions. They may
Typically, older and more traditional people prefer
greater distance and less direct eye contact, while consider direct eye contact, especially with elders,
younger people prefer direct eye contact and less dis- rude or disrespectful. Silence usually indicates accep-
tance with others. Puerto Ricans desire warm and tance, approval, or tolerance. Most South Asians have
smooth interpersonal relationships and may express a soft tone of voice and consider loudness to be dis-
gratitude to health care providers with homemade respectful. Although not time-conscious about social
traditional cooking; these clients might interpret the activities, most South Asians are punctual for sched-
refusal of such an offer as an insult. There may be uled appointments for health care (Lee et al., 2001).
some difficulty being on time for appointments or South Asians believe mental illness to result
limiting the length of an appointment (Juarbe, 1996). from spells cast by an enemy or possession by evil
Physical illness is seen as hereditary, punish- spirits. Those who believe in Ayurvedic philosophy
ment for sin, or lack of attention to personal health. may think a person is susceptible to mental problems
Mental illness is believed to be hereditary or a result related to physical imbalances in the body. Sick peo-
of sufriamientos (suffering). Mental illness carries ple usually assume a passive role and want to rest
great stigma, and past or present history of mental and be relieved of daily responsibilities. Hindus wor-
illness may not be acknowledged. Religious and spiri- ship many gods and goddesses and believe in a social
tual practices are very important, and these clients caste system. Hindus believe that reciting charms
may use spiritual healers or healing practices (Juarbe, and performing rituals will eliminate diseases, ene-
1996). mies, sins, and demons. Many believe that yoga will
eliminate certain mental illnesses. Muslims believe
in one God and pray five times daily after washing
RUSSIANS
their hands. They believe that reciting verses from
A formal greeting or a handshake with direct eye the holy Koran will eliminate diseases and ease suf-
contact is acceptable. These clients reserve touching fering. Sikhs also believe in one god and the equality
or embracing and kissing on the cheeks for close of all people. Spiritual healing practices and prayer
friends and family. Tone of voice can be loud even in are common, but South Asians living in the United
150 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
States readily seek health care from Western physi- A clients health practices and religious beliefs
cians as well (Lee et al., 2001). are other important areas to assess. The nurse can
ask, Do you follow any dietary preferences or re-
strictions? and How can I assist you in practicing
VIETNAMESE your religious or spiritual beliefs? The nurse also can
Vietnamese greet with a smile and bow. A health care gain an understanding of the clients health and ill-
provider should not shake a womans hand unless she ness beliefs by asking, How do you think this health
offers her hand first. Touch in communication is more problem came about? and What kinds of remedies
limited among older, more traditional people. Viet- have you tried at home?
namese may consider the head sacred and the feet An open and objective approach to the client is
profane, so the order of touching is important. As a essential. Clients will be more likely to share per-
sign of respect, many of these clients avoid direct eye sonal and cultural information if the nurse is gen-
contact with those in authority and elders. Personal uinely interested in knowing and does not appear
space is more distant than it is for European Ameri- skeptical or judgmental.
cans. Typically the Vietnamese are soft-spoken and The nurse should ask these same questions even
consider raising the voice and pointing to be dis- to clients from his or her own cultural background.
respectful. They also may consider open expression Again, people in a cultural group vary widely, so the
of emotions or conflict to be bad taste. Punctuality nurse should not assume that he or she knows what
for appointments is usual (Jamin et al., 1999). a client believes or practices just because the nurse
Vietnamese believe mental illness to be the re- shares the same culture.
sult of individual disharmony or an ancestral spirit
returning to haunt the person because of past bad be- SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES
havior. When sick, clients assume a passive role and
expect to have everything their way. The nurse must be aware of the factors
The two primary religions are Catholicism and that influence a clients response to illness including
Buddhism. Catholics recite the rosary and say prayers the individual, interpersonal, and cultural factors
and may wish to see a priest daily. Buddhists pray discussed above. Assessment of these factors can
silently to themselves.
Vietnamese people believe in both Western med-
icine and folk medicine. Some believe that traditional
healers can exorcise evil spirits. Other health prac-
tices include coin rubbing, pinching the skin, acupunc-
ture, and herbal medicine (Jamin et al., 1999).
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
Self-efficacy is a belief that a persons abili- preferred terms of address and ways the
ties and efforts can influence the events in nurse can help support the clients spiritual,
her or his life. A persons sense of self-efficacy religious, or health practices.
is an important factor in coping with stress For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com.
and illness.
Hardiness is a persons ability to resist illness
when under stress.
REFERENCES
Resilience is a persons ability to respond in
healthy manner to stressful circumstances or Adams, S. M., & Partee, D. J. (1998). Hope: The critical
risky situations. factor in recovery. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing,
Resourcefulness is demonstrated in ones 36(4), 2932.
Andrews, M. M., & Boyle, J. S. (2003). Transcultural con-
ability to manage daily activities and is a cepts in nursing care (4th ed.). Philadelphia: Lippin-
personal characteristic acquired through cott Williams & Wilkins.
interactions with others. Auchus, M. P., Wood, K., & Kaslow, N. (1995). Exercise
Spirituality involves the inner core of a per- patterns of psychiatric patients admitted to a short-
sons being and his or her beliefs about the term inpatient unit. Psychosocial Rehabilitation
meaning of life and the purpose for living. Journal, 18(3), 137145.
Bandura, A. (1997). Insights: Self-efficacy. Harvard
It may include belief in God or a higher Mental Health Letter, 13(9), 46.
power, the practice of religion, cultural be- Baetz, M., Larson, D. B. Marcoux, G., Bowen, R., &
liefs and practices, and a relationship with Griffin, R. (2002). Canadian psychiatric inpatient
the environment. religious commitment: An association with mental
Interpersonal factors that influence the health. Canadian Journal of Psychiatry, 47(2),
clients response to illness include a sense of 159166.
Bechtel, G., Giger, J. N., & Davidhizar, R. (1998). Case
belonging, or personal involvement in a sys- managing patients from other cultures. Journal of
tem or environment, and social networks, Care Management, 4(5), 8791.
which provide social support or emotional Beeler, J., Rosenthal, A., & Cohler, B. (1999). Patterns
sustenance. of family caregiving and support to older psychiatric
The increasing social and cultural diversity patients in long-term care. Psychiatric Services,
in the United States and Canada makes it 50(9), 12221224.
Benishek, L. A., & Lopez, F. G. (1997). Critical evaluation
essential for nurses to be knowledgeable of hardiness theory: Gender differences, perception of
about the health and cultural practices of life events, and neuroticism. Work & Stress, 11(3),
various ethnic or racial groups. To provide 3345.
competent nursing care, nurses must be sen- Bisconti, T. L., & Bergeman, C. S. (1999). Perceived social
sitive to and knowledgeable about factors that control as a mediator of the relationships among
social support, psychological well-being, and per-
influence the care of clients including issues
ceived health. Gerontologist, 39(1), 94103.
related to culture, race, gender, sexual orien- Buchanan, B. W., & Carpenter, W. T. (2000). Schizophre-
tation, and social and economic situation. nia: Introduction and overview. In B. J. Sadock &
Culture has the most influence on a persons V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psy-
health beliefs and behaviors. chiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 10961110). Philadelphia:
A model for assessing clients from various Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Buchanan, J. (1995). Social support and schizophrenia:
ethnic backgrounds includes six cultural
A review of the literature. Archives of Psychiatric
phenomena: communication techniques and Nursing, 9(2), 6876.
style, physical distance and space, social Calvert, W. J. (1997). Protective factors within the fam-
organization, time orientation, environmen- ily, and their role in fostering resiliency in African
tal control, and biologic variations. American adolescents. Journal of Cultural Diversity,
Socioeconomic status has a strong influence 4(4), 110117.
Campinha-Bacote, J. (2002). The process of cultural
on a persons health. It may determine
competence in the delivery of health care services:
whether or not the person has insurance, A model of care. Journal of Transcultural Nursing,
adequate access to health care, or the ability 13(3), 181184.
to afford prescribed treatment. Chin, P. (1996). Chinese Americans. In J. G. Lipson,
Knowledge of various cultural patterns and S. L. Dibble, & P. A. Minarik (Eds.), Culture & nurs-
differences helps the nurse begin to relate to ing care: A pocket guide (pp. 7481). San Francisco:
UCSF Nursing Press.
persons of different ethnic backgrounds.
Colin, J. M., & Paperwalla, G. (1996). Haitians. In J. P.
Nurses who are unsure of a persons social Lipson, S. L. Dibble, & P. A. Minarik (Eds.), Culture
or cultural preferences need to ask the client and nursing care: A pocket guide (pp. 139154).
directly during the initial encounter about San Francisco: USCF Nursing Press.
7 CLIENTS RESPONSE TO ILLNESS 153
dela Cruz, F. A., McBride, M. R., Compus, L. B., Calixto, of Human Behavior in the Social Environment,
P., & Van Derveer, C. P. (2002). White paper on the 3(3/4), 159178.
health status of Filipino Americans and recommen- Longo, D. A., & Peterson, S. A. (2002). The role of spiritu-
dations for research. Nursing Outlook, 50(1), 715. ality in psychosocial rehabilitation. Psychiatric Reha-
de Paula, T., Lagana, K., & Gonzales-Ramirez, L. (1996). bilitation Journal, 25(4), 333340.
Mexican Ameericans. In J. G. Lipson, S. L. Dibble, Low, J. (1999). The concept of hardiness: Persistent prob-
P. A. Minarik (Eds.), Culture & nursing care: A lems, persistent appeal. Holistic Nursing Practice,
pocket guide (pp. 203221). San Francisco: USCF 13(3), 2024.
Nursing Press. Lunt, A. (2001). Risk and uncertainty. Psychiatric Reha-
Dickenson, D., Green, G., Hayes, C., Gilheany, B., & bilitation Journal, 25(1), 8992.
Whittaker, A. (2002). Social network and social sup- Meisenhelder, J., & Chandler, E. (2000). Faith, prayer,
port characteristics amongst individuals recently dis- and health outcomes in elderly Native Americans.
charged from acute psychiatric units. Journal of Psy- Clinical Nursing Research, 9(2), 191203.
chiatric & Mental Health Nursing, 47(2), 114123. Meleis, A. I. (1996). Arab Americans. In J. G. Lipson,
Dirksen, S. R. (2000). Predicting well-being among breast S. L. Dibble, & P. A. Minarik (Eds.), Culture & nurs-
cancer survivors. Journal of Advanced Nursing, ing care: A pocket guide (pp. 2336). San Francisco:
32(4), 937943. UCSF Nursing Press.
Evanikoff, L. J. (1996). Russians. In J. G. Lipson, S. L. Mendelson, C. (2002). Health perceptions of Mexican
Dibble, & P. A. Minarik (Eds.), Culture & nursing American women. Journal of Transcultural Nursing,
care: A pocket guide (pp. 239249). San Francisco: 13(3), 210217.
UCSF Nursing Press. Miller, S. W., & Davidhizar, R. (2001). Sociocultural as-
Fallot, R. D. (2001). Spirituality and religion in psychi- pects of adherence to medical regimens for Mexican
atric rehabilitation and recovery from mental illness. Americans. Case Management, 7(3), 4446.
International Review of Psychiatry, 13(2), 110116. Mohr, W. K. (1998). Cross-ethnic variations in the care of
Fields, S. D. (2001). The health belief system of African psychiatric patients: A review of contributing factors
Americans: Essential information for todays practic- and practice considerations. Journal of Psychosocial
ing nurses. Journal of Multicultural Nursing & Nursing, 36(5), 1621.
Health, 7(1), 3640. Musgrave, C. F., Allen, C. E., & Allen, G. J. (2002). Spiri-
Harris, L. (2001). How to survive anything. Self, 23(6), tuality and health for women of color. American
144148.
Journal of Public Health, 92(4), 557560.
Harvard Womens Health Watch. (2001). At the heart of
Ostrove, J. M., Feldman, P., & Adler, N. E. (1999). Rela-
recovery, personal resilience. 9(3), 1.
tions among socioeconomic status indicators and
Hill, R. B. (1998). Enhancing the resilience of African
health for African Americans and whites. Journal of
American families. Journal of Human Behavior in
the Social Environment, 1(2/3), 4961. Health Psychology, 4(4), 451462.
Jamin, D., Yoo, J., Moldoveanu, M., & Tran, L. (1999). Viet- Pollock, S. E. (1986). Human responses to chronic illness:
namese and Armenian health attitudes survey. Jour- Physiological and psychosocial adaptation. Nursing
nal of Multicultural Nursing & Health, 5(1), 614. Research, 35(2), 9095.
Juarbe, T. (1996). Puerto Ricans. In J. G. Lipson, S. L. Ross, N. (2002). Community belonging and health. Health
Dibble, & P. A. Minarik (Eds.), Culture and nursing Reports, 13(3), 3340.
care: A pocket guide (pp. 222238). San Francisco: Rutter, M. (1987). Psychosocial resilience and protective
USCF Nursing Press. mechanisms. American Journal of Orthopsychiatry,
Knisely, J. E., & Northouse, L. (1994). The relationship 57(3), 316331.
between social support, help-seeking behavior, and Shiba, G., & Oka, R. (1996). Japanese Americans.
psychological distress in psychiatric clients. Archives In J. G. Lipson, S. L. Dibble, & P. A. Minarik
of Psychiatric Nursing, 8(6), 357365. (Eds.), Culture & nursing care: A pocket guide
Kobasa, S. C. (1979). Stressful life events, personality, (pp. 180190). San Francisco: UCSF Nursing
and health: An inquiry into hardiness. Journal of Press.
Personality & Social Psychology, 37(1), 111. Tanner, D. (2001). Sustaining the self in later life: Sup-
Kulig, J. C. (1996). Cambodians (Khmer). In J. G. Lipson, porting older people in the community. Ageing &
S. L. Dibble, & P. A. Minarik (Eds.), Culture & nurs- Society, 21(3), 255278.
ing care: A pocket guide (pp. 5563). San Francisco: Teschinsky, U. (2000). Living with schizophrenia: The
UCSF Nursing Press. family illness experience. Issues in Mental Health
Lambert, V. A., Lambert, C. E., Klipple, G. L., & Mew- Nursing, 21(4).
shaw, E. A. (1990). Relationships among hardiness, Varela, L. (1996). Cubans. In J. G. Lipson, S. L. Dibble,
social support, severity of illness, and psychological & P. A. Minarik (Eds.), Culture and nursing care:
well-being in women with rheumatoid arthritis. A pocket guide (pp. 91100). San Francisco: USCF
Health Care for Women International, 35(2), 159173. Nursing Press.
Kennedy, M. G. (1999). Cultural competence and Webster, C., & Austin, W. (1999). Health-related hardi-
psychiatric-mental health nursing. Journal of ness and the effect of a psycho-educational group on
Transcultural Nursing, 10(1), 11. clients symptoms. Journal of Psychiatric and Mental
Krafcik, K. A. (2002). Predictors of resourcefulness in Health Nursing, 6(3), 241247.
school aged children. Issues in Mental Health Nurs-
ing, 23(4), 385407.
Lease, S. H. (1999). Occupational role stressors, coping, ADDITIONAL READINGS
support, and hardiness as predictors of strain. Re-
search in Higher Education, 40(3), 285307. Baker, F. M. (1994). Psychiatric treatment of older
Lee, J., Lei, A., & Sue, S. (2001). The current state of African Americans. Hospital and Community Psy-
mental health research on Asian Americans. Journal chiatry, 45(1), 3237.
154 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Borge, L., Martinsen, E. W., Ruud, T., Watne, O., & Friis, views of the etiology and treatment of mental health
S. (1999). Quality of life, loneliness, and social con- problems. Community Mental Health Journal, 2(3),
tact among long-term psychiatric patients. Psychi- 235241.
atric Services, 50(1), 8184. Nelson, G., Hall, G. B., & Walsh-Bowers, R. (1998). The
Bowsher, J. E., & Keep, D. (1995). Toward an under- relationship between housing characteristics, emo-
standing of three control constructs: Personal con- tional well-being, and the personal empowerment of
trol, self-efficacy, and hardiness. Issues in Mental psychiatric consumers/survivors. Community Mental
Health Nursing, 16(1), 3350. Health Journal, 34(1), 5769.
Callahan, P., Young-Cureton, G., Zalar, M., & Wahl, S. Nicholas, P. K., & Leuner, J. D. (1999). Hardiness, social
(1997). Relationship between tolerance/intolerance of support, and health status: Are there differences in
ambiguity and perceived environmental uncertainty
older African American and Anglo-American adults?
in hospitals. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing, 35(11),
Holistic Nursing Practice, 13(3), 5361.
3944.
Finley, L. Y. (1998). The cultural context: Families coping Sims, E. M., Pernell-Arnold, A., Graham, R., et al. (1998).
with severe mental illness. Psychiatric Rehabilitation Principles of multicultural psychiatric rehabilitation
Journal, 21(3), 23040. services. Psychiatric Rehabilitation Journal, 21(3),
Jordan, J. B. (1997). Mental health considerations with 219223.
the Yupik Eskimo. Alaska Medicine, 39(3), 6770. Solomon, P., & Draine, J. (1995). Adaptive coping among
Low, J. (1996). The concept of hardiness: A brief but criti- family members of persons with serious mental ill-
cal commentary. Journal of Advanced Nursing, 24, ness. Psychiatric Services, 46(11), 11561160.
588590. Tuck, I. (1997). The cultural context of mental health
Meadows, M. (1997). Mental health and medicine: Cul- nursing. Issues in Mental Health Nursing, 18(3),
tural considerations in treating Asians. Minority 269281.
Nurse Newsletter, 4(4), 12. Weaver, H. N., & White, B. J. (1997). The Native Ameri-
Millet, P. E., Sullivan, B. F., Schwebel, A. I., & Myers, can family: Roots of resiliency. Journal of Family So-
L. J. (1996). Black Americans and white Americans cial Work, 2(1), 6779.
Chapter Study Guide
MULTIPLE-CHOICE QUESTIONS
Select the best answer for each of the following
questions.
155
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify the developmental task that corresponds to the following age groups,
according to Erik Erikson.
Infant
School age
Adolescence
Young adult
Maturity
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
1. Briefly explain culturally competent nursing care.
156
8 Assessment
Learning Objectives
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to Key Terms
abstract thinking labile
1. Identify the categories used
to assess the clients affect loose associations
mental health status. automatism mood
2. Formulate questions to blunted affect neologisms
obtain information in each
category. broad affect psychomotor retardation
3. Describe the clients func- circumstantial thinking restricted affect
tioning in terms of self- concrete thinking self-concept
concept, roles, and
relationships. delusion tangential thinking
4. Recognize key physiologic duty to warn thought blocking
functions that frequently flat affect thought broadcasting
are impaired in people with
mental disorders. flight of ideas thought content
5. Obtain and organize hallucinations thought insertion
psychosocial assessment ideas of reference thought process
data to use as a basis for
inappropriate affect thought withdrawal
planning nursing care.
6. Examine ones own feelings insight waxy flexibility
and any discomfort dis- judgment word salad
cussing suicide, homicide,
or self-harm behaviors with
a client.
157
158 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Assessment is the first step of the nursing process and have difficulty answering questions directly. The client
involves the collection, organization, and analysis may minimize or maximize symptoms or problems or
of information about the clients health (American may refuse to provide information in some areas. The
Nurses Association [ANA], 2000). In psychiatric- nurse must address the clients feelings and percep-
mental health nursing, this process is often referred to tions to establish a trusting, working relationship be-
as a psychosocial assessment, which includes a mental fore proceeding with the assessment.
status examination. The purpose of the psychosocial
assessment is to construct a picture of the clients cur-
rent emotional state, mental capacity, and behavioral Clients Ability to Understand
function. This assessment serves as the basis for de-
The nurse also must determine the clients ability to
veloping a plan of care to meet the clients needs. The
hear, read, and understand the language being used
assessment is also a clinical baseline used to evaluate
in the assessment. If the clients primary language dif-
the effectiveness of treatment and interventions or a
fers from that of the nurse, the client may misunder-
measure of the clients progress (ANA, 2000).
stand or misinterpret what the nurse is asking, which
results in inaccurate information. A client with im-
FACTORS INFLUENCING paired hearing also may fail to understand what the
ASSESSMENT nurse is asking. It is important that the information
in the assessment reflects the clients health status; it
Client Participation/Feedback should not be a result of poor communication.
A thorough and complete psychosocial assessment re-
quires active client participation. If the client is unable
or unwilling to participate, some areas of the assess- Nurses Attitude and Approach
ment will be incomplete or vague. For example, the The nurses attitude and approach can influence the
client who is extremely depressed may not have the psychosocial assessment. If the client perceives the
energy to answer questions or complete the assess- nurses questions to be short and curt or feels rushed
ment. Clients exhibiting psychotic thought processes or pressured to complete the assessment, he or she
or impaired cognition may have an insufficient atten- may provide only superficial information or omit dis-
tion span or may be unable to comprehend the ques- cussing problems in some areas altogether. The client
tions being asked. The nurse may need to have several also may refrain from providing sensitive information
contacts with such clients to complete the assessment if he or she perceives the nurse as nonaccepting, de-
or gather further information as the clients condition fensive, or judgmental. For example, a client may be
permits. reluctant to relate instances of child abuse or domes-
tic violence if the nurse seems uncomfortable or non-
Clients Health Status accepting. The nurse must be aware of his or her own
feelings and responses and be able to approach the as-
The clients health status also can affect the psycho- sessment matter-of-factly.
social assessment. If the client is anxious, tired, or in
pain, the nurse may have difficulty eliciting the clients
full participation in the assessment. The information HOW TO CONDUCT THE INTERVIEW
that the nurse obtains may reflect the clients pain or
anxiety, rather than be an accurate assessment of Environment
the clients situation. The nurse needs to recognize The nurse should conduct the psychosocial assess-
these situations and deal with them before continu- ment in an environment that is comfortable, private,
ing the full assessment. The client may need to rest, and safe for both the client and the nurse. An envi-
receive medications to alleviate pain, or be calmed be- ronment that is fairly quiet with few distractions al-
fore the assessment can continue. lows the client to give his or her full attention to the
interview. Conducting the interview in a place such
as a conference room assures the client that no one
Clients Previous Experiences/ will overhear what is being discussed. The nurse
Misconceptions About Health Care should not choose an isolated location for the inter-
The clients perception of his or her circumstances can view, however, particularly if the client is unknown
elicit emotions that interfere with obtaining an accu- to the nurse or has a history of any threatening be-
rate psychosocial assessment. If the client is reluctant havior. The nurse must ensure the safety of self and
to seek treatment or has had previous unsatisfactory client even if that means another person is present
experiences with the health care system, he or she may during the assessment.
8 ASSESSMENT 159
Input From Family and Friends nonjudgmental language and a matter-of-fact tone
avoids giving the client verbal cues to become defen-
If family members, friends, or caregivers have accom- sive or to not tell the truth. For example, when ask-
panied the client, the nurse should obtain their per- ing a client about his or her parenting role, the nurse
ceptions of the clients behavior and emotional state should ask, What types of discipline do you use?
(McBride & Walden-McBride, 1995). How this is done rather than, How often do you physically punish your
depends on the situation. Sometimes the client does child? The first question is more likely to elicit honest
not give permission for the nurse to conduct separate and accurate information; the second question gives
interviews with family members. The nurse should the impression that physical discipline is wrong, and
then be aware that friends or family may not feel com- it may cause the client to respond dishonestly.
fortable talking about the client in his or her presence
and may provide limited information. Or the client
may not feel comfortable participating in the assess- CONTENT OF THE ASSESSMENT
ment without family or friends. This, too, may limit The information gathered in a psychosocial assess-
the amount or type of information the nurse obtains. ment can be organized in many different ways. Most
It is desirable to conduct at least part of the assess- assessment tools or conceptual frameworks contain
ment without others especially in cases of suspected similar categories with some variety in arrangement
abuse or intimidation. The nurse should make every or order. The nurse should use some kind of organiz-
effort to assess the client in privacy in cases of sus- ing framework so that he or she can assess the client
pected abuse. in a thorough and systematic way that lends itself to
analysis and serves as a basis for the clients care. The
framework for psychosocial assessment discussed here
How to Phrase Questions and used throughout this textbook contains the fol-
The nurse may use open-ended questions to start the lowing components:
assessment (see Chap. 6). Doing so allows the client History
to begin as he or she feels comfortable and also gives General appearance and motor behavior
the nurse an idea about the clients perception of his Mood and affect
or her situation. Examples of open-ended questions Thought process and content
are as follows: Sensorium and intellectual processes
What brings you here today? Judgment and insight
Tell me what has been happening to you. Self-concept
How can we help you? Roles and relationships
If the client cannot organize his or her thoughts Physiologic and self-care concerns
or has difficulty answering open-ended questions, the Box 8-1 lists the factors that the nurse should
nurse may need to use more direct questions to ob- include in each of these areas of the psychosocial
tain information. Questions need to be clear, simple, assessment.
and focused on one specific behavior or symptom;
they should not cause the client to remember several
History
things at once. Questions regarding several different
behaviors or symptomsHow are your eating and Background assessments include the clients history,
sleeping habits, and have you been taking any over- age and developmental stage, cultural and spiritual
the-counter medications that affect your eating and beliefs, and beliefs about health and illness. The his-
sleeping?can be confusing to the client. tory of the client, as well as his or her family, may pro-
The following are examples of focused or closed- vide some insight into the clients current situation.
ended questions: For example, has the client experienced similar diffi-
How many hours did you sleep last night? culties in the past? Has the client been admitted to the
Have you been thinking about suicide? hospital, and, if so, what was that experience like? A
How much alcohol have you been drinking? family history that is positive for alcoholism, bipolar
How well have you been sleeping? disorder, or suicide is significant because it increases
How many meals a day do you eat? the clients risk for these problems.
What over-the-counter medications are you The clients chronologic age and developmental
taking? stage are important factors in the psychosocial as-
The nurse should use a nonjudgmental tone and sessment. The nurse evaluates the clients age and de-
language particularly when asking about sensitive in- velopmental level for congruence with expected norms.
formation such as drug or alcohol use, sexual behavior, For example, a client may be struggling with personal
abuse or violence, and childrearing practices. Using identity and attempting to achieve independence from
160 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Box 8-1
PSYCHOSOCIAL ASSESSMENT COMPONENTS
History Abnormal sensory experiences or misperceptions
Age Concentration
Developmental stage Abstract thinking abilities
Cultural considerations Judgment and insight
Spiritual beliefs Judgment (interpretation of environment)
Previous history Decision-making ability
General assessment and motor behavior Insight (understanding ones own part in current
Hygiene and grooming situation)
Appropriate dress Self-concept
Posture Personal view of self
Eye contact Description of physical self
Unusual movements or mannerisms Personal qualities or attributes
Speech Roles and relationships
Mood and affect Current roles
Expressed emotions Satisfaction with roles
Facial expression Success at roles
Thought process and content Significant relationships
Content (what client is thinking) Support systems
Process (how client is thinking) Physiologic and self-care considerations
Clarity of ideas Eating habits
Self-harm or suicide urges Sleep patterns
Sensorium and intellectual processes Health problems
Orientation Compliance with prescribed medications
Confusion Ability to perform activities of daily living
Memory
his or her parents. If the client is 17 years old, these cultures, such as Japan, consider such eye contact to
struggles are normal and anticipated because these be a sign of disrespect.
are two of the primary developmental tasks for the The nurse must not stereotype clients. Just be-
adolescent. If the client is 35 years old and still strug- cause a persons physical characteristics are consis-
gling with these issues of self-identity and indepen- tent with a particular race, he or she may not have
dence, the nurse will need to explore the situation. the attitudes, beliefs, and behaviors traditionally
The clients age and developmental level also may be attributed to that group. For example, many people
incongruent with expected norms if the client has a of Asian ancestry have beliefs and values that are
developmental delay or mental retardation. more consistent with Western beliefs and values than
The nurse must be sensitive to the clients cul- with those typically associated with Asian coun-
tural and spiritual beliefs to avoid making inaccurate tries. To avoid making inaccurate assumptions, the
assumptions about his or her psychosocial function- nurse must ask clients about the beliefs or health
ing (Schultz & Videbeck, 2002). Many cultures have practices that are important to them or how they
beliefs and values about a persons role in society or view themselves in the context of society or relation-
acceptable social or personal behavior that may dif- ships. (See the section on cultural considerations in
fer from those of the nurse. Western cultures gener- Chap. 7).
ally expect that as a person reaches adulthood, he or The nurse also must consider the clients beliefs
she becomes financially independent, leaves home, about health and illness when assessing the clients
and makes his or her own life decisions. In contrast, psychosocial functioning. Some people view emotional
in some Eastern cultures three generations may live or mental problems as family concerns to be handled
in one household and elders of the family make major only among family members. They may view seeking
life decisions for all. Another example is the assess- outside or professional help as a sign of individual
ment of eye contact. Western cultures consider good weakness. Others may believe that their problems can
eye contact to be a positive characteristic indicating be solved only with the right medication and they will
self-esteem and paying attention. People from other not accept other forms of therapy. Another common
8 ASSESSMENT 161
loses track of time, then place, and lastly person. Ori- ing abilities are lacking. When the client continually
entation returns in the reverse order: first, the person gives literal translations, this is evidence of concrete
knows who he or she is, then realizes place, and finally thinking. For instance:
time. Proverb: A stitch in time saves nine.
Disorientation is not synonymous with confu- Abstract meaning: If you take the time to fix
sion. A confused person cannot make sense of his or something now, youll avoid bigger problems
her surroundings or figure things out even though he in the future.
or she may be fully oriented. Literal translation: Dont forget to sew up
holes in your clothes (concrete thinking).
Proverb: People who live in glass houses
MEMORY shouldnt throw stones.
The nurse directly assesses memory, both recent and Abstract meaning: Dont criticize others for
remote, by asking questions with verifiable answers. things you also may be guilty of doing.
For example, if the nurse asks, Do you have any mem- Literal translation: If you throw a stone at a
ory problems? the client may inaccurately respond glass house, it will break (concrete thinking).
no, and the nurse cannot verify that. Similarly if the The nurse also may assess the clients intellectual
nurse asks, What did you do yesterday? the nurse functioning by asking him or her to identify the simi-
may be unable to verify the accuracy of the clients re- larities between pairs of objects: for example, What is
sponses. Hence questions to assess memory generally similar about an apple and an orange? or What do
include ones such as: the newspaper and the television have in common?
What is the name of the current president?
Who was the president before that? Sensory-Perceptual Alterations
In what county do you live?
Some clients experience hallucinations (false sen-
What is the capital of this state?
sory perceptions, or perceptual experiences that do
What is your social security number?
not really exist). Hallucinations can involve the five
senses and bodily sensations. Auditory hallucinations
ABILITY TO CONCENTRATE (hearing voices) are the most common; visual halluci-
nations (seeing things that dont really exist) are the
The nurse assesses the clients ability to concentrate
second most common. Initially clients perceive hallu-
by asking the client to perform certain tasks such as: cinations as real experiences, but later in the illness
Spell the word world backward. they may recognize them as hallucinations.
Begin with the number 100, subtract seven,
subtract seven again, and so on. This is
called serial sevens. Judgment and Insight
Repeat the days of the week backward. Judgment refers to the ability to interpret ones en-
Perform a three-part task such as, Take a vironment and situation correctly and to adapt ones
piece of paper in your right hand, fold it in behavior and decisions accordingly (Chow & Cum-
half, and put it on the floor. (The nurse mings, 2000). Problems with judgment may be evi-
should give the instructions at one time.) denced as the client describes recent behavior and ac-
tivities that reflect a lack of reasonable care for self or
ABSTRACT THINKING AND others. For example, the client may spend large sums
INTELLECTUAL ABILITIES of money on frivolous items when he or she cannot af-
ford basic necessities such as food or clothing. Risky
When assessing intellectual functioning, the nurse behaviors such as picking up strangers in bars or un-
must consider the clients level of formal education. protected sexual activity also may indicate poor judg-
Lack of formal education could hinder performance ment. The nurse also may assess a clients judgment
in many tasks in this section. by asking the client hypothetical questions such as,
The nurse assesses the clients ability to use ab- If you found a stamped, addressed envelope on the
stract thinking, which is to make associations or ground, what would you do?
interpretations about a situation or comment. The Insight is the ability to understand the true na-
nurse usually can do so by asking the client to inter- ture of ones situation and accept some personal re-
pret a common proverb such as a stitch in time saves sponsibility for that situation. The nurse frequently
nine. If the client can explain the proverb correctly, can infer insight from the clients ability to describe re-
his or her abstract thinking abilities are intact. If the alistically the strengths and weaknesses of his or her
client provides a literal explanation of the proverb behavior. An example of poor insight would be a client
and cannot interpret its meaning, abstract think- who places all blame on others for his own behavior,
164 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
saying, Its my wifes fault that I drink and get into Roles and Relationships
fights, because she nags me all the time. This client
is not accepting responsibility for his drinking and People function in their community through various
fighting. Another example of poor insight would be the roles such as mother, wife, son, daughter, teacher, sec-
client who expects all problems to be solved with little retary, or volunteer. The nurse assesses the roles the
or no personal effort, saying, The problem is my med- client occupies, client satisfaction with those roles,
ication. As soon as the doctor gets the medication right, and if the client believes he or she is fulfilling the roles
Ill be just fine. adequately (Hanna & Roy, 2001). The number and
type of roles may vary, but they usually include fam-
ily, occupation, and hobbies or activities. Family roles
Self-Concept include son or daughter, sibling, parent, child, and
Self-concept is the way one views oneself in terms of spouse or partner. Occupation roles can be related to
personal worth and dignity. To assess a clients self- a career, school, or both. The ability to fulfill a role or
concept, the nurse can ask the client to describe him- the lack of a desired role is often central to the clients
self or herself and what characteristics he or she likes psychosocial functioning. Changes in roles also may be
and what he or she would change. The clients descrip- part of the clients difficulty.
tion of self in terms of physical characteristics gives Relationships with other people are important to
the nurse information about the clients body image, ones social and emotional health. Relationships vary
which is also part of self-concept. in terms of significance, level of intimacy or closeness,
Also included in an assessment of self-concept and intensity. The inability to sustain satisfying rela-
are the emotions that the client frequently experi- tionships can result from mental health problems or
ences, such as sadness or anger, and whether or not can contribute to the worsening of some problems. The
the client is comfortable with those emotions. The nurse must assess the relationships in the clients life,
nurse also must assess the clients coping strategies. the clients satisfaction with those relationships, or
He or she can do so by asking, What do you do when any loss of relationships. Common questions include
you have a problem? How do you solve it? What usu- the following:
ally works to deal with anger or disappointment? Do you feel close to your family?
Do you have or want a relationship with a
significant other?
Are your relationships meeting your needs
for companionship or intimacy?
Can you meet your sexual needs
satisfactorily?
Have you been involved in any abusive
relationships?
If the clients family relationships seem to be a
significant source of stress or if the client is closely
involved with his or her family, a more in-depth as-
sessment of this area may be useful. Box 8-3 is the
McMaster Family Assessment Device, an example of
such an in-depth family assessment.
Box 8-3
MCMASTER FAMILY ASSESSMENT DEVICE
Instructions: Following are a number of statements about families. Please read each statement carefully, and decide
how well it describes your own family. You should answer according to how you see your family. For each state-
ment there are four (4) possible responses:
Strongly Agree (SA) Check SA if you feel that the statement describes your family very accurately.
Agree (A) Check A if you feel that the statement describes your family for the most part.
Disagree (D) Check D if you feel that the statement does not describe your family for the most part.
Strongly Disagree (SD) Check SD if you feel that the statement does not describe your family at all.
Try not to spend too much time thinking about each statement, but respond as quickly and honestly as you can. If
you have trouble with one, answer with your first reaction. Please be sure to answer every statement and mark all
your answers in the space provided next to each statement.
STATEMENTS SA A D SD
1. Planning family activities is difficult because we misunderstand each other. _____ _____ _____ _____
2. We resolve most everyday problems around the house. _____ _____ _____ _____
3. When someone is upset the others know why. _____ _____ _____ _____
4. When you ask someone to do something, you have to check that
they did it. _____ _____ _____ _____
5. If someone is in trouble, the others become too involved. _____ _____ _____ _____
6. In times of crisis we can turn to each other for support. _____ _____ _____ _____
7. We dont know what to do when an emergency comes up. _____ _____ _____ _____
8. We sometimes run out of things that we need. _____ _____ _____ _____
9. We are reluctant to show our affection to each other. _____ _____ _____ _____
10. We make sure members meet their family responsibilities. _____ _____ _____ _____
11. We cannot talk to each other about the sadness we feel. _____ _____ _____ _____
12. We usually act on our decisions regarding problems. _____ _____ _____ _____
13. You only get the interest of others when something is important to them. _____ _____ _____ _____
14. You cant tell how a person is feeling from what they are saying. _____ _____ _____ _____
15. Family tasks dont get spread around enough. _____ _____ _____ _____
16. Individuals are accepted for what they are. _____ _____ _____ _____
17. You can easily get away with breaking the rules. _____ _____ _____ _____
18. People come right out and say things instead of hinting at them. _____ _____ _____ _____
19. Some of us just dont respond emotionally. _____ _____ _____ _____
20. We know what to do in an emergency. _____ _____ _____ _____
21. We avoid discussing our fears and concerns. _____ _____ _____ _____
22. It is difficult to talk to each other about tender feelings. _____ _____ _____ _____
23. We have trouble meeting our bills. _____ _____ _____ _____
24. After our family tries to solve a problem, we usually discuss whether it
worked or not. _____ _____ _____ _____
25. We are too self-centered. _____ _____ _____ _____
26. We can express our feelings to each other. _____ _____ _____ _____
27. We have no clear expectations about toilet habits. _____ _____ _____ _____
28. We do not show our love for each other. _____ _____ _____ _____
29. We talk to people directly rather than through go-betweens. _____ _____ _____ _____
30. Each of us has particular duties and responsibilities. _____ _____ _____ _____
31. There are lots of bad feelings in the family. _____ _____ _____ _____
32. We have rules about hitting people. _____ _____ _____ _____
33. We get involved with each other only when something interests us. _____ _____ _____ _____
34. Theres little time to explore personal interests. _____ _____ _____ _____
35. We often dont say what we mean. _____ _____ _____ _____
36. We feel accepted for what we are. _____ _____ _____ _____
37. We show interest in each other when we can get something out
of it personally. _____ _____ _____ _____
38. We resolve most emotional upsets that come up. _____ _____ _____ _____
39. Tenderness takes second place to other things in our family. _____ _____ _____ _____
166 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
Box 8-3
MCMASTER FAMILY ASSESSMENT DEVICECONTD
STATEMENTS SA A D SD
From Schutle, N. S., & Malouff, J. M. (1995). Sourcebook of adult assessment strategies. New York: Plenum Press, Brown University/
Butler Hospital Family Research Program, 1982.
may not be able to get out of bed. Therefore, the nurse DATA ANALYSIS
must assess the clients usual patterns of eating and
sleeping then determine how those patterns have After completing the psychosocial assessment, the
changed (Chow & Cummings, 2000). nurse analyzes all the data that he or she has collected.
The nurse also asks the client if he or she has any Data analysis involves thinking about the overall as-
major or chronic health problems and if he or she sessment rather than focusing on isolated bits of in-
takes prescribed medications as ordered and follows formation. The nurse looks for patterns or themes in
dietary recommendations. The nurse also explores the the data that lead to conclusions about the clients
clients use of alcohol and over-the-counter or illicit strengths and needs and a particular nursing diagno-
drugs. Such questions require nonjudgmental phras- sis. No one statement or behavior is adequate to reach
ing; the nurse must reassure the client that truthful such a conclusion. The nurse also must consider the
information is crucial in determining the clients plan congruence of all information provided by the client,
of care. family, or caregivers and his or her own observations.
Noncompliance with prescribed medications is It is not uncommon for the clients perception of his
an important area. If the client has stopped taking or her behavior and situation to differ from that of
medication or is taking medication other than as pre- others. Assessments in a variety of areas are necessary
scribed, the nurse must help the client feel comfort- to support nursing diagnoses such as Chronic Low
able enough to reveal this information. The nurse Self-Esteem or Ineffective Coping.
also explores the barriers to compliance. Is the client Traditionally data analysis leads to the formula-
choosing noncompliance because of undesirable side tion of nursing diagnoses as a basis for the clients
effects? Has the medication failed to produce the de- plan of care. Nursing diagnoses have been an integral
sired results? Does the client have difficulty obtain- part of the nursing process for many years. With the
ing the medication? Is the medication too expensive sweeping changes occurring in health care, however,
for the client? the nurse also must be able to articulate the clients
8 ASSESSMENT 167
Box 8-4
GLOBAL ASSESSMENT OF FUNCTIONING (GAF) SCALE
Consider psychological, social, and occupational functioning on a hypothetical continuum of mental healthillness.
Do not include impairment in functioning due to physical (or environmental) limitations. (Note: Use intermediate
codes when appropriate, e.g., 45, 68, 72.)
CODE
100 Superior functioning in a wide range of activities; lifes problems never seem to get out of hand; is sought
out by others because of his or her many positive qualities. No symptoms.
91
90 Absent or minimal symptoms (e.g., mild anxiety before an exam), good functioning in all areas, interested
and involved in a wide range of activities, socially effective, generally satisfied with life; no more than
81 everyday problems or concerns (e.g., an occasional argument with family members).
80 If symptoms are present, they are transient and expectable reactions to psychosocial stressors (e.g., dif-
ficulty concentrating after family argument); no more than slight impairment in social, occupational, or
71 school functioning (e.g., temporarily falling behind in schoolwork).
70 Some mild symptoms (e.g., depressed mood and mild insomnia) OR some difficulty in social, occupa-
tional, or school functioning (e.g., occasional truancy, or theft within the household), but generally func-
61 tioning pretty well; has some meaningful interpersonal relationships.
60 Moderate symptoms (e.g., flat affect and circumstantial speech, occasional panic attacks) OR moderate dif-
ficulty in social, occupational, or school functioning (e.g., few friends, conflicts with peers or co-workers).
51
50 Serious symptoms (e.g., suicidal ideation, severe obsessional rituals, frequent shoplifting) OR any serious
impairment in social, occupational, or school functioning (e.g., no friends, unable to keep a job).
41
40 Some impairment in reality testing or communication (e.g., speech is at times illogical, obscure, or irrel-
evant) OR major impairment in several areas such as work or school, family relations, judgment, think-
31 ing, or mood (e.g., depressed man avoids friends, neglects family, and is unable to work; child frequently
beats up younger children, is defiant at home, and is failing at school).
20 Some danger of hurting self or others (e.g., suicide attempts without clear expectation of death; frequently
violent; manic excitement) OR occasionally fails to maintain minimal personal hygiene (e.g., smears feces)
11 OR gross impairment in communication (e.g., largely incoherent or mute).
10 Persistent danger of severely hurting self or others (e.g., recurrent violence) OR persistent inability to
maintain minimal personal hygiene OR serious suicidal act with clear expectation of death.
1
0 Inadequate information.
The rating of overall psychological functioning on a scale of 0100 was operationalized by Luborsky in the Health-Sickness Rat-
ing Scale (Luborsky L: Clinicians Judgments of Mental Health. Archives of General Psychiatry 7:407417, 1962). Spitzer and
colleagues developed a revision of the Health-Sickness Rating Scale called the Global Assessment Scale (GAS) (Endicott J,
Spitzer RL, Fleiss JL, Cohen J: The Global Assessment Scale: A Procedure for Measuring Overall Severity of Psychiatric Distur-
bance. Archives of General Psychiatry 33:766771, 1976). A modified version of the GAS was included in DSM-III-R as the Global
Assessment of Functioning (GAF) Scale.
8 ASSESSMENT 169
(Schultz & Videbeck, 2002). Although the DSM-IV- lieve abortion is a sin, but the client might have had
TR is not a substitute for a thorough psychosocial several elective abortions. Or the nurse may believe
nursing assessment, the descriptions of disorders and that adultery is wrong, but during the course of an as-
related behaviors can be a valuable resource for the sessment he or she may discover that a client has had
nurse to use as a guide. The DSM-IV-TR uses a multi- several extramarital affairs.
axial system to provide the format for a complete psy- Being able to listen to the client nonjudgmentally
chiatric diagnosis: and to support the discussion of personal topics takes
Axis I:clinical disorders, other conditions practice and usually gets easier with experience. Talk-
that may be a focus of clinical attention ing to more experienced colleagues about such dis-
Axis II: personality disorders, mental comfort and methods to alleviate it often helps. It may
retardation also help for the nurse to preface uncomfortable ques-
Axis III: general medical conditions tions by saying to the client, I need to ask you some
Axis IV: psychosocial and environmental personal questions. Remember, this is information
problems that will help the staff provide better care for you.
Axis V: global assessment of functioning The nurse must assess the client for suicidal
(GAF) thoughts. Some beginning nurses feel uncomfortable
The psychosocial and environmental problems discussing suicide or feel that asking about suicide
categorized on Axis IV include educational, occupa- might suggest it to a client who had not previously
tional, housing, financial, and legal problems as well thought about it. This is not the case. It has been
as difficulties with the social environment, relation- shown that the safest way to assess a client with sus-
ships, and access to health care. pected mental disorders is to ask him or her clearly
The GAF is used to make a judgment about the and directly about suicidal ideas. It is the nurses pro-
clients overall level of functioning (Box 8-4). The fessional responsibility to keep the clients safety needs
GAF score given to the client may describe his or her first and foremost, and this includes overcoming any
current level of functioning as well as the highest personal discomfort in talking about suicide (Schultz
& Videbeck, 2002).
level of functioning in the past year or 6 months. This
information is useful in setting appropriate goals for
the clients care. Points to Consider When Doing
a Psychosocial Assessment
SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES The nurse is trying to gain all the informa-
Self-awareness is crucial when a nurse tion needed to help the client. Judgments are
is trying to obtain accurate and complete information not part of the assessment process.
from the client during the assessment process. The Being open, clear, and direct when asking
nurse must be aware of any feelings, biases, and about personal or uncomfortable topics will
values that could interfere with the psychosocial as- help to alleviate the clients anxiety or hesi-
sessment of a client with different beliefs, values, and tancy about discussing the topic.
behaviors. The nurse cannot let personal feelings and Examining ones own beliefs and gaining
beliefs influence the clients treatment. Self-awareness self-awareness is a growth-producing
does not mean the nurses beliefs are wrong or must experience for the nurse.
change, but it does help the nurse to be open and ac- If the nurses beliefs differ strongly from
cepting of others beliefs and behaviors even when the those of the client, the nurse should express
nurse does not agree with them. his or her feelings to colleagues or discuss
Two areas that may be uncomfortable or difficult the differences with them. The nurse must
for the nurse to assess are sexuality and self-harm be- not allow personal beliefs to interfere with
haviors. The beginning nurse may feel uncomfortable, the nurseclient relationship and the assess-
as if prying into personal matters, when asking ques- ment process.
tions about a clients intimate relationships and be-
havior and any self-harm behaviors or suicide. Asking
KEY POINTS
such questions, however, is essential to obtaining a
thorough and complete assessment. The nurse needs The purpose of the psychosocial assessment
to remember that it may be uncomfortable for the is to construct a picture of the clients cur-
client to discuss these topics as well. rent emotional state, mental capacity, and
The nurse may hold beliefs that differ from the behavioral function. This baseline clinical
clients, but he or she must not make judgments about picture serves as the basis for developing a
the clients practices. For example, the nurse may be- plan of care to meet the clients needs.
170 Unit 2 BUILDING THE NURSECLIENT RELATIONSHIP
1. Which of the following is an example of an open- 5. When the nurse is assessing whether or not the
ended question? clients ideas are logical and make sense, the
nurse is examining which of the following?
A. Who is the current president of the United
States? A. Thought content
B. What concerns you most about your health? B. Thought process
C. What is your address? C. Memory
D. Have you lost any weight recently? D. Sensorium
2. Which of the following is an example of a closed- 6. The clients belief that a news broadcast has
ended question? special meaning for him is an example of
A. How have you been feeling lately? A. Abstract thinking
B. How is your relationship with your wife? B. Flight of ideas
C. Have you had any health problems recently? C. Ideas of reference
D. Where are you employed? D. Thought broadcasting
3. Which of the following is not included in the 7. The client who believes everyone is out to get
assessment of sensorium and intellectual him is experiencing a(n)
processes?
A. Delusion
A. Concentration
B. Hallucination
B. Memory
C. Idea of reference
C. Judgment
D. Loose association
D. Orientation
8. To assess the clients ability to concentrate, the
4. Assessment data about the clients speech nurse would instruct the client to do which of the
patterns are categorized in which of the follow- following?
ing areas?
A. Explain what A rolling stone gathers no
A. History moss means.
B. General appearance and motor behavior B. Name the last three presidents.
C. Sensorium and intellectual processes C. Repeat the days of the week backward.
D. Self-concept D. Tell what a typical day is like.
171
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify each of the following terms being described.
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
Identify a question that the nurse might ask to assess each of the following.
2. Insight
172
3. Self-concept
4. Judgment
5. Mood
173
6. Orientation
CLINICAL EXAMPLE
The nurse at a mental health clinic is meeting a new client for the first time and
plans to do a psychosocial assessment. When the client arrives, the nurse finds
a young woman who looks somewhat apprehensive and is crying and twisting
facial tissues in her hands. The client can tell the nurse her name and age but
begins crying before she can provide any other information. The nurse knows it
is essential to obtain information from this young woman, but it is clear she will
have trouble answering all interview questions at this time.
1. How should the nurse approach the crying client? What should the nurse
say and do?
2. Identify five questions that the nurse would choose to ask this client
initially. Give a rationale for the chosen questions.
174
3. What, if any, assumptions might the nurse make about this client and
her situation?
4. If the client decided to leave the clinic before the assessment formally
began, what would the nurse need to do?
175
Unit 3
Current Social and
Emotional Concerns
9 Legal and
Ethical Issues
Learning Objectives
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
178
9 LEGAL AND ETHICAL ISSUES 179
Box 9-1
A PATIENTS BILL OF RIGHTS
1. The patient has the right to considerate and respectful care.
2. The patient has the right and is encouraged to obtain from physicians and other direct caregivers relevant,
current, and understandable information concerning diagnosis, treatment, and prognosis.
3. The patient has the right to make decisions about the plan of care prior to and during the course of treatment
and to refuse a recommended treatment or plan of care to the extent permitted by law and hospital policy and
to be informed of medical consequences of this action. In case of such refusal, the patient is entitled to other
appropriate care and services that the hospital provides, or transfer to another hospital. The hospital should
notify patients of any policy that might affect patient choice within the institution.
4. The patient has the right to have an advance directive (such as a living will, health care proxy, or durable power
of attorney for health care) concerning treatment, with the expectation that the hospital will honor the intent
of that directive to the extent permitted by law and hospital policy.
5. The patient has the right to every consideration of privacy. Case discussion, consultation, examination, and
treatment should be conducted so as to protect each patients privacy.
6. The patient has the right to expect that all communications and records pertaining to his or her care will be
treated as confidential by the hospital, except in cases such as suspected abuse and public health hazards,
when reporting is permitted or required by law. The patient has the right to expect that the hospital will
emphasize the confidentiality of this information when it releases it to any other parties entitled to review in-
formation in these records.
7. The patient has the right to review the records pertaining to his or her medical care and to have the information
explained or interpreted as necessary, except when restricted by law.
8. The patient has the right to expect that, within its capacities and policies, a hospital will make a reasonable
response to the request of a patient for appropriate and medically indicated care and services.
9. The patient has the right to ask and be informed of the existence of business relationships among the hospi-
tal, educational institutions, other health care providers, or payers that may influence the patients treatment
and care.
10. The patient has the right to consent or decline to participate in proposed research studies or human experi-
mentation affecting care and treatment or requiring direct patient involvement, and to have those studies fully
explained prior to consent. A patient who declines to participate in research or experimentation is entitled to
the most effective care that the hospital can otherwise provide.
11. The patient has the right to expect reasonable continuity of care when appropriate and to be informed by
physicians and other caregivers of available and realistic patient care options when hospital care is no longer
appropriate.
12. The patient has the right to be informed of hospital policies and practices that relate to patient care, treatment,
and responsibilities. The patient has the right to be informed of available resources for resolving disputes,
grievances, and conflicts, such as ethics committees, patient representatives, or other mechanisms available
in the institution. The patient has the right to be informed of the hospitals charges for services and available
payment methods.
American Hospital Association. (1992). A patients bill of rights. Chicago: AHA. Reprinted with permission of the AHA, 1992.
180 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
INVOLUNTARY HOSPITALIZATION
Most clients are admitted to inpatient settings on a
voluntary basis, which means they are willing to seek
treatment and agree to be hospitalized. Some clients,
however, do not wish to be hospitalized and treated.
Health care professionals respect these wishes unless
clients are a danger to themselves or others (i.e., they
are threatening or have attempted suicide or repre-
sent a danger to others). Clients hospitalized against
their will under these conditions are committed to the
facility for psychiatric care until they no longer pose
a danger to themselves or anyone else. Each state has
laws that govern the civil commitment process, but
such laws are similar across all 50 states. Civil com-
mitment or involuntary hospitalization curtails the
clients right to freedom (the ability to leave the hos-
pital when he or she wishes). All other client rights, Voluntary clients may sign a written request for
however, remain intact. discharge against medical advice.
A person can be detained in a psychiatric facility
for 48 to 72 hours on an emergency basis until a hear-
ing can be conducted to determine whether or not he their medications after discharge and once again be-
or she should be committed to a facility for treatment come threatening, aggressive, or dangerous. Mental
for a specified period. Many states have similar laws health clinicians increasingly have been held legally
governing the commitment of clients with substance liable for the criminal actions of such clients; this
abuse problems who represent a danger to them- situation contributes to the debate about extended
selves or others when under the influence. civil commitment for dangerous clients. A study by
Weinberger, Sreenivasan & Markowitz (1998) showed
that courts accepted fewer than 50% of mental health
RELEASE FROM THE HOSPITAL professionals petitions for extended civil commitment
Clients admitted to the hospital voluntarily have the of dangerous psychiatric clients. The courts concern is
right to leave, provided they do not represent a danger that clients with psychiatric disorders have civil rights
to themselves or others. They can sign a written re- and should not be unreasonably detained against their
quest for discharge and be released from the hospital wills in a hospital when they are no longer dangerous.
against medical advice. If a voluntary client who is Communities counter that they deserve protection
dangerous to himself or herself or others signs a re- against dangerous people with a history of not taking
quest for discharge, the psychiatrist may file for a civil their medications and who may become a threat.
commitment to detain the client against his or her will
until a hearing can take place to decide the matter.
CONSERVATORSHIP
While in the hospital, the committed client may
take medications and improve fairly rapidly, making The appointment of a conservator or legal guardian is
him or her eligible for discharge when he or she no a separate process from civil commitment. People
longer represents a danger. Some clients stop taking who are gravely disabled; are found to be incompe-
9 LEGAL AND ETHICAL ISSUES 181
Box 9-2
RESTRAINT AND SECLUSION STANDARDS FOR BEHAVIORAL HEALTH
The leaders (medical director, director of patient services) establish and communicate the organizations
philosophy on the use of restraint and seclusion to all staff who have direct care responsibility.
Staffing levels and assignments are set to minimize circumstances that give rise to restraint or seclusion
use and to maximize safety when restraint and seclusion are used.
Staff are trained and competent to minimize the use of restraint and seclusion and in their safe use.
The initial assessment of each client at the time of admission or intake is used to obtain information about
the client that could help minimize the use of restraint or seclusion.
Nonphysical techniques are the preferred intervention in the management of behavior.
Restraint or seclusion use is limited to emergencies in which there is an imminent risk of a client physically
harming himself or herself, staff, or others, and nonphysical interventions would not be effective.
A licensed independent practitioner orders the use of restraint or seclusion.
The clients family is notified promptly of the initiation of restraint or seclusion.
A licensed independent practitioner sees and evaluates the client in person.
Written or verbal orders for initial and continuing use of restraint and seclusion are time-limited.
Clients who are in restraint or seclusion are regularly re-evaluated.
Clinical leadership is informed of instances in which clients experience extended or multiple episodes of
restraint or seclusion.
Individuals in restraint or seclusion are assessed and assisted.
Individuals in restraint or seclusion are monitored.
Restraint and seclusion are discontinued when the individual meets the behavior criteria for their
discontinuation.
The individual and staff participate in a debriefing about the restraint or seclusion episode.
Medical records document that the use of restraint or seclusion is consistent with organization policy.
The organization collects data on the use of restraint and seclusion in order to monitor and improve its
performance of processes that involve risks or may result in sentinel events.
Organizational policies and procedures address the prevention of the use of restraint and seclusion, and,
when employed, guide their use.
Joint Commission on Accreditation of Healthcare Organizations. (2000). Restraint and seclusion standards for behavioral
health. Oakbrook Terrace, IL: Joint Commission Resources. Reprinted with permission.
Adapted from Martinez, R. J., Grimm, M., & Adamson, M. (1999). From the other side of the door. Journal of Psychosocial
Nursing, 37(3), 1322.
9 LEGAL AND ETHICAL ISSUES 183
the client is an adult, however, such discussion re- For example, if a man were admitted to a psychi-
quires a signed release of information. In the case of atric facility stating he was going to kill his wife, the
minor children, signed consent is not required to in- duty to warn his wife is clear. If, however, a client with
form parents or guardians about the use of restraint paranoia were admitted saying, Im going to get them
or seclusion. Providing the family with information before they get me but providing no other informa-
may help prevent legal or ethical difficulties. It also tion, there is no specific third party to warn. Decisions
keeps the family involved in the clients treatment. about the duty to warn third parties usually are made
by psychiatrists or by qualified mental health thera-
DUTY TO WARN THIRD PARTIES pists in outpatient settings.
Mason, T. (1998). Tarasoff liability. International Journal of A tort is a wrongful act that results in injury, loss,
Nursing Studies, 35(1/2), 109114. or damage. Torts may be either unintentional or
intentional.
184 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
Unintentional Torts: Negligence and Malpractice. touching a client without consent or unnecessarily re-
Negligence is an unintentional tort that involves straining a client. False imprisonment is defined as
causing harm by failing to do what a reasonable and the unjustifiable detention of a client such as the in-
prudent person would do in similar circumstances. appropriate use of restraint or seclusion.
Malpractice is a type of negligence that refers specif- Proving liability for an intentional tort involves
ically to professionals such as nurses and physicians three elements (Guido, 2001):
(Guido, 2001). Clients or families can file malpractice 1. The act was willful and voluntary on the
lawsuits in any case of injury, loss, or death. For a part of the defendant (nurse).
malpractice suit to be successful, that is, for the nurse, 2. The nurse intended to bring about conse-
physician, and/or hospital/agency to be liable, the quences or injury to the person (client).
client or family needs to prove the following four ele- 3. The act must be a substantial factor in caus-
ments (Wysoker, 2002): ing injury or consequences.
1. Duty: A legally recognized relationship, i.e.,
physician to client, nurse to client, existed.
PREVENTION OF LIABILITY
The nurse had a duty to the client, meaning
that the nurse was acting in the capacity of Nurses can minimize the risk of lawsuits through
a nurse. safe, competent nursing care and descriptive, accurate
2. Breach of duty: The nurse (or physician) documentation. Box 9-4 highlights ways to minimize
failed to conform to standards of care, the risk of liability.
thereby breaching or failing the existing
duty. The nurse did not act as a reasonable,
prudent nurse would have acted in similar ETHICAL ISSUES
circumstances. Ethics is a branch of philosophy that deals with val-
3. Injury or damage: The client suffered ues of human conduct related to the rightness or
some type of loss, damage, or injury. wrongness of actions and to the goodness and badness
4. Causation: The breach of duty was the of the motives and ends of such actions (King, 1984).
direct cause of the loss, damage, or injury. Ethical theories are sets of principles used to decide
In other words, the loss, damage or injury what is morally right or wrong.
would not have occurred if the nurse had Utilitarianism is a theory that bases decisions
acted in a reasonable, prudent manner. on the greatest good for the greatest number. Deci-
Not all injury or harm to a client can be pre- sions based on utilitarianism consider which action
vented, nor do all client injuries result from mal- would produce the greatest benefit for the most
practice. The issues are whether or not the clients people. Deontology is a theory that says decisions
actions were predictable or foreseeable (and, there- should be based on whether or not an action is morally
fore, preventable) and whether or not the nurse car- right with no regard for the result or consequences.
ried out appropriate assessment, interventions, and Principles used as guides for decision-making in
evaluation that met the standards of care. In the
mental health setting, lawsuits most often are re-
lated to suicide and suicide attempts. Other areas of
concern include clients harming others (staff, family, Box 9-4
other clients); sexual assault; and medication errors
(Wysoker, 2002). STEPS TO AVOID LIABILITY
Practice within the scope of state laws and nurse
Intentional Torts. Psychiatric nurses also may be li- practice act.
able for intentional torts or voluntary acts that result Collaborate with colleagues to determine the best
in harm to the client. Examples include assault, bat- course of action.
tery, and false imprisonment. Use established practice standards to guide
Assault involves any action that causes a person decisions and actions.
to fear being touched in a way that is offensive, in- Always put the clients rights and welfare first.
sulting, or physically injurious without consent or au- Develop effective interpersonal relationships with
thority. Examples include making threats to restrain clients and families.
the client in order to give the client an injection for Accurately and thoroughly document all assess-
failure to cooperate. Battery involves harmful or un- ment data, treatments, interventions, and evalu-
warranted contact with a client; actual harm or injury ation of the clients response to care.
may or may not have occurred. Examples include
9 LEGAL AND ETHICAL ISSUES 185
deontology include autonomy, beneficence, non- Are clients who are psychotic necessarily
maleficence, justice, veracity, and fidelity. incompetent, or do they still have the right to
Autonomy refers to the persons right to self- refuse hospitalization and medication
determination and independence. Beneficence refers (Chamberlin, 1998; Barrett, Taylor, Pullo &
to ones duty to benefit or to promote good for others. Dunlap, 1998)?
Nonmaleficence is the requirement to do no harm to Can consumers of mental health care truly
others either intentionally or unintentionally. Jus- be empowered if health care professionals
tice refers to fairness; that is, treating all people fairly step in to make decisions for them for
and equally without regard for social or economic sta- their own good (Breeze, 1998)?
tus, race, sex, marital status, religion, ethnicity, or Should physicians break confidentiality to
cultural beliefs. Veracity is the duty to be honest report clients who drive cars at high speeds
or truthful. Fidelity refers to the obligation to honor and recklessly (Niveau & Kelley-Puskas,
commitments and contracts. 2001)?
All these principles have meaning in health care. Should a client who is loud and intrusive to
The nurse respects the clients autonomy through pa- other clients on a hospital unit be secluded
tients rights, informed consent, and encouraging the from the others (Terpstra, Terpstra, Pettee &
client to make choices about his or her health care. Hunter, 2001)?
The nurse has a duty to take actions that promote the A health care worker has an established
clients health (beneficence) and that do not harm relationship with a person who later becomes
the client (nonmaleficence). The nurse must treat all a client in the agency where the health care
clients fairly (justice), be truthful and honest (verac- worker practices. Can the health care worker
ity), and honor all duties and commitments to clients continue the relationship with the person
and families (fidelity). who is now a client (Cutcliffe, Epling,
Cassedy, McGregor, Plant & Butterworth,
1998)?
Ethical Dilemmas in Mental Health
To protect the public, can clients with a
An ethical dilemma is a situation in which ethical history of violence toward others be detained
principles conflict or when there is no one clear after their symptoms are stable (Dickenson,
course of action in a given situation. For example, 1997)?
the client who refuses medication or treatment is When a therapeutic relationship has ended,
allowed to do so based on the principle of autonomy. can a health care professional ever have a
If the client presents an imminent threat of danger social or intimate relationship with someone
to self or others, however, the principle of non- he or she met as a client?
maleficence (do no harm) is at risk. To protect the Is it possible to maintain strict professional
client or others from harm, the client may be invol- boundaries (i.e., no previous, current, or
untarily committed to a hospital, even though some future personal relationships with clients) in
may argue that this action violates his or her right small communities and rural areas where all
to autonomy. In this example, the utilitarian theory people in the community know one another
of doing the greatest good for the greatest number (Roberts, Battaglia & Epstein, 1999; Simon
(involuntary commitment) overrides the individual & Williams, 1999)?
clients autonomy (right to refuse treatment). Ethi- The nurse will confront some of these dilemmas di-
cal dilemmas are often complicated and charged rectly, and he or she will have to make decisions about
with emotion, making it difficult to arrive at fair or a course of action. For example, the nurse may observe
right decisions. behavior between another health care worker and a
Many dilemmas in mental health involve the client that seems flirtatious or inappropriate. Others
clients right to self-determination and independence might represent the policies or common practice of the
(autonomy) and concern for the public good (utili- agency where the nurse is employed, and the nurse
tarianism). Examples include the following: will have to decide if he or she can support those prac-
Once a client is stabilized on psychotropic tices or decide to seek a position elsewhere. An exam-
medication, should the client be forced to ple would be an agency that takes only clients with a
remain on medication through the use of history of medication noncompliance if they are sched-
enforced depot injections (Armstrong, 1999; uled for depot injections or remain on an outpatient
Svedberg, Hallstrom & Lutzen, 2000) or commitment status. Yet other dilemmas are in the
through outpatient commitment (Torrey & larger social arena; the nurses decision is whether to
Zdanowicz, 2001)? support current practice or to advocate for change on
186 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
behalf of clients such as laws permitting people to be liefs so that they do not become confused with or over-
detained after treatment is completed when there is a shadow the clients. For example, if a client is grieving
potential of future risk of violence. over her decision to have an abortion, the nurse must
be able to provide support to her even though the
nurse may be opposed to abortion. If the nurse cannot
Ethical Decision-Making do that, then he or she should talk to colleagues to find
The American Nurses Association (ANA) has pub- someone who can meet that clients needs.
lished a Code or Ethics for Nurses to guide choices
about ethical actions (Box 9-5). Models for ethical Points to Consider When Confronting
decision-making include gathering information, clar- Ethical Dilemmas
ifying values, identifying options, identifying legal
considerations and practical restraints, building con- Talk to colleagues or seek professional super-
sensus for the decision reached, and reviewing and vision. Usually the nurse does not need to
analyzing the decision to determine what was learned resolve an ethical dilemma alone.
(Kennedy-Swartz, 2000). Spend time thinking about ethical issues,
and determine what your values and beliefs
are regarding situations before they occur.
SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES Be willing to discuss ethical concerns with
colleagues or managers. Being silent is
All nurses have beliefs about what is condoning the behavior.
right or wrong and good or bad. That is, they have val-
ues just like all other people. Being a member of the
nursing profession, however, presumes a duty to
clients and families under the nurses care: a duty to KEY POINTS
protect rights, to be an advocate, and to act in the Clients can be involuntarily hospitalized if
clients best interests even if that duty is in conflict they present an imminent danger of harm to
with the nurses personal values and beliefs. The nurse themselves or others.
is obligated to engage in self-awareness by identifying The Patients Bill of Rights includes the
clearly and examining his or her own values and be- right to receive and refuse treatment, to be
Box 9-5
AMERICAN NURSES ASSOCIATION CODE OF ETHICS FOR NURSES
1. The nurse, in all professional relationships, practices with compassion and respect for the inherent dignity,
worth, and uniqueness of every individual, unrestricted by considerations of social or economic status, per-
sonal attributes, or the nature of health problems.
2. The nurses primary commitment is to the patient, whether an individual, family, group, or community.
3. The nurse promotes, advocates for, and strives to protect the health, safety, and rights of the patient.
4. The nurse is responsible and accountable for individual nursing practice and determines the appropriate del-
egation of tasks consistent with the nurses obligation to provide optimum patient care.
5. The nurse owes the same duties to self as to others, including the responsibility to preserve integrity and safety,
to maintain competence, and to continue personal and professional growth.
6. The nurse participates in establishing, maintaining, and improving health care environments and conditions
of employment conducive to the provision of quality health care and consistent with the values of the profes-
sion through individual and collective action.
7. The nurse participates in the advancement of the profession through contributions to practice, education,
administration, and knowledge development.
8. The nurse collaborates with other health professionals and the public in promoting community, national, and
international efforts to meet health needs.
9. The profession of nursing, as represented by associations and their members, is responsible for articulating
nursing values, for maintaining the integrity of the profession and its practice, and for shaping social policy.
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
involved in the plan of care, to be treated in ronment. Short-term use is permitted only
the least restrictive environment, to refuse if the client is imminently aggressive and
to participate in research, and to have dangerous to himself or herself or others.
unrestricted visitors, mail, and phone calls. Mental health clinicians have a legal obliga-
The use of seclusion (confinement in a locked tion to breach client confidentiality to warn a
room) and restraint (direct application of third party of direct threats made by the
physical force) falls under the domain of the client.
patients right to the least restrictive envi- Nurses have the responsibility to provide safe,
competent, legal, and ethical care as outlined
in nurse practice acts, the Scope and Stan-
dards of Psychiatric-Mental Health Nursing
Practice, and the Code of Ethics for Nurses.
Critical Thinking Questions A tort is a wrongful act that results in
injury, loss, or damage. Negligence is an
1. Some clients with psychiatric disorders make
headlines when they commit crimes against unintentional tort causing harm through
others that involve serious injury or death. failure to act.
With treatment and medication, these clients Malpractice is negligence by health profes-
are rational and represent no threat to others, sionals in cases in which they have a duty to
but they have a history of stopping their the client that is breached, thereby, causing
medications when released from treatment injury or damage to the client.
facilities. Where and how should these clients Intentional torts include assault, battery,
be treated? What measures can protect their and false imprisonment.
individual rights as well as the public right Ethical theories are sets of principles used to
to safety? decide what is morally right or wrong, such
2. Some critics of deinstitutionalization argue as utilitarianism (the greatest good for the
that taking people who are severely and greatest number) and deontology (using
persistently mentally ill out of institutions principles such as autonomy, beneficence,
and closing some or all those institutions have nonmaleficence, justice, veracity, and
worsened the mental health crisis. These fidelity), to make ethical decisions.
closings have made it difficult for this minor- Ethical dilemmas are situations that arise
ity of mentally ill clients to receive necessary when principles conflict or when there is
inpatient treatment. Opponents counter that no single clear course of action in a given
institutions are harmful because they situation.
segregate the mentally ill from the commu- Many ethical dilemmas in mental health
nity, limit autonomy, and contribute to the involve a conflict between the clients
loss of social skills. With which viewpoint do autonomy and concerns for the public good
you agree? Why? (utilitarianism).
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com.
188 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
1. The client who is involuntarily committed to an 4. Which of the following would indicate a duty to
inpatient psychiatric unit loses which of the warn a third party?
following rights?
A. A client with delusions states, Im going to
A. Right to freedom get them before they get me.
B. Right to refuse treatment B. A hostile client says, I hate all police.
C. Right to sign legal documents C. A client says he plans to blow up the federal
government.
D. The client loses no rights.
D. A client states, If I cant have my girlfriend
2. A client has a prescription for Haloperidol 5 mg back, then no one can have her.
orally two times a day as ordered by the
physician. The client is suspicious and refuses 5. The nurse gives the client quetiapine (Seroquel)
to take the medication. The nurse says, If you in error when olanzapine (Zyprexa) was ordered.
dont take this pill, Ill get an order to give you The client has no ill effects from the quetiapine.
an injection. The nurses statement is an In addition to making a medication error, the
example of nurse has committed which of the following?
A. Assault A. Malpractice
B. Battery B. Negligence
C. Malpractice C. Tort (unintentional)
D. Unintentional tort D. None of the above
189
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify the deontological principle being described.
Doing no harm
Keeping commitments
Promoting good
Being fair
Self-determination
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
1. Describe the concept of the least restrictive environment.
190
3. Identify the steps involved in the ethical decision-making process.
191
10 Anger,
Hostility, and
Learning Objectives Aggression
After reading this chapter,
the student should be able to
192 192
10 ANGER, HOSTILITY, AND AGGRESSION 193
confused with suppressing angry feelings, which can interventions during the triggering and escalation
lead to the problems described earlier. phases are key to preventing physically aggressive
Anger suppression is especially common in behavior (discussed below).
women (Davila, 1999) who have been socialized to
maintain and enhance relationships with others and RELATED DISORDERS
to avoid the expression of so-called negative or unfem-
inine emotions such as anger. Manifestations of anger The media gives a great deal of attention to people
suppression through somatic complaints and psycho- with mental illness who commit aggressive acts. This
logical problems are more common among women than gives the general public the mistaken idea that most
men. Davila suggests that women must recognize that people with mental illness are aggressive and should
anger awareness and expression are necessary for be feared. In reality, clients with psychiatric disor-
their growth and development. ders are much more likely to hurt themselves than
other people.
Although most clients with psychiatric disorders
Hostility and Aggression are not aggressive (Shepherd & Lavender, 1999),
Hostile and aggressive behavior can be sudden and clients with a variety of psychiatric diagnoses can ex-
unexpected. Often, however, stages or phases can be hibit angry, hostile, and aggressive behavior. Clients
identified in aggressive incidents: a triggering phase, with paranoid delusions may believe others are out
an escalation phase, a crisis phase, a recovery phase, to get them; believing they are protecting themselves,
and a postcrisis phase. These phases and their signs, they will retaliate with hostility or aggression. Some
symptoms, and behaviors are discussed later in the clients have auditory hallucinations that command
chapter. them to hurt others. Aggressive behavior also is seen
As a clients behavior escalates toward the crisis in clients with dementia, delirium, head injuries, in-
phase, he or she loses the ability to perceive events toxication with alcohol or other drugs, and antisocial
accurately, solve problems, express feelings appro- and borderline personality disorders.
priately, or control his or her behavior; behavior es- Fava and Rosenbaum (1999) reported that about
calation may lead to physical aggression. Therefore, 40% of clients with major depression have anger at-
tacks. These sudden, intense spells of anger typically
occur in situations in which the depressed person feels
emotionally trapped. Anger attacks involve verbal ex-
pressions of anger or rage but no physical aggression.
Clients described these anger attacks as uncharac-
teristic behavior that was inappropriate for the situ-
ation and was followed by remorse. The anger attacks
seen in some depressed clients may be related to irri-
table mood, overreaction to minor annoyances, and de-
creased coping abilities (Fava & Rosenbaum, 1999).
Intermittent explosive disorder is a rare psychi-
atric diagnosis characterized by discrete episodes of
aggressive impulses that result in serious assaults
or destruction of property. The aggressive behavior
the person displays is grossly disproportionate to any
provocation or precipitating factor. This diagnosis is
made only if the client has no other comorbid psychi-
atric disorders, as discussed above. The person de-
scribes a period of tension or arousal that the aggres-
sive outburst seems to relieve. Afterward, however,
the person is remorseful and embarrassed, and there
are no signs of aggressiveness between episodes (Burt
& Katzman, 2000). Intermittent explosive disorder de-
velops between late adolescence and the third decade
of life (American Psychiatric Association [APA], 2000).
Burt and Katzman noted that clients with intermit-
tent explosive disorder typically are large men with
dependent personality features who respond to feel-
ings of uselessness or ineffectiveness with violent
Assertive communication outbursts.
10 ANGER, HOSTILITY, AND AGGRESSION 195
Acting out is an immature defense mechanism rectly, because doing so would not be feminine and
by which the person deals with emotional conflicts or would challenge male authority. That cultural norm
stressors through actions rather than through reflec- has changed slowly in the past 25 years. Some cul-
tion or feelings. The person engages in acting-out be- tures, such as Asian and Native American, see ex-
havior, such as verbal or physical aggression, to feel pressing anger as rude or disrespectful and avoid it at
temporarily less helpless or powerless. Children and all costs. In these cultures, trying to help a client ex-
adolescents often act out when they cannot handle press anger verbally to an authority figure would be
intense feelings or deal with emotional conflict ver- unacceptable.
bally. To understand acting-out behaviors, it is im- Spector (2001) conducted a literature review to
portant to consider the situation and the persons abil- study whether or not racial bias influences clinicians
ity to deal with feelings and emotions. perceptions of patient dangerousness in Britain and
the United States. She found that clinicians generally
perceived patients with black skin (regardless of eth-
ETIOLOGY nicity or place of birth) as being more dangerous; this
Neurobiologic Theories bias influenced treatment decisions (e.g., more com-
pulsory hospitalizations, increased use of restraint
Researchers have examined the role of neurotransmit- and seclusion).
ters in aggression in animals and humans, but they Two culture-bound syndromes involve aggressive
have been unable to identify a single cause. Findings behavior. Bouffe delirante, a condition observed in
reveal that serotonin plays a major inhibitory role in West Africa and Haiti, is characterized by a sudden
aggressive behavior; therefore, low serotonin levels outburst of agitated and aggressive behavior, marked
may lead to increased aggressive behavior. This find- confusion, and psychomotor excitement. These epi-
ing may be related to the anger attacks seen in some sodes may include visual and auditory hallucinations
clients with depression. In addition, increased activity and paranoid ideation that resemble brief psychotic
of dopamine and norepinephrine in the brain is asso- episodes (Mezzich et al., 2000). Amok is a dissociative
ciated with increased impulsively violent behavior episode characterized by a period of brooding followed
(Kavoussi et al., 1997). Further, structural damage to by an outburst of violent, aggressive, or homicidal be-
the limbic system and the frontal and temporal lobes havior directed at other people and objects. This be-
of the brain may alter the persons ability to modulate havior is precipitated by a perceived slight or insult
aggression; this can lead to aggressive behavior. and is seen only in men. Originally reported from
Malaysia, similar behavior patterns are seen in Laos,
Psychosocial Theories the Philippines, Papua New Guinea, Polynesia (ca-
fard), Puerto Rico (mal de pelea), and among the
Infants and toddlers express themselves loudly and Navajo (iichaa) (Mezzich et al., 2000).
intensely, which is normal for these stages of growth
and development. Temper tantrums are a common re-
sponse from toddlers whose wishes are not granted. TREATMENT
As a child matures, he or she is expected to develop The treatment of aggressive clients often focuses on
impulse control (the ability to delay gratification) treating the underlying or comorbid psychiatric di-
and socially appropriate behavior. Positive relation- agnosis such as schizophrenia or bipolar disorder.
ships with parents, teachers, and peers; success in Successful treatment of comorbid disorders results in
school; and the ability to be responsible for ones self successful treatment of aggressive behavior. Lithium
foster development of these qualities. Children in dys- has been effective in treating aggressive clients with
functional families with poor parenting, inconsistent bipolar disorder, conduct disorders (in children), and
responses to the childs behavior, and lower socio- mental retardation. Carbamazepine (Tegretol) and
economic status are at increased risk of failing to valproate (Depakote) are used to treat aggression
develop socially appropriate behavior; this lack of associated with dementia, psychosis, and personality
development can result in a person who is impulsive, disorders. Atypical antipsychotic agents such as cloza-
easily frustrated, and prone to aggressive behavior. pine (Clozaril), risperidone (Risperdal), and olanza-
pine (Zyprexa) have been effective in treating aggres-
CULTURAL CONSIDERATIONS sive clients with dementia, brain injury, mental
retardation, and personality disorders. Benzodiaze-
What a culture considers acceptable strongly influ- pines can reduce irritability and agitation in older
ences the expression of anger. The nurse must be adults with dementia, but they can result in the loss
aware of cultural norms to provide culturally compe- of social inhibition for other aggressive clients,
tent care. In the United States, women traditionally thereby increasing rather than reducing their aggres-
were not permitted to express anger openly and di- sion (Fava, 1997).
196 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
For aggressive clients with psychoses, the cocktail staffclient interaction, group interaction, and activ-
or chaser approach may be used to produce rapid se- ities. Conversely, when predictability of meetings or
dation. The cocktail method involves giving two med- groups and staffclient interactions were lacking,
ications, usually haloperidol (Haldol) and lorazepam clients often felt frustrated and bored and aggression
(Ativan), in successive doses until the client is se- was more common and intense. Lepage, et al. (2000)
dated. The first dose is given at the time of the ag- found an association between increased numbers of
gressive behavior, a second dose is given 30 minutes to young adults (18 to 20 years of age) on inpatient psy-
1 hour after the behavior, and a third dose is given 1 to chiatric units and higher rates of violence. Nijman
2 hours after the behavior. The chaser approach in- and Rector (1999) discovered that lack of psychologi-
volves giving only lorazepam at the specified time in- cal spacehaving no privacy, being unable to get suf-
tervals, followed by an antipsychotic medication after ficient restmay be more important in triggering ag-
the client is sedated with the lorazepam (Hughes, gression than a lack of physical space.
1999) (Table 10-1). Both methods require careful as- In addition to assessing the unit milieu, the nurse
sessment for the development of extrapyramidal side needs to assess individual clients carefully. A history
effects, which can be quickly treated with benztropine of violent or aggressive behavior is one of the best pre-
(Cogentin). Chapter 2 provides a full discussion of dictors of future aggression. Determining how the
these medications and side effects. client with a history of aggression handles anger and
Although not a treatment per se, the short-term what the client thinks is helpful is important in as-
use of seclusion or restraint may be required during sisting him or her to control or nonaggressively man-
the crisis phase of the aggression cycle to protect the age angry feelings. Clients who are angry and frus-
client and others from injury. Many legal and ethical trated and believe that no one is listening to them
safeguards govern the use of seclusion and restraint are more prone to behave in a hostile or aggressive
(see Chap. 9). manner.
The nurse should assess the clients behavior to
determine which phase of the aggression cycle he or
APPLICATION OF THE
she is in so that appropriate interventions can be im-
NURSING PROCESS
plemented. The five phases of aggression and their
Assessment and effective intervention with angry or signs, symptoms, and behaviors are presented in Table
hostile clients can often prevent aggressive episodes. 10-2. Assessment of clients must take place at a safe
Early assessment, judicious use of medications, and distance. The nurse can approach the client while
verbal interaction with an angry client can often pre- maintaining an adequate distance so the client does
vent anger from escalating into physical aggression. not feel trapped or threatened. To ensure staff safety
and exhibit teamwork, it may be prudent for two
Assessment staff members to approach the client.
Table 10-1
RAPID TRANQUILIZATION OF THE ACUTELY AGGRESSIVE PSYCHOTIC CLIENT
30 Minutes to 1 Hour 1 to 2 Hours
At the Time of the Behavior After the Behavior After the Behavior
Table 10-2
FIVE-PHASE AGGRESSION CYCLE
Phase Definition Signs, Symptoms, and Behaviors
Triggering An event or circumstances in the environment Restlessness, anxiety, irritability, pacing, muscle
initiates the clients response, which is tension, rapid breathing, perspiration, loud
often anger or hostility. voice, anger
Escalation Clients responses represent escalating Pale or flushed face, yelling, swearing, agitated,
behaviors that indicate movement toward a threatening, demanding, clenched fists, threat-
loss of control. ening gestures, hostility, loss of ability to solve
the problem or think clearly
Crisis During a period of emotional and physical Loss of emotional and physical control, throwing
crisis, the client loses control. objects, kicking, hitting, spitting, biting, scratch-
ing, shrieking, screaming, inability to communi-
cate clearly
Recovery Client regains physical and emotional control. Lowering of voice, decreased muscle tension,
clearer, more rational communication, physical
relaxation
Postcrisis Client attempts reconciliation with others and Remorse, apologies, crying, quiet withdrawn
returns to the level of functioning before behavior
the aggressive incident and its antecedents.
Adapted from Keltner, N. L., Schwecke, L. H., & Bostrom, C. E. (1999). Psychiatric nursing (3d ed.). St. Louis:
Mosby, Inc.
empathy for the clients anger or frustration is impor- tion for the safety of the client, staff, and other clients.
tant. The nurse can encourage the client to express his Psychiatric facilities offer training and practice in safe
or her angry feelings verbally, suggesting that the techniques for managing behavioral emergencies, and
client is still in control and can maintain that control. only staff with such training should participate in the
Use of clear, simple, short statements is helpful. The restraint of a physically aggressive client. The nurses
nurse should allow the client time to express himself decision to use seclusion or restraint should be based
or herself. The nurse can suggest that the client go to on the facilitys protocols and standards for restraint
a quiet area or may get assistance to move other clients and seclusion. The nurse should obtain a physicians
to decrease stimulation. Medications (PRN) should be order as soon as possible after deciding to use restraint
offered, if ordered. As the clients anger subsides, the or seclusion.
nurse can help the client to use relaxation techniques Four to six trained staff members are needed to
and look at ways to solve any problem or conflict that restrain an aggressive client safely. Children, ado-
may exist (Maier, 1996). Physical activity, such as lescents, and female clients can be just as aggressive
walking, also may help the client relax and become as adult male clients. The client is informed that his
calmer. or her behavior is out of control and that the staff are
If these techniques are unsuccessful and the taking control to provide safety and prevent injury.
client progresses to the escalation phase, the nurse Four staff members each take a limb; another staff
must take control of the situation. The nurse should member protects the clients head; yet another helps
provide directions to the client in a calm, firm voice. control the clients torso if needed. The client is trans-
The client should be directed to take a time out for ported by gurney or carried to a seclusion room, and
cooling off in a quiet area or his or her room. The nurse restraints are applied to each limb and fastened to
should tell the client that aggressive behavior is not the bed frame. If PRN medication has not been taken
acceptable and that the nurse is there to help the earlier, the nurse may obtain an order for intra-
client regain control. If the client refused medications muscular medication in this type of emergency situ-
during the triggering phase, the nurse should offer ation. As noted above, the nurse performs close as-
them again. sessment of the client in seclusion or restraint and
If the clients behavior continues to escalate and documents the actions.
he or she is unwilling to accept direction to a quiet As the client regains control (recovery phase),
area, the nurse should obtain assistance from other he or she is encouraged to talk about the situation
staff members. Initially four to six staff members or triggers that led to the aggressive behavior. The
should remain ready within sight of the client but not nurse should help the client relax, perhaps sleep, and
as close as the primary nurse talking with the client. return to a calmer state. It is important to help the
This technique, sometimes called a show of force, in- client explore alternatives to aggressive behavior by
dicates to the client that the staff will control the sit- asking what the client or staff can do next time to avoid
uation if the client cannot do so. Sometimes the pres- an aggressive episode. The nurse also should assess
ence of additional staff convinces the client to accept staff members for any injuries and complete the re-
medication and take the time out necessary to regain quired documentation such as incident reports and
control. flow sheets. The staff usually has a debriefing session
When the client becomes physically aggressive to discuss the aggressive episode, how it was handled,
(crisis phase), the staff must take charge of the situa- what worked well or needed improvement, and how
the situation could have been defused more effectively. gender, and have an average age in the late 30s. These
It also is important to encourage other clients to talk authors described the assaulted staff action program
about their feelings regarding the incident. However, (ASAP) established in Massachusetts to help staff vic-
the aggressive client should not be discussed in detail tims cope with the psychological sequelae of assaults
with other clients. by clients in community-based residential programs.
In the postcrisis phase, the client is removed from In addition, ASAP works with staff to determine bet-
restraint or seclusion as soon as he or she meets the ter methods of handling situations with aggressive
behavioral criteria. The nurse should not lecture or clients and ways to improve safety in community set-
chastise the client for the aggressive behavior but tings. It is their belief that similar programs would
should discuss the behavior in a calm, rational man- be beneficial to staff in residential settings in other
ner. The client can be given feedback for regaining con- states.
trol, with the expectation that he or she will be able to
handle feelings or events in a nonaggressive manner
in the future. The client should be reintegrated into SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES
the milieu and its activities as soon as he or she can The nurse must be aware of how he or
participate. she deals with anger before helping clients do so. The
nurse who is afraid of angry feelings may avoid a
Evaluation clients anger, which allows the clients behavior to
escalate. If the nurses response is angry, the situa-
Care is most effective when the clients anger can be tion will escalate into a power struggle and the nurse
defused in an earlier stage (Morales & Duphorne, will lose the opportunity to talk down the clients
1995), but restraint or seclusion is sometimes neces- anger.
sary to handle physically aggressive behavior. The It is important to practice and gain experience in
goal is to teach angry, hostile, and potentially aggres- using techniques for restraint and seclusion before at-
sive clients to express their feelings verbally and safely tempting them with clients in crisis. There is a risk of
without threats or harm to others or destruction of staff injury whenever a client is aggressive. Ongoing
property. education and practice of safe techniques are essential
to minimize or avoid injury to both staff and clients.
COMMUNITY-BASED CARE The nurse must be calm, nonjudgmental, and non-
punitive when using techniques to control a clients
For many clients with aggressive behavior, effective
aggressive behavior. Inexperienced nurses can learn
management of the comorbid psychiatric disorder is
from watching experienced nurses deal with clients
the key to controlling aggression. Regular follow-up
who are hostile or aggressive.
appointments, compliance with prescribed medication,
When verbal techniques fail to defuse a clients
and participation in community support programs
anger and the client becomes aggressive, the nurse
help the client to achieve stability. Anger manage-
may feel frustrated or angry, as if he or she failed. The
ment groups are available to help clients express their
feelings and to learn problem-solving and conflict- clients aggressive behavior, however, does not neces-
resolution techniques. sarily reflect the nurses skills and abilities. Some
Studies of client assaults on staff in the commu- clients have a limited capacity to control their ag-
nity become increasingly important as more clients ex- gressive behaviors, and the nurse can help them to
perience rapid discharge from inpatient or acute care learn alternative ways to handle angry or aggressive
settings. Lewis & Dehn (1999) found that assaults by impulses.
clients in the community were caused partly by stress-
ful living situations, increased access to alcohol and
Points to Consider When Working
drugs, availability of lethal weapons, and noncompli-
ance with medications. These authors also suggested
With Clients Who are Angry,
that staff at private outpatient mental health clinics
Hostile, or Aggressive
may have limited experience dealing with aggressive Identify how you handle angry feelings;
clients. assess your use of assertive communication
Flannery et al. (2000) studied assaults by clients and conflict resolution. Increasing your skills
in community residences including physical or sexual in dealing with your angry feelings will help
assault, nonverbal intimidation, and verbal threats. you to work more effectively with clients.
Clients who were assaultive were most likely to have Discuss situations or the care of potentially
a diagnosis of schizophrenia, be equally divided by aggressive clients with experienced nurses.
200 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
Do not take the clients anger or aggressive Assessment and effective intervention with
behavior personally or as a measure of your angry or hostile clients can often prevent
effectiveness as a nurse. aggressive episodes.
Aggressive behavior is less common and less
KEY POINTS intense on units with strong psychiatric lead-
Anger, expressed appropriately, can be a ership, clear staff roles, and planned and ad-
positive force that helps the person solve equate events such as staffclient interaction,
problems and make decisions. group interaction, and activities.
Hostility, also called verbal aggression, is The nurse must be familiar with the signs,
behavior meant to intimidate or cause symptoms, and behaviors associated with the
emotional harm to another and can lead to triggering, escalation, crisis, recovery, and
physical aggression. postcrisis phases of the aggression cycle.
Physical aggression is behavior meant to In the triggering phase, nursing interventions
harm, punish, or force into compliance include speaking calmly and nonthreaten-
another person. ingly; conveying empathy; listening; offering
Most clients with psychiatric disorders are PRN medication; and suggesting retreat to a
not aggressive. Clients with schizophrenia, quiet area.
bipolar disorder, dementia, head injury, anti- In the escalation phase, interventions in-
social or borderline personality disorders, or clude using a directive approach; taking
conduct disorder, or those intoxicated with control of the situation; using a calm, firm
alcohol or other drugs may be aggressive. voice for giving directions; directing the
Rarely, clients may be diagnosed with client to take a time out in a quiet place;
intermittent explosive disorder. offering PRN medication; and making a
Treatment of aggressive clients often show of force.
involves treating the comorbid psychiatric
In the crisis phase, experienced, trained staff
disorder with mood stabilizers or anti-
use the techniques of seclusion or restraint
psychotic medications.
to deal quickly with the clients aggression.
During the recovery phase, interventions
include helping clients to relax, assisting
Critical Thinking Questions them to regain self-control, and discussing
1. Many community-based residential programs the aggressive event rationally.
will not admit a client with a recent history of In the postcrisis phase, the client is reinte-
aggression. Is this fair to the client? What fac- grated into the milieu.
tors should influence such decisions? Important self-awareness issues include
2. If an aggressive client injures another client examining how one handles angry feelings
or a staff person, should criminal charges be and deals with ones own reactions to angry
filed against the client? Why or why not? clients.
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com.
10 ANGER, HOSTILITY, AND AGGRESSION 201
Nursing Diagnosis
Risk for Other-Directed Violence
At risk for behaviors in which an individual demonstrates that he/she can be
physically, emotionally, and/or sexually harmful to others.
IMPLEMENTATION
Nursing Interventions Rationale
Build a trust relationship with this client as soon Familiarity with and trust in the staff members
as possible, ideally well in advance of aggressive can decrease the clients fears and facilitate
episodes. communication.
Be aware of factors that increase the likelihood of A period of building tension often precedes acting
violent behavior or that signify a build-up of agi- out or violent behavior; however, a client who is
tation. Use verbal communication or PRN med- intoxicated or psychotic may become violent with-
ication to intervene before the clients behavior out warning. Signs of increasing agitation include
reaches a destructive or violent point and physi- increased restlessness, verbal cues (Im afraid of
cal restraint becomes necessary. losing control.), threats, increased motor activity
(pacing, tremors), increased voice volume, de-
creased frustration tolerance, and frowning or
clenching fists.
Decrease environmental stimulation by turning If the client is feeling threatened, he or she can
stereo or television off or lowering the volume; perceive any stimulus as a threat. The client is
lowering the lights; asking other clients, visitors, unable to deal with excess stimuli when agitated.
or others to leave the area (or you can go with the
client to another room).
If the client tells you (verbally or nonverbally) The client may need to learn nondestructive ways
that he or she is beginning to feel hostile, aggres- to express feelings. The client can try out new be-
sive, or destructive, try to help the client express haviors with you in a nonthreatening environ-
these feelings, verbally or physically, in nonde- ment and learn to focus on expressing emotions
structive ways (remain with the client and listen, rather than acting out.
use communication techniques, or take the client
to the gym or outside with adequate supervision
for physical exercise).
Calmly and respectfully assure the client that you The client may fear loss of control and will be re-
(the staff) will provide control if he or she cannot assured that control will be provided. The client
control himself or herself, but do not threaten the may be afraid of what he or she may do if he or
client. she begins to express anger. Show that you are in
control without competing with the client and
without lowering his or her self-esteem.
Be aware of PRN medication and procedures for In an aggressive situation you will need to make
obtaining seclusion or restraint orders. decisions and act quickly. If the client is severely
agitated, medication may be necessary to decrease
the agitation.
Be familiar with restraint, seclusion, and staff as- You must be prepared to act and direct other staff
sistance procedures and legal requirements. in the safe management of the client. You are
legally accountable for your decisions and actions.
10 ANGER, HOSTILITY, AND AGGRESSION 203
Always maintain control of yourself and the situ- Your behavior provides a role model for the client
ation; remain calm. If you do not feel competent and communicates that you can and will provide
in dealing with a situation, obtain assistance as control.
soon as possible.
If you are not properly trained or skilled in deal- Avoiding personal injury, summoning help, leav-
ing safely with a client who has a weapon, do not ing the area, or protecting other clients may be
attempt to remove the weapon. Keep something the only things you can realistically do. You may
(like a pillow, mattress, or a blanket wrapped risk further danger by attempting to remove a
around your arm) between you and the weapon. weapon or subdue an armed client.
If it is necessary to remove the weapon, try to Reaching for a weapon increases your physical
kick it out of the clients hand. (Never reach for a vulnerability.
knife or other weapon with your hand.)
Distract the client momentarily to remove the Distracting the clients attention may give you an
weapon (throw water in the clients face, or yell opportunity to remove the weapon or subdue the
suddenly). client.
*You may need to summon outside assistance Exceeding your abilities may place you in grave
(especially if the client has a gun). When this is danger. It is not necessary to try to deal with a
done, total responsibility for decisions and actions situation beyond your control or to assume per-
is delegated to the outside authorities. sonal risk.
*Notify the charge nurse and supervisor as soon You may need assistance from staff members who
as possible about a (potentially) aggressive situa- are unfamiliar with this client. They will be able
tion; give them pertinent information; including to help more effectively and safely if they are
your assessment of the situation and need for aware of this information.
help, the clients name, the clients care plan, and
orders for medication seclusion, or restraint.
*Follow the hospital staff assistance plan (e.g., The need for help may be immediate in an emer-
use intercom system to page Code _____, area), gency situation. Any information that can be given
and then, if possible, have one staff member meet to arriving staff will be helpful in ensuring safety
the additional help at the unit door with neces- and effectiveness in dealing with this client.
sary information (the clients name, situation,
goal, plan, and so forth).
Do not use physical restraints or techniques with- The client has a right to the fewest restrictions
out sufficient reason. possible within the limits of safety and prevention
of destructive behavior.
Remain aware of the clients body space or terri- Potentially violent people have a body space zone
tory; do not trap the client. much larger than that of other people (up to four
times as large). That is, you need to allow them
more space and stay farther away from them for
them to not feel trapped or threatened.
Allow the client freedom to move around (within Interfering with the clients mobility without the
safety limits) unless you are trying to restrain intent of restraint may increase the clients frus-
him or her. tration, fears, or perception of threat.
Talk with the client in a low, calm voice. You may Using a low voice may help to calm the client or
need to reorient the client; call the client by prevent increasing agitation. The client may be
name, tell the client your name and where you disoriented or unaware of what is happening.
are, and so forth.
Tell the client what you are going to do and what The clients ability to understand the situation
you are doing. Use simple, clear, direct speech; re- and to process information is impaired. Clear
peat if necessary. Do not threaten the client, but limits let the client know what is expected of
state limits and expectations. him or her.
*When a decision has been made to subdue or re- Firm limits must be set and maintained. Bargain-
strain the client, act quickly and cooperatively ing interjects doubt and will undermine the limit.
with other staff members. Tell the client in a
matter-of-fact manner that he or she will be re-
strained, subdued, or secluded; allow no bargain-
ing after the decision has been made. Reassure
the client that he or she will not be hurt and that
restraint or seclusion is to ensure safety.
*While subduing or restraining the client, talk Direct communication will promote cooperation
with other staff members to ensure coordination and safety.
of effort (eg, do not attempt to carry the client
until you are sure that everyone is ready).
Do not help to restrain or subdue the client if you Staff members must maintain self-control at all
are angry (if enough other staff members are pres- times and act in the clients best interest. There is
ent). Do not restrain or subdue the client as a no justification for being punitive to a client.
punishment.
Do not recruit or allow other clients to help in Physical safety of all clients is a priority. Clients
restraining or subduing a client. should not assume a staff role; other clients are not
responsible for controlling the behavior of a client.
If at all possible, do not allow other clients to Other clients may be frightened, agitated, or
watch the situation of staff subduing or restrain- endangered by an aggressive client. They need
ing the client. Take them to a different area, and safety and reassurance at this time.
involve them in activities or discussion.
*Develop and practice consistent techniques of Consistent techniques let each staff person know
restraint as part of nursing orientation and con- what is expected and what to do in advance of
tinuing education. this highly stressful situation and will increase
safety and effectiveness.
*To provide consistency among all staff members, Consistent techniques increase safety and effec-
obtain or develop instructions in safe techniques tiveness. Transporting a client who is agitated
for carrying clients. Obtain additional staff assis- can be dangerous if attempted without sufficient
tance when needed. Have someone clear furniture help and sufficient space.
and so forth from the area through which you will
be carrying the client.
10 ANGER, HOSTILITY, AND AGGRESSION 205
When placing the client in restraints or seclusion, The clients ability to understand what is happen-
tell the client what you are doing and the reason ing to him or her may be impaired.
for this (to regain control or to protect the client
from injuring himself, herself, or others). Use
simple, concise language in a nonjudgmental,
matter-of-fact manner. (See Nursing Diagnosis:
Risk for Injury in this care plan for restraint
safety interventions and rationale.)
Tell the client where he or she is and that he or Being placed in seclusion or restraints can be
she will be safe. Assure the client that staff mem- terrifying to a client. Your assurances may help
bers will check on him or her, and if possible, tell alleviate the clients fears.
the client how to summon the staff.
Reassess the clients need for continued seclusion The client has a right to the least restrictions pos-
or restraint as you observe him or her. Reorient sible within the limits of safety and prevention of
the client or remind him or her of the reason for destructive behavior.
restraint if necessary. Release the client or de-
crease restraint as soon as it is safe and therapeu-
tic to do so. Base your decisions and actions on
the clients, not the staffs, needs.
Remain aware of the clients feelings (including The client is a worthwhile person regardless of
fear), dignity, and rights. his or her unacceptable behavior.
Carefully observe the client, and promptly com- Accurate recording of information is essential in
plete charting and reports in keeping with hospi- situations that may later be reviewed in court.
tal or unit policy. Bear in mind possible legal Restraint, seclusion, assault, and so forth are sit-
implications. uations that may result in legal action.
Administer medications safely: take care to pre- When the client is agitated, you are in a stressful
pare correct dosage, identify correct sites for situation and under pressure to move quickly.
intramuscular administration, withdraw plunger This increases the possibility of making an error
to aspirate for blood, and so forth. in dosage or administration of medication.
Take care to avoid needlestick injury and other Human immunodeficiency virus (HIV) and other
injuries that may involve exposure to the clients diseases are transmitted by exposure to blood or
blood or body fluids. body fluids.
Monitor the client for effects of medications, and Psychoactive drugs can have adverse effects such
intervene as appropriate. as allergic reactions, hypotension, and
pseudoparkinsonian symptoms.
Talk with other clients, especially after the situa- The other clients have their own needs and prob-
tion is resolved; allow them to ventilate their feel- lems. Be careful not to give attention only to the
ings related to the situation. client who is acting out.
Adapted from Schultz JM & Videbeck SL (2002). Lippincotts Manual of Psychiatric Nursing Care Plans (6th ed). Philadelphia,
Lippincott, Williams & Wilkins.
*denotes collaborative interventions
206 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
1. Which of the following is an example of assertive 4. A client is pacing in the hallway with clenched
communication? fists and a flushed face. He is yelling and
swearing. Which phase of the aggression cycle
A. I wish you would stop making me angry.
is he in?
B. I feel angry when you walk away when Im
A. Anger
talking.
B. Triggering
C. You never listen to me when Im talking.
C. Escalation
D. You make me angry when you interrupt me.
D. Crisis
2. Which of the following statements about anger
is true? 5. The nurse observes a client muttering to him-
self and pounding his fist in his other hand
A. Expressing anger openly and directly usually
while pacing in the hallway. Which of the
leads to arguments.
following principles should guide the nurses
B. Anger results from being frustrated, hurt, or action?
afraid.
A. Only one nurse should approach an upset
C. Suppressing anger is a sign of maturity. client to avoid threatening the client.
D. Angry feelings are a negative response to a B. Clients who can verbalize angry feelings
situation. are less likely to become physically
aggressive.
3. Which of the following types of drugs requires
C. Talking to a client with delusions will not be
cautious use with potentially aggressive clients?
helpful, because the client has no ability to
A. Antipsychotic medications reason.
B. Benzodiazepines D. Verbally aggressive clients often calm down
on their own if staff dont bother them.
C. Mood stabilizers
D. Lithium
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Indicate which phase of the aggression cycle would be appropriate for
implementing each of the following interventions.
Using
For further learning, visit physical restraint
http://connection.lww.com techniques
207
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
1. Describe the medication administration techniques of cocktail and chaser.
2. Discuss interventions the nurse(s) might use for a client who becomes
aggressive without warning.
208
11 Abuse and
Violence
Learning Objectives
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
209
210 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
Violent behavior has been identified as a national quently suppress their anger and resentment and do
health concern and a priority for intervention in the not tell anyone. This is particularly true in cases of
United States, where occurrences exceed 2 million childhood sexual abuse.
per year. The most alarming statistics relate to vio- Survivors of abuse often suffer in silence and con-
lence in the home and abuse, or the wrongful use and tinue to feel guilt and shame. Children particularly
maltreatment of another person. Statistics show that come to believe that somehow they are at fault and
most abuse is perpetrated by someone known to the did something to deserve or provoke the abuse. They
victim. Victims of abuse are found across the life span. are more likely to miss school, are less likely to attend
They can be a spouse or partner, a child, or an elderly college, and continue to have problems through ado-
parent. lescence into adulthood (Lansford et al., 2002). As
This chapter discusses domestic abuse (spouse adults, they usually feel guilt or shame for not trying
abuse, child abuse/neglect, elder abuse) and rape. Be- to stop the abuse. Survivors feel degraded, humiliated,
cause many survivors of abuse suffer long-term emo- and dehumanized. Their self-esteem is extremely low,
tional trauma, it also discusses disorders associated and they view themselves as unlovable. They believe
with abuse and violence: posttraumatic stress disorder they are unacceptable to others, contaminated, or
and dissociative disorders. Other long-term problems ruined (Zust, 2000).
associated with abuse and trauma include substance Victims and survivors of abuse may have prob-
abuse (see Chap. 17) and depression (see Chap. 15). lems relating to others. They find trusting others,
especially authority figures, to be difficult. In rela-
tionships, their emotional reactions are likely to be
CLINICAL PICTURE OF ABUSE erratic, intense, and perceived as unpredictable. In-
AND VIOLENCE timate relationships may trigger extreme emotional
Victims of abuse or violence certainly can have phys- responses such as panic, anxiety, fear, and terror.
ical injuries needing medical attention, but they also Even when survivors of abuse desire closeness with
experience psychological injuries with a broad range another person, they may perceive actual closeness
of responses. Some clients are agitated and visibly as intrusive and threatening.
upset; others are withdrawn and aloof, appearing Nurses should be particularly sensitive to the
numb or oblivious to their surroundings. Often domes- abused clients need to feel safe, secure, and in con-
tic violence remains undisclosed for months or even trol of his or her body. They should take care to main-
years because victims fear their abusers. Victims fre- tain the clients personal space, assess the clients
anxiety level, and ask permission before touching him
or her for any reason. Because the nurse may not al-
ways be aware of a history of abuse when initially
working with a client, he or she should apply these
cautions to all clients in the mental health setting.
CHARACTERISTICS
OF VIOLENT FAMILIES
Family violence encompasses spouse battering; ne-
glect and physical, emotional, or sexual abuse of chil-
dren; elder abuse; and marital rape. In many cases,
for years family members tolerate abusive and vio-
lent behavior from relatives that they would never
accept from strangers. In violent families, the family,
which is normally a safe haven of love and protection,
may be the most dangerous place for victims.
Research studies have identified some common
characteristics of violent families regardless of the
type of abuse that exists. They are discussed below
and in Box 11-1.
Social Isolation
One characteristic of violent families is social isola-
Family violence tion. Members of these families keep to themselves
11 ABUSE AND VIOLENCE 211
SPOUSE OR PARTNER ABUSE partners who are not married, same-sex partners, and
wives who abuse their husbands.
Spouse or partner abuse is the mistreatment or An abusive husband often believes his wife be-
misuse of one person by another in the context of an longs to him (like property) and becomes increasingly
intimate relationship. The abuse can be emotional violent and abusive if she shows any sign of inde-
or psychological, physical, sexual, or a combination pendence such as getting a job or threatening to leave.
(which is common). Emotional or psychological Typically the abuser has strong feelings of inade-
abuse includes name-calling, belittling, screaming, quacy and low self-esteem as well as poor problem-
yelling, destroying property, and making threats as solving and social skills. He is emotionally immature,
well as subtler forms such as refusing to speak to or needy, irrationally jealous, and possessive. He may
ignoring the victim. Physical abuse ranges from even be jealous of his wifes attention to their own
shoving and pushing to severe battering and chok- children or beat both his children and wife. By bully-
ing and may involving broken limbs and ribs, in- ing and physically punishing the family, the abuser
ternal bleeding, brain damage, even homicide. Sex- often experiences a sense of power and control, a feel-
ual abuse includes assaults during sexual relations ing that eludes him outside the home. Therefore the
such as biting nipples, pulling hair, slapping and hit- violent behavior often is rewarding and boosts his
ting, as well as rape (discussed later). self-esteem.
Ninety to ninety-five percent of domestic violence Dependency is the trait most commonly found in
victims are women, and estimates are that one in abused wives who stay with their husbands. Women
three women in the United States has been beaten by often cite personal and financial dependency as rea-
a spouse at least once (ABA Commission on Domestic sons why they find leaving an abusive relationship
Violence, 2002). Each year as many as 4 million women extremely difficult. Regardless of the victims talents
in the United States experience a serious assault by a or abilities, she perceives herself as unable to func-
partner. Eight percent of U.S. homicides involve one tion without her husband. She too often suffers from
spouse killing another, and three of every 10 female low self-esteem and defines her success as a person
homicide victims are murdered by their spouse, ex- by her ability to remain loyal to her marriage and
spouse, boyfriend, or ex-boyfriend. make it work. Some women internalize the criti-
An estimated 15% to 25% of women experience cism they receive and mistakenly believe they are to
violence while pregnant, according to a CDC survey. blame. Women also fear their abuser will kill them if
Battering during pregnancy leads to adverse out- they try to leave (Barnett, 2001). This fear is realistic,
comes, such as miscarriage and stillbirth, as well given that national statistics show 65% of women
as further physical and psychological problems for murdered by spouses or boyfriends were attempting
the woman (Mattson & Rodriguez, 1999; Scobie & to leave or had left the relationship (ABA Commission
McGuire, 1999). on Domestic Violence, 2002).
According to the ABA Commission on Domestic
Violence (2002), domestic violence occurs in same-sex
relationships with the same statistical frequency as in Cycle of Abuse and Violence
heterosexual relationships and affects 50,000 lesbian The cycle of violence or abuse is another reason
women and 500,000 gay men each year. Although often cited for why women have difficulty leaving an
same-sex battering mirrors heterosexual battering abusive relationship. A typical pattern exists. Usually
in prevalence, its victims receive fewer protections. the initial episode of battering or violence is followed
Seven states define domestic violence in a way that ex- by a period of the abuser expressing regret, apologiz-
cludes same-sex victims. Twenty-one other states have ing, and promising it will never happen again. He pro-
sodomy laws that designate sodomy (anal inter- fesses his love for his wife and may even engage in
course) as a crime; thus, same-sex victims must first romantic behavior (e.g., buying gifts and flowers).
confess to the crime of sodomy to prove a domestic re- This period of contrition or remorse sometimes is
lationship between partners. The same-sex batterer called the honeymoon period. The woman naturally
has an additional weapon to use against the victim: wants to believe her husband and hopes the violence
the threat of revealing the partners homosexuality to was an isolated incident. After this honeymoon period,
friends, family, employers, or the community. the tension-building phase begins; there may be argu-
ments, stony silence, or complaints from the husband.
The tension ends in another violent episode after
Clinical Picture
which the abuser once again feels regret and remorse
Because abuse often is perpetrated by a husband and promises to change. This cycle continually repeats
against a wife, that example is used in this section. itself. Each time, the victim keeps hoping the violence
These same patterns are consistent, however, between will stop.
11 ABUSE AND VIOLENCE 213
Table 11-1
DOS AND DONTS OF WORKING WITH VICTIMS OF PARTNER ABUSE
Donts Dos
Dont disclose client communications without the Do ensure and maintain the clients confidentiality.
clients consent.
Dont preach, moralize, or imply that you doubt the client. Do listen, affirm, and say I am sorry you have been hurt.
Dont minimize the impact of violence. Do express: Im concerned for your safety.
Dont express outrage with the perpetrator. Do tell the victim: You have a right to be safe and
respected.
Dont imply that the client is responsible for the abuse. Do say: The abuse is not your fault.
Dont recommend couples counseling. Do recommend a support group or individual counseling.
Dont direct the client to leave the relationship. Do identify community resources and encourage the
client to develop a safety plan.
Dont take charge and do everything for the client. Offer to help the client contact a shelter, the police, or
other resources.
Commission on Domestic Violence (1999). Domestic Violence Resources. http://www.abanet.org.domviol/stats/html.
when the woman is alone; the nurse can paraphrase the states have laws requiring police to make arrests
or edit the questions as needed for any given situation. for at least some domestic violence crimes (ABA Com-
mission on Domestic Violence, 2002). Sometimes after
Treatment and Intervention police have been called to the scene, the abuser is al-
lowed to remain at home after talking with police and
Every state in the United States allows police to make
calming down. If an arrest is made, sometimes the
arrests in cases of domestic violence; more than half
abuser is held only for a few hours or overnight. Often
the abuser retaliates upon release; hence, women have
a legitimate fear of calling the police. Studies have
Box 11-2 shown that arresting the batterer may reduce short-
term violence but increases long-term violence.
SAFE QUESTIONS
A woman can obtain a restraining order (pro-
Stress/Safety: What stress do you experience in tection order) from her county of residence that legally
your relationships? Do you feel safe in your rela- prohibits the abuser from approaching or contacting
tionships? Should I be concerned for your safety? her. Nevertheless, a restraining order provides only
Afraid/Abused: Are there situations in your rela-
limited protection. The abuser may decide to violate
tionships where you have felt afraid? Has your
partner ever threatened or abused you or your
the order and severely injure or kill the woman before
children? Have you ever been physically hurt or police can intervene. In one study, 60% of women
threatened by your partner? Are you in a rela- reported acts of abuse after receiving a protection
tionship like that now? Has your partner ever order, and 30% reported acts of severe violence (ABA
forced you to engage in sexual intercourse that Commission on Domestic Violence, 2002). Holt et al.
you did not want? People in relationships/ (2002) found that permanent protective orders were
marriages often fight; what happens when you less likely to be violated in the following 12 months,
and your partner disagree? but likelihood of abuse increased with temporary
Friends/Family: Are your friends aware that you protective orders.
have been hurt? Do your parents or siblings know
Even after a victim of battering has ended the
about this abuse? Do you think you could tell
relationship, problems may continue. Mullen et al.
them, and would they be able to give you support?
Emergency plan: Do you have a safe place to go (1999) reported that stalking, or repeated and per-
and the resources you (and your children) need sistent attempts to impose unwanted communication
in an emergency? If you are in danger now, or contact on another person, is a problem. Stalkers
would you like help in locating a shelter? Would usually are would-be lovers, pursuing a relationship
you like to talk to a social worker/counselor/me that has ended or never even existed. About 40% of
to develop an emergency plan? stalkers in Mullens study refused to accept the end
of the relationship and continued to intrude in their
Ashur, M. L. C. (1993). Asking about domestic violence:
former partners lives.
SAFE questions. JAMA, 269, (18), p. 2367. American Battered womens shelters can provide temporary
Medical Association. housing and food for abused women and their children
when they decide to leave the abusive relationship. In
11 ABUSE AND VIOLENCE 215
many cities, however, shelters are crowded, some have Types of Child Abuse
waiting lists, and the relief they provide is temporary.
The woman leaving an abusive relationship may have Physical abuse of children often results from un-
no financial support and limited job skills or experi- reasonably severe corporal punishment or unjustifi-
ence. Often she has dependent children. These barri- able punishment such as hitting an infant for crying
ers are difficult to overcome, and public or private or soiling his or her diapers. Intentional deliberate
assistance is limited. assaults on children include burning, biting, cutting,
In addition to the many physical injuries that poking, twisting limbs, or scalding with hot water. The
abused women may experience, there are emotional victim often has evidence of old injuries (e.g., scars,
and psychological consequences. Individual psycho- untreated fractures, multiple bruises of various ages)
therapy or counseling, group therapy, or support that the history given by parents or caregivers does
and self-help groups can help abused women deal not explain adequately.
with their trauma and begin to build new, healthier Sexual abuse involves sexual acts performed by
relationships. Battering also may result in post- an adult on a child younger than 18 years. Examples
traumatic stress disorder, which is discussed later include incest, rape, and sodomy performed directly
in this chapter. by the person or with an object; oral-genital contact;
and acts of molestation such as rubbing, fondling, or
exposing the adults genitals. Sexual abuse may con-
CHILD ABUSE sist of a single incident or multiple episodes over a pro-
Child abuse or maltreatment generally is defined as tracted period. A second type of sexual abuse involves
the intentional injury of a child. It can include physical exploitation, such as making, promoting, or selling
abuse or injuries, neglect or failure to prevent harm, pornography involving minors, and coercion of minors
failure to provide adequate physical or emotional care to participate in obscene acts.
or supervision, abandonment, sexual assault or intru- Neglect is malicious or ignorant withholding of
sion, and overt torture or maiming (Biernet, 2000). In physical, emotional, or educational necessities for the
the United States, each state defines child maltreat- childs well-being. Child abuse by neglect is the most
ment, identifies specific reporting procedures, and es- prevalent type of maltreatment and includes refusal
tablishes service delivery systems. Although similari- to seek health care or delay doing so; abandonment;
ties exist among the laws of the 50 states, there is also inadequate supervision; reckless disregard for the
a great deal of variation. For this reason, accurate data childs safety; punitive, exploitive, or abusive emo-
on the type, frequency, and severity of child maltreat- tional treatment; spousal abuse in the childs presence;
ment across the country are difficult to obtain. giving the child permission to be truant; or failing to
In 1997, child protective service agencies in enroll child in school.
49 states investigated an estimated 2 million reports Psychological abuse (emotional abuse) in-
alleging the maltreatment of 3 million children with cludes verbal assaults, such as blaming, screaming,
more than 50% younger than 7 years and 26% younger name-calling, and using sarcasm; constant family
than 4 years. Every day on average more than three discord characterized by fighting, yelling, and chaos;
children die in the United States from abuse or neglect and emotional deprivation or withholding of affection,
(Paulk, 1999). More than 3 million children were re- nurturing, and normal experiences that engender ac-
ported to child protective services for suspected child ceptance, love, security, and self-worth. Emotional
abuse or neglect (Paulk, 1999). Domestic violence also abuse often accompanies other types of abuse (e.g.,
affects children. One study reported that 27% of do- physical or sexual abuse). Exposure to parental alco-
mestic violence homicide victims were children, with holism, drug use, or prostitution, and the neglect that
56% younger than 2 years (Paulk, 1999). results also fall within this category.
Fathers, stepfathers, uncles, older siblings, and
live-in partners of the childs mother often perpetrate
abuse on girls. About 75% of reported cases involve
Clinical Picture
fatherdaughter incest; motherson incest is much Parents who abuse their children often have minimal
less frequent. Estimates are that 15 million women parenting knowledge and skills. They may not under-
in the United States were sexually abused as children, stand or know what their children need, or they may
and one-third of all sexually abused victims were mo- be angry or frustrated because they are emotionally
lested before 9 years of age. Accurate statistics on or financially unequipped to meet those needs. Al-
sexual abuse are difficult to obtain because many in- though lack of education and poverty contribute to
cidences are unreported as a result of shame and em- child abuse and neglect, they by no means explain the
barrassment. In other cases, women do not acknowl- entire phenomenon. Many incidences of abuse and
edge sexual abuse until they are adults (Zust, 2000). violence occur in families who seem to have every-
216 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
thingthe parents are well educated with successful widely. Often these children talk or behave in ways
careers, and the family is financially stable. that indicate more advanced knowledge of sexual
Parents who abuse their children often are emo- issues than would be expected for their age. Other
tionally immature, needy, and incapable of meeting times they are frightened and anxious and may either
their own needs much less those of a child. As in cling to an adult or reject adult attention entirely.
spousal abuse, the abuser frequently views his or her The key is to recognize when the childs behavior is
children as property belonging to the abusing parent. outside what is normally expected for his or her age
The abuser does not value the children as people with and developmental stage. Seemingly unexplained be-
rights and feelings. In some instances, the parent havior, from refusal to eat to aggressive behavior with
feels the need to have children to replace his or her peers, may indicate abuse.
own faulty and disappointing childhood; the parent The nurse does not have to decide with certainty
wants to feel the love between child and parent that that abuse has occurred. Nurses are responsible for re-
he or she missed as a child. The reality of the tremen- porting suspected child abuse with accurate and thor-
dous emotional, physical, and financial demands that ough documentation of assessment data. All 50 states
comes with raising children usually shatters these un-
realistic expectations. When the parents unrealistic
expectations are not met, he or she often reverts to
using the same methods his or her parents used. Box 11-3
This tendency for adults to raise their children in WARNING SIGNS OF ABUSED/
the same way that they were raised perpetuates the
cycle of family violence. Adults who were victims of NEGLECTED CHILDREN
abuse as children frequently abuse their own children Serious injury, such as fractures, burns, or
(Biernet, 2000). lacerations with no reported history of trauma
Delay in seeking treatment for a significant injury
Child or parent gives a history inconsistent with
Assessment severity of injury, such as a baby with contre-
coup injuries to the brain (shaken baby syn-
As with all types of family violence, detection and ac- drome) that the parents claim happened when
curate identification are the first steps. Box 11-3 lists the infant rolled off the sofa
signs that might lead the nurse to suspect neglect or Inconsistencies or changes in the childs history
abuse. Burns or scalds are found in 10% of abused during the evaluation by either the child or
children. The burns may have an identifiable shape, the adult
such as cigarette marks, or may have a stocking and Unusual injuries for the childs age and level
glove distribution, indicating scalding. The parent of of development, such as a fractured femur on
a 2 month old or a dislocated shoulder in a
an infant with a severe skull fracture may report
2 year old
that he or she rolled off the couch, even though the High incidence of urinary tract infections; bruised,
child is too young to do so or the injury is much too red, or swollen genitalia; tears or bruising of
severe for a fall of 20 inches (Ladebauche, 1997). rectum or vagina
Children who have been sexually abused may Evidence of old injuries not reported, such as
have urinary tract infections; bruised, red, or swollen scars, fractures not treated, multiple bruises that
genitalia; tears of the rectum or vagina; and bruis- parent/caregiver cannot explain adequately
ing. The emotional response of these children varies
11 ABUSE AND VIOLENCE 217
have laws, often called mandatory reporting laws, that 20% are others such as siblings, grandchildren, and
require nurses to reported suspected abuse. The nurse boarders.
alone or in consultation with other health team mem- Most victims of elder abuse are 75 years or older;
bers (e.g., physician or social worker) may report 60% to 65% are women. Abuse is more likely when
suspected abuse to appropriate local governmental the elder has multiple, chronic mental and physical
authorities. In some states, that authority is Child health problems and when he or she is dependent on
Protective Services, Children and Family Services, or others for food, medical care, and various activities of
the Department of Health. The number to call can be daily living.
located in the local telephone book. The reporting per- Persons who abuse elders almost always are in a
son may remain anonymous if desired. People who caretaking position or the elder depends on them in
work in such agencies have special education in the in- some way. Most cases of elder abuse occur when one
vestigation of abuse. Questions must be asked in ways older spouse is taking care of another. This type of
that do not further traumatize the child or impede any spousal abuse usually happens over many years after
possible legal actions. The generalist nurse should not a disability renders the abused spouse unable to care
pursue investigation with the child: it may do more for himself or herself. When the abuser is an adult
harm than good. child, it is twice as likely to be a son than a daughter.
A psychiatric disorder or substance abuse also may
Treatment and Intervention aggravate abuse of elders (Goldstein, 2000).
Elders are often reluctant to report abuse, even
The first part of treatment for child abuse or neglect
when they can, because the abuse usually involves
is to ensure the childs safety and well-being (Biernet,
family members whom the elder wishes to protect.
2000). This may involve removing the child from the
Victims also often fear losing their support and being
home, which also can be traumatic. Given the high
moved to an institution.
risk for psychological problems, a thorough psychi-
No national estimates of abuse of elders living in
atric evaluation also is indicated. A relationship of
institutions are available. Under a 1978 federal man-
trust between the therapist and child is crucial to help
date, ombudsmen are allowed to visit nursing homes
the child deal with the trauma of abuse. Depending
to check on the care of the elderly. These ombudsmen
on the severity and duration of abuse and the childs
report that elder abuse is common in institutions
response, therapy may be indicated over a significant
(Goldstein, 2000).
period.
Long-term treatment for the child usually in-
Clinical Picture
volves professionals from several disciplines such
as psychiatry, social work, and psychology. The very The victim may have bruises or fractures; may lack
young child may communicate best through play ther- needed eyeglasses or hearing aids; may be denied
apy where he or she draws or acts out situations with food, fluids, or medications; or may be restrained in a
puppets or dolls rather than talking about what has bed or chair. The abuser may use the victims finan-
happened or his or her feelings. Social service agen- cial resources for his or her own pleasure, while the
cies are involved in determining if returning the child elder cannot afford food or medications. Abusers may
to the parental home is possible based on whether or withhold medical care itself from an elder with acute
not parents can show benefit from treatment. Family or chronic illness. Self-neglect involves the elders
therapy may be indicated if reuniting the family is failure to provide for himself or herself.
feasible. Parents may require psychiatric or substance
abuse treatment. If the child is unlikely to return Assessment
home, short-term or long-term foster care services may
Careful assessment of elderly persons and their care-
be indicated.
giving relationships is essential in detecting elder
abuse. Often, determining if the elders condition re-
ELDER ABUSE sults from deterioration associated with a chronic ill-
Elder abuse is the maltreatment of older adults by ness or from abuse is difficult. Several potential indi-
family members or caretakers. It may include physical cators of abuse require further assessment and careful
and sexual abuse, psychological abuse, neglect, self- evaluation (Box 11-4). These indicators by themselves,
neglect, financial exploitation, and denial of adequate however, do not necessarily signify abuse or neglect.
medical treatment. Estimates are that 500,000 elders The nurse should suspect abuse if injuries have
are abused or neglected in domestic settings, and that been hidden or untreated or are incompatible with
as many as five unreported incidents of abuse or ne- the explanation provided. Such injuries can include
glect occur for each one reported. Nearly 60% of the cuts, lacerations, puncture wounds, bruises, welts, or
perpetrators are spouses, 20% are adult children, and burns. Burns can be cigarette burns, scaldings, acid or
218 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
caustic burns, or friction burns of the wrists or ankles Possible indicators of emotional or psychological
caused from being restrained by ropes, clothing, or abuse include an elder who is hesitant to talk openly
chains. Signs of physical neglect include a pervasive to the nurse or is fearful, withdrawn, depressed, and
smell of urine or feces, dirt, rashes, sores, lice, or in- helpless. The elder also may exhibit anger or agita-
adequate clothing. Dehydration or malnourishment tion for no apparent reason. He or she may deny any
not linked with a specific illness also strongly indi- problems, even when the facts indicate otherwise.
cates abuse. Possible indicators of self-neglect include inability
to manage money (hoarding or squandering while fail-
ing to pay bills), inability to perform activities of daily
living (personal care, shopping, food preparation, and
cleaning), and changes in intellectual function (con-
fusion, disorientation, inappropriate responses, and
memory loss and isolation). Other indicators of self-
neglect include signs of malnutrition or dehydration,
rashes or sores on the body, an odor of urine or feces,
or failure to keep needed medical appointments. For
self-neglect to be diagnosed, the elder must be evalu-
ated as unable to manage day-to-day life and take care
of himself or herself. Self-neglect cannot be established
based solely on family members beliefs that the elder
cannot manage his or her finances. For example, an
older adult cannot be considered to have self-neglect
just because he or she gives away large sums of money
to a group or charity or invests in some venture of
which family members disapprove (Reyes-Ortiz, 2001).
Warnings of financial exploitation or abuse may
include numerous unpaid bills (when the client has
enough money to pay them), unusual activity in bank
accounts, checks signed by someone other than the
elder, or recent changes in a will or power of attorney
when the elder cannot make such decisions. The elder
may lack amenities that he or she can afford such as
clothing, personal products, or a television. The elder
may report losing valuable possessions and report
Elder abuse that he or she has no contact with friends or relatives.
11 ABUSE AND VIOLENCE 219
Box 11-4
POSSIBLE INDICATORS OF ELDER ABUSE
PHYSICAL ABUSE INDICATORS
Frequent, unexplained injuries accompanied by a habit of seeking medical assistance from various locations
Reluctance to seek medical treatment for injuries, or denial of their existence
Disorientation or grogginess indicating misuse of medications
Fear or edginess in the presence of family member or caregiver
NEGLECT INDICATORS
Dirt, fecal or urine smell, or other health hazards in the elders living environment
Rashes, sores, or lice on the elder
Elder has an untreated medical condition or is malnourished or dehydrated not related to a known illness
Inadequate clothing
INDICATORS OF SELF-NEGLECT
Inability to manage personal finances, such as hoarding, squandering, or giving away money while not paying bills
Inability to manage activities of daily living such as personal care, shopping, housework
Wandering, refusing needed medical attention, isolation, substance use
Failure to keep needed medical appointments
Confusion, memory loss, unresponsiveness
Lack of toilet facilities, living quarters infested with animals or vermin
Adapted from the California Registry, Elder Abuse Prevention (1999). http://www.calregistry.com/resources/eldabpag.html
The nurse also may detect possible indicators of from talking with the elder alone. Elder abuse is more
abuse from the caregiver. The caregiver may com- likely when the caregiver has a history of family
plain about how difficult caring for the elder is, in- violence or alcohol or drug problems.
continence, difficulties in feeding, or excessive costs Some states have mandatory reporting laws for
of medication. He or she may display anger or in- elder abuse; others have only voluntary reporting laws.
difference toward the elder and try to keep the nurse Nurses should be familiar with the laws or statutes for
220 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
reporting abuse in their own states. Many cases re- ther injury, and the belief that she has no recourse in
main unreported. The local agency on aging can pro- the legal system. Victims of rape can be any age: re-
vide procedures for reporting abuse in accordance with ported cases have ranged from 15 months to 82 years.
state laws. To find the local agency, call the national The highest incidence is in girls and women 16 to
information center at 1-800-677-1116. 24 years of age. Girls younger than 18 years were the
victims in 61% of the rapes reported (American Med-
ical Association, 1999).
Treatment and Intervention
Rape most commonly occurs in a womans neigh-
Elder abuse may develop gradually as the burden of borhood, often inside or near her home. Most rapes
caregiving exceeds the caretakers physical or emo- are premeditated. Close relatives of the victim perpe-
tional resources. Relieving the caregivers stress and trate 7% of cases; 10% involve more than one attacker.
providing additional resources may help to correct Rape results in pregnancy about 10% of the time (van
the abusive situation and leave the caregiving rela- der Kolk, 2000).
tionship intact. In other cases, the neglect or abuse is Male rape is a significantly underreported crime.
intentional and designed to provide personal gain to It can occur between gay partners or strangers but
the caregiver such as access to the victims financial is most prevalent in institutions such as prisons or
resources. In these situations, removal of the elder or maximum-security hospitals. Estimates are that 2%
caregiver is necessary. to 5% of male inmates are sexually assaulted, but the
figure may be much higher. This type of rape is par-
ticularly violent, and the dynamics of power and con-
RAPE AND SEXUAL ASSAULT trol are the same as for heterosexual rape.
Rape is a crime of violence and humiliation of the vic-
tim expressed through sexual means. Rape is the per-
Dynamics of Rape
petration of an act of sexual intercourse with a female
against her will and without her consent, whether her Most men who commit rapes are 25 to 44 years of
will is overcome by force, fear of force, drugs, or in- age. In terms of race, 51% are white and tend to rape
toxicants. It is also considered rape if the woman is white victims, and 47% are African American and
incapable of exercising rational judgment because tend to rape African-American victims; the remaining
of mental deficiency or when she is below the age 2% come from all other races. Alcohol is involved in
of consent (which varies among states from 14 to 34% of cases. Rape often accompanies another crime.
18 years) (van der Kolk, 2000). The crime of rape re- Almost 75% of arrested rapists have prior criminal
quires only slight penetration of the outer vulva; full histories including other rapes, assaults, robberies,
erection and ejaculation are not necessary. Forced and homicides (van der Kolk, 2000).
acts of fellatio and anal penetration, although they Recent research has categorized male rapists into
frequently accompany rape, are legally considered four categories:
sodomy. The woman who is raped also may be phys- Sexual sadists who are aroused by the pain
ically beaten and injured. of their victims
Rape can occur between strangers, acquaintances, Exploitive predators who impulsively use
married persons, and persons of the same sex although their victims as objects for gratification
seven states define domestic violence in a way that Inadequate men who believe that no woman
excludes same-sex victims (ABA Commission on Do- would voluntarily have sexual relations
mestic Violence, 2000). Strangers commit about 50% with them and are obsessed with fantasies
of rapes, while men known to the victims commit the about sex
rest. A phenomenon called date rape (acquain- Men for whom rape is a displaced expression
tance rape) may occur on a first date, on a ride of anger and rage (van der Kolk, 2000)
home from a party, or when the two people have known Feminist theory proposes that women have his-
each other for some time. It is more prevalent near col- torically served as objects for aggression, dating back
lege and university campuses. The CDC Division of to when women (and children) were legally the prop-
Violence Prevention (1999) reports that the rate of erty of men. In 1982, for the first time a married man
serious injuries associated with dating violence in- was convicted of raping his wife, signaling the end
creases with increased consumption of alcohol by to the notion that sexual intercourse could not be
either victim or perpetrator. denied in the context of marriage.
Rape is a highly underreported crime: estimates Women who are raped are frequently in a life-
are that only 1 rape is reported for every 4 to 10 rapes threatening situation, so their primary motivation
that occur. The underreporting is attributed to the is to stay alive. At times, attempts to resist or fight
victims feelings of shame and guilt, the fear of fur- the attacker succeed; in other situations, fighting and
11 ABUSE AND VIOLENCE 221
yelling result in more severe physical injuries or even Although the treatment of rape victims and the
death. Degree of submission is higher when the at- prosecution of rapists have improved in the past
tacker has a weapon such as a gun or knife. In addition 2 decades, many people still believe that somehow
to forcible penetration, the more violent rapist may uri- a woman provokes rape by her behavior and that
nate or defecate on the woman or insert foreign objects the woman is partially responsible for this crime.
into her vagina and rectum. Box 11-5 summarizes common myths and misunder-
The physical and psychological trauma that rape standings about rape.
victims suffer is severe. Related medical problems can
include acute injury, sexually transmitted diseases,
Assessment
pregnancy, and lingering medical complaints. A cross-
sectional study of medical patients found that women To preserve possible evidence, the physical examina-
who had been raped rated themselves as significantly tion should occur before the woman has showered,
less healthy, visited a physician twice as often, and brushed her teeth, douched, changed her clothes, or
incurred medical costs more than twice as high as had anything to drink. This may not be possible,
women who had not experienced any criminal victim-
ization (American Medical Association, 1999). The
level of violence experienced during the assault was
found to be a powerful predictor of future use of med- Box 11-5
ical services. Many victims of rape experience fear, COMMON MYTHS ABOUT RAPE
helplessness, shock and disbelief, guilt, humiliation,
and embarrassment. They also may avoid the place or When a woman submits to rape, she really
wants it to happen.
circumstances of the rape; give up previously pleasur-
Women who dress provocatively are asking for
able activities; and experience depression, sexual dys- trouble.
function, insomnia, and impaired memory (American Some women like rough sex but later call it rape.
Medical Association, 1999). Once a man is aroused by a woman, he cannot
Until recently, the rights of rape victims often stop his actions.
were ignored. For example, when rape victims re- Walking alone at night is an invitation for rape.
ported a rape to authorities, they often faced doubt Rape cannot happen between persons who are
and embarrassing questions from male officers. The married.
courts did not protect the rights of victimsfor ex- Rape is exciting for some women.
ample, a womans past sexual behavior was admissi-
ble in court, although the past criminal record of her Adapted from University of Buffalo Counseling Center
accused attacker was not. Laws to correct these prob- (1999). http://ub-counseling.buffalo.edu/Relationships/
lems have been enacted on a state-by-state basis since Violence/warnings.html
the mid-1980s.
222 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
because the woman may have done some of these rape, can alert women to the characteristics of men
things before seeking care. If there is no report of oral who are likely to commit dating violence. Examples
sex, then rinsing the mouth or drinking fluids can be include negativity about women, acting tough, heavy
permitted immediately. drinking, jealousy, belittling comments, anger, and
To assess the womans physical status, the nurse intimidation.
asks the victim to describe what happened. If the Rape treatment centers (emergency services
woman cannot do so, the nurse may ask needed ques- that coordinate psychiatric, gynecologic, and physical
tions gently and with care. Rape kits and rape proto- trauma services in one location and work with law en-
cols are available in most emergency room settings forcement agencies) are most helpful to the victim. In
and provide the equipment and instructions needed to the emergency setting, the nurse is an essential part
collect physical evidence. The physician is primarily of the team in providing emotional support to the vic-
responsible for this step of the examination. tim. The nurse should allow the woman to proceed at
her own pace and not rush her through any interview
or examination procedures.
Treatment and Intervention Giving as much control back to the victim as pos-
Victims of rape fare best when they receive immediate sible is important. Ways to do so include allowing her
support and can express fear and rage to family mem- to make decisions, when possible, about whom to call,
bers, nurses, physicians, and law enforcement officials what to do next, what she would like done, etc. It is the
who believe them. Education about rape and the needs womans decision about whether or not to file charges
of victims is an ongoing requirement for health care and testify against the perpetrator. The victim must
professionals, law enforcement officers, and the gen- sign consent forms before any photographs or hair and
eral public. nail samples are taken for future evidence.
Box 11-6 lists warning signs of relationship vio- Prophylactic treatment for STDs, such as chlamy-
lence. These signs, used at the State University of dia or gonorrhea, is offered. Doing so is cost effective:
New York at Buffalo to educate students about date many victims of rape will not return to get definitive
test results for these diseases. HIV testing is strongly
encouraged in high-risk areas such as New York, Cal-
ifornia, New Jersey, and Florida but it is not required
Box 11-6 for low-risk areas. Women are also encouraged to en-
gage in safe-sex practices until the results of HIV test-
WARNING SIGNS OF ing are available. Prophylaxis with ethinyl estradiol
RELATIONSHIP VIOLENCE and norgestrel (Ovral) can be offered to prevent preg-
Emotionally abuses you (insults, makes belittling nancy. Some women may elect to wait to initiate inter-
comments, acts sulky or angry when you initiate vention until they have a positive pregnancy test result
an idea or activity) or miss a menstrual period.
Tells you with whom you may be friends or Rape crisis centers, womens advocacy groups,
how you should dress, or tries to control other and other local resources often provide a counselor or
elements of your life volunteer to be with the victim from the emergency
Talks negatively about women in general room through longer-term follow-up. This person pro-
Gets jealous for no reason vides emotional support, serves as an advocate for
Drinks heavily, uses drugs, or tries to get the woman throughout the process, and can be totally
you drunk
available to the victim. This type of complete and un-
Acts in an intimidating way by invading your
personal space such as standing too close or
conditional support is often crucial to recovery.
touching you when you dont want him to Therapy usually is supportive in approach and
Cannot handle sexual or emotional frustration focuses on restoring the victims sense of control; re-
without becoming angry lieving feelings of helplessness, dependency, and ob-
Does not view you as an equal: sees himself as session with the assault that frequently follow rape;
smarter or socially superior regaining trust; improving daily functioning; finding
Guards his masculinity by acting tough adequate social support; and dealing with feelings of
Is angry or threatening to the point that you guilt, shame, and anger. Group therapy with other
have changed your life or yourself so you wont women who have been raped is a particularly effective
anger him treatment. Some women will attend both individual
and group therapy.
Adapted from the State University of New York at Buffalo It often takes 1 year or more for survivors of rape
Counseling Center (1999). to regain previous levels of functioning. In some cases,
survivors of rape have long-term consequences such
11 ABUSE AND VIOLENCE 223
as posttraumatic stress disorder, which is discussed Research is now showing that 1 in 10 New York area
later in this chapter. residents suffer lingering stress and depression. An
additional 532,240 cases of posttraumatic stress dis-
order have been reported in the New York City Metro-
COMMUNITY VIOLENCE
politan area alone (Schlenger et al., 2002). In addition,
The CDC (1999), the U.S. Department of Education, people are reporting higher relapse rates of depression
the Department of Justice, and the National School and anxiety disorders. The study showed no increase
Safety Center have been examining homicides and of PTSD nation-wide as a result of television watch-
suicides associated with schools. The study examined ing, however, which had been an initial concern.
events on the way to and from school, on school prop- Early intervention and treatment are key to deal-
erty, and at school-sponsored events and found that ing with victims of violence. Following several in-
83% of the victims of school homicide or suicide were stances of school or workplace shootings, immediate
male and 65% of school-associated violent deaths counseling, referrals, and ongoing treatment were in-
were students, 11% were teachers or staff, and 23% stituted immediately to help those involved deal with
were community members killed on school property. the horror of their experience. After the 2001 terror-
The original study was expanded to cover school- ist attacks, teams of physicians, therapists, and other
associated violent deaths from July 1994 to June 1998. health professionals (many associated with univer-
The results showed 173 incidents, most of which were sities and medical centers) have been working with
homicides committed with firearms. The total number survivors, families, and others affected. Despite such
of events decreased since the 19921993 school year, efforts, many people will continue to experience long-
but the number of multiple-victim events during that term difficulties as described in the next section.
period increased. This means that fewer events in-
volving one person have occurred, but multiple-victim
events increased from one per year in 1992 to 1995 to PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS RELATED
five events per year from August 1995 through July TO ABUSE AND VIOLENCE
1998. A person only has to watch the evening news to
know that this is the trend.
Posttraumatic Stress Disorder
The CDC has been working with schools to de- Posttraumatic stress disorder (PTSD) is a dis-
velop curricula that emphasize problem-solving skills, turbing pattern of behavior demonstrated by some-
anger management, and social skills development. one who has experienced a traumatic eventfor ex-
In addition, parenting programs that promote strong ample, a natural disaster, combat, or an assault. The
bonding between parents and children and conflict person with PTSD was exposed to an event that posed
management in the home, as well as mentoring pro- a threat of death or serious injury and responded with
grams for young people, show promise in dealing with intense fear, helplessness, or terror. Three clusters of
school-related violence. A few people responsible for symptoms are present: reliving the event; avoiding
such violence have been diagnosed with a psychiatric reminders of the event; and being on guard, or hyper-
disorder, often conduct disorder, which is discussed arousal. The person persistently re-experiences the
in Chapter 20. Often, however, this violence seems to trauma through memories, dreams, flashbacks, or
occur when alienation, disregard for others, and little reactions to external cues about the event and, there-
regard for self predominate. fore, avoids stimuli associated with the trauma. The
Exposure to community violence tremendously victim feels a numbing of general responsiveness and
affects children and young adults (Veenema, 2001). shows persistent signs of increased arousal such as
Scarpa (2001) reports that a history of violence victim- insomnia, hyperarousal or hypervigilance, irritabil-
ization and witnessing of violence in both high-risk and ity, or angry outbursts. He or she reports losing a
low-risk youth can lead to future problems with ag- sense of connection and control over his or her life. In
gression, depression, relationships, achievement, and PTSD, the symptoms occur 3 months or more after the
abuse of drugs and alcohol. She suggests that ad- trauma, which distinguishes PTSD from acute stress
dressing the problem of violence exposure may help to disorder. This DSM-IV-TR diagnosis is appropriate
alleviate the cycle of dysfunction and further violence. when symptoms appear within the first month after
On a larger scale, violence such as the terrorist the trauma and do not persist longer than 4 weeks.
attacks in New York, Washington, and Pennsylvania PTSD can occur at any age including childhood.
in 2001 also has far-reaching effects on citizens. In the Estimates are that up to 60% of people at risk, such
immediate aftermath, children were afraid to go to as combat veterans and victims of violence and nat-
school or have their parents leave them for any rea- ural disasters, develop PTSD. Complete recovery oc-
son. Adults had difficulty going to work, leaving curs within 3 months for about 50% of people. The
their homes, using public transportation, or flying. severity and duration of the trauma and the proxim-
224 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
Dissociative Disorders
Dissociation is a subconscious defense mechanism
that helps a person protect his or her emotional self
from recognizing the full effects of some horrific or
traumatic event by allowing the mind to forget or re-
move itself from the painful situation or memory. Dis-
sociation can occur both during and after the event.
As with any other protective coping mechanism, dis-
sociating becomes easier with repeated use.
Dissociative disorders have the essential fea-
ture of a disruption in the usually integrated functions
of consciousness, memory, identity, or environmental
perception. This often interferes with the persons re-
lationships, ability to function in daily life, and ability
to cope with the realities of the abusive or traumatic
event. This disturbance varies greatly in intensity in
different people, and the onset may be sudden or grad-
Posttraumatic stress disorder
ual, transient or chronic. Dissociative symptoms are
seen in clients with PTSD.
The DSM-IV-TR describes different types of dis-
ity of the person to the event are the most important sociative disorders:
factors affecting the likelihood of developing PTSD Dissociative amnesia: The client cannot
(American Psychiatric Association [APA], 2000). remember important personal information
Woods (2000) found PTSD symptoms in groups of usually of a traumatic or stressful nature.
women who were being abused as well as women who Dissociative fugue: The client has episodes of
had been out of abusive relationships for an average suddenly leaving the home or place of work
without any explanation, traveling to therapy is effective in dealing with the thoughts and
another city, and being unable to remember subsequent feelings and behavior of trauma and
his or her past or identity. He or she may abuse survivors. Therapy for clients who dissociate
assume a new identity. focuses on reassociation or putting the consciousness
Dissociative identity disorder (formerly back together (McAllister, 2000). Both paroxetine
multiple personality disorder): The client dis- (Paxil) and sertraline (Zoloft) have been used to treat
plays two or more distinct identities or per- PTSD successfully. Clients with dissociative disorders
sonality states that recurrently take control may be treated symptomatically, i.e., with medica-
of his or her behavior. This is accompanied tions for anxiety, depression, or both if these symp-
by the inability to recall important personal toms are predominant.
information. Clients with PTSD and dissociative disorders are
Depersonalization disorder: The client has found in all areas of health care from clinics to primary
a persistent or recurrent feeling of being care offices. The nurse is most likely to encounter these
detached from his or her mental processes or clients in acute care settings when there are concerns
body. This is accompanied by intact reality for their safety or the safety of others, or when acute
testing; that is, the client is not psychotic or symptoms have become intense and require stabiliza-
out of touch with reality. tion. Treatment in acute care is usually short-term
Dissociative disorders, relatively rare in the gen- with the client returning to community-based treat-
eral population, are much more prevalent among those ment as quickly as possible.
with histories of childhood physical and sexual abuse.
Some believe the recent increase in the diagnosis of
dissociative disorders in the United States is the result
APPLICATION OF
of more awareness of this disorder by mental health
THE NURSING PROCESS
professionals (APA, 2000). Assessment
The media has focused much attention on the
BACKGROUND
theory of repressed memories in victims of abuse.
Many professionals believe that memories of child- The health history reveals that the client has a his-
hood abuse can be buried deeply in the subconscious tory of trauma or abuse. It may be abuse as a child or
mind or repressed because they are too painful for in a current or recent relationship. It generally is not
the victim to acknowledge, and that victims can be necessary or desirable for the client to detail specific
helped to recover or remember such painful memo- events of the abuse or trauma; rather, in-depth dis-
ries. If a person comes to a mental health professional cussion of the actual abuse is usually undertaken
experiencing serious problems in relationships, symp- during individual psychotherapy sessions.
toms of PTSD, or flashbacks involving abuse, the men-
tal health professional may help the person remember
GENERAL APPEARANCE
or recover those memories of abuse (McAllister, 2000).
AND MOTOR BEHAVIOR
Some believe that mental health professionals may
be overzealous in helping clients remember abuse The nurse assesses the clients overall appearance
that really did not happen or encouraging clients to and motor behavior. The client often appears hyper-
see themselves as having many parts or as having alert and reacts to even small environmental noises
inner children. This so-called false memory syndrome with a startle response. He or she may be very un-
has created problems in families when groundless ac- comfortable if the nurse is too close physically and
cusations of abuse were made. Fears exist, however, may require greater distance or personal space than
that people abused in childhood will be more reluctant most people. The client may appear anxious or agi-
to talk about their abuse history because, once again, tated and may have difficulty sitting still, often need-
no one will believe them. Still other therapists argue ing to pace or move around the room. Sometimes the
that people experiencing dissociative identity disorder client may sit very still, seeming to curl up with arms
(DID) are suffering anxiety, terror, intrusive ideas and around knees.
emotions, and, therefore, need help (McAllister, 2000).
MOOD AND AFFECT
Treatment and Interventions In assessing mood and affect, the nurse must remem-
Survivors of trauma and abuse who have PTSD or dis- ber that a wide range of emotions is possible, e.g., from
sociative disorders often are involved in group or indi- passivity to anger. The client may look frightened or
vidual therapy in the community to address the long- scared, or agitated and hostile depending on his or her
term effects of their experiences. Cognitive behavioral experience. When the client experiences a flashback,
226 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
he or she appears terrified and may cry, scream, or at- be worthwhile or valued. Clients may think they are
tempt to hide or run away. When the client is dissoci- going crazy and are out of control with no hope of re-
ating, he or she may speak in a different tone of voice gaining control. Clients may see themselves as help-
or appear numb with a vacant stare. The client may less, hopeless, and worthless.
report intense rage or anger or feeling dead inside and
unable to identify any feelings or emotions. ROLES AND RELATIONSHIPS
Clients generally report a great deal of difficulty with
THOUGHT PROCESS AND CONTENT all types of relationships. Problems with authority
The nurse asks questions about thought process and figures often lead to problems at work such as being
content. Clients who have been abused or trauma- unable to take directions from another or have an-
tized report reliving the trauma, often through night- other person monitor his or her performance. Close
mares or flashbacks. Intrusive, persistent thoughts relationships are difficult or impossible because the
about the trauma interfere with the clients ability to clients ability to trust others is severely compromised.
think about other things or to focus on daily living. Often the client has quit work or been fired, and he or
Some clients report hallucinations or buzzing voices she may be estranged from family members. Intru-
in their head. Self-destructive thoughts and impulses sive thoughts, flashbacks, or dissociative episodes may
as well as intermittent suicidal ideation are also com- interfere with the clients ability to socialize with
mon. Some clients report fantasies in which they take family or friends, and the clients avoidant behavior
revenge on their abuser. may keep him or her from participating in social or
family events.
SENSORIUM AND
PHYSIOLOGIC CONSIDERATIONS
INTELLECTUAL PROCESSES
Most clients report difficulty sleeping because of night-
During assessment of sensorium and intellectual pro-
mares or anxiety over anticipating nightmares. Over-
cesses, the nurse usually will find that the client is
eating or lack of appetite is also common. Frequently
oriented to reality except if the client is experiencing
these clients use alcohol or other drugs to attempt to
a flashback or dissociative episode. During those ex-
sleep or to blot out intrusive thoughts or memories.
periences, the client may not respond to the nurse
or may be unable to communicate at all. The nurse
also may find that clients who have been abused or Data Analysis
traumatized have memory gaps, which are periods Nursing diagnoses commonly used in the acute care
for which they have no clear memories. These periods setting when working with clients who dissociate or
may be short or extensive and are usually related to have PTSD related to trauma or abuse include the
the time of the abuse or trauma. Intrusive thoughts following:
or ideas of self-harm often impair the clients ability Risk for Self-Mutilation
to concentrate or pay attention. Ineffective Coping
Post-Trauma Response
JUDGMENT AND INSIGHT Chronic Low Self-Esteem
Powerlessness
The clients insight is often related to the duration of In addition, the following nursing diagnoses may
his or her problems with dissociation or PTSD. Early be pertinent for clients over longer periods, although
in treatment, the client may report little idea about not all diagnoses will apply to each client:
the relationship of past trauma to his or her current Disturbed Sleep Pattern
symptoms and problems. Other clients may be quite Sexual Dysfunction
knowledgeable if they have progressed further in Rape-Trauma Syndrome
treatment. The clients ability to make decisions or Spiritual Distress
solve problems may be impaired. Social Isolation
3. The client will demonstrate healthy, For the client experiencing dissociative symp-
effective ways of dealing with stress. toms, the nurse can use grounding techniques to
4. The client will express emotions focus the client on the present. For example, the
nondestructively. nurse approaches the client and speaks in a calm, re-
5. The client will establish a social support assuring tone. First the nurse calls the client by
system in the community. name and then introduces himself or herself by
name and role. If the area is dark, the nurse turns on
the lights. He or she can reorient the client by saying:
Intervention Janet, Im here with you. My name is Sheila. Im the
PROMOTING THE CLIENTS SAFETY nurse working with you today. Today is Tuesday, Feb.
3, 2000. Youre here in the hospital. This is your room
The clients safety is a priority. The nurse continually at the hospital. Can you open your eyes and look at
must assess the clients potential for self-harm or sui- me? Janet, my name is Sheila. The nurse repeats
cide and take action accordingly. The nurse and treat- this reorienting information as needed. Asking the
ment team must provide safety measures when the client to look around the room will encourage him or
client cannot do so (see Chaps. 10 and 15). To increase her to move his or her eyes and avoid being locked in
the clients sense of personal control, he or she must a daze or flashback (Benham, 1995).
begin to manage safety needs as soon as possible. The As soon as possible, the nurse encourages the
nurse can talk with the client about the difference be- client to change positions. Often during a flashback
tween having self-harm thoughts and taking action the client curls up in a defensive posture. Getting
on those thoughts: having the thoughts does not mean the client to stand and walk around helps to dispel the
the client must act on those thoughts. Gradually the dissociative or flashback experience. At this time, the
nurse can help the client to find ways to tolerate the client can focus on his or her feet moving on the floor
thoughts until they diminish in intensity. or the swinging movements of the arms. The nurse
The nurse can help the client learn to go to a safe must not grab the client or attempt to force him or
place during destructive thoughts and impulses so her to stand up or move. The client experiencing a
that he or she can calm down and wait until they pass. flashback may respond to such attempts aggressively
Initially this may mean just sitting with the nurse or or defensively, even striking out at the nurse. Ideally
around others. Later the client can find a safe place the nurse asks the client how he or she responds to
at home, often a closet or small room, where he or she touch when dissociating or experiencing a flashback
feels safe (Benham, 1995). The client may want to before one occurs; then the nurse will know if using
keep a blanket or pillows there for comfort and pic- touch is beneficial for that client. Also the nurse
tures or a tape recording to serve as reminders of the may ask the client to touch the nurses arm. If the
present. client does so, then supportive touch is beneficial for
this client.
Many clients have difficulty identifying their emo-
HELPING THE CLIENT COPE
tions or gauging the intensity of emotions. They also
WITH STRESS AND EMOTIONS
may report that extreme emotions appear out of no-
Grounding techniques are helpful to use with the where with no warning. The nurse can help clients to
client who is dissociating or experiencing a flashback get in touch with their feelings by using a log or jour-
(Benham, 1995). Grounding techniques remind the nal. Initially clients may use a feelings list so they
client that he or she is in the present, as an adult, can select the feeling that most closely matches their
and is safe. Validating what the client is feeling dur- experience. The nurse encourages the client to write
ing these experiences is important: I know this is down feelings throughout the day at specified inter-
frightening, but you are safe now. In addition, the vals, for example, every 30 minutes (Benham, 1995).
nurse can increase contact with reality and diminish Once clients have identified their feelings, they can
the dissociative experience by helping the client gauge the intensity of those feelings, for example, rat-
to focus on what he or she is currently experiencing ing the feeling on a scale of 1 to 10. Using this process,
through the senses: clients have a greater awareness of their feelings and
What are you feeling? the different intensities; this step is important in
Are you hearing something? managing and expressing those feelings.
What are you touching? After identifying feelings and their intensities,
Can you see me and the room were in? clients can begin to find triggers, or feelings that pre-
Do you feel your feet on the floor? cede the flashbacks or dissociative episodes. Clients
Do you feel your arm on the chair? can then begin to use grounding techniques to dimin-
Do you feel the watch on your wrist? ish or avoid these episodes. They can use deep breath-
228 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
ing and relaxation, focus on sensory information or having a prepared list eliminates confusion or stress.
stimuli in the environment, or engage in positive dis- This list should include a local crisis hotline to call
tractions until the feelings subside. Such distractions when the client experiences self-harm thoughts or
may include physical exercise, listening to music, urges and friends or family to call when feeling lonely
talking to others, or engaging in a hobby or activity or depressed. The client can also identify local activi-
(Clark, 1997). Clients must find which distractions ties or groups that provide a diversion and a chance
work for them then write them down and keep the list to get out of the house. The client needs to establish
and the necessary materials for the activity close at community supports to reduce dependency on health
hand. When clients begin to experience intense feel- care professionals.
ings, they can look at the list and pick up a book, listen Local support groups can be located by calling
to a tape, or draw a picture, for instance. the county mental health services or the Department
of Health and Human Services. A variety of support
groups, both on-line and in person, can be found on
HELPING TO PROMOTE the Internet.
THE CLIENTS SELF-ESTEEM
Often it is useful to view the client as a survivor
Evaluation
of trauma or abuse rather than a victim. For these
clients, who believe they are worthless and have no Long-term treatment outcomes for clients who have
power over the situation, it helps to refocus their survived trauma or abuse may take years to achieve.
view of themselves from being a victim to being a sur- These clients usually make gradual progress in pro-
vivor. Defining themselves as survivors allows them to tecting themselves, learning to manage stress and
see themselves as being strong enough to survive their emotions, and being able to function in their daily
ordeal. It is a more empowering image than seeing lives. But although clients learn to manage their feel-
oneself as a victim. ings and responses, the effects of trauma and abuse
can be far-reaching and last a lifetime.
Nursing Diagnosis
Ineffective Coping
Inability to form a valid appraisal of the stressors, inadequate choices of practiced
responses, and/or inability to use available resources.
IMPLEMENTATION
Remain aware of the clients potential for self- Clients who are in abusive situations are at
destructive or aggressive behavior, and intervene increased risk for aggressive or self-destructive
as necessary. behavior, including homicide and suicide.
Spend time with the client, and encourage the Abusive situations engender a variety of feelings
client to express his or her feelings through that the client needs to express, including grief
talking, writing, crying, and so forth. Be accepting for the loss of an ideal or healthy relationship,
of the clients feelings, including guilt, anger, fear, trust, health, hope, plans, financial security, and
and caring for the abuser. home. In addition, victims of abuse often feel
that they deserved abuse, or it would not have
happened. Finally, abuse in a relationship does
not preclude feelings of caring.
If the client has been abused, encourage him or Recalling and retelling traumatic experiences
her to talk about experiences involving abusive are parts of the grieving process and recovery
behavior; however, do not probe or push the client from such experiences. However, the feelings
to recall experiences. Maintain a nonjudgmental engendered by such recall may create extreme
attitude when talking with the client about these anxiety, and the client may not be ready to face
experiences. these feelings. Long-term supportive therapy
may be indicated.
*Involve the client in group therapy if possible, Support groups can help abusers and victims
such as groups of other victims of abuse, groups of decrease their sense of isolation and shame, in-
abusers, or mixed groups of abusers and victims. crease their self-respect, examine their behaviors,
Refer the client to resources outside the hospital and receive support for change. The client may
if necessary. feel alone in the abusive situation.
Teach the client about abusive behavior. Learning about abuse can give the client a frame-
work within which to begin to identify and express
feelings and face the reality of the abusive
situation.
Teach the client about the stress of being in an The client may need to learn to recognize stress
abusive situation and about the relationship and develop skills that deal effectively with
between stress and physical symptoms. Teach the stress.
client relaxation and other stress management
techniques.
*Help the client identify and contact support Clients in abusive relationships often are isolated
systems, crisis centers, shelters, and other and unaware of support or resources available.
community resources. Provide written information Contacting people or groups before discharge can
to the client (such as telephone numbers of these be effective in ensuring continued contact.
resources), especially if he or she chooses to
return to an abusive situation.
Encourage the client to identify and list options Clients in abusive relationships often see them-
for the future. Help the client identify positive selves as powerless, with no options, desires,
and negative aspects and consequences of these or choices.
options. Encourage the client to discover what he
or she would like and to explore choices.
*Help the client arrange follow-up care or therapy. Family, marital or individual therapy may be in-
Make referrals to therapists, support groups, or dicated provided the therapist is knowledgeable
other community resources as appropriate. about abuse, dynamics within an abusive
11 ABUSE AND VIOLENCE 231
Spend time with the client, and encourage the Abusive situations engender a variety of feelings
client to express his or her feelings through talk- that the client needs to express, including grief
ing, writing, crying, and so forth. Be accepting of for the loss of an ideal or healthy relationship,
the clients feelings, including guilt, anger, fear, trust, health, hope, plans, financial security, and
and caring for the abuser. home. In addition, victims of abuse often feel
that they deserved abuse, or it would not have
happened. Finally, abuse in a relationship does
not preclude feelings of caring.
When interacting with the client, point out and The client may not see his or her strengths or
give support for decision-making, seeking assis- work as valuable and may have suffered abuse
tance, expressions of strengths, problem-solving, when displaying strengths in the past. Positive
and successes. Recognize the clients efforts in support may help reinforce the clients efforts and
interactions, activities, and the treatment plan. promote the individuals growth and self-esteem.
Give the client choices as much as possible. Offering choices to the client conveys that the
Structure some activities at the clients present client has the right to make choices and is capable
level of accomplishment to provide successful of making them. Achievement at any level is an
experiences. opportunity for the client to receive positive
feedback.
*Use role-playing and group therapy to explore The client can try out new or unfamiliar behaviors
and reinforce effective behaviors. in a non-threatening, supportive environment.
Teach the client problem-solving and coping skills. The client needs to learn effective skills and
Support his or her efforts at decision-making; do to make his or her own decisions. When the
not make decisions for the client or give advice. client makes a decision, he or she can enjoy the
achievement of a successful decision or learn that
he or she can survive a mistake and identify
alternatives.
*Encourage the client to pursue educational, Development of the clients strengths and abilities
vocational, or professional avenues as desired. can increase self-confidence and enable the client
Refer the client to a vocational rehabilitation or to see and work toward self-sufficiency and
educational counselor, to a social worker, or to independence from the abusive relationship.
other mental health professionals as appropriate.
*Encourage the client to interact with other Clients in abusive relationships often are socially
clients and staff members and to develop rela- isolated and lack social skills or confidence.
tionships with others outside the hospital.
Assist the client or facilitate interactions as
necessary.
*Refer the client to appropriate resources and Abusive behavior often occurs when economic or
professionals to obtain child care, economic other stressors are present or increased.
assistance, and other social services.
*Help the client identify and contact support sys- Clients in abusive relationships often are isolated
tems, crisis centers, shelters, and other commu- and unaware of support or resources available.
nity resources. Provide written information to the Contacting people or groups before discharge can
client (eg, telephone numbers of these resources), be effective in ensuring continued contact.
especially if he or she chooses to return to an
abusive situation.
Adapted from Schultz, J. M.-Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts Manual of Psychiatric Nursing Care Plans (6th ed). Philadelphia:
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
*denotes collaborative interventions
They may believe that questions about abuse will of- Nurses with a personal history of abuse or trauma
fend the client or fear that incorrect interventions must seek professional assistance to deal with these is-
will worsen the situation. Nurses may even believe sues before working with survivors of trauma or abuse.
that a woman who stays in an abusive relationship Such nurses can be very effective and supportive of
might deserve or enjoy the abuse or that abuse be- other survivors but only after engaging in therapeu-
tween husband and wife is private. Some nurses may tic work and accepting and understanding their own
believe abuse to be a societal or legal, not a health, trauma.
problem.
Listening to stories of family violence or rape is
difficult; the nurse may feel horror or revulsion. Be- Points to Consider When Working
cause clients often watch for the nurses reaction, With Clients Who Have Been
containing these feelings and focusing on the clients Abused or Traumatized
needs are important. The nurse must be prepared to
listen to the clients story, no matter how disturbing, These clients have many strengths they
and support and validate the clients feelings with may not realize. The nurse can help
comments such as That must have been terrifying them move from being victims to being
or Sounds like you were afraid for your life. The survivors.
nurse must convey acceptance and regard for the Nurses should ask all women about abuse.
client as a person with worth and dignity regardless Some will be offended and angry, but it is
of the circumstances. These clients often have low more important not to miss the opportunity
self-esteem and guilt. They must learn to accept and of helping the woman who replies, Yes. Can
face what has occurred. If the client believes that the you help me?
nurse can accept him or her after hearing what has The nurse should help the client to focus on
happened, he or she then may gain self-acceptance. the present rather than dwelling on horrific
Although this acceptance is often painful, it is es- things in the past.
sential to healing. The nurse must remember that Usually a nurse works best with either the
he or she cannot fix or change things; the nurses role survivors of abuse or the abusers themselves.
is to listen and convey acceptance and support for Most find it too difficult emotionally to work
the client. with both groups.
11 ABUSE AND VIOLENCE 233
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
*All of the Websites have multiple links to other sites on the topic.
Dissociative disorders have the essential fea- traumatic stress disorder in children and parents
ture of disruption in the usually integrated after pediatric traffic injury. Pediatrics, 104(6),
1293 1299.
functions of consciousness, memory, identity, Gerlock, A. A. (2001). A profile of who completes and
and environmental perception. The four who drops out of domestic violence rehabilitation.
types are dissociative amnesia, dissociative (2001). Issues in Mental Health Nursing, 22,
fugue, dissociative identity disorder, and 379 400.
depersonalization disorder. Goldstein, M. Z. (2000). Elder abuse, neglect, and
exploitation. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.),
Survivors of trauma and abuse may be Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 2 (7th ed.,
admitted to the hospital for safety concerns pp. 31793184). Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams
or stabilization of intense symptoms such as & Wilkins.
flashbacks or dissociative episodes. Henderson, A. D. (1994). Enhancing nurses effectiveness
with abused women. Journal of Psychosocial Nurs-
The nurse can help the client to minimize ing, 32(3), 1115.
dissociative episodes or flashbacks through Holt, V. L., Kernic, M. A., Lumley, T., Wolf, M. E., &
grounding techniques and reality orientation. Rivara, F. P. (2002). Civil protection orders and
Important nursing interventions for sur- risk of subsequent police-reported violence. Journal
vivors of abuse and trauma include protect- of the American Medical Association, 288(5),
589 594.
ing the clients safety, helping the client Ladebauche, P. (1997). Childhood trauma: When to
learn to manage stress and emotions, and suspect abuse. RN, 60(9), 3843.
working with the client to build a network Lansford, J. E., Dodge, K. A., Pettit, G. S., Bates, G. E.,
of community support. Crozier, J., & Kaplow, J. (2002). A 12-year prospec-
tive study of the long-term effects of early child
Important self-awareness issues for the physical maltreatment on psychological, behavioral,
nurse include managing his or her own and academic problems in adolescence. Archives
feelings and reactions about abuse, being of Pediatric and Adolescent Medicine, 156(8),
willing to ask about abuse, and recognizing 824 830.
Mattson, S., & Rodriguez, E. (1999). Battering in
and dealing with any abuse issues the nurse
pregnant Latinos. Issues in Mental Health Nursing,
may have experienced personally. 20(4), 405422.
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com. McAllister, M. M. (2000). Dissociative identity disorder;
A literature review. Journal of Psychiatric and
Mental Health Nursing, 7, 2533.
Mullen, P. E., Pathe, M., Purcell, R., & Stuart, G. W.
(1999). Study of stalkers. American Journal of
REFERENCES Psychiatry, 156(8), 12441249.
American Bar Association Commission on Domestic Paulk, D. (1999). Recognizing child abuse, child abusers,
Violence (2002). Statistics on domestic violence. and individuals who are likely to abuse. Physicians
Retrieved August 18, 2002, from http://www.abanet. Assistant, 23(5), 3842.
org.domviol/stats.html Reyes-Ortiz, C. A. (2001). Neglect and self-neglect of the
American Medical Association. (1999). http://www. elderly in long term care. Annals of Long-Term Care,
9(2), 2124.
ama-assn.org/
Scarpa, A. (2001). Community violence exposure in a
American Psychiatric Association. (2000). DSM-IV-TR:
young adult sample: Lifetime prevalence and socio-
Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental
economic effects. Journal of Interpersonal Violence,
disorders (rev. 4th ed.). Washington, DC: Author.
16(1), 3653.
Ashur, M. L. C. (1993). Asking about domestic violence: Schlenger, W. E., Caddell, J. M., Ebert, L., Jordan, B. K.,
SAFE questions. Journal of the American Medical Rourke, K. M., Wilson, D., et al. (2002). Psychological
Association, 269(18), 2367. reactions to terrorist attacks: Findings from the Na-
Barnett, O. W. (2001). Why battered women do not leave, tional Study of Americans reactions. Journal of the
part 2. Trauma, Violence, & Abuse, 2(1), 335. American Medical Association, 288(5), 581588.
Benham, E. (1995). Coping strategies: A psycho- Scobie, J., & McGuire, M. (1999). Professional issues:
educational approach. Journal of Psychosocial The silent enemy: Domestic violence during preg-
Nursing, 33(6), 3035. nancy. British Journal of Midwifery, 7(4), 259262.
Biernet, W. (2000). Child maltreatment. In B. J. Sadock The State University of New YorkUniversity of Buffalo,
& V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psy- Counseling Center. (1999). http://ub-counseling.
chiatry, Vol. 2 (7th ed.), pp. 28782889. Philadelphia: buffalo.edu/warnings.shtml
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins. Van der Kolk, B. A. (2000). Physical and sexual abuse
Centers for Disease Control and Prevention (CDC). (1999). of adults. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.),
http://www.cdc.gov/cdc.html Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 2 (7th ed.,
Clark, C. C. (1997). Posttraumatic stress disorder: How to pp. 20022008). Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams,
support healing. American Journal of Nursing, 97(8), & Wilkins.
2732. Veenema, T. G. (2001). Childrens exposure to community
De Vries, A. P. J., Kassam-Adams, N. & Caan, A. violence. Journal of Nursing Scholarship, 33(2),
(1999). Looking beyond the physical injury: Post- 167173.
11 ABUSE AND VIOLENCE 235
Woods, S. J. (2000). Prevalence and patterns of post- age of the Columbine High School massacre: Examin-
traumatic stress disorders in abused and postabused ing the role of imitation. Archives of Pediatrics and
women. Issues in Mental Health Nursing, 21, Adolescent Medicine, 155 (9), 9941001.
309324. Lowry, R., Cohen, L. R., & Modzeleski, W. (1999). School
Zust, B. L. (2000). Effect of cognitive therapy on depres- violence, substance use, and availability of illegal
sion in rural, battered women. Archives of Psychiatric drugs on school property among U.S. high school
Nursing, XIV(2), 5163. students. The Journal of School Health, 69(9),
347355.
Porter, C. A. (1999). Locus of control and adjustment in
ADDITIONAL READINGS female adult survivors of childhood sexual abuse.
Journal of Child Sexual Abuse, 8(1), 325.
Kostinsky, S., Bixler, E. O., & Kettl, P. A. (2001). Threats U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. (2000).
of school violence in Pennsylvania after media cover- Healthy People 2010. Washington, DC: Author.
Chapter
ChapterStudy
Review
Guide
MULTIPLE-CHOICE QUESTIONS
Select the best answer for each of the following
questions.
1. Which of the following is the best action for the 5. The nurse working with a client during a flash-
nurse to take when assessing a child who might back says, I know youre scared, but youre in
be abused? a safe place. Do you see the bed in your room?
A. Confront the parents with the facts and ask Do you feel the chair youre sitting on?
them what happened. The nurse is using which of the following
techniques?
B. Consult with a professional member of the
health team about making a report. A. Distraction
C. Ask the child which of his parents caused B. Reality orientation
this injury.
C. Relaxation
D. Say or do nothing; the nurse has only
suspicions, not evidence. D. Grounding
2. Which of the following interventions would be 6. Which of the following assessment findings
most helpful for a client with dissociative might indicate elder self-neglect?
disorder having difficulty expressing feelings?
A. Hesitancy to talk openly with nurse
A. Distraction
B. Inability to manage personal finances
B. Reality orientation
C. Journaling C. Missing valuables that are not misplaced
3. Which of the following is true about touching a 7. Which type of child abuse can be most difficult to
client who is experiencing a flashback? treat effectively?
A. The nurse should stand in front of the client A. Emotional
before touching.
B. Neglect
B. The nurse should never touch a client who is
having a flashback. C. Physical
C. The nurse should touch the client only after D. Sexual
receiving permission to do so.
D. The nurse should touch the client to increase 8. Women in battering relationships often remain
feelings of security. in those relationships as a result of faulty or
incorrect beliefs. Which of the following beliefs
4. Which of the following is true about domestic is valid?
violence between same-sex partners?
A. If she tried to leave, she would be at
A. Such violence is less common than that increased risk for violence.
between heterosexual partners.
B. If she would do a better job of meeting his
B. The frequency and intensity of violence are needs, the violence would stop.
greater than between heterosexual partners.
C. No one else would put up with her dependent,
C. Rates of violence are about the same as clinging behavior.
between heterosexual partners.
D. She often does things that provoke the
D. None of the above. violent episodes.
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com
236
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify the type of abuse described in the following situations.
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
Explain and give an example to illustrate each of the following concepts:
237
Survivors guilt
238
12 Grief and
Loss
Learning Objectives
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
239
240 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
sense of self-worth, which the person may Kubler-Ross developed a model of five stages to explain
experience as a loss. A loss of role function what people experience as they grieve and mourn:
and the self-perception and worth tied to that 1. Denial is shock and disbelief regarding
role may accompany the death of a loved one. the loss.
Loss related to self-actualization. An external 2. Anger may be expressed toward God, rela-
or internal crisis that blocks or inhibits striv- tives, friends, or health care providers.
ings toward fulfillment may threaten per- 3. Bargaining occurs when the person asks
sonal goals and individual potential (Parkes, God or fate for more time to delay the
1998). A change in goals or direction will pre- inevitable loss.
cipitate an inevitable period of grief as the 4. Depression results when awareness of the
person gives up a creative thought to make loss becomes acute.
room for new ideas and directions. Examples 5. Acceptance occurs when the person shows
include having to give up plans to attend evidence of coming to terms with death.
graduate school or losing the hope of mar- This model became a prototype for care providers as
riage and family. they looked for ways to understand and assist their
The fulfillment of human needs requires dynamic clients in the grieving process.
movement throughout the various levels in the hier-
archy. The simultaneous maintenance of needs in the
BOWLBYS THEORY OF
areas of physiologic integrity, safety, security and
ATTACHMENT BEHAVIORS
sense of belonging, self-esteem, and self-actualization
is challenging and demands flexibility and focus. At John Bowlby, a British psychoanalyst, proposed a
times, a focus on protection may take priority over pro- theory that humans instinctively attain and retain
fessional or self-actualization goals. Likewise, human affectional bonds with significant others through
losses demand a grieving process that simultaneously attachment behaviors, which are crucial to the
challenges each level of need. Specific examples in- development of a sense of security and survival. Ex-
clude the loss of a pregnancy or loss of sight or hearing. amples of attachment behaviors include following,
clinging, calling out, and crying. Bowlby saw that
THE GRIEVING PROCESS human beings modified these attachment behaviors
as they matured from childhood into adulthood, but
Nurses interact with clients responding to a myriad that patterns of attachment behavior formed early
of losses along the continuum of health and illness. endure throughout the life cycle. People experience
Regardless of the type of loss, nurses must have a the most intense emotions when forming a bond such
basic understanding of what is involved to meet the as falling in love; maintaining a bond such as loving
challenge that grief brings to clients. By understand- someone; disrupting a bond such as in a divorce; and
ing the phenomena that clients experience as they renewing an attachment such as resolving a conflict
deal with the discomfort of loss, nurses may promote or renewing a relationship (Bowlby, 1980).
the expression and release of emotional as well as An attachment that is maintained is a source of
physical pain, thus supporting the grieving process. security; an attachment that is renewed is a source
Supporting this process means ministering to psy- of joy. When a bond is threatened or broken, however,
chological as well as physical needs. the person responds with anxiety, protest, and anger.
The therapeutic relationship and therapeutic Actual loss leads to sorrow. According to Bowlby,
communication skills such as active listening are para- these emotions reflect affectional bonds. Loss strongly
mount when assisting grieving clients (see Chaps. 5 activates or arouses attachment behaviors. Thus the
and 6). Recognizing the verbal and nonverbal commu- clinical picture of increased anxiety, sorrow, anger,
nication content of the various stages of grieving can looking for the lost person or object, calling out, cry-
help nurses to select interventions that will meet the ing, and protesting is an attempt to restore the lost
clients psychological and physical needs. affectional bond through attachment behaviors.
3. Experiencing cognitive disorganization and Nurses should not expect all clients to follow pre-
emotional despair with difficulty functioning dictable steps in the grieving process. Indeed, such
in the everyday world an expectation may put added pressure or stress on
4. Reorganizing and reintegrating the sense of a client when he or she most needs acceptance, re-
self to pull life back together flection, and support from care providers to ease the
Another theorist, John Harvey (1998), described grieving. Interventions that nurses can use to facili-
similar phases of grieving: tate the grieving process are discussed later in this
1. Shock, outcry, and denial chapter.
2. Intrusion of thoughts, distractions, and ob-
sessive review of the loss
Tasks of the Grieving Process
3. Confiding in others as a way to emote and to
cognitively restructure an account of the loss Rando (1984) describes tasks inherent to grieving:
Rodebaugh, Schwindt & Valentine (1999) viewed Undoing psychosocial bonds to the loved one
the process of grief as a journey through four stages: and eventually creating new ties
1. Reeling. The person feels shock, disbelief, Adding new roles, skills, and behaviors and
or denial. revising old ones into a new identity and
2. Feelings. The person experiences anguish, sense of self
guilt, profound sadness, anger, lack of concen- Pursuing a healthy lifestyle that includes
tration, sleep disturbances, appetite changes, people and activities
fatigue, and general physical discomfort. Integrating the loss into life, which does not
3. Dealing. The person begins to adapt to the mean ending the grieving but accommodat-
loss by engaging in support groups, grief ing the reality of the loss
therapy, reading, and spiritual guidance. The accompanying Clinical Vignette gives an ex-
4. Healing. The person integrates the loss as ample of integrating loss into life. Margaret has come
part of life. Acute anguish lessens. Healing to view Jamess death and the painful period of grief
does not imply, however, that the person has as a profound and poignant search for meaning in
forgotten or accepted the loss. life. The sense of his presence remains with her as
Table 12-1 compares the theories of grieving. she pursues her life without him, and she often pic-
Table 12-1
THEORETICAL UNDERSTANDING OF THE GRIEVING PROCESS
Theorist/Clinician Phase I Phase II Phase IIIPhase IV
Kubler-Ross Stage I: denial Stage II: anger Stage IV: bargaining Stage V: acceptance
(1969) Stage III:
depression
Bowlby (1980) Numbness; Emotional Cognitive Cognitive
denial yearning for the disorganization; reorganization;
loved one; emotional despair; reintegrating
protesting difficulty sense of self
permanence of functioning
the loss
Harvey (1998) Shock; outcry; Intrusion of Confiding in others
denial thoughts, to emote and
distractions; to cognitively
obsessive restructure
reviewing of account of loss
the loss
Rodebaugh et al. Reeling: Feeling: anguish, Dealing: adapting to Healing: integration
(1999) shock, guilt, sadness, the loss of loss; acute
disbelief, or anger, lack of anguish dissi-
denial concentration, pated; loss may
sleep distur- or may not be
bances, appetite forgotten or
changes, accepted
fatigue, general
discomfort
12 GRIEF AND LOSS 243
tures him before he became ill. Viewing the grieving assumptions about lifes meaning and purpose. Griev-
process more positively, she believes that his death ing often causes a person to change beliefs about self
in some way has encouraged her to become more in- and the world such as perceptions of the worlds
dependent and to participate in new opportunities. benevolence, the meaning of life as related to justice,
and a sense of destiny or life path. Other changes in
thinking and attitude include reviewing and ranking
DIMENSIONS OF GRIEVING values, becoming wiser, shedding illusions about im-
People have many and varied responses to loss. They mortality, viewing the world more realistically, and
express their bereavement in their thoughts, words, re-evaluating religious or spiritual beliefs (Zisook &
feelings, and actions as well as their physiologic re- Downs, 2000).
sponses. Therefore, nurses must use a holistic model of
grieving that encompasses cognitive, emotional, spiri-
QUESTIONING AND TRYING TO MAKE
tual, behavioral, and physiologic dimensions (Davis &
SENSE OF THE LOSS
Nolen-Hoeksema, 2001; Bonano & Kaltman, 1999).
The grieving person needs to make sense of the loss.
He or she will undergo self-examination and question
Cognitive Responses to Grief accepted ways of thinking. The loss challenges old as-
In some respects, the pain that accompanies griev- sumptions about life. For example, when a loved one
ing results from a disturbance in the persons beliefs dies prematurely, the grieving person often questions
(Parkes, 1998). The loss disrupts, if not shatters, basic the belief that life is fair or that one has control
244 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
over life or destiny. He or she searches for answers Emotional responses are evident in all phases of
to why the trauma occurred. The goal of the search is Bowlbys grief process. During the phase of numb-
to give meaning and purpose to the loss. The nurse ing, the common first response to the news of a loss is
might hear the following questions: to be stunned, as though not perceiving reality. Emo-
Why did this have to happen? He took such tions vacillate in frequency and intensity. Contrasting
good care of himself! emotions are common such as experiencing an impul-
Why did such a young person have to die? sive outburst of anger toward the deceased, oneself, or
He was such a good person! Why did this others at one moment then feeling unexpected elation
happen to him? at a sense of union with the deceased (Bowlby, 1980).
Questioning may help the person accept the re- The person may function automatically in a state of
ality of why someone died. For example, perhaps the calm then suddenly become overwhelmed with panic.
death is related to the persons health practices In the Clinical Vignette, Margaret discusses having
maybe he did not take good care of himself and have felt a numbness while going through routine func-
regular check-ups. Or it may include realizing that tions immediately after her husbands death then
loss and death are realities that all must face one one day finding herself in a department store over-
day. Others may discover explanations and meaning whelmed with frustration and wanting to shout,
and even gain comfort from a religious or spiritual per- Doesnt anyone realize Ive just lost my husband?
spective such as believing that the dead person is with In the second phase of yearning and search-
God and at peace (Davis & Nolen-Hoeksema, 2001). ing, reality begins to set in. The grieving person ex-
hibits anger, profound sorrow, and crying. He or she
often reverts to the attachment behaviors of child-
ATTEMPTING TO KEEP THE LOST
hood by acting similar to a child who loses his or her
ONE PRESENT
mother in a store or park. The grieving person may
Belief in an afterlife and the idea that the lost one has express irritability, bitterness, and hostility toward
become a personal guide are cognitive responses that clergy, medical providers, relatives, comforters, and
serve to keep the lost one present. Carrying on an even the dead person. The hopeless yet intense desire
internal dialogue with the loved one while doing an to restore the bond with the lost person compels the
activity is an example: John, I wonder what you bereaved to search for and recover him or her. The
would do in this situation. I wish you were here to grieving person interprets sounds, sights, and smells
show me. Lets see, I think you would probably. . . . associated with the lost one as signs of the deceaseds
This method of keeping the lost one present helps presence, which may intermittently provide comfort
soften the effects of the loss while assimilating its and ignite hope for a reunion. For example, the ring of
reality. the telephone at a time in the day when the deceased
regularly called will trigger the excitement of hear-
ing his or her voice. Or the scent of the deceaseds
Emotional Responses to Grief
perfume will spur her late husband to scan the room
Anger, sadness, and anxiety are the predominant for her smiling face. As hopes for the lost ones return
emotional responses to loss. The grieving person may diminish, sadness and loneliness become constant.
direct anger and resentment toward the dead person In the vignette, Margaret became angry with her
and his or her health practices, family members, or husband for not having his physical examination
health care providers or institutions. Common re- sooner and upset with friends who seemed to dis-
actions the nurse might hear are as follows: appear after James became critically ill. Such emo-
He should have stopped smoking years ago. tional tumult may last several months and seems
If you had taken her to the doctor earlier, necessary for the person to begin to acknowledge the
this might not have happened. true permanence of the loss.
It took you too long to diagnose his illness. During the phase of disorganization and de-
Guilt over things not done or said in the lost spair, the bereaved person begins to understand the
relationship is another painful emotion. Feelings of losss permanence. He or she recognizes that pat-
hatred and revenge are common when death has re- terns of thinking, feeling, and acting attached to life
sulted from extreme circumstances such as suicide, with the deceased must change. As the person relin-
murder, or war (Zisook & Downs, 2000). In a study quishes all hope of recovering the lost one, he or she
to assess short-term grief responses after elective inevitably experiences moments of depression, apa-
abortion, Williams (2001) noted that some women thy, or despair. Night is a time of acute loneliness
experience feelings of loss of control, death anxiety, during this phase.
and dependency as well as feelings of despair and In the final phase of reorganization, the be-
anger. reaved person begins to re-establish a sense of per-
12 GRIEF AND LOSS 245
sonal identity, direction, and purpose for living. He Behavioral Responses to Grief
or she gains independence and confidence (Bowlby,
1980). By experimenting with and accomplishing Behavioral responses to grief are often the easiest to
newly defined roles and functions, the bereaved be- observe. By recognizing behaviors common to griev-
comes personally empowered. This emotional and ing, the nurse can provide supportive guidance for
affective experience is associated closely with the the clients exploration of emotionally and cognitively
inherent cognitive recognition that life without the rough terrain. To promote the process, the nurse must
loved one is a reality and, therefore, must be different. provide a context of acceptance in which the client
In this phase, the person still misses the deceased but can explore his or her behavior. For example, ob-
thinking of him or her no longer evokes painful feel- serving the grieving person as functioning automat-
ings. In the vignette, hearing Spanish music, which ically or routinely without much thought can indi-
Margaret associated with James love and her sense cate that the person is in the phase of numbness
of being loved, was unbearable for many months. the reality of the loss has not set in. Tearfully sob-
Spanish music now inspires warm memories of their bing, crying uncontrollably, showing great restless-
love for each other and comforts Margaret. ness, and searching are evidence of yearning and
seeking. The person actually may call out for the
deceased or visually scan the room for him or her.
Spiritual Responses to Grief Irritability and hostility toward others reveal anger
Closely associated with the cognitive and emotional and frustration in the process. Seeking out as well as
dimensions of grief are the deeply embedded per- avoiding places or activities once shared with the de-
sonal values that give meaning and purpose to life. ceased and keeping or wanting to discard valuables
These values and the belief systems that sustain and belongings of the deceased illustrate fluctuating
them are central components of spirituality and the emotions and perceptions of hope for a reconnection.
spiritual response to grief. During loss, it is within During the phase of disorganization, the cogni-
the spiritual dimension of human experience that a tive act of redefining self-identity is essential, although
person may be most comforted, challenged, or devas- difficult. Although superficial at first, efforts made in
tated. The grieving person may become disillusioned social or work activities are behavioral means to sup-
and angry with God or other religious figures such as port the persons cognitive and emotional shifts. Drug
the priest who in Margarets situation seemed more or alcohol abuse indicates a maladaptive behavioral
concerned about getting a paper than being aware of response to the emotional and spiritual despair. Sui-
her loneliness in the waiting room. The anguish of cide and homicide attempts may be extreme responses
abandonment, loss of hope, or loss of meaning can
cause deep spiritual suffering.
Ministering to the spiritual needs of those griev-
ing is an essential aspect of nursing care. The clients
emotional and spiritual responses become intertwined
as he or she grapples with pain. With an astute aware-
ness of such suffering, nurses can promote a sense of
well-being. Providing opportunities for clients to
share their suffering assists in the psychological and
spiritual transformation that can evolve through
grieving. Finding explanations and meaning through
religious or spiritual beliefs, the client may begin to
identify positive aspects of grieving. The grieving
person also can experience loss as significant to his
or her own growth and development. In the vignette,
although Margaret was disillusioned with aspects
of her religious support system, she eventually finds
much comfort, hope, and strength in her spiritual be-
liefs. She begins to see that her husbands death gave
her life new direction and empowered her to act in
new ways. She states, If he hadnt gone, I wouldnt
be the person I am today. Im very content and peace-
ful about who I am and what I am doing. Through
her volunteer work, she comforts others who have
terminal illness. Sobbing
246 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
if the bereaved person cannot move through the griev- Universal reactions include the initial response
ing process. of shock and social disorientation, attempts to con-
In the phase of reorganization, the bereaved per- tinue a relationship with the deceased, anger with
son participates in activities and reflection that are those perceived as responsible for the death, and a
personally meaningful and satisfying. After finding time for mourning. Each culture, however, defines
creative outlets and building her personal growth, specific acceptable ways to exhibit shock and sadness,
Margaret states, Im happy with who I am and what display anger, and mourn (Bowlby, 1980). Cultural
I do. My life is more authentic. awareness of rituals for mourning can help nurses
understand an individuals or familys behavior.
Physiologic Responses to Grief
Culture-Specific Rituals
Physiologic symptoms and problems associated with
grief responses are often a source of anxiety and con- As people immigrate to the United States and Canada,
cern for the grieving person as well as friends or care- they may lose rich ethnic and cultural roots during
givers. Those grieving may complain of insomnia, the adjustment of acculturation (altering cultural
headaches, impaired appetite, weight loss, lack of en- values or behaviors as a way to adapt to another cul-
ergy, palpitations, indigestion, and changes in the im- ture). For example, funeral directors may discourage
mune and endocrine systems. Sleep disturbances are specific rites of passage that celebrate or mourn the
among the most frequent and persistent bereavement- loss of loved ones or they may be reluctant to allow
associated symptoms (Zisook & Downs, 2000). behavioral expressions they perceive as disruptive.
Many such expressions are culturally related, and
health care providers must be aware of such instances.
CULTURAL CONSIDERATIONS For example, the Hmong (people of a mountainous
Universal Reactions to Loss region of Southeast Asia) believe that harm will come
to the loved one in the next life if the body is invaded
Although all people grieve for lost loved ones, rituals just prior to death. Nurses and physicians inhibit
and habits surrounding death vary among cultures. mourning when they hesitate to accommodate rela-
Each culture defines the process of grieving and in- tives who protest the intrusion of needles and tubes
tegrating loss into life in ways consistent with its be- in their dying loved one (Nelson, 2002).
liefs about life, death, and an afterlife. Each culture Because cultural bereavement rituals have roots
considers certain aspects of the experience more im- in several of the worlds major religions (i.e., Bud-
portant than other aspects (Rotter, 2000) dhism, Christianity, Hinduism, Islam, Judaism), reli-
gious or spiritual beliefs and practices regarding
death frequently guide the clients mourning. In the
United States, various mourning rituals and practices
exist. A few of the major ones are summarized below.
AFRICAN AMERICANS
Most ancestors of todays African Americans came to
the United States as slaves and lived under the in-
fluence of European American and Christian reli-
gious practices. Therefore, many mourning rituals
are tied to religious traditions. In Catholic and Epis-
copalian services, hymns may be sung, poetry read,
and a eulogy spoken; less formal Baptist and Holiness
traditions involve singing, speaking in tongues, and
liturgical dancing. Typically the deceased is viewed in
church before being buried in a cemetery. Mourning
also may be expressed through public prayers, black
clothing, and decreased social activities. The mourn-
ing period may last a few weeks to several years.
MUSLIM AMERICANS
Islam does not permit cremation. It is important to
Physiologic symptoms follow the five steps of the burial procedure, which
12 GRIEF AND LOSS 247
specifies washing, dressing, and positioning of the home before burial. When friends enter, music is
body. The first step is traditional washing of the body played as a way to warn the deceased of the arrival.
by a Muslim of the same gender (Minarik, 1996).
HISPANIC AMERICANS
HAITIAN AMERICANS
Hispanic or Latino Americans have their origins in
Some Haitian Americans practice vodun (voodoo), also Spain, Mexico, Cuba, Puerto Rico, and the Dominican
called root medicine. Derived from Roman Catholic Republic. They are predominately Roman Catholic.
rituals and cultural practices of western Africa (Benin They pray for the soul of the deceased during a novena
and Togo) and Sudan, vodun is the practice of calling (9-day devotion) and a rosary (devotional prayer).
on a group of spirits with whom one periodically They manifest luto (mourning) by wearing black or
makes peace during specific events in life. The death black and white and keeping a subdued manner.
of a loved one may be such a time. This practice can be Respect for the deceased may include not watching
found in several states (Alabama, Louisiana, Florida, TV, going to the movies, listening to the radio, or at-
North Carolina, South Carolina, Virginia) and in some tending dances or other social events for some time.
communities within New York City. Friends and relatives bring flowers and crosses to
decorate the grave.
Guatamalan Americans may include a marimba
CHINESE AMERICANS
band in the funeral procession and services. Lighting
The largest Asian population in the United States, candles and blessing the deceased during a wake in
the Chinese have strict norms for announcing death, the home are common practices.
preparing the body, arranging the funeral and burial,
and mourning after burial. Burning incense and read- NATIVE AMERICANS
ing scripture are ways to assist the spirit of the de-
ceased in the afterlife journey. If the deceased and Ancient beliefs and practices influence the more than
family are Buddhists, meditating before a shrine in 500 Native American tribes in the United States
the room is important. For 1 year after death, the fam- even though many are now Christian. A tribes med-
ily may place bowls of food on a table for the spirit. icine man or priestly healer, who assists the friends
and family of the deceased to regain their spiritual
equilibrium, is an essential spiritual guide. Cere-
JAPANESE AMERICANS
monies of baptism for the spirit of the deceased seem
Buddhist Japanese Americans view death as a life to help ward off depression that those grieving may
passage. Close family members bathe the deceased experience. Perceptions about the meaning of death
with warm water and dress the body in a white kimono and its effects on family and friends are as varied as
after purification rites. For 2 days, family and friends the number of tribal communities.
bearing gifts may visit or offer money for the de- Viewing death as a state of unconditional love
ceased while saying prayers and burning incense. in which the spirit of the deceased remains present
comforts the Cherokee tribe and encourages move-
ment toward lifes purpose of being happy and living
FILIPINO AMERICANS
in harmony with nature and others. The Navajo tribe
Most Filipino Americans are Catholic, and wearing believes in and fears ghosts; death signifies the end
black clothing or armbands is customary during of all that is good so they must avoid touching the
mourning depending on how close one was to the de- body of the deceased. The Dakota believe in a happy
ceased. Family and friends place wreaths on the cas- afterlife called the land of the spirits; they believe
ket and drape a broad black cloth on the home of the that proper mourning is essential not only for the
deceased. Family members commonly place announce- soul of deceased but also to protect members of the
ments in local newspapers asking for prayers and community. To designate the end of mourning, they
blessings on the soul of the deceased. hold a ceremony at burial grounds where they cover
the grave with a blanket or cloth for making clothes
and later give the cloth to a tribe member. They serve
VIETNAMESE AMERICANS
a dinner during which they sing, make speeches, and
Vietnamese Americans are predominately Buddhists, give away money.
who bathe the deceased and dress him or her in black
clothes. They may put a few grains of rice in the mouth
ORTHODOX JEWISH AMERICANS
and place money with the deceased so that he or she
can buy a drink as the spirit moves on in the after- An Orthodox Jewish custom is for a relative to stay
life. The body may be displayed for viewing in the with a dying person so that the soul does not leave
248 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
the body while the person is alone. To leave the body DISENFRANCHISED GRIEF
alone after death is disrespectful. The family of the
deceased may request to cover the body with a sheet. Disenfranchised grief is grief over a loss that is
The eyes of the deceased should be closed and the not or cannot be acknowledged openly, mourned pub-
body should remain covered and untouched until licly, or supported socially. Three categories of circum-
family, a rabbi, or a Jewish undertaker can begin stances can result in disenfranchised grief:
rites. Although organ donation is permitted, autopsy A relationship has no legitimacy.
is not; burial must occur within 24 hours unless de- The loss itself is not recognized.
layed by the Sabbath. The griever is not recognized.
In each situation, there was an attachment fol-
lowed by a loss that leads to grief. The grief process
Nurses Role is more complex because the usual supports that
The diverse cultural environment of the United States facilitate grieving and the healing process are absent
offers the sensitive nurse many opportunities to indi- (Lenhardt, 1997).
vidualize care when working with grieving clients. In In our culture, kin-based relationships receive
extended families, varying expressions and responses the most attention in cases of death. Relationships
to loss can exist depending on the degree of accultur- between lovers, friends, neighbors, foster parents,
ation. Rather than assuming that he or she under- colleagues, and caregivers may be long lasting and
stands a particular cultures appropriate grieving intense, but people suffering loss in these relation-
behaviors, the nurse must encourage clients to dis- ships may not be able to mourn the loss publicly with
cover and use what is effective and meaningful for the same social support and recognition as family
them. For example, the nurse could ask a Hispanic members. In addition, some relationships are not
or Latino client who also is a practicing Catholic if always recognized publicly or sanctioned socially.
he or she would like to pray for the deceased. If an Possible examples include same-sex relationships,
Orthodox Jew has just died, the nurse could offer to cohabitation without marriage, and extramarital
stay with the body while the client notifies relatives. affairs.
As the insensitive or inflexible pressures of ac- Some losses are not recognized or seen as socially
culturation have caused people to lose, minimize, or significant; thus, accompanying grief is not legit-
modify some specific culture-related rituals, they imized, expected, or supported. Examples in this cat-
have consciously put others aside. Many Americans, egory include prenatal death, abortion, relinquishing
however, have experienced a renewed and deepened a child for adoption, death of a pet, or other losses not
awareness of the need for meaningful mourning involving death such as job loss, separation, divorce,
through ritual. An example of such an awareness is and children leaving home. Though these losses can
the creation of the AIDS quilt. The planting of a flag lead to intense grief, other people may perceive them
in the chaotic debris at Ground Zero during the im- as minor (Lenhardt, 1999).
mediate aftermath of the terrorist attack on the World People who experience a loss may not be recog-
Trade Center in September 2001 signaled the begin- nized or fully supported as a griever. For example,
nings of such a ritual. As bodies were recovered and older adults and children experience limited social
removed, the caring diligence and attentive presence recognition for their losses and the need to mourn.
of those facilitating their transport continued this As people grow older, they should expect others
meaningful rite of passage. Through the media, the their age to die. Adults sometimes view children as
United States and much of the world became com- not understanding or comprehending the loss and
panions in grief. This grieving process is arduous, can assume wrongly that their childrens grief is
but the rites in its passage are evolutionary. For ex- minimal. Children also may experience the loss of
ample, creation of a memorial at Ground Zero will be a nurturing parental figure from death, divorce,
an essential aspect of integration of the countrys or family dysfunction such as alcoholism or abuse.
loss. At the time of this writing, plans for a memorial These losses are very significant, yet they may not
are just beginning. In April 2000, a memorial was ded- be recognized.
icated for the 168 persons who died in the bombing of Nurses may experience disenfranchised grief
the Alfred P. Murrah Federal Building in Oklahoma when their need to grieve is not recognized. For ex-
City. During the ceremony, a police chaplain deliv- ample, nurses who work in areas involving organ do-
ered a message to grieving family and friends to Live nation or transplantation are involved intimately
in the present, dream of the future. Memorials and with the death of clients who may donate organs to
public services play an important role in the healing another person(s). The daily intensity of relation-
process. ships between nurses and clients/families creates
12 GRIEF AND LOSS 249
Figure 12-1. Overview of complicated grief. Adapted from Bonanno & Kaltmann,
1999; Parkes, 1998; Stroebe, 2002; and Zisook & Downes, 2000.
strong bonds among them. The emotional effects of Although nurses must recognize that complica-
loss are significant for these nurses; however, there tions may arise in the grief process, the process re-
is seldom a socially ordained place or time to grieve. mains unique and dynamic for each person. Immense
The solitude in which the grieving occurs usually variety exists in terms of the cultural determinants
provides little or no comfort (Albert, 2001). in communicating the experience and the individual
differences in emotional reactions, depth of pain, and
COMPLICATED GRIEVING time needed to acknowledge and grasp the personal
meaning or assimilate the loss. Box 12-1 discusses
Some believe complicated grieving to be a re- styles of grieving.
sponse outside the norm and occurring when a per-
son is void of emotion, grieves for prolonged periods,
or has expressions of grief that seem disproportion-
ate to the event. People may suppress emotional re- Box 12-1
sponses to the loss or become obsessively preoccupied
with the deceased person or lost object. Others actu-
STYLES OF GRIEVING
ally may suffer from clinical depression when they When determining if a person may be experiencing a
cannot make progress in the grief process (Enright & complicated grieving process, the nurse should con-
Marwit, 2002). Figure 12-1 depicts an overview of sider viewing the persons behavior as a unique style
complicated grieving. of grieving. Silver and Wortman (1980) have suggested
three styles of grieving:
Previously existing psychiatric disorders also
The bereaved vacillates from high to low distress
may complicate the grief process, so nurses must over time.
be particularly alert to clients with psychiatric dis- The bereaved shows no distress either as an
orders who also are grieving. Grief can precipitate immediate response to loss or subsequently.
major depression in a person with a history of the dis- The bereaved remains in a high state of distress
order. These clients also can experience grief and a for a period beyond what others would consider
sense of loss when they encounter changes in treat- appropriate.
ment settings, routine, environment, or even staff.
250 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
that the nurse can avoid imposing them on the client. how the person is acting (behavioral), and what is
Attentive presence is being with the client and happening in the persons body (physiological). Effec-
focusing intently on communicating with and under- tive communication skills during assessment can
standing him or her (Skott, 2001). The nurse can lead the client toward understanding his or her ex-
maintain attentive presence by using open body lan- perience. Thus assessment facilitates the clients grief
guage such as standing or sitting with arms down, process.
facing the client, and maintaining moderate eye con- While observing for client responses in the di-
tact especially as the client speaks. Creating a psycho- mensions of grieving, the nurse explores three criti-
logically safe environment includes assuring the cal components in assessment:
client of confidentiality, refraining from judging or Adequate perception regarding the loss
giving specific advice, and allowing the client to share Adequate support while grieving for the loss
thoughts and feelings freely. Adequate coping behaviors during the
process
Assessment
PERCEPTION OF THE LOSS
Effective assessment involves observing all dimen-
sions of human response: what the person is think- Assessment begins with exploration of the clients
ing (cognitive), how the person is feeling (emotional), perception of the loss. What does the loss mean to the
what the persons values and beliefs are (spiritual), client? For the woman who has spontaneously lost
Functioning automatically
Tearful sobbing; uncontrollable crying
Great restlessness; searching behaviors
Irritability and hostility
Behavioral responses Seeking and avoiding places and activities shared with lost one
Keeping valuables of lost one while wanting to discard them
Possibly abusing drugs or alcohol
Possible suicidal or homicidal gestures or attempts
Seeking activity and personal reflection during phase of reorganization
Headaches, insomnia
Impaired appetite, weight loss
Physiologic responses Lack of energy
Palpitations, indigestion
Changes in immune and endocrine systems
252 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
kept former friends away. In fact, it was in just this ing a connection between behavior and feeling;
way that she could accept the caring of some friends continuing to deny reality)
and release the importance of those who would not or Nurse: You said you were unclear about what the
could not be there for her. In this situation, exploring doctor said. I wonder if things didnt seem clear be-
perceptions and the meaning of the loss helped the cause it may have upset you to hear what he had to say.
bereaved to make cognitive shifts that valuably in- Then tonight you dont have an appetite. (using
fluenced her emotional experience. clients experience to make connection between
When loss occurs, especially if it is sudden and doctors news and clients physiologic response
without warning, the cognitive defense mechanism of and behavior)
denial acts as a cushion to soften the effects. Typical Client: What did he say, do you know? (Re-
verbal responses are, I cant believe this has hap- questing information; demonstrating a readi-
pened. It cant be true. Theres been a mistake. ness to hear it again while continuing to adjust
Adaptive denial, in which the client gradually to reality)
adjusts to the reality of the loss, can help the client In this example, the nurse gently but persis-
let go of previous (before the loss) perceptions while tently guides the client toward acknowledging the re-
creating new ways of thinking about himself or her- ality of her impending loss.
self, others, and the world. For example, Margaret had
to face the reality that, although she believed that a
priest (because he was a priest) would care about her INTERVENTIONS REGARDING SUPPORT
being alone in the surgery waiting room, he actually The nurse can help the client to reach out and accept
was concerned only about getting a paper. Gradually what others want to give in support of his or her griev-
she was able to relinquish this assumption. ing process.
Effective communication skills can be useful in Nurse: Who in your life would really want to
helping the client in adaptive denial move toward ac-
know what youve just heard from the doctor? (seek-
ceptance. In the following example, the nurse has
ing information about situational support for
heard in report that Ms. Morrison received the news
the client)
of her upcoming mastectomy. She enters Ms. Morri-
Client: Oh, Im really alone. Im not married.
sons room and sees her crying with a full tray of food
Nurse: Theres no one who would care about this
untouched.
news? (voicing doubt)
Nurse: You must be quite upset about the news
Client: Oh, maybe a friend I talk with on the
you received from your doctor about your surgery.
phone now and then.
(using reflection, assuming the client was cry-
ing as an expected response of grief. Focusing Nurse: Why dont I get the phone book for you
on the surgery is an indirect approach regard- and you can call her right now? (continuing to
ing the subject of cancer.) offer presence; suggesting an immediate source
Client: Im not having surgery. You have me of support; developing a plan of action provid-
mistaken for someone else. (using denial) ing further support)
Nurse: I saw you crying and wonder what is up- Many Internet resources are available to nurses
setting you. Im interested in how you are feeling. who want to help a client find information, support
(focusing on behavior and sharing observation groups, and activities related to the grieving process.
while indicating concern and accepting the Bereavement and Hospice Support Netline is one
clients denial) source with numerous Internet links to various orga-
Client: Im just not hungry. I dont have an ap- nizations that provide support and education through-
petite and Im not clear what the doctor said. (focus- out the United States. If a client does not have Inter-
ing on physiologic response; nonresponsive to net access, most public libraries can help to locate
nurses encouragement to talk about feelings; groups and activities that would serve his or her
acknowledging doctors visit but unsure of what needs. Depending on the state where a person lives,
he saidbeginning to adjust cognitively to real- specific groups exist for those who have lost a child,
ity of condition) spouse, or other loved one to suicide, murder, motor
Nurse: I wonder if not wanting to eat may be re- vehicle accident, or cancer.
lated to what you are feeling. Are there times when
you dont have an appetite and you feel upset about
INTERVENTIONS REGARDING
something? (suggesting a connection between
COPING BEHAVIORS
physiologic response and feelings; promoting
adaptive denial) When attempting to focus Ms. Morrison on the real-
Client: Well, as a matter of fact, yes. But I cant ity of her surgery, the nurse was helping her shift
think what I would be upset about. (acknowledg- from an unconscious mechanism of denial to conscious
12 GRIEF AND LOSS 255
coping with reality. The nurse used communication the loss. Margarets religious practices of prayer and
skills to encourage Ms. Morrison to examine her ex- spiritual reading helped her to discover new depths
perience and behavior as possible ways in which she of meaning and purpose in her life.
might be coping with the news of loss. Margaret and Encouraging the client to care for himself or her-
Jamess logical approach to life allowed them to cope self is another intervention that helps the client cope.
by continuing to have fun together while attending The nurse can offer food without pressuring the client
to medical regimens as they faced the reality of his to eat. Being careful to eat, sleep well, exercise, and
impending death. take time for comforting activities are ways that the
Intervention involves giving the client the op- client can nourish himself or herself. Just as the tired
portunity to compare and contrast ways in which he hiker needs to stop, rest, and replenish himself or her-
or she has coped with significant loss in the past and self, so must the bereaved person take a break from
helping him or her to review strengths and renew a the exhausting process of grieving. Going back to a
sense of personal power. Remembering and practic- routine of work or focusing on other members of the
ing old behaviors in a new situation may lead to ex- family may provide that respite. Volunteer activities
perimentation with new methods and self-discovery. volunteering at a hospice or botanical garden, tak-
Having an historical perspective helps the persons ing part in church activities, or speaking to bereave-
grief work by allowing shifts in thinking about him- ment education groups, for examplecan affirm the
self or herself, the loss, and perhaps the meaning of clients talents and abilities and can renew feelings
of self-worth.
Communication and interpersonal skills are tools
of the effective nurse, just like a stethoscope, scissors,
INTERVENTIONS FOR THE CLIENT and gloves. The client trusts that the nurse will have
what it takes to assist him or her in grieving. In addi-
WHO IS GRIEVING tion to previously mentioned skills, these tools include
Explore clients perception and meaning of his or the following:
her loss. Use simple, nonjudgmental statements to
Allow adaptive denial. acknowledge loss: I want you to know Im
Encourage or assist client to reach out for and thinking of you.
accept support. Refer to a loved one or object of loss by name
Encourage client to examine patterns of coping in (if acceptable in the clients culture).
past and present situation of loss.
Encourage client to review personal strengths
and personal power.
Encourage client to care for himself or herself.
Offer client food without pressure to eat.
Use effective communication:
Offer presence and give broad openings.
Use open-ended questions.
Encourage description.
Share observations.
Use reflection.
Seek validation of perceptions.
Provide information.
Voice doubt.
Use focusing.
Attempt to translate into feelings or verbalize
the implied.
Establish rapport and maintain interpersonal skills
such as
Attentive presence
Respect for clients unique grieving process
Respect for clients personal beliefs
Being trustworthy: honest, dependable,
consistent
Periodic self-inventory of attitudes and issues
related to loss
Nurses tools
256 Unit 3 CURRENT SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL CONCERNS
Words are not always necessary; a light amine their personal attitudes about loss and the
touch on the elbow, shoulder, or hand or just grieving process. Taking a self-awareness inventory
being there indicates caring. means periodic reflection on questions such as:
Respect the clients unique process of grieving. What are the losses in my life, and how do
Respect the clients personal beliefs. they affect me?
Be honest, dependable, consistent, and wor- Am I currently grieving for a significant loss?
thy of the clients trust. How does my loss affect my ability to be pre-
A welcoming smile and eye contact from the client sent to my client?
during intimate conversations indicate the nurses Who is there for me as I grieve?
trustworthiness. How am I coping with my loss?
Is the pain of my personal grief spilling over
as I listen and watch for cues of the clients
Evaluation grieving?
Am I making assumptions about the clients
Evaluation of progress depends on the goals estab-
experience based on my own process?
lished for the client. A review of the tasks and phases
Can I keep appropriate nurseclient bound-
of grieving (discussed earlier in the chapter) can be
aries as I attend to the clients needs?
useful in making a statement about the clients sta-
Do I have the strength to be present and to
tus at any given moment. We could say that while
facilitate the clients grief?
Margaret, in the vignette, still misses James, she is
What does my supervisor or a trusted col-
in the reorganization phase of grieving. She has a
league observe about my current ability to
sense of independence and confidence and has ac-
support a client in the grief process?
complished several tasks of grieving: creating new Ongoing self-examination is an effective method
ties, developing a new sense of self, pursuing new of keeping the therapeutic relationship goal-directed
activities, and integrating the loss into her life. and acutely attentive to the clients needs.
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
Nursing Diagnosis
Grieving
A normal response in the human experience of loss.
IMPLEMENTATION
Talk with the client realistically about his Discussing the loss on this level may help to make
or her loss; discuss concrete changes that the it more real for the client.
client must now begin to make as a result of
the loss.
Encourage the expression of feelings in ways Expression of feelings can help the client to iden-
the client is comfortablefor example, talking, tify, accept, and work through his or her feelings
writing, drawing, crying, wailing, or yelling. even if these are painful or otherwise uncomfort-
Convey your acceptance of these feelings and able for the client.
means of expression. Offer the client verbal
support for attempts to express feelings.
Encourage the client to recall experiences, talk Discussing the lost object or person can help the
about what was involved in his or her relation- client to identify and express the loss, what the
ship with the lost person or object, and so forth. loss means to him or her, and his or her emotional
Discuss with the client the changes in his or her response.
feelings toward self, others, and the lost person or
object as a result of the loss and grief process.
Encourage appropriate (that is, safe) expression of Feelings are not inherently bad or good. Giving
all feelings that the client has toward the lost per- the client support for expressing feelings may
son or object and convey acceptance. Assure the help the client to accept uncomfortable feelings.
client that even negative feelings like anger and
resentment are normal and healthy in grieving.
Convey to the client that although feelings may The client may fear the intensity of his or her
be uncomfortable, they are natural and necessary feelings.
to this process, that he or she can withstand
having these feelings, and that the feelings will
not harm him or her.
Discourage rumination if the client is dwelling on The client needs to identify and express the feel-
his or her guilt or worthlessness. After listening ings that underlie the rumination and to proceed
to the clients feelings, tell the client you will talk through the grief process.
about other aspects of grief and feelings.
Referral to the facility chaplain, clergy, or other The client may be more comfortable discussing
spiritual resource person may be indicated. En- spiritual issues with an advisor who shares his or
courage a connection with those in his or her life her belief system.
who may be a source of support.
Provide opportunities for the release of tension, Physical activity provides a way to relieve tension
anger, guilt, and so forth through physical activi- in a healthy, nondestructive manner.
ties. Promote regular exercise as a healthy means
of dealing with stress and tension.
Limit times and frequency of therapeutic interac- The client needs to develop independent skills of
tions with the client. Encourage independent, communicating feelings and to integrate the loss
spontaneous expression of feelings (writing, initi- into his or her daily life, while meeting his or her
ating interactions with other clients or with other own basic needs.
staff members, getting involved in a physical ac-
tivity). Plan staff-initiated interactions at times
that allow the client to fulfill responsibilities (ac-
tivities, unit duties) and maintain personal care
(sleeping, eating, hygiene).
Encourage the client to talk with others, individ- The client needs to develop independent skills of
ually and in small groups (larger as tolerated), communicating feelings and expressing grief to
about the loss in terms of his or her own and others.
others feelings and about experiences and
changes resulting from the loss.
12 GRIEF AND LOSS 261
Promote sharing, communicating, expressing Sharing grief and experiences with others can
feelings, and support among clients. Use larger help the client to identify and express feelings
groups (such as open report) for a general discus- and to feel normal in grieving. Dwelling on grief
sion of loss and grief (with or without focusing on in social interactions, however, can result in other
this clients loss). Also help the client to realize peoples discomfort with their own feelings and
that there are limits to sharing grief in a social may lead to friends and significant others avoiding
context. the client.
Point out to the client that a major aspect of loss The client may be unaware of the physical stress
is a real physical stress. Encourage good nutri- of the loss or may lack interest in activities of
tion, hydration, and elimination as well as ade- daily living. Physical exercise can relieve tension
quate rest and daily physical exercise (such as or pent-up feelings in a healthy, nondestructive
walking, running, swimming, or cycling) in the manner.
hospital and after discharge.
Teach the client (and his or her family or signifi- These people may have little or no knowledge of
cant others) about the grief process. grief or the process involved in recovery.
Point out to the client that time spent grieving The grief process allows the client to adjust to a
can be nurturing, that is a time of learning and change in his or her life and to begin to move to-
growth from which to gather the strength to go ward future opportunities.
forward.
Adapted from Schultz, J. M., & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts manual of psychiatric nursing care plans, (6th ed.). Philadel-
phia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Skott, C. (2001). Caring narratives and the strategy of Zisook, S., & Schuter, S. R. (2001). Treatment of the
presence: Narrative communication in nursing prac- depression of bereavement. American Behavioral
tice and research. Nursing Science Quarterly, 14(3), Scientist, 44(5), 782797.
249255.
Stroebe, M. S. (2002). Paving the way: From early attach-
ment theory to contemporary bereavement research. ADDITIONAL READINGS
Mortality, 7(2), 127138.
Williams, G. B. (2001). Short-term grief after an elective Burke, M. L., & Eakes, G. G. (1999). Milestones of chronic
abortion. JOGNN Clinical Studies, 30(2), 174. sorrow: Perspectives of chronically ill and bereaved
Zilberfein, F. (1999). Coping with death: Anticipatory persons and family caregivers. Journal of Family
grief and bereavement. Generations, 23(1), 6975. Nursing, 5(4), 374388.
Zisook, S., & Downs, N. S. (2000). Death, dying, and Geissler, E. M. (1998). Pocket guide to cultural assessment.
bereavement. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.). St. Louis: Mosby.
Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 2, Jacobs, S., Mazure, C., & Prigerson, H. (2000). Diagnostic
(7th ed., pp. 963978). Philadelphia: Lippincott criteria for traumatic grief. Death Studies, 24(3),
Williams & Wilkins. 185199.
Chapter Study Guide
MULTIPLE-CHOICE QUESTIONS
Select the best answer for each of the following
questions.
1. Which of the following accurately lists Bowlbys A. inadequate support and old age
phases of the grieving process?
B. childbirth, marriage, and divorce
A. Denial, anger, depression, bargaining,
C. death of a spouse or child, death by suicide,
acceptance
sudden and unexpected death
B. Shock, outcry, and denial; intrusion of D. inadequate perception of the grieving crisis
thought, distractions, and obsessive reviewing
of the loss; confiding in others to emote and 4. Physiologic responses of complicated grieving
cognitively restructure an account of the loss include
C. Numbness and denial of the loss, emotional A. tearfulness when recalling significant memo-
yearning for the loved one and protesting per- ries of the lost one
manence of the loss, cognitive disorganization
and emotional despair, reorganizing and B. impaired appetite, weight loss, lack of energy,
reintegrating a sense of self palpitations
263
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify the dimension of grieving for each of the following client expressions
or behaviors:
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
1. Give an example of each of the following:
Styles of grieving
264
Emotional response during phase of numbing in the grieving process
2. For each of the following client statements, write a response that the nurse
might make and the rationale for the nurses response:
265
Theres nowhere for me to turn.
266
Unit 4
Nursing Practice for
Psychiatric Disorders
13 Anxiety and
Anxiety
Learning Objectives Disorders
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
1. Describe anxiety as a
response to stress.
2. Describe the levels of
anxiety with behavioral
changes related to each
level.
3. Discuss the use of defense Key Terms
mechanisms by people with agoraphobia mild anxiety
anxiety disorders.
anxiety moderate anxiety
4. Describe the current
theories regarding the anxiety disorders obsessions
etiologies of major anxiety assertiveness training panic anxiety
disorders.
automatisms panic attack
5. Evaluate the effectiveness
of treatment including avoidance behavior panic disorder
medications for clients with compulsions phobia
anxiety disorders.
decatastrophizing positive reframing
6. Apply the nursing process
to the care of clients with defense mechanisms primary gain
anxiety and anxiety depersonalization response prevention
disorders.
derealization secondary gain
7. Provide teaching to clients,
families, caregivers, and exposure severe anxiety
communities to increase fear stress
understanding of anxiety
flooding systematic desensitization
and stress-related
disorders.
8. Examine his or her
feelings, beliefs, and atti-
tudes regarding clients
with anxiety disorders.
268
13 ANXIETY AND ANXIETY DISORDERS 269
Anxiety is a vague feeling of dread or apprehen- vert glycogen stores to glucose for food) to pre-
sion; it is a response to external or internal stimuli pare for potential defense needs.
that can have behavioral, emotional, cognitive, and In the resistance stage, the digestive system
physical symptoms. Anxiety is distinguished from reduces function to shunt blood to areas
fear, which is feeling afraid or threatened by a clearly needed for defense. The lungs take in more
identifiable, external stimulus that represents danger air, and the heart beats faster and harder so
to the person. Anxiety is unavoidable in life and can it can circulate this highly oxygenated and
serve many positive functions such as motivating the highly nourished blood to the muscles to
person to take action to solve a problem or to resolve a defend the body by fight, flight, or freeze
crisis. It is considered normal when it is appropriate behaviors. If the person adapts to the stress,
to the situation and dissipates when the situation has the body responses relax, and the gland,
been resolved. organ, and systemic responses abate.
Anxiety disorders comprise a group of condi- The exhaustion stage occurs when the person
tions that share a key feature of excessive anxiety has responded negatively to anxiety and
with ensuing behavioral, emotional, and physiologic stress: body stores are depleted or the
responses. Clients suffering from anxiety disorders emotional components are not resolved,
can demonstrate unusual behaviors such as panic resulting in continual arousal of the physio-
without reason, unwarranted fear of objects or life logic responses and little reserve capacity.
conditions, uncontrollable repetitive actions, re- Autonomic nervous system responses to fear and
experiencing of traumatic events, or unexplainable anxiety generate the involuntary activities of the body
or overwhelming worry. They experience significant that are involved in self-preservation. Sympathetic
distress over time, and the disorder significantly nerve fibers charge up the vital signs at any hint of
impairs their daily routine, social life, and occupa- danger to prepare the bodys defenses. The adrenal
tional functioning. glands release adrenalin (epinephrine), which causes
the body to take in more oxygen, dilate the pupils, and
This chapter discusses anxiety as an expected re-
increase arterial pressure and heart rate while con-
sponse to stress. It also explores anxiety disorders with
stricting the peripheral vessels and shunting blood
particular emphasis on panic disorder and obsessive-
from the gastrointestinal and reproductive systems
compulsive disorder (OCD).
and increasing glycogenolysis to free glucose for fuel
ANXIETY AS A RESPONSE
TO STRESS
Stress is the wear and tear that life causes on the
body (Selye, 1956). It occurs when a person has diffi-
culty dealing with life situations, problems, and goals.
Each person handles stress differently: one person can
thrive in a situation that creates great distress for
another. For example, many people view public speak-
ing as scary, but for teachers and actors it is an every-
day, enjoyable experience. Marriage, children, air-
planes, snakes, a new job, a new school, and leaving
home are examples of stress-causing events.
Hans Selye (1956, 1974), an endocrinologist,
identified the physiologic aspects of stress, which he
labeled the general adaptation syndrome. He used lab-
oratory animals to assess biologic system changes; the
stages of the bodys physical responses to pain, heat,
toxins, and restraint; and later the minds emotional
responses to real or perceived stressors. He deter-
mined three stages of reaction to stress:
In the alarm reaction stage, stress stimulates
the body to send messages from the hypothal-
amus to the glands (such as the adrenal gland
to send out adrenalin and norepinephrine for
fuel) and organs (such as the liver to recon- Three reactions or stages of stress
270 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
for the heart, muscles, and central nervous system. sense of walking in another persons shoes for a mo-
When the danger has passed, parasympathetic nerve ment in time (Sullivan, 1952). Examples of nonverbal
fibers reverse this process and return the body to nor- empathetic communication are when the family of a
mal operating conditions until the next sign of threat client undergoing surgery can tell from the physi-
reactivates the sympathetic responses. cians body language that their loved one has died,
Anxiety causes uncomfortable cognitive, psycho- when the nurse reads a plea for help in a clients eyes,
motor, and physiologic responses such as difficulty or when a person feels the tension in a room where
with logical thought, increasingly agitated motor ac- two people have been arguing and are now not speak-
tivity, and elevated vital signs. To reduce these un- ing to each other.
comfortable feelings, the person tries to reduce the
level of discomfort by implementing new adaptive be-
Levels of Anxiety
haviors or defense mechanisms. Adaptive behaviors
can be positive and help the person to learn: for ex- Anxiety has both healthy and harmful aspects de-
ample, using imagery techniques to refocus attention pending on its degree and duration as well as on how
on a pleasant scene, practicing sequential relaxation well the person copes with it. Anxiety has four levels:
of the body from head to toe, and breathing slowly and mild, moderate, severe, and panic (Table 13-1). Each
steadily to reduce muscle tension and vital signs. Neg- level causes both physiologic and emotional changes
ative responses to anxiety can result in maladaptive in the person.
behaviors such as tension headaches, pain syndromes, Mild anxiety is a sensation that something is
and stress-related responses that reduce the efficiency different and warrants special attention. Sensory
of the immune system. stimulation increases and helps the person focus at-
People can communicate anxiety through words tention to learn, solve problems, think, act, feel, and
such as hearing someone yell fire in a crowded room protect himself or herself. Mild anxiety often moti-
or listening to the agitated voice of a mother who can- vates people to make changes or to engage in goal-
not find her child in a crowded mall. They can convey directed activity. For example, it helps students to
anxiety nonverbally through empathy, which is the focus on studying for an examination.
Moderate anxiety is the disturbing feeling that
something is definitely wrong; the person becomes
nervous or agitated. In moderate anxiety, the person
can still process information, solve problems, and learn
new things with assistance from others. He or she
has difficulty concentrating independently but can be
redirected to the topic. For example, the nurse might
be giving preoperative instructions to a client who is
anxious about the upcoming surgical procedure. As
the nurse is teaching, the clients attention wanders
but the nurse can regain the clients attention and
direct him or her back to the task at hand.
As the person progresses to severe anxiety and
panic, more primitive survival skills take over, de-
fensive responses ensue, and cognitive skills decrease
significantly. A person with severe anxiety has trou-
ble thinking and reasoning. Muscles tighten and
vital signs increase. The person paces; is restless, ir-
ritable, and angry; or uses other similar emotional-
psychomotor means to release tension. In panic, the
emotional-psychomotor realm predominates with ac-
companying fight, flight, or freeze responses. Adrena-
lin surge greatly increases vital signs. Pupils enlarge
to let in more light, and the only cognitive process
focuses on the persons defense.
Table 13-1
LEVELS OF ANXIETY
Anxiety Level Psychological Responses Physiologic Responses
nurses goal must be to lower the persons anxiety Short-term anxiety can be treated with anxio-
level to moderate or mild before proceeding with any- lytic medications (Table 13-2). Most of these drugs are
thing else. It is also essential to remain with the per- benzodiazepines, which are commonly prescribed for
son, because anxiety is likely to worsen if he or she is anxiety. Benzodiazepines have a high potential for
left alone. Talking to the client in a low, calm, and abuse and dependence, however, so their use should
soothing voice can help. If the person cannot sit still, be short-term, ideally no longer than 4 to 6 weeks.
walking with him or her while talking can be effec- These drugs are designed to relieve anxiety so that
tive. What the nurse talks about matters less than the person can deal more effectively with whatever
how he or she says the words. Helping the person to crisis or situation is causing stress. Unfortunately
take deep, even breaths can help lower anxiety. many people see these drugs as a cure for anxiety
During panic level anxiety, the persons safety and continue to use them instead of learning more ef-
is the primary concern. He or she cannot perceive po- fective coping skills or making needed changes. Chap-
tential harm and may have no capacity for rational ter 2 contains additional information about anxiolytic
thought. The nurse must keep talking to the person drugs.
in a comforting manner, even though the client cannot
process what the nurse is saying. Going to a small,
quiet, and nonstimulating environment may help to OVERVIEW OF ANXIETY DISORDERS
reduce anxiety. The nurse can reassure the person Anxiety disorders are diagnosed when anxiety no
that this is anxiety, that it will pass, and that he or longer functions as a signal of danger or a motivation
she is in a safe place. The nurse should remain with for needed change but becomes chronic and permeates
the client until the panic recedes. Panic level anxiety major portions of the persons life, resulting in mal-
is not sustained indefinitely but can last from 5 to adaptive behaviors and emotional disability. Anxiety
30 minutes. disorders have many manifestations, but anxiety is
When working with an anxious person, the nurse the key feature of each (American Psychiatric Associ-
must be aware of his or her own anxiety level. It is ation [APA], 2000). Types include the following:
easy for the nurse to become increasingly anxious. Re- Agoraphobia with or without panic disorder
maining calm and in control is essential if the nurse Panic disorder
is going to work effectively with the client. Specific phobia
Table 13-2
ANXIOLYTIC DRUGS
Generic (Trade) Name Speed of Onset Side Effects Nursing Implications
BENZODIAZEPINES
diazepam (Valium) Very fast Dizziness, clumsiness, Avoid other CNS depressants such
chlorazepate (Tranxene) Fast sedation, headache, as antihistamines and alcohol.
alprazolam (Xanax) Intermediate fatigue, sexual Avoid caffeine.
chlordiazepoxide (Librium) Intermediate dysfunction, blurred Take care with potentially hazardous
clonazepam (Klonopin) Intermediate vision, dry throat and activities such as driving.
mouth, constipation, Rise slowly from lying or sitting
high potential for position.
abuse and Use sugar-free beverages or hard
dependence candy.
Drink adequate fluids.
Take only as prescribed.
Do not stop taking the drug abruptly.
lorazepam (Ativan) Moderately slow
oxazepam (Serax) Moderately slow
NONBENZODIAZEPINES
buspiropne (BuSpar) Very slow Dizziness, restlessness, Rise slowly from sitting position.
meprobamate Rapid agitation, drowsiness, Take care with potentially hazardous
(Miltown, Equanil) headache, weakness, activities such as driving.
nausea, vomiting, Take with food.
paradoxical excite- Report persistent restlessness, agita-
ment or euphoria tion, excitement, or euphoria to
physician.
13 ANXIETY AND ANXIETY DISORDERS 273
Nursing Diagnosis
Anxiety
Vague uneasy feeling of discomfort or dread accompanied by an autonomic response
(the source often nonspecific or unknown to the individual); a feeling of apprehension
caused by anticipation of danger. It is an alerting signal that warns of impending
danger and enables the individual to take measures to deal with the threat.
IMPLEMENTATION RATIONALE
Remain with the client at all times when levels of The clients safety is a priority. A highly anxious
anxiety are high (severe or panic). client should not be left alonehis or her anxiety
will escalate.
Move the client to a quiet area with minimal or The clients ability to deal with excessive stimuli
decreased stimuli. Using a small room or seclu- is impaired.
sion area may be indicated. Anxious behavior can be escalated by external
stimuli.
A smaller room can enhance the clients sense of
security.
The larger the area, the more lost and panicked
the client can become.
Remain calm in your approach to the client. The client will feel more secure if you are calm
and if the client feels that you are in control of the
situation.
Use short, simple, and clear statements. The clients ability to deal with abstractions or
complexity is impaired.
Avoid asking or forcing the client to make choices. The clients ability to problem-solve is impaired.
The client may not make sound decisions or may
be unable to make decisions at all.
Use of PRN medications may be indicated if the Medication may be necessary to decrease the
clients level of anxiety is high or if the client is clients anxiety to a level at which he or she can
experiencing delusions, disorganized thoughts, listen to you and feel safe.
and so forth.
Be aware of your own feelings and level of dis- Anxiety is communicated interpersonally. Being
comfort or anxiety. with the anxious client can raise your own anxi-
ety level.
Encourage the clients participation in relaxation Relaxation exercises are effective, nonchemical
exercises. These can include deep breathing, ways to reduce anxiety.
progressive muscle relaxation, meditation, guided
imagery, and going (mentally) to a quiet, peaceful
place.
Teach the client to use relaxation techniques Independent use of the techniques can give the
independently. client confidence in having some conscious control
over his or her anxious behavior.
Help the client to see mild anxiety as a positive A frequent misconception is that anxiety itself is
catalyst for change. bad and not useful. The client does not need to
avoid anxiety per se.
Adapted from Schultz, JM & Videbeck, SD. (2002). Lippincotts Manual of Psychiatric Nursing Care Plans (6th ed.). Philadelphia:
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Social phobia of U.S. adults have an anxiety disorder over their life-
Obsessive-compulsive disorder (OCD) time (Mendlowicz & Stein, 2000). Anxiety disorders
Generalized anxiety disorder are more prevalent in women, people younger than
Acute stress disorder 45 years, people who are divorced or separated, and
Posttraumatic stress disorder those of lower socioeconomic status. The exception is
Panic disorder and OCD are the most common and OCD, which is equally prevalent in men and women
will be the focus of this chapter. Posttraumatic stress but more common among boys than among girls.
disorder is addressed in Chapter 11. Table 13-3 sum-
marizes the major symptoms of each anxiety disorder. ONSET AND CLINICAL COURSE
The onset and clinical course of anxiety disorders
INCIDENCE are extremely variable depending on the specific dis-
Anxiety disorders have the highest prevalence rates of order. These aspects are discussed later in this chap-
all mental disorders in the United States. About 15% ter within the context of each disorder.
13 ANXIETY AND ANXIETY DISORDERS 275
Table 13-3
SYMPTOMS OF ANXIETY DISORDERS
Disorder Symptoms
Agoraphobia is anxiety about or avoidance of Avoids being outside alone or at home alone; avoids trav-
places or situations from which escape might be eling in vehicles; impaired ability to work; difficulty
difficult or help might be unavailable. meeting daily responsibilities (e.g., grocery shopping,
going to appointments); knows response is extreme
Panic disorder is characterized by recurrent, un- A discrete episode of panic lasting 15 to 30 minutes with
expected panic attacks that cause constant con- four or more of the following: palpitations; sweating;
cern. Panic attack is the sudden onset of intense trembling or shaking; shortness of breath; choking or
apprehension, fearfulness, or terror associated smothering sensation; chest pain or discomfort; nausea;
with feelings of impending doom. derealization or depersonalization; fear of dying or
going crazy; paresthesias; chills or hot flashes
Specific phobia is characterized by significant anxi- Marked anxiety response to the object or situation; avoid-
ety provoked by a specific feared object or situa- ance or suffered endurance of object or situation; signifi-
tion, which often leads to avoidance behavior. cant distress or impairment of daily routine, occupation,
or social functioning; adolescents and adults recognize
their fear as excessive or unreasonable.
Social phobia is characterized by anxiety provoked Fear of embarrassment or inability to perform; avoidance
by certain types of social or performance situa- or dreaded endurance of behavior or situation; recogni-
tions, which often leads to avoidance behavior. tion that response is irrational or excessive; belief that
others are judging him or her negatively; significant
distress or impairment in relationships, work, or social
life; anxiety can be severe or panic level.
Obsessive-compulsive disorder involves obsessions Recurrent, persistent, unwanted, intrusive thoughts,
(thoughts, impulses or images) that cause marked impulses, or images beyond worrying about realistic life
anxiety and/or compulsions (repetitive behaviors problems; attempts to ignore, suppress, or neutralize
or mental acts) that attempt to neutralize anxiety. obsessions with compulsions that are mostly ineffective;
adults and adolescents recognize that obsessions and
compulsions are excessive and unreasonable.
Generalized anxiety disorder is characterized by at Apprehensive expectations more days than not for
least 6 months of persistent and excessive worry 6 months or more about several events or activities;
and anxiety. uncontrollable worrying; significant distress or
impaired social or occupational functioning; three of
the following symptoms: restlessness, easily fatigued,
difficulty concentrating or mind going blank, irritability,
muscle tension, sleep disturbance
Acute stress disorder is the development of anxiety, Exposure to traumatic event causing intense fear, help-
dissociative, and other symptoms within 1 month lessness, or horror; marked anxiety symptoms or
of exposure to an extremely traumatic stressor; it increased arousal; significant distress or impaired
lasts 2 days to 4 weeks. functioning; persistent re-experiencing of the event;
three of the following symptoms: sense of emotional
numbing or detachment, feeling dazed, derealization,
depersonalization, dissociative amnesia (inability to
recall important aspect of the event)
Posttraumatic stress disorder is characterized by Exposure to traumatic event involving intense fear, help-
the re-experiencing of an extremely traumatic lessness or horror; re-experiencing (intrusive recollec-
event, avoidance of stimuli associated with the tions or dreams, flashbacks, physical and psychological
event, numbing of responsiveness, and persistent distress over reminders of the event); avoidance of
increased arousal; it begins within 3 months to memory-provoking stimuli and numbing of general
years after the event and may last a few months responsiveness (avoidance of thoughts, feelings,
or years. conversations, people, places, amnesia, diminished
interest or participation in life events, feeling detached
or estranged from others, restricted affect, sense of
foreboding); increased arousal (sleep disturbance,
irritability or angry outbursts, difficulty concentrating,
hypervigilence, exaggerated startle response); signifi-
cant distress or impairment
Adapted from American Psychiatric Association. (2000). DSM-IV-TR: Diagnostic and statistical manual of
mental disorders-text revision (4th ed.). Washington DC: Author.
276 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
RELATED DISORDERS synapses especially those in the limbic system and the
locus ceruleus, the area where the neurotransmitter
anxiety disorder due to a general medical condition is norepinephrine that excites cellular function is pro-
diagnosed when the prominent symptoms of anxiety duced. Because GABA reduces anxiety and norepi-
are judged to result directly from a physiologic condi- nephrine increases it, researchers believe that a prob-
tion. The person may have panic attacks, generalized lem with the regulation of these neurotransmitters
anxiety, or obsessions or compulsions. Medical condi- occurs in anxiety disorders.
tions causing this disorder can include endocrine dys- Serotonin (5-HT), the indolamine neurotrans-
function, COPD, congestive heart failure, and neuro- mitter usually implicated in psychosis and mood dis-
logic conditions. orders, has many subtypes. 5-HT1a plays a role in
Substance-induced anxiety disorder is anxiety anxiety as well as in affecting aggression and mood.
directly caused by drug abuse, a medication, or expo- Serotonin is believed to play a distinct role in OCD,
sure to a toxin. Symptoms include prominent anxiety, panic disorder, and generalized anxiety disorder. An
panic attacks, phobias, obsessions, or compulsions. excess of norepinephrine is suspected in panic dis-
Separation anxiety disorder is excessive anxiety order, generalized anxiety disorder, and posttraumatic
concerning separation form home or from persons/ stress disorder (Antai-Otong, 2000).
parents/caregivers to whom the client is attached. It
occurs when it is no longer developmentally appro-
priate and before 18 years of age. Psychodynamic Theories
INTRAPSYCHIC/PSYCHOANALYTIC
ETIOLOGY THEORIES
Biologic Theories Freud (1936) saw a persons innate anxiety as the
stimulus for behavior. He described defense mecha-
GENETIC THEORIES nisms as the humans attempt to control awareness of
Anxiety may have an inherited component, because and to reduce anxiety (see Chap. 3). Defense mech-
first-degree relatives of clients with increased anxi- anisms are cognitive distortions that a person uses
ety have higher rates of developing anxiety. Heri- unconsciously to maintain a sense of being in control
tability refers to the proportion of a disorder that can of a situation, to lessen discomfort, and to deal with
be attributed to genetic factors: stress. Because defense mechanisms arise from the
High heritabilities are greater than 0.6 and unconscious, the person is unaware of using them.
indicate that genetic influences dominate. Some people overuse defense mechanisms, which
Moderate heritabilities are 0.3 to 0.5 and stops them from learning a variety of appropriate
suggest a more even influence of genetic and methods to resolve anxiety-producing situations. The
nongenetic factors. dependence on one or two defense mechanisms also
Heritabilities less than 0.3 mean that genet- can inhibit emotional growth, lead to poor problem-
ics are negligible as a primary cause of the solving skills, and create difficulty with relationships.
disorder.
Panic disorder and social and specific phobias includ-
INTERPERSONAL THEORY
ing agoraphobia have moderate heritability. General
anxiety disorder and OCD tend to be more common in Harry Stack Sullivan (1952) viewed anxiety as being
families, but they have not been studied in-depth to generated from problems in interpersonal relation-
determine heritability (Fyer, 2000). At this point, cur- ships. Caregivers can communicate anxiety to infants
rent research indicates a clear genetic susceptibility or children through inadequate nurturing, agitation
to or vulnerability for anxiety disorders; however, ad- when holding or handling the child, and distorted
ditional factors are necessary for these disorders to messages. Such communicated anxiety can result in
actually develop (Gorman, 2000). dysfunction such as failure to achieve age-appropriate
developmental tasks. In adults, anxiety arises from
the persons need to conform to the norms and values
NEUROCHEMICAL THEORIES
of his or her cultural group. The higher the level of
Gamma-amino butyric acid (GABA) is the amino acid anxiety, the lower the ability to communicate and to
neurotransmitter believed to be dysfunctional in anx- solve problems and the greater chance for anxiety dis-
iety disorders. GABA, an inhibitory neurotransmitter, orders to develop.
functions as the bodys natural anti-anxiety agent by Hildegard Peplau (1952) understood that humans
reducing cell excitability, thus decreasing the rate of existed in interpersonal and physiologic realms; thus,
neuronal firing. It is available in one-third of the nerve the nurse can better help the client to achieve health
13 ANXIETY AND ANXIETY DISORDERS 277
by attending to both areas. She identified the four lev- having the person firmly hold his penis until the fear
els of anxiety and developed nursing interventions passes, often with assistance from family members
and interpersonal communication techniques based on or friends, and clamping the penis to a wooden box.
Sullivans interpersonal view of anxiety. Nurses today In women, koro is the fear that the vulva and nipples
use Peplaus interpersonal therapeutic communication will disappear (Spector, 2000).
techniques to develop and to nurture the nurseclient Susto is diagnosed in some Hispanics (Peruvians,
relationship and to apply the nursing process. Bolivians, Colombians, and Central and South Amer-
ican Indians) during cases of high anxiety, sadness,
agitation, weight loss, weakness, and heart rate
BEHAVIORAL THEORY
changes. The symptoms are believed to occur because
Behavioral theorists view anxiety as being learned supernatural spirits or bad air from dangerous places
through experiences. Conversely, people can change and cemeteries invades the body.
or unlearn behaviors through new experiences. Be-
haviorists believe that people can modify maladap-
tive behaviors without gaining insight into the causes
TREATMENT
for them. They contend that disturbing behaviors Treatment for anxiety disorders usually involves
that develop and interfere with a persons life can be medication and therapy. This combination produces
extinguished or unlearned by repeated experiences better results than either one alone (Gorman, 2000).
guided by a trained therapist. Drugs used to treat anxiety disorders are listed in
Table 13-4. Antidepressants are discussed in detail
in Chapter 15.
CULTURAL CONSIDERATIONS Cognitive-behavioral therapy is used success-
Each culture has rules governing the appropriate fully to treat anxiety disorders. Positive reframing
ways to express and deal with anxiety. Culturally means turning negative messages into positive mes-
competent nurses should be aware of them while sages. The therapist teaches the person to create pos-
being careful not to stereotype clients. itive messages for use during panic episodes. For ex-
People from Asian cultures often express anxiety ample, instead of thinking, My heart is pounding. I
through somatic symptoms such as headaches, back- think Im going to die! the client thinks, I can stand
aches, fatigue, dizziness, and stomach problems. One this. This is just anxiety. It will go away. The client
intense anxiety reaction is koro, or a mans profound can write down these messages and keep them read-
fear that his penis will retract into the abdomen and ily accessible such as in an address book, calendar, or
he will then die. Accepted forms of treatment include wallet.
Table 13-4
DRUGS USED TO TREAT ANXIETY DISORDERS
Drug Name Generic (Trade) Classification Used to Treat
Decatastrophizing involves the therapists use Stress and resulting anxiety are not associated
of questions to more realistically appraise the situ- exclusively with life problems. Events that are pos-
ation; the therapist may ask, What is the worst thing itive or desired such as going away to college, get-
that could happen? Is that likely? Could you survive ting a first job, getting married, and having children
that? Is that as bad as you imagine? The client uses are stressful and cause anxiety. Managing the effects
thought-stopping and distraction techniques to jolt of stress and anxiety in ones life is important to
himself or herself from focusing on negative thoughts. being healthy. Tips for managing stress include the
Splashing the face with cold water, snapping a rubber following:
band worn on the wrist, or shouting are all tech- Keep a positive attitude and believe in
niques that can break the cycle of negative thoughts yourself.
(Beamish, Granello & Belcastro, 2002). Accept that there are events you cannot
Assertiveness training helps the person take control.
more control over life situations. Techniques help the Communicate assertively with others.
person negotiate interpersonal situations and foster Learn to relax.
self-assurance. They involve using I statements Exercise regularly.
to identify feelings and to communicate concerns or Eat well-balanced meals.
needs to others. Examples include I feel angry when Limit intake of caffeine and alcohol.
you turn your back while Im talking, I want to have Get enough rest and sleep.
5 minutes of your time for an uninterrupted conver- Set realistic goals and expectations.
sation about something important, and I would like Learn stress management techniques such as
to have about 30 minutes in the evening to relax with- relaxation, guided imagery, and meditation;
practice them as part of your daily routine.
out interruption.
For people with anxiety disorders, it is important to
emphasize that the goal is effective management of
COMMUNITY-BASED CARE stress and anxiety not the total elimination of anxi-
ety. While medication is important to relieve exces-
Nurses encounter many people with anxiety disor-
sive anxiety, it does not solve or eliminate the prob-
ders in community settings rather than in inpatient
lems entirely. Learning effective methods for coping
settings. Formal treatment for these clients usually
with life and its stresses and anxiety management
occurs in community mental health clinics and in the
techniques is essential for overall improvement in
offices of physicians, psychiatric clinical specialists,
life quality.
psychologists, or other mental health counselors. Be-
cause the person with an anxiety disorder often be-
lieves the sporadic symptoms are related to medical PANIC DISORDER
problems, the family practitioner or advanced prac- Panic disorder is composed of discrete episodes of
tice nurse can be the first health care professional to panic attacks, that is, 15 to 30 minutes of rapid,
evaluate him or her. intense, escalating anxiety in which the person ex-
Knowledge of community resources will help the periences great emotional fear as well as physiologic
nurse guide the client to appropriate referrals for as- discomfort. During a panic attack, the person has
sessment, diagnosis, and treatment. The nurse can overwhelmingly intense anxiety and displays four or
refer the client to a psychiatrist or an advanced prac- more of the following symptoms: palpitations, sweat-
tice psychiatric nurse for diagnosis, therapy, and med- ing, tremors, shortness of breath, sense of suffocation,
ication. Other community resources such as anxiety chest pain, nausea, abdominal distress, dizziness,
disorder groups or self-help groups can provide sup- paresthesias, chills, or hot flashes.
port and help the client feel less isolated and lonely. Panic disorder is diagnosed when the person has
recurrent, unexpected panic attacks followed by at
MENTAL HEALTH PROMOTION least 1 month of persistent concern or worry about
future attacks or their meaning or a significant be-
Too often anxiety is viewed negatively as something havioral change related to them. Slightly more than
to avoid at all costs. Actually for many people anxi- 75% of people with panic disorder have spontaneous
ety is a warning that they are not dealing with stress initial attacks with no environmental trigger. Half of
effectively. Learning to heed this warning and to those with panic disorder have accompanying agora-
make needed changes is a healthy way to deal with phobia. Panic disorder is more common in people who
the stress of daily events. have not graduated from college and are not married.
13 ANXIETY AND ANXIETY DISORDERS 279
Clinical Course
The onset of panic disorder peaks in late adolescence
and the mid-30s. Although panic anxiety might be
normal in someone experiencing a life-threatening
situation, a person with panic disorder experiences
these emotional and physiologic responses without
this stimulus. The memory of the panic attack cou-
pled with the fear of having more can lead to avoid-
ance behavior. In some cases, the person becomes
homebound or stays in a limited area near home such
as on the block or within town limits. This behavior
is known as agoraphobia (fear of the marketplace
or fear of being outside). Some people with agora-
phobia fear stepping outside the front door because a
panic attack may occur as soon as they leave the
house. Others can leave the house but feel safe from
the anticipatory fear of having a panic attack only
within a limited area. Agoraphobia also can occur
alone without panic attacks.
The behavior patterns of people with agoraphobia
clearly demonstrate the concepts of primary and sec-
ondary gain associated with many anxiety disorders.
Primary gain is the relief of anxiety achieved by per- Panic attack
forming the specific anxiety-driven behavior: for ex- or sad. When discussing the panic attacks, the client
ample, staying in the house to avoid the anxiety of may be tearful. He or she may express anger at him-
leaving a safe place. Secondary gain is the attention self or herself for being unable to control myself.
received from others as a result of these behaviors. For Most clients are distressed about the intrusion of anx-
instance, the person with agoraphobia may receive at- iety attacks in their lives. During a panic attack, the
tention and caring concern from family members, who client may describe feelings of being disconnected
also assume all the responsibilities of family life out- from himself or herself (depersonalization) or sens-
side the home (e.g., work, shopping). Essentially these ing that things are not real (derealization).
compassionate significant others become enablers of
the self-imprisonment of the person with agoraphobia.
THOUGHT PROCESSES AND CONTENT
Treatment During a panic attack, the client is overwhelmed, be-
lieving that he or she is dying, losing control, or
Panic disorder is treated with cognitive-behavioral
going insane. The client may even consider suicide.
techniques, deep breathing and relaxation, and med-
ications such as benzodiazepines, SSRI antidepres- Thoughts are disorganized, and the client loses the
sants, tricyclic antidepressants, and antihyperten- ability to think rationally. At other times, the client
sives such as clonidine (Catapres) and propanolol may be consumed with worry about when the next
(Inderal). panic attack will occur or how to deal with it.
Box 13-1
HAMILTON RATING SCALE FOR ANXIETY
Instructions: This checklist is to assist the physician or psychiatrist in evaluating each patient as to his degree of
anxiety and pathological condition. Please fill in the appropriate rating;
NONE = 0 MILD = 1 MODERATE = 2 SEVERE = 3 SEVERE, GROSSLY DISABLING = 4
Reprinted with permission from The British Journal of Medical Psychology (1959), Vol. 32, 5055. The British
Psychological Society.
typically avoids people, places, and events associated PHYSIOLOGIC AND SELF-CARE CONCERNS
with previous panic attacks. For example, the person
may no longer ride the bus if he or she has had a panic The client often reports problems sleeping and eat-
attack on a bus. Although avoiding these objects does ing. The anxiety of apprehension between panic at-
not stop the panic attacks, the persons sense of help- tacks may interfere with adequate, restful sleep even
lessness is so great that he or she may take even more though the person may spend hours in bed. Clients
restrictive measures to avoid them such as quitting may experience loss of appetite or eat constantly in
work and remaining at home. an attempt to ease the anxiety.
282 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
PROVIDING CLIENT AND the clients outcomes were achieved. The clients per-
FAMILY EDUCATION ception of the success of treatment also plays a part
in evaluation. Even if all outcomes are achieved, the
Client and family education is of primary importance
nurse must ask if the client is comfortable or satis-
when working with clients who have anxiety dis-
fied with the quality of life.
orders. The client learns ways to manage stress and
Evaluation of the treatment of panic disorder is
to cope with reactions to stress and stress-provoking
based on the following:
situations. With education about the efficacy of com-
Does the client understand the prescribed
bined psychotherapy and medication and the effects
medication regimen, and is he or she
of the prescribed medication, the client can become committed to adhering to it?
the chief treatment manager of the anxiety disorder. Have the clients episodes of anxiety
It is important for the nurse to educate the client and decreased in frequency or intensity?
family members about the physiology of anxiety and Does the client understand various coping
the merits of using combined psychotherapy and drug methods and when to use them?
management. Such a combined treatment approach Does the client believe that his or her quality
along with stress-reduction techniques can help the of life is satisfactory?
client to manage these drastic reactions and allow
him or her to gain a sense of self-control. The nurse
should help the client to understand that these ther- PHOBIAS
apies and drugs do not cure the disorder but are A phobia is an illogical, intense, persistent fear of a
methods to help him or her to control and manage it. specific object or a social situation that causes ex-
Client and family education regarding medications treme distress and interferes with normal function-
should include the recommended dosage and dosage ing. Phobias usually do not result from past, negative
regimen, expected effects, side effects and how to han- experiences. In fact, the person may never have had
dle them, and substances that have a synergistic or contact with the object of the phobia. People with
antagonistic effect with the drug. phobias understand that their fear is unusual and
The nurse encourages the client to exercise regu- irrational and may even joke about how silly it is.
larly. Routine exercise helps to metabolize adrenalin, Nevertheless, they feel powerless to stop it (Rogers &
reduces panic reactions, and increases production of Gournay, 2001).
endorphins; all these activities increase feelings of People with phobias develop anticipatory anxi-
well-being. ety even when thinking about possibly encountering
the dreaded phobic object or situation. They engage
in avoidance behavior that often severely limits their
Evaluation lives. Such avoidance behavior usually does not re-
Evaluation of the plan of care must be individualized. lieve the anticipatory anxiety for long.
Ongoing assessment provides data to determine if There are three categories of phobias:
Agoraphobia (discussed earlier)
Specific phobia, which is an irrational fear of
an object or situation
Social phobia, which is anxiety provoked by
CLIENT AND FAMILY TEACHING: certain social or performance situations
PANIC DISORDER Many people express phobias about snakes,
spiders, rats, or similar objects. These fears are very
Review breathing control and relaxation specific, easy to avoid, and cause no anxiety or worry.
techniques. The diagnosis of a phobic disorder is made only when
Discuss positive coping strategies. the phobic behavior significantly interferes with the
Emphasize the importance of maintaining
persons life by creating marked distress or difficulty
prescribed medication regimen and regular
in interpersonal or occupational functioning.
follow-up.
Describe time management techniques such as
Specific phobias are subdivided into the follow-
creating to do lists with realistic estimated ing categories:
deadlines for each activity, crossing off Natural environmental phobias: fear of
completed items for a sense of accomplishment, storms, water, heights, or other natural
and saying no. phenomena
Stress the importance of maintaining contact Blood-injection phobias: fear of seeing ones
with community and participating in supportive own or others blood, traumatic injury, or an
organizations. invasive medical procedure such as an
injection.
284 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
APPLICATION OF THE NURSING wants to think about and that he or she would never
PROCESS: OBSESSIVE-COMPULSIVE willingly have such ideas or images.
DISORDER
Assessment SENSORIUM AND
Box 13-2 presents the Yale-Brown Obsessive-Com- INTELLECTUAL PROCESSES
pulsive Scale. The nurse can use this tool along with Assessment reveals intact intellectual functioning.
the following detailed discussion to guide his or her The client may describe difficulty concentrating or
assessment of the client with OCD. paying attention when obsessions are strong. There
is no impairment of memory or sensory functioning.
HISTORY
The client usually seeks treatment only when obses- JUDGMENT AND INSIGHT
sions become too overwhelming, compulsions interfere The nurse examines the clients judgment and in-
with daily life (e.g., going to work, cooking meals, par- sight. The client recognizes that the obsessions are ir-
ticipating in leisure activities with family or friends), rational but he or she cannot stop them. He or she can
or both. Clients are hospitalized only when they have make sound judgments (e.g., I know the house is
become completely unable to carry out their daily safe) but cannot act on them. The client still engages
routines. Most treatment is outpatient. The client in ritualistic behavior when the anxiety becomes
often reports that rituals began many years before; overwhelming.
some begin as early as childhood. The more respon-
sibility the client has as he or she gets older, the more
the rituals interfere with the ability to fulfill those SELF-CONCEPT
responsibilities. During exploration of self-concept, the client voices
concern that he or she is going crazy. Feelings of
GENERAL APPEARANCE powerlessness to control the obsessions or compul-
AND MOTOR BEHAVIOR sions contribute to low self-esteem. The client may
think that if he or she were stronger or had more
The nurse assesses the clients appearance and be- will power, he or she could possibly control these
havior. Clients with OCD often seem tense, anxious, thoughts and behaviors.
worried, and fretful. They may have difficulty relating
symptoms because of embarrassment. Their overall
appearance is unremarkable, that is, nothing observ- ROLES AND RELATIONSHIPS
able seems to be out of the ordinary. The exception It is important for the nurse to assess the effects of
is the client who is almost immobilized by her or his OCD on the clients roles and relationships. As the
thoughts and the resulting anxiety. time spent performing rituals increases, the clients
ability to fulfill life roles successfully decreases. Re-
MOOD AND AFFECT lationships also suffer as family and friends tire of
the repetitive behavior, and the client is less avail-
During assessment of mood and affect, clients report able to them as he or she is more consumed with anx-
ongoing, overwhelming feelings of anxiety in response iety and ritualistic behavior.
to the obsessional thoughts, images, or urges. They
may look sad and anxious.
PHYSIOLOGIC AND SELF-CARE
CONSIDERATIONS
THOUGHT PROCESSES AND CONTENT
The nurse examines the effects of OCD on physiology
The nurse explores the clients thought processes and and self-care. As with other anxiety disorders, clients
content. Many clients describe the obsessions as aris- with OCD may have trouble sleeping. Performing rit-
ing from nowhere during the middle of normal activ- uals may take time away from sleep, or anxiety may
ities. The harder the client tries to stop the thought interfere with the ability to go to sleep and wake re-
or image, the more intense it becomes. The client de- freshed. Clients also may report a loss of appetite
scribes how these obsessions are not what he or she or unwanted weight loss. In severe cases, personal
13 ANXIETY AND ANXIETY DISORDERS 287
Box 13-2
YALE-BROWN OBSESSIVE-COMPULSIVE SCALE
For each item circle the number identifying the response which best characterizes the patient.
1. Time occupied by obsessive thoughts 3 Yields to all obsessions without attempting to
How much of your time is occupied by obsessive control them, but does so with some reluctance
thoughts? 4 Completely and willingly yields to all obsessions
How frequently do the obsessive thoughts occur? 5. Degree of control over obsessive thoughts
0 None How much control do you have over your obses-
1 Mild (less than 1 hr/day) or occasional (intrusion sive thoughts?
occurring no more than 8 times a day) How successful are you in stopping or diverting
2 Moderate (13 hr/day) or frequent (intrusion oc- your obsessive thinking?
curring more than 8 times a day, but most of the 0 Complete control
hours of the day are free of obsessions) 1 Much control, usually able to stop or divert ob-
3 Severe (greater than 3 and up to 8 hr/day) or sessions with some effort and concentration
very frequent (intrusion occurring more than 2 Moderate control, sometimes able to stop or
8 times a day and occurring during most of the divert obsessions
hours of the day) 3 Little control, rarely successful in stopping ob-
4 Extreme (greater than 8 hr/day) or near consis- sessions
tent intrusion (too numerous to count and an 4 No control, experienced as completely invol-
hour rarely passes without several obsessions untary, rarely able to even momentarily divert
occurring) thinking
2. Interference due to obsessive thoughts. 6. Time spent performing compulsive behaviors
How much do your obsessive thoughts interfere How much time do you spend performing com-
with your social or work (or role) functioning? pulsive behaviors?
Is there anything that you dont do because of How frequently do you perform compulsions?
them? 0 None
0 None 1 Mild (less than 1 hr/day performing compul-
1 Mild, slight interference with social or occupa- sions) or occasional (performance of compul-
tional activities, but overall performance not sions occurring no more than 8 times a day)
impaired 2 Moderate (13 hr/day performing compulsions)
2 Moderate, definite interference with social or or frequent (performance of compulsions oc-
occupational performance but still manageable curring more than 8 times a day, but most of
3 Severe, causes substantial impairment in so- the hours of the day are free of compulsive
cial or occupational performance behaviors)
4 Extreme, incapacitating 3 Severe (greater than 3 and up to 8 hr/day per-
3. Distress associated with obsessive thoughts forming compulsions) or very frequent (perfor-
How much distress do your obsessive thoughts mance of compulsions occurring more than
cause you? 8 times a day and occurring during most of the
0 None hours of the day)
1 Mild, infrequent and not too disturbing 4 Extreme (greater than 8 hr/day performing com-
2 Moderate, frequent and disturbing but still pulsions) or near consistent performance of
manageable compulsions (too numerous to count and an
3 Severe, very frequent and very disturbing hour rarely passes without several compulsions
4 Extreme, near constant and disabling distress being performed)
4. Resistance against obsessions 7. Interference due to compulsive behaviors
How much of an effort do you make to resist the How much do your compulsive behaviors inter-
obsessive thoughts? fere with your social or work (or role) function-
How often do you try to disregard or turn your at- ing? Is there anything that you dont do be-
tention away from these thoughts as they enter cause of the compulsions?
your mind? 0 None
0 Makes an effort to always resist, or symptoms 1 Mild, slight interference with social or occupa-
so minimal doesnt need to actively resist tional activities, but overall performance not
1 Tries to resist most of the time impaired
2 Makes some effort to resist
Continued
288 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Box 13-2
YALE-BROWN OBSESSIVE-COMPULSIVE SCALEcontd
2 Moderate, definite interference with social or itating anxiety develops during performance of
occupational performance but still manageable compulsions
3 Severe, causes substantial impairment in so- 9. Resistance against compulsions
cial or occupational performance How much of an effort do you make to resist the
4 Extreme, incapacitating compulsions?
8. Distress associated with compulsive behavior 0 Makes an effort to always resist, or symptoms
How would you feel if prevented from perform- so minimal doesnt need to actively resist
ing your compulsions? 1 Tries to resist most of the time
How anxious would you become? How anxious 2 Makes some effort to resist
do you get while performing compulsions until 3 Yields to all compulsions without attempting to
you are satisfied they are completed? control them but does so with some reluctance
0 None 4 Completely and willingly yields to all compul-
1 Mild, only slightly anxious if compulsions pre- sions
vented or only slightly anxious during perfor- 10. Degree of control over compulsive behavior
mance of compulsions 0 Complete control
2 Moderate, reports that anxiety would mount but 1 Much control, experiences pressure to perform
remain manageable if compulsions prevented the behavior but usually able to exercise vol-
or that anxiety increases but remains manage- untary control over it
able during performance of compulsions 2 Moderate control, strong pressure to perform
3 Severe, prominent and very disturbing increase behavior, can control it only with difficulty
in anxiety if compulsions interrupted or promi- 3 Little control, very strong drive to perform be-
nent and very disturbing increases in anxiety havior, must be carried to completion, can only
during performance of compulsions delay with difficulty
4 Extreme, incapacitating anxiety from any inter- 4 No control, drive to perform behavior experi-
vention aimed at modifying activity or incapac- enced as completely involuntary
Reprinted with permission from Goodman W. K., Price L. H., Rasmussen S. A., et al. (1989). The Yale-Brown Obsessive-Compulsive
Scale, I: Development, use, and reliability. Arch Gen Psychiatry 46:1006.
hygiene may suffer because the client cannot com- The client will discuss feelings with another
plete needed tasks. person.
The client will demonstrate effective use of
behavior therapy techniques.
Data Analysis The client will spend less time performing
Depending on the particular obsession and its accom- rituals.
panying compulsions, clients will have varying symp-
toms. Nursing diagnoses can include the following:
Intervention
Anxiety
Ineffective Coping USING THERAPEUTIC COMMUNICATION
Fatigue Offering support and encouragement to the client is
Situational Low Self Esteem important to help him or her manage anxiety re-
Impaired Skin Integrity (if scrubbing or sponses. The nurse can validate the overwhelming
washing rituals) feelings the client experiences while indicating the
belief that the client can make needed changes and
regain a sense of control. The nurse encourages the
Outcome Identification
client to talk about the feelings and to describe them
Outcomes for clients with OCD include the following: in as much detail as the client can tolerate. Because
The client will complete daily routine activi- many clients try to hide their rituals and to keep ob-
ties within a realistic time frame. sessions secret, discussing these thoughts, behav-
The client will demonstrate effective use of iors, and resulting feelings with the nurse is an im-
relaxation techniques. portant step. Doing so can begin to relieve some of
13 ANXIETY AND ANXIETY DISORDERS 289
Teaching about the importance of medication ment, and muddled obliviousness to the environment
compliance to combat OCD is essential. The client (APA, 2000).
may need to try different medications until his or her
response is satisfactory. The chances for improved
SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES
OCD symptoms are enhanced when the client takes
medication and uses behavioral techniques. Working with people who have anxiety
disorders is a different kind of challenge for the nurse.
These clients are usually average people in other re-
Evaluation spects who know that their symptoms are unusual but
feel unable to stop them. They experience much frus-
Treatment has been effective when OCD symptoms no tration and feelings of helplessness and failure. Their
longer interfere with the clients ability to carry out re- lives are out of their control, and they live in fear of the
sponsibilities. When obsessions occur, the client man- next episode. They go to extreme measures to try to
ages resulting anxiety without engaging in compli- prevent episodes by avoiding people and places where
cated or time-consuming rituals. He or she reports previous events occurred.
regained control over his or her life and the ability to It may be difficult for nurses and others to un-
tolerate and manage anxiety with minimal disruption. derstand why the person cannot simply stop perform-
ing the bizarre behaviors interfering with his or her
life. Why does the hand-washer who has scrubbed him-
GENERALIZED ANXIETY DISORDER self raw keep washing his poor sore hands every hour
A person with generalized anxiety disorder (GAD) on the hour? Nurses must understand what and how
worries excessively and feels highly anxious at least anxiety behaviors work, not just for client care but to
50% of the time for 6 months or more. Unable to con- help understand the role anxiety plays in performing
nursing responsibilities. Nurses are expected to func-
trol this focus on worry, the person has three or more
tion at a high level and to avoid allowing their own
of the following symptoms: uneasiness, irritability,
feelings and needs to hinder the care of their clients.
muscle tension, fatigue, difficulty thinking, and sleep
But as emotional beings, nurses are just as vulnera-
alterations. More people with this chronic disorder
ble to stress and anxiety as others, and they have
are seen by family physicians than psychiatrists (Gli-
needs of their own.
atto, 2000). Bourland et al. (2000) report that quality
of life is diminished greatly in older adults with GAD.
Buspirone (BuSpar) and SSRI antidepressants are Points to Consider When Working
the most effective treatment. With Clients With Anxiety and
Anxiety Disorders
Remember that everyone suffers from stress
POSTTRAUMATIC STRESS and anxiety occasionally that can interfere
DISORDER with daily life and work.
Posttraumatic stress disorder can occur in a person Avoid falling into the pitfall of trying to fix
who has witnessed an extraordinarily terrifying and the clients problems.
potentially deadly event. After the traumatic event, Discuss any uncomfortable feelings with a
the person re-experiences all or some of it through more experienced nurse for suggestions on
dreams or waking recollections and responds defen- how to deal with your feelings toward these
sively to these flashbacks. New behaviors develop clients.
related to the trauma such as sleep difficulties, hyper- Remember to practice techniques to manage
vigilance, thinking difficulties, severe startle response, stress and anxiety in your own life
and agitation (APA, 2000). See Chapter 11.
KEY POINTS
ACUTE STRESS DISORDER Anxiety is a vague feeling of dread or appre-
hension. It is a response to external or inter-
Acute stress disorder is similar to posttraumatic stress nal stimuli that can have behavioral, emo-
disorder in that the person has experienced a trau- tional, cognitive, and physical symptoms.
matic situation, but the response is more dissociative. Anxiety has positive and negative side ef-
The person has a sense that the event was unreal, fects. The positive effects produce growth
thinks he or she is unreal, and forgets some aspects and adaptive change. The negative effects
of the event through amnesia, emotional detach- produce poor self-esteem, fear, inhibition,
13 ANXIETY AND ANXIETY DISORDERS 291
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
and anxiety disorders (in addition to other Current etiologic theories and studies of
disorders). anxiety disorders have shown a familial
The four levels of anxiety are mild anxiety incidence and have implicated the neuro-
(helps people learn, grow, and change); mod- transmitters GABA, norepinephrine, and
erate anxiety (increases focus on the alarm; serotonin.
learning is still possible); severe anxiety Treatment for anxiety disorders involves
(greatly decreases cognitive function, in- medication (anxiolytics, SSRI and tricyclic
creases preparation for physical responses, antidepressants, clonidine and propanolol)
increases space needs); and panic (fight, and therapy.
flight, or freeze response; no learning is pos- Cognitive-behavioral techniques include
sible; the person is attempting to free himself positive reframing, decatastrophizing,
or herself from the discomfort of this high thought-stopping, and distraction. Behav-
stage of anxiety). ioral techniques for OCD include exposure
Defense mechanisms are intrapsychic distor- and response prevention.
tions that a person uses to feel more in con- In a panic attack, the person feels as if he or
trol. It is believed that these defense mecha- she is dying. Symptoms can include palpita-
nisms are overused when a person develops tions, sweating, tremors, shortness of
an anxiety disorder. breath, a sense of suffocation, chest pain,
nausea, abdominal distress, dizziness,
paresthesias, and vasomotor lability. The
Critical Thinking Questions person has a fight, flight, or freeze response.
Phobias are excessive anxiety about being
1. Because all people occasionally have anxiety,
in public or open places (agoraphobia);
it is important for nurses to be aware of their
own coping mechanisms. Do a self-assessment: a specific object; or social situations.
What causes you anxiety? What physical, emo- Obsessive-compulsive disorder involves re-
tional, and cognitive responses occur when you current, persistent, intrusive, and unwanted
are anxious? What coping mechanisms do you thoughts, images, or impulses (obsessions)
use? Are they healthy? and ritualistic or repetitive behaviors or
2. Some clients take benzodiazepine anxiolytics mental acts (compulsions) carried out to
for months or even years even though these eliminate the obsessions or to neutralize
medications are designed for short-term use. anxiety.
Why does this happen? What, if anything, Self-awareness about ones anxiety and
should be done for these clients? How would responses to it greatly improves both
you approach the situation? personal and professional relationships.
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com.
292 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
1. The nurse observes a client who is becoming 5. Which of the four classes of medications used for
increasingly upset. He is rapidly pacing, hyper- panic disorder is considered the safest because of
ventilating, clenching his jaw, wringing his low incidence of side effects and lack of physio-
hands, and trembling. His speech is high-pitched logic dependence?
and random; he seems preoccupied with his
A. Benzodiazepines
thoughts. He is pounding his fist into his other
hand. The nurse identifies his anxiety level as B. Tricyclics
A. Mild C. Monoamine oxidase inhibitors
B. Moderate D. Selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors
C. Severe
6. Which of the following would be the best inter-
D. Panic vention for a client having a panic attack?
A. Involve the client in a physical activity.
2. When assessing a client with anxiety, the
nurses questions should be B. Offer a distraction such as music.
A. Avoided until the anxiety is gone C. Remain with the client.
B. Open-ended D. Teach the client a relaxation technique.
C. Postponed until the client volunteers
7. A client with generalized anxiety disorder states
information
I have learned that the best thing I can do is to
D. Specific and direct forget my worries. How would the nurse evalu-
ate this statement?
3. During the assessment, the client tells the nurse
A. The client is developing insight.
that she cannot stop worrying about her appear-
ance and that she often removes old make-up B. The clients coping skills have improved.
and applies fresh make-up every hour or two
C. The client needs encouragement to verbalize
throughout the day. The nurse identifies this
feelings.
behavior as indicative of a(n)
D. The clients treatment has been successful.
A. Acute stress disorder
B. Generalized anxiety disorder 8. A client with anxiety is beginning treatment with
lorazepam (Ativan). It is most important for the
C. Panic disorder
nurse to assess the clients
D. Obsessive-compulsive disorder
A. Motivation for treatment
4. The best goal for a client learning a relaxation B. Family and social support
technique is that the client will
C. Use of coping mechanisms
A. Confront the source of anxiety directly
D. Use of alcohol
B. Experience anxiety without feeling
overwhelmed
C. Report no episodes of anxiety
D. Suppress anxious feelings
293
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify the level of anxiety represented by the following descriptions:
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
1. Discuss the concepts of primary and secondary gain; give an
example of each.
294
CLINICAL EXAMPLE
Mr. Noe has discussed in detail with the community health nurse how his wife
cannot be expected to walk 2 to 3 miles a day after her triple-bypass operation
because she is afraid to leave the house. He has been taking care of her for the
past 13 years during which time she had rarely left the house and then only
with great distress and only accompanied by him. His wife says she gets so anx-
ious she wants to scream and run back in the door if she tries to walk out of it.
She believes something terrible will happen to her. She knows this is true be-
cause the last time she left the house to go to the doctor she had to have triple-
bypass surgery the next day. Mr. Noe takes care of necessary chores outside the
house, attends parents weekend at their childrens colleges, does the grocery
shopping, and so forth.
Mrs. Noe has asked the nurse to figure out how I can get outside and walk
every day, but for each suggestion the nurse makes, Mrs. Noe finds some rea-
son it will not work. The nurse is getting frustrated with Mrs. Noes constant
rejection of her suggestions and sternly says, You havent the foggiest inten-
tion of walking out that door, so why are we doing this?
1. Rather than giving Mrs. Noe suggestions to get her outside, what might be
a better plan?
2. How is Mr. Noes behavior affecting Mrs. Noes agoraphobia? What does
the nurse need to explain and to recommend to Mr. Noe about his response
to her behavior?
295
14 Schizophrenia
Learning Objectives
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to Key Terms
Abnormal Involuntary ideas of reference
1. Discuss various theories
of the etiology of Movement Scale (AIMS) latency of response
schizophrenia. akathisia neuroleptic malignant
2. Describe the positive and
alogia syndrome (NMS)
negative symptoms of
schizophrenia. anhedonia neuroleptics
3. Describe a functional blunted affect polydipsia
and mental status assess- catatonia pseudoparkinsonism
ment for a client with
schizophrenia. command hallucinations psychomotor retardation
4. Apply the nursing process delusions psychosis
to the care of a client with depersonalization tardive dyskinesia
schizophrenia.
dystonic reactions thought blocking
5. Evaluate the effectiveness
of antipsychotic medica- echolalia thought broadcasting
tions for clients with echopraxia thought insertion
schizophrenia.
extrapyramidal side effects thought withdrawal
6. Provide teaching to clients,
families, caregivers, and flat affect waxy flexibility
community members to hallucination word salad
increase knowledge and
understanding of
schizophrenia.
7. Describe the supportive
and rehabilitative needs of
clients with schizophrenia
who live in the community.
8. Evaluate his or her own
feelings, beliefs, and
attitudes regarding clients
with schizophrenia.
296
14 SCHIZOPHRENIA 297
Schizophrenia causes distorted and bizarre thoughts, roughly the same throughout the world (Buchanan &
perceptions, emotions, movements, and behavior. It Carpenter, 2000).
cannot be defined as a single illness; rather, schizo- The symptoms of schizophrenia are divided into
phrenia is thought of as a syndrome or disease process two major categories: positive or hard symptoms/
with many different varieties and symptoms, much signs, which include delusions, hallucinations, and
like the varieties of cancer. For decades, the public grossly disorganized thinking, speech, and behavior,
vastly misunderstood schizophrenia, fearing it as and negative or soft symptoms/signs such as flat af-
dangerous and uncontrollable and causing wild dis- fect, lack of volition, and social withdrawal or dis-
turbances and violent outbursts. Many people be- comfort. Medication can control the positive symp-
lieved that those with schizophrenia needed to be toms, but frequently the negative symptoms persist
locked away from society and institutionalized. Only after positive symptoms have abated. The persis-
recently has the mental health industry come to tence of these negative symptoms over time presents
learn and educate the community at large that schiz- a major barrier to recovery and improved functioning
ophrenia has many different symptoms and presen- in the clients daily life.
tations and is an illness that medication can control. The following are the types of schizophrenia ac-
Thanks to the increased effectiveness of newer atyp- cording to the DSM-IV-TR (APA, 2000). The diag-
ical antipsychotic drugs and advances in community- nosis is made according to the clients predominant
based treatment, many clients with schizophrenia symptoms:
live successfully in the community. Clients whose ill- Schizophrenia, paranoid type: characterized
ness is medically supervised and whose treatment is by persecutory (feeling victimized or spied
maintained often continue to live and sometimes work on) or grandiose delusions, hallucinations,
in the community with family and outside support. and, occasionally, excessive religiosity (delu-
Schizophrenia usually is diagnosed in late ado- sional religious focus) or hostile and aggres-
lescence or early adulthood. Rarely does it manifest sive behavior
in childhood. The peak incidence of onset is 15 to Schizophrenia, disorganized type: character-
25 years of age for men and 25 to 35 years of age for ized by grossly inappropriate or flat affect,
women (APA, 2000). The prevalence of schizophrenia incoherence, loose associations, and ex-
is estimated at about 1% of the total population. In tremely disorganized behavior
the United States, that translates to nearly 3 million Schizophrenia, catatonic type: characterized
people who are, have been, or will be affected by the by marked psychomotor disturbance, either
disease. The incidence and the lifetime prevalence are motionless or excessive motor activity. Motor
Figure 14-1. Scan 11. PET scan with 18F-deoxyglucose shows metabolic activity in a
horizontal section of the brain in a control subject (left) and in an unmedicated patient
with schizophrenia (right). Red and yellow indicate areas of high metabolic activity in
the cortex; green and blue indicate lower activity in the white matter areas of the
brain. The frontal lobe is magnified to show reduced frontal activity in the prefrontal
cortex of the patient with schizophrenia. (Courtesy of Monte S. Buchsbaum, MD,
The Mount Sinai Medical Center and School of Medicine, New York, New York.)
(Clozaril) are both dopamine and serotonin antago- phrenia. Although scientists continue to study these
nists. Drug studies have shown that clozapine can possibilities, few findings have validated them.
dramatically reduce psychotic symptoms and ame- Cytokines are chemical messengers between im-
liorate the negative signs of schizophrenia (Marder, mune cells, mediating inflammatory and immune
2000; OConnor, 1998). responses. Specific cytokines also play a role in signal-
Researchers also are exploring the possibility ing the brain to produce behavioral and neurochemical
that schizophrenia may have three separate symptom changes needed in the face of physical or psychological
complexes or syndromes: hallucinations/delusions; stress to maintain homeostasis. It is believed that
disorganization of thought and behavior; and negative cytokines may have a role in the development of major
symptoms (Arango, Kirkpatrick, & Buchanan, 2000). psychiatric disorders such as schizophrenia (Kronfol
Investigations show that the three syndromes relate & Remick, 2000).
to neurobiologic differences in the brain. It is postu- Recently researchers have been focusing on in-
lated that schizophrenia has [these three] subgroups, fections in pregnant women as a possible origin for
which may be homogeneous relative to course, patho- schizophrenia. Waves of schizophrenia in England,
physiology, and, therefore, treatment. Wales, Denmark, Finland, and other countries have
occurred a generation after influenza epidemics. A
study published in the New England Journal of Med-
IMMUNOVIROLOGIC FACTORS
icine reported higher rates of schizophrenia among
Popular theories have emerged that exposure to a children born in crowded areas in cold weather, con-
virus or the bodys immune response to a virus could ditions that are hospitable to respiratory ailments
alter the brain physiology of people with schizo- (Mortensen et al., 1999).
302 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Table 14-1
ANTIPSYCHOTIC DRUGS, USUAL DAILY DOSAGES, AND INCIDENCE OF SIDE EFFECTS
Usual Daily
Generic (Trade) Name Dosage* (mg) Sedation Hypotension EPS Anticholinergic
CONVENTIONAL ANTIPSYCHOTICS
Chlorpromazine (Thorazine) 2001,600 ++++ +++ ++ +++
Trifluoperazine (Trilafon) 1632 ++ ++++ +
Fluphenazine (Prolixin) 2.520 + + ++++ +
Thioridazine (Mellaril) 200600 ++++ +++ + +++
Mesoridazine (Serentil) 75300 ++++ ++ + ++
Thiothixene (Navane) 630 + + ++++ +
Haloperidol (Haldol) 220 + + ++++ +/0
Loxapine (Loxitane) 60100 +++ ++ +++ ++
Molindone (Moban) 50100 + +/0 + ++
Perphenazine (Etrafon) 1632 ++ ++ +++ +
Trifluoperazine (Stelazine) 650 + + ++++ +
ATYPICAL ANTIPSYCHOTICS
Clozapine (Clozaril) 150500 ++++ ++ +/0 ++
Risperidone (Risperdol) 28 +++ ++ ++ +
Olanzapine (Zyprexa) 520 ++++ +++ + ++
Quetiapine (Seroquel) 150500 ++++ + +
Ziprasidone (Geodon) 40160 mg ++ +/0 + +
*Oral dosage only
EPS, extrapyramidal side effects
++++, very significant; +++, significant; ++, moderate; +, mild; +/0, rare or absent
Table 14-2
SIDE EFFECTS OF ANTIPSYCHOTIC MEDICATIONS AND NURSING INTERVENTIONS
Side Effect Nursing Intervention
Seizures Stop medication; notify physician; protect client from injury during
seizure; provide reassurance and privacy for client after seizure.
Sedation Caution about activities requiring client to be fully alert such as driving
a car.
Photosensitivity Caution client to avoid sun exposure; advise client when in the sun, to
wear protective clothing and sun-blocking lotion.
Weight gain Encourage balanced diet with controlled portions and regular exercise;
focus on minimizing gain.
Anticholinergic symptoms
Dry mouth Use ice chips or hard candy for relief.
Blurred vision Assess side effect, which should improve with time; report to physician
if no improvement.
Constipation Increase fluid and dietary fiber intake; client may need a stool softener if
unrelieved.
Urinary retention Instruct client to report any frequency or burning with urination; report
to physician if no improvement over time.
Orthostatic hypotension Instruct client to rise slowly from sitting or lying position; wait to
ambulate until no longer dizzy or light-headed.
muscle stiffness (continuous) or cogwheeling rigid- client will report symptoms. To provide consistency
ity (ratchet-like movements of joints), drooling, and in assessment among nurses working with the client,
akinesia (slowness and difficulty initiating move- a standardized rating scale for EPS symptoms is use-
ment). These symptoms usually appear in the first ful. The Simpson-Angus scale for EPS is one tool that
few days after starting or increasing the dosage of can be used.
an antipsychotic medication. Treatment of pseudo-
parkinsonism and prevention of further dystonic re- Tardive Dyskinesia. Tardive dyskinesia, a late-
actions are achieved with the medications listed in appearing side effect of antipsychotic medications, is
Table 14-3. characterized by abnormal, involuntary movements
Akathisia is characterized by restless move- such as lip smacking, tongue protrusion, chewing,
ment, pacing, inability to remain still, and the clients blinking, grimacing, and choreiform movements of
report of inner restlessness. Akathisia usually devel- the limbs and feet. These involuntary movements are
ops when the antipsychotic is started or when the embarrassing for clients and may cause them to be-
dose is increased. Clients are very uncomfortable come more socially isolated. Tardive dyskinesia is ir-
with these sensations and may stop taking the anti- reversible once it has appeared, but decreasing or
psychotic medication to avoid these side effects. Beta- discontinuing the medication can arrest the progres-
blockers such as propranolol have been most effective sion. Clozapine (Clozaril), an atypical antipsychotic
in treating akathisia, while benzodiazepines have pro- drug, has not been found to cause this side effect, so
vided some success as well. it often is recommended for clients who have experi-
The early detection and successful treatment of enced tardive dyskinesia while taking conventional
EPS (extrapyramidal side effects) is a very important antipsychotic drugs.
in promoting the clients compliance with medica- Screening clients for late-appearing movement
tion. The nurse is most often the person who will ob- disorders such as tardive dyskinesia is important. The
serve these symptoms or the person to whom the Abnormal Involuntary Movement Scale (AIMS)
14 SCHIZOPHRENIA 305
Table 14-3
EFFICACY OF DRUGS USED TO TREAT EXTRAPYRAMIDAL SIDE EFFECTS AND NURSING INTERVENTIONS
Generic Trade Name Akathisia Dystonia Rigidity Tremor Nursing Interventions
is used to screen for symptoms of movement disor- fever, malaise, ulcerative sore throat, and leukopenia.
ders. The client is observed in several positions, and This side effect may not be manifested immediately
the severity of symptoms is rated from 0 to 4. The but can occur as long as 18 to 24 weeks after the initi-
AIMS can be administered every 3 to 6 months. If the ation of therapy. The drug must be discontinued im-
nurse detects an increased score on the AIMS, indi- mediately. Clients taking this antipsychotic must have
cating increased symptoms of tardive dyskinesia, he weekly white blood cell counts. Currently, clozapine is
or she should notify the physician so that the clients dispensed every 7 days only, and evidence of the white
dosage or drug can be changed to prevent advance- cell count is required before a refill is furnished.
ment of tardive dyskinesia. The AIMS examination
procedure is presented in Box 14-1. Psychosocial Treatment
Seizures. Seizures are an infrequent side effect as- In addition to pharmacologic treatment, many other
sociated with antipsychotic medications. The inci- modes of treatment can help the person with schizo-
dence is 1% of people taking antipsychotics. The no- phrenia. Individual and group therapy, family ther-
table exception is clozapine, which has an incidence apy, family education, and social skills training can
of 5%. Seizures may be associated with high doses of be instituted for clients in both inpatient and com-
the medication. Treatment is a lowered dosage or a munity settings.
different antipsychotic medication. Individual and group therapy sessions are often
supportive in nature, giving the client an opportunity
Neuroleptic Malignant Syndrome. Neuroleptic for social contact and meaningful relationships with
malignant syndrome (NMS) is a serious and fre- other people. Groups that focus on topics of concern
quently fatal condition seen in those being treated such as medication management, use of community
with antipsychotic medications. It is characterized by supports, and family concerns also have been benefi-
muscle rigidity, high fever, increased muscle enzymes cial to clients with schizophrenia (Adams, Wilson, &
(particularly CPK), and leukocytosis (increased leuko- Bagnell, 2000).
cytes). Estimates are that 0.1% to 1% of all clients tak- Clients with schizophrenia can improve their so-
ing antipsychotics develop NMS (OConnor, 1998). cial competence with social skills training, which
Any of the antipsychotic medications can cause NMS, translates into more effective functioning in the com-
which is treated by stopping the medication. The munity. Bustillo et al. (2001) describe three forms
clients ability to tolerate other antipsychotic med- of social skills training: the basic model; the social
ications after NMS varies, but use of another anti- problem-solving model; and the cognitive reme-
psychotic appears possible in most instances. diation model. The basic model involves breaking
complex social behavior into simpler steps, practicing
Agranulocytosis. Clozapine has the potentially fatal through role-playing, and applying the concepts in
side effect of agranulocytosis (failure of the bone mar- the community or real-world setting. The social
row to produce adequate white blood cells). Agranulo- problem-solving model focuses on improving impair-
cytosis develops suddenly and is characterized by ments in information processing that are assumed
306 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Box 14-1
ABNORMAL INVOLUNTARY MOVEMENT SCALE (AIMS) EXAMINATION PROCEDURE
Client identification: Date:
Rated by:
Either before or after completing the examination procedure, observe the client unobtrusively at rest (e.g., in
waiting room).
The chair to be used in this examination should be a hard, firm one without arms.
After observing the client, he or she may be rated on a scale of 0 (none), 1 (minimal), 2 (mild), 3 (moderate), and
4 (severe) according to the severity of symptoms.
Ask the client if there is anything in his/her mouth (i.e., gum, candy, etc.) and if there is to remove it.
Ask client about the current condition of his/her teeth. Ask client if he/she wears dentures. Do teeth or dentures
bother client now?
Ask client whether he/she notices any movement in mouth, face, hands, or feet. If yes, ask to describe and to what
extent the movements currently bother patient or interfere with his/her activities.
0 1 2 3 4 Have client sit in chair with hands on knees, legs slightly apart, and feet flat on floor. (Look at entire
body for movements while in this position.)
0 1 2 3 4 Ask client to sit with hands hanging unsupported. If male, hands between legs; if female and wearing
a dress, hands hanging over knees. (Observe hands and other body areas.)
0 1 2 3 4 Ask client to open mouth. (Observe tongue at rest within mouth.) Do this twice.
0 1 2 3 4 Ask client to protrude tongue. (Observe abnormalities of tongue movement.) Do this twice.
0 1 2 3 4 Ask client to tap thumb with each finger as rapidly as possible for 1015 seconds; separately with right
hand, then with left hand. (Observe facial and leg movements.)
0 1 2 3 4 Flex and extend clients left and right arms. (One at a time.)
0 1 2 3 4 Ask client to stand up. (Observe in profile. Observe all body areas again, hips included.)
0 1 2 3 4 *Ask client to extend both arms outstretched in front with palms down. (Observe trunk, legs, and
mouth.)
0 1 2 3 4 *Have client walk a few paces, turn and walk back to chair. (Observe hands and gait.) Do this twice.
*Activated movements.
to cause deficits in social skills. This includes medi- sion of the family is a factor that improves outcomes
cation and symptom management, recreation, basic for the client, family involvement often is neglected
conversation, and self-care. The cognitive remedia- by health care professionals (Aquila & Korn, 2001).
tion model focuses on improving underlying cogni- Families often have a difficult time coping with the
tive impairments by emphasizing such things as complexities and ramifications of the clients illness.
paying attention and planning. Improvements in This creates stress among family members that is
these basic cognitive functions enhance learning not beneficial for the client or family members. Fam-
in the other two models as well. Information about ily education helps to make family members part of
modules for teaching social problem-solving skills is the treatment team. See Chapter 4 for a discussion
available on the web site of Psychiatric Rehabilita- of the National Alliance for the Mentally Ill (NAMI)
tion Consultants at www.psychrehab.com. Family-to-Family Education Program.
Family education and therapy are known to di- In addition, family members can benefit from a
minish the negative effects of schizophrenia and re- supportive environment that helps them cope with
duce the relapse rate (Dyck et al., 2000). While inclu- the many difficulties presented when a loved one has
14 SCHIZOPHRENIA 307
schizophrenia (Teschinsky, 2000). These concerns in- wise, it is important to elicit information about any
clude continuing as a caregiver for the child who is history of violence or aggression because a history of
now an adult; worrying about who will care for the aggressive behavior is a strong predictor of future ag-
client when the parents are gone; dealing with the so- gression. The nurse might ask What do you do when
cial stigma of mental illness; and possibly facing fi- you are angry, frustrated, upset, or scared?
nancial problems, marital discord, and social isola- The nurse assesses if the client has been using
tion. Such support is available through the NAMI and current support systems by asking the client or sig-
local support groups. The clients health care provider nificant others the following questions:
can make referrals to meet specific family needs. Has the client kept in contact with family or
friends?
Has the client been to scheduled groups or
APPLICATION OF THE
therapy appointments?
NURSING PROCESS
Does the client seem to run out of money
Assessment between paychecks?
Have the clients living arrangements
Schizophrenia affects thought processes and content,
changed recently?
perception, emotion, behavior, and social function-
Finally the nurse assesses the clients perception of his
ing; however, it affects each individual differently.
The degree of impairment in both the acute or psy- or her current situationthat is, what the client be-
chotic phase and the chronic or long-term phase lieves to be significant present events or stressors.
varies greatly; thus, so do the needs of and the nurs- The nurse can gather such information by asking,
ing interventions for each affected client. The nurse What do you see as the primary problem now? or
must not make assumptions about the clients abili- What do you need help managing now?
ties or limitations based solely on the medical diag-
nosis of schizophrenia. GENERAL APPEARANCE, MOTOR
For example, the nurse may care for a client in BEHAVIOR, AND SPEECH
an acute inpatient setting. The client may appear
frightened, hear voices (hallucinating), make no eye Appearance may vary widely among different clients
contact, and mumble constantly. The nurse would with schizophrenia. Some appear normal in terms of
deal with the positive or psychotic signs of the dis- being dressed appropriately, sitting in a chair con-
ease. Another nurse may encounter a client with versing with the nurse, and exhibiting no strange or
schizophrenia in a community setting who is not ex- unusual postures or gestures. Others exhibit odd or
periencing psychotic symptoms; rather, this client bizarre behavior. They may appear disheveled and
lacks energy for daily tasks and has feelings of lone- unkempt with no obvious concern for their hygiene,
liness and isolation (negative signs of schizophrenia). or they may wear strange or inappropriate clothing
Although both clients have the same medical diag- (for instance, a heavy wool coat and stocking cap in
nosis, the approach and interventions that each nurse hot weather).
takes would be very different. Overall motor behavior also may appear odd.
The client may be restless and unable to sit still,
exhibit agitation and pacing, or appear unmoving
HISTORY
(catatonia). He or she also may demonstrate seem-
The nurse first elicits information about the clients ingly purposeless gestures (stereotypic behavior) and
previous history with schizophrenia to establish base- odd facial expressions such as grimacing. The client
line data. He or she asks questions about how the may imitate the movements and gestures of someone
client functioned before the crisis developed such as whom he or she is observing (echopraxia). Ram-
How do you usually spend your time? and Can you bling speech that may or may not make sense to the
describe what you do each day? listener is likely to accompany these behaviors.
The nurse assesses the age of onset of schizophre- Conversely the client may exhibit psychomotor
nia, knowing that poorer outcomes are associated with retardation (a general slowing of all movements).
an earlier age of onset. Learning the clients previous Sometimes the client may be almost immobile, curled
history of hospital admissions and response to hospi- into a ball (fetal position). Clients with the catatonic
talization also is important. type of schizophrenia can exhibit waxy flexibility:
The nurse also assesses the client for previous they maintain any position in which they are placed,
suicide attempts. Ten percent of all people with schiz- even if the position is awkward or uncomfortable.
ophrenia eventually commit suicide. The nurse might The client may exhibit an unusual speech pat-
ask, Have you ever attempted suicide? or Have you tern. Two typical patterns are word salad (jumbled
ever heard voices telling you to hurt yourself? Like- words and phrases that are disconnected or incoher-
308 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
ent and make no sense to the listener) and echolalia MOOD AND AFFECT
(repetition or imitation of what someone else says).
Clients with schizophrenia report and demonstrate
Speech may be slowed or accelerated in rate and vol-
wide variances in mood and affect. They often are de-
ume: the client may speak in whispers or hushed tones
scribed as having flat affect (no facial expression) or
or may talk loudly or yell. Latency of response
blunted affect (few observable facial expressions).
refers to hesitation before the client responds to
The typical facial expression often is described as
questions. This latency or hesitation may last 30 or
mask-like. The affect also may be described as silly,
45 seconds (Cancro & Lehman, 2000) and usually in-
characterized by giddy laughter for no apparent
dicates the clients difficulty with cognition or thought
reason. The client may exhibit an inappropriate ex-
processes. Box 14-2 lists and gives examples of these pression or emotions incongruent with the context
unusual speech patterns. of the situation. This incongruence ranges from mild
or subtle to grossly inappropriate. For example, the
client may laugh and grin while describing the death
of a family member or weep while talking about the
Box 14-2 weather.
UNUSUAL SPEECH PATTERNS OF CLIENTS The client may report feeling depressed and hav-
ing no pleasure or joy in life (anhedonia). Conversely
WITH SCHIZOPHRENIA he or she may report feeling all-knowing, all-powerful,
Clang associations are ideas that are related to and not at all concerned with the circumstance or sit-
one another based on sound or rhyming rather uation. It is more common for the client to report ex-
than meaning. aggerated feelings of well-being during episodes of
Example: I will take a pill if I go up the hill but psychotic or delusional thinking and a lack of energy
not if my name is Jill, I dont want to kill.
or pleasurable feelings during the chronic or long-
Neologisms are words invented by the client.
term phase of the illness.
Example: Im afraid of grittiz. If there are any
grittiz here, I will have to leave. Are you a grittiz?
Verbigeration is the stereotyped repetition of THOUGHT PROCESS AND CONTENT
words or phrases that may or may not have
meaning to the listener. Schizophrenia often is referred to as a thought disor-
Example: I want to go home, go home, go der because that is the primary feature of the dis-
home, go home. ease: thought processes become disordered, and the
Echolalia is the clients imitation or repetition of continuity of thoughts and information processing is
what the nurse says. disrupted (Cancro & Lehman, 2000). The nurse can
Example: Nurse: Can you tell me how youre assess thought process by inferring from what the
feeling? Client: Can you tell me how youre client says. He or she can assess thought content by
feeling, how youre feeling?
evaluating what the client actually says. For exam-
Stilted language is use of words or phrases that
ple, clients may suddenly stop talking in the middle
are flowery, excessive, and pompous.
Example: Would you be so kind, as a represen-
of a sentence and remain silent for several seconds to
tative of Florence Nightingale, as to do me the 1 minute (thought blocking). They also may state
honor of providing just a wee bit of refreshment, that they believe others can hear their thoughts
perhaps in the form of some clear spring water? (thought broadcasting); that others are taking
Perseveration is the persistent adherence to a sin- their thoughts (thought withdrawal); or that oth-
gle idea or topic and verbal repetition of a sen- ers are placing thoughts in their mind against their
tence, phrase, or word, even when another per- will (thought insertion).
son attempts to change the topic. Clients also may exhibit tangential thinking,
Example: Nurse: How have you been sleeping which is veering onto unrelated topics and never an-
lately? Client: I think people have been fol- swering the original question:
lowing me. Nurse: Where do you live? Nurse: How have you been sleeping lately?
Client: At my place people have been follow-
Client: Oh, I try to sleep at night. I like to listen
ing me. Nurse: What do you like to do in your
to music to help me sleep. I really like country-western
free time? Client: Nothing because people
are following me. music best. What do you like? Can I have something to
Word salad is a combination of jumbled words eat pretty soon? Im hungry.
and phrases that are disconnected or incoherent Nurse: Can you tell me how youve been
and make no sense to the listener. sleeping?
Example: Corn, potatoes, jump up, play games, Circumstantiality may be evidenced if the client
grass, cupboard. gives unnecessary details or strays from the topic but
eventually provides the requested information:
14 SCHIZOPHRENIA 309
Nurse: How have you been sleeping lately? The theme or content of the delusions may vary.
Client: Oh, I go to bed early, so I can get plenty Box 14-3 describes and provides examples of the var-
of rest. I like to listen to music or read before bed. ious types of delusions. External, contradictory in-
Right now Im reading a good mystery. Maybe Ill formation or facts cannot alter these delusional be-
write a mystery someday. But it isnt helping, reading liefs. If asked why he or she believes such an unlikely
I mean. I have been getting only 2 or 3 hours of sleep idea, the client often replies, I just know it.
at night.
Poverty of content (alogia) describes the lack of
any real meaning or substance in what the client
says: Box 14-3
Nurse: How have you been sleeping lately?
Client: Well, I guess, I dont know, hard to tell.
TYPES OF DELUSIONS
Persecutory/paranoid delusions involve the
clients belief that others are planning to harm
DELUSIONS the client or are spying, following, ridiculing, or
Clients with schizophrenia usually experience delu- belittling the client in some way. Sometimes the
client cannot define who these others are.
sions (fixed, false beliefs with no basis in reality) in
Examples: The client may think that food has
the psychotic phase of the illness. A common charac- been poisoned or that rooms are bugged with
teristic of schizophrenic delusions is the direct, im- listening devices. Sometimes the persecutor
mediate, and total certainty with which the client is the government, FBI, or other powerful
holds these beliefs. Because the client believes the organization. Occasionally, specific individuals,
delusion, he or she will therefore act accordingly. For even family members, may be named as the
example, the client with delusions of persecution will persecutor.
probably be suspicious, mistrustful, and guarded Grandiose delusions are characterized by the
about disclosing personal information; he or she may clients claim to association with famous people
examine the room periodically or speak in hushed, or celebrities, or the clients belief that he or she
secretive tones. is famous or capable of great feats.
Examples: The client may claim to be engaged
to a famous movie star or related to some public
figure such as claiming to be the daughter of the
President of the United States; may claim he or
she has found a cure for cancer.
Religious delusions often center around the second
coming of Christ or another significant religious
figure or prophet. These religious delusions
appear suddenly as part of the clients psychosis
and are not part of his or her religious faith or
that of others.
Examples: Client claims to be the Messiah or
some prophet sent from God; believes that God
communicates directly to him or her, or that he
or she has a special religious mission in life or
special religious powers.
Somatic delusions are generally vague and unreal-
istic beliefs about the clients health or bodily
functions. Factual information or diagnostic test-
ing does not change these beliefs.
Example: A male client may say that he is preg-
nant, or a client may report decaying intestines
or worms in the brain.
Referential delusions or ideas of reference involve
the clients belief that television broadcasts,
music, or newspaper articles have special mean-
ing for him or her.
Examples: The client may report that the presi-
dent was speaking directly to him on a news
broadcast or that special messages are sent
through newspaper articles.
Thought broadcasting
310 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Initially the nurse assesses the content and ers it is only a curved stick. Reality or factual infor-
depth of the delusion to know what behaviors to ex- mation corrected this illusion. Hallucinations, how-
pect and to try to establish reality for the client. ever, have no such basis in reality.
When eliciting information about the clients delu- The following are the various types of hallucina-
sional beliefs, the nurse must be careful not to sup- tions (Cancro & Lehman, 2000):
port or challenge them. The nurse might ask the Auditory hallucinations, the most common
client to explain what he or she believes by saying type, involve hearing sounds, most often
Can you explain that to me? or Tell me what youre voices, talking to or about the client. There
thinking about that. may be one or multiple voices; a familiar or
unfamiliar persons voice may be speaking.
Command hallucinations are voices de-
SENSORIUM AND INTELLECTUAL
manding that the client take action, often
PROCESSES
to harm self or others, and are considered
One hallmark symptom of schizophrenic psychosis is dangerous.
hallucinations (false sensory perceptions, or per- Visual hallucinations involve seeing images
ceptual experiences that do not exist in reality). Hal- that do not exist at all, such as lights or a
lucinations can involve the five senses and bodily dead person, or distortions such as seeing a
sensations. They can be threatening and frightening frightening monster instead of the nurse.
for the client, although clients less frequently report They are the second most common type of
hallucinations as pleasant. Initially the client per- hallucination.
ceives hallucinations as real, but later in the illness Olfactory hallucinations involve smells or
he or she may recognize them as hallucinations. odors. They may be a specific scent, such as
Hallucinations are distinguished from illusions, urine or feces, or more general such as a
which are misperceptions of actual environmental rotten or rancid odor. In addition to clients
stimuli. For example, while walking through the with schizophrenia, this type of hallucination
woods, a person thinks he sees a snake at the side of often occurs with dementia, seizures, or
the path. On closer examination, however, he discov- cerebrovascular accidents.
Tactile hallucinations refer to sensations
such as electricity running through the body
or bugs crawling on the skin. Tactile halluci-
nations are found most often in clients un-
dergoing alcohol withdrawal; they rarely
occur in clients with schizophrenia.
Gustatory hallucinations involve a taste lin-
gering in the mouth or the sense that food
tastes like something else. The taste may be
metallic or bitter or may be represented as a
specific taste.
Cenesthetic hallucinations involve the clients
report that he or she feels bodily functions
that are usually undetectable. Examples
would be the sensation of urine forming or
impulses being transmitted through the brain.
Kinesthetic hallucinations occur when the
client is motionless but reports the sensation
of bodily movement. Occasionally the bodily
movement is something unusual such as
floating above the ground.
During episodes of psychosis, clients are commonly
disoriented to time and sometimes place. The most
extreme form of disorientation is depersonaliza-
tion in which the client feels detached from her or
his behavior. Although the client can state her or his
name correctly, she or he feels as if her or his body
belongs to someone else or that her or his spirit is de-
Delusions of grandeur tached from the body.
14 SCHIZOPHRENIA 311
Data Analysis
The nurse must analyze assessment data for clients
with schizophrenia to determine priorities and estab-
lish an effective plan of care. Not all clients will have
the same problems and needs, nor is it likely that any
individual client will have all the problems that can
accompany schizophrenia. Levels of family and com-
munity support and available services also will vary,
all of which influence the clients care and outcomes.
The analysis of assessment data generally falls
into two main categories: data associated with the
positive signs of the disease and data associated with
the negative signs. NANDA nursing diagnoses com-
monly established based on the assessment of psy-
chotic symptoms or positive signs are as follows:
Risk for Other-Directed Violence
Risk for Suicide
Self-care deficits Disturbed Thought Processes
Disturbed Sensory Perception
Disturbed Personal Identity
Clients also may fail to recognize sensations such
Impaired Verbal Communication
as hunger or thirst, and food or fluid intake may be in-
NANDA nursing diagnoses based on the assess-
adequate. This can result in malnourishment and con- ment of negative signs and functional abilities in-
stipation. Constipation is also a common side effect of clude the following:
antipsychotic medications, compounding the problem. Self-Care Deficits
Paranoia or excessive fears that food and fluids have Social Isolation
been poisoned are common and may interfere with Deficient Diversional Activity
eating. If the client is agitated and pacing, he or she Ineffective Health Maintenance
may be unable to sit down long enough to eat. Ineffective Therapeutic Regimen Management
Occasionally clients develop polydipsia (exces-
sive water intake), which leads to water intoxication.
Serum sodium levels can become dangerously low, Outcome Identification
leading to seizures. Polydipsia usually is seen in It is likely that the client with an acute, psychotic
clients who have had severe and persistent mental episode of schizophrenia will receive treatment in
illness for many years as well as long-term therapy an intensive setting such as an inpatient hospital
with antipsychotic medications. Polydipsia may be unit. During this phase, the focus of care is stabiliz-
caused by the behavioral state itself or be precipitated ing the clients thought processes and reality orien-
by the use of antidepressant or antipsychotic med- tation as well as ensuring safety. This is also the time
ications (Reus & Frederick-Osborne, 2000). to evaluate resources, make referrals, and begin plan-
Sleep problems are common. Hallucinations may ning for the clients rehabilitation and return to the
stimulate clients, resulting in insomnia. Other times, community.
clients are suspicious and believe harm will come to Examples of outcomes appropriate to the acute,
them if they sleep. As in other self-care areas, the client psychotic phase of treatment are as follows:
may not correctly perceive or acknowledge physical 1. The client will not injure self or others.
cues such as fatigue. 2. The client will establish contact with reality.
14 SCHIZOPHRENIA 313
3. The client will interact with others in the unsafe and may believe his or her well-being to be
environment. in jeopardy. Therefore the nurse must approach the
4. The client will express thoughts and feelings client in a nonthreatening manner. Making demands
in a safe and socially acceptable manner. or being authoritarian will only increase the clients
5. The client will participate in prescribed fears. Giving the client ample personal space usually
therapeutic interventions. enhances his or her sense of security.
Once the crisis or acute psychotic symptoms have A fearful or agitated client has the potential to
been stabilized, the focus is on developing the clients harm self or others. The nurse must observe for signs
ability to live as independently and successfully as of building agitation or escalating behavior such as in-
possible in the community. This usually requires con- creased intensity of pacing, loud talking or yelling, and
tinued follow-up care and participation of the clients hitting or kicking objects. The nurse must institute
family in community support services. Prevention interventions to protect the client, nurse, and others in
and early recognition and treatment of relapse symp- the environment. This may involve administering
toms are important parts of successful rehabilita- medication; moving the client to a quiet, less stimu-
tion. Dealing with the negative signs of schizophre- lating environment; and, in extreme situations, tem-
nia, which medication generally does not affect, is a porarily using seclusion or restraints. See Chapter 10
major challenge for the client and caregivers. for a discussion of dealing with anger and hostility and
Examples of treatment outcomes for continued Chapter 14 for dealing with clients who are suicidal.
care after the stabilization of acute symptoms are as
follows: ESTABLISHING A THERAPEUTIC
1. The client will participate in the prescribed RELATIONSHIP
regimen (including medications and follow-
up appointments). Establishing trust between the client and nurse also
2. The client will maintain adequate routines helps to allay the fears of a frightened client. Initially
for sleeping and food and fluid intake. the client may tolerate only 5 or 10 minutes of con-
3. The client will demonstrate independence in tact at one time. Establishing a therapeutic relation-
self-care activities. ship takes time, and the nurse must be patient. The
4. The client will communicate effectively with nurse provides explanations that are clear, direct,
others in the community to meet his or her and easy to understand. Body language should include
needs. eye contact but not staring, a relaxed body posture, and
5. The client will seek or accept assistance to facial expressions that convey genuine interest and
meet his or her needs when indicated. concern. Telling the client ones name and calling the
The nurse must appreciate the severity of schizophre- client by name are helpful in establishing trust as
nia and the profound and sometimes devastating ef- well as reality orientation.
The nurse must assess carefully the clients re-
fects it has on the lives of clients and their families. It
sponse to the use of touch. Sometimes gentle touch
is equally important to avoid treating the client as a
conveys caring and concern. At other times, the client
hopeless case, someone who no longer is capable of
may misinterpret the nurses touch as threatening
having a meaningful and satisfying life. It is not help-
and therefore undesirable. As the nurse sits near the
ful to expect either too much or too little from the
client, does he or she move or look away? Is the client
client. Careful, ongoing assessment is necessary so
frightened or wary of the nurses presence? If so, that
that appropriate treatment and interventions address
client may not be reassured by touch, but frightened
the clients needs and difficulties while helping the
or threatened by it.
client to reach his or her optimal level of functioning.
of silence. The presence of the nurse is a contact with by making simple statements such as I have seen no
reality for the client and also can demonstrate the evidence of that (presenting reality) or It doesnt
nurses genuine interest and caring to the client. Call- seem that way to me (casting doubt). As antipsychotic
ing the client by name, making references to the day medications begin to have a therapeutic effect, it will
and time, and commenting on the environment are all be possible for the nurse to discuss the delusional
helpful ways to continue to make contact with a client ideas with the client and identify ways in which the
who is having problems with reality orientation and delusions interfere with the clients daily life.
verbal communication. Clients who are left alone for The nurse also can help the client minimize the
long periods become more deeply involved in their psy- effects of delusional thinking. Distraction techniques,
chosis, so frequent contact and time spent with the such as listening to music, watching television, writ-
client are important even if the nurse is unsure that ing, or talking to friends, are useful. Direct action,
the client is aware of the nurses presence. such as engaging in positive self-talk and positive
Actively listening to the client is an important thinking and ignoring the delusional thoughts, may
skill for the nurse trying to communicate with a be beneficial as well (Murphy & Moller, 1993).
client whose verbalizations are disorganized or non-
sensical. Rather than dismissing what the client says
IMPLEMENTING INTERVENTIONS
because it is not clear, the nurse must make efforts
FOR HALLUCINATIONS
to determine the meaning the client is trying to con-
vey. Listening for themes or recurrent statements, Intervening when the client experiences hallucina-
asking clarifying questions, and exploring the mean- tions requires the nurse to focus on what is real and
ing of the clients statements are all useful tech- to help shift the clients response toward reality. Ini-
niques to increase understanding. tially the nurse must determine what the client is
The nurse must let the client know when his or experiencingthat is, what the voices are saying or
her meaning is not clear. It is never useful to pretend what the client is seeing. Doing so will increase the
to understand or just to agree or go along with what nurses understanding of the nature of the clients
the client is saying: this is dishonest and violates feelings and behavior. In command hallucinations,
trust between client and nurse. the client hears voices directing him or her to do
Nurse: How are you feeling today? (using a something, often to hurt self or someone else. For
broad opening statement) this reason, the nurse must elicit a description of the
Client: Invisible. content of the hallucination so that health care per-
Nurse: Can you explain that to me? (seeking sonnel can take precautions to protect the client and
clarification) others as necessary. The nurse might say, I dont
Client: Oh, it doesnt matter. hear any voices; what are you hearing? (presenting
Nurse: Im interested in how you feel; Im just not reality/seeking clarification). This also can help the
sure I understand. (offering self/seeking clarification) nurse understand how to relieve the clients fears or
Client: It doesnt mean much. paranoia. For example, the client might be seeing
Nurse: Let me see if I can understand. Do you ghosts or monster-like images, and the nurse could
feel like youre being ignored, that no one is really lis- respond: I dont see anything, but you must be fright-
tening? (verbalizing the implied) ened. You are safe here in the hospital (presenting
reality/translating into feelings). This acknowledges
the clients fear but reassures the client that no harm
IMPLEMENTING INTERVENTIONS FOR
will come to him or her.
DELUSIONAL THOUGHTS
Clients do not always report or identify halluci-
The client experiencing delusions utterly believes nations. At times the nurse must infer from the clients
them and cannot be convinced that they are false or behavior that hallucinations are occurring. Exam-
untrue. Such delusions powerfully influence the ples of behavior that indicate hallucinations include
clients behavior. For example, if the clients delusion alternately listening and then talking when no one
is that he or she is being poisoned, he or she will be else is present, laughing inappropriately for no ob-
suspicious, mistrustful, and probably resistant to servable reason, and mumbling or mouthing words
providing information and taking medications. with no audible sound.
The nurse must avoid openly confronting the A helpful strategy for intervening with halluci-
delusion or arguing with the client about it. The nurse nations is to engage the client in a reality-based ac-
also must avoid reinforcing the delusional belief by tivity such as playing cards, engaging in occupational
playing along with what the client says. It is the therapy, or listening to music. It is difficult for the
nurses responsibility to present and maintain reality client to pay attention to hallucinations and reality-
14 SCHIZOPHRENIA 315
based activity at the same time, so this technique of and dignity. Taking the client to his or her room or a
distracting the client is often useful. quiet area with less stimulation and fewer people
It also may be useful to work with the client to often helps. Engaging the client in appropriate ac-
identify certain situations or a particular frame of tivities also is indicated. For example if the client is
mind that may precede or trigger auditory halluci- undressing in front of others, the nurse might say,
nations (Lakeman, 2001). Intensity of hallucinations Lets go to your room and you can put your clothes
often is related to anxiety levels; therefore, monitoring back on (encouraging collaboration/redirecting to
and intervening to lower anxiety may decrease the in- appropriate activity). If the client is making verbal
tensity of hallucinations. Clients who recognize that statements to others, the nurse might ask the client
certain moods or patterns of thinking precede the onset to go for a walk or move to another area to listen to
of voices may eventually be able to manage or control music. The nurse should deal with socially inappro-
the hallucinations by learning to manage or avoid par- priate behavior nonjudgmentally and matter-of-factly.
ticular states of mind. This may involve learning to This means making factual statements with no over-
relax when voices occur, engaging in diversions, cor- tones of scolding or talking to the client as if he or she
recting negative self-talk, and seeking out or avoiding were a naughty child.
social interaction. Some behaviors may be so offensive or threaten-
Teaching the client to talk back to the voices ing that others respond by yelling at, ridiculing, or
forcefully also may help him or her manage auditory even taking aggressive action against the client. Al-
hallucinations. The client should do this in a rela- though providing physical protection for the client is
tively private place rather than in public. There is an the nurses first consideration, helping others affected
by the clients behavior also is important. Usually
international self-help movement of voice-hearer
the nurse can offer simple and factual statements
groups developed to assist people to manage audi-
to others that do not violate the clients confiden-
tory hallucinations. One group devised the strategy
tiality. The nurse might make statements such as
of carrying a cell phone (fake or real) to cope with
You didnt do anything to provoke that behavior.
voices when in public places. With cell phones, mem-
Sometimes peoples illnesses cause them to act in
bers can carry on conversations with their voices in
strange and uncomfortable ways. It is important not
the streetand tell them to shut upwhile avoiding to laugh at behaviors that are part of someones ill-
ridicule by looking like a normal part of the street ness (presenting reality/giving information).
scene (Hagen & Mitchell, 2001). Being able to ver- The nurse reassures the clients family that these
balize resistance can help the client feel empowered behaviors are part of the clients illness and not per-
and capable of dealing with the hallucinations. sonally directed at them. Such situations present an
opportunity to educate family members about schizo-
COPING WITH SOCIALLY phrenia and to help allay their feelings of guilt, shame,
INAPPROPRIATE BEHAVIORS or responsibility.
Reintegrating the client into the treatment milieu
Clients with schizophrenia often experience a loss of as soon as possible is essential. The client should not
ego boundaries, which poses difficulties for themselves feel shunned or punished for inappropriate behavior.
and others in their environment and community. Health care personnel should introduce limited stim-
Potentially bizarre or strange behaviors include touch- ulation gradually. For example, when the client is
ing others without warning or invitation, intruding comfortable and demonstrating appropriate behavior
into others living space, and talking to or caressing with the nurse, one or two other people can be en-
inanimate objects, and engaging in such socially in- gaged in a somewhat structured activity with the
appropriate behaviors as undressing, masturbating, client. The clients involvement is gradually increased
or urinating in public. Clients may approach others to small groups and then to larger, less structured
and make provocative, insulting, or sexual statements. groups as he or she can tolerate the increased level of
The nurse must consider the needs of others as well as stimulation without decompensating (regressing to
the needs of clients in these situations. previous, less effective coping behaviors).
Protecting the client is a primary nursing re-
sponsibility and includes protecting the client from
TEACHING CLIENT AND FAMILY
retaliation by others who experience the clients in-
trusions and socially unacceptable behavior. Re- Coping with schizophrenia is a major adjustment
directing the client away from situations or others for both clients and their families. Understanding
can interrupt the undesirable behavior and keep the the illness, the need for continuing medication and
client from further intrusive behaviors. The nurse follow-up, and the uncertainty of the prognosis or re-
also must try to protect the clients right to privacy covery are key issues. Clients and families need help
316 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Nursing Diagnosis
Disturbed Thought Processes
Disruption in cognitive operations and activities
IMPLEMENTATION
Be consistent in setting expectations, enforcing Clear, consistent limits provide a secure structure
rules, and so forth. for the client.
Do not make promises that you cannot keep. Broken promises reinforce the clients mistrust of
others.
Encourage the client to talk with you, but do not Probing increases the clients suspicion and inter-
pry or cross-examine for information. feres with the therapeutic relationship.
Explain procedures, and try to be sure the client When the client has full knowledge of procedures,
understands the procedures before carrying he or she is less likely to feel tricked by the staff.
them out.
Give positive feedback for the clients successes. Positive feedback for genuine success enhances
the clients sense of well-being and helps to make
nondelusional reality a more positive situation for
the client.
Recognize the clients delusions as the clients It is important to recognize the clients environ-
perception of the environment. mental perceptions to understand the feelings he
or she is experiencing.
Initially, do not argue with the client or try to Logical argument does not dispel delusional ideas
convince the client that the delusions are false and can interfere with the development of trust.
or unreal.
Interact with the client on the basis of real things; Interacting about reality is healthy for the client.
do not dwell on the delusional material.
Engage the client in one-to-one activities at first, The client who is distrustful can best deal with one
then activities in small groups, and gradually ac- person initially. Gradual introduction of others
tivities in larger groups. when the client can tolerate it is less threatening.
Recognize and support the clients accomplish- Recognition of accomplishments can lessen the
ments (activities or projects completed, responsi- clients anxiety and the need for delusions as a
bilities fulfilled, interactions initiated). source of self-esteem.
Show empathy regarding the clients feelings; re- The clients delusions can be distressing. Empa-
assure the client of your presence and acceptance. thy conveys your acceptance of the client and your
caring and interest.
Do not be judgmental or belittle or joke about the The clients delusions and feelings are not funny
clients beliefs. to him or her. The client may feel rejected by you
or feel unimportant if approached by attempts at
humor.
Never convey to the client that you accept the You would reinforce the delusion (thus, the clients
delusions as reality. illness) if you indicated belief in the delusion.
Directly interject doubt regarding delusions as As the client begins to trust you, he or she may
soon as the client seems ready to accept this. (e.g., become willing to doubt the delusion if you ex-
I find that hard to believe.) Do not argue with press your doubt.
the client, but present a factual account of the sit-
uation as you see it.
Attempt to discuss the delusional thoughts as a Discussion of the problems caused by the delusions
problem in the clients life; ask the client if he or is a focus on the present and is reality based.
she can see that the delusions interfere with his
or her life.
318 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
they are not the cause of schizophrenia. Participating Teaching Social Skills. Clients may be isolated from
in organizations such as the Alliance for the Mentally others for a variety of reasons. The bizarre behavior
Ill may help families with their ongoing needs. or statements of the client who is delusional or hal-
lucinating may frighten or embarrass family or com-
Teaching Self-Care and Proper Nutrition. Because of munity members. Clients who are suspicious or mis-
apathy or lack of energy over the course of the illness, trustful may avoid contact with others. Other times,
poor personal hygiene can be a problem for clients clients may lack the social or conversation skills they
who are experiencing psychotic symptoms as well as need to make and maintain relationships with oth-
for all clients with schizophrenia. When the client is ers. Lastly, a stigma remains attached to mental ill-
psychotic, he or she may pay little attention to hy- ness, particularly for clients for whom medication
giene or be unable to sustain the attention or concen- fails to relieve the positive signs of the illness.
tration required to complete grooming tasks. The The nurse can help the client develop social skills
nurse may need to direct the client through the nec- through education, role modeling, and practice. The
essary steps for bathing, shampooing, dressing, and client may not discriminate between the topics suit-
so forth. The nurse gives directions in short, clear able for sharing with the nurse and those suitable for
statements to enhance the clients ability to complete using to initiate a conversation on a bus. The nurse
the tasks. The nurse allows ample time for grooming can help the client learn neutral social topics appro-
and performing hygiene and does not attempt to rush priate to any conversation such as the weather or
or hurry the client. In this way, the nurse encourages local events. The client also can benefit from learning
the client to become more independent as soon as pos- that he or she should share certain details of his or
siblethat is, when he or she is better oriented to re- her illness, such as the content of delusions or hallu-
ality and better able to sustain the concentration and cinations, only with a health care provider.
attention needed for these tasks. Modeling and practicing social skills with the
If the client has deficits in hygiene and grooming client can help him or her experience greater success
resulting from apathy or lack of energy for tasks, the in social interactions. Specific skills, such as eye con-
nurse may vary the approach used to promote the tact, attentive listening, and taking turns talking,
clients independence in these areas. The client is most can increase the clients abilities and confidence in
likely to perform tasks of hygiene and grooming if they socializing. Nursing interventions for clients with
become a part of his or her daily routine. Establishing schizophrenia are summarized in the display.
a structure with the client that incorporates his or her
preferences has a greater chance for success than if Medication Management. Maintaining the medica-
the client waits to decide about hygiene tasks or per- tion regimen is vital to a successful outcome for clients
forms them randomly. For example, the client may with schizophrenia. Failing to take medications as
prefer to shower and shampoo on Monday, Wednes- prescribed is one of the most frequent reasons for re-
day, and Friday when getting up in the morning. This currence of psychotic symptoms and hospital admis-
nurse can assist the client to incorporate this plan into sion (Marder, 2000). Clients who respond well to and
the clients daily routine, which leads to it becoming a maintain an antipsychotic medication regimen may
habit. The client thus avoids making daily decisions lead relatively normal lives with only an occasional re-
about whether or not to shower or if he or she feels like lapse. Those who do not respond well to antipsychotic
showering on a particular day. agents may face a lifetime of dealing with delusional
Adequate nutrition and fluids are essential to ideas and hallucinations, negative signs, and marked
the clients physical and emotional well-being. Care- impairment. Many clients find themselves somewhere
ful assessment of the clients eating patterns and between these two extremes. See Client Teaching and
preferences allows the nurse to determine if the client Medication Management: Antipsychotics.
needs assistance in these areas. As with any type of There are many reasons why clients may not
self-care deficit, the nurse provides assistance as long maintain the medication regimen. The nurse must
as needed then gradually promotes the clients inde- determine the barriers to compliance for each client.
pendence as soon as the client is capable. Sometimes clients intend to take their medications
When the client is in the community, factors as prescribed but have difficulty remembering when
other than the clients illness may contribute to in- and if they did so. They may find it difficult to adhere
adequate nutritional intake. Examples include lack to a routine schedule for medications. Several meth-
of money to buy food, lack of knowledge about a nu- ods are available to help clients remember when to
tritious diet, inadequate transportation, or limited take medications. One is using a pill box with com-
abilities to prepare food. A thorough assessment of partments for days of the week and times of the day.
the clients functional abilities for community living Once the box has been filled, perhaps with assistance
will help the nurse to plan appropriate interventions. from the nurse or case manager, the client often has
See the section below on community-based care. no more difficulties. It is also helpful to make a chart
320 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Have the clients psychotic symptoms dis- health and wellness (OBrien, 1998; Wilbur & Arns,
appeared? If not, can the client carry out his 1998). Behavioral home health care also is expanding,
or her daily life despite the persistence of with nurses providing care to persons with schizo-
some psychotic symptoms? phrenia (as well as other mental illnesses) using the
Does the client understand the prescribed holistic approach to integrate clients into the commu-
medication regimen? Is he or she committed nity (Gibson, 1999; Rosedale, 1999). Although much
to adherence to the regimen? has been done to give these clients the support they
Does the client possess the necessary func- need to live in the community, there is still a need to
tional abilities for community living? increase services to homeless persons and those in
Are community resources adequate to help prison with schizophrenia.
the client live successfully in the community? Community support programs often are an im-
Is there a sufficient after-care or crisis plan portant link in helping persons with schizophrenia
in place to deal with recurrence of symptoms and their families. A case manager may be assigned to
or difficulties encountered in the community? the client to provide assistance in handling the wide
Are the client and family adequately knowl- variety of challenges that the client in community set-
edgeable about schizophrenia? tings faces. The client who has had schizophrenia for
Does the client believe that he or she has a some time may have a case manager in the commu-
satisfactory quality of life? nity. Other clients may need assistance to obtain a case
manager. Depending on the type of funding and agen-
COMMUNITY-BASED CARE cies available in a particular community, the nurse
may refer the client to a social worker or may directly
Clients with schizophrenia are no longer hospitalized refer the client to case management services.
for long periods. Most return to live in the community
Case management services often include helping
with assistance provided by family and support ser-
the client with housing and transportation, money
vices. Clients may live with family members, inde-
management, and keeping appointments, as well as
pendently, or in a residential program such as a group
home where they can receive needed services without socialization and recreation. Beebe (2002) found that
being admitted to the hospital. Assertive Community proactive telephone contact with clients in the com-
Treatment (ACT) programs have shown success in re- munity helped address clients immediate concerns
ducing the rate of hospital admissions by managing and avoid relapse and rehospitalization. The most
symptoms and medications; assisting clients with so- common concerns of client included difficulties with
cial, recreational, and vocational needs; and providing treatment and aftercare, dealing with psychiatric
support to clients and their families (McGrew, Wilson, symptoms, environmental stresses, and financial is-
& Bond, 1996). The psychiatric nurse is a member of sues. Although the support of professionals in the
the multidisciplinary team that works with clients in community is vital, the nurse must not to overlook
ACT programs, focusing on the management of med- the clients need for autonomy and potential abilities
ications and their side effects and the promotion of to manage his or her own health.
322 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
MENTAL HEALTH PROMOTION ophrenia but also to stop them from developing in the
first place.
Psychiatric rehabilitation has the goal of recovery for
clients with major mental illness that goes beyond
symptom control and medication management (see SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES
Chapter 4). Working with clients to manage their own
lives, make effective treatment decisions, and have Working with clients with schizophrenia
can present many challenges for the nurse. They have
an improved quality of lifefrom the clients point
many experiences that are difficult for the nurse to
of vieware central components of such programs.
relate to such as delusions and hallucinations. Sus-
Willinsky and Pape (2002) identify mental health
picious or paranoid behavior on the clients part may
promotion as strengthening the clients ability to
make the nurse feel as though he or she is not trust-
bounce back from adversity and to manage the in-
worthy or that his or her integrity is being questioned.
evitable obstacles encountered in life. Strategies in- The nurse must recognize this type of behavior as part
clude fostering self-efficacy and empowering the of the illness and not interpret or respond to it as a
client to have control over his or her life; improving personal affront. Taking the clients statements or be-
the clients resiliency or ability to bounce back emo- havior as a personal accusation only causes the nurse
tionally from stressful events; and improving the to respond defensively, which is counterproductive to
clients ability to cope with the problems, stress, and the establishment of a therapeutic relationship.
strains of everyday living. See Chapter 7 for a full The nurse also may be genuinely frightened or
discussion of resiliency and self-efficacy. threatened if the clients behavior is hostile or ag-
In Australia, a pioneering service has been de- gressive. The nurse must acknowledge these feelings
veloped to work with young people with emerging and take measures to ensure his or her safety. This
psychotic illness. The emphasis is on early, intensive, may involve talking to the client in an open area
and integrated biological, psychological, and social rather than a more isolated location or having an ad-
interventions in the 2 years after the onset of treat- ditional staff person present rather than being alone
ment. The main aims of the project include reduced with the client. If the nurse pretends to be unafraid,
duration of untreated psychosis; expert treatment of the client may sense the fear anyway and feel less
the first episode of psychosis; reduced duration of ac- secure, leading to a greater potential for the client to
tive psychosis in the first episode and beyond; and lose personal control.
maximized recovery, reintegration, and quality of life As with many chronic illnesses, the nurse may be-
(McCann, 2001). come frustrated if the client does not follow the med-
An initiative of early detection, intervention, ication regimen, fails to keep needed appointments, or
and prevention of psychosis (EDIP) has been estab- experiences repeated relapses. The nurse may feel as
lished in Portland, Oregon (Korn, 2001). This project though a great deal of hard work has been wasted or
works with primary care providers to recognize pro- that the situation is futile or hopeless. Schizophrenia
dromal signs that are predictive of later psychotic is a chronic illness, and clients may suffer numerous
episodes such as sleep difficulties, change in appetite, relapses and hospital admissions. The nurse must
loss of energy and interest, odd speech, hearing not take responsibility for the success or failure of
voices, peculiar behavior, inappropriate expression of treatment efforts or view the clients status as a per-
feelings, paucity of speech, ideas of reference, and sonal success or failure. Nurses should look to their
feelings of unreality. Once these high-risk individu- colleagues for helpful support and discussion of these
als are identified, individualized intervention is im- self-awareness issues.
plemented including education, stress management,
and/or neuroleptic medication. Treatment also in- Points to Consider when Working
cludes family involvement, individual and vocational With Clients With Schizophrenia
counseling, and coping strategies to enhance self- Remember that although these clients often
mastery. Interventions are intensive, using home vis- suffer numerous relapses and return for re-
its and daily sessions if needed. peated hospital stays, they do return to living
The Harvard Mental Health Letter (2001) an- and functioning in the community. Focusing
nounced that research is about to begin on the pro- on the amount of time the client is outside
phylactic drug treatment of genetically vulnerable the hospital setting may help decrease the
relatives of clients with schizophrenia who seem to frustration that can result when working
be showing early signs of the disorder such as mild with clients with a chronic illness.
negative symptoms and abnormal brain functioning. Visualize the client not at his or her worst,
There is the hope that it may be possible not only to but as he or she gets better and symptoms
prevent the most debilitating consequences of schiz- become less severe.
14 SCHIZOPHRENIA 323
Remember that the clients remarks are not client is carefully and individually assessed
directed at you personally but are a byprod- with appropriate needs and interventions
uct of the disordered and confused thinking determined.
that schizophrenia causes. Careful assessment of each client as an in-
Discuss these issues with a more experi- dividual is essential to planning an effective
enced nurse for suggestions on how to deal plan of care.
with your feelings and actions toward these Families of clients with schizophrenia may
clients. You are not expected to have all the experience fear, embarrassment, and guilt in
answers. response to their family members illness.
Families must be educated about the dis-
order, the course of the disorder, and how it
KEY POINTS
can be controlled.
Schizophrenia is a chronic illness requiring Failure to comply with treatment and the
long-term management strategies and coping medication regimen and the use of alcohol
skills. Schizophrenia is a disease of the and other drugs are associated with poorer
brain, a clinical syndrome that involves a outcomes in the treatment of schizophrenia.
persons thoughts, perceptions, emotions, For clients with psychotic symptoms, key
movements, and behaviors. nursing interventions include helping to
The effects of schizophrenia on the client protect the clients safety and right to
may be profound, involving all aspects of the privacy and dignity, dealing with socially
clients life: social interactions, emotional inappropriate behaviors in a nonjudgmen-
health, and ability to work and function in tal and matter-of-fact manner, helping
the community. present and maintain reality for the client
Schizophrenia is conceptualized in terms of by frequent contact and communication,
positive signs, such as delusions, hallucina- and ensuring appropriate medication
tions, and disordered thought process, and administration.
negative signs such as social isolation, apa- For the client whose condition is stabilized
thy, anhedonia, and lack of motivation and with medication, key nursing interventions
volition. include continuing to offer a supportive, non-
The clinical picture, prognosis, and out- confrontational approach; maintaining the
comes for clients with schizophrenia vary therapeutic relationship by establishing
widely. Therefore it is important that each trust and trying to clarify the clients feelings
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 11991210). Rosedale, M. (1999). Managed care opens unlikely doors:
Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins. Innovations in behavioral home health care. Home
Marland, G. R., & Cash, K. (2001). Long-term illness and Health Care Management & Practice, 11(4), 4548.
patterns of medicine taking: Are people with schizo- Schultz, J. M., & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts
phrenia a unique group? Journal of Psychiatric and manual of psychiatric nursing care plans (6th ed.).
Mental Health Nursing, 8, 197204. Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
McCann, E. (2001). Recent developments in psychosocial Teschinsky, U. (2000). Living with schizophrenia: The
interventions for people with psychosis. Issues in family illness experience. Issues in Mental Health
Mental Health Nursing, 22, 99107. Nursing, 21, 387396.
McGrew, J. H., Wilson, R. G., & Bond, G. R. (1996). Client Torrey, E. F. (1995). Surviving schizophrenia: For fami-
perspectives on helpful ingredients of assertive com- lies, consumers, and providers (3rd ed.). New York:
munity treatment. Psychiatric Rehabilitation Jour- Harper & Row.
Wilbur, S., & Arns, P. (1998). Psychosocial rehabilitation
nal, 19(3), 1321.
nurses: Taking our place on the multidisciplinary
Mezzich, J. E., Lin, K., & Hughes, C. C. (2000). Acute and team. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing, 36(4), 3348.
transient disorders and cultural bound syndromes. In
B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive
textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 12641276). ADDITIONAL READINGS
Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Miller, M. C. (Ed.) (2001). How schizophrenia develops: Brekke, J. S., Prindle, C., Bae, S. W., & Long, J. D.
New evidence and new ideas. The Harvard Mental (2001). Risks for individuals with schizophrenia who
Health Letter, 17(8), 14. are living in the community. Psychiatric Services,
Mortensen, P. B., Pedersen, C. B., Westergaard, T., 52(10), 13581366.
Wohlfahrt, J., Ewald, H., Mors, O., Andersen, P. K., & Chernomas, W. M., Clarke, D. E., & Chisholm, F. A.
Melbye, M. (1999). Effects of family history and place (2000). Perspectives of women living with schizophre-
and season of birth on the risk of schizophrenia. New nia. Psychiatric Services, 51(12), 15171521.
England Journal of Medicine, 340(8), 603608. Kennedy, M. G., Schepp, K. G., & OConnor, F. W. (2000).
Murphy, M. F., & Moller, M. D. (1993). Relapse manage- Symptom self-management and relapse in schizophre-
ment in neurobiological disorders: The Moller-Murphy nia. Archives of Psychiatric Nursing, XIV(6), 266275.
symptom management assessment tool. Archives of Lambert, L. T. (2001). Identification and management of
schizophrenia in childhood. Journal of Child and
Psychiatric Nursing, 7(4), 226235.
Adolescent Psychiatric Nursing, 14(2), 7380.
OBrien, S. M. (1998). Health promotion and schizophre-
Roder, V., Zorn, P., Muller, D., & Brenner, H. D. (2001).
nia: The year 2000 and beyond. Holistic Nursing Improving recreational, residential, and vocational
Practice, 12(2), 3843. outcomes for patients with schizophrenia. Psychiatric
OConnor, F. L. (1998). The role of serotonin and Services, 52(11), 14391441.
dopamine in schizophrenia. Journal of the American Sayer, J., Ritter, S., & Gournay, K. (2000). Beliefs about
Psychiatric Nurses Association, 4(4), S3041. voices and their effects on coping strategies. Journal
Reus, V. I., & Frederick-Osborne, S. (2000). Psychoneuro- of Advanced Nursing, 31(5), 11991205.
endocrinology. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Tuck, I., du Mont, P., Evans, G., & Shupe, J. (1997). The
Comprehensive Textbook of Psychiatry, Vol. 1 experience of caring for an adult child with schizo-
(7th ed., pp. 104113). Philadelphia: Lippincott, phrenia. Archives of Psychiatric Nursing, 11(3),
Williams, & Wilkins. 118125.
Chapter
Chapter Review
Study Guide
MULTIPLE-CHOICE QUESTIONS
Select the best answer for each of the following
questions.
1. Which of the following are considered the posi- A. Benztropine (Cogentin) 2 mg p.o., BID, prn
tive signs of schizophrenia? B. Fluphenazine (Prolixin) 2 mg p.o., TID, prn
A. Delusions, anhedonia, ambivalence C. Haloperidol (Haldol) 5 mg IM, prn extreme
B. Hallucinations, illusions, ambivalence agitation
C. Delusions, hallucinations, disordered thinking D. Diphenhydramine (Benadryl) 25 mg IM, prn
D. Disordered thinking, anhedonia, illusions
5. Which of the following statements would indi-
2. The family of a client with schizophrenia asks the cate that family teaching about schizophrenia
nurse about the difference between conventional had been effective?
and atypical antipsychotic medications. The A. If our son takes his medication properly, he
nurses answer is based on which of the following? wont have another psychotic episode.
A. Atypical antipsychotics are newer medica- B. I guess well have to face the fact that our
tions but act in the same ways as conven- daughter will eventually be institutionalized.
tional antipsychotics.
C. Its a relief to find out that we did not cause
B. Conventional antipsychotics are dopamine our sons schizophrenia.
antagonists; atypical antipsychotics inhibit
the reuptake of serotonin. D. It is a shame our daughter will never be able
to have children.
C. Conventional antipsychotics have serious
side effects; atypical antipsychotics have vir- 6. When the client describes fear of leaving his
tually no side effects. apartment as well as the desire to get out and
D. Atypical antipsychotics are dopamine and meet others, it is called
serotonin antagonists; conventional anti- A. Ambivalence
psychotics are only dopamine antagonists.
B. Anhedonia
3. The nurse is planning discharge teaching for a C. Alogia
client taking clozapine (Clozaril). Which of the
following is essential to include? D. Avoidance
A. Caution the client not to be outdoors in the 7. The client who hesitates 30 seconds before re-
sunshine without protective clothing. sponding to any question is described as having
B. Remind the client to go to the lab to have A. Blunted affect
blood drawn for a white blood cell count.
B. Latency of response
C. Instruct the client about dietary restrictions.
C. Paranoid delusions
D. Give the client a chart to record a daily
D. Poverty of speech
pulse rate.
8. The overall goal of psychiatric rehabilitation is
4. The nurse is caring for a client who has been
for the client to gain
taking fluphenazine (Prolixin) for 2 days. The
client suddenly cries out, his neck twists to one A. Control of symptoms
side, and his eyes appear to roll back in the B. Freedom from hospitalization
sockets. The nurse finds the following prn
medications ordered for the client. Which one C. Management of anxiety
should the nurse administer? D. Recovery from the illness
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com
326
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify the type of speech pattern exhibited for each of the following client statements.
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
Give an example of each of the following:
1. Delusion
2. Hallucination
327
3. Illusion
For each of the following client statements, write a response the nurse might
make, and the rationale for the nurses response.
328
6. I can feel my stomach rotting away.
CLINICAL EXAMPLE
John Jones, 33, has been admitted to the hospital for the third time
with a diagnosis of paranoid schizophrenia. John had been taking
haloperidol (Haldol) but stopped taking it 2 weeks ago, telling his case
manager it was the poison that is making me sick. Yesterday, John
was brought to the hospital after neighbors called the police because he
had been up all night yelling loudly in his apartment. Neighbors re-
ported him saying, I cant do it! They dont deserve to die! and simi-
lar statements.
John appears guarded and suspicious and has very little to say to
anyone. His hair is matted, he has a strong body odor, and he is dressed
in several layers of heavy clothing even though the temperature is
warm. So far, John has been refusing any offers of food or fluids. When
the nurse approached John with a dose of haloperidol, he said, Do you
want me to die?
1. What additional assessment data does the nurse need to plan care for John?
329
2. Identify the three priorities, nursing diagnoses, and expected outcomes for Johns care, with your
rationales for the choices.
3. Identify at least two nursing interventions for the three priorities listed above.
4. What community referrals or supports might be beneficial for John when he is discharged?
330
15 Mood
Disorders and
Learning Objectives Suicide
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
331
332 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Everyone occasionally feels sad, low, and tired with feeling of being on top of the world also recedes in
the desire to stay in bed and shut out the world. These a few days to a euthymic mood (average affect and
episodes often are accompanied by anergia (lack of activity). Happy events stimulate joy and enthusiasm.
energy), exhaustion, agitation, noise intolerance, and These mood alterations are normal and do not inter-
slowed thinking processes, all of which make decisions fere meaningfully with the persons life.
difficult. Work, family, and social responsibilities drive Mood disorders, also called affective disorders,
most people to proceed with their daily routines, even are pervasive alterations in emotions that are mani-
when nothing seems to go right and their irritable fested by depression, mania, or both. They interfere
mood is obvious to all. Such low periods pass in a with a persons life, plaguing him or her with drastic
few days, and energy returns. Fluctuations in mood and long-term sadness, agitation, or elation. Accom-
are so common to the human condition that we think panying self-doubt, guilt, and anger alter life activi-
nothing of hearing someone say, Im depressed ties especially those that involve self-esteem, occu-
because I have too much to do. Everyday use of the pation, and relationships.
word depressed doesnt actually mean that the per- From early history, people have suffered from
son is clinically depressed but is just having a bad day. mood disturbances. Archaeologists have found holes
Sadness in mood also can be a response to misfortune. drilled into ancient skulls to relieve the evil humors
Death of a friend or relative, financial problems, or loss of those suffering from sad feelings and strange be-
of a job may cause a person to grieve (see Chap. 12). haviors. Babylonians and ancient Hebrews believed
At the other end of the mood spectrum are that overwhelming sadness and extreme behavior
episodes of exaggeratedly energetic behavior. The were sent to people through the will of God or other
person has the sure sense that he or she can take on divine beings. Biblical notables King Saul, King
any task or relationship. In an elated mood, stamina Nebuchadnezzar, and Moses suffered overwhelm-
for work, family, and social events is untiring. This ing grief of heart, unclean spirits, and bitterness of
soul, all of which are symptoms of depression. Abra-
ham Lincoln and Queen Victoria had recurrent
episodes of depression. Other famous people with
mood disorders were writers Virginia Woolf, Sylvia
Plath, and Eugene ONeill; composer George Frid-
eric Handel; musician Jerry Garcia; artist Vincent
Van Gogh; philosopher Frederic Nietzsche; TV com-
mentator and host of 60 Minutes Mike Wallace;
and actress Patty Duke.
Until the mid-1950s no treatment was available
to help people with serious depression or mania. These
people suffered through their altered moods, thinking
they were hopelessly weak to succumb to these devas-
tating symptoms. Family and mental health profes-
sionals tended to agree, seeing sufferers as egocentric
or viewing life negatively. While there are still no cures
for mood disorders, effective treatments for both de-
pression and mania are now available.
Mood disorders are the most common psychi-
atric diagnoses associated with suicide; depression is
one of the most important risk factors for it (Roy,
2000). For that reason, this chapter focuses on major
depression, bipolar disorder, and suicide. It is impor-
tant to note that clients with schizophrenia, sub-
stance use disorders, antisocial and borderline per-
sonality disorders, and panic disorders also are at
increased risk for suicide and suicide attempts.
NEUROCHEMICAL THEORIES
Neurochemical influences of neurotransmitters (chem-
ical messengers) focus on serotonin and norepineph-
rine as the two major biogenic amines implicated
in mood disorders. Serotonin (5-HT) has many roles
in behavior: mood, activity, aggressiveness and ir-
ritability, cognition, pain, biorhythms, and neuro-
endocrine processes (that is, growth hormone, corti-
Seasonal affective disorder sol, and prolactin levels are abnormal in depression).
Deficits of serotonin, its precursor tryptophan, or a
to delusions, hallucinations, poor insight and metabolite (5HIAA) of serotonin found in the blood
judgment, and loss of contact with reality. or cerebrospinal fluid occur in people with depres-
This medical emergency requires immediate sion. Positron emission tomography scans (Fig. 15-1)
treatment (Jones & Venis, 2001). demonstrate reduced metabolism in the prefrontal
cortex, which may promote depression (Tecott, 2000).
Norepinephrine levels may be deficient in de-
ETIOLOGY pression and increased in mania. This catecholamine
Various theories for the etiology of mood disorders energizes the body to mobilize during stress and
exist. Most recent research focuses on chemical bio- inhibits kindling. Kindling is the process by which
logic imbalances as the cause. Nevertheless psycho- seizure activity in a specific area of the brain is
social stressors and interpersonal events appear to initially stimulated by reaching a threshold of the
trigger certain physiologic and chemical changes in cumulative effects of stress, low amounts of electric
the brain, which significantly alter the balance of impulses, or chemicals such as cocaine that sensitize
neurotransmitters (Gabbard, 2000). Effective treat- nerve cells and pathways. These highly sensitized
pathways respond by no longer needing the stimulus
ment addresses both the biologic and psychosocial
to induce seizure activity, which now occurs sponta-
components of mood disorders. Thus nurses need a
neously. It is theorized that kindling may underlie
basic knowledge of both perspectives when working
the cycling of mood disorders as well as addiction.
with clients experiencing these disorders.
Anticonvulsants inhibit kindling; this may explain
their efficacy in the treatment of bipolar disorder
Biologic Theories (Akiskal, 2000).
Dysregulation of acetylcholine and dopamine
GENETIC THEORIES
also are being studied in relation to mood disorders.
Genetic studies implicate the transmission of major Cholinergic drugs alter mood, sleep, neuroendocrine
depression in first-degree relatives, who have twice function, and the electroencephalographic pattern;
15 MOOD DISORDERS AND SUICIDE 335
therefore, acetylcholine seems to be implicated in de- Freud looked at the self-depreciation of peo-
pression and mania. The neurotransmitter problem ple with depression and attributed that self-
may not be as simple as underproduction or depletion reproach to anger turned inward related to
through overuse during stress. Changes in the sensi- either a real or perceived loss. Feeling
tivity as well as the number of receptors are being eval- abandoned by this loss, people became angry
uated for their roles in mood disorders (Tecott, 2000). while both loving and hating the lost object.
Bibring believed that ones ego (or self) aspired
to be ideal (that is, good and loving, superior
NEUROENDOCRINE INFLUENCES
or strong), and that to be loved and worthy,
Hormonal fluctuations are being studied in relation one must achieve these high standards.
to depression. Mood disturbances have been docu- Depression results when, in reality, the per-
mented in people with endocrine disorders such as son was not able to achieve these ideals all
those of the thyroid, adrenal, parathyroid, and pitu- the time.
itary. Elevated glucocorticoid activity is associated Jacobson compared the state of depression to
with the stress response, and evidence of increased a situation in which the ego is a powerless,
cortisol secretion is apparent in about 40% of clients helpless child victimized by the superego,
with depression with the highest rates found among much like a powerful and sadistic mother
older clients. Postpartum hormone alterations pre- who takes delight in torturing the child.
cipitate mood disorders such as postpartum depres- Most psychoanalytical theories of mania
sion and psychosis. About 5% to 10% of people with view manic episodes as a defense against
depression have thyroid dysfunction, notably an ele- underlying depression, with the id taking
vated thyroid-stimulating hormone (TSH). This prob- over the ego and acting as an undisciplined,
lem must be corrected with thyroid treatment or treat- hedonistic being (child).
ment for the mood disorder will be affected adversely Meyer viewed depression as a reaction to a
(Thase, 2000). distressing life experience such as an event
with psychic causality.
Horney believed that children raised by
Psychodynamic Theories rejecting or unloving parents were prone
Many psychodynamic theories about the cause of to feelings of insecurity and loneliness,
mood disorders seemed to blame the victim and his making them susceptible to depression
or her family (Gabbard, 2000): and helplessness.
336 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Table 15-1
SELECTIVE SEROTONIN REUPTAKE INHIBITOR (SSRI) ANTIDEPRESSANTS
Generic (Trade) Name Side Effects Nursing Implications
cardia, decreased output, depressed contractility, and nesia, and neuroleptic malignant syndrome. It can
atrioventricular block. Because many older adults create tolerance in 1 to 3 months. It increases appetite
have concomitant health problems, cyclic antidepres- and causes weight gain and cravings for sweets.
sants are used less often in the geriatric population Maprotiline (Ludiomil) carries a risk of seizures
than newer types of antidepressants that have fewer (especially in heavy drinkers), severe constipation and
side effects and less drug interactions. urinary retention, stomatitis, and other side effects;
this leads to poor compliance. The drug is started
Tetracyclic Antidepressants. Amoxapine (Asendin) and withdrawn gradually. Central nervous system
may cause extrapyramidal symptoms, tardive dyski- depressants can increase the effects of this drug.
Table 15-2
TRICYLIC ANTIDEPRESSANT MEDICATIONS
Generic (Trade) Name Side Effects Nursing Implications
amitriptyline (Elavil) Dizziness, orthostatic hypotension, Assist client to rise slowly from sitting
tachycardia, sedation, headache, position.
tremor, blurred vision, constipation, Administer at bedtime.
dry mouth and throat, weight gain, Encourage use of sugar-free beverages
urinary hesitancy, sweating and hard candy.
Ensure adequate fluids and balanced
nutrition.
Encourage exercise.
Monitor cardiac function.
amoxapine (Asendin) Dizziness, orthostatic hypotension, Assist client to rise slowly from sitting
sedation, insomnia, constipation, position.
dry mouth and throat, rashes Administer at bedtime if client is sedated.
Ensure adequate fluids.
Encourage use of sugar-free beverages
and hard candy.
Report rashes to physician.
doxepin (Sinequan) Dizziness, orthostatic hypotension, Assist client to rise slowly from sitting
tachycardia, sedation, blurred vision, position.
constipation, dry mouth and throat, Administer at bedtime if client is sedated.
weight gain, sweating Ensure adequate fluids and balanced
nutrition.
Encourage use of sugar-free beverages
and hard candy.
Encourage exercise.
imipramine (Tofranil) Dizziness, orthostatic hypotension, Assist client to rise slowly from sitting or
weakness, fatigue, blurred vision, supine position.
constipation, dry mouth and throat, Ensure adequate fluids and balanced
weight gain nutrition.
Encourage use of sugar-free beverages
and hard candy.
Encourage exercise.
desipramine Cardiac dysrhythmias, dizziness, Monitor cardiac function.
(norpramine) orthostatic hypotension, excitement, Assist client to rise slowly from sitting
insomnia, sexual dysfunction, dry position.
mouth and throat, rashes Administer in AM if client is having
insomnia.
Encourage sugar-free beverages and
hard candy.
Report rashes or sexual difficulties to
physician.
nortriptyline Cardiac dysrhythmias, tachycardia, Monitor cardiac function.
(Pamelor) confusion, excitement, tremor, Administer in am if stimulated.
constipation, dry mouth and throat Ensure adequate fluids.
Encourage use of sugar-free beverages
and hard candy.
Report confusion to physician.
benzodiazepines (alprazolam, estazolam, and triazo- and over-the counter preparations (Table 15-4). The
lam) and the H2 blocker terfenadine. Remeron also most serious side effect is hypertensive crisis, a
inhibits the reuptake of serotonin and norepineph- life-threatening condition that can result when a
rine, has few sexual side effects, but has higher inci- client taking MAOIs ingests tyramine-containing
dence of weight gain, sedation, and anticholinergic foods and fluids or other medications. Symptoms are
side effects (Facts and Comparisons, 2002). occipital headache, hypertension, nausea, vomiting,
chills, sweating, restlessness, nuchal rigidity, dilated
MAOIs. This class of antidepressants is used infre- pupils, fever, and motor agitation. These can lead
quently because of potentially fatal side effects and to hyperpyrexia, cerebral hemorrhage, and death.
interactions with numerous drugs, both prescription The MAOI-tyramine interaction produces symp-
340 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Table 15-3
ATYPICAL ANTIDEPRESSANTS
Generic (Trade) Name Side Effects Nursing Implications
venlafaxine (Effexor) Increased blood pressure and pulse; Administer with food.
nausea; vomiting; headache; dizziness; Ensure adequate fluids.
drowsiness; dry mouth; sweating; can Give in PM.
alter many lab tests, e.g., AST, ALT, Encourage use of sugar-free beverages
alkaline phosphatase, creatinine, or hard candy.
glucose, electrolytes
bupropion (Wellbutrin) Nausea, vomiting, lowered seizure Give with food.
threshold, agitation, restlessness, Administer dose in AM.
insomnia, may alter taste, blurred Ensure balanced nutrition and exercise.
vision, weight gain, headache
nefazodone (Serzone) Headache; dizziness; drowsiness; alters Administer prior to meal (food inhibits
results of AST, ALT, LDH, cholesterol, absorption).
glucose, hematocrit Monitor liver and kidney functions.
mirtazipine (Remeron) Sedation, dizziness, dry mouth and Administer in PM.
throat, weight gain, sexual dysfunc- Encourage use of sugar-free beverages
tion, constipation and hard candy.
Ensure adequate fluids and balanced
nutrition.
Report sexual difficulties to physician.
toms within 20 to 60 minutes after ingestion. For ticularly true for older adults). In addition, preg-
hypertensive crisis, transient antihypertensive agents nant women can safely have ECT with no harm to
such as phentolamine mesylate are given to dilate the fetus. Clients who are actively suicidal may be
blood vessels and decrease vascular resistance (Facts given ECT if there is concern for their safety while
and Comparisons, 2002). waiting weeks for the full effects of antidepressant
There is a 2- to 4-week lag period before MAOIs medication.
reach therapeutic levels. Because of the lag period, ECT involves application of electrodes to the
adequate washout periods of 5 to 6 weeks are recom- head of the client to deliver an electrical impulse to
mended between the time the MAOI is discontinued the brain; this causes a seizure. It is believed that the
and another class of antidepressant is started. shock stimulates brain chemistry to correct the chem-
ical imbalance of depression. Historically clients did
not receive any anesthetic or other medication prior
OTHER MEDICAL TREATMENTS
to ECT, and they had full-blown grand mal seizures
AND PSYCHOTHERAPY
that often resulted in injuries from biting the tongue
Electroconvulsive Therapy. Psychiatrists may use to broken bones (Challiner & Griffiths, 2000). ECT
electroconvulsive therapy (ECT) to treat depres- fell into disfavor for a period and was seen as bar-
sion in select groups such as clients who do not re- baric. Today although ECT is administered in a safe
spond to antidepressants or those who experience and humane way with almost no injuries, there are
intolerable side effects at therapeutic doses (par- still critics of the treatment.
Table 15-4
MONOAMINE OXIDASE INHIBITOR (MAOI) ANTIDEPRESSANTS
Generic (Trade) Name Side Effects Nursing Implications
isocarboxazid (Marplan) Drowsiness, dry mouth, overactivity, Assist client to rise slowly from sitting
phenelzine (Nardil) insomnia, nausea, anorexia, consti- position.
tranylcypromine (Parnate) pation, urinary retention, orthostatic Administer in AM.
hypotension Administer with food.
Ensure adequate fluids.
Perform essential teaching on importance
of low tyramine diet.
15 MOOD DISORDERS AND SUICIDE 341
Table 15-5
DISTORTIONS ADDRESSED BY COGNITIVE THERAPY
Cognitive Distortion Definition
Absolute, dichotomous Tendency to view everything in polar categories, i.e., all-or-none, black-or-white
thinking
Arbitrary inference Drawing a specific conclusion without sufficient evidence, i.e., jumping to
(negative) conclusions
Specific abstraction Focusing on a single (often minor) detail while ignoring other, more significant
aspects of the experience, i.e., concentrating on one small (negative) detail
while discounting positive aspects
Overgeneralization Forming conclusions based on too little or too narrow experience, i.e., if one
experience was negative, then ALL similar experiences will be negative
Magnification and Over- or undervaluing the significance of a particular event, i.e., one small negative
minimization event is the end of the world or a positive experience is totally discounted
Personalization Tendency to self-reference external events without basis, i.e., believing that
events are directly related to ones self, whether they are or not
APPLICATION OF THE NURSING may answer some questions with I dont know be-
PROCESS: DEPRESSION cause they are simply too fatigued and overwhelmed to
think of an answer or respond in any detail. Clients
Assessment also may exhibit signs of agitation or anxiety, wringing
HISTORY their hands and having difficulty sitting still. These
clients are said to have psychomotor agitation (in-
The nurse can collect assessment data from the client creased body movements and thoughts) such as pac-
and family or significant others, previous chart in- ing, accelerated thinking, and argumentativeness.
formation, and others involved in the support or care.
It may take several short periods to complete the as-
sessment because clients who are severely depressed MOOD AND AFFECT
feel exhausted and overwhelmed. It can take time for Clients with depression may describe themselves as
them to process the question asked and to formulate hopeless, helpless, down, or anxious. They also may
a response. It is important that the nurse does not try say they are a burden on others, a failure at life, or
to rush clients because doing so will lead to frus- may make other similar statements. They are easily
tration and incomplete assessment data. frustrated, are angry at themselves, and can be angry
To assess the clients perception of the problem, at others (APA, 2000). They experience anhedonia,
the nurse asks about behavioral changes: when they losing any sense of pleasure from activities they for-
started, what was happening when they began, merly enjoyed. Clients may be apathetic, that is, not
their duration, and what the client has tried to do caring about self, activities, or much of anything.
about them. Affect is sad or depressed, or may be flat with no
Assessing the history is important to determine emotional expressions. Typically depressed clients
any previous episodes of depression, treatment, and sit alone staring into space or lost in thought. When
clients response to treatment. The nurse also asks addressed, they interact minimally with a few words
about family history of mood disorders, suicide, or or a gesture. They are overwhelmed by noise and peo-
attempted suicide. ple who might make demands on them, so they with-
draw from the stimulation of interaction with others.
GENERAL APPEARANCE
AND MOTOR BEHAVIOR THOUGHT PROCESS AND CONTENT
Many people with depression look sad; sometimes they Clients with depression experience slowed thinking
just look ill. The posture often is slouched with head processes: their thinking seems to occur in slow
down and minimal eye contact. They have psycho- motion. With severe depression, they may not re-
motor retardation (slow body movements, slow cog- spond verbally to questions. Clients tend to be nega-
nitive processing, and slow verbal interaction). Re- tive and pessimistic in their thinking, that is, they be-
sponses to questions may be minimal with only one or lieve that they will always feel this bad, things will
two words. Latency of response is seen when clients never get any better, and nothing will help. Clients
take up to 30 seconds to respond to a question. They make self-deprecating remarks, criticizing themselves
15 MOOD DISORDERS AND SUICIDE 343
harshly, and focusing only on failures or negative clients may hear degrading and belittling voices or
attributes. They tend to ruminate, which is repeat- they may even have command hallucinations that
edly going over the same thoughts. Those who expe- orders them to commit suicide.
rience psychotic symptoms have delusions; they often
believe that they are responsible for all the tragedies
and miseries in the world. JUDGMENT AND INSIGHT
Often clients with depression have thoughts of Clients with depression experience impaired judg-
dying or committing suicide. It is important to assess ment because they cannot use their cognitive abilities
suicidal ideation by asking about it directly. The nurse to solve problems or to make decisions. They often can-
may ask Are you thinking about suicide? or What not make decisions or choices because of their extreme
suicidal thoughts are you having? Most clients will apathy or their negative belief that it doesnt matter
readily admit to suicidal thinking. Suicide is discussed anyway.
in full later in this chapter. Insight may be intact, especially if clients have
been depressed previously. Others have very limited
SENSORIUM AND insight and are totally unaware of their behavior,
INTELLECTUAL PROCESSES feelings, or even their illness.
clients cannot sleep or they feel exhausted and un- outcomes for a client with the psychomotor retarda-
refreshed no matter how much time they spend in tion form of depression include the following:
bed. They lose interest in sexual activities, and men The client will not injure himself or herself.
often experience impotence. Some clients neglect per- The client will independently carry out
sonal hygiene because they lack the interest or en- activities of daily living (showering, changing
ergy. Constipation commonly results from decreased clothing, grooming).
food and fluid intake as well as inactivity. If fluid in- The client will establish a balance of rest,
take is severely limited, clients also may be dehy- sleep, and activity.
drated. The client will establish a balance of adequate
nutrition, hydration, and elimination.
The client will evaluate self-attributes
DEPRESSION RATING SCALES realistically.
Clients complete some rating scales for depression; The client will socialize with staff, peers, and
mental health professionals administer others. These family/friends.
assessment tools, along with evaluation of behavior, The client will return to occupation or school
thought processes, history, family history, and situ- activities.
ational factors, help to create a diagnostic picture. The client will comply with antidepressant
Self-rating scales of depressive symptoms include the regimen.
Zung Self-Rating Depression Scale and the Beck De- The client will verbalize symptoms of a
recurrence.
pression Inventory. Self-rating scales are used for
case-finding in the general public and may be used
over the course of treatment to determine improve- Intervention
ment from the clients perspective.
The Hamilton Rating Scale for Depression (Table PROVIDING FOR SAFETY
15-6) is a clinician-rated depression scale used like a The first priority is to determine if a client with de-
clinical interview. The clinician rates the range of pression is suicidal. If a client has suicidal ideation
the clients behaviors such as depressed mood, guilt, or hears voices commanding him or her to commit
suicide, and insomnia. There is also a section to score suicide, measures to provide a safe environment are
diurnal variations, depersonalization (sense of unreal- necessary. If the client has a suicide plan, the nurse
ity about the self), paranoid symptoms, and obsessions. asks additional questions to determine the lethality
of the intent and plan. The nurse reports this infor-
mation to the treatment team. Health care personnel
Data Analysis
follow hospital or agency policies and procedures for
The nurse analyzes assessment data to determine instituting suicide precautions (e.g., removal of
priorities and to establish a plan of care. Nursing di- harmful items, increased supervision). A thorough
agnoses commonly established for the client with discussion is presented later in the chapter.
depression include the following:
Risk for Suicide
PROMOTING A THERAPEUTIC RELATIONSHIP
Imbalanced Nutrition: Less Than Body
Requirements It is important to have meaningful contact with clients
Anxiety who have depression and to begin a therapeutic rela-
Ineffective Coping tionship regardless of the state of depression. Some
Hopelessness clients are quite open in describing their feelings of
Ineffective Role Performance sadness, hopelessness, helplessness, or agitation.
Self Care Deficit Clients may be unable to sustain a long interaction,
Chronic Low Self-Esteem so several shorter visits help the nurse to assess sta-
Disturbed Sleep Pattern tus and to establish a therapeutic relationship.
Impaired Social Interaction The nurse may find it difficult to interact with
these clients because he or she empathizes with such
sadness and depression. The nurse also may feel un-
Outcome Identification
able to do anything for clients with limited responses.
Outcomes for clients with depression relate to how the Clients with psychomotor retardation (slow speech,
depression is manifestedfor instance, whether or slow movement, slow thought processes) are very non-
not the person is slow or agitated, sleeps too much or communicative or may even be mute. The nurse can
too little, or eats too much or too little. Examples of sit with such clients for a few minutes at intervals
15 MOOD DISORDERS AND SUICIDE 345
Table 15-6
HAMILTON RATING SCALE FOR DEPRESSION
For each item select the cue which best characterizes day in activities (hospital job or hobbies) ex-
the patient. clusive of ward chores
1: Depressed Mood (Sadness, hopeless, helpless, 4 Stopped working because of present illness. In
worthless) hospital, rate 4 if patient engages in no activi-
0 Absent ties except ward chores, or if patient fails to
1 These feeling states indicated only on ques- perform ward chores unassisted
tioning 8: Retardation (Slowness of thought and speech;
2 These feeling states spontaneously reported impaired ability to concentrate; decreased motor
verbally activity)
3 Communicates feeling states nonverbally 0 Normal speech and thought
i.e., through facial expression, posture, voice, 1 Slight retardation at interview
and tendency to weep 2 Obvious retardation at interview
4 Patient reports VIRTUALLY ONLY these feeling 3 Interview difficult
states in his spontaneous verbal and nonver- 4 Complete stupor
bal communication 9: Agitation
2: Feelings of Guilt 0 None
0 Absent 1 Playing with hands, hair, etc.
1 Self-reproach, feels he has let people down 2 Hand-wringing, nail biting, hair pulling, biting
2 Ideas of guilt or rumination over past errors of lips
or sinful deeds 10: Anxiety psychic
3 Present illness is a punishment. Delusions of 0 No difficulty
guilt 1 Subjective tension and irritability
4 Hears accusatory or denunciatory voices 2 Worrying about minor matters
and/or experiences threatening visual halluci- 3 Apprehensive attitude apparent in face or
nations speech
3: Suicide 4 Fears expressed without questioning
0 Absent 11: Anxiety somatic
1 Feels life is not worth living 0 Absent Physiological concomitants
2 Wishes he were dead or any thoughts of pos- of anxiety, such as:
sible death to self 1 Mild Gastrointestinaldry mouth,
3 Suicide ideas or gesture wind, indigestion, diarrhea,
4 Attempts at suicide (any serious attempt cramps, belching
rates 4) 2 Moderate Cardiovascularpalpitations,
4: Insomnia early headaches
0 No difficulty falling asleep 3 Severe Respiratoryhyperventila-
1 Complains of occasional difficulty falling tion, sighing
asleepi.e., more than 1/4 hour 4 Incapacitating Urinary frequency
2 Complains of nightly difficulty falling asleep Sweating
5: Insomnia middle 12: Somatic symptoms gastrointestinal
0 No difficulty 0 None
1 Patient complains of being restless and dis- 1 Loss of appetite but eating without staff
turbed during the night encouragement. Heavy feelings in abdomen
2 Waking during the nightany getting out of 2 Difficulty eating without staff urging. Requests
bed rates 2 (except for purpose of voiding) or requires laxatives or medication for bowels
6: Insomnia late or medication for G.I. symptoms
0 No difficulty 13: Somatic symptoms general
1 Waking in early hours of the morning but goes 0 None
back to sleep 1 Heaviness in limbs, back or head. Backaches,
2 Unable to fall asleep again if gets out of bed headache, muscle aches. Loss of energy and
7: Work and activities fatigability
0 No difficulty 2 Any clear cut symptom rates 2
1 Thoughts and feelings of incapacity, fatigue or 14: Genital symptoms
weakness related to activities, work, or hob- 0 Absent Symptoms such as:
bies 1 Mild Loss of libido
2 Loss of interest in activity, hobbies, or work 2 Severe Menstrual disturbances
either directly reported by patient, or indirect 15: Hypochondriasis
in listlessness, indecision and vacillation (feels 0 Not present
he has to push self to work or activities) 1 Self-absorption (bodily)
3 Decrease in actual time spent in activities or 2 Preoccupation with health
decrease in productivity. In hospital, rate 3 if 3 Frequent complaints, requests for help, etc
patient does not spend at least three hours a 4 Hypochondriacal delusions
(continued )
346 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Table 15-6
(Continued )
PROMOTING ACTIVITIES OF DAILY LIVING can promote eating. Monitoring food and fluid intake
AND PHYSICAL CARE may be necessary until clients are consuming ade-
quate amounts.
The ability to perform daily activities is related to the
Promoting sleep may include the short-term use
level of psychomotor retardation. To assess ability to
of a sedative or giving medication in the evening if
perform ADLs independently, the nurse first asks
drowsiness or sedation is a side effect. It is also im-
the client to perform the global task. For example:
portant to encourage clients to remain out of bed and
Martin, its time to get dressed. (global task)
active during the day to facilitate sleeping at night. It
If a client cannot respond to the global request,
is important to monitor the number of hours clients
the nurse breaks the task into smaller segments.
sleep as well as if they feel refreshed on awakening.
Clients with depression can become overwhelmed
easily with a task that has several steps. The nurse
can use success in small, concrete steps as a basis to USING THERAPEUTIC COMMUNICATION
increase self-esteem and to build competency for a
slightly more complex task the next time. Clients with depression are often overwhelmed by
If clients cannot choose between articles of cloth- the intensity of their emotions. Talking about these
ing, the nurse selects the clothing and directs clients feelings can be beneficial. Initially the nurse encour-
to put them on. For example: Here are your gray ages clients to describe in detail how they are feeling.
slacks. Put them on. This still allows clients to par- Sharing the burden with another person can provide
ticipate in dressing. If this is what clients are capa- some relief. At these times the nurse can listen at-
ble of doing at this point, this activity will reduce de- tentively, encourage clients, and validate the inten-
pendence on staff. This request is concrete, and if sity of their experience. For example,
clients cannot do this, the nurse has information Nurse: How are you feeling today. (broad
about the level of psychomotor retardation. opening)
If a client cannot put on slacks, the nurse assists Client: I feel so awful . . . terrible.
by saying, Let me help you with your slacks, Martin. Nurse: Tell me more. What is that like for you?
The nurse helps clients to dress only when they can- (using a general lead, encouraging description)
not perform any of the above steps. This allows clients Client: I dont feel like myself. I dont know what
to do as much as possible for themselves and to avoid to do.
becoming dependent on the staff. The nurse can carry Nurse: That must be frightening. (validating)
out this same process for eating, taking a shower, It is important at this point that the nurse does
and performing routine self-care activities. not attempt to fix the clients difficulties or offer
Because abilities change over time, the nurse clichs such as Things will get better or But you
must assess them on an ongoing basis. This contin- know your family really needs you. Although the
ual assessment takes more time than simply helping nurse may have good intentions, remarks of this type
clients to dress. Nevertheless it promotes indepen- belittle the clients feelings or make the client feel
dence and provides dynamic assessment data about more guilty and worthless.
psychomotor abilities. As clients begin to improve, the nurse can help
Often clients decline to engage in activities be- them to learn or rediscover more effective coping
cause they are too fatigued or have no interest. The strategies such as talking to friends, spending leisure
nurse can validate these feelings yet still promote time to relax, taking positive steps to deal with stres-
participation. For example: I know you feel like stay- sors, and so forth. Improved coping skills may not
ing in bed, but it is time to get up for breakfast. Often prevent depression but may assist clients to deal with
clients may want to stay in bed until they feel like the effects of depression more effectively.
getting up or engaging in ADLs. The nurse can let
clients know that they must become more active to MANAGING MEDICATIONS
feel better rather than waiting passively for improve-
ment. It may be helpful to avoid asking yes-or-no The increased activity and improved mood that anti-
questions. Instead of asking Do you want to get up depressants produce can provide the energy for sui-
now? the nurse would say It is time to get up now. cidal clients to carry out the act. Thus the nurse must
Reestablishing balanced nutrition can be chal- assess suicide risk even when clients are receiving
lenging when clients have no appetite or dont feel antidepressants. It is also important to ensure that
like eating. The nurse can explain that beginning to clients ingest the medication and are not saving it in
eat will help stimulate appetite. Food offered fre- attempt to commit suicide. As clients become ready
quently and in small amounts can prevent over- for discharge, careful assessment of suicide potential
whelming clients with a large meal that they feel un- is important because they will have a supply of anti-
able to eat. Sitting quietly with clients during meals depressant medication at home. SSRIs are rarely
348 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Nursing Diagnosis
Ineffective Coping
Inability to form a valid appraisal of the stressors, inadequate choices of practiced
responses, and/or inability to use available resources
IMPLEMENTATION
Continually assess the clients potential for suicide. Depressed clients may have a potential for suicide
that may or may not be expressed and that may
change with time. You must remain aware of this
suicide potential at all times.
Observe the client closely, especially under the You must be aware of the clients activities at all
following circumstances: times when there is a potential for suicide or
self-injury:
After antidepressant medication begins to raise Risk of suicide increases as the clients energy
the clients mood level is increased by medication.
After any sudden dramatic behavioral change These changes may indicate that the client has
(sudden cheerfulness, relief, freedom from guilt, come to a decision to commit suicide.
or giving away personal belongings)
Unstructured time on the unit Risk of suicide increases when the clients time is
unstructured.
Times when the number of staff on the unit is Risk of suicide increases when observation of the
limited client decreases.
Reorient the client to person, place, and time as Repeated presentation of reality is concrete re-
indicated (call the client by name, tell the client inforcement for the client.
your name, tell the client where he or she is,
and so forth).
If the client is ruminating, tell him or her that Minimizing attention and reinforcement may
you will talk about reality or about the clients help to decrease rumination. Providing reinforce-
feelings, but limit the attention given to repeated ment for reality orientation and expression of
expressions of rumination. feelings will encourage these behaviors.
Initially assign the same staff members to work The clients ability to respond to others may be
with the client whenever possible. impaired. Initially limiting the number of new
contacts will facilitate familiarity and trust.
However, the number of people interacting with
the client should increase as soon as possible to
minimize dependency and to facilitate the clients
abilities to communicate with a variety of people.
When approaching the client, use a moderate, Being overly cheerful may indicate to the client
level tone of voice. Avoid being overly cheerful. that other feelings are not acceptablethat being
cheerful is the goal or the norm.
Use silence and active listening when interacting The client may not communicate if you are talking
with the client. Let the client know that you are too much. Your presence and use of active listen-
concerned and that you consider the client a ing will communicate your interest and concern.
worthwhile person.
When first communicating with the client, use The clients ability to perceive and respond to
simple, direct sentences; avoid complex sentences complex stimuli is impaired.
or directions.
Avoid asking the client many questions, espe- Asking questions and requiring only brief answers
cially questions that require only brief answers. may discourage the client from communicating or
taking responsibility for expressing his or her
feelings.
Be comfortable sitting with the client in silence. Your silence will convey your expectation that the
Let the client know you are available to converse, client will communicate and your acceptance of
but do not require the client to talk. the clients difficulty with communication.
Allow (and encourage) the client to cry. Stay with Crying is a healthy way of expressing feelings of
and support the client if he or she desires. Provide sadness, hopelessness, and despair. The client
privacy if the client desires and it is safe to do so. may not feel comfortable crying and may need
encouragement or privacy.
Do not cut off interactions with cheerful remarks You may be uncomfortable with certain feelings
or platitudes (e.g., No one really wants to die, the client expresses. If this is true, it is important
Of course life is worth living, or Youll feel for you to recognize this and discuss it with
better soon.). Do not belittle the clients feelings. another staff member rather than directly or
Accept the clients verbalizations of feelings as indirectly communicating your discomfort to the
real, and give support for this ventilation of feel- client. Proclaiming the clients feelings to be
ings, especially for expressions of emotions that inappropriate or wrong or otherwise belittling
may be difficult for the client to accept in himself them is detrimental.
or herself (like anger).
Encourage the client to ventilate feelings in what- Ventilation of feelings may help to relieve feelings
ever way is comfortableverbal and nonverbal. of despair, hopelessness, sadness, and so forth.
Let the client know you will listen and accept Feelings are not inherently good or bad. You must
what is being expressed. remain nonjudgmental about the clients feelings
and directly express this to the client.
Interact with the client on topics with which he or Topics that are uncomfortable for the client and
she is comfortable. Do not probe for information. probing may be threatening and initially may
discourage communication. When trust has been
established, the client may be encouraged to
discuss more difficult topics.
Teach the client about the problem-solving process: The client may be unaware of a systematic
explore possible options, examine the consequences method for solving problems. Successful use of
of each alternative, select and implement an alter- the problem-solving process facilitates the clients
native, and evaluate the results. confidence in the use of coping skills.
Provide positive feedback at each step of the Positive feedback at each step will give the client
process. If the client is not satisfied with the cho- many opportunities for success and encourage
sen alternative, assist the client to select another him or her to persist in problem-solving as well as
alternative. enhance the clients confidence. The client also
can learn to survive making a mistake.
Adapted from Schultz, J. M. & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts Manual of Psychiatric Nursing Care Plans (6th ed.). Philadelphia:
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Box 15-1
MOOD DISORDER QUESTIONNAIRE
The following questionnaire can be used as a starting point to help you recognize the I signs/symptoms of bipolar
disorder but is not meant to be a substitute for a full me??? evaluation. Bipolar disorder is complex and an accurate,
thorough diagnosis can be made through a personal evaluation by your doctor. However, a positive screening may
suggest that you might benefit from seeking such an evaluation from your doctor. Regardless of the questionnaire
results, if you or your family has concerns about your mental health, please contact your physician and/or other
healthcare professional.
When completed, your responses may be printed for further discussion with you.
Instructions: Please answer each question as best you can.
1. Has there ever been a period of time when you were not your usual self and . . . YES NO
. . . you felt so good or so hyper that other people thought you were not your nor-
mal self or you were so hyper that you got into trouble?
. . . you were so irritable that you shouted at people or started fights or arguments?
. . . you felt much more self-confident than usual?
. . . you got much less sleep than usual and found you didnt really miss it?
. . . you were much more talkative or spoke much faster than usual?
. . . thoughts raced through your head or you couldnt slow your mind down?
. . . you were so easily distracted by things around you that you had trouble concen-
trating or staying on track?
. . . you had much more energy than usual?
. . . you were much more active or did many more things than usual?
. . . you were much more social or outgoing than usual, for example, you telephoned
friends in the middle of the night?
. . . you were much more interested in sex than usual?
. . . you did things that were unusual for you or that other people might have thought
were excessive, foolish, or risky?
. . . spending money got you or your family into trouble?
2. If you checked YES to more than one of the above, have several of these ever hap-
pened during the same period of time?
3. How much of a problem did any of these cause youlike being unable to work; hav-
ing family, money or legal troubles; getting into arguments or fights? Please select one
response only.
[ ] No [ ] Minor [ ] Moderate [ ] Serious
Problem Problem Problem Problem
4. Have any of your blood relatives (children, siblings, parents, grandparents, aunts,
uncles) had manic-depressive illness or bipolar disorder?
5. Has a healthcare professional ever told you that you have manic-depressive illness
or bipolar disorder?
Hirschfeld, R. M. A., Williams, J. B., Spitzer, R. L., Calabrese, J. R., Flynn, et al. (2000). Development and Validation of a
Screening Instrument for Bipolar Spectrum Disorder: The Mood Disorder Questionnaire, American Journal of Psychiatry
157(11): 18731875.
15 MOOD DISORDERS AND SUICIDE 353
cohol abuse as well as those recently discharged from of bipolar disorder. Manic episodes typically begin
the hospital (Young, Macritchie & Calabrese, 2000). suddenly with rapid escalation of symptoms over a
Whereas a person with major depression slowly few days and they last from a few weeks to several
slides into depression that can last for 6 months to months. They tend to be briefer and to end more sud-
2 years, the person with bipolar disorder cycles be- denly than depressive episodes. Adolescents are
tween depression and normal behavior (bipolar de- more likely to have psychotic manifestations.
pressed) or mania and normal behavior (bipolar The diagnosis of a manic episode or mania re-
manic). Or he or she can run the gamut from mania quires at least 1 week of unusual and incessantly
to normal behavior to depression and back again in heightened, grandiose, or agitated mood in addition
repeated cycles (bipolar mixed episodes). A person to three or more of the following symptoms: exagger-
with bipolar mixed episodes alternates between major ated self-esteem; sleeplessness; pressured speech;
depressive and manic episodes interspersed with flight of ideas; reduced ability to filter extraneous
periods of normal behavior. Each mood may last for stimuli; distractibility; increased activities with in-
weeks or months before the pattern begins to descend creased energy; and multiple, grandiose high-risk ac-
or ascend once again. Figure 15-2 compares major tivities involving poor judgment and severe conse-
depression and bipolar disorder and shows the three quences such as spending sprees, sex with strangers,
categories of bipolar cycles. and impulsive investments (APA, 2000).
Bipolar disorder occurs almost equally among Clients often do not understand how their illness
men and women. It is more common in highly edu- affects others. They may stop taking medications be-
cated people. Pliszka, Sherman, Barrow, and Irick cause they like the euphoria and feel burdened by the
(2000) marked the 1-year prevalence rate of bipolar side effects, blood tests, and physicians visits needed
illness at close to 2% because 50% of people with to maintain treatment. Family members are con-
bipolar illness deny their mania. cerned and exhausted by their loved ones behavior;
they often stay up late at night for fear that the manic
Onset and Clinical Course person may do something impulsive and dangerous.
The mean age for a first manic episode is the early
20s, but some people experience onset in adolescence Treatment
while others start older than 50 years (APA, 2000).
PSYCHOPHARMACOLOGY
Currently debate exists about whether or not some
children diagnosed with attention deficit/hyperactiv- Treatment for bipolar disorder involves a lifetime
ity disorder (ADHD) actually have a very early onset regimen of medications: either an antimanic agent
354 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
MAJOR DEPRESSIVE DISORDER'S GRADUAL DESCENT INTO AND BACK FROM DEPRESSION
Depression (dysthymia)
Mania
Normal mood
Depression
2. Bipolar manic = cycle only alternates between mania and normal (euthymic) behavior.
Figure 15-2. Graphic depic-
3. Bipolar depressed = cycle alternates between depression and normal (euthymic) behavior. tion of mood cycles.
called lithium or anticonvulsant medications used ordered thinking as seen with delusions, hallucina-
as mood stabilizers (see Chapter 2). This is the only tions, and illusions), an antipsychotic agent is ad-
psychiatric disorder in which medications can pre- ministered in addition to the bipolar medications.
vent acute cycles of bipolar behavior. Once thought Some clients keep taking both bipolar medications
to help reduce manic behavior only, lithium and and antipsychotics.
these anticonvulsants also protect against the effects
of bipolar depressive cycles. If a client in the acute Lithium. Lithium is a salt contained in the human
stage of mania or depression exhibits psychosis (dis- body; it is similar to gold, copper, magnesium, man-
ganese, and other trace elements. Once believed to be
helpful for bipolar mania only, investigators quickly
realized that lithium also could partially or com-
pletely mute the cycling toward bipolar depression.
MAJOR SYMPTOMS OF MANIA
Response rate in acute mania to lithium therapy is
Heightened, grandiose, or agitated mood 70% to 80%. In addition to treating the range of
Exaggerated self-esteem bipolar behaviors, lithium also can stabilize bipolar
Sleeplessness disorder by reducing the degree and frequency of
Pressured speech
cycling or eliminating manic episodes (Griswold &
Flight of ideas
Reduced ability to filter out extraneous stimuli;
Pessar, 2000).
easily distractible Lithium not only competes for salt receptor sites
Increased number of activities with increased but also affects calcium, potassium, and magnesium
energy ions as well as glucose metabolism. Its mechanism
Multiple, grandiose high-risk activities, using of action is unknown, but it is thought to work in the
poor judgment with severe consequences synapses to hasten destruction of catecholamines
(dopamine, norepinephrine), inhibit neurotransmitter
15 MOOD DISORDERS AND SUICIDE 355
release, and decrease the sensitivity of postsynaptic of people with bipolar illness. These drugs are catego-
receptors (Facts and Comparisons, 2002). rized as miscellaneous anticonvulsants. Their mecha-
Lithiums action peaks in 30 minutes to 4 hours nism of action is largely unknown (Young et al., 2000)
for regular forms and 4 to 6 hours for the slow-release but they may raise the brains threshold for dealing
form. It crosses the bloodbrain barrier and placenta with stimulation; this prevents the person from being
and is distributed in sweat and breast milk. Lithium bombarded with external and internal stimuli. See
use during pregnancy is not recommended because it Table 15-7.
can lead to first-trimester developmental abnormal- Carbamazepine (Tegretol), which had been used
ities. Onset of action is 5 to 14 days; with this lag pe- for grand mal and temporal lobe epilepsy as well as
riod, antipsychotic or antidepressant agents are used trigeminal neuralgia, was the first anticonvulsant
carefully in combination with lithium to reduce symp- found to have mood-stabilizing properties but the
toms in acutely manic or acutely depressed clients. threat of agranulocytosis was of great concern. Clients
Half-life of lithium is 20 to 27 hours (Fact and Com- taking carbamazepine need to have drug serum lev-
parisons, 2002). els checked regularly to monitor for toxicity and to
determine if the drug has reached therapeutic levels,
Anticonvulsant Drugs. Lithium is effective in about which are generally 4 to 12 ug per ml (Griswold &
75% of people with bipolar illness. The rest do not Pessar, 2000). Baseline and periodic laboratory test-
respond or have difficulty taking lithium because of ing also must also be done to monitor for suppression
side effects, problems with the treatment regimen, of white blood cells.
drug interactions, or medical conditions such as renal Valproic acid (Depakote), also known as dival-
disease that contraindicate use of lithium. Several proex sodium or sodium valproate, is an anticon-
anticonvulsants traditionally used to treat seizure vulsant used for simple absence and mixed seizures,
disorders have proven helpful in stabilizing the moods migraine prophylaxis, and mania. The mechanism of
Table 15-7
ANTICONVULSANTS USED AS MOOD STABILIZERS
Generic (Trade) Name Side Effects Nursing Implications
carbamazepine (Tegretol) Dizziness, hypotension, ataxia, sedation, Assist client to rise slowly from sitting
blurred vision, leukopenia, rashes position.
Monitor gait and assist as necessary.
Report rashes to physician.
divalproex (Depakote) Ataxia, drowsiness, weakness, fatigue, Monitor gait and assist as necessary.
menstrual changes, dyspepsia, nau- Provide rest periods.
sea, vomiting, weight gain, hair loss Give with food.
Establish balanced nutrition.
gabapentin (Neurontin) Dizziness, hypotension, ataxia, coordi- Assist client to rise slowly from sitting
nation, sedation, headache, fatigue, position.
nystagmus, nausea, vomiting Provide rest periods.
Give with food.
lamotrigine (Lamictal) Dizziness, hypotension, ataxia, coordi- Assist client to rise slowly from sitting
nation, sedation, headache, weak- position.
ness, fatigue, menstrual changes, Monitor gait and assist as necessary.
sore throat, flu-like symptoms, Provide rest periods.
blurred or double vision, nausea, Monitor physical health.
vomiting, rashes Give with food.
Report rashes to physician.
topiramate (Topamax) Dizziness, hypotension, anxiety, ataxia, Assist client to rise slowly from sitting
incoordination, confusion, sedation, position.
slurred speech, tremor, weakness, Monitor gait and assist as necessary.
blurred or double vision, anorexia, Orient client.
nausea, vomiting Protect client from potential injury.
Give with food.
oxcarbazepine (Trileptal) Dizziness, fatigue, ataxia, confusion, Assist client to rise slowly from sitting
nausea, vomiting, anorexia, headache, position.
tremor, confusion, rashes Monitor gait and assist as necessary.
Give with food.
Orient client and protect from injury.
Report rashes to physician.
356 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
action is unclear. Therapeutic levels are monitored is difficult. This continual movement has many ram-
periodically to remain at 50 to 125 ug per ml, as are ifications: clients can become exhausted or injure
baseline and ongoing liver function tests including themselves.
serum ammonia levels and platelet and bleeding In the manic phase, the client may wear clothes
times (Griswold & Pessar, 2000). that reflect the elevated mood: clothing that is brightly
Gabapentin (neurontin), lamotrigine (Lamictal), colored, flamboyant, attention-getting, and perhaps
and topiramate (Topamax) are other anticonvulsants sexually suggestive. For example, a woman in the
sometimes used as mood stabilizers but less frequently manic phase may wear a lot of jewelry and hair orna-
than valproic acid. Value ranges for therapeutic levels ments or her make-up can be garish and heavy, while
are not established. a male client may wear a tight and revealing muscle
Clonazepam (Klonopin) is an anticonvulsant and shirt or go bare-chested.
a benzodiazepine (a schedule IV controlled substance) Clients experiencing a manic episode think, move,
used in simple absence and minor motor seizures, and talk fast. Pressured speech, one of the hallmark
panic disorder, and bipolar disorder. Physiologic symptoms, means unrelentingly rapid and often loud
dependence can develop with long-term use. This drug speech without pauses. Those with pressured speech
may be used in conjunction with Lithium or other interrupt and cannot listen to others. They ignore
mood stabilizers but is not used alone to manage bi- verbal and nonverbal cues indicating that others wish
polar disorder. to speak and they continue with constant intelligi-
ble or unintelligible speech, turning from one listener
PSYCHOTHERAPY to another or speaking to no one at all. If inter-
rupted, clients with mania often start over from the
Psychotherapy can be useful in the mildly depressive
beginning.
or normal portion of the bipolar cycle. It is not use-
ful during acute manic stages because the persons
attention span is brief and he or she can gain little MOOD AND AFFECT
insight during times of accelerated psychomotor activ-
ity (Bouchard, 1999). Psychotherapy combined with Mania is reflected in periods of euphoria, exuberant
medication can reduce the risk of suicide and injury, activity, grandiosity, and false sense of well-being.
provide support to the client and family, and help Projection of an all-knowing and all-powerful image
the client to accept the diagnosis and treatment plan may be an unconscious defense against underlying
(Griswold & Pessar, 2000). low self-esteem. Some clients manifest mania with
an angry, verbally aggressive tone and are sarcastic
and irritable especially when others set limits on their
APPLICATION OF THE NURSING behavior. Mood is quite labile, and periods of loud
PROCESS: BIPOLAR DISORDER laughter may alternate with episodes of tears.
The focus of this discussion will be on the client ex-
periencing a manic episode of bipolar disorder. The
THOUGHT PROCESS AND CONTENT
reader should return to the Nursing Process discussion
for Depression to examine nursing care of the client Cognitive ability or thinking is confused and jumbled
experiencing a depressed phase of bipolar disorder. with thoughts racing one after another, which is often
referred to as flight of ideas. Clients cannot con-
Assessment nect concepts and jump from one subject to another.
Circumstantiality and tangentiality also charac-
HISTORY terize thinking. At times, clients may be unable to
Taking a history with a client in the manic phase often communicate thoughts or needs in ways that others
proves difficult. The client may jump from subject understand.
to subject, which makes it difficult for the nurse to These clients start many projects at one time
follow. Obtaining data in several short sessions, as but cannot carry any to completion. There is little
well as talking to family members, may be necessary. true planning, but clients talk nonstop about plans
The nurse can obtain much information, however, by and projects to anyone and everyone, insisting on
watching and listening. the importance of accomplishing these activities.
Sometimes they try to enlist help from others in one
or more activities. They do not consider risks or per-
GENERAL APPEARANCE
sonal experience, abilities, or resources. Clients start
AND MOTOR BEHAVIOR
these activities as they occur in their thought pro-
Clients with mania experience psychomotor agita- cesses. Examples of these multiple activities are going
tion and seem to be in perpetual motion; sitting still on shopping sprees, using credit cards excessively
15 MOOD DISORDERS AND SUICIDE 357
while unemployed and broke, starting several busi- can fluctuate (labile emotions) readily between
ness ventures at once, having promiscuous sex, gam- euphoria and hostility. Clients with mania can be-
bling, taking impulsive trips, embarking on illegal come hostile to others whom they perceive as stand-
endeavors, making risky investments, talking with ing in way of desired goals. They cannot postpone or
multiple people, and speeding (APA, 2000). delay gratification. For example, a manic client tells
Some clients experience psychotic features dur- his wife, You are the most wonderful woman in the
ing mania; they express grandiose delusions involv- world. Give me $50 so I can buy you a ticket to the
ing importance, fame, privilege, and wealth. Some opera. When she refuses, he snarls and accuses her
may claim to be the President, a famous movie star, of being cheap and selfish and may even strike her.
or even God or a prophet.
PHYSIOLOGIC AND SELF-CARE
SENSORIUM AND CONSIDERATIONS
INTELLECTUAL PROCESSES
Clients with mania can go days without sleep or food
Clients may be oriented to person and place but rarely and not even realize they are hungry or tired. They
to time. Intellectual functioning, such as fund of knowl- may be on the brink of physical exhaustion but are
edge, is difficult to assess during the manic phase. unwilling to stop or unable to rest or sleep. They often
Clients may claim to have many abilities that they do ignore personal hygiene as boring when they have
not possess. Ability to concentrate or to pay attention more important things to do. Clients may throw
is grossly impaired. Again, if a client is psychotic, he away possessions or destroy valued items. They may
or she may experience hallucinations. even physically injure themselves and tend to ignore
or be unaware of health needs that can worsen.
JUDGMENT AND INSIGHT
Data Analysis
People in the manic phase are easily angered and
irritated and strike back at what they perceive as The nurse analyzes assessment data to determine
censorship by others because they impose no restric- priorities and to establish a plan of care. Nursing
tions on themselves. They are impulsive and rarely diagnoses commonly established for clients in the
think before acting or speaking, which makes their manic phase are as follows:
judgment poor. Insight is limited because they believe Risk for Other-Directed Violence
they are fine and have no problems. They blame any Risk for Injury
difficulties on others. Imbalanced Nutrition: Less Than Body
Requirements
Ineffective Coping
SELF-CONCEPT
Noncompliance
Clients with mania often have exaggerated self- Ineffective Role Performance
esteem; they believe they can accomplish anything. Self-Care Deficit
They rarely discuss their self-concept realistically. Chronic Low Self-Esteem
Nevertheless, a false sense of well-being masks dif- Disturbed Sleep Pattern
ficulties with chronic low self-esteem.
Outcome Identification
ROLES AND RELATIONSHIPS
Examples of outcomes appropriate to mania are as
Clients in the manic phase rarely can fulfill role re- follows:
sponsibilities. They have trouble at work or school The client will not injure self or others.
(if they are even attending) and are too distracted The client will establish a balance of rest,
and hyperactive to pay attention to children or ADLs. sleep, and activity.
While they may begin many tasks or projects, they The client will establish adequate nutrition,
complete few. hydration, and elimination.
These clients have a great need to socialize but The client will participate in self-care
little understanding of their excessive, overpowering, activities.
and confrontational social interactions. Their need The client will evaluate personal qualities
for socialization often leads to promiscuity. Clients realistically.
invade the intimate space and personal business of The client will engage in socially appropriate,
others. Arguments result when others feel threatened reality-based interaction.
by such boundary invasions. Although the usual mood The client will verbalize knowledge of his or
of manic people is elation, emotions are unstable and her illness and treatment.
358 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
patiently and frequently repeats this request dur- in unprotected sex with virtual strangers. Clients
ing conversation because clients will return to rapid may ask staff members or other clients (of the same
speech. or opposite sex) for sex, graphically describe sexual
Clients in the manic phase often use pronouns acts, or display their genitals. The nurse handles such
when referring to people, making it difficult for lis- behavior in a matter-of-fact, nonjudgmental manner.
teners to understand who is being discussed and when For example, Mary, lets go to your room and find a
the conversation has moved to a new subject. While sweater. It is important to treat clients with dignity
clients are agitatedly talking, they usually are think- and respect despite their inappropriate behavior. It is
ing and moving just as quickly, so it is a challenge for not helpful to scold or chastise them. They are not
the nurse to follow a coherent story. The nurse can children engaging in willful misbehavior.
ask clients to identify each person, place, or thing being In the manic phase, clients cannot understand
discussed. personal boundaries, so it is the staffs role to keep
When speech includes flight of ideas, the nurse clients in view for intervention as necessary. For ex-
can ask clients to explain the relationship between ample, a staff member who sees a client invading the
topicsfor example, What happened then? or Was intimate space of others can say, Jeffrey, Id appreci-
that before of after you got married? The nurse also ate your help in setting up a circle of chairs in the group
assesses and documents the coherence of messages. therapy room. This large motor activity distracts
Clients with pressured speech rarely let others Jeffrey from his inappropriate behavior, appeals to
speak. Instead, they talk nonstop until they run out his need for heightened physical activity, is non-
of steam or just stand there looking at the other per- competitive, and is socially acceptable. The staffs vig-
son before moving away. Those with pressured speech ilant redirection to a more socially appropriate activ-
do not respond to others verbal or nonverbal sig- ity protects clients from the hazards of unprotected
nals that indicate a desire to speak. The nurse avoids sex and reduces embarrassment over such behaviors
becoming involved in power struggles over who will when they return to normal behavior.
dominate the conversation. Instead, the nurse may
talk to clients away from others, so there is no com-
MANAGING MEDICATIONS
petition for the nurses attention. The nurse also sets
limits regarding taking turns speaking and listening, Lithium is not metabolized; rather, it is reabsorbed by
and giving attention to others when they need it. the proximal tubule and excreted in the urine. Peri-
Clients with mania cannot have all requests granted odic serum lithium levels are used to monitor the
immediately even though that may be their desire. clients safety and to ensure that the dose given has
increased the serum lithium level to a treatment level
or reduced it to a maintenance level. There is a nar-
PROMOTING APPROPRIATE BEHAVIORS
row range of safety among maintenance levels (0.5 to
These clients need to be protected from their pursuit 1 mEq /L), treatment levels (0.8 to 1.5 mEq /L), and
of socially unacceptable and risky behaviors. The toxic levels (1.5 mEq/L and above). It is important to
nurse can direct their need for movement into socially assess for signs of toxicity and ensure that clients
acceptable large motor activities such as arranging and their families have this information prior to dis-
chairs for a community meeting or walking. In acute charge. (See Table 15-8.) Older adults can have symp-
mania, clients lose the ability to control their behav- toms of toxicity at lower serum levels. Lithium is
ior and engage in risky activities. Because acutely potentially fatal in overdose.
manic clients feel extraordinarily powerful, they place Clients should drink adequate water (approxi-
few restrictions on themselves. They act out impul- mately 2 liters per day) and continue with the usual
sive thoughts, have inflated and grandiose percep- amount of dietary table salt. Having too much salt in
tions of their abilities, are demanding, and need im- the diet because of unusually salty foods or the in-
mediate gratification. This can affect their physical, gestion of salt-containing antacids can reduce recep-
social, occupational, or financial safety as well as that tor availability for lithium and increase lithium ex-
of others. Clients may make purchases that exceed cretion, so the lithium level will be too low. If there is
their ability to pay. They may give away money or too much water, lithium is diluted and the lithium
jewelry or other possessions. The nurse may need to level will be too low to be therapeutic. Drinking too
monitor a clients access to such items until his or her little water or losing fluid through excessive sweat-
behavior is less impulsive. ing, vomiting, or diarrhea will increase the lithium
In an acute manic episode, clients also may lose level, which may result in toxicity. Monitoring daily
sexual inhibitions resulting in provocative and risky weights and the balance between intake and output
behaviors. Clothing may be flashy or revealing, or and checking for dependent edema can be helpful in
clients may undress in public areas. They may engage monitoring fluid balance. The physician should be
360 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Table 15-8
SYMPTOMS AND INTERVENTIONS OF LITHIUM TOXICITY
Serum Lithium Level Symptoms of Lithium Toxicity Interventions
1.52 mEq/L Nausea and vomiting, diarrhea, reduced Withhold next dose; call physician. Serum
coordination, drowsiness, slurred lithium levels are ordered and doses of
speech, muscle weakness lithium are usually suspended for a few
days or the dose is reduced.
23 mEq/L Ataxia, agitation, blurred vision, tinnitus, Withhold future doses, call physician, stat
giddiness, choreoathetoid movements, serum lithium level. Gastric lavage may
confusion, muscle fasciculation, hyper- be used to remove oral lithium; IV con-
reflexia, hypertonic muscles, myoclonic taining saline and electrolytes used to
twitches, pruritus, maculopapular rash, ensure fluid and electrolyte function
movement of limbs, slurred speech, and maintain renal function.
large output of dilute urine, incontinence
of bladder of bowel, vertigo
3.0 and above Cardiac arrhythmia, hypotension, pe- All of preceding interventions plus lithium
ripheral vascular collapse, focal or ion excretion is augmented with use of
generalized seizures, reduced levels of aminophylline, mannitol, or urea. He-
consciousness from stupor to coma, modialysis may also be used to remove
myoclonic jerks of muscle groups, and lithium from the body. Respiratory, cir-
spasticity of muscles culatory, thyroid, and immune systems
are monitored and assisted as needed.
contacted if the client has diarrhea, fever, flu, or any is that they cannot complete any. They move readily
condition that leads to dehydration. between these goals while sometimes obsessing about
Thyroid function tests usually are ordered as a the importance of one over another, but the goals can
baseline and every 6 months during treatment with quickly change. Clients may invest in a business in
lithium. In 6 to 18 months, one-third of clients taking which they have no knowledge or experience, go on
lithium have an increased level of thyroid-stimulating spending sprees, impulsively travel, speed, make new
hormone, which can cause anxiety, labile emotions, best friends, and take the center of attention in any
and sleeping difficulty. Decreased levels are impli- group. They are egocentric and have little concern
cated in fatigue and depression. for others except as listeners, sexual partners, or the
Because most lithium is excreted in the urine, means to achieve one of their poorly conceived goals.
baseline and periodic assessments of renal status are Education about the cause of bipolar disorder,
necessary to assess renal function. The reduced renal medication management, ways to deal with behav-
function in older adults necessitates lower doses. iors, and potential problems that manic people can
Lithium is contraindicated in people with compro- encounter is important for family members. Educa-
mised renal function or urinary retention and those tion reduces the guilt, blame, and shame that accom-
taking low-salt diets or diuretics. Lithium also is con- pany mental illness, increases client safety, enlarges
traindicated in people with brain or cardiovascular the support system for clients and the family mem-
damage. bers, and promotes compliance. Education takes the
mystery out of treatment for mental illness by pro-
viding a proactive view: this is what we know, this is
PROVIDING CLIENT AND FAMILY TEACHING
what can be done, and this is what you can do to help.
Educating clients about the dangers of risky behav- Family members often say they know clients have
ior is necessary; however, clients with acute mania stopped taking their medication when, for example,
largely fail to heed such teaching because they have clients become more argumentative, talk about buying
little patience or capacity to listen, understand, and expensive items that they cannot afford, hotly deny
see the relevance of this information. Clients with anything is wrong, or demonstrate any other signs of
euphoria may not see why the behavior is a problem escalating mania. People sometimes need permission
because they believe they can do anything without to act on their observations, so a family education ses-
impunity. As they begin to cycle toward normalcy, sion is an appropriate place to give this permission and
however, risky behavior lessens and clients become to set up interventions for various behaviors.
ready and able for teaching. Clients should learn to adhere to the established
Manic clients start many tasks, create many dosage of lithium and not to omit doses or change
goals, and try to carry them out all at once. The result dosage intervals; unprescribed dosage alterations
15 MOOD DISORDERS AND SUICIDE 361
interfere with maintenance of serum lithium levels. In the United States, men commit approximately 72%
Clients should know about the many drugs that in- of suicides, which is roughly 3 times the rate of women
teract with lithium and should tell each physician although women are 4 times more likely than men to
they consult that they are taking lithium. When a attempt suicide. The higher suicide rates for men are
client taking lithium seems to have increased manic partly the result of the method chosen (e.g., shooting,
behavior, lithium levels should be checked to deter- hanging, jumping from a high place). Women are more
mine if there is lithium toxicity. Periodic monitoring likely to overdose on medication. Men, young women,
of serum lithium levels is necessary to ensure the Caucasians, and separated and divorced people are at
safety and adequacy of the treatment regimen. Per- increased risk for suicide. Adults older than 65 years
sistent thirst and dilute urine can indicate the need compose 10% of the population but account for 25% of
to call a physician and have the serum lithium level suicides. Suicide is the second leading cause of death
checked to see if the dosage needs to be reduced. (after accidents) among people 15 to 24 years of age,
Clients and family members should know the and the rate of suicide is increasing most rapidly in
symptoms of lithium toxicity and interventions to this age group (Kuszmar et al., 2001).
take including backup plans if the physician is not Clients with psychiatric disorders especially de-
immediately available. The nurse should give these pression, bipolar disorder, schizophrenia, substance
in writing and explain them to clients and family. abuse, post-traumatic stress disorder, and borderline
personality disorder are at increased risk for suicide.
Chronic medical illnesses associated with increased
Evaluation risk of suicide include cancer, HIV/AIDS, diabetes,
Evaluation of the treatment of bipolar disorder in- CVAs, and head and spinal cord injury. Environmen-
cludes but is not limited to the following: tal factors that increase suicide risk include isolation,
Safety issues recent loss, lack of social support, unemployment, crit-
Comparison of mood and affect between start ical life events, and family history of depression or sui-
of treatment and present cide. Behavioral factors that increase risk include im-
Adherence to treatment regimen of medication pulsivity, erratic or unexplained changes from usual
and psychotherapy behavior, and unstable lifestyle (Kuszmar et al., 2001).
Changes in clients perception of quality of life Suicidal ideation means thinking about killing
Achievement of specific goals of treatment oneself. Active suicidal ideation is when a person
including new coping methods thinks about and seeks ways to commit suicide. Pas-
sive suicidal ideation is when a person thinks about
wanting to die or wishes he or she were dead but has
SUICIDE
no plans to cause his or her death. People with ac-
Suicide is the intentional act of killing oneself. Sui- tive suicidal ideation are considered more poten-
cidal thoughts are common in people with mood dis- tially lethal.
orders, especially depression. Each year more than Attempted suicide is a suicidal act that either
30,000 suicides are reported in the United States; sui- failed or was incomplete. In an incomplete suicide
cide attempts are estimated to be 8 to 10 times higher. attempt, the person did not finish the act because 1)
someone recognized the suicide attempt as a cry for
help and responded or 2) the person was discovered
and rescued (Roy, 2000).
CLIENT AND FAMILY TEACHING Suicide involves ambivalence. Many fatal acci-
dents may be impulsive suicides. It is impossible to
FOR THE CLIENT WITH MANIA know, for example, if the person who drove into a
Teach about bipolar illness and ways to manage telephone pole did this intentionally. Hence keeping
the disorder. accurate statistics on suicide is difficult. There are
Teach about medication management includ- also many myths and misconceptions about suicide
ing the need for periodic blood work and of which the nurse should be aware. The nurse must
management of side effects.
know the facts and warning signs for those at risk for
For clients taking Lithium, teach about the need
suicide as described in Box 15-2.
for adequate salt and fluid intake and seeking
medical care for vomiting and diarrhea.
Educate the client and family about risk-taking Assessment
behavior.
Teach about behavioral signs of relapse and how A history of previous suicide attempts increases risk
to seek treatment in early stages. for suicide. The first 2 years after an attempt rep-
resent the highest risk period, especially the first
362 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Box 15-2
MYTHS AND FACTS ABOUT SUICIDE
MYTHS FACTS
People who talk about suicide never Suicidal people often send out subtle or not-so-subtle messages that
commit suicide. convey their inner thoughts of hopelessness and self-destruction. Both
subtle and direct messages of suicide should be taken seriously with
appropriate assessments and interventions.
Suicidal people only want to hurt While the self-violence of suicide demonstrates anger turned inward, the
themselves, not others. anger can be directed toward others in a planned or impulsive action.
Physical harm: Psychotic people may be responding to inner voices
that command the individual to kill others before killing the self. A de-
pressed person who has decided to commit suicide with a gun may
impulsively shoot the person who tries to grab the gun in an effort to
thwart the suicide.
Emotional harm: Often family members, friends, health care profes-
sionals, and even police involved in trying to avert a suicide or those
who did not realize the persons depression and plans to commit sui-
cide feel intense guilt and shame because of their failure to help and
are stuck in a never-ending cycle of despair and grief. Some people,
depressed after the suicide of a loved one, will rationalize that suicide
was a good way out of the pain and plan their own suicide to
escape pain. Some suicides are planned to engender guilt and pain in
survivors; for example, as someone who wants to punish another for
rejecting or not returning love.
There is no way to help someone Suicidal people have mixed feelings (ambivalence) about their wish to
who wants to kill himself or herself. die, wish to kill others, or to be killed. This ambivalence often prompts
the cries for help evident in overt or covert cues. Intervention can help
the suicidal individual get help from situational supports, choose to live,
learn new ways to cope, and move forward in life.
Do not mention the word suicide to a Suicidal people have already thought of the idea of suicide and may
person you suspect to be suicidal, have begun plans. Asking about suicide does not cause a non-suicidal
because this could give him or her person to become suicidal.
the idea to commit suicide.
Ignoring verbal threats of suicide or Suicidal gestures are a potentially lethal way to act out. Threats should
challenging a person to carry out his not be ignored or dismissed nor should a person be challenged to carry
or her suicide plans will reduce the out suicidal threats. All plans, threats, gestures or cues should be taken
individuals use of these behaviors. seriously and immediate help given that focuses on the problem about
which the person is suicidal.
When asked about suicide, it is often a relief for the client to know that
his or her cries for help have been heard and that help is on the way.
Once a suicide risk, always a suicide While it is true that most people who successfully commit suicide have
risk. made attempts at least once before, the majority of people with suicidal
ideation can have positive resolution to the suicidal crisis. With proper
support, finding new ways to resolve the problem helps these individu-
als become emotionally secure and have no further need for suicide as a
way to resolve a problem.
15 MOOD DISORDERS AND SUICIDE 363
3 months. Those with a relative who committed sui- also standard practice to inquire about suicide or
cide are at increased risk for suicide: the closer the self-harm thoughts in any setting where people seek
relationship, the greater the risk. One possible ex- treatment for emotional problems.
planation is that the relatives suicide offers a sense
of permission or acceptance of suicide as a method RISKY BEHAVIORS
of escaping a difficult situation. This familiarity and
acceptance also is believed to contribute to copycat A few people who commit suicide give no warning
suicides by teenagers, who are greatly influenced by signs. Some artfully hide their distress and suicide
their peers actions (Roy, 2000). plans. Others act impulsively by taking advantage of
Many people with depression who have suicidal a situation to carry out the desire to die. Some suici-
ideation lack the energy to implement suicide plans. dal people in treatment describe placing themselves
The natural energy that accompanies increased sun- in risky or dangerous situations such as speeding in a
light in spring is believed to explain why most sui- blinding rainstorm or when intoxicated. This Russian
cides occur in April. Most suicides happen on Monday roulette approach carries a high risk of harm to both
mornings, when most people return to work (another clients and innocent bystanders. It allows clients to feel
energy spurt). Research has shown that antidepres- brave by repeatedly confronting death and surviving.
sant treatment actually can give clients with depres-
sion the energy to act on suicidal ideation (Roy, 2000). LETHALITY ASSESSMENT
When a client admits to having a death wish or sui-
WARNINGS OF SUICIDAL INTENT
cidal thoughts, the next step is to determine poten-
Most people with suicidal ideation send either direct tial lethality. This assessment involves asking the
or indirect signals to others about their intent to following questions:
harm themselves. The nurse never ignores any hint Does the client have a plan? If so, what is it?
of suicidal ideation regardless of how trivial or subtle Is the plan specific?
it seems and the clients intent or emotional status. Are the means available to carry out this
Often people contemplating suicide have ambivalent plan? (For example, if the person plans to
and conflicting feelings about their desire to die; they shoot himself, does he have access to a gun
frequently reach out to others for help. For example, and ammunition?)
a client might say, I keep thinking about taking my If the client carries out the plan, is it likely
entire supply of medications to end it all (direct) or to be lethal? (For example, a plan to take
I just cant take it anymore (indirect). Box 15-3 pro- 10 aspirin is not lethal; a plan to take a
vides more examples of client statements about sui- 2-week supply of a tricyclic antidepressant is.)
cide and effective responses from the nurse. Has the client made preparations for death
Asking clients directly about thoughts of suicide such as giving away prized possessions,
is important. Psychiatric admission assessment in- writing a suicide note, or talking to friends
terview forms routinely include such questions. It is one last time?
Where and when does the client intend to
carry out the plan?
DRUG ALERT Is the intended time a special date or anniver-
sary that has meaning for the client?
ANTIDEPRESSANTS AND SUICIDE RISK
Specific and positive answers to these questions all
Depressed clients who begin taking an anti- increase the clients likelihood of committing suicide.
depressant may have a continued or increased It is important to consider whether or not the client
risk for suicide in the first few weeks of therapy. believes her or his method is lethal even if it is not.
They may experience an increase in energy from Believing a method to be lethal poses a significant risk.
the antidepressant but remain depressed. This
increase in energy may make clients more likely
Outcome Identification
to act on suicidal ideas and able to carry them out.
Also, because antidepressants take several weeks Suicide prevention usually involves treating the un-
to reach their peak effect, clients may become dis- derlying disorder, such as mood disorder or psychosis,
couraged and act on suicidal ideas because they with psychoactive agents. The overall goals are first
believe the medication is not helping them. For to keep the client safe and later to help him or her to
these reasons, it is extremely important to moni- develop new coping skills that do not involve self-harm.
tor the suicidal ideation of depressed clients until Other outcomes may relate to ADLs, sleep and nour-
the risk has subsided. ishment needs, and problems specific to the crisis such
as stabilization of psychiatric illness/symptoms.
364 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Box 15-3
SUICIDAL IDEATION: CLIENT STATEMENTS AND NURSE RESPONSES
CLIENT STATEMENT NURSE RESPONSES
I just want to go to sleep and not think Specifically just how are you planning to sleep and not think
anymore. anymore?
By sleep, do you mean die?
What is it you do not want to think of anymore?
I want it to be all over. I wonder if you are thinking of suicide.
What is it you specifically want to be over?
It will just be the end of the story. Are you planning to end your life?
How do you plan to end your story?
You have been a good friend. You sound as if you are saying good-bye. Are you?
Remember me. Are you planning to commit suicide?
What is it you really want me to remember about you?
Here is my chess set that you have always What is going on that you are giving away things to remember
admired. you by?
If there is ever any need for anyone to I appreciate your trust. However, I think there is an important
know this, my will and insurance papers message you are giving me. Are you thinking of ending
are in the top drawer of my dresser. your life?
I cant stand the pain anymore. How do you plan to end the pain?
Tell me about the pain.
Sounds like you are planning to harm yourself.
Everyone will feel bad soon. Who is the person you want to feel bad by killing yourself?
I just cant bear it anymore. What is it you cannot bear?
How do you see an end to this?
Everyone would be better off without me. Who is one person you believe would be better off without
you?
How do you plan to eliminate yourself, if you think everyone
would be better off without you?
What is one way you perceive others would be better off
without you?
Nonverbal change in behavior from agitated You seem different today. What is this about?
to calm, anxious to relaxed, depressed to I sense you have reached a decision. Share it with me.
smiling, hostile to benign, from being
without direction to appearing to be
goal-directed
Examples of outcomes for a suicidal person in- an authoritative role to help clients stay safe. In this
clude the following: crisis situation, clients see few or no alternatives to
The client will be safe from harming self or resolve their problems. The nurse lets clients know
others. that their safety is the primary concern and will take
The client will engage in a therapeutic precedence over other needs or wishes. For example,
relationship. a client may want to be alone in her room to think
The client will establish a no-suicide contract. privately. This will not be allowed while she is at in-
The client will create a list of positive creased risk for suicide.
attributes.
The client will generate, test, and evaluate
realistic plans to address underlying issues. PROVIDING A SAFE ENVIRONMENT
Inpatient hospital units have policies for general
Intervention environmental safety. Some policies are more liberal
than others, but all usually deny clients access to
USING AN AUTHORITATIVE ROLE
materials on cleaning carts, their own medications,
Intervention for suicide or suicidal ideation becomes sharp scissors, and penknives. For suicidal clients,
the first priority of nursing care. The nurse assumes staff members remove any item that they can use to
15 MOOD DISORDERS AND SUICIDE 365
commit suicide such as sharp objects, shoelaces, belts, contracts are not, however, a guarantee of safety.
lighters, matches, pencils, pens, and even clothing Clients make contracts with input from nurses or
with drawstrings. other health care professionals. Contracts also can
Institutional policies for suicide precautions again specify when clients will be re-evaluated. The litera-
vary, but usually staff members observe clients every ture is divided on the effectiveness of such contracts
10 minutes if lethality is low. For clients with high or agreements (Potter & Dawson, 2001; Miller, Jacobs
potential lethality, one-to-one supervision by a staff & Gutheil, 1998). At no time should a nurse assume
person is initiated. This means that clients are in di- that a client is safe just because a contract is in place.
rect sight of and no more than 2 to 3 feet away from
a staff member for all activities including going to the
bathroom. Clients are under constant staff observa- CREATING A SUPPORT SYSTEM LIST
tion with no exceptions. This may be frustrating or Suicidal clients often lack social support systems such
upsetting to clients, so staff members may need to ex- as relatives, friends, or religious, occupational, and
plain the purpose of such supervision usually more community support groups. This lack may result from
than once. social withdrawal, behavior associated with a psy-
chiatric or medical disorder, or movement of the per-
INITIATING A NO-SUICIDE CONTRACT son to a new area because of school, work, change in
family structure or financial status. The nurse as-
The nurse can implement a no-suicide contract at
sesses support systems and the type of help each per-
home as well as in the inpatient treatment setting.
son or group can give a client. Mental health clinics,
In such contracts, clients agree to keep themselves
hotlines, psychiatric emergency evaluation services,
safe and to notify staff at the first impulse to harm
student health services, church groups, and self-help
themselves (at home, clients agree to notify their care-
groups are part of the community support system.
givers; the contract must identify backup people in
The nurse makes a list of specific names and agen-
case caregivers are unavailable). The urge to commit
cies that clients can call for support; he or she obtains
suicide may return suddenly, so someone must always
be available for support. A list of support people who client consent to avoid breach of confidentiality. Many
agree to be readily available should be generated. suicidal people do not have to be admitted to a hos-
Most suicidal people adhere to no-suicide con- pital and can be treated successfully in the community
tracts because they appeal to the will to live. These with the help of these support people and agencies.
Family Response
Suicide is the ultimate rejection of family and friends.
Implicit in the act of suicide is the message to others
that their help was incompetent, irrelevant, or un-
welcome. Some suicides are done to place blame on a
certain personeven to the point of planning how
that person will be the one to discover the body. Most
suicides are efforts to escape untenable situations.
Even if a person believes love for family members
prompted his or her suicideas in the case of some-
one who commits suicide to avoid lengthy legal bat-
tles or to save the family the financial and emotional
cost of a lingering deathrelatives still grieve and
may feel guilt, shame, and anger.
Significant others may feel guilty for not know-
ing how desperate the suicidal person was, angry
because the person did not seek their help or trust
them, ashamed that their loved one ended his or her
life with a socially unacceptable act, and sad about
being rejected. Suicide is newsworthy, and there may
be whispered gossip and even news coverage. Life in-
surance companies may not pay survivors benefits to
families of those who kill themselves. Also the one
death may spark copycat suicides among family
No-suicide contract members or others, who may feel they have been
366 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
given permission to do the same. Families can dis- It is not the nurses role to decide how long these clients
integrate after a suicide. must suffer. It is the nurses role to provide support-
ive care for clients and family as they work through
the difficult emotional decisions about if and when
Nurses Response these clients should be allowed to die; people who
When dealing with a client who has suicidal ideation have been declared legally dead can be disconnected
or attempts, the nurses attitude must indicate un- from life support. Each state has defined legal death
conditional positive regard not for the act but for the and the ways to determine it.
person and his or her desperation. The ideas or at-
tempts are serious signals of a desperate emotional
COMMUNITY-BASED CARE
state. The nurse must convey the belief that the per-
son can be helped and can grow and change. Nurses in any area of practice in the community fre-
Trying to make clients feel guilty for thinking of quently are the first health care professionals to rec-
or attempting suicide is not helpful; they already feel ognize behaviors consistent with mood disorders. In
incompetent, hopeless, and helpless. The nurse does some cases, a family member may mention distress
not blame clients or act judgmentally when asking about a clients withdrawal from activities; difficulty
about the details of a planned suicide. Rather, the thinking, eating, and sleeping; complaints of being
nurse uses a nonjudgmental tone of voice and moni- tired all the time; sadness; and agitation (all symp-
tors his or her body language and facial expressions toms of depression), or of cycles of euphoria, spend-
to make sure not to convey disgust or blame. ing binges, loss of inhibitions, changes in sleep and
Nurses believe that one person can make a dif- eating patterns, and loud clothing styles and colors
ference in anothers life. They must convey this belief (all symptoms of the manic phase of bipolar disorder).
when caring for suicidal people. Nevertheless nurses Documenting and reporting these behaviors can
also must realize that no matter how competent and help these people to receive treatment. Estimates
caring interventions are, a few clients will still com- are that nearly 40% of people who have been diag-
mit suicide. A clients suicide can be devastating to nosed with a mood disorder do not receive treatment
the staff members who treated him or her especially (Akiskal, 2000). Contributing factors may include
if they have gotten to know the person and his or her the stigma still associated with mental disorders,
family well over time. Even with therapy, staff mem- the lack of understanding about the disruption to
bers may end up leaving the health care facility or life that mood disorders can cause, confusion about
the profession as a result. treatment choices, or a more compelling medical di-
agnosis; these combine with the reality of limited
time that health care professionals devote to any
Legal and Ethical Considerations one client.
Assisted suicide is a topic of national legal and ethi- People with depression can be treated success-
cal debate with much attention focusing on the court fully in the community by psychiatrists, psychiatric
decisions related to the actions of Dr. Jack Kevorkian, advanced practice nurses, and primary care physi-
a physician who has participated in numerous as- cians. People with bipolar disorder, however, should
sisted suicides. Oregon was the first state to adopt be referred to a psychiatrist or psychiatric advanced
assisted suicide into law and has set up safeguards to practice nurse for treatment. The physician or nurse
prevent indiscriminate assisted suicide. Many people who treats a person with bipolar disorder must un-
believe it should be legal in any state for health care derstand the drug treatment, dosages, desired ef-
professionals or family to assist those who are ter- fects, therapeutic levels, and potential side effects so
minally ill and want to die. Others view suicide as that he or she can answer questions and promote
against the laws of humanity and religion and believe compliance with treatment (Bouchard, 1999).
that health care professionals should be prosecuted
if they assist those trying to die. Groups such as the
Hemlock Society and people such as Dr. Kevorkian
MENTAL HEALTH PROMOTION
are lobbying for changes in laws that would allow Several studies have been conducted to determine
health care professionals and family members to as- how to prevent mood disorders and suicide. Adams
sist with suicide attempts for the terminally ill. Con- (2000) describes a program called Insight that uses
troversy and emotion continue to surround the issue. an educational approach designed to address the
Often nurses must care for terminally or chron- unique stressors that contribute to the increased in-
ically ill people with a poor quality of life such as those cidence of depressive illness in women. Insight has
with the intractable pain of terminal cancer or severe succeeded in increasing self-esteem and reducing
disability or those kept alive by life-support systems. loneliness and hopelessness, which in turn decrease
15 MOOD DISORDERS AND SUICIDE 367
the likelihood of depression. Researchers in England nurse to provide limits and redirection in a calm
have found that individualized postpartum care with manner until the client can control his or her own
home visits by nurses significantly lowered the inci- behavior independently.
dence of postpartum depression (Boyles, 2002). Some health care professionals consider suicidal
Borowsky, Ireland and Resnick (2001) studied people to be failures, immoral, or unworthy of care.
more than 13,000 adolescents in an attempt to iden- These negative attitudes may result from several fac-
tify factors that predicted future suicide attempts. tors. They may reflect societys negative view of sui-
They suggest that promotion of protective factors cide: many states still have laws against suicide al-
(those factors associated with a reduction in suicide though they rarely enforce these laws. Health care
risk) would improve the mental health of adoles- professionals may feel inadequate and anxious deal-
cents. The protective factors include close parent- ing with suicidal clients, or they may be uncomfort-
child relationships, academic achievement, family life able about their own mortality. Many people have
stability, and connectedness with peers and others had thoughts about ending it all, even if for a fleet-
outside the family. Likewise, screening for early de- ing moment when life is not going well. The scariness
tection of risk factors, such as family strife, parental of remembering such flirtations with suicide causes
alcoholism or mental illness, history of fighting, and anxiety. If this anxiety is not resolved, the staff per-
access to weapons in the home, can lead to referral and son can demonstrate avoidance, demeaning behav-
early intervention. ior, and superiority to suicidal clients. Therefore, to
be effective the nurse must be aware of his or her own
feelings and beliefs about suicide.
SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES
Nurses working with clients who are Points to Consider When Working
depressed often empathize with them and begin also With Clients With Mood Disorders
to feel sad or agitated. They may unconsciously start
Remember that clients with mania may
to avoid contact with these clients to escape such
seem happy, but they are suffering inside.
feelings. The nurse must monitor his or her feelings
For clients with mania, delay client teaching
and reactions closely when dealing with clients with
until the acute manic phase is resolving.
depression to make sure he or she fulfills the re-
Schedule specific short periods with depressed
sponsibility to establish a therapeutic nurseclient
or agitated clients to eliminate unconscious
relationship.
avoidance of them.
People with depression are usually negative, pes-
Do not try to fix a clients problems. Use
simistic, and unable to generate new ideas easily. They
therapeutic techniques to help him or her
feel hopeless and incompetent. The nurse easily can find solutions.
become consumed with suggesting ways to fix the prob- Use a journal to deal with frustration, anger,
lems. Most clients find some reason why the nurses or personal needs.
solutions will not work: I have tried that, It would If a particular clients care is troubling, talk
never work, I dont have the time to do that, or You with another professional about the plan of
just dont understand. Rejection of suggestions can care, how it is being carried out, and how it
make the nurse feel incompetent and question his or is working.
her professional skill. Unless a client is suicidal or is
experiencing a crisis, the nurse does not try to solve
the clients problems. Instead, the nurse uses thera- KEY POINTS
peutic techniques to encourage clients to generate Studies have found a genetic component to
their own solutions. Studies have shown that clients mood disorders. The incidence of depression
tend to act on plans or solutions they generate rather is up to three times greater in first-degree
than those that others offer (Schultz & Videbeck, relatives of people with diagnosed depres-
2002). Finding and acting on their own solutions gives sion. People with bipolar disorder usually
clients renewed competence and self-worth. have a blood relative with bipolar disorder.
Working with clients who are manic can be ex- Only 9% of people with mood disorders ex-
hausting. They are so hyperactive that the nurse may hibit psychosis.
feel spent or tired after caring for them. The nurse Major depression is a mood disorder that
may feel frustrated because these clients engage in robs the person of joy, self-esteem, and
the same behaviors repeatedly, such as intrusiveness energy. It interferes with relationships and
with others, undressing, singing, rhyming, and danc- occupational productivity.
ing. It takes hard work to remain patient and calm Symptoms of depression include sadness, dis-
with the manic client, but it is essential for the interest in previously pleasurable activities,
368 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
crying, lack of motivation, asocial behavior, hibitors are used least: clients are at risk for
and psychomotor retardation (slowed think- hypertensive crisis if they ingest tyramine-
ing, talking, and movement). Sleep distur- rich foods and fluids while taking these drugs.
bances, somatic complaints, loss of energy, MAOIs also have a lag period before reaching
change in weight, and a sense of worthless- adequate serum levels.
ness are other common features. People with bipolar disorder cycle between
Several antidepressants are used to treat de- mania, normalcy, and depression. They also
pression. Selective serotonin reuptake may cycle only between mania and normalcy
inhibitors, the newest type, have the fewest or between depression and normalcy.
side effects. Tricyclic antidepressants are older Clients with mania have a labile mood, are
and have a longer lag period before reaching grandiose and manipulative, have high self-
adequate serum levels; they are the least ex- esteem, and believe they are capable of any-
pensive type. Monoamine oxidase reuptake in- thing. They sleep little, are always in frantic
motion, invade others boundaries, cannot
Critical Thinking Questions sit still, and start many tasks. Speech is
rapid and pressured, reflects rapid thinking,
1. Is it possible for someone to make a rational and may be circumstantial and tangential
decision to commit suicide? Under what with features of rhyming, punning, and
circumstances? flight of ideas. Clients show poor judgment
2. Are laws ethical that permit physician-assisted with little sense of safety needs and take
suicide? Why or why not? physical, financial, occupational, or inter-
3. A person with bipolar disorder frequently personal risks.
discontinues taking medication when out of Lithium is used to treat bipolar disorder. It
the hospital, becomes manic, and engages in is helpful for bipolar mania and can partially
risky behavior such as speeding, drinking or completely eradicate cycling toward bi-
and driving, and incurring large debts. How polar depression. Lithium is effective in 75%
do you reconcile the clients right to refuse of clients but has a narrow range of safety;
medication with public or personal safety? thus, ongoing monitoring of serum lithium
Who should make such a decision? How could levels is necessary to establish efficacy while
it be enforced? preventing toxicity. Clients taking lithium
must ingest adequate salt and water to avoid
15 MOOD DISORDERS AND SUICIDE 369
overdosing or underdosing because lithium Boyles, S. (2002). More care means less depression, but
salt uses the same postsynaptic receptor U.S. docs arent reimbursed. Retrieved 2/3/2002
http://my.webmd.com/printing/article/1663.51885
sites as sodium chloride does. Other anti- Bouchard, G. J. (1999). Office management of mania and
manic drugs include sodium valproate, depression: When patients go to extremes. Clinician
carbamazepine, other anticonvulsants, and Reviews, 9(8), 4971.
clonazepam, which is also a benzodiazepine. Challiner, V., & Griffiths, L. (2000). Electroconvulsive
For clients with mania, the nurse must therapy: A review of the literature. Journal of Psy-
chiatric and Mental Health Nursing, 7, 191198.
monitor food and fluid intake, rest and sleep, DelBello, M. P., Strakowski, S. M., Sax, K. W., McElroy,
and behavior with a focus on safety until S. L., Keck, P. E., Jr., West, S. A., & Gabbard, G. O.
medications reduce the acute stage and (2000). Mood disorders: Psychodynamic aspects. In
clients resume responsibility for themselves. B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive
textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., 13281338).
Suicidal ideation means thinking of suicide. Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
People with increased rates of suicide include Facts and Comparisons (2002). Drug Facts and Compar-
single adults, divorced men, adolescents, isons, 56th ed. St. Louis: Facts and Comparisons:
older adults, the very poor or very wealthy, A Wolters Kluwer Company.
Griswold, K. S., & Pessar, L. F. (2000). Management of
urban dwellers, migrants, students, whites, bipolar disorder. American Family Physician, 62(6),
people with mood disorders, substance 13431353.
abusers, people with medical or personality Jones, H. W., & Venis, J. A. (2001). Identification and
disorders, and people with psychosis. classification of postpartum psychiatric disorders.
Journal of Psychosocial Nursing, 39(12), 2330.
The nurse must be alert to clues to a clients Kelsoe, J. R. (2000). Mood disorders: Genetics. In B. J.
suicidal intentboth direct (making threats Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive text-
of suicide) and indirect (giving away prized book of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., 13081328).
possessions, putting his or her life in order, Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Kuszmar, T. J., Cheatham, W. L., Kacer, K., & Riely, M.
making vague good-byes). (2001). Suicide and prevention in high-risk hospital-
Conducting a suicide lethality assessment ized populations. Physician Assistant, 25(6), 2132.
involves determining the degree to which Miller, M. C., Jacobs, D. G., & Gutheil, T. G. (1998).
the person has planned his or her death Talisman or taboo: The controversy of the suicide
prevention contract. Harvard Review of Psychiatry,
including time, method, tools, place, person
6(2), 7887.
to find the body, reason, and funeral plans. Nierenberg, A. A. (2001). Current perspectives on the di-
Nursing interventions for those at risk for agnosis and treatment of major depressive disorder.
suicide involve keeping the person safe by The American Jouranl of Managed Care, 7(11), sup.,
instituting a no-suicide contract, ensuring S353366.
Pliszka, S. R., Sherman, J. O., Barrow, M. V., & Irick, S.
close supervision, and removing objects that (2000). Affective disorder in juvenile offenders:
the person could use to commit suicide. A preliminary study. American Journal of Psychiatry,
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com. 157(1), 130132.
Potter, M. L., & Dawson, A. M. (2001). From safety con-
tract to safety agreement. Journal of Psychosocial
REFERENCES Nursing, 39(8), 3845.
Roy, A. (2000). Suicide. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock
Adams, P. (2000). INSIGHT: A mental health prevention (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 2
intervention. Nursing Clinics of North America, (7th ed., 20312040). Philadelphia: Lippincott
35(2), 329338. Williams & Wilkins.
American Psychiatric Association. (2000). DSM-IV-TR: Rush, A. J. (2000). Mood disorders: Treatment of de-
Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental disor- pression. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.),
ders-text revision (4th ed.). Washington, DC: Author. Comprehensive Textbook of Psychiatry, Vol. 1
Andrews, M. M., & Boyle, J. S. (2003). Transcultural con- (7th ed., 13771385). Philadelphia: Lippincott
cepts in nursing care (4th ed.). Philadelphia: Lippin- Williams, & Wilkins.
cott Williams & Wilkins. Singer, E. A. (2001). Seasonal affective disorder: Autumn
Akiskal, H. S. (2000). Mood disorders: Introduction onset, winter gloom. Clinician Reviews, 11(11), 4954.
and overview. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock Tecott, L. H. (2000). Monoamine neurotransmitters. In
(Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1 B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive
(7th ed., 12841308). Philadelphia: Lippincott textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., 4150).
Williams & Wilkins. Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Black, K., Shea, C., Dursun, S., & Kutcher, S. (2000). Se- Thase, M. E. (2000). Mood disorders: Neurobiology. In
lective serotonin reuptake inhibitor discontinuation B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive
syndrome: Proposed diagnostic criteria. Journal of textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., 13181328).
Psychiatry and Neuroscience, 25(3), 256261. Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Borowsky, I. W., Ireland, M., & Resnick, M. D. (2001). Young, A. H., Macritchie, K. A. N., & Calabrese, J. R.
Adolescent suicide attempts: Risk and protective (2000). Treatment of bipolar affective disorder.
factors. Pediatrics, 107, 485493. British Medical Journal, 321(7272), 13021303.
Chapter
ChapterStudy
Review
Guide
MULTIPLE-CHOICE QUESTIONS
Select the best answer for each of the following
questions.
1. The nurse observes that a client with bipolar dis- A. Do you feel better after talking with others
order is pacing in the hall, talking loudly and during lunch?
rapidly, and using elaborate hand gestures. The
B. Im so happy to see you interacting with
nurse concludes that the client is demonstrating
other clients.
which of the following?
C. I see you were sitting with others at lunch
A. Aggression
today.
B. Anger
D. You must feel much better than you were a
C. Anxiety few days ago.
D. Psychomotor agitation
5. Which of the following typifies the speech of a
person in the acute phase of mania?
2. A client with bipolar disorder begins taking
lithium carbonate (Lithium) 300 mg four times A. Flight of ideas
a day. After 3 days of therapy, the client says
B. Psychomotor retardation
My hands are shaking. The best response by
the nurse is C. Hesitant
A. Fine motor tremors are an early effect of D. Mutism
lithium therapy that usually subsides in a
few weeks. 6. What is the rationale for a person taking
lithium to have enough water and salt in his or
B. It is nothing to worry about unless it contin-
her diet?
ues for the next month.
A. Salt and water are necessary to dilute
C. Tremors can be an early sign of toxicity, but
lithium to avoid toxicity.
well keep monitoring your lithium level to
make sure youre okay. B. Water and salt convert lithium into a usable
solute.
D. You can expect tremors with Lithium. You
seem very concerned about such a small C. Lithium is metabolized in the liver, necessi-
tremor. tating increased water and salt.
D. Lithium is a salt that has greater affinity for
3. What are the most common types of side effects
receptor sites than sodium chloride.
from SSRIs?
A. Dizziness, drowsiness, dry mouth 7. Identify the serum lithium level for maintenance
and safety.
B. Convulsions, respiratory difficulties
A. 0.1 to 1.0 mEq/L
C. Diarrhea, weight gain
B. 0.5 to 1.5 mEq/L
D. Jaundice, agranulocytosis
C. 10 to 50 mEq/L
4. The nurse observes that a client with depression
D. 50 to 100 mEq/L
sat at the table with two other clients during
lunch. The best feedback the nurse could give
the client is
370
8. A client says to the nurse, You are the best 9. A client with mania begins dancing around the
nurse Ive ever met. I want you to remember day room. When she twirled her skirt in front
me. What is an appropriate response by of the male clients, it was obvious she had no
the nurse? underpants on. The nurse distracts her and
takes her to her room to put on underpants.
A. Thank you. I think you are special too. The nurse acted as she did to
B. I suspect you want something from me. A. Minimize the clients embarrassment about
What is it? her present behavior.
C. You probably say that to all your nurses. B. Keep her from dancing with other clients.
C. Avoid embarrassing the male clients who are
D. Are you thinking of suicide?
watching.
D. Teach her about proper attire and hygiene.
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
1. Identify four areas that must be included in a patient teaching plan for a
client starting lithium treatment.
2. Identify four client statements that might indicate a subtle message about
suicidal ideation.
371
CLINICAL EXAMPLE
June, 46 years old, is divorced with three children: 10, 13, and 16 years of age.
She works in the county clerks office and has called in sick four times in the
past 2 weeks. June has lost 17 pounds in the past 2 months, is spending a lot of
time in bed, but still feels exhausted all the time. During the admission in-
terview, June looks overwhelmingly sad, is tearful, has her head down, and
makes little eye contact. She answers the nurses questions with one or two
words. The nurse considers postponing the remainder of the interview because
June seems unable to provide much information.
1. What assessment data are crucial for the nurse to obtain prior to ending
the interview?
372
3. Identify a short-term outcome for each of the nursing diagnoses.
373
16 Personality
Disorders
Learning Objectives
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
374
16 PERSONALITY DISORDERS 375
This chapter discusses the other personality dis- change their behavior and may view changes as a
orders briefly. Most clients with these disorders are threat.
not treated in acute care settings for the primary The difficulties associated with personality dis-
diagnosis of personality disorder. Nurses may en- orders persist throughout young and middle adult-
counter these clients in any health care setting or in hood but tend to diminish in the 40s and 50s. Those
the psychiatric setting when a client is already hos- with antisocial personality disorder are less likely to
pitalized for another major mental illness. engage in criminal behavior, although problems with
Two disorders currently being studied for in- substance abuse and disregard for the feelings of
clusion as personality disorders are depressive and others persist. Clients with borderline personality
passive-aggressive personality disorders. They are disorder tend to demonstrate decreased impulsive
included in the DSM-IV-TR. This chapter discusses behavior, increased adaptive behavior, and more
them briefly as well. stable relationships by 50 years of age. This in-
creased stability and improved behavior can occur
even without treatment. Some personality disorders,
ONSET AND CLINICAL COURSE such as schizoid, schizotypal, paranoid, avoidant, and
Personality disorders are relatively common occurring obsessive-compulsive, tend to remain consistent
in 10% to 13% of the general population. Incidence is throughout life (Seivewright, Tyrer, & Wright, 2002).
even higher for people in lower socioeconomic groups
and unstable or disadvantaged populations. Fifteen ETIOLOGY
percent of all psychiatric inpatients have a primary di-
agnosis of a personality disorder. Forty percent to 45% Biologic Theories
of those with a primary diagnosis of major mental ill- Personality develops through the interaction of hered-
ness also have a coexisting personality disorder that itary dispositions and environmental influences. Tem-
significantly complicates treatment. In mental health perament refers to the biologic processes of sensa-
outpatient settings, the incidence of personality dis- tion, association, and motivation that underlie the
order is 30% to 50% (Cloninger & Svrakic, 2000). integration of skills and habits based on emotion. Ge-
Clients with personality disorders have a higher death netic differences account for about 50% of the vari-
rate especially as a result of suicide; they also have ances in temperament traits.
higher rates of suicide attempts, accidents, and emer- The four temperament traits are harm avoidance,
gency department visits and increased rates of sepa- novelty seeking, reward dependence, and persistence.
ration, divorce, and involvement in legal proceedings Each of these four genetically influenced traits affects
regarding child custody (Cloninger & Syrakic, 2000). a persons automatic responses to certain situations.
Personality disorders have been correlated highly These response patterns are ingrained by 2 to 3 years
with criminal behavior (70% to 85% of criminals have of age (Cloninger & Svrakic, 2000).
personality disorders), alcoholism (60% to 70% of al- People with high harm avoidance exhibit fear of
coholics have personality disorders), and drug abuse uncertainty, social inhibition, shyness with strangers,
(70% to 90% of those who abuse drugs have personal- rapid fatigability, and pessimistic worry in anticipa-
ity disorders) (Cloninger & Syrakic, 2000). tion of problems. Those with low harm avoidance are
People with personality disorders often are de- carefree, energetic, outgoing, and optimistic. High
scribed as treatment-resistant. This is not surpris- harm-avoidance behaviors may result in maladaptive
ing, considering that personality characteristics and inhibition and excessive anxiety. Low harm-avoidance
behavioral patterns are deeply ingrained. It is diffi- behaviors may result in unwarranted optimism and
cult to change ones personality; if such changes unresponsiveness to potential harm or danger.
occur, they evolve slowly. The slow course of treat- A high novelty-seeking temperament results in
ment can be very frustrating for family, friends, and someone who is quick-tempered, curious, easily bored,
health care providers. impulsive, extravagant, and disorderly. He or she may
Another barrier to treatment is that many clients be easily bored and distracted with daily life, prone
with personality disorders do not perceive their dys- to angry outbursts, and fickle in relationships. The
functional or maladaptive behaviors as a problem; in- person low in novelty seeking is slow-tempered, sto-
deed, sometimes these behaviors are a source of pride. ical, reflective, frugal, reserved, orderly, and tolerant
For example, a belligerent or aggressive person may of monotony; he or she may adhere to a routine of
perceive himself or herself as having a strong person- activities.
ality and being someone who cant be taken advan- Reward dependence defines how a person re-
tage of or pushed around. Clients with personality sponds to social cues. People high in reward depen-
disorders frequently fail to understand the need to dence are tenderhearted, sensitive, sociable, and
16 PERSONALITY DISORDERS 377
socially dependent. They may become overly depen- Self-transcendence describes the extent to which
dent on approval from others and readily assume the a person considers himself or herself to be an integral
ideas or wishes of others without regard for their own part of the universe. Self-transcendent people are
beliefs or desires. People with low reward depen- spiritual, unpretentious, humble, and fulfilled. These
dence are practical, tough-minded, cold, socially in- traits are helpful when dealing with suffering, illness,
sensitive, irresolute, and indifferent to being alone. or death. People low in self-transcendence are practi-
Social withdrawal, detachment, aloofness, and dis- cal, self-conscious, materialistic, and controlling. They
interest in others can result. may have difficulty accepting suffering, loss of control,
Highly persistent people are hardworking and personal and material losses, and death.
ambitious overachievers who respond to fatigue or Character matures in stepwise stages from in-
frustration as a personal challenge. They may perse- fancy through late adulthood. Chapter 3 discusses
vere even when a situation dictates that they should psychological development according to Freud, Erik-
change or stop. People with low persistence are in- son, and others. Each stage has an associated devel-
active, indolent, unstable, and erratic. They tend to opmental task that the person must perform for ma-
give up easily when frustrated and rarely strive for ture personality development. Failure to complete a
higher accomplishments. developmental task jeopardizes the persons ability
These four temperament genetically independent to achieve future developmental tasks. For example,
traits occur in all possible combinations. Some of the if the task of basic trust is not achieved in infancy,
descriptions above of high and low levels of traits cor- mistrust results and subsequently interferes with
respond closely with the descriptions of the various achievement of all future tasks.
personality disorders. For example, people with anti- Experiences with family, peers, and others can
social personality disorder are low in harm avoidance significantly influence psychosocial development. So-
traits and high in novelty seeking traits, while people cial education in the family creates an environment
with dependent personality disorder are high in re- that can support or oppress specific character devel-
ward dependence traits and harm avoidance traits. opment. For example, a family environment that does
not value and demonstrate cooperation with others
(compassion, tolerance) will fail to support the devel-
Psychodynamic Theories opment of that trait in its children. Likewise, the per-
son with nonsupportive or difficult peer relationships
Although temperament is largely inherited, social
growing up may have lifelong difficulty relating to
learning, culture, and random life events unique to
others and forming satisfactory relationships.
each person influence character. Character con-
In summary, personality develops in response to
sists of concepts about the self and the external
inherited dispositions (temperament) and environ-
world. It develops over time as a person comes into
mental influences (character), which are experiences
contact with people and situations and confronts
unique to each person. Personality disorders result
challenges. Three major character traits have been
when the combination of temperament and character
distinguished: self-directedness, cooperativeness, and development produces maladaptive, inflexible ways
self-transcendence. When fully developed, these char- of viewing self, coping with the world, and relating to
acter traits define a mature personality (Cloninger & others.
Svrakic, 2000).
Self-directedness is the extent to which a person
is responsible, reliable, resourceful, goal-oriented, CULTURAL CONSIDERATIONS
and self-confident. Self-directed people are realistic Judgments about personality functioning must in-
and effective and can adapt their behavior to achieve volve a consideration of the persons ethnic, cultural,
goals. People low in self-directedness are blaming, and social background (APA, 2000). Members of mi-
helpless, irresponsible, and unreliable. They cannot nority groups, immigrants, political refugees, and peo-
set and pursue meaningful goals. ple from different ethnic backgrounds may display
Cooperativeness refers to the extent to which a guarded or defensive behavior as a result of language
person sees himself or herself as an integral part of barriers or previous negative experiences; this should
human society. Highly cooperative people are de- not be confused with paranoid personality disorder.
scribed as empathic, tolerant, compassionate, sup- People with religious or spiritual beliefs, such as clair-
portive, and principled. People with low cooperative- voyance, speaking in tongues, or evil spirits as a cause
ness are self-absorbed, intolerant, critical, unhelpful, of disease, could be misinterpreted as having schizo-
revengeful, and opportunistic; that is, they look out typal personality disorder.
for themselves without regard for the rights and feel- There is also a difference in how some cultural
ings of others. groups view avoidance or dependent behavior, partic-
378 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
ularly for women. An emphasis on deference, passiv- toms. These chronic symptoms usually respond to
ity, and politeness should not be confused with a de- low-dose antipsychotic medications (Rivas-Vasquez
pendent personality disorder. Cultures that value & Blais, 2001).
work and productivity may produce citizens with a Several types of aggression have been described
strong emphasis in these areas; this should not be con- in people with personality disorders. Aggression may
fused with obsessive-compulsive personality disorder. occur in impulsive people (some with a normal elec-
Certain personality disorders, such as antisocial troencephalogram, some with an abnormal one); peo-
and schizoid personality disorders, are diagnosed ple who exhibit predatory or cruel behavior; or people
more often in men. Borderline and histrionic person- with organic-like impulsivity, poor social judgment,
ality disorders are diagnosed more often in women. and emotional lability. Lithium, anticonvulsant mood
Social stereotypes about typical gender roles and be- stabilizers, and benzodiazepines are used most often
haviors can influence diagnostic decisions if clinicians to treat aggression. Low-dose neuroleptics may be use-
are unaware of such biases (Tredget, 2001). ful in modifying predatory aggression (Rivas-Vasquez
& Blais, 2002).
TREATMENT Mood dysregulation symptoms include emotional
instability, emotional detachment, depression, and
Several treatment strategies are used with clients dysphoria. Emotional instability and mood swings re-
with personality disorders; these strategies are based spond favorably to lithium, carbamazepine (Tegretol),
on the disorders type and severity or the amount of valproate (Depakote), or low-dose neuroleptics such
distress or functional impairment the client experi- as haloperidol (Haldol). Emotional detachment, cold
ences. Combinations of medication and group and in- and aloof emotions, and disinterest in social relations
dividual therapy are more likely to be effective than is often respond to selective serotonin reuptake in-
any single treatment (Tredget, 2001). Not all people
hibitors (SSRIs) or atypical antipsychotics such as
with personality disorders seek treatment, however,
risperidone (Risperdal), olanzapine (Zyprexa), and
even when significant others urge them to do so. Typ-
quetiapine (Seroquel). Atypical depression is often
ically people with paranoid, schizoid, schizotypal, nar-
treated with SSRIs or monoamine oxidase inhibitor
cissistic, and passive-aggressive personality disorders
antidepressants (MAOIs) or low-dose antipsychotic
are least likely to engage or remain in any treatment.
medications (Pharmacology Update, 2002).
They see other people, rather than their own behav-
Anxiety seen with personality disorders may be
ior, to be the cause of their problems.
chronic cognitive anxiety, somatic anxiety, or severe
acute anxiety. Chronic, constant anxiety responds to
Psychopharmacology SSRIs and MAOIs, as does chronic somatic anxiety, or
Pharmacologic treatment of clients with personality anxiety manifested as multiple physical complaints.
disorders focuses on the clients symptoms rather than Episodes of acute, severe anxiety are best treated with
the particular subtype. The four symptom categories MAOIs or low-dose antipsychotic medications.
that underlie personality disorders are cognitive- Table 16-1 summarizes drug choices for various
perceptual distortions including psychotic symptoms; target symptoms of personality disorders. These drugs
affective symptoms and mood dysregulation; aggres- including side effects and nursing considerations are
sion and behavioral dysfunction; and anxiety. These discussed in detail in Chapter 2.
four symptom categories relate to the underlying tem-
peraments that distinguish the DSM-IV-TR clusters Individual and Group Psychotherapy
of personality disorders:
Low reward dependence and cluster A dis- Therapy helpful to clients with personality disorders
orders correspond to the categories of affective varies according to the type and severity of symptoms
dysregulation, detachment, and cognitive dis- and the particular disorder. Inpatient hospitalization
turbances (Rivas-Vasquez & Blais, 2002). usually is indicated when safety is a concern, for
High novelty seeking and cluster B disorders example, a person with borderline personality dis-
correspond to the target symptoms of impul- order who has suicidal ideas or engages in self-injury.
siveness and aggression. Otherwise hospitalization is not useful and may even
High harm avoidance and cluster C disorders result in dependence on the hospital and staff.
correspond to the categories of anxiety and Individual and group psychotherapy goals for
depression symptoms. clients with personality disorders focus on building
Cognitive-perceptual disturbances include mag- trust, teaching basic living skills, providing support,
ical thinking, odd beliefs, illusions, suspiciousness, decreasing distressing symptoms such as anxiety,
ideas of reference, and low-grade psychotic symp- and improving interpersonal relationships. Relax-
16 PERSONALITY DISORDERS 379
Table 16-2
SUMMARY OF SYMPTOMS AND NURSING INTERVENTIONS FOR PERSONALITY DISORDERS
Personality Disorder Symptoms/Characteristics Nursing Interventions
Paranoid Mistrust and suspicions of others; Serious, straightforward approach; teach client
guarded, restricted affect to validate ideas before taking action; involve
client in treatment planning
Schizoid Detached from social relationships; Improve clients functioning in the community;
restricted affect; involved with assist client to find case manager
things more than people
Schizotypal Acute discomfort in relationships; Develop self-care skills; improve community
cognitive or perceptual distortions; functioning; social skills training
eccentric behavior
Antisocial Disregard for rights of others, rules, Limit-setting; confrontation; teach client to
and laws solve problems effectively and manage
emotions of anger or frustration
Borderline Unstable relationships, self-image, Promote safety; help client to cope and control
and affect; impulsivity; self- emotions; cognitive restructuring tech-
mutilation niques; structure time; teach social skills
Histrionic Excessive emotionality and attention- Teach social skills; provide factual feedback
seeking about behavior
Narcissistic Grandiose; lack of empathy; need Matter-of-fact approach; gain cooperation with
for admiration needed treatment; teach client any needed
self-care skills
Avoidant Social inhibitions; feelings of inade- Support and reassurance; cognitive restructur-
quacy; hypersensitive to negative ing techniques; promote self-esteem
evaluation
Dependent Submissive and clinging behavior; Foster clients self-reliance and autonomy;
excessive need to be taken care of teach problem-solving and decision-making
skills; cognitive restructuring techniques
Obsessive-compulsive Preoccupation with orderliness, Encourage negotiation with others; assist client
perfectionism, and control to make timely decisions and complete work;
cognitive restructuring techniques
Depressive Pattern of depressive cognitions and Assess self-harm risk; provide factual feed-
behaviors in a variety of contexts back; promote self-esteem; increase involve-
ment in activities
Passive-aggressive Pattern of negative attitudes and Help client to identify feelings and express
passive resistance to demands for them directly; assist client to examine own
adequate performance in social feelings and behavior realistically
and occupational situations
they believe they have something to gain. One of the problem and fail to understand why their lack of emo-
most effective interventions is helping clients to learn tion or social involvement troubles others. They are
to validate ideas before taking action; however, this self-absorbed and loners in almost all aspects of daily
requires the ability to trust and to listen to one person. life. Given an opportunity to engage with other peo-
The rationale for this intervention is that clients can ple, these clients will decline. They also are indiffer-
avoid problems if they can refrain from taking action ent to praise or criticism and are relatively unaffected
until they have validated their ideas with another per- by the emotions or opinions of others. They also expe-
son. This helps prevent clients from acting on para- rience dissociation from or no bodily or sensory plea-
noid ideas or beliefs. It also assists them to start bas- sures. For example, the client has little reaction to
ing decisions and actions on reality. beautiful scenery, a sunset, or a walk on the beach.
Clients have a pervasive lack of desire for in-
volvement with others in all aspects of life. They do
SCHIZOID PERSONALITY DISORDER not have or desire friends, rarely date or marry, and
Clinical Picture have little or no sexual contact. They may have some
connection with a first-degree relative, often a par-
Schizoid personality disorder is characterized by ent. Clients may remain in the parental home well
a pervasive pattern of detachment from social rela- into adulthood if they can maintain adequate sepa-
tionships and a restricted range of emotional expres- ration and distance from other family members.
sion in interpersonal settings. It occurs in approxi- They have few social skills, are oblivious to the social
mately 0.5% to 7% of the general population and is cues or overtures of others, and do not engage in so-
more common in men than in women. People with cial conversation. They may succeed in vocational
schizoid personality disorder avoid treatment as areas provided that they value their jobs and have
much as they avoid other relationships, unless their little contact with others in work such as computers
life circumstances change significantly (APA, 2000). or electronics.
Clients with schizoid personality disorder dis-
play a constricted affect and little, if any, emotion.
They are aloof and indifferent, appearing emotionally Nursing Interventions
cold, uncaring, or unfeeling. They report no leisure or Nursing interventions focus on improved functioning
pleasurable activities, because they rarely experience in the community. If a client needs housing or a
enjoyment. Even under stress or adverse circum- change in living circumstances, the nurse can make
stances, their response appears passive and disinter- referrals to social services or appropriate local agen-
ested. There is marked difficulty experiencing and ex- cies for assistance. The nurse can help agency person-
pressing emotions, particularly anger or aggression. nel find suitable housing that will accommodate the
Oddly clients do not report feeling distressed about clients desire and need for solitude. For example, the
this lack of emotion; it is more distressing to family client with a schizoid personality disorder would func-
members. Clients usually have a rich and extensive tion best in a board and care facility, which provides
fantasy life, although they may be reluctant to reveal meals and laundry service but requires little social in-
that information to the nurse or anyone else. The teraction. Facilities designed to promote socialization
ideal relationships that occur in the clients fantasies through group activities would be less desirable.
are rewarding and gratifying; these fantasies though If the client has an identified family member as
are in stark contrast to real-life experiences. The fan- his or her primary relationship, the nurse must as-
tasy relationship often includes someone the client certain if that person can continue in that role. If that
has met only briefly. Nevertheless, these clients can person cannot, the client may need to establish at
distinguish fantasies from reality, and no disordered least a working relationship with a case manager in
or delusional thought processes are evident. the community. The case manager then can help the
Clients generally are accomplished intellectually client to obtain services and health care, manage fi-
and often involved with computers or electronics in nances, etc. The client has a greater chance of success
hobbies or work. They may spend long hours solving if he or she can relate his or her needs to one person
puzzles or mathematical problems, although they see instead of neglecting important areas of daily life.
these pursuits as useful or productive rather than fun.
Clients may be indecisive and lack future goals
or direction. They see no need for planning and really SCHIZOTYPAL PERSONALITY
have no aspirations. They have little opportunity to DISORDER
exercise judgment or decision-making because they
Clinical Picture
rarely engage in these activities. Insight might be de-
scribed as impaired, at least by the social standards Schizotypal personality disorder is characterized
of others: these clients do not see their situation as a by a pervasive pattern of social and interpersonal
382 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
deficits marked by acute discomfort with and reduced ployment without support or assistance. Mistrust of
capacity for close relationships as well as by cognitive others, bizarre thinking and ideas, and unkempt ap-
or perceptual distortions and behavioral eccentrici- pearance can make it difficult for these clients to get
ties. Incidence is about 3% to 5% of the population; the and to keep jobs.
disorder is slightly more common in men than in
women. Clients may experience transient psychotic
Nursing Interventions
episodes in response to extreme stress. An estimated
10% to 20% of people with schizotypal personality dis- The focus of nursing care for clients with schizotypal
order eventually develop schizophrenia (APA, 2000). personality disorder is development of self-care and
Clients often have an odd appearance that causes social skills and improved functioning in the commu-
others to notice them. Clothes are ill fitting, do not nity. The nurse encourages clients to establish a daily
match, and may be stained or dirty. Clients may be routine for hygiene and grooming. Such a routine is
unkempt and disheveled. They may wander aimlessly important rather than depending on the client to de-
and at times becoming preoccupied with some envi- cide when hygiene and grooming tasks are necessary.
ronmental detail. Speech is coherent but may be loose, It is useful for clients to have an appearance that is
digressive, or vague. Clients often provide unsatisfac- not bizarre or disheveled, because stares or comments
tory answers to questions and may be unable to spec- from others can increase discomfort. Because these
ify or to describe information clearly. They frequently clients are uncomfortable around others and this is
use words incorrectly, which makes their speech not likely to change, the nurse must help them func-
sound bizarre. For example, in response to a question tion in the community with minimal discomfort. It
about sleeping habits, the client might respond, Sleep may help to ask clients to prepare a list of people in the
is slow, the REMs dont flow. These clients have a re- community with whom they must have contact such
stricted range of emotions; that is, they lack the abil- as a landlord, store clerk, or pharmacist. The nurse
ity to experience and to express a full range of emo- can then role-play interactions that clients would have
tions such as anger, happiness, and pleasure. Affect is with each of these people; this allows clients to prac-
often flat and sometimes is silly or inappropriate. tice clear and logical requests to obtain services or to
Cognitive distortions include ideas of reference, conduct personal business. Because face-to-face con-
magical thinking, odd or unfounded beliefs, and a tact is more uncomfortable, clients may be able to
preoccupation with parapsychology such as ESP and make written requests or to use the telephone for busi-
clairvoyance. Ideas of reference usually involve the ness. Social skills training may help clients to talk
clients belief that events have special meaning for clearly with others and to reduce bizarre conversa-
him or her; however, these ideas are not firmly fixed tions. It helps to identify one person with whom clients
and delusional as may be seen in clients with schizo- can discuss unusual or bizarre beliefs such as a social
phrenia. In magical thinking, which is normal in worker or family member. Given an acceptable outlet
small children, a client believes he or she has special for these topics, clients may be able to refrain from
powersthat by thinking about something, he or she these conversations with people who might react
can make it happen. In addition, clients may express negatively.
ideas that indicate paranoid thinking and suspi-
ciousness usually about the motives of other people.
Clients experience great anxiety around other CLUSTER B PERSONALITY
people especially those who are unfamiliar. This does DISORDERS
not improve with time or repeated exposures; rather,
the anxiety may intensify. This results from the be-
ANTISOCIAL PERSONALITY
lief that strangers cannot be trusted. Clients do not
DISORDER
view their anxiety as a problem that arises from a Antisocial personality disorder is characterized
threatened sense of self. Interpersonal relationships by a pervasive pattern of disregard for and violation of
are troublesome; therefore, clients may have only one the rights of others and with the central characteris-
significant relationship usually with a first-degree tics of deceit and manipulation. This pattern also has
relative. They may remain in their parents home well been referred to as psychopathy, sociopathy, or dys-
into the adult years. They have a limited capacity for social personality disorder. It occurs in about 3% of the
close relationships, even though they may be unhappy general population and is three to four times more
being alone. common in men than in women. In prison populations,
Clients cannot respond to normal social cues and, about 50% are diagnosed with antisocial personality
hence, cannot engage in superficial conversation. disorder. Antisocial behaviors tend to peak in the 20s
They may have skills that could be useful in a voca- and diminish significantly after 45 years of age (APA,
tional setting, but they are not often successful in em- 2000).
16 PERSONALITY DISORDERS 383
of their actions and do not consider morals or ethics not necessarily effective for these clients and may, in
when making decisions. Their behavior is determined fact, bring out their worst qualities.
primarily by what they want, and they perceive their Nursing diagnoses commonly used when work-
needs as immediate. In addition to seeking immedi- ing with these clients include the following:
ate gratification, these clients also are impulsive. Ineffective Coping
Such impulsivity ranges from simple failure to use Ineffective Role Performance
normal caution (waiting for a green light to cross a Risk for Other-Directed Violence
busy street) to extreme thrill-seeking behaviors such
as driving recklessly. Outcome Identification
Clients lack insight and almost never see their
actions as the cause of their problems. It is always The treatment focus often is behavioral change. Al-
someone elses fault: some external source is respon- though treatment is unlikely to affect the clients in-
sible for their situation or behavior. sight or view of the world and others, it is possible to
make changes in behavior. Treatment outcomes may
include the following:
SELF-CONCEPT
The client will demonstrate nondestructive
Superficially clients appear confident, self-assured, ways to express feelings and frustration.
and accomplished, perhaps even flip or arrogant. The client will identify ways to meet his or
They feel fearless, disregard their own vulnerability, her own needs that do not infringe on the
and usually believe they cannot be caught in lies, de- rights of others.
ceit, or illegal actions. They may be described as ego- The client will achieve or maintain satisfac-
centric (believing the world revolves around them); tory role performance (e.g., at work, as a
but actually the self is quite shallow and empty; these parent).
clients are devoid of personal emotions. They realisti-
cally appraise their own strengths and weaknesses. Intervention
ROLES AND RELATIONSHIPS FORMING A THERAPEUTIC RELATIONSHIP
AND PROMOTING RESPONSIBLE BEHAVIOR
Clients manipulate and exploit those around them.
They view relationships as serving their needs and The nurse must provide structure in the therapeutic
pursue others only for personal gain. They never think relationship, identify acceptable and expected be-
about the repercussions of their actions to others. For haviors, and be consistent in those expectations. The
example, a client is caught scamming an older person nurse must minimize attempts by these clients to
out of her entire life savings. The clients only com- manipulate and to control the relationship.
ment when caught is, Can you believe thats all the Limit-setting is an effective technique that in-
money I got? I was cheated! There should have been volves three steps:
more. 1. Stating the behavioral limit (describing the
These clients often are involved in many rela- unacceptable behavior)
tionships sometimes simultaneously. They may marry 2. Identifying the consequences if the limit is
and have children, but they cannot sustain long- exceeded
term commitments. They usually are unsuccessful 3. Identifying the expected or desired behavior
as spouses and parents and leave others abandoned Consistent limit-setting in a matter-of-fact, non-
and disappointed. They may obtain employment read- judgmental manner is crucial to success. For exam-
ily with their adept use of superficial social skills, but ple, a client may approach the nurse flirtatiously and
over time their work history is poor. Problems may re- attempt to gain personal information. The nurse
sult from absenteeism, theft, or embezzlement, or they would use limit-setting by saying, It is not accept-
may simply quit out of boredom. able for you to ask personal questions. If you continue,
I will terminate our interaction. We need to use this
time to work on solving your job-related problems.
Data Analysis The nurse should not become angry or respond to the
People with antisocial personality disorder generally client harshly or punitively.
do not seek treatment voluntarily unless they per- Confrontation is another technique designed
ceive some personal gain from doing so. For example, to manage manipulative or deceptive behavior. The
a client may choose a treatment setting as an alter- nurse points out a clients problematic behavior while
native to jail or to gain sympathy from an employer; remaining neutral and matter-of-fact; he or she avoids
they may cite stress as a reason for absenteeism or accusing the client. The nurse also can use confronta-
poor performance. Inpatient treatment settings are tion to keep clients focused on the topic and in the pre-
16 PERSONALITY DISORDERS 385
Nursing Diagnosis
Ineffective Coping
Inability to form a valid appraisal of the stressors, inadequate choices of practiced
responses, and/or inability to use available resources
IMPLEMENTATION
Give positive feedback for honesty. The client Honest identification of the consequences for the
may try to act as though he or she is sick or clients behavior is necessary for future behavior
helpless or use other techniques to avoid change.
responsibility.
Identify behaviors that are unacceptable. These You must supply limits when the client is unable
may be general (stealing others possessions) or or unwilling to do so. Limits must be clear, con-
specific (embarrassing Ms. X by using profane crete, and not open to misinterpretation.
language or telling lewd jokes).
Develop specific consequences for the identified Unpleasant consequences may help decrease or
unacceptable behaviors (the client may not go to eliminate unacceptable behaviors.
the gym that day, watching television is prohib-
ited, and so forth). To be effective the consequence
must involve something the client enjoys.
Avoid any discussion or debate about why the Your refusal to be manipulated or charmed will
rules or requirements exist. State the requirement help to decrease manipulative behavior.
or rule in a matter-of-fact manner. The client may
attempt to get special concessions or bend the rules
just this once with numerous reasons, excuses,
and justifications. Avoid arguing with the client.
Inform the client of unacceptable behaviors and The client must be aware of expectations and con-
the resulting consequences in advance of their sequences.
occurrence.
*Communicate and document in the clients care If all team members follow only the written plan,
plan all behaviors and consequences in specific the client will not be able to manipulate changes
terms for all staff members. The client may in the plan.
attempt to gain favor with individual staff mem-
bers or play one staff member against another.
(Last night the nurse told me I could do that.)
Avoid discussing another staff members actions The client will attempt to focus attention on others
or statements with the client until the other staff to decrease attention to himself or herself or may
member is present. attempt to manipulate staff members.
*Be consistent and firm with the care plan. Do Consistency is essential. If the client can find just
not make independent changes in rules or conse- one person to make independent changes, any
quences. Any change should be made by the staff plan will become ineffective.
as a group, and the new information should be
conveyed to all staff members working with this
client including professionals in other disciplines.
(Also you may designate a primary staff person to
be responsible for minor decisions and refer all
questions to this person.)
Avoid trying to coax or convince the client to do The client must decide to begin accepting per-
the right thing. sonal responsibility for his or her own behavior
and the consequences resulting from poor choices.
When the client exceeds a limit, provide conse- A consequence must closely follow the unaccept-
quences immediately after the behavior in a able behavior to be most effective. If you are
matter-of-fact manner. angry, the client may take advantage of it. It is
better to get out of the situation if possible and let
someone else handle it. Do not react to the client
in an angry or punitive manner.
Point out the clients responsibility for his or her The client needs to learn the connection between
behavior in a nonjudgmental manner. his or her behavior and the consequences of that
behavior, but blame and judgment are not
appropriate.
Provide immediate positive feedback or reward Immediate positive feedback will help to increase
for acceptable behavior. the frequency of the acceptable behavior. The
client must receive attention for positive
behaviors, not just unacceptable ones.
Require gradually longer periods of acceptable This gradual progression will help to develop
behavior to obtain a reward. Inform the client of the clients ability to delay gratification. This is
changes in requirements and rewards as these necessary if the client is to function effectively in
decisions are made. For example, at first the client society.
must demonstrate acceptable behavior for 2 hours
to earn 1 hour of television time. Gradually, both
the requirement and the reward are increased.
The client could progress to 5 days of acceptable
behavior and earn a 2-day weekend pass.
Encourage the client to identify sources of frus- This activity should facilitate the clients ability to
tration, how he or she dealt with it previously, accept responsibility for his or her own behavior.
and any unpleasant consequences that resulted.
Explore alternative, socially and legally acceptable The client has the opportunity to learn to make
methods of dealing with identified frustrations. alternative choices.
Help the client to try alternatives as situations The client can role-play alternatives in a non-
arise. Give positive feedback when the client uses threatening environment.
alternatives successfully.
*Include exploration and information on job seek- The client may have had little or no successful
ing, work attendance, debt paying, court appear- experience in these areas. Dealing with conse-
ances, and so forth when working with the client quences and working are responsible behaviors.
in anticipation of discharge. The client can benefit from assistance in these
areas.
Adapted from Schultz, J. M. & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts Manual of Psychiatric Nursing Care Plans (6th ed.). Philadelphia:
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
388 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
tions often are used to manage these difficulties and contract is not a promise to the nurse but is the
to stabilize the clients condition. clients promise to himself or herself to be safe. This
distinction is critical to avoid blurring the bound-
aries between nurse and client (Brown, Comtois, &
PROMOTING THE CLIENTS SAFETY Linehan, 2002).
The clients physical safety is always a priority. The When clients are relatively calm and thinking
nurse must always seriously consider suicidal ideation clearly, it is helpful for the nurse to explore self-harm
with the presence of a plan, access to means for en- behavior. The nurse avoids sensational aspects of the
acting the plan, and self-harm behaviors and institute injury; the focus is on identifying mood and affect,
appropriate interventions (see Chap. 15). Clients often level of agitation and distress, and circumstances sur-
experience chronic suicidality or ongoing, intermittent rounding the incident. In this way, clients can begin
ideas of suicide over months or years. The challenge to identify trigger situations, moods, or emotions that
for the nurse, in concert with the client, is to deter- precede self-harm and to use more effective coping
mine when suicidal ideas are likely to be translated skills to deal with the trigger issues.
into action. If clients do injure themselves, the nurse assesses
Clients may enact self-harm urges by cutting, the injury and need for treatment in a calm, matter-
burning, or punching themselves, which sometimes of-fact manner. Lecturing or chastising clients is puni-
causes permanent physical damage. Self-injury can tive and has no positive effect on self-harm behaviors.
occur when a client is enraged or experiencing dis- Deflecting attention from the actual physical act is
sociative episodes or psychotic symptoms. They may usually desirable (Tredget, 2001).
occur for no readily apparent reason. Helping clients
to avoid self-injury can be difficult when antecedent
conditions vary greatly. Sometimes clients may dis- PROMOTING THE THERAPEUTIC
cuss self-harm urges with the nurse if they feel com- RELATIONSHIP
fortable doing so. The nurse must remain nonjudg- Regardless of the clinical setting, the nurse must pro-
mental when discussing this topic. The nurse can vide structure and limit-setting in the therapeutic re-
encourage clients to enter a no self-harm contract, lationship. In a clinic setting, this may mean seeing
in which a client promises to not engage in self-harm the client for scheduled appointments of a predeter-
and to report to the nurse when he or she is losing mined length rather than whenever the client appears
control. The nurse emphasizes that the no self-harm and demands the nurses immediate attention. In the
hospital setting, the nurse would plan to spend a spe-
cific amount of time with the client working on issues
or coping strategies rather than giving the client ex-
NURSING INTERVENTIONS FOR THE CLIENT clusive access when he or she has had an outburst.
Limit-setting and confrontation techniques, which are
WITH BORDERLINE PERSONALITY DISORDER
described earlier, are also helpful.
Promoting clients safety
No self-harm contract
Safe expression of feelings and emotions ESTABLISHING BOUNDARIES IN
Helping client to cope and control emotions RELATIONSHIPS
Identifying feelings
Journal entries Clients have difficulty maintaining satisfying inter-
Moderating emotional responses personal relationships. Personal boundaries are un-
Decreasing impulsivity clear, and clients often have unrealistic expectations.
Delaying gratification Erratic patterns of thinking and behaving often alien-
Cognitive restructuring techniques ate them from others. This may be true for both pro-
Thought-stopping
fessional and personal relationships. Clients easily
Decatastrophizing
can misinterpret the nurses genuine interest and
Structuring time
Teaching social skills caring as a personal friendship, and the nurse may
Teaching effective communication skills feel flattered by a clients compliments. The nurse
Therapeutic relationship must be quite clear about establishing the boundaries
Limit-setting of the therapeutic relationship to ensure that neither
Confrontation the clients nor the nurses boundaries are violated.
For example:
16 PERSONALITY DISORDERS 393
more likely to follow the plan if it is in written form. this is readily apparent to others but not to clients.
This also can help clients to plan ahead to spend time They experience rapid shifts in moods and emotions
with others instead of frantically calling others when and may be laughing uproariously one moment and
in distress. The written schedule also allows the nurse sobbing the next. Thus, their displays of emotion may
to help clients to engage in more healthful behaviors seem phony or forced to observers. Clients are self-
such as exercise, planning meals, and cooking nutri- absorbed and focus most of their thinking on them-
tious food. selves with little or no thought about the needs of
others. They are highly suggestible and will agree with
almost anyone to gain attention. They express strong
Evaluation opinions very firmly, but because they base them on
As with any personality disorder, changes may be little evidence or facts, the opinions often shift under
small and slow. The degree of functional impairment the influence of someone they are trying to impress.
of clients with borderline personality disorder may Clients are uncomfortable when they are not the
vary widely. Clients with severe impairment may be center of attention and go to great lengths to gain that
evaluated in terms of their ability to be safe and to re- status. They use their physical appearance and dress
frain from self-injury. Other clients may be employed to gain attention. At times they may fish for compli-
and have fairly stable interpersonal relationships. ments in unsubtle ways, fabricate unbelievable sto-
Generally when clients experience fewer crises less ries, or create public scenes to attract attention. They
frequently over time, treatment has been effective. may even faint, become ill, or fall to the floor. They
brighten considerably when given attention after
HISTRIONIC PERSONALITY some of these behaviors; this leaves others feeling
DISORDER that they have been used. Any comment or statement
that could be interpreted as uncomplimentary or un-
Clinical Picture flattering may produce a strong response such as a
Histrionic personality disorder is characterized temper tantrum or crying outburst.
by a pervasive pattern of excessive emotionality and Clients tend to exaggerate the intimacy of rela-
attention-seeking. It occurs in 2% to 3% of the general tionships. They refer to almost all acquaintances as
population and 10% to 15% of the clinical population. dear, dear friends. They may embarrass family
It is seen more often in women than in men. Clients members or friends by flamboyant and inappropriate
usually seek treatment for depression, unexplained public behavior such as hugging and kissing someone
physical problems, and difficulties in relationships who has just been introduced or sobbing uncontrol-
(APA, 2000). lably over a minor incident. Clients may ignore old
The tendency of these clients to exaggerate the friends if someone new and interesting has been in-
closeness of relationships or to dramatize relatively troduced. People with whom these clients have rela-
minor occurrences can result in unreliable data. tionships often describe being used, manipulated, or
Speech is usually colorful and theatrical, full of su- exploited shamelessly.
perlative adjectives. It becomes apparent, however, Clients may have a wide variety of vague physi-
that although colorful and entertaining, descriptions cal complaints or relate exaggerated versions of phys-
are vague and lack detail. Overall appearance is nor- ical illness. These episodes usually involve the atten-
mal, although clients may overdress (e.g., wear an tion clients received (or failed to receive) rather than
evening dress and high heels for a clinical interview). any particular physiologic concern.
Clients are overly concerned with impressing others
with their appearance and spend inordinate time,
Nursing Interventions
energy, and money to this end. Dress and flirtatious
behavior are not limited to social situations or rela- The nurse gives clients feedback about their social
tionships but also occur in occupational and profes- interactions with others including manner of dress
sional settings. The nurse may feel these clients are and nonverbal behavior. Feedback should focus on
charming or even seducing him or her. appropriate alternatives not merely criticism. For ex-
Clients are emotionally expressive, gregarious, ample, the nurse might say, When you embrace and
and effusive. They often exaggerate emotions in- kiss other people on first meeting them, they may in-
appropriately. For example a client says, He is the terpret your behavior in a sexual manner. It would be
most wonderful doctor! He is so fantastic! He has more acceptable to stand at least 2 feet away from
changed my life! to describe a physician she has seen them and to shake hands.
once or twice. In such a case, the client cannot specify It also may help to discuss social situations to ex-
why she views the doctor so highly. Expressed emo- plore the clients perceptions of others reactions and
tions, although colorful, are insincere and shallow; behavior. Teaching social skills and role-playing those
16 PERSONALITY DISORDERS 395
NARCISSISTIC PERSONALITY
DISORDER
Clinical Picture
Narcissistic personality disorder is character-
ized by a pervasive pattern of grandiosity (in fantasy
or behavior), need for admiration, and lack of empa-
thy. It occurs in 1% to 2% of the general population Narcissistic personality
and 2% to 16% of the clinical population. Fifty per-
cent to 75% of people with this diagnosis are men.
criticism and need constant attention and admiration.
Narcissistic traits are common in adolescence and do
They often display a sense of entitlement (unrealistic
not necessarily indicate that a personality disorder
expectation of special treatment or automatic compli-
will develop in adulthood. Individual psychotherapy
ance with wishes). They may believe that only special
is the most effective treatment, and hospitalization
or privileged people can appreciate their unique qual-
is rare unless comorbid conditions exist for which the
ities or are worthy of their friendship. They expect
client requires inpatient treatment (APA, 2000).
special treatment from others and often are puzzled
Clients may display an arrogant or haughty at-
or even angry when they do not receive it. They often
titude. They lack the ability to recognize or to em-
form and exploit relationships to elevate their own
pathize with the feelings of others. They may express
status. Clients assume total concern from others
envy and begrudge others any recognition or mater- about their welfare. They discuss their own concerns
ial success because they believe it rightfully should in lengthy detail with no regard for the needs and feel-
be theirs. Clients tend to disparage, belittle, or dis- ings of others and often become impatient or con-
count the feelings of others. They may express their temptuous of those who discuss their own needs and
grandiosity overtly, or they quietly may expect to be concerns.
recognized for their perceived greatness. They often At work, these clients may experience some suc-
are preoccupied with fantasies of unlimited success, cess because they are ambitious and confident. Diffi-
power, brilliance, beauty, or ideal love. These fan- culties are common, however, because they have trou-
tasies reinforce their sense of superiority. Clients may ble working with others (whom they consider to be
ruminate about long-overdue admiration and privi- inferior) and have limited ability to accept criticism or
lege and compare themselves favorably with famous feedback. They also are likely to believe that they are
or privileged people. underpaid and underappreciated or should have a
Thought-processing is intact, but insight is lim- higher position of authority even though they are not
ited or poor. Clients believe themselves to be superior qualified.
and special and are unlikely to consider that their be-
havior has any relation to their problems: they view
Nursing Interventions
their problems as the fault of others.
Underlying self-esteem is almost always fragile Clients with narcissistic personality disorder can
and vulnerable. These clients are hypersensitive to present one of the greatest challenges to the nurse.
396 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
The nurse must use self-awareness skills to avoid the ance of guaranteed acceptance before they are willing
anger and frustration that their behavior and atti- to risk forming a relationship.
tude can engender. Clients may be rude and arro- Clients may report some success in occupational
gant, unwilling to wait, and harsh and critical of the roles because they are so eager to please or to win a su-
nurse. The nurse must not internalize such criticism pervisors approval. Shyness, awkwardness, or fear of
or take it personally. The goal is to gain cooperation failure, however, may prevent them from seeking jobs
of these clients with other treatment as indicated. that might be more suitable, challenging, or reward-
The nurse teaches about comorbid medical or psychi- ing. For example, a client may reject a promotion and
atric conditions, medication regimen, and any needed continue to remain in an entry-level position for years
self-care skills in a matter-of-fact manner. He or she even though he or she is well qualified to advance.
sets limits on rude or verbally abusive behavior and
explains his or her expectations from the client. Nursing Interventions
These clients require much support and reassurance
CLUSTER C PERSONALITY from the nurse. In the nonthreatening context of the
DISORDERS relationship, the nurse can help them to explore pos-
itive self-aspects, positive responses from others, and
AVOIDANT PERSONALITY DISORDER possible reasons for self-criticism. Helping clients to
Clinical Picture practice self-affirmations and positive self-talk may
be useful in promoting self-esteem. Other cognitive
Avoidant personality disorder is characterized by restructuring techniques, such as reframing and de-
a pervasive pattern of social discomfort and reticence, catastrophizing (described previously), can enhance
low self-esteem, and hypersensitivity to negative eval- self-worth. The nurse can teach social skills and help
uation. It occurs in 0.5% to 1% of the general popula- clients to practice them in the safety of the nurse
tion and 10% of the clinical population. It is equally client relationship. Although these clients have many
common in men and women. Clients are good candi- social fears, those are often counterbalanced by their
dates for individual psychotherapy (APA, 2000). desire for meaningful social contact and relation-
These clients are likely to report being overly ships. The nurse must be careful and patient with
inhibited as children and that they often avoid un- clients and not expect them to implement social skills
familiar situations and people with an intensity be- too rapidly.
yond that expected for developmental stage. This
inhibition, which may have continued throughout up-
bringing, contributes to low self-esteem and social DEPENDENT PERSONALITY
alienation. Clients are apt to be anxious and may fid- DISORDER
get in the chair and make poor eye contact with the Clinical Picture
nurse. They may be reluctant to ask questions or to
make requests. They may appear sad as well as anx- Dependent personality disorder is characterized
ious. They describe being shy, fearful, socially awk- by a pervasive and excessive need to be taken care of,
ward, and easily devastated by real or perceived crit- which leads to submissive and clinging behavior and
icism. Their usual response to these feelings is to fears of separation. These behaviors are designed to
become more reticent and withdrawn. elicit caretaking from others. The disorder occurs in as
Clients have very low self-esteem. They are hyper- much as 15% of the population and is seen three times
sensitive to negative evaluation from others and more often in women than in men. It runs in families
readily believe themselves inferior. Clients are reluc- and is most common in the youngest child. People with
tant to do anything perceived as risky, which for them dependent personality disorder often seek treatment
is almost anything. They are fearful and convinced for anxious, depressed, or somatic symptoms (APA,
that they will make a mistake, be humiliated, or 2000).
embarrass themselves and others. Because they are Clients are frequently anxious and may be mildly
unusually fearful of rejection, criticism, shame, or dis- uncomfortable. They are often pessimistic and self-
approval, they tend to avoid situations or relation- critical; other people hurt their feelings easily. They
ships that may result in these feelings. They usually commonly report feeling unhappy or depressed; this is
strongly desire social acceptance and human com- associated most likely with the actual or threatened
panionship: they wish for closeness and intimacy but loss of support from another. They are preoccupied ex-
fear possible rejection and humiliation. These fears cessively with unrealistic fears of being left alone to
hinder socialization, which makes clients seem awk- care for themselves. They believe they would fail on
ward and socially inept and reinforces their beliefs their own, so keeping or finding a relationship occu-
about themselves. They may need excessive reassur- pies much of their time. They have tremendous diffi-
16 PERSONALITY DISORDERS 397
These clients have low self-esteem and are al- These questions may challenge some rigid and inflex-
ways harsh, critical, and judgmental of themselves; ible thinking.
they believe that they could have done better re- Encouraging clients to take risks, such as letting
gardless of how well the job has been done. Praise and someone else plan a family activity, may improve
reassurance do not change this belief. Clients are bur- relationships. Practicing negotiation with family or
dened by extremely high and unattainable standards friends also may help clients to relinquish some of
and expectations. Although no one could live up to their need for control.
these expectations, they feel guilty and worthless for
being unable to achieve them. They tend to evaluate
self and others solely on deeds or actions without re- OTHER RELATED DISORDERS
gard for personal qualities. Researchers are studying the following two dis-
These clients have much difficulty in relation- orders, depressive personality disorder and passive-
ships, few friends, and little social life. They do not aggressive disorder, for inclusion as personality dis-
express warm or tender feelings to others; attempts orders. The DSM-IV-TR currently lists and describes
to do so are very stiff and formal and may sound in- these conditions.
sincere. For example, if a significant other expresses
love and affection, a clients response might be, The
feeling is mutual. DEPRESSIVE PERSONALITY
Marital and parental-child relationships are DISORDER
often difficult because these clients can be harsh and Clinical Picture
unrelenting. For example, most clients are frugal, do
not give gifts or want to discard old items, and insist Depressive personality disorder is characterized
that those around them do the same. Shopping for by a pervasive pattern of depressive cognitions and
something new to wear may seem frivolous and behaviors in various contexts. It occurs equally in men
wasteful. Clients cannot tolerate lack of control and, and women and more often in people with relatives
hence, may organize family outings to the point that who have major depressive disorders. People with de-
no one enjoys them. These behaviors can cause daily pressive personality disorders often seek treatment
strife and discord in family life. for their distress and generally have a favorable re-
At work, clients may experience some success, sponse to antidepressant medications (APA, 2000).
particularly in fields when precision and attention to Although clients with depressive personality dis-
detail are desirable. They may miss deadlines, how- order may seem to have similar behavior characteris-
ever, while trying to achieve perfection or may fail to tics as clients with major depression (e.g., moodiness,
make needed decisions while searching for more brooding, joylessness, pessimism), the personality dis-
data. They fail to make timely decisions because of order is much less severe. Clients with depressive per-
continually striving for perfection. They have diffi- sonality disorder usually do not experience the sever-
culty working collaboratively, preferring to do it my- ity and long duration of major depression nor the
self so it is done correctly. If clients do accept help hallmark symptoms of sleep disturbances, loss of ap-
from others, they may give such detailed instructions petite, recurrent thoughts of death, and total dis-
and watch the other person so closely that coworkers interest in all activities. Major depressive episode is
are insulted, annoyed, and refuse to work with them. discussed in Chapter 15.
Given this excessive need for routine and control, These clients have a sad, gloomy, or dejected af-
new situations and compromise are also difficult. fect. They express persistent unhappiness, cheerless-
ness, and hopelessness, regardless of the situation.
They often report the inability to experience joy or
Nursing Interventions pleasure in any activity; they cannot relax and do not
Nurses may be able to help clients to view decision- display a sense of humor. Clients may repress or not
making and completion of projects from a different express anger. They brood and worry over all aspects
perspective. Rather than striving for the goal of per- of daily life. Thinking is negative and pessimistic;
fection, clients can set a goal of completing the project these clients rarely see any hope for future improve-
or making the decision by a specified deadline. Help- ment. They view this pessimism as being realistic.
ing clients to accept or to tolerate less-than-perfect Regardless of positive outcomes in a given situation,
work or decisions made on time may alleviate some negative thinking continues. Judgment or decision-
difficulties at work or home. Clients may benefit from making skills are usually intact but dominated by
cognitive restructuring techniques. The nurse can pessimistic thinking; clients often blame themselves
ask, What is the worst that could happen? or How or others unjustly for situations beyond anyones
might your boss (or your wife) see this situation? control.
16 PERSONALITY DISORDERS 399
that no one can figure out whats wrong with me. I ter A and Cluster B traits were more likely to com-
just have to suffer. Its my bad luck! mit violent acts in adulthood. Bleiberg (2002) found
that children at risk for Cluster B personality dis-
orders demonstrate dramatic emotional responses
Nursing Interventions to other people, while paradoxically showing self-
The nurse may encounter much resistance from the centeredness and utter disregard for the feelings of
client in identifying feelings and expressing them di- others. Bleiberg describes treatment for these chil-
rectly. Often clients do not recognize that they feel dren as a collaborative effort with parents that pro-
angry and may express it indirectly. The nurse can motes the childs ability to mentalize, which is the
help them examine the relationship between feelings capacity to interpret and to respond to human be-
and subsequent actions. For example, a client may havior and emotions (of self and others) in a human,
intend to complete a project at work but then pro- meaningful way.
crastinates, forgets, or becomes ill and misses the Mahoney (2000) studied involvement in activities
deadline. Or the client may intend to participate in a rather than problem behaviors. The Carolina Longi-
family outing but becomes ill, forgets, or has an tudinal Study, which followed 695 children from early
emergency when it is time. By focusing on the be- childhood to 24 years of age, provided the data. Chil-
havior, the nurse can help the client to see what is so dren who were involved in activities that were highly
annoying or troubling to others. The nurse also can structured, met regularly, involved skill mastery, and
help the client to learn appropriate ways to express were led by one or more adults were less likely to drop
feelings directly especially negative feelings such as out of school or participate in criminal activity. Higher
anger. Methods such as having the client write about dropout rates and criminal activity in children and
adolescents are associated with the development of
the feelings or role-play are effective. If the client is
adult personality disorders.
unwilling to engage in this process, however, the
nurse cannot force him or her to do so.
SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES
COMMUNITY-BASED CARE Because clients with personality dis-
orders take a long time to change their behaviors, at-
Caring for clients with personality disorders occurs titudes, or coping skills, nurses working with them
primarily in community-based settings. Acute psychi- easily can become frustrated or angry. These clients
atric settings such as the hospital are useful for safety continually test the limits or boundaries of the nurse
concerns for short periods. The nurse will use skills to client relationship with attempts at manipulation.
deal with clients who have personality disorders in Nurses must discuss feelings of anger or frustration
clinics, outpatient settings, doctors offices, and many with colleagues to help them recognize and cope with
medical settings. Often the personality disorder is not their own feelings.
the focus of attention; rather, the client may be seek- The overall appearance of clients with personal-
ing treatment for a physical condition. ity disorders can be misleading. Unlike clients who
Most people with personality disorders are are psychotic or severely depressed, clients with per-
treated in group or individual therapy settings, com- sonality disorders look as though they are capable of
munity support programs, or self-help groups. Others functioning more effectively. The nurse can easily but
will not seek treatment for their personality disorder mistakenly believe the client simply lacks motivation
but may be treated for a major mental illness. Wher- or the willingness to make changes and may feel frus-
ever the nurse encounters clients with personality trated or angry. It is easy for the nurse to think, Why
disorders including in his or her own life, the inter- does the client continue to do that? Cant he see it only
ventions discussed in this chapter can prove useful. gets him into difficulties? This reaction is similar to
reactions the client has probably received from others.
Clients with personality disorders also challenge
MENTAL HEALTH PROMOTION the ability of therapeutic staff to work as a team. For
Recent research has focused on identifying behav- example, clients with antisocial or borderline person-
iors in children and adolescents that correlate with alities often manipulate staff members by splitting
the development of personality disorders as adults themthat is, causing staff to disagree or to contra-
(Bleiberg, 2002; Johnson et al., 2000). These efforts dict one another in terms of the limits of the treat-
are designed to identify those at high risk for adult ment plan. This can be quite disruptive. In addition,
personality disorders early enough to provide effec- team members may have differing opinions about in-
tive treatment and prevention strategies. Johnson dividual clients. One staff member may believe that a
et al. (2000) found that adolescents exhibiting Clus- client needs assistance, while another may believe
16 PERSONALITY DISORDERS 401
that the client is overly dependent. Ongoing commu- Rapid or substantial changes in personality
nication is necessary to remain firm and consistent are unlikely. This can be a primary source of
about expectations for clients. frustration for family members, friends, and
health care professionals.
Schizotypal personality disorder is charac-
Points to Consider When Working terized by social and interpersonal deficits,
With Clients With Personality cognitive and perceptual distortions, and
Disorders eccentric behavior.
Talking to colleagues about feelings of People with paranoid personality disorders
frustration will help you to deal with your are suspicious, mistrustful, and threatened
emotional responses so you can be more by others.
effective with clients. People with depressive personality disorder
Clear, frequent communication with other are sad, gloomy, and negative; experience no
health care providers can help to diminish pleasure; and tend to brood or ruminate
the clients manipulation. about their lives.
Do not take undue flattery or harsh criticism Schizoid personality disorder includes
personally; it is a result of the clients marked detachment from others, restricted
personality disorder. emotions, indifference, and fantasy.
Set realistic goals and remember that People with antisocial personality disorder
behavior changes in clients with personality often appear glib and charming, but they are
disorders take a long time. Progress can be suspicious, insensitive, and uncaring and
very slow. often exploit others for their own gain.
People with borderline personality disorder
have markedly unstable mood, affect, self-
KEY POINTS image, interpersonal relationships, and
People with personality disorders have traits impulsivity; they often engage in self-harm
that are inflexible and maladaptive and behavior.
cause either significant functional impair- People with obsessive-compulsive personal-
ment or subjective distress. ity disorder are preoccupied with orderliness,
Personality disorders are relatively common perfection, and interpersonal control at the
and diagnosed in early adulthood, although expense of flexibility, openness, and efficiency.
some behaviors are evident in childhood or Histrionic personality disorder is character-
adolescence. ized by excessive emotionality and dramatic,
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
http://www.bpdcentral.com
Critical Thinking Questions the type and severity of symptoms the client
experiences in aggression and impulsivity,
1. Where do you see yourself in relation to the mood dysregulation, anxiety, and psychotic
four types of temperament (harm avoidance, symptoms.
novelty seeking, reward dependence, and Clients with borderline personality disorder
persistence)? often have self-harm urges that they enact
2. What has been the most significant influence by cutting, burning, or punching themselves;
on your development as a person? this behavior sometimes causes permanent
3. There is a significant correlation between the physical damage. The nurse can encourage
diagnosis of antisocial personality disorder the client to enter into a no self-harm con-
and criminal behavior. The DSM-IV-TR in- tract in which the client promises to try to
cludes violation of the rights of others in the keep from harming himself or herself and to
definition of this disorder. Is this personality report to the nurse when he or she is having
disorder more a social than a mental health self-harm urges.
problem? Why? Nurses must use self-awareness skills to
minimize client manipulation and deal with
feelings of frustration.
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com.
attention-seeking, and seductive or provoca-
tive behavior. REFERENCES
Narcissistic personality disorder is charac-
terized by grandiosity, need for admiration, Alper, G., & Peterson, S. J. (2001). Dialectical behavior
lack of empathy for others, and a sense of therapy for patient with borderline personality dis-
order. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing, 39(10), 3845.
entitlement. American Psychiatric Association. (2000). DSM-IV-TR:
Avoidant personality disorder is character- Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental disorders-
ized by social discomfort and reticence in all Text revision (4th ed.). Washington DC: Author.
situations, low self-esteem, and hypersensi- Bleiberg, E. (2002). How to help children at risk of devel-
tivity to negative evaluation. oping a borderline or narcissistic personality disorder.
Brown University Child and Adolescent Behavior
Dependent personality disorder is character- Letter, 18(6), 1, 34.
ized by a pervasive and excessive need to be Brown, M. Z., Comtois, K. A., & Linehan, M. M. (2002).
taken care of, which leads to submissive and Reasons for suicide attempts and nonsuicidal self-
clinging behaviors and fears of separation injury in women with borderline personality disorder.
and abandonment. Journal of Abnormal Psychology, 111(1), 198202.
Cloninger, C. R., & Svrakic, D. M. (2000). Personality
People with passive-aggressive personality disorders. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.),
disorder demonstrate passive resistance to Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 2 (7th ed.,
demands for adequate social and occupa- pp. 17231764). Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams &
tional performance and negativity; they often Wilkins.
play the role of a martyr. Divalproex may help women with bipolar/borderline dis-
order. (2002). Pharmacology Update, 13(7), 67.
The therapeutic relationship is crucial in Gabbard, G. O. (2000). Psychoanalysis. In B. J. Sadock &
caring for clients with personality disorders. V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psy-
Nurses can help clients identify their feelings chiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 563607). Philadelphia:
and dysfunctional behaviors and to develop Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
appropriate coping skills and positive behav- Harvard Medical School Health. (2002). Borderline per-
sonality disorder: New recommendations. Harvard
iors. Therapeutic communication and role- Mental Health Letter, 18(9), 46.
modeling help to promote appropriate social Johnson, J. G., Cohen, P., Smailes, E., Kasen, S.,
interactions, which help to improve Oldham, J. M., Skodol, A. E., & Brook, J. S. (2000).
interpersonal relationships. Adolescent personality disorders associates with vio-
Several therapeutic strategies are effective lence and criminal behavior during adolescence and
early adulthood. American Journal of Psychiatry,
when working with clients with personality 157(9), 14061412.
disorders. Cognitive restructuring tech- Linehan, M. M. (1993). Cognitive-behavioral treatment
niques such as thought-stopping, positive of borderline personality disorder. New York: The
self-talk, and decatastrophizing are useful; Guilford Press.
self-help skills and skills help the client to McMurran, M., Fyffe, S., McCarthy, L., Duggan, C., &
Lathem, A. (2001). Stop & think: A social problem-
function better in the community. solving therapy with personality-disordered offend-
Psychotropic medications are prescribed for ers. Criminal Behavior & Mental Health, 11(4),
clients with personality disorders based on 273285.
16 PERSONALITY DISORDERS 403
404
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify the personality disorder that is described in each of the following.
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
Describe the behavior associated with each of the following temperament
traits.
405
Novelty seeking: Low
Persistence: High
Persistence: Low
406
CLINICAL EXAMPLE
Susan Marks, 25 years of age, is diagnosed with borderline personality disorder.
She has been attending college sporadically but has only 15 completed credits
and no real career goal. She is angry because her parents have told her she must
get a job to support herself. Last week she met a man in the park and fell in love
with him on the first date. She has been calling him repeatedly, but he will not
return her calls. Declaring that her parents have deserted her and her boyfriend
doesnt love her anymore, she slashes her forearms with a sharp knife. She then
calls 911, stating, Im about to die! Please help me! She is taken by ambulance
to the emergency room and is admitted to the inpatient psychiatry unit.
407
17 Substance
Abuse
Learning Objectives
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
408
17 SUBSTANCE ABUSE 409
Substance use/abuse and related disorders are a The DSM-IV-TR lists 11 diagnostic classes of
national health problem. Findings from surveys con- substance abuse:
ducted by the National Institute for Mental Health Alcohol
show that in the United States, about 14% of adults Amphetamines or similarly acting sympath-
meet the criteria for an alcohol-related disorder and omimetics
6.2% of adults meet the criteria for a substance- Caffeine
related disorder other than alcohol or tobacco (Jaffe, Cannabis
2000c). These figures do not include adolescents, Cocaine
whose increasing use of alcohol and other drugs is a Hallucinogens
national concern. Findings from a survey of 12- to Inhalants
17-year-olds by the Substance Abuse and Mental Nicotine
Health Services Administration indicated that 9% Opioids
had used an illicit substance and 18.8% had con- Phencyclidine (PCP) or similarly acting drugs
sumed alcohol in the month before the survey (1997). Sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics
The actual prevalence of substance abuse is difficult It also categorizes substance-related disorders into
to determine precisely because many people meeting two groups: those that include disorders of abuse and
the criteria for diagnosis do not seek treatment and dependence, and substance-induced disorders such
surveys conducted to estimate prevalence are based as intoxication, withdrawal, delirium, dementia, psy-
on self-reported data that may be inaccurate. chosis, mood disorder, anxiety, sexual dysfunction,
Drug and alcohol abuse costs business and indus- and sleep disorder.
try an estimated $100 billion annually. Alcoholism This chapter describes the specific symptoms of
alone accounts for 500 million lost days of work. Up to intoxication, overdose, withdrawal, and detoxifica-
40% of industrial fatalities and 47% of workplace in- tion for each substance with the exception of caffeine
juries are linked to alcoholism and alcohol consump- and nicotine. Although caffeine and nicotine abuse
can cause significant physiologic health problems
tion. Estimates of motor vehicle fatalities related to
and result in substance-induced disorders such as
alcohol are 50% (Substance Abuse and Mental Health
sleep disorders, anxiety, and withdrawal, treatment
Services Administration, 2002).
of these two substances usually is not viewed as
The number of babies suffering the physiologic
falling into the mental health arena.
and emotional consequences of prenatal exposure to
Intoxication is use of a substance that results
alcohol or drugs (e.g., fetal alcohol syndrome, crack
in maladaptive behavior. Withdrawal syndrome
babies) is increasing at alarming rates. Chemical
refers to the negative psychological and physical re-
abuse also results in increased violence including do-
actions that occur when use of a substance ceases or
mestic abuse, homicide, and child abuse and neglect.
dramatically decreases. Detoxification is the process
These rising statistics regarding substance abuse do of safely withdrawing from a substance. The treat-
not bode well for future generations. ment of other substance-induced disorders such as
Studies have shown that 50% of all people seek- psychosis and mood disorders is discussed in depth
ing treatment for alcohol-related disorders have at in separate chapters.
least one parent who is or was an alcoholic (Brown Substance abuse can be defined as using a drug
University Digest, 2002). Many people in treatment in a way that is inconsistent with medical or social
programs as adults report having had their first norms and despite negative consequences. The DSM-
drink of alcohol as a young child, before 10 years of IV-TR distinguishes substance abuse from depen-
age. This first drink was often a taste of the drink of dence for purposes of medical diagnosis. Substance
a parent or family member. With the increasing rates abuse denotes problems in social, vocational, or legal
of use being reported among young people today, this areas of the persons life, whereas substance depen-
problem seems to be spiraling out of control unless dence also includes problems associated with addic-
great strides can be made through programs for pre- tion such as tolerance, withdrawal, and unsuccessful
vention, early detection, and effective treatment. attempts to stop using the substance. This distinction
between abuse and dependence frequently is viewed
TYPES OF SUBSTANCE ABUSE as unclear and unnecessary (Jaffe, 2000c), because the
distinction does not affect clinical decisions once with-
Many substances can be used and abused; some can drawal or detoxification has been completed. Hence
be obtained legally while others are illegal. This dis- the terms substance abuse and substance dependence
cussion includes alcohol and prescription medica- or chemical dependence can be used interchangeably.
tions as substances that can be abused. Abuse of In this chapter, the term substance use is used to in-
more than one substance is termed polysubstance clude both abuse and dependence; it is not meant to
abuse. refer to the occasional or one-time user.
410 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
substance abuse is featured near the end of this holics are four times as likely to develop alcoholism
chapter. The effects on adults who grew up in a home (Schuckit, 2000) compared to the general population.
with an alcoholic parent are discussed later as are Some theorists believe that inconsistency in the par-
the special needs of clients with a dual diagnosis of ents behavior, poor role modeling, and lack of nurtur-
substance use and a major psychiatric disorder. ing pave the way for the child to adopt a similar style
of maladaptive coping, stormy relationships, and sub-
stance abuse. Others hypothesize that even children
ETIOLOGY
who abhorred their family lives are likely to abuse
The exact causes of drug use, dependence, and addic- substances as adults because they lack adaptive cop-
tion are not known, but various factors are thought to ing skills and cannot form successful relationships
contribute to the development of substance-related (Brown University Digest, 2002).
disorders (Jaffe, 2000c). Much of the research on bio- Some people use alcohol as a coping mechanism
logic and genetic factors has been done on alcohol or to relieve stress and tension, increase feelings of
abuse, but psychological, social, and environmental power, and decrease psychological pain. High doses
studies have examined other drugs as well. of alcohol, however, actually increase muscle tension
and nervousness (Schuckit, 2000).
Biologic Factors
Children of alcoholic parents are at higher risk for Social and Environmental Factors
developing alcoholism and drug dependence than are Cultural factors, social attitudes, peer behaviors,
children of nonalcoholic parents (Jaffe, 2000c). This in- laws, cost, and availability all influence initial and
creased risk is partly the result of environmental fac- continued use of substances (Jaffe, 2000c). In gen-
tors, but evidence points to the importance of genetic eral, younger experimenters use substances that carry
factors as well. Several studies of twins have shown a less social disapproval such as alcohol and cannabis,
higher rate of concordance (when one twin has it, the
whereas older people use drugs such as cocaine and
other twin gets it) among identical than fraternal
opioids that are more costly and rate higher dis-
twins. Adoption studies have shown higher rates of
approval. Alcohol consumption increases in areas
alcoholism in sons of biologic fathers with alcoholism
where availability increases and decreases in areas
than in those of nonalcoholic biologic fathers. These
where costs of alcohol are higher because of increased
studies lead theorists to describe the genetic compo-
taxation. Many people view the social use of cannabis,
nent of alcoholism as a genetic vulnerability that is
although illegal, as not very harmful; some even ad-
then influenced by various social and environmental
vocate legalizing the use of marijuana for social pur-
factors. Slutske, Heaht, Madden, Bucholz, Statham &
Martin (2002) found that 50% to 60% of the variation poses. Urban areas where cocaine and opioids are
in causes of alcoholism was the result of genetics, with readily available also have high crime rates, high un-
the remainder caused by environmental influences. employment, and substandard school systems that
Neurochemical influences on substance use pat- contribute to high rates of cocaine and opioid use and
terns have been studied primarily in animal research low rates of recovery. Thus environment and social
(Jaffe, 2000c). The ingestion of mood-altering sub- customs can influence a persons use of substances.
stances stimulates dopamine pathways in the limbic
system, which produces pleasant feelings or a high CULTURAL CONSIDERATIONS
that is a reinforcing, or positive, experience. Distri-
bution of the substance throughout the brain alters Attitudes toward substance use, patterns of use, and
the balance of neurotransmitters that modulate plea- physiologic differences to substances vary in different
sure, pain, and reward responses. Researchers have cultures. Muslims do not drink alcohol, but wine is an
proposed that some people have an internal alarm integral part of Jewish religious rites. Some Native
that limits the amount of alcohol consumed to one or American tribes use peyote, a hallucinogen, in reli-
two drinks, so that they feel a pleasant sensation but gious ceremonies. It is important to be aware of such
go no further. People without this internal signaling beliefs when assessing for a substance abuse problem.
mechanism experience the high initially but con- Certain ethnic groups have genetic traits that
tinue to drink until central nervous system depres- either predispose them to or protect them from devel-
sion is marked and they are intoxicated. oping alcoholism. For instance, flushing, a reddening
of the face and neck as a result of increased blood flow,
has been linked to variants of genes for enzymes in-
Psychological Factors
volved in alcohol metabolism. Even small amounts of
In addition to the genetic links to alcoholism, family alcohol can produce flushing, which may be accompa-
dynamics are thought to play a part. Children of alco- nied by headaches and nausea. The flushing reaction
412 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
is highest among people of Asian ancestry (National tration, memory, and judgment. Some people become
Institute on Alcohol Abuse and Alcoholism, 2000). aggressive or display inappropriate sexual behavior
Another genetic difference between ethnic groups when intoxicated. The person who is intoxicated may
is found in other enzymes involved in metabolizing al- experience a blackout.
cohol in the liver. Variations have been found in the An overdose, or excessive alcohol intake in a short
structure and activity levels of the enzymes among period, can result in vomiting, unconsciousness, and
Asians, African Americans, and whites. One enzyme respiratory depression. This combination can cause
found in people of Japanese descent has been associ- aspiration pneumonia or pulmonary obstruction.
ated with faster elimination of alcohol from the body. Alcohol-induced hypotension can lead to cardiovascu-
Other enzyme variations are being studied to deter- lar shock and death. Treatment of an alcohol overdose
mine their effects on the metabolism of alcohol among is similar to that for any central nervous system de-
various ethnic groups (National Institute on Alcohol pressant: gastric lavage or dialysis to remove the drug,
Abuse and Alcoholism, 2000). and support of respiratory and cardiovascular func-
Statistics for individual tribes vary, but alcohol tioning in an intensive care unit. The administration
abuse overall plays a part in the five leading causes of of central nervous system stimulants is contraindi-
death for Native Americans (motor vehicle crashes, cated (Lehne, 2001). The physiologic effects of repeated
alcoholism, cirrhosis, suicide, and homicide). Among intoxication and long-term use are listed in Box 17-1.
tribes with high rates of alcoholism, an estimated 75%
of all accidents are alcohol-related (National Institute
on Alcohol Abuse and Alcoholism, 2000). WITHDRAWAL AND DETOXIFICATION
In Japan, alcohol consumption has quadrupled Symptoms of withdrawal usually begin 4 to 12 hours
since 1960. The Japanese do not regard alcohol as a after cessation or marked reduction of alcohol intake.
drug, and there are no religious prohibitions against Symptoms include coarse hand tremors, sweating,
drinking. Milne (2002) describes a traditionally in- elevated pulse and blood pressure, insomnia, anxi-
dulgent attitude toward those who drink too much, ety, and nausea or vomiting. Severe or untreated
stating In a tightly knit society where concealing withdrawal may progress to transient hallucinations,
emotions and frustrations is a highly developed and seizures, or deliriumcalled delirium tremens (DTs).
necessary part of maintaining consensus, getting Alcohol withdrawal usually peaks on the second day
drunk is a socially sanctioned safety valve (p. 388). and is over in about 5 days (American Psychiatric As-
Brady (2002) identifies explosive binge drinking sociation [APA], 2000). This can vary, however, and
among some Aboriginal people that is associated withdrawal may take 1 to 2 weeks.
with trauma, violence, and accidents. Alcohol poi- Because alcohol withdrawal can be life threat-
soning is identified as one major aspect of Russias ening, detoxification needs to be accomplished under
dismal health situation (Onishchenko, 2002, p. 23). medical supervision. If the clients withdrawal symp-
toms are mild and he or she can abstain from alcohol,
TYPES OF SUBSTANCES he or she can be treated safely at home. For more se-
AND TREATMENT vere withdrawal or for clients who cannot abstain
during detoxification, a short admission of 3 to 5 days
The classes of mood-altering substances have some
similarities and differences in terms of intended effect,
intoxication effects, and withdrawal symptoms. Treat-
ment approaches after detoxification, however, are
quite similar. This section presents a brief overview Box 17-1
of seven classes of substances and the effects of in-
PHYSIOLOGIC EFFECTS OF
toxication, overdose, withdrawal, and detoxification
and it highlights important elements the nurse to be LONG-TERM ALCOHOL USE
aware of. Cardiac myopathy
Wernickes encephalopathy
Korsakoffs psychosis
Alcohol Pancreatitis
INTOXICATION AND OVERDOSE Esophagitis
Hepatitis
Alcohol is a central nervous system depressant that Cirrhosis
is absorbed rapidly into the bloodstream. Initially the Leukopenia
effects are relaxation and loss of inhibitions. With Thrombocytopenia
intoxication, there is slurred speech, unsteady gait, Ascites
lack of coordination, and impaired attention, concen-
17 SUBSTANCE ABUSE 413
is the most common setting. Some psychiatric units labile mood, impaired attention or memory, and even
also admit clients for detoxification, but this is less stupor and coma.
common. Benzodiazepines alone, when taken orally in over-
Safe withdrawal usually is accomplished with the dose, are rarely fatal but the person will be lethargic
administration of benzodiazepines such as lorazepam and confused. Treatment includes gastric lavage fol-
(Ativan), chlordiazepoxide (Librium), or diazepam lowed by ingestion of activated charcoal and a saline
(Valium) to suppress the withdrawal symptoms. cathartic; dialysis can be used if symptoms are severe
Withdrawal can be accomplished by fixed-schedule (Lehne, 2001). The clients confusion and lethargy
dosing known as tapering or symptom-triggered dos- will improve as the drug is excreted.
ing in which the presence and severity of withdrawal Barbiturates, in contrast, can be lethal when
symptoms determine the amount of medication needed taken in overdose. They can cause coma, respiratory
and the frequency of administration. Often the proto- arrest, cardiac failure, and death. Treatment in an
col used is based on an assessment tool such as the intensive care unit is required using lavage or dialy-
Clinical Institute Withdrawal Assessment of Alcohol sis to remove the drug from the system and to sup-
Scale, Revised (CIWA-Ar) in Box 17-2. Total scores port respiratory and cardiovascular function.
less than 8 indicate mild withdrawal; scores from 8 to
15 indicate moderate withdrawal (marked arousal);
and scores greater than 15 indicate severe with- WITHDRAWAL AND DETOXIFICATION
drawal. Clients on symptom-triggered dosing receive The onset of withdrawal symptoms depends on the
medication based on CIWA scores alone, while clients half-life of the drug (see Chap. 2). Medications, such as
on fixed dose tapers also can receive additional doses lorazepam, whose actions typically last about 10 hours
depending on the level of CIWA scores. Both methods produce withdrawal symptoms in 6 to 8 hours; longer-
of medicating clients are safe and effective (Daeppen acting medications such as diazepam may not produce
et al., 2002). withdrawal symptoms for 1 week (APA, 2000). The
withdrawal syndrome is characterized by symptoms
Sedatives, Hypnotics, and Anxiolytics that are the opposite of the acute effects of the drug:
that is, autonomic hyperactivity (increased pulse,
INTOXICATION AND OVERDOSE
blood pressure, respirations, and temperature), hand
This class of drugs includes all central nervous system tremor, insomnia, anxiety, nausea, and psychomotor
depressants: barbiturates, nonbarbiturate hypnotics, agitation. Seizures and hallucinations occur only
and anxiolytics particularly benzodiazepines. Benzo- rarely in severe benzodiazepine withdrawal (Ciraulo
diazepines and barbiturates are the most frequently & Sarid-Segal, 2000).
abused drugs in this category (Ciraulo & Sarid-Segal, Detoxification from sedatives, hypnotics, and
2000). The intensity of the effect depends on the par- anxiolytics is often managed medically by tapering the
ticular drug. The effects of the drugs, symptoms of in- amount of the drug the client receives over a period of
toxication, and withdrawal symptoms are similar to days or weeks, depending on the drug and the amount
those of alcohol. In the usual prescribed doses, these the client had been using. Tapering, or administer-
drugs cause drowsiness and reduce anxiety, which is ing decreasing doses of a medication, is essential with
the intended purpose. Intoxication symptoms include barbiturates to prevent coma and death that will
slurred speech, lack of coordination, unsteady gait, occur if the drug is stopped abruptly. For example,
414 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Box 17-2
ADDICTION RESEARCH FOUNDATION CLINICAL INSTITUTE
WITHDRAWAL ASSESSMENT FOR ALCOHOL, REVISED (CIWA-AR)
NAUSEA AND VOMITINGAsk Do you feel sick to TACTILE DISTURBANCESAsk, Have you any itching,
your stomach? Have you vomited? Observation. pins and needles sensations, any burning, any numbness
0 no nausea and no vomiting or do you feel bugs crawling on or under your skin?
1 mild nausea with no vomiting Observation.
2 0 none
3 1 very mild itching, pins and needles, burning or
4 intermittent nausea with dry heaves numbness
5 2 mild itching, pins and needles, burning or numbness
6 3 moderate itching, pins and needles, burning or
7 constant nausea, frequent dry heaves and vomiting numbness
4 moderately severe hallucinations
TREMORArms extended and fingers spread apart. 5 severe hallucinations
Observation. 6 extremely severe hallucinations
0 no tremor 7 continuous hallucinations
1 not visible, but can be felt fingertip to fingertip
2 AUDITORY DISTURBANCESAsk Are you more aware
3 of sounds around you? Are they harsh? Do they frighten
4 moderate, with patients arms extended you? Are you hearing anything that is disturbing to you?
5 Are you hearing things you know are not there? Obser-
6 vation.
7 severe, flapping tremors 0 not present
1 very mild harshness or ability to frighten
PAROXYSMAL SWEATSObservation. 2 mild harshness or ability to frighten
0 no sweat visible 3 moderate harshness or ability to frighten
1 barely perceptible sweating, palms moist 4 moderately severe hallucinations
2 5 severe hallucinations
3 6 extremely severe hallucinations
4 beads of sweat obvious on forehead 7 continuous hallucinations
5
6 VISUAL DISTURBANCESAsk, Does the light appear
7 drenching sweats too bright? Is its color different? Does it hurt your eyes?
Are you seeing anything that is disturbing to you? Are
ANXIETYAsk, Do you feel nervous? Observation. you seeing things you know are not there? Observation.
0 no anxiety, at ease 0 not present
1 mildly anxious 1 very mild sensitivity
2 2 mild sensitivity
3 3 moderate sensitivity
4 moderately anxious, or guarded, so anxiety is 4 moderately severe hallucinations
inferred 5 severe hallucinations
5 6 extremely severe hallucinations
6 7 continuous hallucinations
7 equivalent to acute panic states as seen in severe
delirium or acute psychotic reactions HEADACHE, FULLNESS IN HEADAsk, Does your
head feel different? Does it feel like there is a band
AGITATIONObservation. around your head? Do not rate for dizziness or light-
0 normal activity headedness. Otherwise, rate severity.
1 somewhat more than normal activity 0 not present
2 1 very mild
3 2 mild
4 moderately fidgety and restless 3 moderate
5 4 moderately severe
6 5 severe
7 paces back and forth during most of the interview, or 6 very severe
constantly thrashes about 7 extremely severe
Continued
17 SUBSTANCE ABUSE 415
Box 17-2
ADDICTION RESEARCH FOUNDATION CLINICAL INSTITUTE
WITHDRAWAL ASSESSMENT FOR ALCOHOL, REVISED (CIWA-AR)contd
ORIENTATION AND CLOUDING OF SENSORIUMAsk, Maximum Possible Score 67
What day is this? Where are you? Who am I?
0 oriented and can do serial additions A score of less than 10 usually indicates no need
1 cannot do serial additions or is uncertain about date for additional withdrawal medication.
2 disoriented for date by no more than 2 calendar days
3 disoriented for date by more than 2 calendar days
4 disoriented for place and/or person
when tapering the dosage of a benzodiazepine, the are rare (Jaffe, 2000a). Treatment with chlorpro-
client may be given Valium 10 mg four times a day; mazine (Thorazine), an antipsychotic, controls hallu-
the dose is decreased every 3 days, and the number of cinations, lowers blood pressure, and relieves nausea
times a day the dose is given also is decreased until (Lehne, 2001).
the client is safely withdrawn from the drug.
WITHDRAWAL AND DETOXIFICATION
Stimulants (Amphetamines, Withdrawal from stimulants occurs within a few
Cocaine, Others) hours to several days after cessation of the drug and
Stimulants are drugs that stimulate or excite the is not life threatening. Marked dysphoria is the pri-
central nervous system. Although the DSM-IV-TR mary symptom and is accompanied by fatigue, vivid
categorizes amphetamines, cocaine, and central ner- and unpleasant dreams, insomnia or hypersomnia,
vous system stimulants separately, the effects, intox- increased appetite, and psychomotor retardation or
ication, and withdrawal symptoms of these drugs are agitation. Marked withdrawal symptoms are referred
virtually identical. They are grouped together here to as crashing; the person may experience depres-
for this reason. sive symptoms including suicidal ideation for several
Stimulants have limited clinical use (with the ex- days. Stimulant withdrawal is not treated pharmaco-
ception of stimulants used to treat attention deficit logically.
hyperactivity disorder; see Chapter 20) and a high po-
tential for abuse. Amphetamines (uppers) were pop-
ular in the past; they were used by people who wanted
Cannabis (Marijuana)
to lose weight or to stay awake. Cocaine, an illegal Cannabis sativa is the hemp plant that is widely cul-
drug with virtually no clinical use in medicine, is tivated for its fiber used to make rope and cloth and for
highly addictive and a popular recreational drug be- oil from its seeds. It has become widely known for its
cause of the intense and immediate feeling of eupho- psychoactive resin (Macfadden & Woody, 2000). This
ria it produces. resin contains more than 60 substances called canna-
Methamphetamine is particularly dangerous. It binoids of which delta-9-tetrahydrocannabinol (THC)
is highly addictive and causes psychotic behavior. is thought to be responsible for most of the psycho-
Brain damage related to its use is frequent, primarily active effects. Marijuana refers to the upper leaves,
as a result of the substances used to make it. flowering tops, and stems of the plant; hashish is the
dried resinous exudate from the leaves of the female
plant. Cannabis is most often smoked in cigarettes
INTOXICATION AND OVERDOSE
(joints), but it can be eaten.
Intoxication from stimulants develops rapidly; effects Cannabis is the most widely used illicit sub-
include the high or euphoric feeling, hyperactivity, stance in the United States. Research has shown that
hypervigilance, talkativeness, anxiety, grandiosity, cannabis has short-term effects of lowering intra-
hallucinations, stereotypic or repetitive behavior, ocular pressure, but it is not approved for the treat-
anger, fighting, and impaired judgment. Physiologic ment of glaucoma. It also has been studied for its
effects include tachycardia, elevated blood pressure, effectiveness in relieving the nausea and vomiting as-
dilated pupils, perspiration or chills, nausea, chest sociated with cancer chemotherapy and the anorexia
pain, confusion, and cardiac dysrhythmias. Overdoses and weight loss of AIDS. Currently two cannabinoids,
of stimulants can result in seizures and coma; deaths dronabinol (Marinol) and nabilone (Cesamet), have
416 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
been approved for treating nausea and vomiting from one (Narcan), an opioid antagonist, is the treatment
cancer chemotherapy (Voth & Schwartz, 1997). of choice because it reverses all signs of opioid toxic-
ity. Naloxone is given every few hours until the opioid
level drops to nontoxic; this process may take days
INTOXICATION AND OVERDOSE
(Lehne, 2001).
Cannabis begins to act less than 1 minute after in-
halation. Peak effects usually occur in 20 to 30 min-
WITHDRAWAL AND DETOXIFICATION
utes and last at least 2 to 3 hours. Users report a high
feeling similar to that with alcohol, lowered inhibi- Opioid withdrawal develops when drug intake ceases
tions, relaxation, euphoria, and increased appetite. or decreases markedly, or it can be precipitated by the
Symptoms of intoxication include impaired motor co- administration of an opioid antagonist. Initial symp-
ordination, inappropriate laughter, impaired judg- toms are anxiety, restlessness, aching back and legs,
ment and short-term memory, and distortions of time and cravings for more opioids (Jaffe & Jaffe, 2000).
and perception. Anxiety, dysphoria, and social with- Symptoms that develop as withdrawal progresses
drawal may occur in some users. Physiologic effects, include nausea, vomiting, dysphoria, lacrimation,
in addition to increased appetite, include conjunctival rhinorrhea, sweating, diarrhea, yawning, fever, and
injection (bloodshot eyes), dry mouth, hypotension, insomnia. Symptoms of opioid withdrawal cause sig-
and tachycardia. Excessive use of cannabis may pro- nificant distress but do not require pharmacologic in-
duce delirium or, rarely, cannabis-induced psychotic tervention to support life or bodily functions. Short-
disorder, both of which are treated symptomatically. acting drugs such as heroin produce withdrawal
Overdoses of cannabis do not occur (Macfadden & symptoms in 6 to 24 hours; the symptoms peak in 2 to
Woody, 2000). 3 days and gradually subside in 5 to 7 days. Longer-
acting substances such as methadone may not pro-
duce significant withdrawal symptoms for 2 to 4 days,
WITHDRAWAL AND DETOXIFICATION
and the symptoms may take 2 weeks to subside.
Although some people have reported withdrawal Methadone can be used as a replacement for the opi-
symptoms of muscle aches, sweating, anxiety, and oid, and the dosage is then decreased over 2 weeks.
tremors, no clinically significant withdrawal syn- Substitution of methadone during detoxification re-
drome is identified (Lehne, 2001). duces symptoms to no worse than a mild case of flu
(Lehne, 2001). Withdrawal symptoms such as anxi-
Opioids ety, insomnia, dysphoria, anhedonia, and drug crav-
ing may persist for weeks or months.
Opioids are popular drugs of abuse because they de-
sensitize the user to both physiologic and psychologi-
cal pain and induce a sense of euphoria and well being.
Hallucinogens
Opioid compounds include both potent prescription Hallucinogens are substances that distort the users
analgesics such as morphine, meperidine (Demerol), perception of reality and produce symptoms similar
codeine, hydromorphone, oxycodone, methadone, oxy- to psychosis including hallucinations (usually visual)
morphone, hydrocodone, and propoxyphene, and ille- and depersonalization. Hallucinogens also cause
gal substances such as heroin and normethadone. increased pulse, blood pressure, and temperature,
People who abuse opioids spend a great deal of their dilated pupils, and hyperreflexia. Examples of hallu-
time obtaining the drugs; they often engage in illegal cinogens are mescaline, psilocybin, lysergic acid dieth-
activity to get them. Health care professionals who ylamide (LSD), and designer drugs such as Ecstasy.
abuse opioids often write prescriptions for themselves Phencyclidine (PCP), developed as an anesthetic, is
or divert prescribed pain medication for clients to included in this section because it acts similarly to
themselves (APA, 2000). hallucinogens.
involve health professionals. Alcoholics Anonymous reported feeling overlooked or ignored by an essen-
(AA) was founded in the 1930s by alcoholics. This self- tially white, male, middle-class organization. Treat-
help group developed the 12-step program model for ment programs have developed to meet these needs
recovery (Box 17-3), which is based on the philosophy such as Women for Sobriety (exclusively for women)
that total abstinence is essential and that alcoholics and Rational Recovery (treatment program that does
need the help and support of others to maintain so- not include AA or its tenets). Self-help support groups
briety. Key slogans reflect the ideas in the 12 steps exist for gay, lesbian, and non-Christian members.
such as one day at a time (approach sobriety one day The 12-step concept of recovery has been used for
at a time), easy does it (dont get frenzied about other drugs as well. Such groups include Narcotics
daily life and problems), and let go and let God (turn Anonymous; Al-Anon, a support group for spouses,
your life over to a higher power). Each new member partners, and friends of alcoholics; and AlaTeen, a
has a sponsor who helps him or her. Once sober, a group for children of parents with substance prob-
member can be a sponsor for another person. lems. This same model has been used in self-help
Regular attendance at meetings is emphasized. groups for people with gambling problems and eating
Meetings are available daily in large cities and at least disorders. National addresses for these groups are
weekly in smaller towns or rural areas. AA meetings listed in Box 17-4.
may be closed (only those who are pursuing recovery
can attend) or open (anyone can attend). Meetings
Treatment Settings and Programs
may be educational with a featured speaker; other
meetings simply offer the opportunity for members to Clients being treated for intoxication and withdrawal
relate their battles with alcohol and to ask the others or detoxification are encountered in a wide variety of
for help staying sober. medical settings from the emergency department to
Many treatment programs, regardless of setting, the outpatient clinic. Clients needing medically su-
use the 12-step approach and emphasize participation pervised detoxification often are treated on medical
in AA. They also include individual counseling and a units in the hospital setting and then referred to an
wide variety of groups. Group experiences involve appropriate outpatient treatment setting when they
education about substances and their use, problem- are medically stable.
solving techniques, and cognitive techniques to iden- Health professionals provide extended or outpa-
tify and to modify faulty ways of thinking. An overall tient treatment in various settings including clinics
theme is coping with life, stress, and other people or centers offering day and evening programs, half-
without the use of substances. way houses, residential settings, or special chemical
Although traditional treatment programs and dependency units in hospitals. Generally the type of
AA have been successful for many people, they are treatment setting selected is based on the clients
not effective for everyone. Some object to the empha- needs as well as his or her insurance coverage. For ex-
sis on God and spirituality; others do not respond well ample, for someone who has limited insurance cover-
to the confrontational approach and to being labeled age, is working, and has a supportive family, the out-
an alcoholic or an addict. Women and minorities have patient setting may be chosen first because it is less
Box 17-3
TWELVE STEPS OF ALCOHOLICS ANONYMOUS
1. We admitted that we were powerless over alcohol, that our lives had become unmanageable.
2. Came to believe that a Power greater than ourselves could restore us to sanity.
3. Made a decision to turn our wills and lives over to the care of God as we understood Him.
4. Made a searching and fearless moral inventory of ourselves.
5. Admitted to God, to ourselves, and to another human being the exact nature of our wrongs.
6. Were entirely ready to have God remove all these defects of character.
7. Humbly asked Him to remove our shortcomings.
8. Made a list of all persons we had harmed, and became willing to make amends to them all.
9. Made direct amends to such people whenever possible, except when to do so would injure them or others.
10. Continued to take personal inventory and when we were wrong promptly admitted it.
11. Sought through prayer and meditation to improve our conscious contact with God as we understood Him,
praying only for knowledge of His will for us and the power to carry that out.
12. Having had a spiritual awakening as a result of these steps, we tried to carry this message to alcoholics and
to practice these principles in all our affairs.
17 SUBSTANCE ABUSE 419
Box 17-4
NATIONAL ADDRESSES FOR SELF-HELP GROUPS AND TREATMENT PROGRAMS
Alcoholics Anonymous Women for Sobriety
PO Box 459, Grand Central Station PO Box 618
New York, NY 10163 Quakertown, PA 18951
1-212-870-3400 1-800-333-1606
Al-Anon Family Group Headquarters, Inc. Rational Recovery Systems
1600 Corporate Landing Parkway 1460 Pleasant Valley Road
Virginia Beach, VA 23454 Placerville, CA 95667
1-757-563-1600 1-530-621-4374
expensive, the client can continue to work, and the uct labels carefully because any product containing
family can provide support. If the client cannot re- alcohol can produce symptoms.
main sober during outpatient treatment, then in- Methadone, a potent synthetic opiate, is used as
patient treatment may be required. Clients with re- a substitute for heroin in some maintenance pro-
peated treatment experiences may need the structure grams. The client takes one daily dose of methadone,
of a halfway house with a gradual transition into the which meets the physical need for opiates but does not
community. produce cravings for more. Methadone does not pro-
duce the high associated with heroin. The client has
Pharmacologic Treatment essentially substituted his or her addiction to heroin
for an addiction to methadone; however, methadone is
Pharmacologic treatment in substance abuse has two safer because it is legal, controlled by a physician, and
main purposes: to permit safe withdrawal from alco- available in tablet form. The client avoids the risks of
hol, sedative/hypnotics, and benzodiazepines and to intravenous drug use, the high cost of heroin (which
prevent relapse. Table 17-1 summarizes drugs used in often leads to criminal acts), and the questionable con-
substance abuse treatment. For clients whose primary tent of street drugs.
substance is alcohol, vitamin B1 (thiamine) often is Levomethadyl is a narcotic analgesic whose only
prescribed to prevent or to treat Wernickes syndrome purpose is the treatment of opiate dependence. It is
and Korsakoffs syndrome, which are neurologic con- used in the same manner as methadone.
ditions that can result from heavy alcohol use. Cyano- Naltrexone (ReVia) is an opioid antagonist often
cobalamin (vitamin B12) and folic acid often are pre- used to treat overdose. It blocks the effects of any opi-
scribed for clients with nutritional deficiencies. oids that might be ingested, thereby negating the ef-
Alcohol withdrawal usually is managed with a fects of using more opioids. It also has been found to
benzodiazepine anxiolytic agent, which is used to reduce the cravings for alcohol in abstinent clients,
suppress the symptoms of abstinence. The most com- although research is in the early stages (Zepf, 2002).
monly used benzodiazepines are lorazepam, chlor- Acamprosate (Campral), which modulates neuro-
diazepoxide, and diazepam. These medications can transmission of GABA and NMDA, has been used
be administered on a fixed schedule around the clock with some success in the United Kingdom to decrease
during withdrawal. Giving these medications on an alcohol cravings and to maintain abstinence; acam-
as-needed basis according to symptom parameters, prosate is only in clinical trials in the United States
however, is just as effective and results in a speedier (Harvard Mental Health Letter, 2002).
withdrawal (Lehne, 2001). Clonidine (Catapres) is an alpha-2-adrenergic ag-
Disulfiram (Antabuse) may be prescribed to help onist used to treat hypertension. It is given to clients
to deter clients from drinking. If a client taking disul- with opiate dependence to suppress some effects of
firam drinks alcohol, a severe adverse reaction occurs withdrawal or abstinence. It is most effective against
with flushing, a throbbing headache, sweating, nau- nausea, vomiting, and diarrhea but produces modest
sea, and vomiting. In severe cases, severe hypoten- relief from muscle aches, anxiety, and restlessness
sion, confusion, coma, and even death may result (see (Lehne, 2001).
Chap. 2). The client also must avoid a wide variety of Odansetron (Zofran), a 5-HT3 antagonist that
products that contain alcohol such as cough syrup, lo- blocks the vagal stimulation effects of serotonin in the
tions, mouthwash, perfume, aftershave, vinegar, and small intestine, is used as an antiemetic. It has been
vanilla and other extracts. The client must read prod- used in young males at high risk for alcohol depen-
420 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Table 17-1
DRUGS USED FOR SUBSTANCE ABUSE TREATMENT
Drug Use Dosage Nursing Considerations
lorazepam Alcohol withdrawal 24 mg every 24 hours Monitor vital signs and global
(Ativan) prn assessments for effectiveness;
may cause dizziness or
drowsiness
chlordiazepoxide Alcohol withdrawal 50100 mg, repeat in Monitor vital signs and global
(Librium) 24 hours if necessary; assessments for effectiveness;
not to exceed may cause dizziness or
300 mg/day drowsiness
disulfiram Maintain abstinence from 500 mg/day for 12 weeks, Teach client to read labels to
(Antabuse) alcohol then 250 mg/day avoid products with alcohol
methadone Maintain abstinence from Up to 120 mg/day for May cause nausea and vomiting
(Dolophine) heroin maintenance
levomethadyl Maintain abstinence from 6090 mg 3 times a week Do not take drug on consecutive
(ORLAAM) opiates for maintenance days; take-home doses are not
permitted
naltrexone Blocks the effects of 350 mg/week, divided Client may not respond to nar-
(ReVia, Trexan) opiates; reduces alcohol into 3 doses for opiate- cotics used to treat cough,
cravings blocking effect; diarrhea, or pain; take with
50 mg/day for up to food or milk; may cause
12 weeks for alcohol headache, restlessness,
cravings or irritability
clonidine Suppresses opiate 0.1 mg every 6 hours prn Take blood pressure before each
(Catapres) withdrawal symptoms dose; withhold if client is
hypotensive
thiamine Prevent or treat Wernicke- 100 mg/day Teach client about proper
(vitamin B1) Korsakoff syndrome in nutrition
alcoholism
Folic acid Treat nutritional 12 mg/day Teach client about proper
(folate) deficiencies nutrition; urine may be dark
yellow
Cyanocobalamin Treat nutritional 25250 mcg/day Teach client about proper
(vitamin B12) deficiencies nutrition
dence or with early-onset alcohol dependence. It is also not be possible for the client who needs
in clinical trials for treatment of methamphetamine psychotropic drugs to treat his or her
addiction (Psychopharmacology Update, 2002). mental illness.
The concept of limited recovery is more
acceptable in the treatment of psychiatric ill-
Dual Diagnosis nesses, but substance abuse has no limited
The client with both substance abuse and another psy- recovery concept.
chiatric illness is said to have a dual diagnosis. Dual The notion of lifelong abstinence, which is
diagnosis clients who have schizophrenia, schizoaffec- central to substance use treatment, may
tive disorder, or bipolar disorder present the greatest seem overwhelming and impossible to the
challenge to health care professionals. It is estimated client who lives day to day with a chronic
that 50% of people with a substance abuse disorder mental illness.
also have a mental health diagnosis (Jaffe, 2000c). The use of alcohol and other drugs can
Traditional methods of treatment for major psychi- precipitate psychotic behavior; this makes it
atric illness or primary substance abuse often have difficult for professionals to identify whether
little success in these clients for the following reasons: symptoms are the result of active mental
Clients with a major psychiatric illness may illness or substance abuse.
have impaired abilities to process abstract Some have suggested that dual diagnosis clients
concepts; this is a major barrier in substance present challenges that traditional settings cannot
abuse programs. meet. Only a few units specialize in the treatment of
Substance use treatment emphasizes avoid- dual diagnosis clients, and their work is demanding
ance of all psychoactive drugs. This may with a high rate of recidivism. Only treatment that is
17 SUBSTANCE ABUSE 421
dually focused, however, has been shown to have any The Alcohol Use Disorders Identification Test
type of success (Drake et al., 2001; Magura, Laudet, (AUDIT) is a useful screening device to detect haz-
Mahmood, Rosenblum & Knight, 2002). Research and ardous drinking patterns that may be precursors to
funding are needed to develop more effective methods full-blown substance use disorders (Bohn, Babor &
of treatment. Kranzler, 1995). This tool (Box 17-5) promotes recog-
nition of problem drinking in the early stage, when
resolution without formal treatment is more likely
APPLICATION OF THE (Cloud & Granfield, 2001). Early detection and treat-
NURSING PROCESS ment are associated with more positive outcomes.
Identifying people with substance use problems can Detoxification is the initial priority. A nursing
be difficult. Substance use typically includes the use care plan for the client in alcohol withdrawal is in-
of defense mechanisms especially denial. Clients cluded at the end of this chapter. Priorities for indi-
may deny directly having any problems or may mini- vidual clients are based on their physical needs and
mize the extent of problems or actual substance use. may include safety, nutrition, fluids, elimination,
In addition, the nurse may encounter clients with and sleep. The remainder of this section will focus on
substance problems in various settings unrelated to care of the client being treated for substance abuse
mental health. A client may come to a clinic for treat- after detoxification.
ment of medical problems related to alcohol use, or a
client may develop withdrawal symptoms while in Assessment
the hospital for surgery or an unrelated condition.
HISTORY
The nurse must be alert to the possibility of substance
use in these situations and prepared to recognize Clients with a parent or other family members with
their existence and to make appropriate referrals. substance abuse problems may report a chaotic fam-
Box 17-5
ALCOHOL USE DISORDER IDENTIFICATION TEST (AUDIT)
The following questionnaire will give you an indication of the level of risk associated with your current drinking pat-
tern. To accurately assess your situation, you will need to be honest in your answers. This questionnaire was devel-
oped by the World Health Organization and is used in many countries to assist people to better understand their cur-
rent level of risk in relation to alcohol consumption.
1. How often do you have a drink containing alcohol? (0) Never, (1) Monthly or less, (2) 2 to 4 times a month,
(3) 2 to 3 times a week, (4) 4 or more times a week.
2. How many standard drinks do you have on a typical day when you are drinking? (0) 1 or 2, (1) 3 or 4, (2) 5 or
6, (3) 7 to 9, (4) 10 or more.
3. How often do you have six or more drinks on one occasion? (0) Never, (1) Less than monthly, (2) Monthly,
(3) Weekly, (4) Daily or almost daily.
4. How often during the last year have you found that you were not able to stop drinking once you had started?
(0) Never, (1) Less than monthly, (2) Monthly, (3) Weekly, (4) Daily or almost daily.
5. How often during the past year have you failed to do what was normally expected of you because of drink-
ing? (0) Never, (1) Less than monthly, (2) Monthly, (3) Weekly, (4) Daily or almost daily.
6. How often during the last year have you needed a drink in the morning to get yourself going after a heavy
drinking session? (0) Never, (1) Less than monthly, (2) Monthly, (3) Weekly, (4) Daily or almost daily.
7. How often during the last year have you had a feeling of guilt or remorse after drinking? (0) Never, (1) Less
than monthly, (2) Monthly, (3) Weekly, (4) Daily or almost daily.
8. How often during the last year have you been unable to remember what happened the night before because
you had been drinking? (0) Never, (1) Less than monthly, (2) Monthly, (3) Weekly, (4) Daily or almost daily.
9. Have you or someone else been injured as a result of your drinking? (0) Never, (1) Less than monthly,
(2) Monthly, (3) Weekly, (4) Daily or almost daily.
10. Has a relative, a doctor, or other health worker been concerned about your drinking or suggested that you cut
down? (0) No, (2) Yes, but not in the last year, (4) Yes, during the last year.
Adapted from Babor, T., de la Fuente, J. R., Saunders, J., Grant. (1992). Alcohol Use Disorders Identification Test (AUDIT): Guide-
lines for use in primary health care. World Health Organization, Geneva. Used with permission. Bohn, Babor & Kranzler (1995).
422 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
ily life, although this is not always the case. They gen- unaffected by the situation especially if they are still
erally describe some crisis that precipitated entry in denial about the substance use.
into treatment such as physical problems or develop-
ment of withdrawal symptoms while being treated for
another condition. Usually other people such as an THOUGHT PROCESS AND CONTENT
employer threatening loss of a job or a spouse or part- During assessment of thought process and content,
ner threatening loss of a relationship, are involved in clients are likely to minimize their substance use,
a clients decision to seek treatment. Rarely do clients blame others for their problems, and rationalize their
decide to seek treatment independently with no out- behavior. They may think they cannot survive with-
side influence. out the substance or may express no desire to do so.
They may focus their attention on finances, legal is-
sues, or employment problems as the main source
GENERAL APPEARANCE AND
MOTOR BEHAVIOR of difficulty, rather than their substance use. They
may believe that they can quit on their own if they
Assessment of general appearance and behavior usu-
ally reveals appearance and speech to be normal.
Clients may appear anxious, tired, and disheveled if
they have just completed a difficult course of detoxifi-
SYMPTOMS OF SUBSTANCE ABUSE
cation. Depending on their overall health status and
any health problems resulting from substance use, Denial of problems
clients may appear physically ill. Most clients are Minimizes use of substance
Rationalization
somewhat apprehensive about treatment, may resent
Blaming others for problems
being in treatment, or feel pressured by others to be Anxiety
there. This may be the first time in a long time that Irritability
clients have had to deal with any difficulty without Impulsivity
the help of a psychoactive substance. Feelings of guilt and sadness or anger and
resentment
Poor judgment
MOOD AND AFFECT Limited insight
Wide ranges of mood and affect are possible. Some Low self-esteem
Ineffective coping strategies
clients are sad and tearful, expressing guilt and re-
Difficulty expressing genuine feelings
morse for their behavior and circumstances. Others Impaired role performance
may be angry and sarcastic or quiet and sullen, un- Strained interpersonal relationships
willing to talk to the nurse. Irritability is common be- Physical problems such as sleep disturbances
cause clients are newly free of substances. Clients and inadequate nutrition
may be pleasant and seemingly happy, appearing
17 SUBSTANCE ABUSE 423
wanted to and they continue to deny or minimize the from intravenous drug use, or lung or neurologic dam-
extent of the problem. age from using inhalants.
about how others perceive their interaction or ability pleted treatment. Still others seek individual or fam-
to listen. ily counseling. In addition to formal aftercare, the
The nurse also can help clients to find ways to re- nurse also may encounter recovering clients in a clinic
lieve stress or anxiety that do not involve substance or physicians office.
use. Relaxation, exercise, listening to music, or en-
gaging in activities may be effective. Clients also may
MENTAL HEALTH PROMOTION
need to develop new social activities or leisure pur-
suits if most of their friends or habits of socializing A person only has to watch television or read a mag-
involved the use of substances. azine to see many advertisements targeted at the pro-
The nurse can help clients to focus on the present motion of responsible drinking or encouraging par-
not the past. It is not helpful for clients to dwell on ents to be an antidrug for their children. Increasing
past problems and regrets. Rather, they must focus on public awareness and educational advertising have
what they can do now regarding their behavior or re- not made any significant change in the rates of sub-
lationships. Clients may need support from the nurse stance abuse in the United States (National Institute
to view life and sobriety in feasible termstaking it for Mental Health, 2002). Two populations currently
one day at a time. The nurse can encourage clients to identified for prevention programs are older adults
set attainable goals such as What can I do today to and college-aged adults.
stay sober? instead of feeling overwhelmed by think- Menninger (2002) describes drinking problems
ing, How can I avoid substances for the rest of my among older adults as falling into two distinct pat-
life? Clients need to believe that they can succeed. terns: early-onset alcoholism (two-thirds)clients
who have been drinking all their lives; and late onset-
alcoholism (one-third)clients who develop alcohol-
Evaluation ism late in life. Late-onset alcoholism is usually milder
The effectiveness of substance abuse treatment is and more amenable to treatment, yet health care
based heavily on the clients abstinence from sub- professionals overlook it more frequently. Menninger
stances. In addition, successful treatment should re- suggests use of a screening tool, such as AUDIT, in
sult in more stable role performance, improved inter- all primary care settings to promote early identifica-
personal relationships, and increased satisfaction tion of older adults with alcoholism. He believes that
with quality of life. brief intervention at an early stage will arrest or pre-
vent the development of late-onset alcoholism in this
population.
COMMUNITY-BASED CARE The College Drinking Prevention Program, which
Many people receiving treatment for substance abuse is government-sponsored, is a response to some of the
do so in community-based settings such as outpatient following statistics about college students between 18
treatment, freestanding substance abuse treatment and 24 years of age (National Institute on Alcohol
facilities, and recovery programs such as AA and Ra- Abuse and Alcoholism, 2002):
tional Recovery. Follow-up or aftercare for clients in 1400 students die annually from alcohol-
the community is based on the clients preferences or related unintentional injuries.
the programs available. Some clients remain active in 500,000 students are unintentionally injured
self-help groups. Others attend aftercare program while under the influence of alcohol.
600,000 students are assaulted by another
sessions sponsored by the agency where they com-
student under the influence of alcohol.
70,000 students are victims of alcohol-
related assault or date rape.
25% of students report academic conse-
NURSING INTERVENTIONS FOR quences of their drinking.
CLIENTS WITH SUBSTANCE ABUSE This prevention program was designed to help college
students avoid the predictable or expected binge
Health teaching for the client and family
Dispel myths surrounding substance abuse
drinking common at U.S. colleges and universities.
Decrease codependent behaviors among family Some campuses offer alcohol and drug-free dormito-
members ries for students, and some college-wide activities no
Make appropriate referrals for family members longer allow alcohol to be served. Educational pro-
Promote coping skills grams (about the above statistics) are designed to
Role-play potentially difficult situations raise student awareness about excessive drinking.
Focus on the here-and-now with clients Students who wish to abstain from alcohol are en-
Set realistic goals such as staying sober today couraged to socialize together and to provide support
to one another for this lifestyle choice.
426 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
SUBSTANCE ABUSE IN
HEALTH PROFESSIONALS SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES
Physicians, dentists, and nurses have far higher rates The nurse must examine his or her be-
of dependence on controlled substances, such as liefs and attitudes about substance abuse. A history of
opioids, stimulants, and sedatives, than other profes- substance use in the nurses family can influence
sionals of comparable educational achievement such strongly his or her interaction with clients. The nurse
as lawyers. One reason is thought to be the ease of ob- may be overly harsh and critical, telling the client that
taining controlled substances (Jaffe, 2000c). Health he or she should realize how youre hurting your fam-
care professionals also have higher rates of alcoholism ily. Conversely the nurse may unknowingly act out
than the general population. old family roles and engage in enabling behavior such
The issue of reporting colleagues with suspected as sympathizing with the clients reasons for using
substance abuse is an important and extremely sen- substances. Examining ones own substance use or the
sitive one. It is difficult for colleagues and supervisors use by close friends and family may be difficult and
to report their peers for suspected abuse. Nurses may unpleasant but is necessary if the nurse is to have
therapeutic relationships with clients.
hesitate to report suspected behaviors for several rea-
The nurse also might have different attitudes
sons: they have difficulty believing that a trained
about various substances of abuse. For example, a
health care professional would engage in abuse, they
nurse may have empathy for clients who are addicted
may feel guilty or fear falsely accusing someone, or
to prescription medication but disgusted by clients
they may simply want to avoid conflict. Substance
who use heroin or other illegal substances. It is im-
abuse by health professionals is very serious, how-
portant to remember that the treatment process and
ever, because it can endanger clients. Nurses have an
underlying issues of substance abuse, remission, and
ethical responsibility to report suspicious behavior
relapse are quite similar regardless of the substance.
to a supervisor and in some states a legal obligation
Many clients experience periodic relapses. For
as defined in the states nurse practice act. Nurses
some, being sober is a life-long struggle. The nurse
should not try to handle such situations alone by
may become cynical or pessimistic when clients return
warning the coworker; this often just allows the for multiple attempts at substance use treatment.
coworker to continue to abuse the substance without Such thoughts as he deserves health problems if he
suffering any repercussions. keeps drinking or she should expect to get hepatitis
General warning signs of abuse include poor or HIV infection if she keeps doing IV drugs are signs
work performance, frequent absenteeism, unusual that the nurse has some self-awareness problems that
behavior, slurred speech, and isolation from peers. will prevent him or her from working effectively with
More specific behaviors that might indicate sub- clients and their families.
stance abuse include the following:
Incorrect drug counts
Excessive controlled substances listed as Points to Consider When Working
wasted or contaminated With Clients and Families With
Reports by clients of ineffective pain relief Substance Abuse Problems
from medications especially if relief had been Remember that substance abuse is a chronic,
adequate previously recurring disease for many people, just like
Damaged or torn packaging on controlled diabetes or heart disease. Even though
substances clients look like they should be able to con-
Increased reports of pharmacy error trol their substance abuse easily, they cannot
Consistent offers to obtain controlled without assistance and understanding.
substances from pharmacy Examine substance abuse problems in your
Unexplained absences from the unit own family and friends even though it may
Trips to the bathroom after contact with be painful. Recognizing your own back-
controlled substances ground, beliefs, and attitudes is the first step
Consistent early arrivals at or late depar- toward managing those feelings effectively so
tures from work for no apparent reason they do not interfere with the care of clients
Nurses can become involved in substance abuse just and families.
as any other person might. Nurses with abuse prob- Approach each treatment experience with an
lems deserve the opportunity for treatment and re- open and objective attitude. The client may
covery as well. Reporting suspected substance abuse be successful in maintaining abstinence after
could be the crucial first step toward a nurse getting his or her second or third (or more) treat-
the help he or she needs. ment experience.
17 SUBSTANCE ABUSE 427
Nursing Diagnosis
Ineffective Coping
Inability to form a valid appraisal of the stressors, inadequate choices of practiced
responses, and/or inability to use available resources.
Stabilization
The client will
Demonstrate appropriate or adequate
social skills
Identify social activities in drug- and
alcohol-free environments
Assess own strengths and weak-
nesses realistically
Community
The client will
Maintain contact or relationship
with a professional in the community
Verbalize plans to join a community
support group that meets the needs
of clients with a dual diagnosis, if
available
Participate in drug- and alcohol-free
programs and activities
IMPLEMENTATION
Validate the clients frustration or anger in deal- Expressing feelings outwardly, especially negative
ing with dual problems (e.g. I know this must be ones, may relieve some of the clients stress and
very difficult.). anxiety.
Consider alcohol or substance use as a factor that For the client with a dual diagnosis, substance
influences the clients ability to live in the com- use is not necessarily the major problem he or she
munity, as you would other factors such as taking experiences; it may be only one of several prob-
medications, keeping appointments, having ade- lems. Overemphasis on any single factor, even
quate eating and sleeping patterns, and so forth. substance use, is not a guarantee of success.
Maintain frequent contact with the client even if Frequent contact decreases the length of time the
it is only brief telephone calls. client feels stranded or left alone to deal with
problems.
Give positive feedback for abstinence on a day-by- Positive feedback reinforces abstinent behavior.
day basis.
If drinking or substance use occurs, discuss the The client may be able to see the relatedness of
events that led to the incident with the client in a the events or a pattern of behavior while dis-
nonjudgmental manner. cussing the situation.
Discuss ways to avoid similar circumstances in Anticipatory planning may prepare the client to
the future. avoid similar circumstances in the future.
Assess the amount of unstructured time with The client is more likely to experience frustration
which the client must cope. or dissatisfaction, which can lead to substance
use when he or she has excessive amounts of
unstructured time.
Assist the client to plan weekly or even daily Scheduled events provide the client with some-
schedules of purposeful activities: errands, thing to anticipate or look forward to doing.
appointments, taking walks, and so forth.
Writing the schedule on a calendar may be Visualization of the schedule provides a concrete
beneficial. reference for the client.
Recording a journal of activities, feelings, and A journal can provide a focus for the client and
thoughts may be helpful to the client. can yield information that is useful in future
planning. The client also may record information
that would otherwise be forgotten or overlooked.
Teach the client social skills. Describe and The client may have little or no knowledge of
demonstrate specific skills such as eye contact, social interaction skills. Modeling the skills
attentive listening, nodding, and so forth. Discuss provides a concrete example of the desired skills.
the kind of topics that are appropriate for social
conversation such as the weather, news, local
events, and so forth.
Give positive support to the client for appropriate Positive feedback will encourage the client to
use of social skills. continue socialization attempts and enhance
self-esteem.
*Refer the client to volunteer or vocational Purposeful activity makes better use of the
services if indicated. clients unstructured time and can enhance the
clients feelings of worth and self-esteem.
*Refer the client to community support services Problems for clients who have dual diagnosis are
that address mental health and substance complicated and long-term, requiring ongoing and
dependence-related needs. extended assistance.
430 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
Al-Anon/Alateen http://www.al-anon.org/
Jaffe, J. H. (2000a). Amphetamine (or amphetamine-like) Researchers examine odansetron for methamphetamine
related disorders. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock treatment. (2002). Alcoholism & Drug Abuse Weekly,
(Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1 1435, 34.
(7th ed., pp. 971982). Philadelphia: Lippincott Schuckit, M. A. (2000). Alcohol-related disorders. In B. J.
Williams & Wilkins. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive text-
Jaffe, J. H. (2000c). Substance-related disorders: intro- book of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 953971).
duction and overview. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
(Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1 Slutske, W. S., Heaht, A. C., Madden, P. A. F., Bucholz,
(7th ed., pp. 924952). Philadelphia: Lippincott K. K., Statham, D. J., & Martin, N. G. (2002).
Williams & Wilkins. Personality and the genetic risk for alcohol
Jaffe, J. H., & Jaffe, A. B. (2000). Opioid-related disorders. dependence. Journal of Abnormal Psychology,
In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive 111(1), 124133.
textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 10381169). Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Adminis-
Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins. tration. (1997). National household survey on drug
Lehne, R. A. (2001). Pharmacology for nursing care abuse. United States Department of Health and
(4th ed.). Philadelphia: W. B. Saunders. Human Services.
Macfadden, W., & Woody, G. E. (2000). Cannabis-related Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Adminis-
disorders. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), tration. (2002). Statistics for alcoholism & drug
Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., dependency. United States Department of Health
pp. 990999). Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & and Human Services. Document available: http://
Wilkins. www.alcoholism.vg/alcohol_statistics.html
Magura, S., Laudet, A. B., Mahmood, D., Rosenblum, A., Voth, E. A., & Schwartz, R. H. (1997). Medicinal applica-
& Knight, E. (2002). Adherence to medication tions of delta-9-tetrahydrocannabinol and marijuana.
regimens and participation in dual-focus self-help Annals of Internal Medicine, 126(10), N791N798.
groups. Psychiatric Services, 53(3), 310316. Zepf, B. (2002) Use of naltrexone to maintain sobriety in
Menninger, J. A. (2002). Assessment and treatment of alcoholics. American Family Physician, 65(7), 1432.
alcoholism and substance-related disorders in the
elderly. Bulletin of the Menninger Clinic, 66(2),
166183. ADDITIONAL READINGS
Milne, D. (2002). Alcohol consumption in Japan.
Canadian Medical Association Journal, 167(4), 388. Jersild, D. (2002). Alcohol in the vulnerable lives of col-
National Institute on Alcohol Abuse and Alcoholism. lege women. Chronicle of Higher Education, 48(38),
(2000). Alcohol and minorities. Document available: B10B11.
http://www.niaaa.nih.gov/ Migdole, S. (2002). Dual-diagnosis program guidelines
National Institute on Alcohol Abuse and Alcoholism. focus on making gradual progress. Behavioral Health
(2002). A snapshot of high-risk college drinking Accreditations & Accountability Alert, 7(4), 13.
consequences. Document available: http://www. Wills, T. A., Sandy, J. M., Yaeger, A. M., Cleary, S. D., &
collegedrinkingprevention.gov Shinar, O. (2001). Coping dimensions, life stress, and
Onishchenko, G. (2002). Latest figures on alcohol poison- adolescent substance use: A latent growth analysis.
ing highlight one aspect of Russias dismal health Journal of Abnormal Psychology, 110(2), 309323.
situation. Current Digest of the Post Soviet Press, Zukin, S. R. (2000). Phencyclidine (or phencyclidine-like)
54(5), 2326. related disorders. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock
Psychopharmacology Update (2002). Researchers exam- (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1
ine odansetron for methamphetamine treatment. (7th ed., pp. 10631071). Philadelphia: Lippincott
Psychopharmacology Update, 13(11), 1, 4. Williams & Wilkins.
Chapter
ChapterStudy
Review
Guide
MULTIPLE-CHOICE QUESTIONS
Select the best answer for each of the following
questions.
1. Which of the following statements would indicate 5. The Twelve Steps of AA teach that
that teaching about naltrexone (ReVia) has been
effective? A. Acceptance of being an alcoholic will prevent
urges to drink.
A. Ill get sick if I use heroin while taking this
medication. B. A Higher Power will protect individuals if
they feel like drinking.
B. This medication will block the effects of any
opioid substance I take. C. Once a person has learned to be sober, he or
she can graduate and leave AA.
C. If I use opioids while taking naltrexone, Ill
become extremely ill. D. Once a person is sober, he or she remains at
risk to drink.
D. Using naltrexone may make me dizzy.
6. The nurse has provided an in-service program on
2. Clonidine (Catapres) is prescribed for symptoms impaired professionals. She knows that teaching
of opioid withdrawal. Which of the following has been effective when staff identify the follow-
nursing assessments is essential before giving a ing as the greatest risk for substance abuse
dose of this medication? among professionals:
A. Assess the clients blood pressure. A. Most nurses are codependent in their personal
B. Determine when the client last used an opiate. and professional relationships.
C. Monitor the client for tremors. B. Most nurses come from dysfunctional fami-
lies and are at risk for developing addiction.
D. Complete a thorough physical assessment.
C. Most nurses are exposed to various substances
3. Which of the following would the nurse recognize and believe they are not at risk to develop the
as signs of alcohol withdrawal? disease.
A. Coma, disorientation, and hypervigilance D. Most nurses have preconceived ideas about
what kind of people become addicted.
B. Tremulousness, sweating, and elevated blood
pressure 7. A client comes to day treatment intoxicated, but
C. Increased temperature, lethargy, and says he is not. The nurse identifies that the
hypothermia client is exhibiting symptoms of
D. Talkativeness, hyperactivity, and blackouts A. Denial
B. Reaction formation
4. Which of the following behaviors would indicate
stimulant intoxication? C. Projection
A. Slurred speech, unsteady gait, impaired D. Transference
concentration
8. The client tells the nurse that she takes a drink
B. Hyperactivity, talkativeness, euphoria every morning to calm her nerves and stops her
C. Relaxed inhibitions, increased appetite, tremors. The nurse realizes the client is at risk for
distorted perceptions A. An anxiety disorder
D. Depersonalization, dilated pupils, visual B. A neurological disorder
hallucinations
C. Physical dependence
D. Psychological addiction
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com
432
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Give two examples of drugs for each of the following categories.
Stimulants
Opioids
Hallucinogens
Inhalants
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
1. List four behaviors that might lead the nurse to suspect another health
care professional of substance abuse.
433
CLINICAL EXAMPLE
Sharon, 43 years of age, is attending an outpatient treatment program for
alcohol abuse. She is divorced, and her two children live with their father.
Sharon broke up with her boyfriend of 3 years just last week. She recently was
arrested for the second time for driving while intoxicated, which is why she is
in this treatment program. Sharon tells anyone who will listen that she is not
an alcoholic but is in this program only to avoid serving time in jail.
434
18 Eating
Disorders
Learning Objectives
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
435
436 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Eating is part of everyday life. It is necessary for much overlap among the eating disorders: 30% to 35%
survival, but it is also a social activity and part of of normal-weight people with bulimia have a history
many happy occasions. People go out for dinner, invite of anorexia nervosa and low body weight and about
friends and family for meals in their homes, and cel- 50% of people with anorexia nervosa exhibit bulimic
ebrate special events such as marriages, holidays, behavior (Kaye, Klump, Frank, & Strober, 2000). The
and birthdays with food. Yet for some people, eating distinguishing features of anorexia include an earlier
is a source of worry and anxiety. Are they eating too age of onset and below-normal body weight; the per-
much? Do they look fat? Is some new weight-loss pro- son fails to recognize the eating behavior as a problem.
motion going to be the answer? Clients with bulimia have a later age of onset and
Obesity has been identified as a major health near-normal body weight. They usually are ashamed
problem in the United States; some call it an epidemic. and embarrassed by the eating behavior.
The number of obesity-related illnesses among children More than 90% of cases of anorexia nervosa
has increased dramatically (Wang & Dietz, 2002). At and bulimia occur in females (American Psychiatric
the same time, millions of women are either starving Association [APA], 2000). Although fewer men than
themselves or engaging in chaotic eating patterns that women suffer from eating disorders, the number of
can lead to death. men with anorexia or bulimia may be much higher
This chapter focuses on anorexia nervosa and than previously believed (Woodside et al., 2002). Men,
bulimia nervosa, the two most common eating dis- however, are less likely to seek treatment. The preva-
orders found in the mental health setting. It discusses lence of both eating disorders is estimated to be 1%
strategies for early identification and prevention of to 3% of the general population in the United States
these disorders. (Halmi, 2000).
their weight. Clients with the restricting subtype family or friends. A profound sense of emptiness is
lose weight primarily through dieting, fasting, or ex- common.
cessively exercising. Those with the binge eating and As the illness progresses, depression and lability
purging subtype engage regularly in binge eating fol- in mood become more apparent. As dieting and com-
lowed by purging. Binge eating means consuming a pulsive behaviors increase, clients isolate themselves.
large amount of food (far greater than most people This social isolation can lead to a basic mistrust of
eat at one time) in a discrete period of usually 2 hours others and even paranoia. Clients may believe that
or less. Purging means the compensatory behaviors their peers are jealous of their weight loss and may
designed to eliminate food by means of self-induced think that family and health care professionals are
vomiting or misuse of laxatives, enemas, and diuret- trying to make them fat and ugly.
ics. Some clients with anorexia do not binge but still In a long-term outcome study of clients with
engage in purging behaviors after ingesting small anorexia nervosa, Zipfel, Lowe, Reas, Deter & Herzog
amounts of food. (2000) found that after 21 years, 50% had recovered
Clients with anorexia become totally absorbed in fully, 25% had intermediate outcomes, 10% still met
their quest for weight loss and thinness. The term all the criteria for anorexia nervosa, and 15% had
anorexia is actually a misnomer: these clients do died of anorexia-related causes. In another study,
not lose their appetites. They still experience hunger clients with the lowest body weights and longest
but ignore it and signs of physical weakness and fa- durations of illness tended to relapse most often and
tigue; they often believe that if they eat anything, have the poorest outcomes (Herzog, Dorer & Keel,
they will not be able to stop eating and will become 1999). Clients who abuse laxatives are at a greater risk
fat. Clients with anorexia often are preoccupied with for medical complications (Turner, Batik & Palmer,
food-related activities such as grocery shopping, col- 2000). Table 18-1 lists common medical complications
lecting recipes or cookbooks, counting calories, creat- of eating disorders.
ing fat-free meals, and cooking family meals. They
also may engage in unusual or ritualistic food be-
haviors such as refusing to eat around others, cutting Bulimia Nervosa
food into minute pieces, or not allowing the food they Bulimia nervosa, often simply called bulimia, is an
eat to touch their lips. These behaviors increase their eating disorder characterized by recurrent episodes
sense of control. Excessive exercise is common; it (at least twice a week for 3 months) of binge eating
may occupy several hours a day. followed by inappropriate compensatory behaviors to
Anorexia nervosa typically begins between 14 to avoid weight gain such as purging (self-induced vom-
18 years of age. In the early stages, clients often deny iting or use of laxatives, diuretics, enemas, or emet-
that they have anxiety regarding their appearance or ics), fasting, or excessively exercising (APA, 2000).
a negative body image. They are very pleased with The amount of food consumed during a binge episode
their ability to control their weight and may express is much larger than a person would normally eat.
this. When they initially come for treatment, they The client often engages in binge eating secretly. Be-
may be unable to identify or to explain their emotions tween binges, the client may eat low-calorie foods or
about life events such as school or relationships with fast. Binging or purging episodes are often precipi-
Table 18-1
MEDICAL COMPLICATIONS OF EATING DISORDERS
Body System Symptoms
About 50% of clients with bulimia recover fully, obsessive-compulsive disorder (26%), and social phobia
20% continue to meet all the criteria for the disease, (34%). Personality disorders also are prevalent: 25%
and 30% have episodic bouts of bulimia. One-third of of clients with the restricting type of anorexia have
fully recovered clients have a relapse. Clients with a cluster C anxious personality traits, and 40% of clients
comorbid personality disorder tend to have poorer with the binge and purge type have cluster B impulsive
outcomes than those without. The death rate from personality traits. Clients with bulimia have comor-
bulimia is estimated at 3% or less. bid psychiatric diagnoses of major depressive disorder
(36% to 70%), substance abuse (18% to 32%), and per-
sonality disorders (28% to 77%) that are primarily
Related Disorders
cluster B impulsive personality traits (Halmi, 2000).
Eating disorders usually first diagnosed in infancy and Eating disorders, particularly bulimia, often are
childhood include rumination disorder, pica, and feed- linked to a history of sexual abuse (Redford, 2001).
ing disorder (see Chap. 20). Common elements in Such a history may be a factor contributing to prob-
clients with these disorders are family dysfunction and lems with intimacy, sexual attractiveness, and low
parentchild conflicts (Patel, Phillips & Pratt, 1998). interest in sexual activity. Matsunaga et al. (1999)
Binge eating disorder is listed as a research cat- studied women recovering from bulimia and found
egory in DSM-IV-TR, 2000; it is being investigated that those with a history of physical or sexual abuse
to determine its classification as a mental disorder. had increased rates of borderline personality dis-
The essential features are recurrent episodes of binge order and posttraumatic stress disorder and more
eating; no regular use of inappropriate compensatory severe core eating disorder symptoms such as drive
behaviors such as purging or excessive exercise or for thinness, body dissatisfaction, and ineffectiveness.
abuse of laxatives; guilt, shame, and disgust about Whether or not sexual abuse has a cause-and-effect
eating behaviors; and marked psychological distress relationship with the development of eating dis-
(Costin, 2002). Clients are more likely to be overweight orders, however, remains unclear.
or obese, overweight as children, and teased about
their weight at an early age. Thirty-five percent re-
ported that binge eating preceded dieting; 65% re- ETIOLOGY
ported dieting before binge eating (Grilo & Masheb,
A specific cause for eating disorders is unknown. Ini-
2000).
Night eating syndrome (NES) is characterized by tially dieting may be the stimulus that leads to their
morning anorexia, evening hyperphagia (consuming development. Biologic vulnerability, developmental
50% of daily calories after the last evening meal), problems, and family and social influences can turn
and nighttime awakenings (at least once a night) to dieting into an eating disorder (Table 18-2). Psycho-
consume snacks. It is associated with life stress, low logical and physiologic reinforcement of maladaptive
self-esteem, anxiety, depression, and adverse reac- eating behavior sustains the cycle (Halmi, 2000).
tions to weight loss. Most people with NES are obese
(Gluck, 2002). Biologic Factors
Comorbid psychiatric disorders are common in
clients with anorexia nervosa and bulimia nervosa. Studies of anorexia nervosa and bulimia nervosa have
Clients with anorexia nervosa have a high rate of shown that these disorders tend to run in families.
major depression (68%), anxiety disorders (65%), Grise & Kaye (2002) found a genetic susceptibility for
Table 18-2
RISK FACTORS FOR EATING DISORDERS
Developmental Sociocultural
Disorder Biologic Risk Factors Risk Factors Family Risk Factors Risk Factors
Anorexia nervosa Obesity; dieting at Issues of developing Family lacks emo- Cultural ideal of
an early age autonomy and tional support; being thin; media
having control parental maltreat- focus on beauty,
over self and envi- ment; cannot deal thinness, fitness;
ronment; develop- with conflict preoccupation
ing a unique iden- with achieving the
tity; dissatisfaction ideal body
with body image
Bulimia nervosa Obesity; early dieting; Self-perceptions of Chaotic family with Same as above;
possible serotonin being overweight, loose boundaries; weight-related
and norepineph- fat, unattractive, parental maltreat- teasing
rine disturbances; and undesirable; ment including
chromosome 1 dissatisfaction possible physical
susceptibility with body image or sexual abuse
anorexia nervosa on chromosome 1. Genetic vulner- Increased levels of the neurotransmitter sero-
ability also might result from a particular personal- tonin and its precursor tryptophan have been linked
ity type or a general susceptibility to psychiatric dis- with increased satiety. Low levels of serotonin as
orders. Or it may directly involve a dysfunction of well as low platelet levels of monoamine oxidase have
the hypothalamus (Halmi, 2000). A family history of been found in clients with bulimia and the binge and
mood or anxiety disorders (e.g., obsessive-compulsive purge subtype of anorexia nervosa (Carrasco, Diaz-
disorder) places a person at risk for an eating dis- Marsa, Hollander, Cesar & Saiz-Ruiz, 2000); this
order. Wade, Bulick, Neale & Kendler (2000) attrib- may explain binging behavior. The positive response
uted 58% of cases of anorexia nervosa to heritability of some clients with bulimia to treatment with selec-
but could not totally discount the influence of a shared tive serotonin reuptake inhibitor antidepressants
environment. supports the idea that serotonin levels at the synapse
Disruptions of the nuclei of the hypothalamus may be low in these clients.
may produce many of the symptoms of eating disor-
ders. Two sets of nuclei are particularly important in Developmental Factors
many aspects of hunger and satiety (satisfaction of
appetite): the lateral hypothalamus and the ventro- ANOREXIA NERVOSA
medial hypothalamus. Deficits in the lateral hypo- Onset of anorexia nervosa usually occurs during ado-
thalamus result in decreased eating and decreased lescence or young adulthood. Some researchers believe
responses to sensory stimuli that are important to its causes are related to developmental issues.
eating. Disruption of the ventromedial hypothalamus Two essential tasks of adolescence are the strug-
leads to excessive eating, weight gain, and decreased gle to develop autonomy and the establishment of a
responsiveness to the satiety effects of glucose, which unique identity. Autonomy, or exerting control over
are behaviors seen in bulimia. oneself and the environment, may be difficult in fam-
Many neurochemical changes accompany eating ilies that are overprotective or in which enmeshment
disorders, but it is difficult to tell whether they cause (lack of clear role boundaries) exists. Such families do
or result from eating disorders and the characteris- not support members efforts to gain independence,
tic symptoms of starvation, binging, and purging. For and teenagers may feel as though they have little or
example, norepinephrine levels rise normally in re- no control over their lives. They begin to control their
sponse to eating, allowing the body to metabolize and eating through severe dieting and thus gain control
to use nutrients. Norepinephrine levels do not rise over their weight. Losing weight becomes reinforc-
during starvation, however, because few nutrients ing: by continuing to lose, these clients exert control
are available to metabolize. Therefore, low norepi- over one aspect of their lives.
nephrine levels are seen in clients during periods of Serpell, Treasure, Teasdale & Sullivan (1999)
restricted food intake. Also, low epinephrine levels studied girls with anorexia nervosa to determine pos-
are related to the decreased heart rate and blood itive or reinforcing aspects of the disorder. Two main
pressure seen in clients with anorexia. themes were conforming to a strict diet and fitting
18 EATING DISORDERS 441
BULIMIA NERVOSA
Self-perceptions of the body can influence the de- Body image disturbance
velopment of identity in adolescence greatly. Self-
perceptions that include being overweight lead to
the belief that dieting is necessary before one can be with eating or weight in adolescence or early adult-
happy or satisfied. Brewerton, Dansky, Kilpatrick hood (Johnson, Cohen, Kasan & Brook, 2002). Ad-
& ONeil (2000) found that severe dieting (with a versity was defined as physical neglect, sexual abuse,
goal to lose 15 pounds) preceded binging behavior in or parental maltreatment that included little care,
46% of the clients, 37% reported binging behavior affection, and empathy and excessive paternal con-
before beginning any serious dieting, and 17% began trol, unfriendliness, or overprotectiveness.
binging and dieting at the same time. Clients with bu-
limia nervosa report dissatisfaction with their bodies
as well as the belief that they are fat, unattractive,
Sociocultural Factors
and undesirable. In the United States and other Western countries,
the media fuels the image of the ideal woman as
thin. The culture equates beauty, desirability, and
Family Influences ultimately happiness with being very thin, perfectly
Girls growing up amid family problems and abuse are toned, and physically fit. Adolescents often idealize
at higher risk for both anorexia and bulimia. Mazzeo actresses and models as having the perfect look or
& Espelage (2002) found that response to family con- body even though many of these celebrities are under-
flict and problems was strongly associated with dis- weight or use special effects to appear thinner than
ordered eating. Girls growing up in families without they are. Books, magazines, dietary supplements,
emotional support often try to escape their negative exercise equipment, plastic surgery advertisements,
emotions. They place an intense focus outward on and weight loss programs abound; the dieting indus-
something concrete: physical appearance. Disordered try is a billion-dollar business. The culture considers
eating becomes a distraction from emotions. being overweight a sign of laziness, lack of self-control,
Childhood adversity has been identified as a sig- or indifference; it equates pursuit of the perfect body
nificant risk factor in the development of problems with beauty, desirability, success, and will power.
442 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Thus many women speak of being good when they settings include inpatient specialty eating disorder
stick to their diet and bad when they eat desserts units, partial hospitalization or day treatment pro-
or snacks. grams, and outpatient therapy. The choice of setting
Pressure from others also may contribute eat- depends on the severity of the illness, such as weight
ing disorders. Sherwood, Neumark-Sztainer, Story, loss, physical symptoms, duration of binging and purg-
Beuhring & Resnick (2002) noted that pressure from ing, drive for thinness, body dissatisfaction, and co-
coaches, parents, and peers and the emphasis placed morbid psychiatric conditions. Major life-threatening
on body form in sports such as gymnastics, ballet, and complications that indicate the need for hospital ad-
wrestling can promote eating disorders in athletes. mission include severe fluid, electrolyte, and meta-
Parental concern over a girls weight and teasing bolic imbalances; cardiovascular complications; se-
from parents or peers reinforces a girls body dis- vere weight loss and its consequences (Muscari,
satisfaction and her need to diet or control eating in 2002); and risk for suicide. Outpatient therapy has
some way. the best success with clients who have been ill for less
than 6 months, are not binging and purging, and have
parents likely to participate effectively in family ther-
CULTURAL CONSIDERATIONS apy (Halmi, 2000).
Both anorexia nervosa and bulimia nervosa are far
more prevalent in industrialized societies, where MEDICAL MANAGEMENT
food is abundant and beauty is linked with thinness
(Patel et al., 1998). For example, before 1995 there Medical management focuses on weight restoration,
was little television on the Island of Fiji. Eating dis- nutritional rehabilitation, rehydration, and correc-
orders were almost nonexistent and being plump tion of electrolyte imbalances. Clients receive nutri-
was considered the ideal shape for girls and women. tionally balanced meals and snacks that gradually
In the 5 years following the widespread introduction increase caloric intake to a normal level for size,
of television, the number of eating disorders in Fiji age, and activity. Severely malnourished clients may
skyrocketed (Sorgen, 2002). require total parenteral nutrition, tube feedings, or
Eating disorders are most common in the United hyperalimentation to receive adequate nutritional
States, Canada, Europe, Australia, Japan, New intake. Generally, access to a bathroom is supervised
Zealand, and South Africa. Immigrants from cultures to prevent purging as clients begin to eat more food.
in which eating disorders are rare may develop eat- Weight gain and adequate food intake are most
ing disorders as they assimilate the thin-body ideal often the criteria for determining the effectiveness
(APA, 2000). of treatment.
Eating disorders appear equally common among
Hispanic and white women and less common among PSYCHOPHARMACOLOGY
African American and Asian women (Halmi, 2000).
Minority women who are younger, better educated, Several classes of drugs have been studied, but few
and more closely identified with white, middle-class have shown clinical success. Amitriptyline (Elavil)
values are at increased risk for developing an eating and the antihistamine cyproheptadine (Periactin)
disorder. in high doses (up to 28 mg/day) can promote weight
Over the past several years, eating disorders gain in inpatients with anorexia nervosa. Olanza-
have shown a staggering increase among all U.S. so- pine (Zyprexa) has been used with success because
cial classes and ethnic groups (Jacob, 2001). With of both its antipsychotic effect (on bizarre body
todays technology, the entire world is exposed to the image distortions) and associated weight gain. Flu-
Western ideal, which equates thinness with beauty oxetine (Prozac) has shown some effectiveness in
and desirability. As this ideal becomes widespread preventing relapse in clients whose weight has been
to non-Western cultures, anorexia and bulimia will partially or completely restored. Close monitoring is
likely increase there as well. needed, because weight loss can be a side effect (Zhu
& Walsh, 2002).
TREATMENT
PSYCHOTHERAPY
Anorexia Nervosa
Family therapy may be beneficial for families of clients
Clients with anorexia nervosa can be very difficult younger than 18 years. Families who demonstrate
to treat because they are often resistant, appear enmeshment, unclear boundaries among members,
uninterested, and deny their problems. Treatment and difficulty handling emotions and conflict can
18 EATING DISORDERS 443
1. Like eating with other people. _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
X
2. Prepare foods for others but do not eat
what I cook. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
3. Become anxious prior to eating. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
4. Am terrified about being overweight. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
5. Avoid eating when I am hungry. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
6. Find myself preoccupied with food. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
7. Have gone on eating binges where I feel
that I may not be able to stop. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
8. Cut food into small pieces. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
9. Aware of the calorie content of foods
that I eat. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
10. Particularly avoid foods with a high car-
bohydrate content (eg, bread, potatoes,
rice, etc.). _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
11. Feel bloated after meals. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
12. Feel that others would prefer I ate more. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
13. Vomit after I have eaten. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
14. Feel extremely guilty after eating. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
15. Am preoccupied with a desire to be
thinner. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
16. Exercise strenuously to burn off calories. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
17. Weigh myself several times a day. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
18. Like my clothes to fit tightly. _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
X
19. Enjoy eating meat. _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
X
20. Wake up early in the morning. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
21. Eat the same foods day after day. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
22. Think about burning up calories when I
exercise. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
23. Have regular menstrual periods. _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
X
24. Other people think I am too thin. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
25. Am preoccupied with the thought of
having fat on my body. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
26. Take longer than others to eat. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
27. Enjoy eating at restaurants. _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
X
28. Take laxatives. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
29. Avoid foods with sugar in them. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
30. Eat diet foods. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
31. Feel that food controls my life. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
32. Display self-control around food. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
33. Feel that others pressure me to eat. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
34. Give too much time and thought to food. _____X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
35. Suffer from constipation. _____ _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____
36. Feel uncomfortable after eating sweets. _____X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
37. Engage in dieting behavior. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
38. Like my stomach to be empty. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
39. Enjoy trying new rich foods. _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
X
40. Have impulse to vomit after meals. _____
X _____ _____ _____ _____ _____
Scoring: The patient is given the questionnaire without the Xs, just blank. 3 points are assigned to endorsements
that coincide with the Xs; the adjacent alternatives are weighted as 2 points and 1 point, respectively. A total score
of over 30 indicates significant concerns with eating behavior.
18 EATING DISORDERS 445
iors. Avoiding bad or fattening foods gives them a intake or to engage in purging despite the negative
sense of power and control over their bodies, whereas effect on health.
eating, binging, or purging leads to anxiety, depres- In contrast, clients with bulimia are ashamed of
sion, and feeling out of control. Clients with eating the binge eating and purging. They recognize these
disorders often seem sad, anxious, and worried. Those behaviors as abnormal and go to great lengths to
with anorexia seldom smile, laugh, or enjoy any at- hide them. They feel out of control and unable to
tempts at humor; they are somber and serious most of change even though they recognize their behaviors
the time. In contrast, clients with bulimia are initially as pathologic.
pleasant and cheerful as though nothing is wrong.
The pleasant faade usually disappears when they
SELF-CONCEPT
begin describing binge eating and purging; they may
express intense guilt, shame, and embarrassment. Low self-esteem is prominent in clients with eating
It is important to ask clients with eating disorders disorders. They see themselves only in terms of their
about thoughts of self-harm or suicide. It is not un- ability to control their food intake and weight. They
common for these clients to engage in self-mutilating tend to judge themselves harshly and see themselves
behaviors such as cutting. Concern about self-harm as bad if they eat certain foods or fail to lose weight.
and suicidal behavior should increase when clients They overlook or ignore other personal characteris-
have a history of sexual abuse (see Chaps. 11 and 15). tics or achievements as less important than thinness.
Clients often perceive themselves as helpless, power-
less, and ineffective. This feeling of lack of control over
THOUGHT PROCESSES AND CONTENT
themselves and their environment only strengthens
Clients with eating disorders spend most of the time their desire to control their weight.
thinking about dieting, food, and food-related behav-
ior. They are preoccupied with their attempts to avoid
ROLES AND RELATIONSHIPS
eating or eating bad or wrong foods. Clients can-
not think about themselves without thinking about Eating disorders interfere with the ability to fulfill
weight and food. The body image disturbance can be roles and to have satisfying relationships. Clients
almost delusional; even if clients are severely under- with anorexia may begin to fail at school, which is in
weight, they can point to areas on their buttocks or sharp contrast to previously successful academic per-
thighs that are still fat, thereby, fueling their need formance. They withdraw from peers and pay little
to continue dieting. Clients with anorexia who are attention to friendships. They believe that others will
severely underweight may have paranoid ideas about not understand or fear that they will begin out-of-
their family and health care professionals, believ- control eating with others.
ing that they are their enemies who are trying to Clients with bulimia feel great shame about their
make them fat by forcing them to eat. binge eating and purging behaviors. As a result, they
tend to lead secret lives that include sneaking behind
the backs of friends and family to binge and purge in
SENSORIUM AND
privacy. The time spent buying and eating food then
INTELLECTUAL PROCESSES
purging can interfere with role performance both at
Generally clients with eating disorders are alert and home and at work.
oriented; their intellectual functions are intact. The
exception is clients with anorexia who are severely
PHYSIOLOGIC AND SELF-CARE
malnourished and showing signs of starvation such
CONSIDERATIONS
as mild confusion, slowed mental processes, and dif-
ficulty with concentration and attention. The health status of clients with eating disorders re-
lates directly to the severity of self-starvation, purg-
ing behaviors, or both (see Table 18-1). In addition,
JUDGMENT AND INSIGHT
clients may exercise excessively, almost to the point
Clients with anorexia have very limited insight and of exhaustion, in an effort to control weight. Many
poor judgment about their health status. They do clients have sleep disturbances such as insomnia, re-
not believe that they have a problem; rather they duced sleep time, and early-morning wakening. Those
think that others are trying to interfere with their who frequently vomit have many dental problems
ability to lose weight and to achieve the desired body such as loss of tooth enamel, chipped and ragged teeth,
image. Facts about failing health status are not and dental caries. Frequent vomiting also may result
enough to convince these clients of their true prob- in sores in the mouth. Complete medical and dental
lems. Clients with anorexia continue to restrict food examinations are essential.
446 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Data Analysis
Nursing diagnoses for clients with eating disorders INTERVENTIONS FOR CLIENTS WITH
include the following: EATING DISORDERS
Imbalanced Nutrition: Less Than/More
Than Body Requirements Establishing nutritional eating patterns
Sit with the client during meals and snacks.
Ineffective Coping
Offer liquid protein supplement if unable to
Disturbed Body Image complete meal.
Other nursing diagnoses may be pertinent such as Adhere to treatment program guidelines
Deficient Fluid Volume, Constipation, Fatigue, and regarding restrictions.
Activity Intolerance. Observe client following meals and snacks
for 1 to 2 hours.
Weigh client daily in uniform clothing.
Outcome Identification Be alert for attempts to hide or discard food
For severely malnourished clients, their medical con- or inflate weight.
dition must be stabilized before psychiatric treat- Helping the client identify emotions and develop
ment can begin. Medical stabilization may include nonfood-related coping strategies
Ask the client to identify feelings.
parenteral fluids, total parenteral nutrition, and
Self-monitoring using a journal
cardiac monitoring.
Relaxation techniques
Examples of expected outcomes for clients with Distraction
eating disorders include the following: Assist client to change stereotypical beliefs.
The client will establish adequate nutritional Helping the client deal with body image issues
eating patterns. Recognize benefits of a more near-normal
The client will eliminate use of compensatory weight.
behaviors such as excessive exercise and use Assist to view self in ways not related to body
of laxatives and diuretics. image.
The client will demonstrate nonfood-related Identify personal strengths, interests, talents.
coping mechanisms. Providing client and family education (See Client
and Family Teaching)
The client will verbalize feelings of guilt,
anger, anxiety, or an excessive need for
control.
The client will verbalize acceptance of body
away from other clients. Depending on the treatment
image with stable body weight.
program, diet beverages and food substitutions may
be prohibited, and a specified time may be set for con-
Interventions suming each meal or snack. Clients also may be dis-
couraged from performing food rituals such as cutting
ESTABLISHING NUTRITIONAL
food into tiny pieces or mixing food in unusual combi-
EATING PATTERNS
nations. The nurse must be alert for any attempts by
Typically inpatient treatment is for clients with clients to hide or to discard food.
anorexia nervosa who are severely malnourished and After each meal or snack, clients may be re-
clients with bulimia whose binge eating and purging quired to remain in view of staff for 1 to 2 hours to en-
behaviors are out of control. Primary nursing roles sure that they do not empty the stomach by vomiting.
are to implement and to supervise the regimen for Some treatment programs limit client access to bath-
nutritional rehabilitation. Total parenteral nutrition rooms without supervision particularly after meals
or enteral feedings may be prescribed initially when to discourage vomiting. As clients begin to gain weight
a clients health status is severely compromised. and to become more independent in eating behavior,
When clients can eat, a diet of 1200 to 1500 calo- these restrictions are lessened gradually.
ries per day is ordered, with gradual increases in calo- In most treatment programs, clients are weighed
ries until clients are ingesting adequate amounts for only once daily usually on awakening and after they
height, activity level, and growth needs. Typically, al- have emptied the bladder. Clients should wear mini-
lotted calories are divided into three meals and three mal clothing, such as a hospital gown, each time they
snacks. A liquid protein supplement is given to re- are weighed. They may attempt to place objects in
place any food not eaten to ensure consumption of the their clothing to give the appearance of weight gain.
total number of prescribed calories. The nurse is re- Clients with bulimia often are treated on an
sponsible for monitoring meals and snacks and often outpatient basis. The nurse must work closely with
initially will sit with a client during eating at a table clients to establish normal eating patterns and to
18 EATING DISORDERS 447
Nursing Diagnosis
Ineffective Coping
Inability to form a valid appraisal of the stressors, inadequate choices of practiced
responses, and/or inability to use available resources.
IMPLEMENTATION
Encourage the client to eat with other clients, Eating with other people will discourage secrecy
when tolerated. about eating although initially the clients anxiety
may be too high to join others at mealtime.
Encourage the client to express feelings such as Verbal expression of feelings can help decrease
anxiety and guilt about having eaten. the clients anxiety and the urge to engage in
purging behaviors.
Ask the client directly about thoughts of suicide The clients safety is a priority. It is important to
or self-harm. remember that you will not give the client ideas
about suicide by addressing the issue directly.
Encourage the client to keep a diary in which to A diary can help the client to examine the food in-
write types and amounts of foods eaten and to take and the feelings he or she experiences. Grad-
identify feelings that occur before, during, and ually the client may be able to see relationships
after eating, especially related to urges to engage among these feelings and behaviors. Initially the
in binge or purge behavior. client may be able to write about these feelings
and behaviors more easily than talk about them.
Encourage the client to describe and discuss feel- You can help the client begin to express feelings in
ings verbally. Begin to separate dealing with feel- a nonthreatening environment. Being nonjudg-
ings from eating or purging behaviors. Maintain a mental gives the client permission to openly dis-
nonjudgmental approach. cuss feelings that may be negative or unacceptable
to him or her without fear of rejection or reprisal.
Discuss the types of foods that are soothing to the You may be able to help the client see how he or
client and that relieve anxiety. she has used food to deal with feelings or to com-
fort himself or herself.
Help the client to explore ways of relieving It is important to help the client separate emo-
anxiety and expressing feelings especially tional issues from food and eating behaviors.
anger, frustration, and anxiety, that are not
associated with eating. Help the client to iden-
tify ways to experience pleasure that are not
related to food or eating.
Give positive feedback for the clients efforts. The client may have become accustomed to judg-
ing himself or herself on accomplishments (often
food related) with no regard for feelings. Your sin-
cere praise can promote the clients attempts to
deal openly and honestly with anxiety, anger, and
other feelings.
*Teach the client and significant others about The client and significant others may have little
bulimic behaviors, physical complications, nutri- actual knowledge of the illness and of food, nutri-
tion, food, and so forth. Refer the client to a dieti- tion, and so forth. Factual information can be
tian for further instruction if indicated. useful to dispel incorrect beliefs and to separate
food issues from emotional issues.
*Teach the client and significant others about Antidepressant and other medications are some-
the purpose, action, timing, and possible adverse times prescribed for bulimia. The client needs to
effects of medications, if any. be aware of the effects of the medications and
their safe use. Remember some antidepressant
medications may take several weeks to achieve
a therapeutic effect.
Teach the client about the use of the problem- Successful use of the problem-solving process
solving process. can help increase the clients self-esteem and
confidence.
Explore with the client his or her personal You can help the client discover his or her
strengths. Making a written list is sometimes strengths. It will not be useful, however, for
helpful. you to list the clients strengthshe or she
needs to identify them but may benefit from
your supportive expectation that he or she
will do so.
Discuss with the client the idea of accepting a less The clients previous expectations or perception of
than ideal body weight. an ideal weight may have been unrealistic and
even unhealthy.
Encourage the client to incorporate fattening (or This will enhance the clients sense of control of
bad) foods into the diet as he or she can tolerate. overeating.
*Encourage the client to develop these skills and Many bulimic clients are passive and nonassertive
use them in daily life. Refer the client to assertive- in interpersonal relationships. Assertiveness
ness training books or classes if indicated. training may foster a sense of increased control,
confidence, and healthy relationship dynamics.
Encourage the client to express his or her feelings Expression of feelings can help the client to iden-
about family members, significant others, and tify, accept, and work through feelings in a direct
their roles and relationships. manner.
*Refer the client to long-term therapy if indicated. Treatment for eating disorders often is a long-term
Encourage the client to follow through with ther- process. The client may be more likely to engage
apy on an outpatient basis. Use of contracting in ongoing therapy if he or she has contracted
with the client may be helpful to promote follow to do this.
through.
*Ongoing therapy may need to include family Dysfunctional relationships with family members
members or significant others to sustain and con- or significant others are thought to be a primary
tinue the clients nonfood-related coping skills. issue with clients experiencing eating disorders.
*Refer the client and family and significant others These groups can offer support, education, and
to support groups in the community or via the resources to clients and their families or signif-
Internet (e.g., Anorexia Nervosa and Associated icant others.
Disorders, Overeaters Anonymous).
*Refer the client to a substance dependence treat- Substance use is common among clients with
ment program or substance dependence support bulimia.
group (e.g., Alcoholics Anonymous), if appropriate.
Adapted from Schultz, J. M. & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts Manual of Psychiatric Nursing Care Plans (6th ed.). Philadelphia:
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
cycle. Clients need encouragement to set realistic For clients who purge, the most important goal
goals for eating throughout the day (Muscari, 2002). is to stop. Teaching should include information about
Eating only salads and vegetables during the day the harmful effects of purging by vomiting and laxa-
may set up clients for later binges as a result of too tive abuse. The nurse explains that purging is an in-
little fat and carbohydrates. effective means of weight control and only disrupts
the neuroendocrine system. In addition, purging pro-
motes binge eating by decreasing the anxiety that
follows the binge. The nurse explains that if clients
CLIENT AND FAMILY TEACHING: can avoid purging, they may be less likely to engage in
binge eating. The nurse also teaches the techniques of
EATING DISORDERS distraction and delay, because they are useful against
CLIENT both binging and purging. The longer clients can delay
Basic nutritional needs either binging or purging, the less likely they are to
Harmful effects of restrictive eating, dieting, carry out the behavior.
purging The nurse explains to family and friends that
Realistic goals for eating they can be most helpful by providing emotional sup-
Acceptance of healthy body image port, love, and attention. They can express concern
FAMILY AND FRIENDS
about the clients health, but it is rarely helpful to
focus on food intake, calories, and weight.
Provide emotional support.
Express concern about clients health.
Encourage client to seek professional help. Evaluation
Avoid talking only about weight, food intake,
calories. The nurse can use assessment tools such as the Eat-
Become informed about eating disorders. ing Attitudes Test to detect improvement for clients
It is not possible for family and friends to force the with eating disorders. Both anorexia and bulimia are
client to eat. The client needs professional help chronic for many clients. Residual symptoms such as
from a therapist or psychiatrist. dieting, compulsive exercising, and discomfort eating
in a social setting are common. Treatment is consid-
452 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
ered successful if the client maintains a body weight offices may encounter clients in various settings who
within 5% to 10% of normal with no medical compli- are at risk for developing or who already have an
cations from starvation or purging. eating disorder. In these settings, early identifica-
tion and appropriate referral are primary responsi-
bilities of the nurse. Anstine and Grinenko (2000)
COMMUNITY-BASED CARE
suggest routine screening of young women for eating
Treatment for clients with eating disorders usually disorders (Box 18-1). Such early identification could
occurs in community settings. Hospital admission result in early intervention and prevention of a full-
is indicated only for medical necessity such as for blown eating disorder.
clients with dangerously low weight, electrolyte im-
balances, or renal, cardiac, or hepatic complications.
Clients who cannot control the cycle of binge eating
SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES
and purging may be treated briefly in an inpatient An emaciated, starving client with ano-
setting. Other treatment settings include partial hos- rexia can be a shocking sight, and the nurse may
pitalization or day treatment programs, individual or want to take care of this child and nurse her back
group outpatient therapy, and self-help groups. to health. When the client rejects this help and re-
sists the nurses caring actions, the nurse can become
angry and frustrated and feel incompetent to handle
MENTAL HEALTH PROMOTION
the situation.
Nurses can educate parents, children, and young The client initially may view the nurse, who is
people about strategies to prevent eating disorders. responsible for making the client eat, as the enemy.
Important aspects include realizing that the ideal The client may hide or throw away food or become
figures portrayed in advertisements and magazines overtly hostile as anxiety about eating increases. The
are unrealistic, developing realistic ideas about body nurse must remember that the clients behavior is a
size and shape, resisting peer pressure to diet, im- symptom of anxiety and fear about gaining weight
proving self-esteem, and learning coping strategies and not personally directed toward the nurse. Taking
for dealing with emotions and life issues. the clients behavior personally may cause the nurse
The Atlanta Center for Eating Disorders (2002) to feel angry and behave in a rejecting manner.
offers the following advice: Because eating is such a basic part of everyday
Read the research about fad diets: they dont life, the nurse may wonder why the client cannot just
work. No fat diets are unhealthy, and eat like everyone else. The nurse also may find it dif-
claims about special combinations food diets ficult to understand how a 75-pound client sees her-
are unfounded. self as fat when she looks in the mirror. Likewise
Send the right message to children about when working with a client who binges and purges,
food and body image issues. Parents who are the nurse may wonder why the client cannot exert the
constantly worrying about or talking about
weight or are always on a diet powerfully
influence their children. Give up dieting and
eat well-balanced meals. Box 18-1
Listen to your conversation. Weight, dieting,
and appearance are among the most common DISORDERED EATING SCREENING QUESTIONS
topics for women. Make a pact with friends How many diets have you been on in the past
to stop talking about your bodies negatively. year?
Focus on the positive aspects of yourself and How often does your weight affect how you feel
others that have nothing to do with physical about yourself?
appearance. How often do you feel you should be dieting?
How often do you feel dissatisfied with your
Encourage healthy expression of emotions.
body size?
Learn positive ways to communicate.
Give up wanting to be thin before doing
anything, and get on with enjoying your life. Reprinted with permission from Elsevier Science form Rapid
Increase physical activity by focusing on screening for disordered eating in college-aged females in
the primary care setting by Anstine, D., & Grinenko, D.
the enjoyment of movement not how many Anstine, D., & Grinenko, D. Journal of Adolescent Health,
calories youll burn. 26(5), 338342. 2000 by the Society for Adolescent
School nurses, student health nurses at colleges Medicine.
and universities, and nurses in clinics and doctors
18 EATING DISORDERS 453
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
will power to stop. The nurse must remember that the Ninety percent of clients with eating dis-
clients eating behavior has gotten out of control. Eat- orders are female. Anorexia begins at ages
ing disorders are a mental illness just like schizo- 14 through 18, and bulimia at age 18 or 19.
phrenia or bipolar affective disorder. Many neurochemical changes are present in
eating disorders, but it is uncertain whether
these changes cause or are a result of the
Points to Consider When Working eating disorder.
With Clients With Eating Disorders Persons with eating disorders feel un-
Be empathetic and nonjudgmental, although attractive and ineffective and may be
this is not easy. Remember the clients per- poorly equipped to deal with the challenges
spective and fears about weight and eating. of maturity.
Avoid sounding parental when teaching Societal attitudes regarding thinness,
about nutrition or why laxative use is harm- beauty, desirability, and physical fitness
ful. Presenting information factually without may influence the development of eating
chiding the client will obtain more positive disorders.
results. Severely malnourished clients with anorexia
Do not label clients as good when they avoid nervosa may require intensive medical treat-
purging or eat an entire meal. Otherwise ment to restore homeostasis before psychiatric
clients will believe they are bad on days treatment can begin.
when they purge or fail to eat enough food.
Family therapy is effective for clients with Halmi, K. A. (2000). Eating disorders. In B. J. Sadock
anorexia; cognitive-behavioral therapy is & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of
psychiatry, Vol. 2 (7th ed., pp. 16631676).
most effective for clients with bulimia. Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Interventions for clients with eating dis- Herzog, D. B., Dorer, D. J., & Keel, P. K. (1999). Recov-
orders include establishing nutritional eat- ery and relapse in anorexia and bulimia nervosa: a
ing patterns, helping the client to identify 7.5-year follow-up study. Journal of the Academy of
emotions and develop nonfood-related cop- Child and Adolescent Psychiatry, 38(7), 829837.
Jacob, A. V. (2001). Body image distortion and eating
ing strategies, helping the client to deal with disorders: No longer a culture bound topic. Healthy
body image issues, and providing client and Weight Journal, 15(6), 9395.
family education. Johnson, J. G., Cohen, P., Kasen, S. & Brook, J. S. (2002).
Focus on healthy eating and pleasurable Childhood adversities associated with risk for eating
disorders or weight problems during adolescence or
physical exercise; avoid fad or stringent diet- early adulthood. American Journal of Psychiatry,
ing. Parents must become aware of their 159(3), 394400.
own behavior and attitudes and the way Kaye, W. H., Klump, K. L., Frank, G. K. W., & Strober,
they influences children. M. (2000). Anorexia and bulimia nervosa. Annual
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com. Review of Medicine, 51, 299313.
Matsunaga, H., Kaye, W. H., McConahan, C., Plotnicov,
K., Pollice, C., Rao, R., & Stein, D. (1999). Psycho-
pathological characteristics of recovered bulimics
REFERENCES who have a history of physical or sexual abuse. Jour-
nal of Nervous and Mental Diseases, 187(8), 472476.
American Psychiatric Association. (2000). DSM-IV-TR: Mazzeo, S. E., & Espelage, D. L. (2002). Associations
Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental dis- between childhood physical and emotional abuse
orders-text revision (4th ed.). Washington, DC: and disordered eating behaviors. Journal of Coun-
Author. seling Psychology, 49(1), 86100.
Anstine, D., & Grinenko, D. (2000). Rapid screening for McIntosh, V. V., Bulik, C. M., McKenzie, J. M., Luty,
disordered eating in college-aged females in the pri- S. E., & Jordan, J. (2000). Interpersonal psychother-
mary care setting. Journal of Adolescent Health, apy for anorexia nervosa. International Journal of
26(5), 338342. Eating Disorders, 27(2), 125139.
Atlanta Center for Eating Disorders. (2002). How can you Muscari, M. (2002). Effective management of adolescents
help prevent eating disorders? Document available: with anorexia and bulimia. Journal of Psychosocial
http://eatingdisorders.home.mindspring.com/ Nursing, 40(2), 2331.
causes2.htm Patel, D. R., Phillips, E. L., & Pratt, H. D. (1998). Eating
Brewerton, T. D., Dansky, B. S., Kilpatrick, D. G., & disorders. Indian Journal of Pediatrics, 65(4),
ONeil, P. M. (2000). Which comes first in the patho- 487494.
genesis of bulimia: Dieting or binging? Charleston, Redford, J. (2001). Are sexual abuse and bulimia linked?
SC: Medical University of South Carolina, Depart- Physician Assistant, 25(5), 231.
ment of Psychiatry and Behavioral Sciences. Schultz, J. M., & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts
Carrasco, J. L., Diaz-Marsa, M., Hollander, E., Cesar, J., manual of psychiatric nursing care plans (6th ed.).
Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams, & Wilkins.
& Saiz-Ruiz, J. (2000). Decreased platelet monoamine
Serpell, L., Treasure, J., Teasdale, J., & Sullivan, V.
oxidase activity in female bulimia nervosa. European
(1999). Anorexia nervosa: Friend or foe. 179186.
Neuropsychopharmacology, 10, 113117.
Sherwood, N. E., Neumark-Sztainer, D., Story, M.,
Costin, C. (2002). An update on binge eating disorder.
Beuhring, T., & Resnick, M. D. (2002). Weight-
Healthy Weight Journal, 16(2), 2023. related sports involvement in girls: Who is at risk
Finelli, L. A. (2001). Revisiting the identity issue in for disordered eating? American Journal of Health
anorexia. Journal of Psychosocial Nursing, 39(8), Promotion, 16(6), 341349.
2329. Sorgen, C. (2002). Overcoming eating disorders. Document
Gardner, R. M., Friedman, B. N., & Jackson, N. A. (1999). available: http://my.webmd.com/printing/article/
Body size estimations, body dissatisfaction, and ideal 1674.52649
size preferences in children six through thirteen. Turner, J., Batik, M., & Palmer, L. J. (2000). Detection
Journal of Youth and Adolescence, 28(5), 603618. and importance of laxative abuse in adolescents with
Gluck, M. E. (2002). Night eating syndrome. Healthy anorexia nervosa. Journal of the American Academy
Weight Journal, 16(2), 2729. of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry, 39(3), 378385.
Gowers, S., & North, C. (1999). Difficulties in family func- Wade, T. D., Bulik, C. M., Neale, M., & Kendler, K. S.
tioning and adolescent anorexia nervosa. British (2000). Anorexia nervosa and major depression:
Journal of Psychiatry, 174(1), 6366. Shared genetic and environmental risk factors.
Grise, D. E., & Kaye, W. H. (2002). Chromosomal locus American Journal of Psychiatry, 157(3), 469471.
identified for susceptibility to anorexia nervosa. Wang, G., & Dietz, W. G. (2002). Economic burden of
American Journal of Human Genetics, 70, 787792. obesity in youths aged 6 to 17 years: 19791999.
Grilo, C. M., & Masheb, R. M. (2000). Onset of dieting Pediatrics, 109(5), E811.
vs. binge eating in outpatients with binge eating Wilson, G. T., & Vitousek, K. M. (1999). Self-monitoring
disorder. International Journal of Obesity, 24(4), in the assessment of eating disorders. Psychological
404409. Assessment, 11(4), 480489.
18 EATING DISORDERS 455
Woodside, D. B., Garfinkel, P. E., Lin, E., Goering, P., ADDITIONAL READINGS
Kaplan, A. S., Goldbloom, D. S., & Kennedy, S. H.
(2002). Comparisons of men with full or partial eating Daee, A., Robinson, P., Lawson, M., Turpin, J. A.,
disorders, men without eating disorders, and women. Gregory, B., & Tobias, J. J. (2002). Psychologic and
American Journal of Psychiatry 158(4), 570574. physiologic effects of dieting during adolescence.
Zhu, A. J., & Walsh, B. T. (2002). Pharmacologic treatment Southern Medical Journal, 95(9), 10321031.
of eating disorders. Canadian Journal of Psychiatry, Morgan, R. (2002). The men in the mirror. Higher Chron-
47(3), 227234. icle of Education, 49(5), A53A54.
Zipfel, S., Lowe, B., Reas, D. L., Deter, H., & Herzog, W. Picker, L. (2002). New hope for bulimia. Shape, 6667.
(2000). Long-term prognosis in anorexia nervosa: Wiser, S., & Telch, C. F. (1999). Dialectic behavior therapy
Lessons from a 21-year follow-up study. Lancet, 355, for binge eating disorder. Journal of Clinical Psychol-
721722. ogy, 55(6), 755768.
Chapter
ChapterStudy
Review
Guide
MULTIPLE-CHOICE QUESTIONS
Select the best answer for each of the following
questions.
1. Treating clients with anorexia nervosa with a B. Cultures where beauty is linked to thinness
selective serotonin reuptake inhibitor anti- have an increased risk for eating disorders.
depressant such as fluoxetine (Prozac) may
C. Eating disorders are a major health problem
present which of the following problems?
only in the United States and Europe.
A. Clients object to the side effect of weight
D. Persons with anorexia nervosa are popular
gain.
with their peers as a result of their thinness.
B. Fluoxetine can cause appetite suppression
and weight loss. 5. All but which of the following are initial goals for
C. Fluoxetine can cause clients to become giddy treating the severely malnourished client with
and silly. anorexia nervosa?
D. Clients with anorexia get no benefit from A. Correction of body image disturbance
fluoxetine. B. Correction of electrolyte imbalances
456
8. A client with bulimia is learning to use the tech- B. Assist the client to make out daily meal plans
nique of self-monitoring. Which of the following for one week.
interventions by the nurse would be most benefi-
C. Encourage the client to ignore feelings and
cial for this client?
impulses related to food.
A. Ask the client to write about all feelings and D. Teach the client about nutrition content and
experiences related to food. calories of various foods.
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify each of the following characteristics as being typical of anorexia
nervosa, bulimia nervosa, or both.
457
2. Describe the concept of body image disturbance.
CLINICAL EXAMPLE
Judy is a 17-year-old high school junior who is active in gymnastics. She is 5 feet
7 inches tall, weighs 85 pounds, and has not had a menstrual period for 5 months.
The family physician referred her to the inpatient eating disorders unit with a
diagnosis of anorexia nervosa. During the admission interview, Judy is defen-
sive about her weight loss, stating she needs to be thin to be competitive in her
sport. Judy points to areas on her buttocks and thighs, saying, See this? I still
have plenty of fat. Why cant everyone just leave me alone?
458
2. Write an expected outcome for each identified nursing diagnosis.
459
19 Somatoform
Disorders
Learning Objectives
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
460
19 SOMATOFORM DISORDERS 461
In the early 1800s, the medical field began to consider Psychological factors and conflicts seem
the various social and psychological factors that important in initiating, exacerbating, and
influence illness. The term psychosomatic began maintaining the symptoms.
to be used to convey the connection between the Symptoms or magnified health concerns are
mind (psyche) and the body (soma) in states of health not under the clients conscious control
and illness. Essentially the mind can cause the body (Guggenheim, 2000).
to create physical symptoms or to worsen physical Clients are convinced that they harbor serious
illnesses. Real symptoms can begin, continue, or be physical problems despite negative results during
worsened as a result of emotional factors. Examples diagnostic testing. They actually experience these
include diabetes, hypertension, and colitis, all of physical symptoms as well as the accompanying pain,
which are medical illnesses influenced by stress and distress, and functional limitations such symptoms
emotions. When a person is under a lot of stress or induce. Clients do not willfully control the physical
is not coping well with stress, symptoms of these symptoms. While their illnesses are psychiatric in
medical illnesses worsen. In addition, stress can cause nature, many clients do not seek help from mental
physical symptoms unrelated to a diagnosed med- health professionals. Unfortunately, many health
ical illness. After a stressful day at work, many peo- care professionals who do not understand the nature
ple experience tension headaches that can be quite of somatoform disorders are not sympathetic to these
painful. The headaches are a manifestation of stress clients complaints (Servan-Schreiber, Kolb & Tabas,
rather than a symptom of an underlying medical 2000). Nurses must remember that these clients really
problem. experience the symptoms they describe and cannot
The term hysteria refers to multiple physical voluntarily control them.
The five specific somatoform disorders are as fol-
complaints with no organic basis; the complaints
lows (American Psychiatric Association, [APA], 2000):
are usually described dramatically. The concept of
Somatization disorder is characterized
hysteria probably originated in Egypt and is about
by multiple physical symptoms. It begins by
4000 years old. In the Middle Ages, hysteria was as-
30 years of age, extends over several years,
sociated with witchcraft, demons, and sorcerers.
and includes a combination of pain and
People with hysteria, usually women, were considered
gastrointestinal, sexual, and pseudoneuro-
evil or possessed by evil spirits (Goodwin & Guze,
logic symptoms.
1989). Paul Briquet and Jean Martin Charcot, both
French physicians, identified hysteria as a disorder
of the nervous system.
Sigmund Freud, working with Charcot, observed
that people with hysteria improved with hypnosis
and experienced relief from their physical symptoms
when they recalled memories and expressed emo-
tions. This development led Freud to propose that
people can convert unexpressed emotions into physi-
cal symptoms (Guggenheim, 2000), a process now re-
ferred to as somatization. This chapter discusses so-
matoform disorders, which are based on the concept
of somatization.
OVERVIEW OF SOMATOFORM
DISORDERS
Somatization is defined as the transference of men-
tal experiences and states into bodily symptoms. So-
matoform disorders can be characterized as the
presence of physical symptoms that suggest a med-
ical condition without a demonstrable organic basis
to account fully for them. The three central features
of somatoform disorders are as follows:
Physical complaints suggest major medical
illness but have no demonstrable organic
basis. Somatoform disorders
462 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
sion disorder usually occurs between 10 and 35 years who are in or familiar with medical professions such
of age. Pain disorder and hypochondriasis can occur as nurses, physicians, medical technicians, or hospi-
at any age (APA, 2000). tal volunteers (Turner & Reid, 2002; Wilson, 2001).
All the somatoform disorders are either chronic People who injure clients or their children through
or recurrent, lasting for decades for many people. Munchausens by proxy generally are arrested and
Clients with somatization disorder and conversion prosecuted in the legal system.
disorder most likely seek help from mental health
professionals after they have exhausted efforts at
ETIOLOGY
finding a diagnosed medical condition. Clients with
hypochondriasis, pain disorder, and body dysmorphic Psychosocial Theories
disorder are unlikely to receive treatment in mental
Psychosocial theorists believe that people with so-
health settings unless they have a comorbid condi-
matoform disorders keep stress, anxiety, or frustra-
tion. Clients with somatoform disorders tend to go
tion inside rather than expressing them outwardly.
from one physician or clinic to another, or they may
This is called internalization. Clients express these
see multiple providers at once in an effort to obtain
internalized feelings and stress through physical
relief of symptoms. They tend to be pessimistic about
symptoms (somatization). Both internalization and
the medical establishment and often believe that
somatization are unconscious defense mechanisms.
their disease could be diagnosed if providers were
Clients are not consciously aware of the process, nor
more competent.
do they voluntarily control it.
People with somatoform disorders do not readily
RELATED DISORDERS and directly express their feelings and emotions ver-
bally. They have tremendous difficulty dealing with
Somatoform disorders need to be distinguished from
interpersonal conflict. When placed in situations
other body-related mental disorders such as malin-
involving conflict or emotional stress, their physical
gering and factitious disorders in which people feign
symptoms appear to worsen. The worsening of physi-
or intentionally produce symptoms for some purpose
cal symptoms helps them to meet psychological needs
or gain. In malingering and factitious disorders, peo-
for security, attention, and affection through primary
ple willfully control the symptoms. In somatoform dis-
and secondary gain (Guggenheim, 2000). Primary
orders, clients do not voluntarily control their physi-
cal symptoms.
Malingering is the intentional production of
false or grossly exaggerated physical or psychological
symptoms; it is motivated by external incentives such
as avoiding work, evading criminal prosecution, ob-
taining financial compensation, or obtaining drugs.
People who malinger have no real physical symptoms
or grossly exaggerate relatively minor symptoms.
Their purpose is some external incentive or outcome
that they view as important and results directly
from the illness. People who malinger can stop the
physical symptoms as soon as they have gained what
they wanted.
Factitious disorder occurs when a person in-
tentionally produces or feigns physical or psycholog-
ical symptoms solely to gain attention. People with
factitious disorder may even inflict injury to them-
selves to receive attention. The common term for
factitious disorder is Munchausens syndrome. A
variation of factitious disorder, Munchausens by
proxy, occurs when a person inflicts illness or injury
on someone else to gain the attention of emergency
medical personnel or to be a hero for saving the vic-
tim. An example would be a nurse who gives excess
intravenous potassium to a client and then saves his
life by performing CPR. Although factitious dis-
orders are uncommon, they occur most often in people Factitious disorder
464 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
gains are the direct external benefits that being sick sensation such as peristalsis and attach a pathologic
provides such as relief of anxiety, conflict, or distress. rather than a normal meaning to it (Guggenheim,
Secondary gains are the internal or personal bene- 2000). Too little inhibition of sensory input amplifies
fits received from others because one is sick such as at- awareness of physical symptoms and exaggerates re-
tention from family members and comfort measures sponse to bodily sensations. For example, minor dis-
(e.g., being brought tea, receiving a back rub). Servan- comfort, such as muscle tightness, becomes amplified
Schreiber et al. (2002) identify this as a need to be because of the clients concern and attention to the
sick to have emotional needs met. tightness. This amplified sensory awareness causes
Somatization is associated most often with the person to experience somatic sensations as more
women, as evidenced by the old term hysteria (Greek intense, noxious, and disturbing (Hardy, Warmbrodt
for wandering uterus). Ancient theorists believed & Chrisman, 2001).
that unexplained female pains resulted from migra- Somatization disorder is found in 10% to 20% of
tion of the uterus throughout the womans body. female first-degree relatives of people with this dis-
Psychosocial theorists posit that increased incidence order. Conversion symptoms are found more often in
of somatization in women may be related to various relatives of people with conversion disorder. First-
factors: degree relatives of those with pain disorder are more
Boys in the United States are taught to be likely to have depressive disorders, alcohol depen-
stoic and to take it like a man, causing dence, and chronic pain (APA, 2000).
them to offer fewer physical complaints as
adults.
Women seek medical treatment more often
CULTURAL CONSIDERATIONS
than men do, and it is more socially accept- The type and frequency of somatic symptoms and
able for them to do so. their meaning may vary across cultures. Pseudo-
Childhood sexual abuse, which is related to neurologic symptoms of somatization disorder in
somatization, happens more frequently to Africa and South Asia include burning hands and
girls. feet and the nondelusional sensation of worms in the
Women more often receive treatment for head or ants under the skin. Symptoms related to
psychiatric disorders with strong somatic male reproduction are more common in some coun-
components such as depression. tries or culturesfor example, men in India often
have dhat, which is a hypochondriacal concern about
loss of semen. Somatization disorder is rare in men
Biologic Theories
in the United States but more common in Greece and
Research has shown differences in the way that Puerto Rico.
clients with somatoform disorders regulate and inter- Many culture-bound syndromes have correspond-
pret stimuli. These clients cannot sort relevant from ing somatic symptoms not explained by a medical
irrelevant stimuli and respond equally to both types. condition (Table 19-1). Koro occurs in Southeast Asia
In other words, they may experience a normal body and may be related to body dysmorphic disorder. It
Table 19-1
CULTURE-BOUND SYNDROMES
Syndrome Culture Characteristics
is characterized by the belief that the penis is shrink- Involvement in therapy groups is beneficial for
ing, will disappear into the abdomen and cause the some people with somatoform disorders. Studies of
man to die. Falling-out episodes, found in the south- clients with somatization disorder who participated
ern United States and the Caribbean islands, are in a structured cognitive-behavioral group showed
characterized by a sudden collapse during which the evidence of improved physical and emotional health
person cannot see or move. Hwa-byung is a Korean 1 year later (Guggenheim, 2000). The overall goals of
folk syndrome attributed to the suppression of anger the group were offering peer support, sharing methods
and includes insomnia, fatigue, panic, indigestion, of coping, and perceiving and expressing emotions.
and generalized aches and pains. Sangue dormido In terms of prognosis, somatoform disorders tend
(sleeping blood) occurs among Portuguese Cape to be chronic or recurrent. Conversion disorder often
Verde Islanders who report pain, numbness, tremors, remits in a few weeks with treatment but recurs in
paralysis, seizures, blindness, heart attack, and mis- 25% of clients. Somatization disorder, hypochondria-
carriages. Shenjing shuariuo occurs in China and sis, and pain disorder often last for many years, and
includes physical and mental fatigue, dizziness, head- clients report being in poor health. People with body
ache, pain, sleep disturbance, memory loss, gastro- dysmorphic disorder may be preoccupied with the
intestinal problems, and sexual dysfunction (Mezzich, same or a different perceived body flaw throughout
Lin & Hughes, 2000). their lives (APA, 2000).
Table 19-2
ANTIDEPRESSANTS USED TO TREAT SOMATOFORM DISORDERS
Drug Usual dose (mg/day) Nursing Considerations
fluoxetine (Prozac) 2060 Monitor for rash, hives, insomnia, headache, anxiety, drowsiness,
nausea, loss of appetite; avoid alcohol
paroxetine (Paxil) 2060 Monitor for nausea, loss of appetite, dizziness, dry mouth,
somnolence or insomnia, sweating, sexual dysfunction; avoid
alcohol
sertraline (Zoloft) 50200 Monitor for nausea, loss of appetite, diarrhea, headache,
insomnia, sexual dysfunction; avoid alcohol
466 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Box 19-1
ASSESSMENT QUESTIONS FOR SYMPTOMS IN SCREENING TEST FOR SOMATIZATION DISORDER
1. Have you ever had trouble breathing?
2. Have you ever had trouble with menstrual cramps?
3. Have you ever had burning sensations in your sexual organs, mouth, or rectum?
4. Have you ever had difficulties swallowing or had an uncomfortable lump in your throat that stayed for at least
an hour?
5. Have you ever found that you could not remember what you had been doing for hours or days at a time? If yes,
did this happen even though you had not been drinking or using drugs?
6. Have you ever had trouble with frequent vomiting?
7. Have you ever had frequent pain in your fingers or toes?
Adapted from Othmer, E., & DeSouza, C. (1983). A screening test for somatization disorder (hysteria). American Journal of
Psychiatry, 142(10), 11461149. American Psychiatric Association. Reprinted with permission.
tests, and perhaps even a number of surgical proce- THOUGHT PROCESS AND CONTENT
dures. It is likely that they have seen multiple health
Clients who somatize do not experience disordered
care providers over several years. Clients may express
thought processes. The content of their thinking is
dismay or anger at the medical community with com-
primarily about often exaggerated physical concerns;
ments such as They just cant find out whats wrong
with me or Theyre all incompetent, and theyre try- for example, when they have a simple cold, they may
ing to tell me Im crazy! The exception may be clients be convinced it is pneumonia. They may even talk
with conversion disorder, who show little emotion about dying and what music they want played at
when describing physical limitations or lack of a med- their funeral.
ical diagnosis (la belle indifference). Clients are unlikely to be able to think about or to
respond to questions about emotional feelings. They
will answer questions about how they feel in terms of
GENERAL APPEARANCE AND physical health or sensations. For example, the nurse
MOTOR BEHAVIOR may ask, How did you feel about having to quit your
Overall appearance usually is not remarkable. Often job? The client might respond Well, I thought Id feel
clients walk slowly or with an unusual gait because better with the extra rest, but my back pain was just
of the pain or disability caused by the symptoms. They as bad as ever.
may exhibit a facial expression of discomfort or phys- Clients with hypochondriasis focus on the fear of
ical distress. In many cases, they will brighten and serious illness rather than the existence of illness
look much better as the assessment interview begins seen in clients with other somatoform disorders.
because they have the nurses undivided attention. They are just as preoccupied with physical concerns
as other somatizing clients and are likewise very lim-
Clients with somatization disorder usually describe
ited in their abilities to identify emotional feelings or
their complaints in colorful, exaggerated terms but
interpersonal issues.
often lack specific information.
nurse can help the client to plan social contact with The sexual confinement, emotional oppres-
others, can role-play what to talk about (other than sion, and social suffocation of the Victorian
the clients complaints), and can improve the clients era have dissipated.
confidence in making relationships. The nurse also The interaction of mind and body now has a
can help clients to identify stressful life situations and scientific foundation.
plan strategies to deal with them. For example if a As people continue to gain knowledge about them-
client finds it difficult to accomplish daily household selves and to express their emotional needs and de-
tasks, the nurse can help him to plan a schedule with sires directly, the incidence of coping through physical
difficult tasks followed by something client may enjoy. symptoms should continue to decline.
Nursing Diagnosis
Ineffective Coping
Inability to form a valid appraisal of the stressors, inadequate choices of practiced
responses, and/or inability to use available resources.
IMPLEMENTATION
*The nursing staff should note the medical staffs Genuine physical problems must be noted and
assessment of each complaint on the clients treated.
admission.
*Each time the client voices a new complaint (or It is unsafe to assume that all physical complaints
claims injury), the client should be referred to the are hypochondriacalthe client could really be ill
medical staff for assessment (and treatment if or injured. The client may attempt to establish the
appropriate). legitimacy of complaints by being genuinely in-
jured or ill.
*Minimize the amount of time and attention given If physical complaints are unsuccessful in gaining
to complaints. When the client makes a complaint, attention, they should decrease in frequency over
refer him or her to the medical staff (if it is a new time.
complaint) or follow the team treatment plan; then
tell the client you will discuss something else but
not bodily complaints. Tell the client that you are
interested in the client as a person, not just in his
or her physical complaints. If the complaint is not
acute, ask the client to save the complaint until a
regular appointment with the medical staff.
Withdraw your attention if the client insists on It is important to make clear to the client that at-
making complaints the sole topic of conversation. tention is withdrawn from physical complaints,
Tell the client your reason for withdrawal and not from the client as a person.
that you desire to discuss other topics or will
interact at a later time.
Allow the client a specific time limit (like 5 min- Because physical complaints have been the
utes per hour) to discuss physical complaints with clients primary coping strategy, it is less threat-
one person. The remaining staff will discuss only ening to the client if you limit this behavior ini-
other issues with the client. tially rather than forbid it. The clients hypochon-
driacal behavior may exacerbate if he or she is
denied this coping mechanism abruptly before
new skills can be developed.
Do not argue with the client about the somatic Arguing with the client still constitutes attention,
complaints. Acknowledge the complaint as the even though it is negative. The client is able to
clients feeling or perception and then follow the avoid discussing feelings.
previous approaches.
Use the interventions suggested previously as This approach helps the client to make the transi-
well as minimal objective reassurance in conjunc- tion to discussing feelings.
tion with questions (or other techniques) to
explore the clients feelings. (Your tests have
shown that you have no lesions. Do you still feel
that you do? What are your feelings about this?)
Encourage the client to discuss his or her feelings The focus is on feelings of fear, not fear of physi-
about the fears rather than the fears themselves. cal problems.
Explore the clients feelings of lack of control over The client may have helpless feelings but may not
stress and life events. recognize this independently.
Initially, carefully assess the clients self-image, This assessment provides a knowledge base re-
social patterns, and ways of dealing with anger, garding hypochondriacal behaviors.
stress, and so forth.
Talk with the client about sources of satisfaction Open-ended discussion usually is nonthreatening
and dissatisfaction in his or her daily life, family and helps the client to begin self-assessment.
and other significant relationships, employment,
and so forth.
After some discussion of the above and the contin- The clients perception of stressors usually is
ued strengthening of your trust relationship, talk more significant than others perception of those
more directly with the client and encourage the stressors. The client will operate on the basis of
client to talk more openly about specific stresses, what he or she believes.
recent and ongoing. What does the client perceive
as stressful?
If the client is using denial as a defense mecha- If the client is in denial, more direct approaches
nism, the discussion of stresses may need to be may produce anger or hostility and threaten the
less direct. Point out apparent, probable, or possi- trust relationship.
ble stresses to the client (in a nonthreatening way)
and ask the client for feedback.
Gradually help the client to identify possible The client can begin to see the relatedness of
connections between stress and anxiety and the stress and physical problems at his or her own
occurrence or exacerbation of physical symptoms. pace. Self-realization will be more acceptable to
Points you might help the client to assess are: the client as opposed to the nurse telling the
What makes the client more or less comfortable? client the problem.
What is the client doing or what is going on
around the client when he or she feels more or
less comfortable or is experiencing symptoms?
Encourage the client to keep a diary of events or Reflecting on written items may be more accurate
situations, stresses, and occurrence of symptoms. and less threatening to the client.
This diary can then be used to identify relation-
ships between stresses and symptoms.
Talk with the client at least once per shift, focus- Continued, regular interest in the client facili-
ing on the identification and expression of the tates the relationship. It also can desensitize the
clients feelings. client regarding discussion of feelings and emo-
tional issues.
Encourage the client to ventilate feelings by talk- The client may have difficulty identifying and
ing or crying, through physical activities, and so expressing feelings directly. Your encouragement
forth. and support may help him or her to develop these
skills.
*Teach the client and his or her family or The client and his or her family or significant
significant others about the dynamics of others may have little or no knowledge of stress,
hypochondriacal behavior and the treatment interpersonal dynamics, hypochondriacal behav-
plan including plans after discharge. ior, and so on. Knowledge of the treatment plan
will promote long-term behavior change.
*Talk with the client and significant others about Maintaining limits to reduce secondary gain
the concept of secondary gains and together de- requires everyones participation to be successful.
velop a plan to reduce those gains. Identify the The clients family and significant others must be
needs the client is attempting to meet with sec- aware of the clients needs if they want to be effec-
ondary gains (such as attention or escape from tive in helping to meet those needs.
perceived responsibilities or from stress).
Help the client plan to meet his or her needs in Positive feedback and support for healthier be-
more direct ways. (Show the client that attention havior tends to make that behavior recur more
and support are available when he or she is not frequently. The clients family and significant
exhibiting symptoms or complaints and when he others also must use positive reinforcement.
or she deals with responsibilities directly or
asserts himself or herself in the face of stress or
discomfort.)
Reduce the benefits of illness as much as possible. If physical problems do not get the client what he
Do not allow the client to avoid responsibilities by or she wants, the client is less likely to cope in
voicing somatic discomfort; do not excuse the that manner.
client from activities or allow special privileges
such as staying in bed or dressing in night clothes.
*Work with the medical staff to limit the number, A team effort helps to discourage the clients
variety, strength, and frequency of medications, manipulation of some staff members to obtain
enemas, and so forth that are made available to additional medication. See Care Plan 42: Passive-
the client. Aggressive Personality Disorder.
When the client requests a medication or treat- If the client can obtain stress relief in a nonchem-
ment for a complaint, encourage the client to ical, nonmedical way, he or she is less likely to
identify what precipitated the complaint and to use the medication or treatment.
deal with the discomfort in other ways.
Observe and record the circumstances surround- Alerting the client to situations surrounding the
ing the occurrence or exacerbation of complaints; complaint helps him or her to see the relatedness
talk about your observations with the client. of stress and physical symptoms.
Help the client to identify and use nonchemical Learning nonchemical pain relief techniques will
methods of pain relief such as relaxation shift the focus of coping away from physical
techniques. means and increase the clients sense of control.
Teach the client more healthful daily living habits Optimal physical wellness is especially important
with regard to diet, sleep, comfort measures, stress with clients using physical symptoms as a coping
management techniques, daily fluid intake, daily strategy.
exercise, decreased stimuli, rest, possible connec-
tion between caffeine and anxiety symptoms, and
so forth. See Care Plan 35: Sleep Disorders.
Encourage the client to discuss his or her feelings The focus is on feelings of fear, not fear of physi-
about the fears rather than the fears themselves. cal problems.
Help the client to explore his or her feelings of The client may have helpless feelings but may not
lack of control over stress and life events. recognize this independently.
Talk with the client at least once per shift; focus Continued, regular interest in the client facilitates
on the identification and expression of the clients the relationship. It also can desensitize the client
feelings. regarding discussion of feelings and emotional
issues.
Encourage the client to ventilate feelings by talking The client may have difficulty identifying and ex-
or crying, through physical activities, and so forth. pressing feelings directly. Your encouragement and
support may help the client to develop these skills.
Encourage the client to identify and express feel- Direct expression of feelings will minimize the
ings directly in interpersonal relationships or need to use physical symptoms to express them.
stressful situations, especially feelings with
which the client is uncomfortable (such as anger
or resentment).
Notice the clients interactions with others (other The client can gain confidence dealing with
clients, staff members, visitors, significant others, stress.
yourself), and give positive feedback for self- The client needs to know that appropriate expres-
assertion and the direct expression of feelings, sions of anger or other negative emotions are ac-
especially anger, resentment, and other so-called ceptable and that he or she can feel better physi-
negative emotions. cally as a result of these expressions.
Adapted from Schultz, J. M. & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts Manual of Psychiatric Nursing Care Plans (6th ed.). Philadelphia:
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
19 SOMATOFORM DISORDERS 475
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
Psychosomatics http://www.bma-wellness.com/psychiatry/
Psychosomatics.html
Clients with somatization disorder actually syndromes. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.),
experience symptoms and the associated Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed.,
pp. 12641276). Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams &
discomfort and pain. The nurse should never
Wilkins.
try to confront the client about the origin of Micale, M. S. (2000). The decline of hysteria. Harvard
these symptoms until the client has learned Mental Health Letter, 17(1), 46.
other coping strategies. Schultz, J. M. & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts
Somatoform disorders are chronic or recur- Manual of Psychiatric Nursing Care Plans (6th ed.).
Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
rent, so progress toward treatment outcomes
Serven-Schreiber, D., Kolb, N. R., & Tabas, G. (2000).
can be slow and difficult. Somatizing patients: Part I. Practical diagnosis.
Nurses caring for clients with somatoform American Family Physician, 61(4), 10731078.
disorders must show patience and under- Serven-Schreiber, D., Kolb, N. R., & Tabas, G. (2000).
standing toward them as they struggle Somatizing patients: Part II. Practical management.
American Family Physician, 61(5), 14231428.
through years of recurrent somatic com-
Turner, J., & Reid, S. (2002). Munchausens syndrome.
plaints and attempts to learn new emotion- Lancet, 359(9303), 346349.
and problem-focused coping strategies. Wilson, R. G. (2001). Fabricated or induced illness in chil-
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com. dren. British Medical Journal, 323(7308), 296297.
1. The nurse is caring for a client with a conversion 5. Which of the following is true about clients with
disorder. Which of the following assessments hypochondriasis?
will the nurse expect to see? A. They may interpret normal body sensations
A. Extreme distress over the physical symptom as signs of disease.
B. They often exaggerate or fabricate physical
B. Indifference about the physical symptom symptoms for attention.
C. Labile mood C. They do not show signs of distress about their
D. Multiple physical complaints. physical symptoms.
D. All of the above are true statements.
2. Which of the following statements would indi-
6. The clients family asks the nurse What is
cate that teaching about somatization disorder
hypochondriasis? The best response by the
has been effective?
nurse is Hypochondriasis is
A. The doctor believes I am faking my symp- A. A persistent preoccupation with getting a se-
toms. rious disease.
B. If I try harder to control my symptoms, I will B. An illness not fully explained by a diagnosed
feel better. medical condition.
C. Characterized by a variety of symptoms over
C. I will feel better when I begin handling
a number of years.
stress more effectively.
D. The eventual result of excessive worrying
D. Nothing will help me feel better physically. about diseases.
3. Paroxetine (Paxil) has been prescribed for a client 7. A client with somatization disorder has been at-
with a somatoform disorder. The nurse instructs tending group therapy. Which of the following
the client to watch for which of the following side statements indicates that therapy is having a
effects? positive outcome for this client?
A. I feel better physically just from getting a
A. Constipation
chance to talk.
B. Increased appetite B. I havent said much, but I get a lot from lis-
C. Increased flatulence tening to others.
C. I shouldnt complain too much; my problems
D. Nausea arent as bad as others.
4. Emotion-focused coping strategies are designed D. The other people in this group have emo-
tional problems.
to accomplish which of the following outcomes?
A. Helping the client manage difficult situations 8. A client who developed numbness in the right
more effectively hand could not play the piano at a scheduled
recital. The consequence of the symptom, not
B. Helping the client manage the intensity of having to perform, is best described as
symptoms A. Emotion-focused coping
C. Teaching the client the relationship between B. Phobia
stress and physical symptoms C. Primary gain
D. Relieving the clients physical symptoms. D. Secondary gain
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com
477
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify the type of somatoform disorder that is described by each of the
following statements.
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
Define each of the following and provide an example.
Primary gain
Secondary gain
La belle indifference.
478
CLINICAL EXAMPLE
Mary Jones, 34 years of age, was referred to a chronic pain clinic with a diag-
nosis of pain disorder. She has been unable to work for 7 months because of back
pain. Mary has seen several doctors, has had an MRI, and has tried various
anti-inflammatory medications. She tells the nurse that she is at the clinic as a
last resort because none of her doctors will do anything for her. Marys gait is
slow, her posture is stiff, and she grimaces frequently while trying to sit in a
chair. She reports being unable to drive a car, play with her children, do house-
work, or enjoy any of her previous leisure activities.
1. Identify three nursing diagnoses that would be pertinent for Marys plan of
care.
3. Describe five interventions that the nurse might implement to achieve the
outcomes.
479
4. What other disciplines might make a contribution to Marys care at the
clinic?
5. Identify any community referrals the nurse might make for Mary.
480
20 Child and
Adolescent
Learning Objectives Disorders
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
481
482 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Psychiatric disorders are not diagnosed as easily in adolescence and continue into adulthood. Discussions
children as they are in adults. Children usually lack of mood, anxiety, and eating disorders are presented
the abstract cognitive abilities and verbal skills to in separate chapters of this text.
describe what is happening. Because they constantly This chapter focuses on those psychiatric dis-
are changing and developing, children have no sense orders usually first diagnosed in infancy, child-
of a stable, normal self to allow them to discriminate hood, or adolescence (Box 20-1); many of these can
unusual or unwanted symptoms from normal feel- persist into adulthood. The childhood psychiatric
ings and sensations. Additionally, behaviors that are disorders most common in mental health settings
normal in a child of one age may indicate problems and specialized treatment units include pervasive
in a child of another age. For example, an infant who developmental disorders, attention deficit hyper-
cries and wails when separated from her mother is activity disorder (ADHD), and disruptive behavior
normal. If the same child at 5 years of age cries and disorders. For this reason, the chapter presents an
shows extreme anxiety when separated from her or in-depth discussion of ADHD and conduct disorder
his mother, however, this behavior would warrant (the most prevalent disruptive behavior disorder)
investigation. with appropriate nursing diagnoses and interven-
Children and adolescents experience some of the tions as well as sample nursing care plans. It dis-
same mental health problems as adults, such as mood cusses less common disorders briefly; generally
and anxiety disorders, and are diagnosed with these most of these disorders are not treated in inpatient
disorders using the same criteria as for adults. Eat- psychiatric units unless they coexist with other
ing disorders, especially anorexia, usually begin in disorders.
Box 20-1
DISORDERS FIRST DIAGNOSED IN INFANCY, CHILDHOOD, AND ADOLESCENCE
MENTAL RETARDATION ATTENTION DEFICIT AND DISRUPTIVE
Mild BEHAVIOR DISORDERS
Moderate Attention deficit hyperactivity disorder
Severe Conduct disorder
Profound Oppositional defiant disorder
Each category except feeding and eating disorders has an additional diagnosis Not Otherwise Specified (NOS) for similar
problems that do not meet the criteria for other diagnoses in the category (DSM-IV-TR, 2000). Adapted from DSM-IV-TR (2000).
20 CHILD AND ADOLESCENT DISORDERS 483
and language therapists work with children who The National Institute of Child Health and Human
have communication disorders to improve their Development states there is no relationship and the
communication skills and to teach parents to con- MMR vaccine is safe. Congressional hearings in 2002
tinue speech therapy activities at home (Johnson & continued to review testimony from those who be-
Beitchman, 2000). lieve a link exists.
Autism tends to improve, in some cases substan-
tially, as children start to acquire and to use language
PERVASIVE DEVELOPMENTAL to communicate with others. If behavior deteriorates
DISORDERS in adolescence, it may reflect the effects of hormonal
Pervasive developmental disorders are charac- changes or the difficulty meeting increasingly com-
terized by pervasive and usually severe impairment plex social demands. Autistic traits persist into adult-
hood, and most people with autism remain depen-
of reciprocal social interaction skills, communication
dent to some degree on others. Manifestations vary
deviance, and restricted stereotypical behavioral
from little speech and poor daily living skills through-
patterns (Volkmar & Klin, 2000). This category of
out life to adequate social skills that allow relatively
disorders also is called autism spectrum disorders
independent functioning. Social skills rarely improve
and includes autistic disorder (classic autism), Retts
enough to permit marriage and child rearing. Adults
disorder, childhood disintegrative disorder, and
with autism may be viewed as merely odd or reclu-
Aspergers disorder. Approximately 75% of children
sive or they may be given a diagnosis of obsessive-
with pervasive developmental disorders have men-
compulsive disorder, schizoid personality disorder,
tal retardation (APA, 2000).
or mental retardation.
Until the mid-1970s, children with autism usu-
AUTISTIC DISORDER ally were treated in segregated, specialty outpatient,
or school programs. Those with more severe behav-
Autistic disorder, the best known of the pervasive
iors were referred to residential programs. Since then,
developmental disorders, is more prevalent in boys most residential programs have been closed; children
than in girls and is identified no later than 3 years of with autism are being mainstreamed into local
age. Children with autism display little eye contact school programs whenever possible (Kimball, 2002).
with and make few facial expressions toward others; Short-term inpatient treatment is used when behav-
they do not use gestures to communicate. They do iors such as head-banging or tantrums are out of
not relate to peers or parents. They lack spontaneous control. When the crisis is over, community agencies
enjoyment, have apparently no moods or emotional support the child and family.
affect, and cannot engage in play or make-believe with The goals of treatment of children with autism
toys. There is little intelligible speech. These children are to reduce behavioral symptoms and to promote
engage in stereotyped motor behaviors such as hand- learning and development particularly the acquisi-
flapping, body-twisting, or head-banging. tion of language skills (Volkmar & Klin, 2000). Com-
Eighty percent of cases of autism are early-onset prehensive and individualized treatment including
with developmental delays starting in infancy. The special education and language therapy is associated
other 20% of children with autism have seemingly with more favorable outcomes. Pharmacologic treat-
normal growth and development until 2 or 3 years of ment with antipsychotics such as haloperidol (Hal-
age when developmental regression or loss of abili- dol) or risperidone (Risperdal) may be effective for
ties begin. They stop talking and relating to parents specific target symptoms such as temper tantrums,
and peers and begin to demonstrate the behaviors de- aggressiveness, self-injury, hyperactivity, and stereo-
scribed above (National Institute of Child and Human typed behaviors (Tanguay, 2000). Other medications
Development [NICHD], 2002). such as naltrexone (ReVia), clomipramine (Anafranil),
Autism was once thought to be rare and was es- clonidine (Catapres), and stimulants to diminish self-
timated to occur in 4 to 5 children per 1000 in the injury and hyperactive and obsessive behaviors have
1960s. Current estimates suggest that 1 in 1000 to 1 had varied but unremarkable results (Volkmar &
in 500 U.S. children from 1 to 15 years of age have Klin, 2000).
autism (NICHD, 2002). Figures on the prevalence of
autism in adults are unreliable.
RETTS DISORDER
Autism does have a genetic link; many children
with autism have a relative with autism or autistic Retts disorder is a pervasive developmental disorder
traits. Controversy continues about whether or not characterized by the development of multiple deficits
measles, mumps and rubella (MMR) vaccinations after a period of normal functioning. It occurs exclu-
contribute to the development of late-onset autism. sively in girls, is rare, and persists throughout life.
20 CHILD AND ADOLESCENT DISORDERS 485
Retts disorder develops between birth to 5 months of in autistic disorder but there are no language or cog-
age. The child loses motor skills and begins showing nitive delays. This rare disorder occurs more often in
stereotyped movements instead. She loses interest boys than in girls; the effects are generally life-long.
in the social environment, and severe impairment
of expressive and receptive language becomes evident
as she grows older. Treatment is similar to those ATTENTION DEFICIT AND
for autism. DISRUPTIVE BEHAVIOR DISORDERS
ATTENTION DEFICIT
CHILDHOOD DISINTEGRATIVE HYPERACTIVITY DISORDER
DISORDER Attention deficit hyperactivity disorder (ADHD)
Childhood disintegrative disorder is characterized by is characterized by inattentiveness, overactivity, and
marked regression in multiple areas of functioning impulsiveness. ADHD is a common disorder, espe-
after at least 2 years of apparently normal growth cially in boys, and probably accounts for more child
and development (APA, 2000). Typical age of onset is mental health referrals than any other single dis-
3 to 4 years. Children with childhood disintegrative order (McCracken, 2000a). The essential feature of
disorder have the same social and communication ADHD is a persistent pattern of inattention and/or
deficits and behavioral patterns seen with autistic hyperactivity and impulsivity more common than
disorder. This rare disorder occurs slightly more often generally observed in children of the same age.
in boys than in girls. ADHD affects an estimated 3% to 5% of all school-
age children. The ratio of boys to girls ranges from
31 in nonclinical settings to 91 in clinical settings
ASPERGERS DISORDER (McCracken, 2000a). To avoid overdiagnosis of ADHD,
Aspergers disorder is a pervasive developmental dis- a qualified specialist, such as a pediatric neurologist
order characterized by the same impairments of social or a child psychiatrist, must conduct the evaluation
interaction and restricted, stereotyped behaviors seen for ADHD. Children who are very active or hard
SYMPTOMS OF ADHD
INATTENTIVE BEHAVIORS HYPERACTIVE/IMPULSIVE BEHAVIORS
Misses details Fidgets
Makes careless mistakes Often leaves seat, (e.g., during a meal)
Has difficulty sustaining attention Runs or climbs excessively
Doesnt seem to listen Cant play quietly
Does not follow-through on chores or homework Is always on the go; driven
Has difficulty with organization Talks excessively
Avoids tasks requiring mental effort Blurts out answers
Often loses necessary things Interrupts
Is easily distracted by other stimuli Cant wait for turn
Is often forgetful in daily activities Is intrusive with siblings/playmates
Table 20-1
STIMULANT DRUGS USED TO TREAT ADHD
Generic (Trade) Name Dosage (mg/day) Nursing Considerations
niques can help children to express themselves, for the childs attention or redirect the child to a topic
example, by drawing pictures of themselves, their may evoke resistance and anger.
family, and peers. These techniques are especially
useful when children are unable or unwilling to ex-
THOUGHT PROCESS AND CONTENT
press themselves verbally.
There are generally no impairments in this area,
although assessment can be difficult depending on the
APPLICATION OF THE NURSING childs activity level and age or developmental stage.
PROCESS: ADHD
Assessment SENSORIUM AND
During assessment, the nurse gathers information INTELLECTUAL PROCESSES
from the childs parents, day care providers (if any),
The child is alert and oriented with no sensory or
and teachers as well as through direct observation.
perceptual alterations such as hallucinations. Ability
Assessing the child in a group of peers is likely to
to pay attention or to concentrate is markedly im-
yield useful information because the childs behavior
paired. The childs attention span may be as little as
may be subdued or different in a focused one-to-one
2 or 3 seconds with severe ADHD or 2 or 3 minutes
interaction with the nurse. It is often helpful to use a
in milder forms of the disorder. Assessing the childs
checklist when talking with parents to help focus
memory may be difficult; he or she frequently answers,
their input on the target symptoms or behaviors
I dont know because he or she cannot pay attention
their child exhibits.
to the question or stop the mind from racing. The
child with ADHD is very distractible and rarely able
HISTORY to complete tasks.
Parents may report that the child was fussy and had
problems as an infant. Or they may not have noticed JUDGMENT AND INSIGHT
the hyperactive behavior until the child was a tod-
dler or entered day care or school. The child probably Children with ADHD usually exhibit poor judgment
has difficulties in all major life areas, such as school and often do not think before acting. They may fail to
or play, and displays overactive or even dangerous perceive harm or danger and engage in impulsive acts
behavior at home. Often parents say the child is out such as running into the street or jumping off high
of control, and they feel unable to deal with the be- objects. Although assessing judgment and insight in
havior. Parents may report many largely unsuccess- young children is difficult, children with ADHD dis-
ful attempts to discipline the child or to change the play more lack of judgment when compared with those
behavior. of the same age. Most young children with ADHD are
totally unaware that their behavior is different from
that of others and cannot perceive how it harms others.
GENERAL APPEARANCE AND Older children might report, No one at school likes
MOTOR BEHAVIOR me, but they cannot relate the lack of friends to their
The child cannot sit still in a chair and squirms and own behavior.
wiggles while trying to do so. He or she may dart
around the room with little or no apparent purpose. SELF-CONCEPT
Speech is unimpaired, but the child cannot carry on
a conversation: he or she interrupts, blurts out an- Again, this may be difficult to assess in a very young
swers before the question is finished, and fails to pay child, but generally the self-esteem of children with
attention to what has been said. Conversation topics ADHD is low. Because they are not successful at
may jump abruptly. The child may appear immature school, may not develop many friends, and have
or lag behind in developmental milestones. trouble getting along at home, they generally feel out
of place and bad about themselves. The negative re-
actions their behavior evokes from others often cause
MOOD AND AFFECT them to see themselves as bad or stupid.
Mood may be labile, even to the point of verbal out-
bursts or temper tantrums. Anxiety, frustration, and
ROLES AND RELATIONSHIPS
agitation are common. The child appears to be driven
to keep moving or talking and appears to have little The child is usually unsuccessful academically and
control over movement or speech. Attempts to focus socially at school. He or she frequently is disruptive
490 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
IMPROVING ROLE PERFORMANCE ily and are less likely to meet expectations if times
for activities are arbitrary or differ from day to day.
It is extremely important to give the child specific,
positive feedback when he or she meets stated expec-
tations. Doing so reinforces desired behaviors and PROVIDING CLIENT AND FAMILY
gives the child a sense of accomplishment. For exam- EDUCATION AND SUPPORT
ple, the adult might say, You walked down the stairs
Including parents in planning and providing care for
safely or You did a good job of asking to play with
the child with ADHD is important. The nurse can
the guitar and waited until it was your turn.
teach parents the approaches described above for use
Managing the environment helps the child to
at home. Parents feel empowered and relieved to
improve his or her ability to listen, pay attention, and
have specific strategies that can help both them and
complete tasks. A quiet place with minimal noise and
their child be more successful.
distraction is desirable. At school, this may be a seat
The nurse must listen to parents feelings. They
directly facing the teacher at the front of the room
may feel frustrated, angry, or guilty and blame them-
and away from the distraction of a window or door.
selves or the school system for their childs problems.
At home, the child should have a quiet area for home- Parents need to hear that neither they nor their child
work away from the television or radio. are at fault, and that techniques and school pro-
grams are available to help. Children with ADHD
SIMPLIFYING INSTRUCTIONS qualify for special school services under the Individ-
uals with Disabilities Education Act (IDEA).
Before beginning any tasks, adults must gain the Because raising a child with ADHD can be frus-
childs full attention. It is helpful to face the child on trating and exhausting, it often helps parents to at-
his or her level and use good eye contact. The adult tend support groups that can provide information
should tell the child what needs to be done and break and encouragement from other parents with the same
the task into smaller steps if necessary. For example, problems. Parents must learn strategies to help their
if the child has 25 math problems, it may help to give child improve his or her social and academic abilities,
him or her 5 problems at a time, then 5 more when but they also must understand how to help rebuild
those are completed, and so on. This approach pre- their childs self-esteem. Most of these children have
vents overwhelming the child and provides the op- low self-esteem because they have been labeled as
portunity for feedback about each set of problems he having behavior problems and have been corrected
or she completes. With sedentary tasks, it is also im- continually by parents and teachers for not listen-
portant to allow the child to have breaks or opportu- ing, not paying attention, and misbehaving. Parents
nities to move around. should give positive comments as much as possible
Adults can use the same approach for tasks such to encourage the child and acknowledge his or her
as cleaning or picking up toys. Initially the child strengths. One technique to help parents to achieve
needs the supervision or at least the presence of the a good balance is to ask them to count the numbers
adult. The adult can direct the child to do one portion of times they praise or criticize their child each day
of the task at a time; when the child shows progress, or for several days.
the adult can give only occasional reminders then Although medication can help reduce hyper-
allow the child to complete the task independently. activity and inattention and allow the child to focus
It helps to provide specific, step-by-step directions during school, it is by no means a cure-all. The child
rather than give a general direction such as Please needs strategies and practice to improve social skills
clean your room. The adult could say, Put your dirty and academic performance. Because these children
clothes in the hamper. After this step is completed, often are not diagnosed until the second or third grade,
the adult gives another direction: Now make the
bed. The adult assigns specific tasks until the child
has completed the overall chore.
CLIENT/FAMILY TEACHING FOR ADHD
PROMOTING A STRUCTURED Include parents in planning and providing care.
DAILY ROUTINE Refer parents to support groups.
Focus on childs strengths as well as problems.
A structured daily routine is helpful. The child will Teach accurate administration of medication and
accomplish getting up, dressing, doing homework, possible side effects.
playing, going to bed, and so forth much more read- Inform parents that child is eligible for special
ily if there is a routine time for these daily activities. school services.
Children with ADHD do not adjust to changes read-
492 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
they may have missed much basic learning for read- CONDUCT DISORDER
ing and math. Parents should know that it will take
time for them to catch up to other children of the Conduct disorder is characterized by persistent
same age. antisocial behavior in children and adolescents
that significantly impairs their ability to function
in social, academic, or occupational areas. Symp-
Evaluation toms are clustered in four areas: aggression to peo-
Parents and teachers are likely to notice positive out- ple and animals, destruction of property, deceitful-
comes of treatment before the child does. Medica- ness and theft, and serious violation of rules (Steiner,
tions are often effective in decreasing hyperactivity 2000). People with conduct disorder have little
and impulsivity and improving attention relatively empathy for others; they have low self-esteem, poor
quickly, if the child responds to them. Improved so- frustration tolerance, and temper outbursts. Con-
ciability, peer relationships, and academic achieve- duct disorder frequently is associated with early
ment happen more slowly and gradually but are pos- onset of sexual behavior, drinking, smoking, use
sible with effective treatment. of illegal substances, and other reckless or risky
Nursing Diagnosis
Impaired Social Interaction
Insufficient or excessive quantity or ineffective quality of social exchange.
IMPLEMENTATION
Provide an environment as free from distractions The clients ability to deal with external stimula-
as possible. Institute interventions on a one-to-one tion is impaired.
basis. Gradually increase the amount of environ-
mental stimuli.
Engage the clients attention before giving instruc- The client must hear instructions as a first step
tions (i.e., call the clients name and establish eye toward compliance.
contact).
Give instructions slowly, using simple language The clients ability to comprehend instructions
and concrete directions. (especially if they are complex or abstract) is
impaired.
Ask the client to repeat instructions before be- Repetition demonstrates that the client has accu-
ginning tasks. rately received the information.
Separate complex tasks into small steps. The likelihood of success is enhanced with less
complicated components of a task.
Provide positive feedback for completion of The clients opportunity for successful experiences
each step. is increased by treating each step as an opportu-
nity for success.
Allow breaks during which the client can move The clients restless energy can be given an ac-
around. ceptable outlet, so that he or she can attend to
future tasks more effectively.
Clearly state expectations for task completion. The client must understand the request before he
or she can attempt task completion.
Initially assist the client to complete tasks. If the client is unable to complete a task indepen-
dently, having assistance will allow success and
will demonstrate how to complete the task.
Progress to prompting or reminding the client to The amount of intervention gradually is de-
perform tasks or assignments. creased to increase client independence as the
clients abilities increase.
Give the client positive feedback for performing This approach, called shaping, is a behavioral
behaviors that come close to task achievement. procedure in which successive approximations of
a desired behavior are positively reinforced. It al-
lows rewards to occur as the client gradually mas-
ters the actual expectation.
Assist the client to verbalize by asking sequenc- Sequencing questions provide a structure for dis-
ing questions to keep on the topic (Then what cussions to increase logical thought and decrease
happens? and What happens next?). tangentiality.
*Teach the clients family or caregivers to use the Successful interventions can be instituted by the
same procedures for the clients tasks and inter- clients family or caregivers by using this process.
actions at home. This will promote consistency and enhance the
clients chances for success.
*Explain and demonstrate positive parenting It is important for parents or caregivers to engage
techniques to family or caregivers such as time-in in techniques that will maintain their loving
for good behavior; i.e., being vigilant in identifying relationship with the child while promoting or at
the childs first bid for attention and responding least not interfering with therapeutic goals.
positively to that behavior; special time, i.e., guar- Children need to have a sense of being lovable to
anteed time a parent or surrogate spends daily their significant others that is not crucial to the
with the child with no interruptions and no dis- nurseclient therapeutic relationship.
cussion of problem-related topics; ignoring minor
transgressions by immediate withdrawal of eye
contact or physical contact and cessation of discus-
sion with the child to avoid secondary gains.
Adapted from Schultz, J. M. & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts Manual of Psychiatric Nursing Care Plans (6th ed.). Philadelphia:
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
behaviors. It occurs three times more often in boys 10 years of age. These adolescents are less likely to
than in girls. As many as 30% to 50% of these chil- be aggressive, and they have more normal peer re-
dren are diagnosed with antisocial personality dis- lationships. They are less likely to have persistent
order as adults. conduct disorder or antisocial personality disorder
as adults (APA, 2000).
Conduct disorders can be classified as mild, mod-
Onset and Clinical Course erate, or severe (APA, 2000):
Two subtypes of conduct disorder are based on age of Mild: The person has some conduct problems
onset. The childhood-onset type involves symptoms that cause relatively minor harm to others.
before 10 years of age including physical aggression Examples include lying, truancy, and staying
toward others and disturbed peer relationships. out late without permission.
These children are more likely to have persistent Moderate: The number of conduct problems
conduct disorder and to develop antisocial personal- increases as does the amount of harm to
ity disorder as adults. Adolescent-onset type is de- others. Examples include vandalism and
fined by no behaviors of conduct disorder until after theft.
20 CHILD AND ADOLESCENT DISORDERS 495
Severe: The person has many conduct prob- more likely to develop antisocial personality disorder
lems with considerable harm to others. Ex- as adults. Even those who do not have antisocial per-
amples include forced sex, cruelty to animals, sonality disorder may lead troubled lives with difficult
use of a weapon, burglary, and robbery. interpersonal relationships, unhealthy lifestyles, and
The course of conduct disorder is variable. People an inability to support themselves (Steiner, 2000).
with the adolescent-onset type or mild problems can
achieve adequate social relationships and academic or Etiology
occupational success as adults. Those with the child-
Researchers generally accept that genetic vulnerabil-
hood-onset type or more severe problem behaviors are
ity, environmental adversity, and factors such as poor
coping interact to cause the disorder. Risk factors
include poor parenting, low academic achievement,
poor peer relationships, and low self-esteem; protec-
tive factors include resilience, family support, positive
peer relationships, and good health (Steiner, 2000).
There is a genetic risk for conduct disorder, and may even worsen the situation (Steiner, 2000).
although no specific gene marker has been identi- Treatment must be geared toward the clients devel-
fied (Steiner, 2000). The disorder is more common in opmental age; no one treatment is suitable for all
children who have a sibling with conduct disorder ages. Preschool programs such as Head Start result
or a parent with antisocial personality disorder, in lower rates of delinquent behavior and conduct dis-
substance abuse, mood disorder, schizophrenia, or order through use of parental education about normal
ADHD (APA, 2000). growth and development, stimulation for the child,
A lack of reactivity of the autonomic nervous and parental support during crises.
system has been found in children with conduct dis- For school-age children with conduct disorder, the
order; this nonresponsiveness is similar to adults child, family, and school environment are the focus of
with antisocial personality disorder. The abnormal- treatment. Techniques include parenting education,
ity may cause more aggression in social relationships social skills training to improve peer relationships,
as a result of decreased normal avoidance or social and attempts to improve academic performance and
inhibitions. Research into the role of neurotransmit- increase the childs ability to comply with demands
ters is promising (Steiner, 2000). from authority figures. Family therapy is considered
Poor family functioning, marital discord, poor par- essential for children in this age group (Steiner, 2000).
enting, and a family history of substance abuse and Adolescents rely less on their parents and more
psychiatric problems are all associated with the devel- on peers, so treatment for this age group includes in-
opment of conduct disorder. Child abuse is an espe- dividual therapy. Many adolescent clients have some
cially significant risk factor. The specific parenting pat- involvement with the legal system as a result of crim-
terns considered ineffective are inconsistent parental inal behavior, and they may have restrictions on their
responses to the childs demands and giving in to de- freedom as a result. Use of alcohol and other drugs
mands as the childs behavior escalates. Exposure to plays a more significant role for this age group; any
violence in the media and community is a contributing treatment plan must address this issue. The most
factor for the child at risk in other areas. Socioeconomic promising treatment approach includes keeping the
disadvantages such as inadequate housing, crowded client in his or her environment with family and indi-
conditions, and poverty also increase the likelihood of vidual therapy. The plan usually includes conflict res-
conduct disorder in at-risk children (Steiner, 2000). olution, anger management, and teaching social skills.
Academic underachievement, learning disabili- Medications alone have little effect but may be
ties, hyperactivity, and problems with attention span used in conjunction with treatment for specific symp-
are all associated with conduct disorder. Children toms. For example, the client who presents a clear
with conduct disorder have difficulty functioning in danger to others may be prescribed an antipsychotic
social situations. They lack the abilities to respond medication or a client with a labile mood may bene-
appropriately to others and to negotiate conflict, and fit from lithium or another mood stabilizer such as
they lose the ability to restrain themselves when emo- carbamazepine (Tegretol) or valproic acid (Depakote)
tionally stressed. They often are accepted only by peers (Steiner, 2000).
with similar problems (Steiner, 2000).
APPLICATION OF THE NURSING
Cultural Considerations PROCESS: CONDUCT DISORDER
Concerns have been raised that difficult children Assessment
may be mistakenly labeled as having conduct disorder.
HISTORY
Knowing the clients history and circumstances is
essential for accurate diagnosis. In high-crime areas, Children with conduct disorder have a history of dis-
aggressive behavior may be protective and not nec- turbed relationships with peers, aggression toward
essarily indicative of conduct disorder. In immigrants people or animals, destruction of property, deceitful-
from war-ravaged countries, aggressive behavior may ness or theft, and serious violation of rules (e.g., tru-
have been necessary for survival so they should not be ancy, running away from home, staying out all night
diagnosed with conduct disorder (APA, 2000). without permission). The behaviors and problems
may be mild to severe.
Treatment
GENERAL APPEARANCE AND
Many treatments have been used for conduct dis-
MOTOR BEHAVIOR
order with only modest effectiveness. Early interven-
tion is more effective, and prevention is more effec- Appearance, speech, and motor behavior are typically
tive than treatment. Dramatic interventions such as normal for the age group but may be somewhat ex-
boot camp or incarceration have not proven effective treme (e.g., body piercings, tattoos, hairstyle, clothing).
20 CHILD AND ADOLESCENT DISORDERS 497
These clients often slouch and are sullen and unwill- tity is related to their behaviors such as being cool
ing to be interviewed. They may use profanity, call if they have had many sexual encounters or feeling
the nurse or physician names, and make disparaging important if they have stolen expensive merchandise
remarks about parents, teachers, police, and other or been expelled from school.
authority figures.
ROLES AND RELATIONSHIPS
MOOD AND AFFECT
Relationships with others, especially those in author-
Clients may be quiet and reluctant to talk or openly ity, are disruptive and may be violent. This includes
hostile and angry. Their attitude is likely to be dis- parents, teachers, police, and most other adults. Ver-
respectful toward parents, the nurse, or anyone in a bal and physical aggression is common. Siblings may
position of authority. Irritability, frustration, and be a target for ridicule or aggression. Relationships
temper outbursts are common. Clients may be un- with peers are limited to others who display similar
willing to answer questions or to cooperate with the behaviors; these clients see peers who follow rules
interview; they believe that they do not need help or as dumb or afraid. Clients usually have poor grades,
treatment. If a client has legal problems, he or she have been expelled, or have dropped out. It is unlikely
may express superficial guilt or remorse but it is un- that they have a job (if old enough) because they
likely that these emotions are sincere. would prefer to steal they want or needed. Their idea
of fulfilling roles is being tough, breaking rules, and
taking advantage of others.
THOUGHT PROCESS AND CONTENT
Thought processes are usually intactthat is, clients PHYSIOLOGIC AND SELF-CARE
are capable of logical, rational thinking. Nevertheless, CONSIDERATIONS
they perceive the world to be aggressive and threat-
ening and they respond in the same manner. Clients Clients are often at risk for unplanned pregnancy and
may be preoccupied with looking out for themselves sexually transmitted diseases because of their early
and behave as though everyone is out to get me. and frequent sexual behavior. Use of drugs and alco-
Thoughts or fantasies about death or violence are hol is an additional risk to health. Clients with con-
common. duct disorders are involved in physical aggression
and violence including weapons; this results in more
injuries and deaths than compared with others of the
SENSORIUM AND same age.
INTELLECTUAL PROCESSES
Clients are alert and oriented with intact memory Data Analysis and Planning
and no sensory-perceptual alterations. Intellectual
Nursing diagnoses commonly used for clients with
capacity is not impaired, but typically these clients conduct disorders include the following:
have poor grades because of academic underachieve- Risk for Other-Directed Violence
ment, behavioral problems in school, or failure to Noncompliance
attend class and to complete assignments. Ineffective Coping
Impaired Social Interaction
JUDGMENT AND INSIGHT Chronic Low Self-Esteem
INTERVENTIONS FOR CONDUCT DISORDER The nurse must show acceptance of clients as worth-
while persons even if their behavior is unacceptable.
Decreasing violence and increasing compliance
This means that the nurse must be matter-of-fact
with treatment
Protect others from clients aggression and
about setting limits and must not make judgmental
manipulation. statements about clients. He or she must focus only
Set limits for unacceptable behavior. on the behavior. For example, if a client broke a chair
Provide consistency with clients treatment plan. during an angry outburst, the nurse would say,
Use behavioral contracts. John, breaking chairs is unacceptable behavior. You
Institute time-out. need to let staff know youre upset so you can talk about
Provide a routine schedule of daily activities. it instead of acting out. The nurse must avoid saying
Improving coping skills and self-esteem things like, Whats the matter with you? Dont you
Show acceptance of the person, not necessarily know any better? Comments such as these are per-
the behavior. sonal and do not focus on the specific behavior; they
Encourage the client to keep a diary.
reinforce the clients self-image as a bad person.
Teach and practice problem-solving skills.
Promoting social interaction
Clients with a conduct disorder often have a tough
Teach age-appropriate social skills. exterior and are unable or reluctant to discuss feel-
Role-model and practice social skills. ings and emotions. Keeping a diary may help them
Provide positive feedback for acceptable to identify and express their feelings. The nurse can
behavior. discuss these feelings with clients and explore bet-
Providing client and family education ter, safer expressions than through aggression or
acting out.
20 CHILD AND ADOLESCENT DISORDERS 499
Nursing Diagnosis
Ineffective Coping
Inability to form a valid appraisal of the stressors, inadequate choices of practiced
responses, and/or inability to use available resources.
IMPLEMENTATION
Nursing Interventions *denotes collaborative interventions Rationale
Encourage the client to openly discuss his or her Verbalizing feelings is an initial step toward deal-
thoughts and feelings. ing with them in an appropriate manner.
Give positive feedback for appropriate discussions. Positive feedback increases the likelihood of
continued performance.
Tell the client that he or she is accepted as a per- Clients with conduct disorders frequently experi-
son, although a particular behavior may not be ence rejection. The client needs support to
acceptable. increase self-esteem, while understanding that
behavioral changes are necessary.
Give the client positive attention when behavior The client may have been receiving the majority
is not problematic. of attention from others when he or she was en-
gaged in problematic behavior, a pattern that
needs to change.
Teach the client about limit-setting and the need The client may have no knowledge of the concept
for these limits. Include time for discussion. of limits and how limits can be beneficial. The
client has an opportunity to ask questions when
manipulation is not needed. This allows the client
to hear about the relationship between aberrant
behavior and consequences.
Teach the client a simple problem-solving process The client may not know how to solve problems
as an alternative to acting out (identify the prob- constructively or may not have seen this behavior
lem, consider alternatives, select and implement modeled in the home.
an alternative, evaluate the effectiveness of the
solution).
Help the client to practice the problem-solving The clients abilities and skills will increase with
process with situations on the unit, then with sit- practice. He or she will experience success with
uations the client may face at home, school, and practice.
so forth.
Role-model appropriate conversation and social This allows the client to see what is expected in a
skills for the client. nonthreatening situation.
Specify and describe the skills you are Clarification of expectations decreases the chance
demonstrating. that the client will misinterpret expectations.
Practice social skills with the client on a one-to-one As the client gains comfort with the skills
basis. through practice, he or she will increase their use.
Gradually introduce other clients into the inter- Success with others is more likely to occur once
actions and discussions. the client has been successful with the staff.
Assist the client to focus on age- and situation- Peer relationships are enhanced when the client
appropriate topics. is able to interact as other adolescents do.
Encourage the client to give and receive feedback Peer feedback can be influential in shaping the
with others in his or her age group. behavior of an adolescent.
Teach the client about transmission of human All clients need to know how to prevent transmis-
immunodeficiency virus (HIV) infection and other sion of HIV and STDs. Because these clients may
sexually transmitted diseases (STDs). act out sexually or use intravenous drugs, it is es-
pecially important that they be educated about
HIV infections.
*Assess the clients use of alcohol or other sub- Often adolescents with conduct disorders also
stances, and provide referrals as indicated. have substance abuse issues.
Adapted from Schultz, J. M. & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts Manual of Psychiatric Nursing Care Plans (6th ed.). Philadelphia:
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
502 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Box 20-2
THE SNAP-IV TEACHER + PARENT RATING SCALE
James M. Swanson, PhD, University of California, Irvine, CA 92715
Name
Completed by
Not At Just Quite A Very
For each item, check the column which best describes this child: All Little A Bit Much
Table 20-2
ACCEPTABLE CHARACTERISTICS AND ABNORMAL BEHAVIOR IN ADOLESCENCE
Acceptable Abnormal
Occasional psychosomatic complaints Fears, anxiety, and guilt about sex, health, education
Inconsistent and unpredictable behavior Defiant, negative, or depressed behavior
Eagerness for peer approval Frequent hypochondriacal complaints
Competitive in play Learning irregular or deficient
Erratic work-leisure patterns Poor personal relationships with peers
Critical of self and others Inability to postpone gratification
Highly ambivalent toward parents Unwillingness to assume greater autonomy
Anxiety about lost parental nurturing Acts of delinquency, ritualism, obsessions
Verbal aggression to parents Sexual aberrations
Strong moral and ethical perceptions Inability to work or socialize
Adapted from Cotton, N. S. (2000). Normal adolescence. In B. J. Sadoch & V. A. Sadoch (Eds.). Comprehen-
sive textbook of psychiatry (7th ed., pp. 25502557). Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
504 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
ity of the tics change over time, and the person expe-
riences almost all the possible tics described above
during his or her lifetime. The person has significant
impairment in academic, social, or occupational areas
and feels ashamed and self-conscious. This rare dis-
order (4 or 5 in 10,000) is more common in boys and
usually identified by 7 years of age. Some people have
lifelong problems; others have no symptoms after
early adulthood (APA, 2000).
ELIMINATION DISORDERS
Encopresis is the repeated passage of feces into in-
appropriate places, such as clothing or the floor, by a
child who is at least 4 years of age either chronologi-
cally or developmentally. It is often involuntary, but
it can be intentional. Involuntary encopresis usually
is associated with constipation that occurs for psycho-
logical, not medical, reasons. Intentional encopresis
Oppositionaldefiant disorder often is associated with oppositional defiant disorder
or conduct disorder.
Stress exacerbates tics, which diminish during sleep Enuresis is the repeated voiding of urine during
and when the person is engaged in an absorbing ac- the day or at night into clothing or bed by a child at
tivity. Common simple motor tics include blinking, least 5 years of age either chronologically or develop-
jerking the neck, shrugging the shoulders, grimac- mentally. Most often enuresis is involuntary; when
ing, and coughing. Common simple vocal tics include intentional, it is associated with a disruptive behav-
clearing the throat, grunting, sniffing, snorting, and ior disorder. Seventy-five percent of children with
barking. Complex vocal tics include repeating words enuresis have a first-degree relative who had the dis-
or phrases out of context, coprolalia (use of socially order. Most children with enuresis do not have a co-
unacceptable words, frequently obscene), palilalia existing mental disorder.
(repeating ones own sounds or words), and echolalia Both encopresis and enuresis are more common
(repeating the last-heard sound word or phrase) in boys than in girls; 1% of all 5 year olds have enco-
(APA, 2000). Complex motor tics include facial ges- presis and 5% of all 5 year olds have enuresis. Enco-
tures, jumping, or touching or smelling an object. presis can persist with intermittent exacerbations for
Tic disorders tend to run in families. Abnormal years; it is rarely chronic. Most children with enure-
transmission of the neurotransmitter dopamine is sis are continent by adolescence; only 1% of all cases
thought to play a part in tic disorders (McCracken, persist into adulthood.
2000b). Tic disorders usually are treated with risperi- Impairment associated with elimination dis-
done (Risperdal) or olanzapine (Zyprexa), which are orders depends on the limitations on the childs social
atypical antipsychotics. It is important for clients activities, effects on self-esteem, degree of social os-
with tic disorders to get plenty of rest and to manage tracism by peers, and anger, punishment, and rejec-
stress, because fatigue and stress increase symptoms. tion on the part of parents or caregivers (APA, 2000).
Enuresis can be treated effectively with imipra-
mine (Tofranil), an antidepressant with a side effect
TOURETTES DISORDER of urinary retention. Both elimination disorders re-
Tourettes disorder involves multiple motor tics spond to behavioral approaches, such as a pad with a
and one or more vocal tics, which occur many times a warning bell, and to positive reinforcement for conti-
day for more than 1 year. The complexity and sever- nence. For children with a disruptive behavior dis-
20 CHILD AND ADOLESCENT DISORDERS 505
order, psychological treatment of that disorder may dren are often excessively shy, socially withdrawn
improve the elimination disorder (Mikkelsen, 2000). or isolated, and clinging; they may have temper
tantrums. Selective mutism is rare and slightly more
common in girls than in boys. It usually lasts only a
OTHER DISORDERS OF INFANCY, few months but may persist for years.
CHILDHOOD, OR ADOLESCENCE
SEPARATION ANXIETY DISORDER REACTIVE ATTACHMENT DISORDER
Separation anxiety disorder is characterized by anx- Reactive attachment disorder involves a markedly
iety exceeding that expected for developmental level disturbed and developmentally inappropriate social
related to separation from the home or those to whom relatedness in most situations. This disorder usually
the child is attached (APA, 2000). When apart from begins before 5 years of age and is associated with
attachment figures, the child insists on knowing their grossly pathogenic care such as parental neglect,
whereabouts and may need frequent contact with abuse, or failure to meet the childs basic physical or
them such as phone calls. These children are mis- emotional needs. Repeated changes in primary care-
erable away from home and may fear never seeing givers, such as multiple foster care placements, also
their homes or loved ones again. They often follow can prevent the formation of stable attachments
parents like a shadow, will not be in a room alone, (APA, 2000). The disturbed social relatedness may be
and have trouble going to bed at night unless some- evidenced by the childs failure to initiate or respond
one stays with them. Fear of separation may lead to to social interaction (inhibited type) or indiscrimi-
avoidance behaviors such as refusal to attend school nate sociability or lack of selectivity in choice of at-
or go on errands. Separation anxiety disorder often is
tachment figures (disinhibited type). In the first type,
accompanied by nightmares and multiple physical
the child will not cuddle or desire to be close to any-
complaints such as headaches, nausea, vomiting, and
one. In the second type, the childs response is the
dizziness.
same to a stranger or to a parent.
Separation anxiety disorders are thought to re-
Initially, treatment focuses on the childs safety,
sult from an interaction between temperament and
including removal of the child from the home if ne-
parenting behaviors. Inherited temperament traits,
glect or abuse is found. Individual and family ther-
such as passivity, avoidance, fearfulness, or shyness
in novel situations, coupled with parenting behaviors apy (either with parents or foster caregivers) is most
that encourage avoidance as a way to deal with effective. With early identification and effective in-
strange or unknown situations are thought to cause tervention, remission or considerable improvements
anxiety in the child (Sylvester, 2000). can be attained. Otherwise the disorder follows a
Depending on the severity of the disorder, chil- continuous course with relationship problems per-
dren may have academic difficulties and social with- sisting into adulthood.
drawal if their avoidance behavior keeps them from
school or relationships with others. Children may be STEREOTYPIC MOVEMENT
described as demanding, intrusive, and in need of DISORDER
constant attention, or they may be compliant and
eager to please. As adults, they may be slow to leave Stereotypic movement disorder is associated with
the family home or overly concerned about and pro- many genetic, metabolic, and neurologic disorders
tective of their own spouses and children. They may and often accompanies mental retardation. The pre-
continue to have marked discomfort when separated cise cause is unknown. It involves repetitive motor
from home or family. Parent education and family behavior that is nonfunctional and either interferes
therapy are essential components of treatment; 80% with normal activities or results in self-injury re-
of children experience remission at 4-year follow-up quiring medical treatment (APA, 2000). Stereotypic
(Sylvester, 2000). movements may include waving, rocking, twirling
objects, biting fingernails, banging the head, biting
or hitting oneself, or picking at the skin or body ori-
SELECTIVE MUTISM fices. Generally speaking, the more severe the retar-
Selective mutism is characterized by persistent fail- dation, the higher the risk for self-injury behaviors.
ure to speak in social situations where speaking is Stereotypic movement behaviors are relatively stable
expected, such as school (APA, 2000). Children may over time but may diminish with age (Luby, 2000).
communicate by gestures, nodding or shaking the No specific treatment has been shown effective.
head, or occasionally one-syllable vocalizations in a Clomipramine (Anafranil) and desipramine (Nor-
voice different from their natural voice. These chil- pramin) are effective in treating severe nail-biting;
506 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
Kimball, J. W. (2002). Behavior analytic instruction for book of psychiatry (7th ed., pp. 27702777). Philadel-
children with autism. Focus on Autism and Other phia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Developmental Disabilities, 17(2), 5566. Swanson, J. M. (2000). The SNAP-IV Teacher + Parent
King, B. H., Hodapp, R. M., & Dykens, E. M. (2000). Men- Rating Scale. Document available: http://www.add-
tal retardation. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), pediatrics.com/add/snap-iv.html
Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry (7th ed., Sylvester, C. (2000). Separation anxiety disorder and
pp. 25872613). Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams other anxiety disorders. In B. J. Sadock & V. A.
& Wilkins. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry
Lehne, R. A. (2001). Pharmacology for nursing care (7th ed., pp. 26592678). Philadelphia: Lippincott
(4th ed.). Philadelphia: W. B. Saunders. Williams & Wilkins.
Luby, J. L. (2000). Stereotypic movement disorder of Tanguay, P. E. (2000). Pervasive developmental dis-
infancy and disorders of infancy and childhood not orders: A 10-year review. Journal of the American
otherwise specified. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock Academy of Child and Adolescent Psychiatry, 39(3),
(Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry 10791095.
(7th ed., pp. 27352739). Philadelphia: Lippincott Volkmar, F. R., & Klin, A. (2000). Pervasive developmen-
Williams & Wilkins. tal disorders. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.),
McCracken, J. T. (2000a). Attention deficit disorders. In Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry (7th ed.,
B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive pp. 26592678). Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams
textbook of psychiatry (7th ed., pp. 26792687).
& Wilkins.
Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Wender, P. H. (2000). Adult manifestations of attention
McCracken, J. T. (2000b). Tic disorders. In B. J. Sadock
deficit/hyperactivity disorder. In B. J. Sadock & V. A.
& V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of
psychiatry (7th ed., pp. 27112719). Philadelphia: Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins. (7th ed., pp. 26882692). Philadelphia: Lippincott
Mikkelsen, E. J. (2000). Elimination disorders. In B. J. Williams & Wilkins.
Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive text-
book of psychiatry (7th ed., pp. 27202728). Philadel-
phia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins. ADDITIONAL READINGS
Mohr, W. K. (2001). Bipolar disorder in children. Journal
of Psychosocial Nursing, 39(3), 1218. Ambrosini, P. J. (2000). A review of pharmacotherapy of
Moyer, P. (2002). Cognitive behavioral therapy may major depression in children and adolescents. Psychi-
prevent anxiety disorders in at-risk children. atric Services, 51(5), 627633.
Reuter Medical News. Document available: Baker, C. (1999). Innovative new program: from chaos to
http://www.medscape.com/viewarticle/443686 order: A nursing-based psychoeducation program for
National Institute of Child Health and Human Develop- parents of children with attention deficit-hyperactivity
ment. (2002). Document available: http://ww.nichd.nih/ disorder. Canadian Journal of Nursing Research,
gov/publications/pub/autism/facts 31(2), 7175.
Pary, R., Lewis, S., Matuschka, P. R., & Lippmann, S. Gordon, M. F. (2000). Normal child development. In
(2002). Attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder: An B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive
update. Southern Medical Journal, 95(7), 743749. textbook of psychiatry (7th ed., pp. 25342557).
Searight, H. R. (2000). Adult ADD: Evaluation and treat- Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
ment in family medicine. American Family Physi- Pataki, C. S. (2000). Child psychiatry: Introduction and
cian, 62(9), 20772086. overview. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.),
Spagna, M. E., Cantwell, D. P., & Baker, L. (2002). Motor Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry (7th ed.,
skills disorder: Developmental coordination disorder. pp. 25322534). Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams
In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive & Wilkins.
textbook of psychiatry (7th ed., pp. 26292633). Tremblay, C., Hebert, M., & Piche, C. (2000). Type I
Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins. and type II posttraumatic stress disorder in sexu-
Steiner, H. (2000). Disruptive behavior disorders. In B. J. ally abused children. Journal of Child Sexual
Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive text- Abuse, 9(1), 6590.
Chapter Study Guide
MULTIPLE-CHOICE QUESTIONS
Select the best answer for each of the following
questions.
1. A child is taking pemoline (Cylert) for ADHD. A. Critical of self and others
The nurse must be aware of which of the follow- B. Defiant, negative, and depressed behavior
ing side effects?
C. Frequent hypochondriacal complaints
A. Decreased thyroid-stimulating hormone
D. Unwillingness to assume greater autonomy
B. Decreased red blood cell count
C. Elevated white blood cell count 5. Which of the following is used to treat enuresis?
D. Elevated liver function tests A. Imipramine (Tofranil)
B. Methylphenidate (Ritalin)
2. Teaching for methylphenidate (Ritalin) should
include which of the following? C. Olanzapine (Zyprexa)
A. Give the medication after meals. D. Risperidone (Risperdal)
B. Give the medication when the child becomes 6. An effective nursing intervention for the impul-
overactive. sive and aggressive behaviors that accompany
C. Increase the childs fluid intake when he or conduct disorder is
she is taking the medication. A. Assertiveness training
D. Take the childs temperature daily. B. Consistent limit setting
3. The nurse would expect to see all the following C. Negotiation of rules
symptoms in a child with ADHD except D. Open expression of feelings
A. Easily distracted and forgetful
7. The nurse recognizes which of the following as a
B. Excessive running, climbing, and fidgeting common behavioral sign of autism?
C. Moody, sullen, and pouting behavior A. Clinging behavior toward parents
D. Interrupts others and cant take turns B. Creative, imaginative play with peers
4. Which of the following is normal adolescent C. Early language development
behavior? D. Indifference to being hugged or held
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify the disorder associated with the following behaviors.
509
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
1. Define the steps in limit setting.
510
2. What information will the nurse provide about ADHD?
4. What referrals can the nurse make for Dixie and her parents?
511
21 Cognitive
Disorders
Learning Objectives
After reading this chapter, the
student should be able to
512
21 COGNITIVE DISORDERS 513
Cognition is the brains ability to process, retain, and sory disturbances such as illusions, misinterpreta-
use information. Cognitive abilities include reason- tions, or hallucinations. An electrical cord on the floor
ing, judgment, perception, attention, comprehension, may appear to them to be a snake (illusion). They may
and memory. These cognitive abilities are essential for mistake the banging of a laundry cart in the hall-
many important tasks including making decisions, way for a gunshot (misinterpretation). They may
solving problems, interpreting the environment, and see angels hovering above when nothing is there
learning new information. (hallucination). At times, they also experience distur-
A cognitive disorder is a disruption or impair- bances in the sleepwake cycle, changes in psycho-
ment in these higher-level functions of the brain. motor activity, and emotional problems such as anx-
Cognitive disorders can have devastating effects on iety, fear, irritability, euphoria, or apathy (American
the ability to function in daily life. They can cause Psychiatric Association [APA], 2000).
people to forget the names of immediate family An estimated 10% to 15% of people in the hospi-
members, to be unable to perform daily household tal for general medical conditions are delirious at any
tasks, and to neglect personal hygiene (Caine & given time. Delirium is common in older acutely ill
Lyness, 2000). clients. An estimated 30% to 50% of acutely ill older
The primary categories of cognitive disorders adult clients become delirious at some time during
are delirium, dementia, and amnestic disorders. All their hospital stay. Risk factors for delirium include
involve impairment of cognition, but they vary with increased severity of physical illness, older age, and
respect to cause, treatment, prognosis, and effect on baseline cognitive impairment (e.g., as seen in de-
clients and family members or caregivers. This chap- mentia; Caine & Lyness, 2000). Children may be more
ter focuses on delirium and dementia. It emphasizes susceptible to delirium especially related to a febrile
not only care of clients with cognitive disorders but illness or certain medications such as anticholiner-
also the needs of their caregivers. gics (APA, 2000).
DELIRIUM Etiology
Delirium is a syndrome that involves a disturbance Delirium almost always results from an identifiable
of consciousness accompanied by a change in cog- physiologic, metabolic, or cerebral disturbance or dis-
nition. Delirium usually develops over a short pe- ease or from drug intoxication or withdrawal. The
riod, sometimes a matter of hours, and fluctuates or most common causes are listed in Box 21-1. Often
changes throughout the course of the day. Clients delirium results from multiple causes and requires a
with delirium have difficulty paying attention, are careful and thorough physical examination and lab-
easily distracted and disoriented, and may have sen- oratory tests for identification.
PSYCHOPHARMACOLOGY
SYMPTOMS OF DELIRIUM Clients with quiet, hypoactive delirium need no spe-
Difficulty with attention
cific pharmacologic treatment aside from that indi-
Easily distractible cated for the causative condition. Many clients with
Disoriented delirium, however, show persistent or intermittent
May have sensory disturbances such as illusions, psychomotor agitation that can interfere with effec-
misinterpretations, or hallucinations tive treatment or pose a risk to safety. Sedation to pre-
Can have sleepwake cycle disturbances vent inadvertent self-injury may be indicated. An
Changes in psychomotor activity antipsychotic medication such as haloperidol (Haldol)
May experience anxiety, fear, irritability, eupho- may be used in doses of 0.5 to 1 mg to decrease agi-
ria, or apathy
tation. Sedatives and benzodiazepines are avoided
because they may worsen delirium (Caine & Lyness,
2000). Clients with impaired liver or kidney function
Cultural Considerations could have difficulty metabolizing or excreting seda-
People from different cultural backgrounds may not tives. The exception is delirium induced by alcohol
be familiar with the information requested to assess withdrawal, which usually is treated with benzo-
memory such as the name of former U.S. presidents. diazepines (see Chap. 17).
Other cultures may consider orientation to placement
and location differently. Also some cultures and reli- OTHER MEDICAL TREATMENT
gions, such as Jehovahs Witnesses, do not celebrate
birthdays, so clients may have difficulty stating their While the underlying causes of delirium are being
date of birth. The nurse should not mistake failure to treated, clients also may need other supportive phys-
know such information for disorientation (APA, 2000). ical measures. Adequate, nutritious food and fluid
intake will speed recovery. Intravenous fluids or even
total parenteral nutrition may be necessary if a clients
Treatment and Prognosis physical condition has deteriorated and he or she
The primary treatment for delirium is to identify and cannot eat and drink.
to treat any causal or contributing medical conditions. If a client becomes agitated and threatens to
Delirium is almost always a transient condition that dislodge intravenous tubing or catheters, physical
clears with successful treatment of the underlying restraints may be necessary so that needed medical
cause. Nevertheless some causes, such as head injury treatments can continue. Restraints are used only
or encephalitis, may leave clients with cognitive, when necessary and stay in place no longer than
behavioral, or emotional impairments even after the warranted because they may increase the clients
underlying cause resolves. agitation.
Box 21-1
MOST COMMON CAUSES OF DELIRIUM
Physiologic or metabolic Hypoxemia, electrolyte disturbances, renal or hepatic failure, hypo- or hyperglycemia,
dehydration, sleep deprivation, thyroid or glucocorticoid disturbances, thiamine or vi-
tamin B12 deficiency, vitamin C, niacin, or protein deficiency, cardiovascular shock,
brain tumor, head injury, and exposure to gasoline, paint solvents, insecticides, and
related substances
Infection Systemic: sepsis, urinary tract infection, pneumonia
Cerebral: meningitis, encephalitis, HIV, syphilis
Drug-related Intoxication: anticholinergics, lithium, alcohol, sedatives, and hypnotics
Withdrawal: alcohol, sedatives, and hypnotics
Reactions to anesthesia, prescription medication or illicit (street) drugs
Compiled from Caine, E. D., & Lyness, J. M. (2000). Delirium, dementia, and amnestic and other cognitive disorders. In B. J.
Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.). Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 854923). Philadelphia: Lippincott
Williams & Wilkins, and Ribby, K. J., & Cox, K. R. (1996). Development, implementation, and evaluation of a confusion protocol.
Clinical Nurse Specialist, 10(5), 241247.
21 COGNITIVE DISORDERS 515
SENSORIUM AND
MOOD AND AFFECT INTELLECTUAL PROCESSES
Clients with delirium often have rapid and unpre- The primary and often initial sign of delirium is an
dictable mood shifts. A wide range of emotional re- altered level of consciousness that is seldom stable and
sponses is possible such as anxiety, fear, irritability, usually fluctuates throughout the day. Clients usually
anger, euphoria, and apathy. These mood shifts and are oriented to person but frequently disoriented to
emotions usually have nothing to do with the clients time and place. They demonstrate decreased aware-
516 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
JUDGMENT AND INSIGHT person; I did this to myself. This would indicate pos-
sible long-term problems with self-concept.
Judgment is impaired. Clients often cannot perceive
potentially harmful situations or act in their own best
interests. For example, they may try repeatedly to PHYSIOLOGIC AND
pull out intravenous tubing or urinary catheters; this SELF-CARE CONSIDERATIONS
causes pain and interferes with necessary treatment.
Clients with delirium most often experience dis-
Insight depends on the severity of the delirium.
turbed sleepwake cycles that may include difficulty
Clients with mild delirium may recognize that they
falling asleep, daytime sleepiness, nighttime agita-
are confused, receiving treatment, and will likely
tion, or even a complete reversal of the usual daytime
improve. Those with severe delirium may have no
waking/nighttime sleeping pattern (APA, 2000). At
insight into the situation.
times, clients also ignore or fail to perceive internal
body cues such as hunger, thirst or the urge to uri-
ROLES AND RELATIONSHIPS nate or defecate.
Outcome Identification ple, the nurse might say, Good morning, Mrs. Jones.
I see you are awake and look ready for breakfast
Treatment outcomes for the client with delirium may (giving information). Reminding the client of the
include the following: nurses name and role repeatedly may be necessary
The client will be free of injury. such as My name is Sheila, and Im your nurse today.
The client will demonstrate increased orien- Im here now to walk in the hall with you (reality
tation and reality contact. orientation). Orienting objects, such as a calendar and
The client will maintain an adequate balance clock, in the clients room are useful.
of activity and rest. Often the use of touch reassures clients and
The client will maintain adequate nutrition provides contact with reality. It is important to eval-
and fluid balance. uate each clients response to touch rather than as-
The client will return to his or her optimal sume all clients will welcome it. A client who smiles
level of functioning. or draws closer to the nurse when touched is re-
sponding positively. The fearful client may perceive
Intervention touch as threatening rather than comforting and
startle or draw away.
PROMOTING THE CLIENTS SAFETY Clients with delirium can experience sensory
Maintaining the clients safety is the priority focus of overload, which means more stimulation is coming
nursing interventions. Medications should be used into the brain than they can handle. Reducing envi-
judiciously because sedatives may worsen confu- ronmental stimulation is helpful because these clients
sion and increase the risk for falls or other injuries are distracted and overstimulated easily. Minimizing
(Small, 2000). environmental noises including television or radio
The nurse teaches clients to request assistance should calm them. It is also important to monitor
for activities such as getting out of bed or going to the response to visitors. Too many visitors or more than
bathroom. If clients cannot request assistance, they one person talking at once may increase the clients
require close supervision to prevent them from at- confusion. The nurse can explain to visitors that the
tempting activities they cannot perform safely alone. client will best tolerate quiet talking with one person
The nurse responds promptly to calls from clients for at a time.
assistance and checks clients at frequent intervals. The clients room should be well lit to minimize
If a client is agitated or pulling at intravenous environmental misperceptions. When clients experi-
lines or catheters, physical restraints may be nec- ence illusions or misperceptions, the nurse corrects
essary. Use of restraints, however, may increase them matter-of-factly. It is important to validate the
the clients fears or feelings of being threatened so clients feelings of anxiety or fear generated by the
restraints are a last resort. The nurse first tries other misperception but not to reinforce that mispercep-
strategies such as having a family member stay with tion. For example, a client hears a loud noise in the
the client to reassure him or her. hall and asks the nurse, Was that an explosion?
The nurse might respond, No, that was a cart bang-
ing in the hall. It was really loud, wasnt it? It made
MANAGING THE CLIENTS CONFUSION
me startle a little when I heard it (presenting reality/
The nurse approaches these clients calmly and speaks validating feelings).
in a clear, low voice. It is important to give realistic
reassurance to clients such as I know things are up-
PROMOTING SLEEP AND
setting and confusing right now, but your confusion
PROPER NUTRITION
should clear as you get better (validating/giving in-
formation). Facing clients while speaking helps to The nurse monitors the clients sleep and elimination
capture their attention. The nurse provides explana- patterns and food and fluid intake. Clients may re-
tions that clients can comprehend, avoiding lengthy quire prompting or assistance to eat and drink ade-
or too detailed discussions. The nurse phrases ques- quate food and fluids. It may be helpful to sit with
tions or provides directions to clients in short, simple clients at meals or frequently offer fluids. Family mem-
sentences, allowing adequate time for clients to grasp bers also may be able to help clients to improve their
the content or to respond to a question. He or she per- intake. Assisting clients to the bathroom periodically
mits clients to make decisions as they are able and may be necessary to promote elimination if clients do
takes care not to overwhelm or frustrate them. not make these requests independently.
The nurse provides orienting cues when talking Promoting a balance of rest and sleep is impor-
with clients such as calling them by name and refer- tant if clients are experiencing a disturbed sleep pat-
ring to the time of day or expected activity. For exam- tern. Discouraging or limiting daytime napping may
518 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
Nursing Diagnosis
Acute Confusion
Abrupt onset of a cluster of global, transient changes and disturbances in attention,
cognition, psychomotor activity, level of consciousness, and/or sleep/wake cycle.
IMPLEMENTATION
If limits on the clients behavior or actions are The client has the right to be informed of any
necessary, explain limits, consequences, and restrictions and the reasons limits are needed.
reasons clearly within the clients ability to
understand.
Involve the client in making plans or decisions as Compliance with treatment is enhanced if the
much as he or she is able to participate. client is emotionally invested in it.
Give the client factual feedback on his or her The client must become aware that his or her
misperceptions, delusions, or hallucinations perceptions are not shared by others.
(e.g., That is a chair.).
In a matter-of-fact manner, convey to the client When given feedback in a nonjudgmental way,
that others do not share his or her interpretations the client can feel validated for his or her feelings,
(e.g., I dont see anyone else in the room.). while recognizing that others do not respond to
similar stimuli in the same way.
Assess the client daily or more often if needed for Clients with organically based problems tend to
his or her level of functioning. fluctuate frequently in terms of their capabilities.
Allow the client to make decisions as much as he Decision-making increases the clients participa-
or she is able. tion, independence, and self-esteem.
Assist the client to establish a daily routine Activities that are routine or part of the clients
including hygiene, activities, and so forth. habits do not require continual decisions about
whether or not to perform a particular task.
Teach the client about underlying cause(s) of When the client has knowledge about the cause(s)
confusion and delirium. of confusion, he or she can seek assistance when
indicated.
Adapted from Schultz, J. M. & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts Manual of Psychiatric Nursing Care Plans (6th ed.). Philadelphia:
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Etiology
Causes vary although the clinical picture is similar
for most dementias. Often no definitive diagnosis can
be made until completion of a postmortem examina-
tion. Metabolic activity is decreased in the brains of
clients with dementia (Fig. 21-1); it is not known
whether dementia causes decreased metabolic activ-
ity or if decreased metabolic activity results in de-
mentia. A genetic component has been identified for
Multiple cognitive deficits of dementia.
some dementias such as Huntingtons disease. An
abnormal APOE Gene is known to be linked with
Alzheimers disease. Other causes of dementia are
Moderate: Confusion is apparent along with related to infections such as HIV or Creutzfeldt-Jakob
progressive memory loss. The person no disease. The most common types of dementia and their
longer can perform complex tasks but known or hypothesized causes follow (APA, 2000;
remains oriented to person and place. He or Caine & Lyness, 2000; Small, 2000):
she still recognizes familiar people. Toward Alzheimers disease is a progressive brain
the end of this stage, the person loses the disorder that has a gradual onset but causes
ability to live independently and requires an increasing decline in functioning includ-
assistance because of disorientation to time ing loss of speech, loss of motor function, and
and loss of information such as address and profound personality and behavioral changes
Table 21-1
COMPARISON OF DELIRIUM AND DEMENTIA
Indicator Delirium Dementia
Figure 21-1. Metabolic activity in a subject with Alzheimers disease (left) and in a
control subject (right). (Courtesy of Monte S. Buchsbaum, MD, The Mount Sinai
Medical Center and School of Medicine, New York, New York.)
Parkinsons disease is a slowly progres- elderly family members. In many Eastern countries
sive neurologic condition characterized by and among Native Americans, elders hold a position
tremor, rigidity, bradykinesia, and postural of authority, respect, power, and decision-making for
instability. It results from loss of neurons the family; this does not change despite memory loss
of the basal ganglia. Dementia has been or confusion. For fear of seeming disrespectful, other
reported in approximately 20% to 60% of family members may be reluctant to make decisions
people with Parkinsons disease and is or plans for elders with dementia. The nurse must
characterized by cognitive and motor slow- work with family members to accomplish goals with-
ing, impaired memory, and impaired execu- out making them feel that they have betrayed the
tive functioning. revered elder.
Huntingtons disease is an inherited,
dominant gene disease that primarily
involves cerebral atrophy, demyelination, Treatment and Prognosis
and enlargement of the brain ventricles. Whenever possible, the underlying cause of demen-
Initially there are choreiform movements tia is identified so that treatment can be instituted.
that are continuous during waking hours For example, the progress of vascular dementia, the
and involve facial contortions, twisting, second most common type, may be halted with ap-
turning, and tongue movements. Personality propriate treatment of the underlying vascular con-
changes are the initial psychosocial manifes- dition (e.g., changes in diet, exercise, control of hyper-
tations followed by memory loss, decreased tension or diabetes). Improvement of cerebral blood
intellectual functioning, and other signs of flow may arrest the progress of vascular dementia in
dementia. The disease begins in the late 30s some people (Caine & Lyness, 2000).
or early 40s and may last 10 to 20 years or The prognosis for the progressive types of de-
more before death. mentia may vary as described above but all prognoses
Dementia can be a direct pathophysiologic involve progressive deterioration of physical and men-
consequence of head trauma. The degree and tal abilities until death. Typically in the latter stages,
type of cognitive impairment and behavioral clients have minimal cognitive and motor function,
disturbance depend on the location and are totally dependent on caregivers, and are unaware
extent of the brain injury. When it occurs of their surroundings or people in the environment.
as a single injury, the dementia is usually They may be totally uncommunicative or make un-
stable rather than progressive. Repeated intelligible sounds or attempts to verbalize.
head injury (for example, from boxing) may For degenerative dementias, no direct therapies
lead to progressive dementia. have been found to reverse or retard the fundamen-
An estimated 5 million people in the United States tal pathophysiologic processes (Caine & Lyness, 2000).
have moderate to severe dementia from various causes Levels of numerous neurotransmitters, such as acetyl-
(Alzheimers Association, 2002). Prevalence rises with choline, dopamine, norepinephrine, and serotonin,
age. Estimated prevalence of moderate to severe de- are decreased in dementia. This has led to attempts
mentia in people older than 65 years is about 5%. at replenishment therapy with acetylcholine pre-
Dementia of the Alzheimers type is the most common cursors, cholinergic agonists, and cholinesterase in-
type in North America, Scandinavia, and Europe; hibitors. Tacrine (Cognex), donepezil (Aricept), rivas-
vascular dementia is more prevalent in Russia and tigmine (Exelon), and galantamine (Reminyl) are
Japan. Dementia of the Alzheimers type is more com- cholinesterase inhibitors and have shown modest
mon in women; vascular dementia is more common therapeutic effects and temporarily slow the progress
in men. of dementia (Table 21-2). They have no effect, how-
ever, on the overall course of the disease. Tacrine ele-
Cultural Considerations vates liver enzymes in about 50% of clients using it;
therefore, liver function is assessed every 1 to 2 weeks.
Clients from other cultures may find the questions Clients with dementia demonstrate a broad range
used on many assessment tools for dementia difficult of behaviors that can be treated symptomatically.
or impossible to answer. Examples include the names Doses of medications are one-half to two-thirds lower
of former U.S. presidents. To avoid drawing erroneous than usually prescribed (Caine & Lyness, 2000). Anti-
conclusions, the nurse must be aware of differences depressants are effective for significant depressive
in the persons knowledge base. symptoms. Antipsychotics such as haloperidol (Hal-
The nurse also must be aware of different cul- dol), olanzapine (Zyprexa), risperidone (Risperdal),
turally influenced perspectives and beliefs about and quetiapine (Seroquel) may be used to manage
21 COGNITIVE DISORDERS 525
Table 21-2
DRUGS USED TO TREAT DEMENTIA
Name Dosage Range and Route Nursing Considerations
tacrine (Cognex) 40 160 mg orally per day Monitor liver enzymes for hepatoxic effects.
divided into 4 doses Monitor for flu-like symptoms.
donepezil (Aricept) 510 mg orally per day Monitor for nausea, diarrhea, and insomnia.
Test stools periodically for GI bleeding.
rivastigmine (Exelon) 312 mg orally per day divided Monitor for nausea, vomiting, abdominal pain,
into 2 doses and loss of appetite.
galantamine (Reminyl) 1632 mg orally per day divided Monitor for nausea, vomiting, loss of appetite,
into 2 doses dizziness, and syncope.
Adapted from Drug facts and comparisons. (2002). 56th ed. St. Louis: A Wolters Kluwer Company.
begin to demonstrate catastrophic emotional reactions pleasant. Clients are likely to believe the hallucina-
in response to environmental changes that clients tion is reality.
may not perceive or understand accurately or when
they cannot respond adaptively. These catastrophic
JUDGMENT AND INSIGHT
reactions may include verbal or physical aggression,
wandering at night, agitation, or other behaviors that Clients with dementia have poor judgment in light of
seem to indicate a loss of personal control. the cognitive impairment. They underestimate risks
Clients may display a pattern of withdrawal and unrealistically appraise their abilities, which re-
from the world they no longer understand. They are sults in a high risk for injury. Clients cannot evalu-
lethargic, look apathetic, and pay little attention to ate situations for risks or danger. For example, they
the environment or the people in it. They appear to may wander outside in the winter wearing only thin
lose all emotional affect and seem dazed and listless. nightclothes and not consider this to be a risk.
Insight is limited. Initially the client may be
aware of problems with memory and cognition and
THOUGHT PROCESS AND CONTENT
may worry that he or she is losing my mind. Quite
Initially the ability to think abstractly is impaired, quickly, these concerns over the ability to function
resulting in loss of the ability to plan, sequence, mon- diminish, and clients have little or no awareness of
itor, initiate, or stop complex behavior (APA, 2000). the more serious deficits that have developed. In this
The client loses the ability to solve problems or to context, clients may accuse others of stealing posses-
take action in new situations because he or she can- sions that have actually been lost or forgotten.
not think about what to do. The ability to generalize
knowledge from one situation to another is lost be-
SELF-CONCEPT
cause the client cannot recognize similarities or dif-
ferences in situations. These problems with cognition Initially clients may be angry or frustrated with them-
make it impossible for the employed client to con- selves for losing objects or forgetting important things.
tinue working. The clients ability to perform tasks Some clients express sadness at their bodies for get-
such as planning activities, budgeting, or planning ting old and at the loss of functioning. Soon, though,
meals is lost.
As the dementia progresses, delusions of perse-
cution are common. The client may accuse others of
stealing objects he or she has lost or may believe he
or she is being cheated or pursued.
SENSORIUM AND
INTELLECTUAL PROCESSES
Clients lose intellectual function, which eventually
involves the complete loss of their abilities. Memory
deficits are the initial and essential feature of de-
mentia. Dementia first affects recent and immediate
memory, then eventually impairs the ability to rec-
ognize close family members and even oneself. In mild
and moderate dementia, clients may make up answers
to fill in memory gaps (confabulation). Agnosia is
another hallmark of dementia. Clients lose visual spa-
tial relations, which is often evidenced by deteriora-
tion of the ability to write or draw simple objects.
Attention span and ability to concentrate are in-
creasingly impaired until clients lose the ability to do
either. Clients are chronically confused about the en-
vironment, other people, and eventually themselves.
Initially they are disoriented to time in mild demen-
tia, time and place in moderate dementia, and finally
to self in the severe stage.
Hallucinations are a frequent problem. Visual
hallucinations are most common and generally un- Judgment
21 COGNITIVE DISORDERS 527
and other people, and validating feelings and dignity A family member might say, Ill sit in the kitchen
of clients by being responsive to them, offering choices, and talk to you while you make lunch (suggesting col-
and reframing (technique in which the nurse offers laboration) rather than, You cant cook by yourself
alternative points of view to explain events) (Finnema because you might set the house on fire. In this way,
et al., 2000). This is in contrast to medical models the nurse or caregiver supports the clients desire and
of care that focus on progressive loss of function and ability to engage in certain tasks while providing pro-
identity. tection from injury.
Nurses can use the following interventions in Clients with dementia may believe that their
any setting for clients with dementia. Education for physical safety is jeopardized; they may feel threat-
family members caring for clients at home and for ened or suspicious and paranoid. These feelings can
professional caregivers in residential or skilled facil- lead to agitated or erratic behavior that compromises
ities is an essential component of providing safe and safety. Avoiding direct confrontation of the clients
supportive care. The discussion provides examples fears is important. Clients with dementia may strug-
that apply to various settings. gle with fears and suspicion throughout their illness.
Triggers of suspicion include strangers, changes in
the daily routine, or impaired memory. The nurse
PROMOTING THE CLIENTS SAFETY
must discover and address these environmental trig-
Safety considerations involve protecting against in- gers rather than confront the paranoid ideas.
jury, meeting physiologic needs, and managing risks For example, a client reports that his belongings
posed by the environment including internal stimuli have been stolen. The nurse might say, Lets go look
such as delusions and hallucinations. Clients cannot in your room and see whats there and help the client
accurately appraise the environment and their abil- to locate the misplaced or hidden items (suggesting
ities; therefore, they do not exercise normal caution collaboration). If the client is in a room with other
in daily life. For example, the client living at home people and says, Theyre here to take me away! the
may forget food cooking on the stove; the client liv- nurse might say, Those people are here visiting with
ing in a residential care setting may leave for a walk someone else. Lets go for a walk and let them visit
in cold weather without a coat and gloves. Assis- (presenting reality/distraction). The nurse then can
tance or supervision that is as unobtrusive as pos- take the client to a quieter and less stimulating place,
sible protects clients from injury while preserving which moves the client away from the environmental
their dignity. trigger (Boyd, 2001).
21 COGNITIVE DISORDERS 529
PROMOTING ADEQUATE SLEEP ical activities but cannot initiate, plan, or carry out
AND PROPER NUTRITION, those activities without assistance.
HYGIENE, AND ACTIVITY
Clients require assistance to meet basic physiologic STRUCTURING THE ENVIRONMENT
needs. The nurse monitors food and fluid intake to AND ROUTINE
ensure adequacy. Clients may eat poorly because of
A structured environment and established routines
limited appetite or distraction at mealtime. The nurse
can reassure clients with dementia. Familiar sur-
addresses this problem by providing foods clients like,
roundings and routines help to eliminate some con-
sitting with clients at meals to provide cues to con-
fusion and frustration from memory loss. Providing
tinue eating, having nutritious snacks available when-
routines and structure, however, does not mean forc-
ever clients are hungry, and minimizing noise and ing clients to conform to the structure of the setting
undue distraction at mealtimes. Clients who have dif- or routines that other people determine. Rather than
ficulty manipulating utensils may be unable to cut impose new structure, the nurse encourages clients
meat or other foods into bite-size pieces. The food to follow their usual routine and habits of bathing
should be cut up when it is prepared, not in front and dressing (Engelman et al., 2002). For example, it
of clients, to deflect attention from their inability to is important to know whether a client prefers a tub
do so. Food that can be eaten without utensils or bath or shower and washes at night or in the morn-
finger foods such as sandwiches and fresh fruit may ing and to include those preferences in the clients
be best. care. Research has shown that attempting to change
In contrast, clients may eat too much, even in- the dressing behavior of clients may result in physi-
gesting inedible items. Providing low-calorie snacks, cal aggression as clients make ineffective attempts to
such as carrot and celery sticks, can satisfy the desire resist unwanted changes (Allen-Burge et al., 1999).
to chew and eat without unnecessary weight gain. Monitoring response to daily routines and making
Enteral nutrition often becomes necessary when needed adjustments are important aspects of care.
dementia is most severe, although not all families The nurse needs to monitor and manage the
choose to use tube feedings. clients tolerance of stimulation. Generally clients
Adequate intake of fluids and food is also neces- can tolerate less stimulation when they are fatigued,
sary for proper elimination. Clients may fail to re- hungry, or stressed. Also, with the progression of
spond to cues indicating constipation, so the nurse or dementia, tolerance for environmental stimuli de-
caregiver monitors the clients bowel elimination pat- creases. As this tolerance diminishes, clients need a
terns and intervenes with increased fluids and fiber quieter environment with fewer people and less noise
or prompts as needed. Urinary elimination can be- or distraction.
come a problem if clients do not respond to the urge
to void or are incontinent. Reminders to urinate may
be helpful when clients are still continent but not ini- PROVIDING EMOTIONAL SUPPORT
tiating use of the bathroom. Sanitary pads can ad- The therapeutic relationship between client and nurse
dress dribbling or stress incontinence; adult diapers, involves empathic caring (Williams & Tappen, 1999),
rather than indwelling catheters, are indicated for which includes being kind, respectful, calm, and re-
incontinence. The nurse checks disposable pads and assuring and paying attention to the client. Nurses
diapers frequently and changes soiled items promptly use these same qualities with many different clients
to avoid infection, skin irritation, and unpleasant in various settings. In most situations, clients give
odors. It is also important to provide good hygiene to positive feedback to the nurse or caregiver, but clients
minimize these risks. with dementia often seem to ignore the nurses efforts
Balance between rest and activity is an essential and may even respond with negative behavior such
component of the daily routine. Mild physical activ- as anger or suspicion. This makes it more difficult
ity such as walking promotes physical health but is for the nurse or caregiver to sustain caring behavior.
not a cognitive challenge. Daily physical activity also Nevertheless, nurses and caregivers must maintain
helps clients to sleep at night. The nurse provides rest all the qualities of the therapeutic relationship even
periods so clients can conserve and regain energy, when clients do not seem to respond.
but extensive daytime napping may interfere with Because of their disorientation and memory loss,
nighttime sleep. The nurse encourages clients to en- clients with dementia often become anxious and re-
gage in physical activity because they may not initi- quire much patience and reassurance (Williams &
ate such activities independently; many clients tend Tappen, 1999). The nurse can convey reassurance by
to become sedentary as cognitive abilities diminish. approaching the client in a calm, supportive manner
Clients often are quite willing to participate in phys- as if nurse and client are a teama we can do it
530 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
together approach. The nurse reassures the client esteem as clients discuss accomplishments. Active lis-
that he or she knows what is happening and can take tening, asking questions, and providing cues to con-
care of things when the client is confused and cannot tinue will promote successful use of this technique.
do so. For example, if the client is confused about get- Clients have increasing problems interacting with
ting dressed, the nurse might say, Ill be glad to help others as dementia progresses. Initially clients retain
you with that shirt. Ill hold it for you while you put verbal language skills, but other people may find them
your arms in the sleeves (offering self /suggesting difficult to understand as words are lost or content
collaboration). becomes vague. The nurse must listen carefully to
Supportive touch is effective with many clients. the client and try to determine the meaning behind
Touch can provide reassurance and convey caring what is being said. The nurse might say, Are you
when words may not be understood. Holding the hand trying to say you want to use the bathroom? or Did
of the client who is tearful and sad and tucking the I get that right, you are hungry? (seeking clarifica-
client into bed at night are examples of ways to use tion). It is also important not to interrupt clients or
supportive touch. As with any use of touch, the nurse to finish their thoughts. If a client becomes frustrated
must evaluate each clients response. Clients who when the nurse cannot understand his or her mean-
respond positively will smile or move closer toward ing, the nurse might say, Can you show me what
the nurse. Those who are threatened by physical you mean or where you want to go? (assisting to take
touch will look frightened or pull away from the nurse action).
especially if the touch is sudden or unexpected or if When verbal language becomes less coherent,
the client misperceives the nurses intent. the nurse should remain alert to the clients non-
verbal behavior. When nurses or caregivers consis-
tently work with a particular client, they develop the
PROMOTING INTERACTION
ability to determine the clients meaning through non-
AND INVOLVEMENT
verbal behavior. For example, if the client becomes
In a psychosocial model of dementia care, the nurse restless, it may indicate that he or she is hungry if it
or caregiver plans activities that reinforce the clients is close to mealtime or tired if it is late in the evening.
identity and keep him or her engaged and involved in Sometimes it is impossible to determine exactly what
the business of living (Allen-Burge et al., 1999). The the client is trying to convey, but the nurse can still be
nurse or caregiver tailors these activities to the clients responsive. For example, a client is pacing and looks
interests and abilities: they should not be routine upset but cannot indicate what is bothering her. The
group activities that everyone is supposed to do. nurse says, You look worried. I dont know whats
For example, a client with an interest in history may wrong, but lets go for a walk (making an observation/
enjoy documentary programs on television; a client offering self).
who likes music may enjoy singing. Clients often need Interacting with clients with dementia often
the involvement of another person to sustain atten- means dealing with thoughts and feelings that are
tion in the activity and to enjoy it more fully. Those not based in reality but arise from the clients suspi-
who have long periods without anything to engage cion or chronic confusion. Rather than attempting to
their interest are more likely to become restless and explain reality or allay suspicion or anger, it is often
agitated. Clients engaged in activities are more likely useful to employ the techniques of distraction, time
to stay calm. away, or going along to reassure the client (Finnema
Reminiscence therapy (thinking about or et al., 2000).
relating personally significant past experiences) is Distraction involves shifting the clients atten-
an effective intervention for clients with dementia tion and energy to a more neutral topic. For example,
(Spector, Orrell, Davies & Woods, 2000). Rather than the client may display a catastrophic reaction to the
lamenting that the client is living in the past, this current situation such as jumping up from dinner
therapy encourages family and caregivers also to and saying, My food tastes like poison! The nurse
reminisce with the client. Reminiscing uses the clients might intervene with distraction by saying, Can you
remote memory, which is not affected as severely or come to the kitchen with me and find something youd
quickly as recent or immediate memory. Photo albums like to eat? or You can leave that food. Can you come
may be useful in stimulating remote memory, and and help me find a good program on television?
they provide a focus on the clients past. Sometimes (redirection/distraction). Clients usually calm down
clients like to reminisce about local or national events when the nurse directs their attention away from the
and talk about their role or what they were doing at triggering situation.
the time. In addition to keeping clients involved in the Time away involves leaving clients for a short
business of living, reminiscence also can build self- period then returning to them to re-engage in inter-
21 COGNITIVE DISORDERS 531
action. For example, the client may get angry and has responded effectively to the clients worry without
yell at the nurse for no discernible reason. The nurse addressing the reality of the clients concern. Going
can leave the client for about 5 or 10 minutes then along is a specific intervention for clients with demen-
return without referring to the previous outburst. tia and should not be used with those experiencing
The client may have little or no memory of the inci- delusions whose conditions are expected to improve.
dent and may be pleased to see the nurse on his or The nurse can use reframing techniques to offer
her return. clients different points of view or explanations for sit-
Going along means providing emotional re- uations or events. Because of their perceptual difficul-
assurance to clients without correcting their misper- ties and confusion, clients frequently interpret envi-
ception or delusion. The nurse does not engage in delu- ronmental stimuli as threatening. Loud noises often
sional ideas or reinforce them, but he or she does not frighten and agitate them. For example, one client
deny or confront their existence. For example, a client may interpret anothers yelling as a direct personal
is fretful, repeatedly saying, Im so worried about the threat. The nurse can provide an alternative explana-
children. I hope theyre OK, and speaking as though tion such as That lady has many family problems,
his adult children were small and needed protection. and she yells sometimes because shes frustrated (re-
The nurse could reassure the client by saying, Theres framing). Alternative explanations often reassure
no need to worry; the children are just fine (going clients with dementia, who become less frightened
along), which is likely to calm the client. The nurse and agitated (Allen-Burge et al., 1999).
Nursing Diagnosis
Impaired Memory
Inability to remember or recall bits of information or behavioral skills.
Encourage the client to use written cues such as a Written cues decrease the clients need to recall
calendar, lists, or a notebook. appointments, activities, and so on without
assistance.
Keep environmental changes to a necessary mini- There is less demand on memory function when
mum. Determine practical and convenient loca- structure is incorporated in the clients environ-
tions for the clients possessions, and return items ment and daily routine.
to this location after use. Establish a usual rou-
tine of activities and alter the routine only when
necessary.
Provide single step instructions for the client Clients with memory impairment cannot remem-
when instructions are needed. ber multistep instructions.
Provide verbal connections between implements Giving the client an implement while stating its
and their functions rather than assuming the related function is an approach that compensates
client will know what is expected of him or her. for memory loss.
For example, Here is a washcloth to wash your
face, Here is a spoon you can use to eat your
dessert.
Integrate reminders of previous events into cur- Providing links with previous behaviors helps the
rent interactions such as Earlier you put some client to make connections that he or she may not
clothes in the washing machine, its time to put be able to make independently.
them in the dryer.
Increase assistance with tasks as needed, but do It is important to maximize independent function
not rush to do things for the client that he or and to unobtrusively assist the client when mem-
she can still do independently. ory function has deteriorated further.
Use a matter-of-fact approach when assuming It is important to preserve the clients dignity and
tasks the client can no longer perform. Do not minimize his or her frustration with progressive
allow the client to work unsuccessfully at any memory loss.
given task for an extended period of time.
Adapted from Schultz, J. M. & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts Manual of Psychiatric Nursing Care Plans (6th ed.). Philadelphia:
Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Caring for clients with dementia can be emotion- Supporting the caregiver is an important com-
ally and physically exhausting and stressful. Care- ponent of providing care to clients with dementia at
givers may need to drastically change their own lives, home. Caregivers must have an ongoing relationship
such as quitting a job, to provide care. Caregivers with a knowledgeable health professional; the clients
may have young children as well. They often feel ex- physician can make referrals to other health care
hausted and as if they are on duty 24 hours a day. providers. Depending on the situation, that person
Caregivers caring for parents may have difficulty may be a nurse, care manager, or social worker. This
being in charge of their mothers or fathers (role re- person can provide information, support, and assis-
versal). They may feel uncomfortable or depressed tance during the time that home care is provided.
about having to bathe, feed, or change diapers for Caregivers need education about dementia and the
parents. type of care that clients need. Caregivers should use
Role strain is identified when the demands of the interventions previously discussed to promote the
providing care threaten to overwhelm a caregiver. clients well being, deal with deficits and limitations,
Indications of role strain include constant fatigue and maximize the quality of the clients life. Because
that is unrelieved by rest, increased use of alcohol the care that clients need change as the dementia pro-
or other drugs, social isolation, inattention to per- gresses, this education by the nurse, care manager, or
sonal needs, and inability or unwillingness to accept social worker is ongoing.
help from others. Caregivers may feel unappreci- Caregivers need outlets for dealing with their
ated by other family members as indicated by state- own feelings. Support groups can help them to ex-
ments such as No one ever asks how I am! (Small, press frustration, sadness, anger, guilt, or ambiva-
2000). In some situations, role strain can contribute lence; all these feelings are common. Attending a sup-
to the neglect or abuse of clients with dementia (see port group regularly also means that caregivers have
Chap. 11). time with people who understand the many demands
21 COGNITIVE DISORDERS 535
of caring for a family member with dementia (Fung stroke or other cerebrovascular events, head injury,
& Chien, 2002). The clients physician can provide in- and neurotoxic exposures such as carbon monoxide
formation about support groups and the local chap- poisoning, chronic alcohol ingestion, and vitamin B12
ter of the National Alzheimers Disease Association or thiamine deficiency. Alcohol-induced amnestic dis-
is listed in the phone book. Area hospitals and public order results from a chronic thiamine or vitamin B
health agencies also can help caregivers to locate deficiency called Korsakoffs syndrome.
community resources. The main difference between dementia and
Caregivers should be able to seek and accept as- amnestic disorders is that once the underlying med-
sistance from other people or agencies. Often care- ical cause is treated or removed, the clients condition
givers think that others may not be able to provide no longer deteriorates. Treatment of amnestic dis-
care as well as they do or say they will seek help orders focuses on eliminating the underlying cause
when they really need it. Caregivers must maintain and rehabilitating the client and includes prevent-
their own well-being and not wait until they are ex- ing further medical problems. Some amnestic dis-
hausted before seeking relief. Sometimes family mem- orders improve over time when the underlying cause
bers disagree about care for the client. The primary is stabilized. Other clients have persistent impairment
caregiver may feel as if other family members should of memory and attention with minimal improvement;
volunteer to help without being asked, but other this can occur in cases of chronic alcohol ingestion or
family members feel that the primary caregiver malnutrition. Nursing diagnoses and interventions
chose to take on the responsibility and do not feel ob- are similar to those used when dealing with the mem-
ligated to help out regularly. Whatever the feelings ory loss, confusion, and impaired attention abilities
are among family members, it is important for them of clients with dementia or delirium (see the display
all to express their feelings and ideas and participate on nursing interventions for dementia).
in caregiving according to their own expectations.
Many families need assistance to reach this type of
compromise. SELF-AWARENESS ISSUES
Finally caregivers need support to maintain a
Working with and caring for clients with
personal life. They need to continue to socialize with
dementia can be exhausting and frustrating for both
friends and to engage in leisure activities or hobbies
nurse and caregiver. Teaching is a fundamental role
rather than focus solely on the clients care. Care-
for nurses, but teaching clients who have dementia
givers who are rested, happy, and have met their
can be especially challenging and frustrating. These
own needs are better prepared to manage the rigor-
clients do not retain explanations or instructions, so
ous demands of the caregiver role. Most caregivers
the nurse must repeat the same things continually.
need to be reminded to take care of themselves; this
act is not selfish but really in the clients best long- The nurse must be careful not to lose patience and
term interests. not to give up on these clients. The nurse may begin
to feel that repeating instructions or explanations
does no good because clients do not understand or
RELATED DISORDERS remember them. Discussing these frustrations with
Amnestic disorders are characterized by a distur- others can help the nurse to avoid conveying negative
bance in memory that results directly from the physi- feelings to clients and families or experiencing pro-
ologic effects of a general medical condition or the per- fessional and personal burnout.
sisting effects of a substance such as alcohol or other The nurse may get little or no positive response
drugs (APA, 2000). The memory disturbance is suffi- or feedback from clients with dementia. It can be dif-
ciently severe to cause marked impairment in social ficult to deal with feelings about caring for people
or occupational functioning and represents a signifi- who will never get better and go home. As dementia
cant decline from previous functioning. Confusion, progresses, clients may seem not to hear or respond
disorientation, and attentional deficits are common. to anything the nurse does. It is sad and frustrating
Clients with amnestic disorders are similar to those for the nurse to see clients decline and eventually lose
with dementia in terms of memory deficits, confusion, their abilities to manage basic self-care activities and
and problems with attention. They do not, however, interaction with others. Remaining positive and sup-
have the multiple cognitive deficits seen in dementia portive to clients and family can be difficult when the
such as aphasia, apraxia, agnosia, and impaired exec- outcome is so bleak. In addition, the progressive de-
utive functions. cline may last months or years, which adds to the
Several medical conditions can cause brain dam- frustration and sadness. The nurse may need to deal
age and result in an amnestic disorderfor example, with personal feelings of depression and grief as the
536 Unit 4 NURSING PRACTICE FOR PSYCHIATRIC DISORDERS
I N T E R N E T R E S O U R C E S
Resource Internet Address
safety, structure, support, interpersonal nal of Alzheimers Disease and Other Dementias,
involvement, and social interaction. 17(1), 3743.
Finnema, E., Droes, R. M., Ribbe, M., & Van Tilburg, W.
Many clients with dementia receive care at
(2000). The effects of emotion-oriented approaches in
home rather than in institutional settings the care of persons suffering from dementia: A review
(e.g., nursing homes). The caregiver role of the literature. International Journal of Geriatric
(often assumed by a spouse or adult child) Psychiatry, 15(2), 141161.
can be physically and emotionally exhaust- Fung, W. Y., & Chien, W. T. (2002). The effectiveness of a
ing and stressful; this contributes to care- mutual support group for family caregivers of a rela-
tive with dementia. Archives of Psychiatric Nursing,
giver role strain. To deal with the exhausting 16(3), 134144.
demands of this role, family caregivers need Lo, R., & Brown, R. (2000). Caring for family carers and
ongoing education and support from a health people with dementia. The International Journal of
care professional such as a nurse, social Psychiatric Nursing Research, 6(2), 684694.
worker, or case manager. Loscalzo, J. (2002). Homocysteine and dementias. New
England Journal of Medicine, 346(7), 466468.
Caregivers must learn how to meet the clients Maxmen, J. S., & Ward, N. G. (2002). Psychotropic drugs:
physiologic and emotional needs and to pro- Fast facts (3rd ed.). New York: W. W. Norton &
tect him or her from injury. Areas for teaching Company.
include monitoring the clients health, avoid- Schultz, J. M., & Videbeck, S. L. (2002). Lippincotts
ing alcohol and recreational drugs, ensuring manual of psychiatric nursing care plans (6th ed.).
Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
adequate nutrition, scheduling regular check- Seshadri, S., Beiser, A., Selhub, J., Jacques, P. F.,
ups, getting adequate rest, promoting activity Rosenberg, I. H., DAgostino, R. B., Wilson, P. F.,
and socialization, and helping the client to & Wolf, P. A. (2002). Plasma homocysteine as a risk
maintain independence as much as possible. factor for dementia and Alzheimers disease. New
The therapeutic relationship with clients England Journal of Medicine, 346(7), 476483.
Small, G. W. (2000). Alzheimers disease and other
with dementia is supportive and protective
dementias. In B. J. Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.),
and recognizes the clients individuality Comprehensive textbook of psychiatry, Vol. 2 (7th ed.,
and dignity. pp. 30683085). Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams &
For further learning, visit http://connection.lww.com. Wilkins.
Spector, A., Orrell, M., Davies, S., & Woods, R. T. (2000).
Reminiscence therapy for dementia. Cochrane Data-
REFERENCES base Systematic Reviews, 4, CD001120.
Williams, C. L., & Tappen, R. M. (1999). Can we create a
Allen-Burge, R., Stevens, A. B., & Burgio, L. D. (1999). therapeutic relationship with nursing home residents
Effective behavioral interventions for decreasing in the later stages of Alzheimers disease? Journal of
dementia-related challenging behavior in nursing Psychosocial Nursing, 37(3), 2835.
homes. International Journal of Geriatric Psychiatry,
14, 213232.
Alzheimers Association Mid-Iowa Chapter. (2002). ADDITIONAL READINGS
Des Moines, IA.
American Psychiatric Association. (2000). DSM-IV-TR: Hawranik, P. G., & Strain, L. A. (2001). Cognitive
Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental disorders- impairment, disruptive behavior, and home care
text revision (4th ed.). Washington, DC: Author. utilization. Western Journal of Nursing Research,
Boyd, M. A. (2001). Behavioral disturbances associated 23(2), 148162.
with dementia: Nursing implications. Journal of the Keough, J., & Huebner, R. A. (2000). Treating dementia:
American Psychiatric Nurses Association, 7(6), The complementing team approach of occupational
S14S22. therapy and psychology. The Journal of Psychology,
Caine, E. D., & Lyness, J. M. (2000). Delirium, dementia, 134(4), 375391.
and amnestic and other cognitive disorders. In B. J. Neelon, V. J., Champagne, M. T., Carlson, J. R., & Funk,
Sadock & V. A. Sadock (Eds.), Comprehensive text- S. G. (1996). The NEECHAM confusion scale: Con-
book of psychiatry, Vol. 1 (7th ed., pp. 854923). struction, validation, and clinical testing. Nursing
Philadelphia: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins. Research, 45(6), 324330.
Engelman, K. K., Matthews, R. M., & Altus, D. E. (2002). Schindler, R. J., & Cucio, C. P. (2000). Late-life dementia:
Restoring dressing independence in persons with Review of the APA guidelines for patient manage-
Alzheimers disease: A pilot study. American Jour- ment. Geriatrics, 55(10), 5562.
Chapter
ChapterStudy
Review
Guide
MULTIPLE-CHOICE QUESTIONS
Select the best answer for each of the following
questions.
1. The nurse is talking with a woman who is B. I will keep Mother busy with favorite activi-
worried that her mother has Alzheimers ties as long as she can participate.
disease. The nurse knows that the first sign C. I will try to find new and different things to
of dementia is do every day.
A. Disorientation to person, place, or time D. I will encourage Mother to talk about her
B. Memory loss that is more than ordinary friends and family.
forgetfulness
5. A client with delirium is attempting to remove
C. Inability to perform self-care tasks without
the intravenous tubing from his arm, saying to
assistance
the nurse, Get off me! Go away! The client is
D. Variable with different people experiencing which of the following?
A. Delusions
2. The nurse has been teaching a caregiver about
donepezil (Aricept). The nurse knows that teach- B. Hallucinations
ing has been effective by which of the following C. Illusions
statements?
D. Disorientation
A. Lets hope this medication will stop the
Alzheimers disease from progressing any 6. Which of the following statements indicates the
further. caregivers accurate knowledge about the needs
B. It is important to take this medication on of a parent at the onset of stage moderate
an empty stomach. dementia?
C. Ill be eager to see if this medication makes A. I need to give my parent a bath at the same
any improvement in concentration. time every day.
D. This medication will slow the progress of B. I need to postpone any vacations for 5 years.
Alzheimers disease temporarily. C. I need to spend time with my parent doing
things we both enjoy.
3. When teaching a client about tacrine (Cognex),
D. I need to stay with my parent 24 hours a day
the nurse will include which of the following?
for supervision.
A. Taking tacrine can increase the risk for
elevated liver enzymes. 7. Which of the following interventions is most
B. Tacrine causes agranulocytosis in some appropriate in helping a client with early stage
clients. dementia complete ADLs?
C. The most common side effect is skin rash. A. Allow enough time for the client to complete
ADLs as independently as possible.
D. Tacrine has no known serious side effects.
B. Provide the client with a written list of all the
4. Which of the following statements by the care- steps needed to complete ADLs.
giver of a client newly diagnosed with dementia C. Plan to provide step-by-step prompting to
requires further intervention by the nurse? complete the ADLs.
A. I will remind Mother of things she has D. Tell the client to finish ADLs before breakfast
forgotten. or the nursing assistant will do them.
538
8. A client with late moderate stage dementia
has been admitted to a long-term care facility.
Which of the following nursing interventions will
help the client to maintain optimal cognitive
function?
A. Discuss pictures of children and grandchil-
dren with the client.
B. Do word games or crossword puzzles with the
client.
C. Provide the client with a written list of daily
activities.
D. Watch and discuss the evening news with the
client.
FILL-IN-THE-BLANK QUESTIONS
Identify each of the following behaviors as occurring primarily in delirium
or dementia.
Tactile hallucinations
Slurred speech
Chronic confusion
SHORT-ANSWER QUESTIONS
Describe each of the following interventions for a client with dementia,
and give an example.
Distraction
539
Time away
Going along
Reminiscence
540
CLINICAL EXAMPLE
Martha Smith, a 79-year-old widow with Alzheimers disease, was admitted to
a nursing home. The disease has progressed over the past 4 years to the point
that she can no longer live alone in her own house. Martha has poor judgment
and no short-term memory. She had stopped paying bills, preparing meals, and
cleaning her home. She had become increasingly suspicious of her visiting nurse
and home health aide, finally refusing to allow them in the house.
Following her arrival at the facility, Martha has been sleeping poorly and fre-
quently wanders from her room in the middle of the night. She seems agitated
and afraid in the dining room at mealtimes, is eating very little, and has lost
weight. If left alone, Martha would wear the same clothing day and night and
would not attend to her personal hygiene.
1. What additional assessments would the nurse want to make to plan care
for this client?
2. What nursing diagnoses would the nurse identify for this client?
541
3. Write an expected outcome and at least two interventions for each nursing
diagnosis.
542